SlideShare a Scribd company logo
LM-Cookery Grade 10
1
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Page
Cover Page
Table of Contents
Introduction......................................................................................4
Content Standard and Performance Standard............................5
Objectives...................................................................................5
Program Requirements...............................................................5
Learning Episodes ......................................................................6
How to Use the Module...............................................................7
Diagnostic Assessment ..................................................................8
Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies (PECs)..........................13
Environment and Market (EM)........................................................27
Quarter I Egg, Cereal, and Starch Dishes
Overview.....................................................................................49
Objectives...................................................................................49
Pre-Test 1...................................................................................49
Lesson 1 Prepare Egg Dishes
LO 1 Perform Mise‘en Place.................................................53
LO 2 Prepare and Cook egg Dishes…..................................64
LO 3 Present Egg dishes… ..................................................85
LO 4 Storing Egg Dishes…...................................................100
Lesson 2 Prepare Cereals and Starch Dishes
LO 1 Perform Mise‘en Place.................................................103
LO 2 Prepare Starch and Cereal Dishes… ...........................113
LO 3 Present Starch and Cereal Dishes… ...........................124
LO 4 Store Starch and Cereal Dishes… ...............................131
Enhancement Activity… ................................................................135
Post Test 1...................................................................................137
Quarter II Vegetable and Seafood Dishes
Overview .....................................................................................141
Objectives ...................................................................................141
Pre-Test 2 ...................................................................................141
Lesson 1 Prepare Vegetable Dishes
LO 1 Perform Mise‘ En Place................................................145
LO 2 Prepare Vegetable Dishes…........................................166
LM-Cookery Grade 10
2
LO 3 Present Vegetable Dishes ........................................... 185
LO 4 Store Vegetable Dishes ............................................... 191
Lesson 2 Prepare and Cook Seafood Dishes
LO 1 Perform Mise‘ En Place………………………………… 193
LO 2 Handle Seafood Dishes……………………………….. 200
LO 3 Cook Seafood...………………………… ……………… 205
LO 4 Plate/Present Seafood Dishes…………………………. 226
LO 5 Store Seafood……………….…………………………… 232
Enhancement Activity .................................................................234
Post Test 2 ............................................................................... 235
Quarter III Stocks, Sauces, Soups and Poultry Dishes
Overview ………………………………………………………… 238
Objectives................................................................................... 238
Pre-Test 3................................................................................... 238
Lesson 1 Prepare Stocks, Sauces and Soups
LO 1 Prepare Stocks Required for Menu Items…................. 242
LO 2 Prepare Soups Required for Menu Items..................... 255
LO 3 Prepare Sauces Required for Menu Items… ............... 271
LO 4 Store and Reconstitute Stocks, Sauces and Soups… 284
Lesson 2 Prepare Poultry Dishes
LO 1 Perform Mise‘ En Place ............................................... 287
LO 2 Cook Poultry Dishes…................................................. 297
LO 3 Plate/Present Poultry Dishes….................................... 313
LO 4 Store Poultry................................................................ 320
Enhancement Activity…………………………………………….
Post Test 3.................................................................................. 326
Quarter IV Meat Dishes
Overview .................................................................................... 329
Objectives................................................................................... 329
Pre-Test 4................................................................................... 329
Lesson 1 Prepare and Cook Meat Dishes
LO 1 Perform Mise‘en Place………………………………. 333
LO 2 Cook Meat………………….…..…………………….. 340
LO 3 Plate/Present desserts………….……..……………. 365
LO 4 Store Meat……………………………………………. 375
Enhancement Activity…………………………………………….
Post Test ……………………………………………………….. 382
LM-Cookery Grade 10
3
Summative Test…………………………………………………….. 387
Synthesis ………..………………………………………………. 392
Glossary ………………………………………………………… 393
References…….…………………………………………………… 397
Key to Correction ………………………………………………… 403
LM-Cookery Grade 10
4
Introduction
Technology and Livelihood Education (TLE) is one nomenclature in the
implementation of the K to 12 Basic Education Program (BEP). It is
composed of four components, namely, Agri-Fishery Arts, Home Economics,
Industrial Arts and Information and Communication Technology. In this
learning material, the focus is on a course in Home Economics – Cookery.
The course provides varied and relevant activities and opportunities to
determine your understanding of the key concepts and to demonstrate core
competencies as prescribed in TESDA Training Regulation in Cookery. Thus,
it aims to provide quality service to target clients alongside of assessing
yourself as to the aspects of business that you may consider to strengthen
and become part of the food provider sector.
The world of work today presents a picture of available jobs that are
getting scarcer each year. To address this reality, the Department of
Education is stretching its available resources, prioritizing needs, and
developing sustainable programs to lead and to prepare the young minds as
future skillful chef or any related job. The department further believes that it is
in honing the skills that the learner can have an edge over other job seekers.
DepEd endeavors to equip the learners with the appropriate knowledge,
attitudes, values and skills necessary to become productive citizen of our
society.
This learner‘s material is specifically crafted to focus on the different
activities that will assess your level in terms of skills and knowledge
necessary to get a Certificate of Competency and/or National Certification.
This learner‘s material will surely make you a certified food provider.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
5
Content Standard
The learner demonstrates understanding of core concepts and theories
in cookery lessons.
Performance Standard
The learner independently demonstrates core competencies in cookery
as prescribed in the TESDA Training Regulation.
Objectives
Learners are expected to become proficient in performing skills on the
following competencies:
1. develop personal entrepreneurial skills;
2. prepare egg dishes;
3. prepare cereals and starch dishes;
4. prepare vegetables dishes;
5. prepare and cook seafood dishes;
6. prepare stocks, sauces and soups;
7. prepare poultry and game dishes; and
8. prepare and cook meat.
Program Requirements
Grade 10 students who will take Cookery course as their specialization
in Technology and Livelihood Education (TLE) – Home Economics should
have successfully taken the exploratory course in Commercial Cooking in
Grade 7/8 and have successfully completed the competencies indicated in
Grade 9.
The student of this course must possess the following characteristic:
1. incline in cooking and other cooking-related activities;
2. can communicate both in oral and written;
3. physically and mentally fit;
4. with good moral character; and
5. can perform basic mathematical computation.
Learners are expected to develop their knowledge and skills in
Cookery, demonstrate mise ‘en place, cook, present and evaluate egg, starch
and cereal, vegetable, stocks, sauces and soups, poultry and game, and
meat dishes.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
6
This learner‘s material should be taken for one school year for a total
of 160 hours. Lessons should be taken one at a time, following the correct
sequence being presented and should accomplish the assessment or
enhancement activities before proceeding to the next lesson.
Along the learning process, learners of this course are required to
complete the 25-hour industry involvement to different food services to
experience the actual workplace.
Learning Episodes
This learner‘s material is subdivided into four (4) quarters which may
serve as the recommended scope and limit for every academic grading
period. In every quarter there are lessons that comprise the learning
outcomes.
Before exploring the core competencies of Cookery, you will be guided
on how to assess your own Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies and
Skills (PECS) and demonstrate your understanding about the Environment
and Market.
Quarter I is compose of two lessons. Lesson I is all about preparation,
cooking and presenting different kinds of egg dishes while Lesson II is on
cereals and starch dishes.
Quarter II has two lessons, the preparation of vegetable dishes and
seafood dishes. Learn the different kinds and classifications of vegetables
and seafood, cooking, plating dishes and storing food items.
Quarter III consists of lessons on preparing stocks, sauces and soups,
and poultry and game dishes.
Quarter IV covers lessons on how to prepare and cook different kinds
of meat like pork, beef, carabeef and others.
Enjoy using this learner‘s material as your guide to become a
successful chef in the future.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
7
HOW TO USE THIS LEARNER’S MATERIAL?
Here are some reminders on how to use this material.
1. Answer the diagnostic assessment before you proceed to the different
activities. The diagnostic assessment determines how much you know
about the lessons and identifies the areas you ought to learn more. Your
teacher will check and analyze your score to determine your learning
needs.
2. This learner‘s material contains relevant information and activities. Go
over each activity carefully. If you encounter difficulties, do not hesitate to
consult your teacher for assistance. Do not skip any topic unless you are
told to do so. REMEMBER that each activity is a preparation for the
succeeding activities.
3. For every lesson/learning outcomes, perform the enhancement activities
to enrich the knowledge and skills.
4. After successfully finished the tasks, answer the post-test to be given by
your teacher. Your score will be analyzed and will be used by your
teacher for the computation of your grades.
5. Lastly, DO NOT marks the learner‘s material in any way.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
8
A. Multiple Choice.
Directions: Read the following questions carefully and choose the
letter that best describes the statement. Write your answer on your
test notebook.
1. Which of the following is the right step by step procedures in manual
dishwashing.
A. Drain and air-dry, scrape and pre-rinse, rinse, sanitize, and wash
dishes.
B. Rinse, scrape and pre-rinse, wash, drain, air-dry and sanitize dishes
C.Scrape and pre-rinse, rinse, wash, sanitize, drain and air-dry dishes
D.Scrape and pre-rinse, wash, rinse, sanitize, drain and air-dry dishes
2. Which of the following parts of an egg is produced by the oviduct and
consist of four alternating layers of thick and thin consistencies.
A. Air cell C. Chalaza
B. Albumen D. Yolk
3. Which of the following vitamins is found in eggs?
A. B1 C. D
B. C D. K
4. The appearance of egg is important for consumer appeal. ON what basis
are shells evaluated?
A. cleanliness, shape, texture and soundness
B. grade, texture, cleanliness, shape
C. shape, texture, cleanliness and size
D. texture, soundness, size and cleanliness
5. Which of the following market forms of eggs is seldom used in cooking.
A. Dried egg C. Frozen egg
B. Fresh egg D. Shelled egg
6. Which of the following raises coagulation temperature producing softer,
weaker gel when added to egg used in culinary.
A. Alkali C. Sugar
B. Salt D. Vinegar
7. Which kind of egg dish is prepared by slipping shelled eggs into barely
simmering water and gently cooking until the egg holds its shape?
A. Fried egg C. Scrambled egg
B. Poached egg D. Soft-boiled egg
DIAGNOSTIC ASSESSMENT
LM-Cookery Grade 10
9
8. Which of the following tools is not used in cooking omelet?
A. Bowls C. Sauté pan
B. Fork D. Skimmer
9. Which of the following is true in plating egg dishes?
A. Choose serving dish small enough to let each food item stand out
B. Play with color and texture
C. Protein dish should cover half of the plate
D. Use even numbers in setting the dish.
10.Which of the following sources of starch is rarely used in manufacturing
food starch?
A. Cassava C. Potato
B. Corn D. Rice
11. Which of the following changes in starch during cooking is the resistance
to flow; increase in thickness or consistency.
A. Dextrinization C. Retrogadation
B. Gelatinization D. Viscosity
12. Which of the following is suggested if you will hold pasta for a short time
for later service?
A. Cook pasta ahead of time and chill
B. Drain and add sauce
C. Drain, toss with a small amount of oil, cover and hold in warmer
D. Undercook slightly the pasta
13.Which is the process of making a new product to be sold to the
customers?
A. Product Analysis C. Product Development
B. Product Conceptualization D. Product Implementation
14. This is a meaningful and unforgettable statement that captures the
essence of your brand.
A. Branding C. Tagline
B. Product Naming D. Unique Selling Proposition
15.What managerial tool is used to assess the environment to gather
important information for strategic planning?
A. Environmental Scanning C. Survey Analysis
B. SWOT Analysis D.WOTS Analysis
16. What animal produces veal meat?
A. Calf C. Hog
B. Deer D. Sheep
17. Which of the following market forms of meat does not undergo chilling?
A. Cured meat C. Frozen meat
B. Fresh meat D. Processed meat
LM-Cookery Grade 10
10
18. What part of the meat helps you identify the less tender cuts?
A. Bone C. Flesh
B. Fat D. Ligament
19. What part of the meat has the greatest amount of quality protein?
A. Bone C. Flesh
B. Fat D. Ligament
20. Which of the following meat cuts requires long and slow cooking
temperature?
A. Less tender C. Tender
B. Slightly tough D. Tough
21. Which of the following is a long – bladed hatchet or a heavy knife used by
a butcher?
A. Butchers knife C. Cleaver knife
B. Chopper knife D. Set of slicing knife
22. Which of the cooking methods does not belong to dry heat method?
A. Baking C. Roasting
B. Broiling D. Stewing
23. What do you call to the cooking method when meat is cooked in steaming
liquid in which bubbles are breaking on the surface.
A. Boiling C. Roasting
B. Broiling D. Stewing
24. Which is an oil-acid mixture used to enhance the flavor of meat.
A. Brine solution C. Soy sauce and vinegar
B. Marinade D. Salt and calamansi
25. Which of the following tools is used for carving?
A. Cleaver knife C. Slicer
B. Fork D. Razor knife
26. To which meat cut do internal organs belong?
A. Less tender cuts C. Tough cuts
B. Tender cuts D. Variety cuts
27. Where should meat products be stored?
A. Crisper C. Dry shelf
B. Cold shelf D. Freezer
28. Which of the following is the tenderest cut of beef?
A. Chunk C. Sirloin
B. Round cut D. Tenderloin
29. Which will you consider first when buying meats?
A. Brand C. Quality
B. Price D. Round cut
30. What is your primary consideration when storing goods?
A. Expiration date C. Quantity
B. Fragility D. Size
LM-Cookery Grade 10
11
31. What do ou call to young immature pigeon of either sex with extra tender
meat?
A. Duck C. Rooster
B. Fryer D. Squab
32. To what part of poultry does breast meat belong?
A. Dark meat C. Variety meat
B. Tough meat D. White meat
33. Which of the following characteristics is a good quality of a live poultry?
A. Free from pin feathers and shows no cuts
B. Eyes are clear
C.Is heavy and the skin is watery
D.Thighs are well-developed
34. What do you call to a young chicken that is usually 9 to 12 weeks of?
A. Fryer C. Roaster
B. Hen D. Stag
35. How many days should a whole chicken be refrigerated?
A. 1 day C. 2 to 4 days
B. 1 to 2 days D. 3 to 4 days
36. How do you classify the fleshy part of chicken like breast?
A. Entrails C. Viscera
B. Dark meat D. White meat
37. What cookery method is used for a matured poultry?
A. Boiling C. Roasting
B. Frying D. Stewing
38. What cookery method is suitable for the less tender cuts?
A. Boiling C. Roasting
B. Frying D. Stewing
39. What is the best cooking temperature for poultry?
A. High temperature C. Low to moderate temperature
B. Low temperature D. Moderate temperature
40. What factor affects the poultry meat‘s tenderness and juiciness?
A. Age C. Cuts
B. Cookery D. Sex
41. What is the flavor component of vegetables which gives strong flavor and
odor to some vegetables like onions, leeks, garlic, chives, cabbage, and
broccoli?
A. Flavonoids C. Sugar
C. Glutamic acid D. Sulfur compounds
42. What is a way of cooking by placing blanched or raw vegetables in the
pan, adding liquid (stock, water, wine) then covering and cooking it slowly.
A. Boiling C. Braising
B. Baking D. Sautéing
LM-Cookery Grade 10
12
43. Which of the following plating styles is not a classic arrangement?
A. Starch or vegetable item is heaped in the center while the main item
is sliced and lean up against it.
B. The main item is in the center, with vegetable distributed around it.
C. The vegetable item is n the rear and main item, starch item and
garnish at the front.
D.The main item is in the center with neat piles of vegetables carefully
arranged around.
44. Which of the following vegetables is cooked uncovered?
A. Fruit vegetables C. Roots and tubers
B. Green vegetables D. Yellow vegetables
45. Which of the following is a freshwater fish?
A. Bluefish C. Grouper
B. Cat fish D. Sole
46. Which is the market form of fish where both sides of a fish is still joined
but bones are removed?
A. Butterfly C. Fillet
B. Drawn D. Steak
47. Which of the following is a characteristic of a fresh fish?
A. With fresh and foul odor
B. Eyes are dull, shiny and bulging
C. Gills are red or pink
D. Flesh shrink when pressed
48. Which of the following seafood is cooked just enough to heat to keep juicy
and plump?
A. Fat fish C. Flat fish
B. lean fish D. Shellfish
49. Which of the following is a cooking method suited to fat fish?
A. Baking C. Deep -frying
B. Boiling D. Sautéing
50. What is used to baste lean fish to help prevent them from drying up.
A. Butter C. Soy sauce
B. Cream D. Tomato sauce
LM-Cookery Grade 10
13
Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies (PECs)
Content Standards Performance Standards
The learner demonstrates
understanding of one‘s PECs in
Cookery.
The learner independently creates a
plan of action that strengthens and or
further develops his/her PECs in
Cookery
Quarter I Time Allotment: 4 hours
Module 1
Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies
Introduction
In this module, you will learn more about entrepreneurship and the
entrepreneurial competencies related to Cookery. You will have a first-hand
experience in educational activities leading to personal assessment of your
entrepreneurial competencies and assessment of entrepreneurial
competencies of a successful chef within your area. You will also have some
activities that will align your competencies those of successful practitioners.
Moreover, this module will stimulate your mind to think about
entrepreneurship and its role in the business community, as well as in the
economic and social development.
To start with this module, let us first understand entrepreneurs and
entrepreneurship.
Entrepreneurs are people with skills and capabilities to see and
evaluate business opportunities. They are individuals that can strategically
identify products or services needed by the community and they have the
capacity to deliver these at the right time and at the right place.
Entrepreneurs are agents of economic change; they organize, manage
and assume risks of a business. Some of the good qualities of an
entrepreneur are opportunity seeker, risk taker, goal setter, excellent planner,
a confident problem solver, hardworking, persistent, and a committed worker.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
14
Entrepreneurship, on the other hand, is not just a simple business
activity. It is a strategic process of innovation and new venture creation.
Basically, entrepreneurship is both an art and science of converting business
ideas into marketable products or services to improve the quality of living.
Now that you have a little background knowledge about entrepreneurs
and entrepreneurship, can you now walk through in assessing your PECs?
Always remember that ―Successful entrepreneurs continuously develop and
improve their PECs.‖
To begin with, let us first try to find out the competencies you will
master as you finish this module.
OBJECTIVES
At the end of this module, you are expected to:
 identify areas for improvement, development and growth;
 align your PECs according to your business or career choice; and
 create a plan of action that ensures success in your business or career
choice.
Now that you have an idea about the knowledge and skill that you will
develop and master, take the first challenge in this module – the pre-
assessment.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
15
PRE-ASSESSMENT
As part of your initial activity, you will be challenged to dig deeper on
your knowledge and previous experiences on the topic. Try to diagnose or
assess what you already know about PECs by answering Task 1.
Task 1: Matching Type
Direction: Match the entrepreneurial competencies in column A with
their meaning in column B. Write the letter of the correct answer on the
space provided before each number.
A B
1. Creative A. make a wise decision towards the set
objectives
2. Profit-oriented B. strategic thinking and setting of goals
3. Discipline C. trust in one‘s ability
4. Decision Making D. adoptable to change
5. People Skill E. innovative to have edge over other
competitors
6. Planner F. solid dedication
7. Self-confidence G. skillful in record keeping
8. Hardworking H. always stick to the plan
9. Ability to accept change I. working diligently
10. Committed J effective and efficient communication
and relation to people
K. always looking for income
Task 2: Guide Questions
Direction: The following are guide questions which encapsulate the entire
module. Write your answers on your assignment notebook, and then share
these to the class.
A. Explain why entrepreneurial activities are important to social
development and progress of the economy.
B. What entrepreneurial activities do you know and capable of doing
which are related to Cookery?
C. Given the opportunity to own a business that relates with Cookery are
you confident to manage it? Explain your answer.
D. What do you think are the most important competencies you must
possess in order to be successful in running your chosen business?
LM-Cookery Grade 10
16
Goals and
Targets
Learning
Activities
Ultimate Goal
After answering all the guide questions to the best of your
knowledge and skills, share those with your classmates. You too, may
compare your insights, personal knowledge, and relevant experiences on
the topic to make it more exciting and engaging.
E. Name successful entrepreneurs from your area whose business is
related to Cookery. Be able to share to the class their PECs that
made them successful.
LEARNING GOALS AND TARGET
After understanding the objectives of this module, having gone through
pre-assessment, and answering the guide questions, you will be asked to set
your own personal goals. These goals will trigger you to further achieve the
ultimate objective of this module. In the end, these goals will motivate you to
learn more about PECs.
Figure 1: Strategic process to achieve the objectives of this module
READING RESOURCES AND INSTRUCTIONAL ACTIVITIES
After setting your own personal goals and targets in achieving the
objectives of this module, check your inherent knowledge of PECs. Answer
the following guide questions with the help of your classmates.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
17
Task 3: Group Activity
Direction: Answer the following guide questions on a separate sheet of
paper. Share your answers to the class.
1. Explain the importance of assessing one‘s PECs before engaging in a
particular entrepreneurial activity.
2. Are there other strategies or approaches where you can assess your
PECs? Explain how those strategies will become more useful in
selecting a viable business venture.
3. What are the desirable personal characteristics, attributes, lifestyles,
skills and traits of a prospective entrepreneur? Why are these
important?
4. Why there is a need to assess one‘s PECs in terms of characteristics,
attributes, lifestyles, skills, and traits before starting a particular
business?
LM-Cookery Grade 10
18
Know
5. What is the significance of evaluating PECs of a successful
entrepreneur? What helpful insights can you draw from this activity?
_
.
How was your experience in answering the guide questions with your
classmates? Were you able to benefit from them? What were the insights you
have realized?
This time you‘re going to study the different topics that will enrich your
knowledge of PECs. Read carefully all the important details about the
succeeding topic.
Assessment of Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies (PECs) and Skills vis-
à-vis a Practicing Entrepreneur or Employee in a Province
Entrepreneurial competencies refer to the important characteristics that
should be possessed by an individual in order to perform entrepreneurial
functions effectively. In this module, you will learn some of the most important
characteristics, attributes, lifestyle, skills and traits of a successful
entrepreneur in order to be successful in a chosen career.
Below are few important characteristics / traits / attributes of a good
entrepreneur:
Hardworking: One of the important characteristics of a good
entrepreneur is hardworking. This means habitually working
diligently for a long period of time. Hardworking people keep on
improving their performance to produce good products and/or
provide good services.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
19
 Self-confidence: Entrepreneurs have confidence in one‘s ability
and own judgment. They exhibit self-confidence in order to cope
with all the risks of operating their own business.
Discipline: Successful entrepreneurs always stick on the plan and
fight the temptation to do what is unimportant.
Committed: A good entrepreneur accepts full responsibility of
everything in his/her business. He/she gives full commitment and
solid dedication to make the business successful.
Ability to accept change: Nothing is permanent but change.
Change occurs frequently. When you own a business, you should
cope-up and thrive on changes. Capitalize on positive changes to
make your business grow.
Creative: An entrepreneur should be creative and innovative to
stay in the business and in order to have an edge over the other
competitors.
Has the Initiative: An entrepreneur takes the initiative. You must
put yourself in a position where you are responsible for the failure
or success of your business.
Profit-Oriented: An entrepreneur enters into the world of business
to generate profit or additional income. This shall become the
bread and butter for you and for your family as well. Therefore, you
must see to it that the business can generate income.
Listed below are the important skills of a successful entrepreneur:
Planner: Planning is strategic thinking and setting of goals to
achieve objectives by carefully maximizing all the available
resources. A good entrepreneur develops and applies step-by-step
plans to realize goals. A good entrepreneur knows that planning is
an effective skill only when combined with action.
 People Skills: It‘s a very important skill in order to be successful in
any kind of business. People skills refer to effective and efficient
communication and relation to people working in and out of your
LM-Cookery Grade 10
20
Process
business. In day-to-day business transactions, you need to deal
with people. A well-developed people skill can spell out the
difference between success and failure of the business.
Decision Making: Successful entrepreneurs have the ability to
think quickly, and to make a wise decision towards pre-determined
set objectives. No one can deny that the ability to make wise
decisions is an important skill that an entrepreneur should
possess. Sound decision should spring out from given facts and
information and should be towards the pre-determined objectives.
In order to firm up what you have learned and to have a better
appreciation of the different entrepreneurial competencies, read the PECs
checklist presented below, then answer the same.
Task 4: PECs Checklist
Directions: Using the PECs checklist, assess yourself by indicating a check
(/) mark in either strengths or development areas column. Interpret the results
by counting the total number of check marks in each of the columns. After
accomplishing the checklist, form a group and share your insights and
experiences why you came up with that personal assessment.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
21
Table 1: PECs Checklist
Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies of
an Entrepreneur
Personal Assessment in
terms of:
Strengths Development
Areas
Hardworking
- Working diligently
Self-confidence
- Confidence in one‘s ability
Discipline
- Always stick to the plan
Committed
- Solid dedication
Ability to accept changes
- Adoptable to change
Creative
- Innovative to have edge over other
competitors
Profit-oriented
- Always looking for income
Planner
- Strategic thinking and setting of goals
People Skill
- effective and efficient communication
and relation to people
Decision Making
- make a wise decision towards the set
objectives
TOTAL
LM-Cookery Grade 10
22
Interpretation or Insights:
.
How was your experience in discovering your strengths and the areas
to be developed? Did you gain valuable experience in exchanging insights
with your classmates? To learn more and deepen your understanding of
PECs, do Task 5 below.
Task 5: Interview
Interview a successful chef or entrepreneur in your area whose type of
business is related with Cookery. Focus your interview on PECs and other
business-related attributes that helped them become successful. Analyze the
result of the interview and reflect on the similarities and/or differences. Write
your answer on a separate sheet of paper.
Sample Interview Guide
Name of Proprietor/Practitioner:
Age: Number of Years in Business:
Business Name:
Business Address:
1. What are your preparations before you engaged in this type of
business or job?
Reflect and Understand
LM-Cookery Grade 10
23
2. What are your special skills and characteristics that are related with
your business or job?
3. How did you solve business-related problems during the early years of
your business operation?
4. Did you follow the tips from a successful businessman or practitioner
before you engage in your business?
5. What are your best business practices that you can share with aspiring
students?
6. What are the salient characteristics, attributes, lifestyle, skills and traits
that made you successful in your business or job?
Note: Cull the needed information from the interview to supply
answer/s to Row 1 in the table below. Meanwhile, fill out the second
row with your PECs.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
24
Personal
Entrepreneurial
Competencies
Characteristics Attributes Lifestyles Skills Traits
Successful
Entrepreneur in
the place
My PECs
Using the information on the table above, analyze and reflect on the
similarities and differences in your answers. Put your reflection on the
table below. Write your conclusion on the space provided.
Personal
Entrepreneurial
Competencies
Similarities Differences
Characteristics
Attributes
Lifestyles
Skills
Traits
Conclusion:
.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
25
After performing the activities on the importance of PECs, let‘s
determine how much you have learned. Perform Task 6 to determine how
well you have understood the lesson.
Task 6: Preparation of a Plan of Action
Directions: Using the table below and the information generated from
Task 5 (Interview), prepare an action plan that indicates how
you would align your PECs to the PECs of a successful
entrepreneur in Cookery in your place.
Objective Area Activities Strategies
Time
Frame
Expected
Outcome
To align my
PECs with
the PECs of
a successful
entrepreneur
in Cookery.
Characteristics
Skills
Attribute
Traits
Transfer
LM-Cookery Grade 10
26
Task 7: Essential Questions
Directions: Read and study the following questions below. You may use a
separate sheet of paper or your notebook to write your answers.
1. Why is there a need to compare and align one‘s PECs with the PECs
of a successful entrepreneur?
.
2. How does your action plan help sustain your strong PECs and/or
address your development areas?
.
3. What plan of action would you prepare to address your development
areas?
.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
27
ENVIRONMENT AND MARKET(EM)
Content Standards Performance Standards
The learner demonstrates
understanding of environment and
market in Cookery in one‘s area.
The learner independently creates a
business vicinity map reflective of
potential market in Cookery in a
province.
Quarter I Time Allotment: 4 hours
Introduction
Module 2
Environment and Market
People who aspire to start a business need to explore the economic,
cultural and social conditions prevailing in an area. Needs and wants of the
people in a certain area that are not met may be considered as business
opportunities. Identifying the needs of the community, its resources, available
raw materials, skills, and appropriate technology can help a new entrepreneur
in seizing a business opportunity.
To be successful in any kind of business venture, potential
entrepreneurs should always look closely at the environment and market.
They should always be watchful on the existing opportunities and constraints.
The opportunities in the business environment are those factors that provide
possibilities for a business to expand and make more profits. Constraints, on
the other hand, are that factor that limit the business to grow, hence reduces
the chance of generating profit. One of the best ways to evaluate the
opportunities and constraints is to conduct SWOT (Strengths, Weaknesses,
Opportunities and Threats) Analysis.
SWOT Analysis is a managerial tool to assess the environment. This
gathers important information which in turn is used in strategic planning.
Strengths and weaknesses are internal in an organization. Basically, they
relate to resources owned by the organization, by the things that you have
control over, and as well as to the extent of its marketing.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
28
Opportunities and threats exist in the external environment.
Opportunities relate to the market, to the development of new technologies,
and external factors such as government policies, climate, and trends.
Threats relate to what the competition is doing, as well as legal and other
constraints.
Now that you have read some important considerations to look into to
be successful in any business, you are now ready to explore more about the
environment and market.
To begin with, let‘s find out the competencies that you will master as
you finish this module.
OBJECTIVES
At the end of this module, you are expected to:
 identify what is of ―value‖ to the customer;
 identify the customer to sell to;
 explain what makes a product unique and competitive;
 apply creativity and innovative techniques to develop marketable
product; and
 employ a unique selling proposition (USP) to the product and/or
service.
Now that you have an idea about the things you will learn, take the first
challenge in this module – the pre-assessment.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
29
PRE-ASSESSMENT
Task 1: Multiple-Choice
Directions: Choose the letter of the best answer. Write your answer on a
separate sheet of paper.
1. This is generated by examining the goods and services sold in the
community.
A. business creation C. business concept
B. business pricing D. business idea
2. A process of making a new product to be sold to the customers.
A. product analysis C. product development
B. product conceptualization D. productimplementation
3. These are luxuries, advantages and desires that every individual
considers beyond necessity.
A. wants C. requirements
B. desires D. needs
4. This is the factor or consideration presented by a seller as the reason
that one product or service is different from and better than that of the
competition.
A. unique selling plan C. unique pricing policy
B. unique selling proposition D. finding value-added
5. In this stage, the needs of the target market are identified, reviewed
and evaluated.
A. concept development C. project development
B. economic analysis D. refine specification
6. This is the introduction of new ideas to make the product and services
more attractive and saleable to the target customers.
A. new idea C. product development
B. creativity D. innovation
7. A managerial tool used to assess the environment and to gather
important information that can be used for strategic planning.
A. environmental scanning C. WOTS Analysis
B. SWOT Analysis D. survey analysis
8. A marketing practice of creating name, symbol or design that identifies
and differentiate a product from the other products.
A. product naming C. branding
B. unique selling proposition D. tagline
9. This is a meaningful and unforgettable statement that captures the
essence of the brand.
A. product naming C. branding
B. unique selling proposition D. tagline
LM-Cookery Grade 10
30
10. These are the things that people cannot live without in a society.
A. wants C. requirements
B. desires D. needs
Task 2: Guide Questions:
Directions: Read and study the guide questions below. Use a separate
sheet of paper to write your answer.
1. How does one determine the product or services to be produced and
or to be offered or delivered to the target customers?
2. How does one select an entrepreneurial activity?
3. When can one say that a certain product has a ―value‖?
4. Are innovation and creativity to your product or services important?
Why?
5. How can one effectively respond to the needs of the target customer?
6. Express from the viewpoint of business owner the importance of
scanning the environment and market in generating business ideas.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
31
7. Using self-assessment, explain your level of confidence in formulating
a business idea.
LEARNING GOALS AND TARGET
After reading and understanding the objectives of this module and
having gone through the pre-assessment and guide questions, you will be
asked to set your own personal goals. These goals will trigger you to further
achieve the ultimate objective of this module. In the end, these goals will
motivate you to learn more about Environment and Market.
Figure 2: Strategic process to achieve the objectives of this module.
READING RESOURCES AND INSTRUCTIONAL ACTIVITIES
After setting your own personal goals and targets in achieving the
objectives of this module, you will have the opportunity to read and learn
more about environment and market. You will also be given a chance to do
practical exercises and activities to deepen your understanding of the topic.
After all the guide questions have been answered and skills have been
mastered, share those with your classmates. Discuss your insights, personal
knowledge, and relevant experiences on the topic to make it more exciting
and engaging.
Goals and
Targets
Learning
Activities
Ultimate Goal
LM-Cookery Grade 10
32
Product Development
When we talk of product development, we are referring to a process of
making a new product to be sold by a business or enterprise to its customers.
The product development may involve modification of an existing product or
its presentation, or formulation of an entirely new product that satisfies a
newly defined customer‘s needs, wants and/or a market place.
The term development in this module refers collectively to the entire
process of identifying a market opportunity, creating a product to appeal to
the identified market, and finally, testing, modifying and refining the product
until it becomes ready for production.
There are basic, yet vital questions that you can ask yourself about
product development. When you find acceptable answers to these, you may
now say that you are ready to develop a product and/or render services:
1. For whom are the product services aimed at?
2. What benefits will the customers expect from it?
3. How will the product differ from the existing brand? From its
competitor?
Likewise, needs and wants of the people within an area should also be
taken into big consideration. Everyone has his/her own needs and wants.
However, everyone has different concepts of needs and wants. Needs in
business are important things that every individual cannot live without in a
society. These include:
1. basic commodities for consumption;
2. clothing and other personal belongings;
3. shelter, sanitation and health; and
4. education.
Basic needs are essential to an individual to live with dignity and pride
in a community. These needs can obviously help you generate business
ideas and subsequently to product development.
Know
LM-Cookery Grade 10
33
Wants are desires, luxury and extravagance that signify wealth and
expensive way of living. Wants or desires are considered above all the basic
necessities of life. Some examples of wants or desires: fashion accessories,
expensive shoes and clothes, travelling around the world, eating in an
expensive restaurant; watching movies, concerts, having luxurious cars,
wearing expensive jewelries, perfume, living in impressive homes, among
others.
Needs and wants of people are the basic indicators of the kind of
business that you may engage into because it can serve as the measure of
your success. Some other good points that might be considered in business
undertakings are the kind of people, their needs, wants, lifestyle, culture and
tradition, and social orientation that they belong to.
To summarize, product development entirely depends on the needs
and wants of the customers. Another important issue to deal with is the key
concepts of developing a product. The succeeding topic will enlighten you
about the procedure in coming up with a product.
Concepts of Developing a Product
Concept development is a critical phase in the development of a
product. In this stage, the needs of the target market are identified and
competitive products are reviewed before the product specifications are
defined. The product concept is selected along with an economic analysis to
come up with an outline of how a product is being developed. Below is a
figure that shows the stages of concept development of a product.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
34
Concept
Development
Figure 3: Concept Development
The process of product development follows the following steps:
A. Identify Customer Needs: Using survey forms, interviews, researches,
focus group discussions, and observations, an entrepreneur can easily
identify customers‘ needs and wants. In this stage, the information that
can be possibly gathered are product specifications (performance, taste,
size, color, shape, life span of the product, etc.). This stage is very
important because this would determine the product to be produced or
provided.
B. Establish Target Specifications: Based on customers' needs and reviews
of competitive products, you may now establish target specifications of
the prospective new product and/or services. Target specifications are
essentially a wish-list.
Establish
Target
Specifications
Perform
Economic
Analysis
Analyze
Competitive
Products
Plan
Remaining
Developme
nt Project
Refine
Specifications
Selecta
Product
Concept
Generate
Product
Concepts
Identify
Customer
Needs
LM-Cookery Grade 10
35
C. Analyze Competitive Products: It is imperative to analyze existing
competitive products to provide important information in establishing
product or services specifications. Other products may exhibit successful
design attributes that should be emulated or improved upon in the new
product or services.
D. Generate Product Concepts:After having gone through with the previous
processes, you may now develop a number of product concepts to
illustrate what types of product or services are both technically feasible
and would best meet the requirements of the target specifications.
E. Select a Product Concept: Through the process of evaluation between
attributes, a final concept is selected. After the final selection, additional
market research can be applied to obtain feedback from certain key
customers.
F. Refine Product Specifications: In this stage, product or services
specifications are refined on the basis of input from the foregoing
activities. Final specification as the results of extensive study, expected
service life, projected selling price and among others are being
considered in this stage.
G. Perform Economic Analysis: Throughout the process of product
development, it is very important to always review and estimate the
economic implications regarding development expenses, manufacturing
costs, and selling price of the product or services to be offered or
provided.
H. Plan the Remaining Development Project: In this final stage of concept
development, you may prepare a detailed development plan which
includes list of activities, the necessary resources and expenses, and
development schedule with milestones for tracking progress.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
36
Finding Value
People buy for a reason. There should be something in your product or
service that would give consumers a good reason to go back and buy for
more. There must be something that has to make you the best option for your
target customers; otherwise they have no reason to buy what you‘re selling.
This implies further, that you offer something to your customers that they will
make them value or treasure your product or service.
The value that you incorporate to your product is called value
proposition. Value proposition is ―a believable collection of the most
persuasive reasons people should notice you and take the action you‘re
asking for.‖ Value is created by fulfilling deep desires and solving deep
problems. This is what gets people moving, what people getsspending for
your product or service.
Innovation
Innovation is the introduction of something new in your product or
service. This may be a new idea, a new method or a device. If you want to
increase your sales and profit, you must innovate. Some of the possible
innovations in your products are change of packaging, improve taste, color,
size, shape and perhaps price. Some of the possible innovations in providing
services are application of new improved methods, additional featured
services and possibly freebees.
Unique Selling Proposition (USP)
Unique Selling Proposition is the factor or consideration presented by a
seller as the reason that one product or service is different from and better
than that of the competitions. Before you can begin to sell your product or
service to your target customers, you have to sell yourself on it. This is
especially important when your product or service is similar to those around
you.
USP would require careful analysis of other businesses' ads and
marketing messages. If you analyze what they say or what they sell, not just
their product or service characteristics, you can learn a great deal about how
companies distinguish themselves from competitors.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
37
Here's how to discover your USP and use it to increase your sales and profit:
 Use empathy: Put yourself in the shoes of your customers. Always
focus on the needs of the target customers and forget falling in love
with your own product or service. Always remember, you are making
this product or providing for the target customers to eventually increase
sales and earn profit and not making this product or service for you.
Essential question such as what could make them come back again
and ignore competition should be asked to oneself. Most possible
answers may be focused on quality, availability, convenience,
cleanliness, and reliability of the product or service.
 Identify what motivates your customers. It is very important for you to
understand and find out what drives and motivates your customers to
buy your product or service. Make some efforts to find out, analyze and
utilize the information that motivates the customers in their decisions to
purchase the product or service.
 Discover the actual and genuine reasons why customers buy your
product instead of a competitor's. Information is very important in
decision making. A competitive entrepreneur always improve this
products or services to provide satisfaction and of course retention of
customers. As your business grows, you should always consider the
process of asking your customers important information and questions
that you can use to improve your product or service.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
38
In order to firm up your understanding of the topic previously
presented, you will be tasked to form a group and conduct an interview with a
successful entrepreneur or practitioner. You have to document this interview
and present this to the whole class for reflection and appreciation.
Task 3: Interview
Directions: Select a successful entrepreneur or practitioner. Conduct an
interview using the set of questions below. Document the
interview and present this to the class.
1. How did you identify your customers?
2. What were your considerations in selecting your customers?
3. Explain how your product or service becomes unique compared to
other products.
4. Did you consult somebody before you engage in this business? Cite
sample insights that you gained from the consultation.
Process
LM-Cookery Grade 10
39
5. What were your preparations before you started the actual business?
6. What creative and innovative techniques did you adopt to your product
or service? What was the effect of the innovative techniques to the
sales and profits of your business?
7. What strategy did you consider to have a unique selling proposition to
your product or service?
Task 4: Video Viewing
In order to deepen your understanding of the lesson, perform the
following tasks:
1. Browse the internet and view the topics related to:
a. customers‘ needs and wants
b. techniques in identifying customers‘ needs and wants
c. creativity or innovations in products and services
d. unique selling proposition
e. product development
2. Prepare a short narrative report about the aforementioned topics. You
may highlight the ―aspect‖ that increases your knowledge of product
development.
Reflect and Understand
LM-Cookery Grade 10
40
3. Analyze a
Competitive
Product
-
-
4. Generate Product
Concept
-
-
Task 5: Product Conceptualization
Direction: Using the space and figures below, develop your own concept for
your product or service. Utilize bullets in every stage of product
conceptualization in listing important key ideas.
Transfer
7. Prepare a
Development Plan
-
-
-
6.RefineProduct
Specification
-
-
5. Select A product
Concept
-
-
2. Target
Specifications
-
-
-
1. Identify
Customers Need
-
-
LM-Cookery Grade 10
41
Generating Ideas for Business
The process of developing and generating business idea is not a
simple process. Some people just come with a bunch of business ideas but
are not really feasible. There are two problems that arise; first is the
excessive generation of ideas that can forever remain in the dreaming stage
and the second is when they don‘t have ideas and don‘t want to become
entrepreneurs.
The most optimal way is to have a systematic approach in generating
and selecting business idea that will be transferred in real business. Here are
some basic yet very important considerations that may be used to generate
possible ideas for business:
1. Examine existing goods and services. Are you satisfied with the product?
What do other people who use the product say about it? How can it be
improved? There are many ways of improving a product from the way it is
made to the way it is packed and sold. You can also improve the
materials used in crafting the product. In addition, you can introduce new
ways of using the product, making it more useful and adaptable to the
customers‘ many needs. When you are improving the product or
enhancing it, you are doing an innovation. You can also do an invention
by introducing an entirely new product to replace the old one.
Business ideas may also be generated by examining what goods and
services are sold outside of the community. Very often, these products
are sold in a form that can still be enhanced or improved.
2. Examine the present and future needs. Look and listen to what the
customers, institutions, and communities are missing in terms of goods
and services. Sometimes, these needs are already obvious and felt at the
moment. Other needs are not that obvious because they can only be felt
in the future, in the event of certain developments in the community. For
example, an area will have its electrification facility in the next six months.
Only by that time will the entrepreneur could think of electrically-powered
Know
LM-Cookery Grade 10
42
or generated business such as photo copier, computer service, digital
printing, etc.
3. Examine how the needs are being satisfied. Needs for the products and
services are referred to as market demand. To satisfy these needs is to
supply the products and services that meet the demands of the market.
The term market refers to whoever will use or buy the products or
services, and these may be people or institutions such as other
businesses, establishments, organizations, or government agencies.
There is a very good business opportunity when there is absolutely no
supply to a pressing market demand.
Businesses or industries in the locality also have needs for goods and
services. Their needs for raw materials, maintenance, and other services
such as selling and distribution are good sources of ideas for business.
4. Examine the available resources around you. Observe what materials or
skills are available in abundance in your area. A business can be started
out of available raw materials by selling them in raw form and by
processing and manufacturing them into finished products. For example,
in a copra-producing town, there will be many coconut husks and shells
available as ―waste‖ products. These can be collected and made into
coco rags or doormat and charcoal bricks and sold profitably outside the
community.
A group of people in your neighborhood may have some special skills that
can be harnessed for business. For example, women in the Mountain
Province possess loom weaving skills that have been passed on from one
generation to another. Some communities there set up weaving
businesses to produce blankets, decorative and various souvenir items for
sale to tourists and lowland communities.
Business ideas can come from your own skills. The work and experience
you may have in agricultural arts, industrial arts, home economics, and
ICT classes will provide you with business opportunities to acquire the
needed skills which will give you extra income, should you decide to
engage in income-generating activities. With your skills, you may also
tinker around with various things in your spare time. Many products were
invented this way.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
43
5. Read magazines, news articles, and other publications on new products
and techniques or advances in technology. You can pick up new business
ideas from Newsweek, Reader‘s Digest, Business Magazines, ―Go
Negosyo‖, KAB materials, and Small-Industry Journal. The Internet also
serves as a library where you may browse and surf on possible
businesses. It will also guide you on how to put the right product in the
right place, at the right price, at the right time.
Key Concepts of Selecting a Business Idea
Once you have embarked on identifying business opportunities, you
will eventually see that there are many possibilities that are available for you.
It is very unlikely that you will have enough resources to pursue all of them at
once.
You have to select the most promising one among hundreds of ideas.
It will be good to do this in stages. In the first stage, you screen your ideas to
narrow them down to about few choices. In the next stage, trim down the
choices to two options. In the final stage, choose between the two and
decide which business idea is worth pursuing.
In screening your ideas, examine each one in terms of the following
factors:
1. How much capital is needed to put up the business?
2. How big is the demand for the product? Do many people need
this product and will continue to need it for a long time?
3. How is the demand met? Who are processing the products to
meet the needs (competition or demand)? How much of the need
is now being met (supply)?
4. Do you have the background and experiences needed to run this
particular business?
5. Will the business be legal, not going against any existing or
foreseeable government regulation?
6. Is the business in line with your interest and expertise?
Your answers to these questions will be helpful in screening which
ones among your many ideas are worth examining further and worth
pursuing.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
44
Branding
Branding is a marketing practice of creating name, symbol or designs
that identifies and differentiates product or services from the rest. It is also a
promise to your customers. It tells them what they can expect from your
product or service and it differentiates your offerings from other competitors.
Your brand is derived from who you are, who you want to be and what people
perceive you to be.
Branding is one of the most important aspects of any business. An
effective brand strategy gives you a major edge in increasingly competitive
markets.
The features of a good product brand are as follows:
- Delivers the message clearly
- Confirms your credibility
- Connects your target prospects emotionally
- Motivates the buyer
- Concretizes user loyalty
Here are some simple tips to publicize your brand:
.
 Develop a tagline. Write a meaningful, unforgettable, and easy to
remember statement that captures the essence of your brand.
 Get a great logo. Create a logo suitable to your business and
consistent with your tagline and place it everywhere.
 Write down your brand messaging. Select key messages you
want to communicate about your brand.
 Be true to your brand. Deliver your brand promise.
 Be consistent. Be reliable and consistent every time.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
45
In generating business idea, you should first identify what type of
business is suited to your business idea. You should analyze and scan the
potential environment, study the marketing practices and strategies of your
competitors, analyze the strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and the
threats in your environment to ensure that the products or services you are
planning to offer will be patronized within the easy reach by your target
consumers.
Bear in mind these simple rules for successful SWOT Analysis:
 Be realistic about the strengths and weaknesses of your business
when conducting SWOT Analysis.
 SWOT Analysis should distinguish between where your business is
today, and where it could be in the future.
 SWOT Analysis should always be specific. Avoid any grey area.
 Always apply SWOT Analysis in relation to your competition‘ i.e. better
than or worse than your competitions.
 Keep your SWOT Analysis short and simple. Avoid complexity and
over analysis.
 SWOT Analysis is subjective.
Process
LM-Cookery Grade 10
46
Task 6: SWOT Analysis
Directions: Utilize the SWOT Analysis table below to list up all your
observations. Be guided by the strategies in analyzing and formulating
realistic and attainable activities. Write down the activities on the available
spaces provided to create the best business idea.
Strength (S) Weaknesses (W)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Opportunities (O) Threats (T)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Strategies:
 SW - Maximize on the strengths to overcome the internal weakness.
 OW - Capitalize on the opportunities to eliminate the internal
weakness.
 ST - Maximize on your strengths to eliminate the external threats.
 OT - Take advantage of the available opportunities to eliminate the
external threats.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
47
Analysis:
Activities:
My Best Business Idea:
In order to deepen your understanding of the topics previously
discussed, you will be asked to perform the following activities:
Reflect and Understand
LM-Cookery Grade 10
48
QUARTER I
Prepare Egg, Cereal, and Starch Dishes
Task 7: Extra Readings and Video Viewing
Reading books and watching videos have been considered as one of
the most effective educational activities that can help learners deepen their
understanding on a certain topic. In this particular task, you will be asked to
conduct extra readings and video viewings in the Internet on the following
topics:
A. Steps in Selecting Business Idea
B. Criteria of a Viable Business Idea
C. Benefits of a Good Brand
D. Ways on Developing a Brand
After successfully performing the assigned task, make a narrative
report about it and share it to the class.
Task 9: Making My Own Logo
Direction: Generate a clear and appealing product brand with a logo and a
tagline.
TransferTr
Logo
Logo
LM-Cookery Grade 10
49
QUARTER I
Prepare Egg, Cereal, and Starch Dishes
Overview
This quarter will provide you learners the essential knowledge and
opportunities to develop your skills and gained understanding in the
preparation, cooking, presentation, and storing egg, cereal, and starch
dishes. You will be able to know the needed tools and equipment and learn
how to clean and sanitize them after each use. Differentiated activities and
hands – on activities were given to give you opportunities to transfer what you
have learned.
Objectives
At the end of the lesson, you are expected to:
1. perform Mise‘en place;
2. prepare and cook egg, cereal and starch dishes;
3. present egg, cereal and starch dishes; and
4. store egg, cereal and starch dishes.
Let’s See What You Know
Pretest 1
A. Multiple Choice.
Directions: Read each question carefully. Choose the letter which
corresponds to the correct answer and write it in your test
notebook.
1. It is a small hand tool used generally in decorative works such as
making garnishes.
A. bread knife C. channel knife
B. butcher knife D. paring knife
LM-Cookery Grade 10
50
2. It is a perforated bowl of varying sizes made of stainless steel,
aluminum or plastic used to drain, wash or cook ingredients from liquid.
A. Canister C. Mixing bowl
B. Colander D. Soup bowl
3. It is used for turning and lifting eggs, pan cakes and meats on griddles,
grills, sheet pans, and the likes and also used to scrape and clean
griddles.
A. Measuring spoon C. Rubber scraper
B. Offset spatula D. Wooden spoon
4. It is used to scrape off all the contents of bowls and pans from the
sides and fold in beaten eggs in batter or whipped cream.
A. Paring knife C. Wire whisk
B. Rubber spatula D. Wooden spoon
5. It is a screen – type mesh supported by a round metal frame used for
sifting dry ingredients like starch and flour.
A. Colander C. Sieve
B. Funnel D. Skimmer
6. It is a device with loops of stainless steel wire fastened to a handle. It
is used for blending, mixing, whipping eggs or batter, and for blending
gravies, sauces, and soups.
A. Fork C. Spoon
B. Knife D. Whisk
7. It is a miniature Bain Marie with an upper dish containing indentations
each sized to hold an egg or contains separate device for poaching.
A. Egg Poacher C. Frying pan
B. Double boiler D. Omelet pan
8. It is a chamber or compartment used for cooking, baking, heating, or
drying.
A. Blender C. Mixer
B. Burner D. Oven
9. It is the process of washing and sanitizing dishes, glassware, flatware,
and pots and pans either manually or mechanically.
A. Bleaching C. Ware washing
B. Hand washing D. Washing machine
10. It requires a dishwashing machine capable of washing, rinsing, and
drying dishes, flatware, and glassware.
A. Hand washing C. Mechanical ware washing
B. Manual ware washing D. Washing machine
11. It is the egg‘s outer covering which accounts for about 9 to 12 % of its
total weight depending on egg size.
A. Chalaza C. Shell
B. Germinal disc D. Yolk
LM-Cookery Grade 10
51
12. This is the entrance of the latebra, the channel leading to the center of
the yolk.
A. Chalaza C. Shell
B. Germinal disc D. Yolk
13. It is the yellow to yellow - orange portion which makes up to about 33% of
the liquid weight of the egg.
A. Chalaza C. Shell
B. Germinal disc D. Yolk
14. A disease that is carried and transmitted to people by food is referred
to as food borne .
A. Bacteria C. Infection
B. Illness D Intoxication
15. It is a disease that results from eating food containing harmful micro-
organism.
A. Food borne bacteria C. Food borne infection
B. Food borne illness D. Food borne intoxication
16. It is a disease that results from eating food containing toxins from
bacteria, molds or certain plants or animals.
A. Food borne bacteria C. Food borne infection
B. Food borne illness D. Food borne intoxication
17. It is used for mixing creams, butter and for tossing salads.
A. Electric mixer C. Wire whisk
B. Serving spoon D. Wooden spoon
18. It is used for preparing meat, chicken, and other grains or legumes,
such as mongo and white beans in lesser time.
A. Double boiler C. pressure cooker
B. Frying pan D. rice cooker
19. It is a long chainlike molecule, sometimes called the linear fraction, and
is produced by linking together 500 to 2, 000 glucose molecules which
contributes to the gelling characteristics to cooked and cooled starch
mixtures.
A. Amylopectin C. Dextrin
B. Amylose D. Mucin
20. This problem is usually encountered when using acid or acid
ingredients such as lemon or vinegar.
A. Scorching C. Thinning of gel.
B. Skin formation D. Weak gelling
21. This results when there is too much liquid in relation to the starch.
A. Scorching C. Thinning of gel.
B. Skin formation D. Weak gelling
LM-Cookery Grade 10
52
22. This problem can be reduced by covering the container of the starch
gel with a waterproof cover.
A. Scorching C. Thinning of gel.
B. Skin formation D. Weak gelling
23. This can be avoided by temperature control and constant stirring so
the starch granules do not settle at the bottom of the cooking pan.
A. Scorching C. Thinning of Gel.
B. Skin formation D. Weak gelling
24. It can be stored in the refrigerator for 2 or 3 days.
A. Cooked pasta C. Fresh pasta
B. Dried pasta D. Frozen pasta
25. FIFO stands for
A. Fan In Fan On C. First In First Out
B. First In Fight Out D. Fit In Fit Out
B. Give one risk in the preparation and cooking of starch, cereal dishes and
other foods, and give some guidelines pertaining to food safety.
Your answer will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
SCORE CRITERIA
4 Explains very clearly the complete guidelines to consider pertaining to food
safety related to the given risk.
3 Explains clearly the complete guidelines to consider pertaining to food
safety related to the given risk.
2 Explains partially the guidelines to consider pertaining to food safety
related to the given risk.
1 Was not able to explain any guidelines to consider pertaining to food
safety related to the given risk.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
53
Overview
In cookery, egg refers to poultry or fowl products. The versatility of
eggs is evident in its presence in numerous food items. Eggs may be eaten
cooked in its shell, fried or poached or may be combined with other
ingredients to produce another dish. In baking, egg acts both as an
emulsifier and leavener.
The egg‘s protective coating or mucin layer which aids in the
maintenance of its freshness by covering the small holes in the shell is called
bloom. Bloom is removed during washing so it is not advisable to wash eggs
prior to storage unless it is very dirty. Removal of the mucin layer will expose
the holes making the egg susceptible to bacterial penetration and
dehydration, thus hastening deterioration of its quality.
Eggs are produced commercially in farms with a few hundred laying
chickens, or in large laying complexes with thousands of layers. Small and
micro-sized backyard poultry either in small poultry cages or as free range
chicken are also producing eggs. Egg is indeed a convenient food for any
meal in and out of the house.
Learning Outcome 1 Perform Mise’en Place
At the end of the lesson, you are expected to:
1. identify tools, utensils and equipment needed in egg preparation;
2. clean, sanitize and prepare tools, utensils and equipment needed
in preparing egg dishes;
3. identify egg components and its nutritive value; and
4. identify and prepare ingredients according to standard recipe.
In the preparation of egg dishes, the first consideration is to identify
the needed tools and equipment and how to clean and sanitize them after
each use.
LESSON 1 PREPARE EGG DISHES
LM-Cookery Grade 10
54
Tools, Utensils and Equipment Needed In Egg Preparation
Kitchen Tools
1. Channel Knife – a small hand tool used generally in decorative works
such as making garnishes.
2. Colander – a perforated bowl of varying sizes made of stainless steel,
aluminum or plastic, used to drain, wash or cook ingredients from
liquid.
3. Offset spatula – a broad – bladed implement bent to keep the hand off
hot surfaces. It is used for turning and lifting eggs, pan cakes, and
meats on griddles, grills, sheet pans, and the likes and also used to
scrape and clean griddles.
4. Pastry Brush – a small implement used to brush the surface of
unbaked pastries or cookies with egg white, egg yolk or glaze.
5. Rubber spatula or scraper – a broad flexible plastic or rubber scraper,
that is rectangular in shape with a curve on one side. It is used to
scrape off all the contents of bowls and pans from the sides and fold in
beaten eggs in batter or whipped cream.
6. Sieve – a screen – type mesh supported by a round metal frame used
for sifting dry ingredients like starch and flour.
7. Spoons: solid, slotted and perforated – large stainless spoons holding
about 3 ounces used for mixing, stirring, and serving. Slotted and
perforated spoons are large, long-handled spoons with holes in the
bowl used to remove larger solid particles from liquids.
8. Wire whip or Whisk – a device with loops of stainless steel wire
fastened to a handle. It is used for blending, mixing, whipping eggs or
batter, and for blending gravies, sauces, and soups.
Kitchen Utensils
1. Egg Poacher – A miniature Bain Marie with an upper dish containing
indentations each sized to hold an egg or contains separate device for
poaching.
2. Omelet Pan – a heavy-based frying usually of cast iron or copper, with
rounded sloping sides used exclusively for omelets and never washed
after used but cleaned with absorbent paper.
3. Measuring cup- a kitchen utensil used for measuring liquid or bulksolid
cooking ingredients such as flour and sugar
4. Measuring spoon- used to measure an amount of an ingredient, either
liquid or dry, when cooking. Measuring spoons may be made of plastic,
metal, and other materials.
5. Sauce pan- deep cooking pan with a handle used primarily for cooking
sauce.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
55
6. Mixing bowl - these containers have smooth, rounded interior surfaces
with no creases to retain some mixture and is used for mixing
ingredients.
Kitchen Equipment
1. Oven - a chamber or compartment used for cooking, baking, heating,
or drying.
2. Electric mixer - A hand-held mixer which usually comes with various
attachments including a whisk attachment for whisking cream, batters
and egg whites, and sugar.
3. Refrigerator - a kitchen appliance where you store food at a cool
temperature.
Cleaning and Sanitizing Tools and Equipment
A cleaning program that is an overall system should be prepared to
organize all your cleaning and sanitizing tasks. The program should also
help identify your cleaning needs, set up a master cleaning schedule, select
the supplies and tools to use, and train yourselves to make the best of your
skills.
Cleaning is the removal of visible soil while sanitizing means reducing
the number of harmful microorganisms by using very hot water or a chemical
sanitizing solution. To be effective, cleaning and sanitizing must be two-step
process. Surfaces must first be cleaned and rinsed before being sanitized.
There are many cleaning products or agents and a variety of
equipment in the market. Choose the best for your workplace and follow
instructions in the label.
Here are some points to support your workplace training:
1. Clean in a logical order.
2. Different cleaning tasks require different methods. Getting
things wrong can cause damage to surface, harm to yourself,
and spread bacteria and dirt.
3. Many cleaning agents are harmful. Their contact with your skin
or eyes or breathing in the fumes can cause a serious illness.
4. Mixing one agent with another can be very dangerous. A
chemical reaction can be set up, or in some cases, produce
poisonous fumes.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
56
Ware washing
Ware washing is the process of washing and sanitizing dishes,
glassware, flatware, and pots and pans either manually or mechanically.
Manual ware washing uses a three-compartment sink and is used primarily
for pots and pans. It may be used for dishes and flatware in small operations.
Mechanical ware washing requires a dishwashing machine capable of
washing, rinsing, and drying dishes, flatware, and glassware. In large
operations, heavy-duty pot and pan washing machines have been designed
to remove cooked-on food.
Manual Dishwashing
Procedure
1. Scrape and pre-rinse.
The purpose of this step is to keep the wash water cleaner
longer.
2. Wash.
Use warm water at 1100F to 1200F and a good detergent.
Scrub well with a brush to remove all traces of leftover and
grease.
3. Rinse.
Use clean warm water to rinse off detergent. Change the
water frequently, or use running water with an overflow.
4. Sanitize.
Place utensils in rack and immerse in hot water at 1700F for
thirty seconds. (A gas or electric heating element is needed to
hold water at this temperature.)
5. Drain and air-dry.
Do not towel-dry. This may contaminate utensils.
Mechanical Dishwashing
The steps in washing dishes by machine are the same as in the
manual methods. Except that the machine does the washing, rinsing, and
sanitizing.
Procedure
1. Scrape and pre-rinse.
2. Rack dishes so that the dishwasher spray will strike all surfaces.
3. Run machine for a full cycle.
4. Set the sanitizing temperatures at 1800F for machine that sanitizes
by heat and at 1400F for machine that sanitizes by chemical
disinfectant.
5. Air-dry and inspect dishes. Do not touch food – contact surfaces.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
57
Review of Learning Outcome 1
A. YES/NO Cards. Directions: Using a 4 x 6 inches Index Card, do the
activity below:
a. Write YES on one side and NO on the other side
b. When the teacher shows you a kitchen tool, a kitchen utensil or
equipment with label, raise the index card showing YES if the label
is correct and NO if it is wrong.
c. Do the same in the succeeding questions.
Performance Activity 1
B. Clean and sanitize tools and equipment by performing the given
activity.
You will be asked to clean and sanitize the tools and equipment in the
food laboratory. Follow the procedures properly in performing the task.
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in cleaning and sanitizing tools
and equipment and performs the skill without supervision and with
initiative and adaptability to problem situations.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in cleaning and sanitizing tools
and equipment and performs the skill satisfactorily without
assistance or supervision.
2 Follows the procedures in cleaning and sanitizing tools and
equipment with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily
with some assistance and/or supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in cleaning and sanitizing
tools and equipment and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
After knowing the needed tools and equipment needed in
the preparation of egg dishes and on how to clean and sanitize them
after each use, the next consideration is to know what makes up an
egg and appreciate other things about egg.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
58
Physical Structure and
Composition of Eggs
We
normally distinguish 3
parts of an egg, the
shell, the egg white, and
the egg yolk, but a
closer scrutiny reveals a
much more detailed
structure of an egg.
Structure
1. Shell. The
egg‘s outer covering, the
shell, accounts for about
9 to 12 % of its total
weight depending on
egg size. The shell is the
egg‘s first line of
defense against
bacterial contamination.
The shell is produced by the shell gland (uterus) of the oviduct, and
has an outer coating, the bloom or cuticle. The cuticle somewhat
seals the pores and is useful in reducing moisture losses and in
preventing bacterial penetration of the egg shell.
2. Air cell. This is the empty space between the white and shell at the
large end of the egg which is barely existent in newly laid egg. When
an egg is first laid, it is warm. As it cools, the contents contract and
the inner shell membrane separate from the outer shell membrane
to form the air cell.
3. Albumen/Egg white. Albumen, also called egg white, accounts for
most of an egg‘s liquid weight, about 67%. This is produced by the
oviduct and consists of four alternating layers of thick and thin
consistencies. From the yolk outward, they are designated as the
inner thick or chalaziferous white, the inner thin white, the outer
thick white and the outer thin white. The outer thin white is a narrow
fluid layer next to the shell membrane. The outer thick white is a gel
that forms the center of the albumen. The inner thin white is a fluid
layer located next to the yolk. The inner thick white (chalasiferous
layer) is a dense, matted, fibrous capsule terminates on each end in
the chalazae, which are twisted in opposite directions and serve to
keep the yolk centered.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
59
4. Chalaza. This is the ropey strands of egg white at both sides of the
egg, which anchor the yolk in place in the center of the thick white.
They are sometimes mistaken for egg imperfections or beginning
embryos, which of course they are not. The twist in the chalaza is
meant to keep the germinal disc always on top whichever way the
egg may turn. The more prominent the chalazae the fresher is the
egg.
5. Germinal Disc. This is the entrance of the latebra, the channel
leading to the center of the yolk. The germinal disc is barely
noticeable as a slight depression on the surface of the yolk. When
the egg is fertilized, sperm enter by way of the germinal disc, travel
to the center and a chick embryo starts to form. Since table eggs are
not fertilized, this is not as easy to recognize as when the egg is
fertilized.
6. Membranes. There are two kinds of membranes, one just under the
shell and the other covering the yolk. These are the shell membrane
and the vitelline membrane. Just inside the shell are two shell
membranes, inner and outer. The air cell formed due to the
contraction of egg as it cools, is found between the two layers of this
shell membrane. The outer membrane sticks to the shell while the
inner membrane sticks to the albumen. During storage, the egg
losses water by evaporation, causing the air cell to enlarge. The
vitelline membrane is the covering that protects the yolk from
breaking. The vitelline membrane is weakest at the germinal disc
and tends to become more fragile as the egg ages. Every cook has
experienced that the yolk of eggs that are no longer fresh easily
break.
7. Yolk. The yolk or the yellow to yellow- orange portion makes up about
33% of the liquid weight of the egg. The egg yolk is formed in the ovary.
On the surface of the yolk, there is a small white spot about 2 mm in
diameter. This is the germinal disc and it is present even if the egg is
infertile. In infertile eggs, the germinal disc contains the genetic material
from the hen only but when fertilized, it contains the zygote that will
eventually develop into a chick. The yolk material serves as a food
source for embryonic development. It contains all the fat in the egg and a
little less than half of the protein. The main protein in the egg yolk is
vitelline, a lipoprotein. It also contains phosvitin which is high in
phosphorus and has antioxidant properties, and livetin which is high in
sulfur.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
60
Composition of an Egg
% % Water % Protein % Fat % Ash
Whole Egg 100 65.5 11.8 11.0 11.7
Albumen 58 88 11.0 0.2 0.8
Yolk 31 48 17.5 32.5 2.0
Nutritive Value of Egg
Egg is indeed one of nature‘s complete food. It contains high quality
protein with all the essential amino acids, all of the vitamins except vitamin C,
and many minerals. Egg products are particularly good for fortifying food low
in protein quality. Except for mother‘s milk, eggs provide the best protein
naturally available. Egg protein is often used as a reference standard for
biological values of their proteins.
Egg Nutrient Chart
Nutrient Content of a Large Egg
Nutrient (unit) Whole Egg Egg White Egg Yolk
Calories (kcal) 72 17 55
Protein (g) 6.3 3.6 2.7
Carbohydrate (g) 0.36 0.24 0.61
Carbohydrate (g) 0.36 0.24 0.61
Total fat (g) 4.8 0.06 4.5
Monounsaturated fat (g) 1.8 0 2
Polyunsaturated fat (g) 1 0 0.72
Saturated fat (g) 1.6 0 1.6
Trans fat (g) 0.02 0 0.02
Cholesterol (mg) 186 0 184
Choline (mg) 126 0.4 116
Riboflavin (mg) 0.2 0.15 0.09
Vitamin B12 (mcg) 0.45 0.03 0.33
Folate (mcg) 24 1 25
Vitamin D (IU) 41 0 37
Vitamin A (IU) 270 0 245
Vitamin B 6 (mg) 0.09 0 0.06
Thiamin (mg) 0.02 0 0.03
Vitamin E (mg) 0.5 0 0.44
Selenium (mcg) 15.4 6.6 9.5
Phosphorous (mg) 99 5 66
LM-Cookery Grade 10
61
Iron (mg) 0.88 0.03 0.46
Zinc (mg) 0.65 0.01 0.39
Calcium (mg) 28 2 22
Sodium (mg) 71 55 8
Potassium (mg) 69 54 19
Magnesium (mg) 6 4 1
Source: U.S. Department of Agriculture, Agricultural Research Service, 2010. USDA National
Nutrient Database for Standard Reference, Release 23. Nutrient Data Laboratory Home
Page: http://www.ars.usdA.gov/nutrientdata
Egg quality
Egg quality has two general components: shell quality (exterior
quality) and interior egg quality. Interior egg quality has direct bearing on the
functional properties of eggs while shell quality has direct influence on
microbiological quality.
Egg Grading. Grading is a form of quality control used to classify eggs
for exterior and interior quality. In the Philippines, the grade
designations are A, B, C, and D.
Egg Size. Several factors influence the size of the egg: breed, age of
hen, weight, feed and environmental factors. Native chickens have
much smaller eggs than commercial breeds. Some commercial breeds
have bigger eggs than others. Of the same breed, new layers tend to
have smaller eggs compared to older hens. Pullets that are
significantly underweight at sexual maturity will also produce small
eggs. Better fed hens lay larger eggs than underfed ones. The
environmental factors that lead to smaller eggs are heat, stress and
overcrowding.
The egg sizes are Jumbo, Extra Large, Large, Medium, Small
and Peewee. Medium, Large, and Extra Large are the sizes commonly
available.
Egg Size Classification
Size Jumbo
Extra
large
Large Medium Small Peewee
Weight of 12
eggs in grams
840 756 672 588 504 420
Average
weight per egg
in grams
70 63 56 49 42 35
LM-Cookery Grade 10
62
Philippine Standard of Quality for Chicken Eggs
Quality
Factor
A B C D
Shell
Clean
Unbroken
Normal shape
Clean
Unbroken
Normal shape
Moderately
stained
Unbroken
Slightly
abnormal
shape
Moderately
stained
Unbroken
May be
abnormal
shape
Air Cell
Depth of 0.3cm or
less
Practically regular
Depth of
0.5cm or less
Practically
regular
Depth of 1.0 cm
or less
May be loose
or bubbly
Depth of 1cm
May be loose
or bubbly
Egg White
Clear
Firm
72 Haigh units or
higher
Clear
Reasonably
Firm
60 - 71 Haugh
units
Clear
May be slightly
weak
31-59 haugh
units
May be weak
and watery
Small clots or
spots may be
present
Less than 31
Haugh units
Egg Yolk
Outlined defined
Round and firm
Free from defects
Outline fairly
well defined
Round and
firm
Free from
defects
Outline may be
well defined.
May be slightly
enlarged and
flattened.
Practically free
from defects.
May have
embryonic
development
Outline may be
well defined.
May be
enlarged and
flattened.
May have
embryonic
development
The appearance of the egg, as influenced by severity of defects, is
important for consumer appeal. Egg shells are evaluated on the basis of
cleanliness, shape, texture, and soundness.
The unit for describing egg freshness, based on the thickness of
the albumen is called Haugh unit with a symbol of HU named before
Raymond Haugh in 1937.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
63
E
En
nh
ha
an
nc
ce
em
me
en
nt
t
A. Minute to Write It
Directions: In your test notebook write whether you agree or disagree
to the following statements and justify your answer.
1. Egg is a complete food.
2. Egg is composed of the shell, egg white and egg yolk.
B. Pictorial Report
Directions: Make a pictorial report with illustration showing the qualities
of a fresh egg in terms of egg size and grading.
Your output will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
SCORE CRITERIA
5 Compiled pictures properly and illustrate the qualities of a fresh egg in
terms of egg size and grading in a very attractive manner.
4 Compiled pictures properly and illustrate the qualities of a fresh egg in
terms of egg size and grading in an attractive manner.
3 Compiled pictures properly and illustrate the qualities of a fresh egg in
terms of egg size and grading in a less attractive manner.
2 Compiled pictures properly and illustrate the qualities of a fresh egg in
terms of egg size and grading in a less attractive manner.
1 Improperly compiled pictures but were not able to illustrate the qualities of
a fresh egg in terms of egg size and grading in disorderly manner.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
64
Learning Outcome 2 Prepare and Cook Egg Dishes
At the end of the lesson, you are expected to:
1. identify and prepare ingredients according to standard recipes;
2. identify the market forms of eggs;
3. explain the uses of eggs in culinary; and
4. cook egg dishes with appropriate taste and seasoned in
accordance with the prescribed standard.
Market Forms of Egg
There are three market forms of eggs namely: fresh, dried (whole,
egg whites/egg yolks), and frozen (whole, egg whites/egg yolks).
1. Fresh Eggs or shell eggs may be purchased individually, by dozen
or in trays of 36 pieces.
2. Frozen Eggs – are made of high quality fresh eggs. They come in
the form of whole eggs with extra yolks and whites. Frozen eggs
are pasteurized and must be thawed before use.
3. Dried Eggs – are seldom used. Their whites are used for preparing
meringue. Dried eggs are used primarily as ingredients in food
industry. They are not commonly sold directly to consumers.
Eggs are also sold in several processed forms: bulk or fluid
whole eggs (which sometimes includes a percentage of extra yolks to obtain
a specific blend), egg whites, and egg yolks. Pasteurized eggs are used in
preparations such as salad dressings, eggnog, or desserts, where the
traditional recipe may have indicated that the eggs should be raw. These
products generally are available in liquid or frozen form. Frozen egg products
on the other hand are used as ingredients by food processors. Products
containing egg yolk usually have salt, sugar or corn syrup added to prevent
gelation or increased viscosity during freezing. They are packed in 30-
lB.containers and in 4-, 5-, 8-, and 10-lB.pouches or waxed or plastic cartons.
Dried powdered eggs are also sold and may be useful for some
baked goods or in certain circumstances. For food service use, they are
generally sold in 6-oz. pouches, and 3-lB.and 25-lB.poly packs.
Egg substitutes may be entirely egg-free or may be produced
from egg whites, with dairy or vegetable products substituted by yolks. These
substitutes are important for people with reduced-cholesterol diet
requirement.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
65
Uses of Eggs in culinary
Egg is cooked in many ways. It can be the main protein dish; it
can be a main or accessory ingredient in dishes from appetizers to desserts.
It can be cooked by dry heat, moist heat, with or without oil, as simply or as
elaborately as one‘s inclination for the moment. Indeed it can be eaten
anywhere.
Effect of Heat on Eggs
1. Coagulation of proteins: white at 60-65 0C, yolk at 65-700C.
 Beyond this temperature, over coagulation occurs and
water is squeezed out causing shrinkage resulting in a
tough product.
2. Formation of greenish discoloration at the interface of the yolk and
white when egg is overcooked
 Due to the reaction between the iron in the yolk and the
hydrogen sulfide liberated from the sulfur containing ferrous
sulfide.
 Reaction is favored by
- High cooking temperature
- Prolonged cooking
 Reaction is prevented by immediate cooling of the egg (e.g.
immersing in cold water) after cooking
Uses of Egg
1. Cooked and served ―as is‖, e.g.
 in the shell – soft cooked ( 5 minutes simmering) or hard cooked (15
minutes simmering)
 poached – cooked in simmering water; addition of salt and vinegar
hastens coagulation
 fried – keep low to moderate temperature
 scrambled – addition of sugar delays coagulation; addition of liquids
and acids decreases coagulation point
 omelet
2. Eggs as emulsifier
 Lecithin and lysolecithin are responsible for the remarkable ability of
egg yolk to act as an emulsifying agent; both are phosphoproteins
containing polar and non-polar ends such that the polar end holds
water while the non-polar end holds the fat, thus, prevent oil droplets in
suspension from coalescing.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
66
3. As binding, thickening agent, and gelling agents
 Eggs are useful as binding, thickening and gelling agents because they
contain proteins that are easily denatured by heat
 Using whole egg requires lower coagulation temperatures resulting in a
stiffer gel
 Addition of sugar, raises coagulation temperature producing softer,
weaker gel
 Softer gel is produced with the addition of scalded milk and acid
 In cooking custards, Bain Marie, double boiler or steamer is used to
avoid boiling which can produce a porous custard
 Soft custards are produced by constant stirring.
4. As foam
 When egg is beaten albumen is denatured, air is incorporated as white
is stretched into thin films
 With continued beating, the air cells are subdivided and volume is
increased
 Protein network dries up and stabilizes the gas or air foams
- If only egg whites are used, the color turns white and soft peaks
are formed. The egg proteins collect at the air/liquid interface of
the air bubble and undergo surface denaturation.
- If whole eggs or only egg yolks are used, the color becomes
pale yellow with continued beating; volume is increased (but not
as much as when only whites are used); no surface
denaturation occurs.
- With further beating of egg whites, liquid drains out, air bubbles
coalesce and foam breaks.
- The same changes occur when the foam is allowed to stand too
long.
- Maximum stability is reached at soft stage while maximum
volume attained is at stiff stage
- Stages in foam formation
A. frothy – large air bubbles that flow easily
B. soft foam – air cells are smaller and more numerous; foam
becomes whiter; soft peaks are formed when beater is lifted
C.stiff foam – peaks hold their shape; when bowl is tipped, it
holds, moist and glossy
D.dry – moistness and glossiness disappear; specks of egg
white are seen
LM-Cookery Grade 10
67
 Factors to be considered in foam formation (leavening agent)
a. Beating time and temperature: as the time of beating
increases, both volume and stability of the foam increases
initially, then, decreases; white can be beaten/whipped more
readily at room temperature than at refrigerator temperature –
refrigerated eggs are more viscous, thus, hard to beat/whip.
b. Eggs beaten at room temperature whip better resulting in
bigger volume and finer texture.
c. Whole eggs or egg yolk require more beating to produce a
good foam
d. Stored eggs foam faster but produce smaller volume than
fresh eggs.
e. Acids (e.g. cream of tartar, 1 t per cup) increase the stability
of foams, but when added too early, delay foam formation
(reduced volume) thus, increases the time necessary for
beating
f. Sugar also increases the stability of foams but delays foams
formation (reduced volume), thus, it should be added after
foaming has started and soft peaks are formed; sugar retards
the denaturation of egg white
g. Addition of soda increases stability and volume
h. Addition of salt lowers quality of the foam
i. Type of egg: duck eggs do not foam well because they lack
ovumucin
j. Dilution of egg white by water produces bigger volume but
lesser foam; this produces more tender cakes, but in
meringues, syneresis occurs.
k. Applications of foam in cookery
 as leavening e.g. in angel cake, sponge cake, chiffon
cakes
 as meringue, e.g.
(a) soft meringue for topping of cream, chocolate, or lemon
pie, requires a proportion of two tablespoons sugar per
egg white
(b) hard meringue for confections, base of fruit pies or
Sans Rival Cake, requires a proportion of ¼ cup sugar
per egg white
 structural and textural agent – tenderness and fluffiness to
products, e.g. fluffy or foamy, soufflé, divinity, foam cakes,
popovers
LM-Cookery Grade 10
68
5. As coloring and flavoring agent
Egg Products
1. Balut from duck eggs
2. Pidan eggs
3. Century eggs
4. Pickled eggs
Eggs may be cooked in a lot of ways:
Egg Dishes
 Eggs cooked in a shell
Hard and soft-cooked eggs are cooked this way. Eggs should
only be simmered and not boiled to prevent overcoagulation which
would cause the eggs to be tough. The optimum cooking time for eggs
in shells is 20 to 25 minutes. To avoid cracking of the eggs during
cooking, refrigerated eggs should be warmed at ambient temperature
before cooking. Before boiling, water at room temperature should be
used.
Sometimes yolks of eggs may become greenish during cooking.
This color is due to the formation of iron sulfide. Darkening often
occurs in eggs wherein the pH of the albumen is high. It may also be a
result of cooking too long at very high temperature.
To avoid this, fresh eggs should always be used. Eggs should
be cooked within a minimum period and cooled immediately in running
water after cooking.
 Eggs prepared out of the shell
This method involves breaking the egg and using both the yolk
and white during cooking. Poaching, frying, and the process of making
scrambled eggs or omelet are some of the common methods done.
Culinary Uses:
 Eggs as a thickening agent and binder
When used as a binder or thickener, the hydrophilic colloids of
yolks and whites, due to the presence of proteins are converted into a
hydrophobic colloid thus turning it into a gel.
At high temperature, the gel toughens. This explains why the
white becomes an opaque mass when cooked at a temperature of
620C. For egg yolk, coagulation starts at 650C.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
69
 Eggs as leavening agent
Baked products such as sponge cakes, chiffon cakes, meringues, and
soufflés make use of eggs as leavened resulting in a light, airy texture. This is
explained by the incorporation of air during the beating of eggs. Foam is formed
when the albumen surrounds a colloidal system of air bubbles. When beating
eggwhites, overbeating must be avoided as this tends to stretch the albumen
and would result in a dry, watery appearance.
Why do you need to eat eggs?
Eggs may be considered as "functional foods". Functional foods are
foods that may have health benefits beyond their traditional nutritional value.
Eggs as functional foods contain lutein and zeaxanthin that reduce the risk of
cataracts and macular degeneration. Eggs may also belong to "designer
foods". Designer foods are foods that have been modified through
biotechnology to enhance their quality or nutritional value. Eggs as designer
foods contain omega-3-polyunsaturated fatty acids and vitamin E. So learn
now and explore the various egg dishes below.
Variety of Egg Dishes
Cooking Eggs in the Shell
Although the term boiled may appear in the name, eggs prepared in
the shell should actually be cooked at a bare simmer for best results. Eggs
are cooked in the shell to make hard- and soft-cooked and coddled eggs.
They may be served directly in the shell or they may be shelled and used to
make another preparation, such as deviled eggs, or as a garnish for salads or
vegetable dishes.
Select a pot deep enough for the eggs to be submerged in water. Have
on hand a slotted spoon, skimmer, or spider to remove eggs from the water
once they are cooked.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
70
Directions: Given the different recipes in preparing and cooking egg dishes,
perform the suggested activities below. Your product and performance will be
evaluated using the given rubric after each activity.
Hard – Cooked Eggs
Makes 10 servings
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Gas range
Saucepan
Ladle
Ingredients Needed:
20 Eggs
Cold water
Procedure:
1. Prepare tools, equipment and food items.
2. Place the eggs in a pot. Fill the pot with enough cold water to cover the
eggs by 2in/5in.
3. Bring the water to a boil and immediately lower the temperature to a
simmer. Begin timing the cooking at this point.
4. Cook small eggs for 12 minutes, medium eggs for 13 minutes, large
eggs for 14 to 15 minutes, and extra-large eggs for 15 minutes.
5. Drain immediately and cool under cold running water to stop cooking.
6. Peel as soon as possible by cracking the shell starting from the large
end. For easier peeling, peel while still warm, and hold under running
water to help loosen the shell.
7. Serve the eggs or refrigerate until needed.
Coddled Eggs. Put cold eggs into already simmering water and simmer for
30 seconds.
Soft-Cooked Eggs. Put cold eggs into already simmering water and simmer
for 3 to 4 minutes.
Medium-Cooked Eggs. Put cold eggs into already simmering water and
simmer for 5 to 7 minutes.
Poached Eggs
LM-Cookery Grade 10
71
Poached eggs are prepared by slipping shelled eggs into barely
simmering water and gently cooking until the egg holds its shape. The fresher
the egg, the more centered the yolk, the less likely the white is spread and
become ragged.
Poached eggs can be prepared in advance and held safely throughout
a typical service period to make the workload easier during service. Slightly
under poach the eggs, shock them in ice water to arrest the cooking process,
trim them, and hold them in cold water. At the time of service, reheat the eggs
in simmering water.
Eggs are most often poached in water, though other liquids, such as
red wine, stock, or cream, can also be used. Add vinegar and salt to the water
to encourage the egg protein to set faster. Otherwise, the egg whites can
spread too much before they coagulate.
Standard Qualities of Poached Eggs and Cooked Eggs in the Shell
1. Bright, shiny appearance
2. Compact, round shore, not spread or flattened
3. Firm but tender whites
4. Warm, liquid yolks
Poached Eggs
Makes 10 servings
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Saucepan
Skimmer
Ingredients Needed:
1 gal/3.84L water
1tbsp/15g salt
1 floz. /30ml distilled white vinegar
20 eggs
Procedure:
1. Prepare tools, equipment and food items. Be sure that eggs are chilled
until ready to poach.
2. Combine the water, salt and vinegar, in a deep pan and bring it to a
bare simmer.
3. Break each egg into a clean cup, and then slide the egg carefully into
the poaching water.
4. Cook for 3 to 5 minutes, or until the whites are set and opaque.
5. Remove the eggs from the water with a slotted spoon, blot them on
absorbent toweling, and trim the edges if desired.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
72
6. Serve or chill and refrigerate for later use.
A good-cooked poached egg has a compact, glossy, tender white, and
unbroken, thickened yolk
Critical factors:
 quality of the egg
 temperature
 amount of liquid
 the way the egg is put in the pan
Fried Eggs
Fried eggs call for perfectly fresh eggs, the correct heat level, an
appropriate amount of cooking fat, and a deft hand. Fried eggs may be
served sunny side up (not turned) or over (turned once). Fried eggs may
be basted with fat as they fry. Using very fresh eggs is the only way to
ensure a rich flavor and good appearance of the finished dish.
Standard Qualities of Fried Eggs
1. White should be shiny, uniformly set, and tender, not browned,
blistered or crisp at edges.
2. Yolk should be set properly according to desired doneness. Sunny
side-up yolks should be yellow and well rounded. In other styles, the
yolk is covered with a thin layer of coagulated white.
3. Relatively compact, standing high. Not spread out and thin.
5. A fried egg should have a yolk covered with a thin film of coagulated
egg white and still remain slightly fluid.
6. The egg white should be opaque, firm and tender, not chewy, crisp or
brown.
7. A perfectly fried egg is a glory to behold – crispy edges and a wobbly,
pinkish yolk.
8. It will provide a fried egg with a slightly crispy, frilly edge; the white will
be set and the yolk soft and runny
LM-Cookery Grade 10
73
Types of Fried Eggs
1. Sunny side up
Cook slowly without flipping until white is
completely set but yolk is still soft and yellow.
Heat must be low or bottom will toughen or burn
before top is completely set.
2. Basted
Do not flip. Add a few drops of water to pan
and cover to steam cook the top. A thin film
of coagulated white will cover the yolk which
should remain liquid.
3. Over easy
Fry and flip over. Cook just until the white
is just set but the yolk is still liquid.
4. Over medium
Fry and flip over. Cook until the yolk is partially
set.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
74
5. Over hard
Fry and flip over. Cook until the yolk is completely
set.
Fried Eggs
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Sauté pan (preferably non-stick)
Dish, turner
Ingredients Needed:
Fresh egg
Oil or clarified or whole butter, as needed for frying
Salt, as needed
Ground black pepper, as needed
Procedure:
1. Select very fresh grade AA eggs for best results.
2. Break the eggs into a dish.
3. Add about 1/8 inch fat to the sauté pan and set it to a moderate heat. Too
much fat will make the eggs greasy. Less fat will cause them to stick,
unless a pan with the nonstick coating is used.
4. When the fat is hot enough, slide the egg into the pan.
5. Tilt the pan, allowing the fat to collect at the side of the pan, and baste the
eggs with the fat as they cook.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
75
6. Season the eggs with salt and pepper and serve at once.
Eggs over Easy, Medium or Hard: turn the eggs over near the end of their
cooking time with a spatula and cook them on the other side until done as
desired, 20 to 30 seconds for over easy, 1 minute for over medium, 2
minutes for over hard.
Desirable Qualities of Fried Eggs
 glossy
 moist
 tender
Common pitfalls:
 eggs brown and crisp
 eggs white blistered
 eggs odd-shaped
 eggs sticking
Scrambled Eggs
Scrambled eggs can be made in two ways: the eggs can be stirred
constantly over low heat for a soft delicate curd and a creamy texture, or
stirred less frequently as they cook for a larger curd and a firm texture.
Whether prepared to order or to serve on a buffet line, scrambled eggs
must be served hot, fresh and moist.
Choose eggs that are fresh, with intact shells. Adding a small amount
of water or stock (about 2tsp/10ml per egg) to the beaten eggs will make
them puffier as the water turns to steam. Milk or cream may be used to
enrich the eggs. Scrambled eggs can be seasoned with salt and pepper,
and/or flavored or garnished with fresh herbs, cheese, sautéed vegetables,
smoked fish, or truffles.
Eggs can be scrambled in a sauté pan or on a griddle. Nonstick
surfaces make it easy to prepare scrambled eggs with a minimum amount
of added fat. Pans used for eggs should be reserved for that use only, if
possible. A table fork, wooden spoon, or spatula is needed for stirring the
eggs in cooking.
Do not overcook scrambled eggs or hold them too long. Overcooked
eggs are tough and watery and will turn green in steam table. Scrambled
eggs should be soft and moist.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
76
For flavor variations, the following ingredients may be added to
scrambled eggs before serving.
Chopped parsley or other herbs
Grated cheese
Diced ham
Crumbled bacon
Sautéed diced onions and green bell pepper
Diced smoked salmon
Sliced cooked breakfast sausage
A good scrambled egg must not be tough nor burned but completely
coagulated
Preparing and Cooking Egg Dishes
Directions: Given the different recipes in preparing and cooking egg dishes,
perform each of the activity and you will be evaluated using a rubric.
Scrambled Eggs
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Stainless bowl
Fork or egg beater
Sauté pan, steam kettle or tilting skillets
Ingredients Needed:
30 Eggs
1 tbsp. /15g salt
1 tsp/2g ground pepper
5 floz. /50ml water or milk (optional)
2 ½ floz. /75 ml clarified butter or oil
LM-Cookery Grade 10
77
Procedure:
1. Collect equipment and food items.
2. Break eggs into a stainless steel bowl and beat until well blended.
Season with salt and pepper.
3. Add small amount of milk or cream about 1 to 1 ½ t, if desired.
4. Heat butter in a small sauté pan or heat nonstick pan over medium
heat and add butter or oil, tilting the pan to coat the entire surface. The
pan should be hot but not smoking.
5. Pour the egg mixture into the pan.
6. Cook over low heat, stirring frequently with the back of the fork or
wooden spoon until the eggs are soft and creamy.
7. Remove the eggs from the heat when fully cooked, but still moist.
8. Serve at once.
Omelets
The rolled, or French-style, omelets start out like scrambled eggs, but
when the eggs start to set, they are rolled over. A folded or American style,
omelet is prepared in much the same manner, though it is often cooked on a
griddle rather than in a pan, and instead of being rolled, the American omelet
is folded in half. There are two other styles of omelets, both based upon a
beaten mixture of eggs, cooked either over direct heat or in an oven.
Choose eggs that are fresh, with intact shells. As with scrambled eggs,
the ability of the egg to hold its shape is irrelevant, but fresh eggs are
preferable. Omelets can be seasoned with salt, pepper, and herbs. Clarified
butter or oil is the most common cooking fat.
Omelets may be filled or garnished with cheese, sautéed vegetables or
potatoes, meats, and smoked fish, among other things. These fillings and
garnishes are incorporated at the appropriate point to be certain they are fully
cooked and hot when the eggs have been cooked. Grated or crumbled
cheeses will melt sufficiently from the heat of the eggs, and are often added
just before an omelet is rolled or folded.
Two Factors for Making Quality Omelets
1. High Heat.
This is an opposite to the basic principle of low temperature egg
cookery. The omelet cooks so fast that its internal temperature never has
time to get too high.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
78
2. A conditioned omelet pan.
The pan must have sloping sides and be of the right size so the omelet
can be shaped properly. It must be well seasoned or conditioned to avoid
sticking.
Suggested Omelet Fillings
Cheese Sautéed or creamed mushrooms
Creamed or curried chicken Creamed or buttered spinach
Sautéed onions with or without bacon Sautéed onions and diced potatoes
LM-Cookery Grade 10
79
Plain Rolled Omelet
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Small bowls
Sauté pan
Fork
Ingredients Needed:
30 eggs
1tbsp/15g salt
1tsp/2g ground pepper
5fl oz. /150 ml water, stock, milk, or cream (optional)
2 ½ fl.oz. /175 ml, as needed clarified butter or oil
Procedure
1. Prepare equipment and food items.
2. For each portion, beat 3 eggs well and season with salt and pepper.
Add the liquid, if using.
3. Heat a nonstick omelet pan over high heat and add the butter or oil,
tilting the pan to coat the entire surface.
4. Pour the entire egg mixture into the pan and scramble it with the back
of the fork or wooden spoon.
5. Move the pan and the utensil at the same time until the egg mixture
has coagulated slightly. Smooth the eggs into an even layer.
6. Let the egg mixture finish cooking without stirring.
7. Tilt the pan and slide a fork or a spoon around the lip of the pan,
under the omelet, to be sure it is not sticking. Slide the omelet to the
front of the pan and use a fork or a wooden spoon to fold it inside to
the center.
8. Turn the pan upside down, rolling the omelet onto the plate. The
finished omelet should be oval shaped.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
80
Notes:
Options for filling an omelet: A pre-cooked filling may be added to the
eggs after they have been smoothed into an even layer and before the omelet
is rolled. Alternatively, the rolled omelet can be slit open at the top, and a pre-
cooked filling can be spooned into the pocket.
To give the omelet, additional sheen, rub the surface lightly with butter.
A perfect omelet is fluffy, moist and tender, soft in the center, yellow in
color with no brown at all or just a hint of it, oval in shape, and all in one
continuous piece
Ham and Cheese Frittata
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Skillet/Non-stick pan
Knife
Non-stick turner
Fork or wire whisk
Small bowl
Chopping board
Ingredients:
1 cup diced cooked ham
½ cup sliced tomato
1pc white onion (cut into ring)
½ cup stripped sweet bell pepper
10pcs lightly beaten egg
¼ tsp ground black pepper
¼ cup shredded cheddar cheese
¼ cup evaporated milk
¼ tsp iodized salt
Procedure
1. In a skillet coated non-stick turner, put little oil, sauté the ham, onion,
tomato, red bell pepper and season to taste.
2. In a bowl, combine the egg and milk, salt, black pepper and pour over
ham mixture. Let eggs set on the bottom, then lift the edges to allow
any uncooked egg to flow underneath. Cover and cook until the eggs
LM-Cookery Grade 10
81
are set for about 3 minutes. Sprinkle with cheese and cut into wedges
to serve.
Read more: http://www.tasteofhome.com/recipes/ham-and-cheese-
frittata#ixzz36CpQIoa7
Standard Recipe CMDC
Baked Eggs
Baked eggs are also quick and easy to prepare.
1. Place a little butter in a custard cup. Put the cup in 1750C (3500F) oven
until the butter melts.
2. Break an egg into the cup, and sprinkle with salt and pepper, then top
the egg with a little milk.
3. Bake 15 to 20 minutes or until the egg white is set.
Review of Learning Outcome 2
Formative Assessment:
Direction: Label the types of fried eggs.
1.
2.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
82
3.
4.
5.
A. Direction: Prepare poached egg individually following the procedures
below.
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Saucepan
Skimmer
Ingredients Needed:
Eggs
Distilled vinegar
LM-Cookery Grade 10
83
Water
Procedure:
1. Prepare mise‘en place
2. Add 1 teaspoon salt and 2 teaspoons
distilled vinegar per quart of water if eggs
are not very fresh. This will help to
coagulate the egg white faster and keeps a
better shape.
3. Bring water to a simmer.
4. Break eggs one at a time, into a dish or a
small plate and slide into the simmering
water.
5. Simmer 3 to 5 minutes, until whites are
coagulated but yolks are still soft.
6. Remove eggs from pan with slotted spoon
or skimmer.
7. Drain well and trim off ragged edges.
8. Serve immediately.
(To hold for later service, plunge
immediately into cold water to stop
cooking. Reheat briefly in hot water at
service time).
LM-Cookery Grade 10
84
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking poached
egg and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision
and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking poached
egg and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or
supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking poached
egg with minor errors and performs the skill less satisfactorily with
some assistance and/or supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking
poached egg and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
Learning Outcome 3 Present Egg Dishes
Part of serving food is presentation. It should appeal to your mouth,
nose, and eyes. You don‘t have to be a trained chef to learn the basics of
plating, which is the art of presenting food in an attractive way.
Seven Simple Ways to Present Food like a Chef
1. Set the table properly. Your day-
to-day meals might be free-for-
all, but if you‘ve got guests
coming over, it‘s nice to have the
knives and forks in the right
places.
http://startcooking.com/public/images/IMG
LM-Cookery Grade 10
85
P4143.JPG
2. Choose your plates wisely. Make
sure your serving plates are big
enough to let each food item
stand out, but small enough that
the portions don‘t look tiny.
3. Read the clock! A fool proof way
to arrange food on a plate is to
place the carbohydrate (rice,
pasta, bread, etc.) at ―11
o‘clock,‖ the vegetables at ―2
o‘clock,‖ and the protein at ―6
o‘clock‖ from the diner‘s point of
view. This will also help you
portion correctly, if you
remember that vegetables
should cover about half of the
plate, starch one fourth, and
protein one fourth.
http://startcooking.com/public/IMG_1389.J
PG
LM-Cookery Grade 10
86
4. Just like with centerpieces, it‘s
good to have a little bit of height,
but don‘t overdo it or your guests
won‘t know how to proceed! If
you have a mound of mashed
potatoes (mid-height), you may
want to lean your pork chop
against it so that it is standing up
(high), with a row of snow peas
(low) in front. Or, top some rice
(low) with sliced grilled chicken
(cut into a few diagonal slices,
and fan them out) (mid-height)
and cross asparagus over top of
it (high).
5. Be odd. Don‘t be strange, but
things generally look more
interesting when they‘re in sets
of odd numbers, rather than even
numbers.
6. Play with color and texture. Even
if you‘re just serving Tomato
Soup and Grilled Cheese
Sandwiches, a green paper
napkin can make this simple
meal look really special!
http://startcooking.com/public/IMG_480
9.jpg
LM-Cookery Grade 10
87
7. Play with Height. This Chicken
Stir-fry with Broccoli looks more
interesting because of the high
mound of rice sitting next to it.
8. Garnish appropriately. Don‘t lose
sight of the recipe you made in
the first place! Any garnish on
the plate should be edible and
should enhance the flavor of the
main dishes. Grilled salmon
might be served with a lemon
wedge, for example. Garnishes,
like the cut-up fruit with the fried
egg below, are also a great way
to add color or texture.
http://startcooking.com/public/IMG_783
5-1.JPG
LM-Cookery Grade 10
88
Different Techniques in Presenting Egg Dishes Attractively.
Scrambled egg and bun on a plate Boiled eggs on white plate with
with cereal bread garnish
Scrambled egg with herbs Fried egg with bacon and toasted bread
Egg in a sandwich Hard-boiled eggs in different sizes and shape
LM-Cookery Grade 10
89
Scrambled egg in Manhattan plate Deviled eggs
Stuffed egg Salad egg
Poached egg Stir-fried eggs
LM-Cookery Grade 10
90
Baked eggs Hard boiled Easter eggs
Fried egg toppings Soft boiled egg
Shaped poached egg Baked eggs in potato bowls
LM-Cookery Grade 10
91
Occupational Health and Safety (OHS)
Occupational Health and Safety (OHS) is a cross-disciplinary area
concerned with protecting the safety, health and welfare of people engaged in
work or employment. Knowing OHS is essential to minimize the hazards and
risks not only to students, trainers and other people within the training
institution but also to others who will be affected.
Good OHS Practice
1. Disaster Plan - there should be plan in place to deal with any
emergency.
2. Training and Providing Relevant Information
3. Work and storage areas should be designed, constructed, and
equipped to ensure that there is minimum risk to archive material or
staff. It should be kept free of food and drinks, harmful contaminants,
pollutants or vermin radiation.
4. Near Miss and Hazardous Incidents and Accident Investigation
5. Report of Notifiable Accidents, Incidents and Dangerous Occurrences
6. First Aid
7. Personal Protective Equipment (PPE)
Basic Food Microbiology
Certain microscopic organisms, such as bacteria, are able to invade
the human body and cause illness and sometimes death. Because
contaminated foods are the major sources of organisms transmitted to
people, it is essential that food production must have a clear understanding of
food microbiology and the conditions involve in it.
What is food borne illness? Food borne infection? Food borne intoxication?
Food-borne illness is a disease that is carried and transmitted to
people by food.
Food-borne infection is a disease that results from eating food
containing harmful micro-organism.
Food-borne intoxication is a disease that results from eating food
containing toxins from bacteria, molds or certain plants or animals.
The common causes of outbreaks of food borne illness are:
1. Failure to properly refrigerate food
2. Failure to thoroughly heat or cook food
3. Infected employees/workers because of poor personal hygiene
practices
LM-Cookery Grade 10
92
4. Foods prepared a day or more before they are served
5. Raw, contaminated ingredients incorporated into foods that receive no
further cooking
6. Cross-contamination of cooked food through improperly cleaned
equipment
7. Failure to reheat food to temperature that kills bacteria
8. Prolonged exposure to temperatures favorable to bacterial growth.
Aside from food safety we should also be aware of the different
hazards in our workplace such as kitchen hazards, electrical hazards and
others. To avoid or control these kind of hazards the following should be
observed:
1. Use caution when working around hot oil.
2. Get trained in the proper use and maintenance of your deep fryer.
3. Observe all safety procedures and wear all protective equipment
provided for your use while preparing hot items.
4. Use gloves, scrapers, and other cleaning tools with handles.
5. Use the correct grease level and cooking temperatures for your deep
fryer.
6. Keep stove surfaces clean to prevent grease flare-ups.
7. Avoid reaching over or climbing on top of fryers and other hot surfaces.
Clean vents when oil is cool.
8. Keep floor surfaces clean and dry to prevent slipping or falling onto hot
surfaces.
9. Wear slip-resistant shoes. Floors should be cleaned often with grease-
cutting solutions.
10. Do not work closely to hot fryers when the floor is wet.
11. Do not spill water or ice into hot oil as this may cause a flare-up.
12. Do not overfill or pour excessive amount of frozen fries into deep fryer
at one time.
13. Overfilling causes excessive splashing and bubbling over of hot oil.
14. Do not pour excess ice from fry packages into the fryer.
15. Do not overheat the oil; use only manufacturers recommended cooking
temperatures.
16. Do not move or strain hot oil containers; wait until the oil is cool!
17. Extinguish hot oil/grease fires by using a class K fire extinguisher.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
93
Here are some tips on how to handle eggs:
Purchasing: Do not buy dirty, cracked, or outdated eggs.
Storage:
1. Store at 45 o F or below.
2. Store in closed container.
3. Store away from strong odors.
4. Refrigerate leftover egg dishes in shallow containers.
5. Do not allow drippings to contaminate eggs.
Preparation/Cooking:
1. Keep refrigerated before and after cooking.
2. Keep everything clean.
3. Use only clean, not cracked eggs.
4. Cook thoroughly.
5. Wash container used for egg thoroughly.
6. Use egg separator
Service/Transport:
1. Serve promptly after cooking.
2. Keep cold food cold, hot food hot.
3. Use ice or cold packs when transporting.
4. Avoid eating raw eggs or food that contain raw eggs.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
94
Review of Learning Outcome 3
Formative Assessment (Learning Outcome 3)
A. Directions: Identify the different ways in presenting cooked eggs. Write
your answer in your test notebook.
1.
3.
5.
2.
4.
6.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
95
7. 8.
9. 10.
B. Directions: Prepare and cook French omelet individually using the
given recipe. Present your product in an artistic way. Your product and
performance will be evaluated using the given rubric.
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Small bowls
Sauté pan
Fork
LM-Cookery Grade 10
96
Ingredients Needed:
Three eggs
Salt and pepper
Clarified butter
Fillings
Procedure:
1. Prepare the necessary equipment.
2. Beat two or three eggs on a small bowl
first until well-mixed. Do not whip until
frothy. Season with salt and pepper. A
tablespoon water may be added to make
the omelet lighter.
3. Place an omelet pan over high heat.
4. When the pan is hot, add one tablespoon
clarified butter to coat the inside of the
pan. Give it a second to get hot.
5. Add eggs to the pan.
6. With one hand, vigorously shake the pan
back and forth. At the same time, stir the
eggs with a circular motion with the bottom
side of the fork, but do not let the fork
scrape the pan.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
97
8. Tilt the handle up and shake the pan so the
omelet slides to the opposite side.
9. For filled omelet, spoon the filling across the
center of the egg.
10. With the fork, fold the sides of the omelet
over the center.
11. Grasp the handle of the pan, and tilt the
omelet into the plate so it inverts and
keeps an oval shape.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
98
Your output will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
Dimension
P E R F O R M A N C E L E V E L
Excellent
(4 pts.)
Very
Satisfactory
(3 pts.)
Satisfactory
(2 pts.)
Needs Improvement
(1 pt.)
No
Attempt
(0 pt.)
Points
Earned
1. Use of tools
and equipment
Uses tools and
equipment correctly
and confidently at all
times
Uses tools
and
equipment
correctly and
confidently
most of the
times
Uses tools and
equipment correctly
but less confidently
sometimes
Uses tools and
equipment
incorrectly and less
confidently most of
the time
No
attempt
2. Application
of procedures
Manifests very clear
understanding of the
step- by-step
procedure
Manifests
clear
understandin
g of the step-
by-step
procedure
Manifests
understanding of
the step-by-step
procedure
but sometimes
seeks clarification
Manifests less
understanding of the
step- by-step
procedure seeking
clarification most of
the time
No
attempt
Works independently
with ease and
confidence at all times
Works
independentl
y with ease
and
confidence
most of the
time
Works independently
with ease and
confidence
sometimes
Works independently
but with assistance
from others most of
the time
No
attempt
3. Safety work
habits
Observes safety
precautions at all times
Observes
safety
precautions
most of the
time
Observes safety
precautions
sometimes
Not observing safety
precautions most of
the time
No
attempt
4. Final Output Output is very
presentable and taste
exceeds the standard.
Output is
very
presentable
and taste
meets the
standard.
Output is
presentable and
taste is little below
the standard.
Output is not so
presentable and
taste is not within the
standard.
No
attempt
5. Time
management
Work completed ahead
of time
Work
completed
within
allotted time
Work completed
(mins./hours/day
s) beyond
Work completed
(mins./hours/day
s) beyond
No
attempt
TOTAL POINTS
LM-Cookery Grade 10
99
Learning Outcome 4 Store Egg Dishes
Storage is done to maintain the quality of food, prolong the shelf-life,
maintain an adequate supply of food and ensure its safety for consumption.
Proper storage of food is very crucial in keeping food safe because the
manner and temperature of storage will affect the food‘s susceptibility to
bacterial growth, other contaminants and infestation. Storing food will not
improve its quality, it will only delay the rate of deterioration, and thus the
proper period of storage should also be observed.
Eggs should be stored properly to prevent increase in alkalinity and
bacterial growth. They should be stored in an oval, dry place to retard
deterioration, as enzymatic activity is greater at room temperature.
Keeping eggs as fresh as possible depends on the care taken by the
farmer, wholesaler, and grocer to refrigerate them at all times. After you have
chosen your eggs by size, grade, freshness, and type, proper storage will
help maintain their quality.
Kind of Storage
 Cold Storage (refrigerated storage, deep chilling, freezer storage)
keeping potentially hazardous foods cold enough to prevent bacteria
from growing.
The temperature of the freezer compartment must be at 0°F
or less, and the eggs should be stored in an area of the
freezer where there is the least amount of temperature
fluctuation.
 Dry Storage should be dry, cool, well-ventilated, free from insects and
rodents, clean and orderly.
In the absence of refrigerators, eggs may be stored at room
temperature for about seven days. Left-over egg yolks and egg whites
should be kept in containers that will prevent drying.
Tips for Storing Raw and Cooked Eggs:
 Put eggs in the refrigerator as soon as possible after purchase.
 Keep them in their covered carton (large end up) to preserve moisture
and assure darkness. Do not put them in the egg box at the door of the
refrigerator.
 Keep eggs away from strong odors. These can be absorbed through
the shells, which are porous.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
100
 Whole eggs can be beaten slightly and placed in a container with a
tight seal and stored in the freezer for up to one year.
 Egg whites also can be stored for up to a year in a tightly sealed
container in the freezer.
 When storing egg yolks in the freezer, a small amount of sugar or salt
should be added to prevent the yolks from becoming too thick and
gelatinous over time.
 Add a pinch of salt per yolk if the yolks will be used for savory dishes,
or add about a ¼ teaspoon of sugar per yolk if the yolks will be used
for sweet dishes.
 Do not wash eggs before storing them. This destroys the mineral-oil
film that coats the shells and helps keep them fresh.
 Dip the eggs in oil to cover the pores and to delay its deteriorative
changes, reduce mold penetration and retard spoilage.
 Do not keep eggs longer than 2 weeks in the refrigerator.
 Left-over raw yolks can be refrigerated for several days when covered
with water, milk, or oil. Two yolks can be used in place of 1 whole egg
in a recipe.
 Left-over raw whites can be stored in a tightly covered plastic or glass
container in the refrigerator for several days or as long as they do not
have any odor. They can also be frozen, although when thawed the
white is thinner. However, you can use them successfully in recipes
calling for egg whites.
Recommended Storage Time for Eggs
Fresh shell eggs Buy best before date
Left-over yolks or whites Within 2 to 4 days
Hard-Cooked eggs Within 1 week
Prepared egg dishes Within 3 to 4 days
Pickled eggs Within 1 month
Frozen whole eggs (blended) Within 4 months
Carson, Byrta, M.S., et.al., How you Plan and Prepare Meals, third edition copyright 1980 by McGraw-Hill, Inc.
pp. 353 -363
LM-Cookery Grade 10
101
Review of Learning Outcome 4
A. Directions: Write true if the statement is correct and false if it is incorrect.
Write your answer on your test notebook.
1. Eggs should be stored properly to prevent increase in alkalinity and
bacterial growth.
2. Fresh eggs can be kept more than two weeks.
3. When storing egg yolks in the freezer, a small amount of sugar or salt
should be added to prevent the yolks from becoming too thick and thin over
time.
4. To delay the deteriorative changes, reduce the penetration of mold and
retard spoilage of eggs, cover the pores by dipping the eggs in oil.
5. In the absence of refrigerator, eggs may be stored at room temperature for
about two weeks.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
102
Cereals are usually starchy pods or grains. Cereal grains are the most
important group of food crops in the world named after the Roman goddess of
harvest, Ceres. Rice, wheat and corn are the three most cultivated cereals in
the world. Starch on the other hand, exists in nature as the main component
of cereals and tubers. In manufactured and processed foods, it plays an
obvious role in achieving the desired viscosity in such products as cornstarch
pudding, sauces, pie fillings, and gravies.
Starch is the second most abundant organic substance on earth. It is
found in all forms of leafy green plants, located in the roots, fruits or grains.
Many of the food staples of man throughout the world are basically starchy
foods, such as rice, corn, cassava, wheat, potato and others. Starch is the
source of up to 80% of calories worldwide. Besides this significant role,
starches have been used in food manufacture, cosmetics, pharmaceuticals,
textiles, paper, construction materials, and other industries.
Objectives
At the end of the module the learners are expected to:
1. perform mise‘en place;
2. prepare starch and cereal dishes;
3. present starch and cereal dishes; and
4. store starch and cereal dishes.
Learning Outcome 1 Perform Mise’en Place
Tools and Equipment Needed
The success of cooking starch and cereal dishes depends on the
proper tools and equipment used in the preparation of food. The preparation
of starch and cereal dishes requires the various tools and equipment below.
Each tool must be used according to its function.
1. Mixing bowl – used when preparing cake mixture, salads, creams, and
sauces.
2. Sifter – used for separating coarse particles of flour, sugar, baking
powder, and powdered ingredients to retain finer textures.
LESSON 2 PREPARE CEREALS AND STARCH
LM-Cookery Grade 10
103
3. Wire whip – used for beating egg whites, egg yolk, creams and
mayonnaise.
4. Wooden spoon – used for mixing creams, butter, and for tossing
salads.
5. Slotted spoon – used to separate solid particles from soup; also for
stirring purposes, such as making egg white fine in texture for bird‘s
nest soup and mock nido soup.
6. Blending fork – used for testing the tenderness of meat, combining big
cuts and particles of meat and vegetables, and for blending other
ingredients with flour.
7. Rubber scraper – used for scraping off mixtures of butter, sugar, and
egg from the sides of the mixing bowl.
8. Strainer – used for separating liquids from fine or solid food particles,
such as coco cream from coconut and tamarind extract.
9. Tongs – used for handling hot foods.
10. Measuring Cups – used for measuring dry and liquid ingredients
11. Measuring spoon – used for measuring dry and liquid ingredients
which require a little amount
12. Sauce pan and pots – used for cooking meat and fish dishes with
gravy and sauce.
13. Kettle and rice cooker – used for cooking rice and other foods.
14. Pressure cooker – used for tenderizing or cooking meat, chicken, and
other grains or legumes, such as mongo and white beans in lesser
time..
15. Double boiler – used for preparing sauces which easily get scorched
when cooked directly on the stove.
16. Steamer – used for cooking food by steaming.
17. Colander - a perforated bowl of varying sizes made of stainless steel,
aluminum or plastic, used to drain, wash, or cook ingredients from
liquid
18. Canister - a plastic or metal container with a lid that is used for keeping
dry products
19. Butcher knife – used for cutting, sectioning, and trimming raw meats
20. Channel knife – a small hand tool used generally in decorative works
such as making garnishes.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
104
Sources of Starch
The parts of plants that store most starch are seeds, roots, and tubers.
Thus, the most common sources of food starch are:
 cereal grains, including corn, wheat, rice, grain, sorghum, and oats;
 legumes; and
 roots or tubers, including potato, sweet potato, arrowroot, and the
tropical cassava plant (marketed as tapioca)
Common Source of Manufactured Food Starch
1. corn
2. potato
3. Tapioca (cassava)
Starches are named after its plant sources
 corn starch from corn
 rice starch from rice
 tapioca from cassava
Classification of Starch
1. Native or Natural Starch refers to the starches as originally derived
from its plant source.
2. Modified Starches are starches that have been altered physically or
chemically, to modify one or more of its key chemicals and/or physical
property.
3. Purified starch may be separated from grains and tubers by a process
called wet milling. This procedure employs various techniques of
grinding, screening, and centrifuging to separate the starch from fiber,
oil, and protein.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
105
Starch Composition and Structure
The Starch Molecule
Starch is polysaccharide made up of hundreds or even thousands of
glucose molecules joined together. The molecules of starch are two general
types, called fractions: amylose and amylopectin.
Amylose is a long chain-like molecule, sometimes called the linear
fraction, and is produced by linking together 500 to 2, 000 glucose molecules.
The amylose fraction of starch contributes gelling characteristics to cooked
and cooled starch mixtures. A gel is rigid to a certain degree and holds a
shape when molded.
Amylopectin has a highly branched, bushy type of structure, very
different from the long, string-like molecules of amylose. In both, amylose and
amylopectin, however, the basic building unit is glucose. Cohesion or
thickening properties are contributed by amylopectin when a starch mixture is
cooked in the presence of water, but this fraction does not produce a gel.
Most natural starches are mixtures of the two fractions. Corn, wheat,
rice, potato, and tapioca starches contains 24 to 16 percent amylose, with the
remainder being amylopectin. The root starches of tapioca and potato are
lower in amylose content than the cereal starches of corn, wheat, and rice.
The Starch Granule
In the storage areas of plants, notably the seeds and roots, molecules
of starch are deposited in tiny, organized units called granules. Amylose and
amylopectin molecules are placed together in tightly packed stratified layers
formed around a central spot in the granule called the hilum. The starch
molecules are systematically structured in the granule to form crystalline-like
patterns. If the starch granules, in a water suspension, are observed
microscopically under polarized light, the highly oriented structure causes the
light to be rotated so that a Maltese cross pattern on each granule is
observed. This phenomenon is called birefringence. The pattern disappears
when the starch mixture is heated and the structure disrupted. The sizes and
shapes of granules differ among starches from various sources, but all starch
granules are microscopic in size.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
106
Composition of Starch
Potato Cassava Wheat Cornstarch
Moisture,% 19 13 13
Ash,% 0.4 0.2 0.2
Protein, % 0.06 0.1 0.4
Lipid,% 0.05 0.1 0.8
Phosphorus% 0.08 0.01 0.06
Amylose,% 21 17 28
Micrograph
1. Muhrbeck, P. and A.-C.Eliasson. 1987. Influence of pH and ionic strength on the viscoelastic properties of starch
gels- a comparison of potato and cassava starches. Carbohydrate Polymers 7: 291-300.
Starch Properties and Reactions
1. Gelatinization.The sum of changes that occur in the first stages of heating
starch granules in a moist environment which includes swelling of granules
as water is absorbed and disruption of the organized granule structure.
2. Viscosity. The resistance to flow; increase in thickness or consistency.
When the newly gelatinized starch is stirred, more swollen granules break
and more starch molecules spill causing increase in viscosity or thickness.
Changes in Gelatinization of Starch
hydration and swelling to several times original size
loss of birefringence
increase in clarity
marked, rapid increase in consistency and attainment of peak
"dissolution" of linear molecules and diffusion from ruptured granules.
with heat removal, retro gradation of mixture to a paste-like mass of
gel.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
107
The type of sugar influences the temperature and rate of
gelatinization. The effect of sugar is attributed to competition for water.
It was observed that sugar actually interacts with the amorphous areas
of the starch granules.
Different Sweeteners Added to Starch Gel Preparation.
 honey
 molasses
 panutsa or granulated sugar
3. Retrogadationis the process in which starch molecules, particularly the
amylose fraction, re-associate or bond together in an ordered structure
after disruption by gelatinization; ultimately a crystalline order appears.
4. Syneresis. Oozing of liquid from gel when cut and allowed to stand (e.g.
jelly or baked custard). The oozing of liquid from a rigid gel; sometimes
called weeping.
This reaction occurs in all kinds of gels:
puddings
jellies
custards
gelatin
agar
5. Dextrinization. It is the process of forming dextrin. Dextrins – are partially
hydrolyzed starches that are prepared by dry roasting. In home kitchens,
dextrinization is achieved by toasting flour for polvoron, rice flour for kare-
kare sauce, and bread slices for breakfast.
6. Hydrolysis Starches undergo hydrolysis during cooking or processing and
during storage of food where a chemical reaction in which a molecular
linkage is broken and a molecule of water is utilized.
a. Prolonged heating of starches with acid will promote hydrolysis.
This can happen when cooking an acidic food, such as:
Pineapple pie resulting in reduced viscosity or firmness of the
pie filling.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
108
Functional Properties of Starches
Starch plays various roles in food, a typical multi-tasker
1. Thickeners in gravies, sauces and pudding. It absorbs water and
become a gel when cooked.
2. Colloidal stabilizers
3. Moisture retainer
4. Gel forming agents
5. Binders
6. Package
7. Flavor carriers– its ability to trap oils and fats, which absorb
flavoring substances more efficiently.
Starches – are added to processed meats (luncheon meats, hot dogs,
sausages, etc.) as a filler, binder, moisture, retainer, and fat substitute. The
quality characteristics of the starch itself depends upon which role or function
it was used.
Cereal. Cereal is any grain that is used for food. Grains especially
whole grain are not just empty calories. These are very valuable and can
contribute a great deal to our health. You should include at least four servings
from this food group each day.
Cereal-processed food:
 A whole grain cereal is a grain product that has retained the specific
nutrients of the whole, unprocessed grain and contains natural
proportions of bran, germ and endosperm.
 Enriched cereals are excellent sources of thiamine, niacin, riboflavin,
and iron.
 A restored cereal is one made from either the entire grain or portions
of one or more grains to which there have been added sufficient
amounts of thiamine, niacin, and iron to attain the accepted whole
grain levels of these three nutrients found in the original grain from
which the cereal is prepared.
Cereals provide the body with:
 Carbohydrates
 Protein
 Fat
 Vitamins
 Minerals
 Water
 Cellulose or roughage
LM-Cookery Grade 10
109
Nutritional Significance of Noodles and Pasta or Alimentary Paste
The physiological function of noodles and
pasta will depend on its starch and other constituents.
Since it is basically a starchy food, the nutritional
significance discussed for starches also applies. In
addition to starches, including resistant starches I
(RS), noodles and pasta may contain other fibers and
some proteins and fat as well.
Nutritive value:
 Water
 Protein
 Fat
 Carbon
 Calcium
 Phosphorous
 Iron
 Thiamin
 Riboflavin
 Niacin
Dried Noodles and Pasta
 Macaroni • Miki
 Spaghetti • Chicken Mami
 Pancit Canton • Linguini
 Bihon • Lasagňa
 Sotanghon
 Miswa
LM-Cookery Grade 10
110
Review of Learning Outcome 1
A. Directions: Complete the table by writing the appropriate tool and
equipment in column B to perform the task given in column A. Write
your answer in your test notebook.
A B
1. Used for separating coarse
particles of flour, sugar,
baking powder, and powdered
ingredients to retain finer
textures.
2. Used for cooking meat and
fish dishes with gravy and
sauce.
3. Used for cooking food by
steaming
4. Used for tenderizing meat,
chicken, and other grains or
legumes, such as mongo and
white beans in lesser time.
5. Used for separating liquids
from fine or solid food
particles, such as coco cream
from coconut and tamarind
extract.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
111
B. Directions: Enumerate the different kinds of starch and give its nutritional
value
1.
2.
3.
4.
C.Give at least three starch properties and reactions and describe it in one
sentence.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
112
Learning Outcome 2 Prepare and Cook Starch and Cereal
Dishes
One of the properties of starch is viscosity which is the resistance to
flow of starch and modified starch paste. In the preparation and cooking of
starch and cereal dishes, factors affecting starch paste viscosity and starch
gel strength should be considered.
Factors Affecting Starch Paste Viscosity and Starch Gel Strength
 Stress or other factor. Stirring Amount and Type. This is a gelatinized
cornstarch dispersion that is likely to break; the granules broke apart
due to stirring.
 Kind and Amount of Starch. Certain type of starch will influence the
characteristics of the starch paste viscosity and gel strength. Generally
speaking, with "native starches" the greater the amount of amylopectin
the more viscous the starch paste, whereas, the greater the amount of
amylase, the firmer the gel is (greater the gel strength).
 Heating rate. The faster starch-water dispersion is heated; the thicker
it will be at the identical endpoint temperature.
 Endpoint Temperature
 Each type of starch has a specific endpoint temperature at
which it will undergo optimum gelatinization.
 Incompletely gelatinized starch will not attain optimum starch
paste viscosity or gel strength.
 Over gelatinization results in decreased starch paste viscosity
and gel strength because the swollen granules fragmented with
stirring and/or imploded due to the extensive loss of amylase
from the granule.
 Cooling and storage conditions
 If cooled too fast, the amylase will not have time to form the
vital micelles necessary for the three dimensional structure.
 If cooled too slowly, the amylase fractions will have a chance to
align too much and become too close together and the liquid
portion will not be trapped in the micelles. In both instances
there will be weeping and syneresis (the contraction of a gel
accompanied by the separating out of liquid.).
LM-Cookery Grade 10
113
 Ingredients added (acid, enzyme, sugar, fat and emulsifiers
a. Addition of acid or enzyme can also cause dextrinization (the
process of forming dextrins).
 Dextrin – a pale powder obtained from starch, used mainly
as an adhesive.
 In making kalamansi pudding or pie, if the juice is added
early in the gelatinization process, dextrinization of the
starch will occur resulting in decreased viscosity and gel
strength.
 Sugar will delay or inhibit gelatinization of starch.
 Starch pudding with excess sugar will be less viscous or
form less firm gel.
 A cake may collapse as the structural contribution of starch
is delayed or inhibited.
 Decreased starch paste viscosity and gel strength because
the sugar added to water won‘t be available for
gelatinization. The kind of sugar used also affect viscosity.
 Fat and surfactants, will serve to ―waterproof‖ the starch
granules so that water will not penetrate as readily during the
gelatinization process.
Functions of Starch and Application in Filipino Dishes
Functions of
Starch
Type of Food
Preparation
Recipes
Thickening Sauces, Gravies, Pie
fillings and soups
Sauces: Sweet sour, lechon,
lumpia, kare-kare, palabok
Pie filling: mango, buko,
apple, pineapple
Soups: Arrozcaldo, cream
soups.
Gelling Puddings, kakanin Bread pudding, majaBlanca,
sapin-sapin, kutchinta,
cassava bibingka
Binding and
filling
Meat loaves and meat
emulsions
Luncheon meat, hot dogs,
Vienna sausage, chicken
nuggets, chicken balls,
Ukoy, tempura
LM-Cookery Grade 10
114
Stabilizing Beverage, syrup, salad
dressing
Chocolate drinks, fruits
drinks, yogurt drinks,
cooked dressings
Moisture
retaining
Cake fillings, candies Cake rolls, cream fillings
Coating or
ducting
Breads, confectionery,
pastries
Pan de sal, Biscuits,
candies, espasol
Diluent Baking powder, Cupcake
Coloring Toasts, bread crumbs Polvoron, Lechon sauce,
Kare-kare sauce, breadings
Common Problems in Starch Cookery
1. Thinning of Gel. This problem is usually encountered when using acid
or acid ingredients such as lemon or vinegar.
2. Weak Gel. Weak gel results if there is too much liquid in relation to the
starch
3. Skin Formation. Skin formation is due to loss of water from the starch
and protein molecules near the surface of the mixture. To reduce this
problem, cover container of the starch gel with a waterproof cover.
4. Scorching. This can be avoided by temperature control and constant
stirring so the starch granules do not settle at the bottom of the cooking
pan.
5. Raw Starch Flavor. This is due to ungelatinized starch.
Principles in Cooking Cereals
In cooking all cereal products, the following points should be observed:
1. Use a double boiler.
2. Observe carefully the correct proportions of cereal, water and salt.
3. Cook at boiling temperature (212° F.).
4. Watch the time by the clock, and always cook the full time prescribed,
preferably longer.
5. Serve attractively.
6. Improper cooking and poor serving are largely responsible for
unpopularity of cereal foods.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
115
Cooking Pasta
Pasta should be cooked al dente, or ―to the tooth‖. This means the
cooking should be stopped when the pasta still feels firm to the bite, not soft
and mushy. The pleasure of cooking pasta is its texture, and this is lost if it is
overcooked. To test for doneness, break pasta into small piece and taste it.
As soon as pasta is al dente, cooking must be stopped at once. Half a minute
extra is enough to overcook it.
Cooking times differ for every shape and size of pasta. Timing also
depends on the kind of flour used, and the moisture content.
Fresh egg pasta, if it has not been allowed to dry, takes only 1 to 1 ½
minutes to cook after the water has returned to a boil.
Italian practice is to toss the pasta with the sauce the minute it is
drained, the sauce immediately coats all surfaces of the pasta, and the
cheese, melts in the heat of the boiling hot noodles.
This picture is to be replaced.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
116
Basic Principles in Preparing Pasta
Pasta Shapes
There are hundreds of shapes and sizes of pasta with each shape
used for different preparations based on how the sauce will cling, the
texture desired, or how the product will be used. For example:
• Pasta shapes with holes or ridges, such as wagon wheels or
rotini, are perfect for chunkier sauces.
• Thin, delicate pastas, such as angel hair or vermicelli, are
better served with light, thin sauces.
• Thicker pasta shapes, such as fettuccine, work well with heavier
sauces.
• Very small pasta shapes, like alphabet shapes and acini di
pepe, are good for soups.
Flavored pasta is available in a variety of shapes in both the dried and
fresh forms. Vegetable ingredients are added to pasta to provide both color
and flavor. An example of flavored pasta is spinach noodles that are green.
Follow the package directions for cooking flavored pastas.
Cooking Time Depends on the Shape
It is important to be familiar with different shapes of pasta so
cooking times can be adjusted. The larger and fuller the pasta shape, the
longer the cooking time. Most pasta recipes specify cooking times for pasta
cooked al dente, tender but firm. Al dente is an Italian phrase that means
―to the tooth.‖ Some of the pasta shapes and cooking times are shown in
the ―Cooking Chart for Various Pasta Shapes.‖ Just seeing this chart helps
to emphasize how important it is to follow the recipe and cook pasta the
right way.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
117
Pasta Gets Bigger and Heavier when Cooked
Generally, pasta doubles or triples in weight when it is
cooked. Likewise, the volume increases 2 to 2 ½ times during cooking.
Follow the Recipe
The general rule for cooking pasta in boiling water is for 1 pound
of pasta, use 1 gallon of water, 1 teaspoon of salt, and 1 teaspoon of oil. For
100 servings of spaghetti, 6 gallons of water, 2 tablespoons of salt, and 2
tablespoons of oil are needed to cook 6 pounds of dried spaghetti.
When pasta is to be used as an ingredient in a recipe that
will be cooked more, like macaroni and cheese, it should be slightly
undercooked. This means reducing the cooking time by about 2 minutes.
Pasta that is not cooked enough is tough and chewy. Pasta that is
overcooked is soft and pasty. When overcooked pasta is combined with a
sauce, it often breaks apart. Handle pasta the right way after it is cooked.
Like most foods, pasta is best when it is cooked and served right away.
However, it is sometimes necessary to cook it ahead and hold it until time
for service.
Suggestions for Holding Pasta
To serve immediately Drain, add sauce, and serve.
To hold for a short time
for service later
Drain, toss with a small amount of oil to prevent
sticking, cover, and hold in warmer.
To serve as part of a
salad
Cook pasta a day ahead so it will be chilled when
combined with the other salad ingredients. Do not
combine hot pasta with cold ingredients. Drain and
cover with cold water just long enough to cool. The
pasta does not need refrigeration for a short time,
it is cooled in the water. When pasta is cool, drain
and toss lightly with oil to prevent sticking or drying
out. Cover and refrigerate.
To cook a day ahead
for service in a heated
dish
Drain and cover with cold water just long enough
to cool. When pasta is cool, drain and toss lightly
with oil to prevent sticking or drying out. Cover and
refrigerate. When it is time to use the pasta,
immerse it in boiling water until just heated
through. Drain immediately and use according to
LM-Cookery Grade 10
118
the recipe. The pasta should not be cooked more,
just heated to serving temperature.
To use in a cooked dish Slightly undercook the pasta.
Cooking Chart for Various Pasta Shapes
Pasta Name
Cooking Time
for al dente
Pasta Name
Cooking Time
for al dente
Lasagna 15 minutes Ziti 10 minutes
Bow Ties 11 minutes Fettuccine 8 minutes
Wagon
Wheels
11 minutes
Rotini
8 minutes
Linguine
10 minutes
Elbow
Macaroni
6 minutes
Rigatoni 10 minutes Noodles 6 minutes
Spaghetti 10 minutes
Directions: Given the recipe, by pair or by group cook pasta following the
procedures. Your product and performance will be evaluated using the given
rubric.
How to Cook Pasta?
Materials needed:
 500g pasta
 Salt
 Water
LM-Cookery Grade 10
119
Tools/equipment needed
 Burner
 Kettle
 Ladle
 Colander
Procedure for Cooking Pasta
1. Put 4 quarter water per 500 g of pasta in a kettle. Add 1 ½ teaspoon
salt.
2. Boil the water rapidly and drop in the pasta. As it softens, stir gently to
keep it from sticking together and to the bottom. Continue to boil,
stirring a few times.
3. Drain immediately in a colander as soon as it is al dente, and rinse with
cold running water until the pasta is completely cooled. If serve
immediately, just drain well from hot water.
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking pasta
and performs the skill without supervision.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking pasta
and performs the skill with some assistance or supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking pasta
with minor errors and performs the skill with some assistance
and/or supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking
pasta and was not able to perform the skill.
Risk in the preparation and cooking of starch and cereal dishes and
other food
 Food handlers;
 Kitchen facilities;
 Food selection and preparation; and
 Safe temperatures.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
120
Guidelines on proper and safe handling of food
1. Food handlers
 Undergo training on food safety and obtain medical certificates from
the local/provincial/city/municipal health office.
 Observe proper hand washing technique
 Wear complete cooking outfit and use disposable gloves for direct food
contact.
 Observe personal hygiene at all times.
 Avoid handling food if you are sick.
2. Kitchen facilities
 Use separate equipment and utensils for handling raw foods
 Sanitize all surfaces and equipment used for food preparation
 Clean thoroughly the cutting-boards and work areas after each use
 Protect the kitchen areas and food from insects, pests and other
animals
 Maintain the highest standards of sanitation in the kitchen at all times
 Repair immediately broken but still serviceable kitchen tools, utensils
and equipment to be ready for next use
 Sanitize completely all kitchen utensils especially cups, saucers,
flatware after each use
 Provide for adequate space, proper ventilation and window screens in
the area
 Provide garbage receptacle for proper waste disposal
3. Food Preparation and Cooking
 Check expiry dates of food commodities bought and those in stock
 Use iodized salt as a must in salt-seasoned preparations
 Cover the food properly.
 Practice segregation of materials
 Store food properly
4. Safe temperature
 Do not leave cooked food at room temperature for more than two
hours
 Refrigerate promptly all cooked and perishable food preferably below
50C within four hours
LM-Cookery Grade 10
121
 Do not store food too long even in the refrigerator.
 Thaw food inside the refrigerator, not at room temperature.
 Check internal temperature during cooking to assure proper end-point
time and temperature has been met to at least 700C/1650F
 Reheat cooked food thoroughly to 700C/1650F within two hours
B. Directions: Collect at least 20 different recipes of starch and cereal
dishes and compile it using any kind of paper, any decorating materials,
glue, and coloring materials.
Your output will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
SCORE CRITERIA
5 Compiled properly (20) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in a very
attractive manner
4 Compiled properly (16-19) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in an
attractive manner
3 Compiled properly (10-15) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in simple
manner
2 Compiled properly (6-9) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in simple
manner
1 Compiled less than 6 recipes of starch and cereal dishes in disorganized
manner
LM-Cookery Grade 10
122
s:
C. Directions: Given the recipe, prepare and present Fettuccine Alfredo
following the procedures.
Ingredient
1 cup heavy cream
2 tbsp butter
1 ½ lb. fresh fettuccine
1 cup heavy cream
6 tbsp. freshly grated parmesan cheese
salt to taste
pepper to taste
Procedure:
1. Combine the cream and butter in a sauté pan. Bring to simmer,
reduce by ¼ and remove from heat.
2. Drop the noodles into boiling salted water, return to a full boil and
drain. Undercook slightly the noodles because they will cook further in
the cream.
3. Put the noodles in the pan with hot cream and butter. Toss the
noodles with two forks until they are well coated with the cream, over
low heat.
4. Add the remainder of the cream and cheese and toss to mix well.
5. Add salt and pepper to taste.
6. Plate and serve immediately.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
123
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking starch
dish and performs the skill without supervision and with initiative
and adaptability to problem situations.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking starch
dish and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or
supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking starch
dish with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with
some assistance and/or supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking
starch dish and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
Learning Outcome 3 Present Starch and Cereal Dishes
Techniques in Preparing Pasta before Plating
1. Pasta is best if cooked and served immediately. Try to cook pasta
upon order.
2. If pasta is to be served immediately, just drain and do not rinse in cold
water.
3. If pasta is to be used cold in salad, it is ready to be incorporated in the
recipe as soon as it has cooled.
4. If pasta is to be held, toss gently with a small amount of oil to keep it
from sticking.
5. Measure portions into mounds on trays. Cover with plastic film and
refrigerate until service time.
6. To serve, place the desired number of portions in a china cap and
immerse in simmering water to reheat. Drain, plate, and add sauce.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
124
PLATING AND PRESENTING PASTA DISHES
LM-Cookery Grade 10
125
D. Make an album of twenty different kinds of starch and cereal dish
presentations with recipes.
Your output will be rated using the rubric below:
SCORE CRITERIA
5 Compiled properly (20) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in a very
attractive manner
4 Compiled properly (16-19) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in an
attractive manner
3 Compiled properly (10-15) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in simple
manner
2 Compiled properly (6-9) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in simple
manner
1 Compiled less than 6 recipes of starch and cereal dishes in disorganized
manner
LM-Cookery Grade 10
126
B. Directions: Given the needed tools and equipment, prepare and present
Baked Lasagna following the recipe below:
Baked Lasagna
Ingredients:
¾ lb. ricotta cheese
2 tbsp. parmesan cheese, grated
1 pc egg
salt to taste
pepper to taste
1 lb. lasagna
6 cups meat sauce
¾ lb. mozzarella cheese, shredded
4 tbsp. parmesan cheese, grated
LM-Cookery Grade 10
127
Procedure:
1. Mix together the ricotta, parmesan and eggs then season to taste with salt
and pepper.
2. Cook lasagna noodles. Lay them out in a single layer on oiled sheet pans.
3. Ladle a little meat sauce into the pan. Spread it across the bottom.
4. Arrange a layer of noodles in the pan. Add a layer of ricotta mixture, a
layer of noodles, a layer of sauce and a layer mozzarella.
5. Continue making layers of noodles, ricotta, sauce and mozzarella until all
ingredients are used. Top with parmesan cheese.
6. Bake at 375°F (190°C. for about 30-45 minutes. Cover lightly with foil,
then remove after 15 minutes of baking time.
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
I. Products:
Very
Good
(4)
Good
(3)
Fair
(2)
Poor
(1)
1. General Appearance
a. attractive and appealing to appetite
b. pleasing and good color combination
c. ingredients cooked just right
2. Palatability
a. delicious
b. taste just right
3. Nutritive value
a. highly nutritious
II. Procedures:
1. Use of Resources:
a. keep working table orderly while preparing the
ingredients
b. use only the proper and needed utensils and
dishes
c. use time-saving techniques and devices
2. Cleanliness and sanitation
a. is well- groomed and properly dressed for
cooking, use clean apron, hair nets, hand towel
and pot holder
b. observe sanitary handling of food
3. Conservation of nutrients
a. follow proper preparation and cooking
procedures
LM-Cookery Grade 10
128
A. Directions: Watch a video in the YouTube showing how to make a
homemade pasta. Note down the procedures in your notebook and make a
narrative observation on a short bond paper for submission next meeting.
Review procedures and prepare for actual preparation.
B. Directions: Make your homemade pasta using your bare hands. You may
include other ingredients. Your products, performance and presentation will
be rated using the given rubric.
How to Make Homemade Pasta by Hand
Tools & Utensils:
Rolling pin
Mixing bowl
Measuring cup/spoon
Sharp cutter/knife
Ingredients:
2 cups all-purpose flour
¼ tsp salt
3 pcs egg
1tbsp milk
1tsp olive oil
Procedure:
1. Combine 2 cups all-purpose flour and 1/4 teaspoon salt on pastry board,
culling board, or countertop; make well in center. Whisk 3 eggs, 1
tablespoon milk, and 1 teaspoon olive oil in small bowl until well blended;
gradually pour into the flour mixture while mixing with fork or fingertips to
form ball of dough.
2. Gradually add the mixture to the flour to make a ball of dough.
3. Place dough on lightly floured surface; flatten slightly. To knead dough, fold
dough in half toward you and press dough away from you with heels of
hands. Give dough a quarter turn and continue folding, pushing, and
turning. Continue kneading for 5 minutes until smooth and elastic, adding
more flour to prevent sticking if necessary. Wrap dough in plastic and let it
stand for 15 minutes.
4. Knead the dough until it becomes smooth and elastic.
5. Unwrap dough and knead briefly (as described in step 2) on lightly floured
surface. Using lightly floured rolling pin, roll out dough to 1/8-inch-thick
circle on lightly floured surface. Gently pick up dough circle with both
LM-Cookery Grade 10
129
hands. Hold it up to the light to check for places where dough is too thick.
Return to board. Let rest until dough is slightly dry but can be handled
without breaking.
6. Lightly flour dough circle; roll loosely on rolling pin.
7. Loosely roll the dough on a rolling pin.
8. Slide rolling pin out; press dough roll gently with hand and cut into strips of
desired width with sharp knife. Carefully unfold strips.
9. Cut the dough into strips of desired width.
10 Pasta can be dried and stored at this point. Hang strips over pasta rack or
clean broom handle covered with plastic wrap and propped between two
chairs. Dry for at least 3 hours; store in airtight container at room
temperature for 4 days. To serve, cook pasta in large pot of boiling salted
water 3 to 4 minutes just until al dente. Drain well.
11. Dry the pasta using a drying rack.
Your performance will be rated using the rubric below.
4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking
homemade pasta and performs the skill without supervision.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking
homemade pasta and performs the skill without some assistance
or supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking
homemade pasta with minor errors and performs the skill with
some assistance and/or supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking
homemade pasta and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
130
Learning Outcome 4 Store Starch and Cereal Dishes
Introduction
Proper storage of food is very crucial in keeping food safe because the
manner and temperature of storage will affect the food‘s susceptibility to
bacterial growth, other contaminants, and infestation. Storing food will not
improve its quality, it will only delay the rate of deterioration, and thus, the
proper period of storage should also be observed.
FIFO (First In, First Out) in storing food is very important. Though it is a
long-time method in store-keeping where the first food stored should be the
first food to be out from the storage it is high time to make it a habit or put into
practice. Write the expiry date, date received and date of storage to the food
package and regularly check the expiration date.
How to Store Pasta Noodles
Pasta is stored in airtight containers.
Pasta noodles are usually sold dry at the grocery store, allowing you to
store them with other staples in your pantry. Dry noodles have a long storage
life when properly packaged. Improper storage causes the pasta to become
moist, which leads to mildew. Even without moisture, pasta can become stale
if it's not stored correctly. Proper storage ensures your pasta to always taste
its best.
1. Dry Pasta
 Remove the pasta from the store packaging if the noodles come in a
box or other non-airtight container.
 Place the noodles in a sealable plastic bag or other container that
closes tightly. For long noodles, such as spaghetti, use a tall plastic
storage container.
 Seal the bag or screw the lid on tightly. Store the pasta in a cool, dry
place. Dry pasta stores indefinitely, but should be used within two
years to prevent loss of flavor. Store dried egg noodles for up to six
months.
Dried pasta need not to be refrigerated. It can be stored on the shelf in
an airtight container in a dry area that is not exposed to extreme
temperature. Dried pasta can be stored indefinitely and still be safe to eat
but the USDA recommends storing dried pasta for no more than two years
to obtain the best quality. Some manufacturers will stamp their packages
with a "best if used by" date, which indicates that the flavor, color and
nutritional value may be affected if used beyond that date.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
131
2. Cooked Pasta
 Pour the noodles into a colander. Allow as much moisture as possible
to drain. Noodles left in standing water become overly soft and mushy.
 Sprinkle 1 tsp. salad oil over the noodles. Toss the pasta so the
noodles are evenly coated in the oil. Salad oil prevents the pastafrom
sticking together.
 Place the pasta in a tight-sealed container. Store in the refrigerator for
three to five days.
 Cooked pasta can be stored unsauced in an airtight container and
refrigerated for 4 or 5 days. The sauce should be refrigerated separate
from the pasta and can be stored for 6 or 7 days. This prevents the
pasta from soaking up too much flavor and oil from the sauce, which
causes the taste of the pasta to be drowned out. If the pasta is stored
together with the sauce, it should be eaten within 1 or 2 days to limit
the amount of sauce that is absorbed. If cooked pasta is not going to
be used within the suggested time period, it should be frozen and then
it can be stored for approximately 3 months. Frozen cooked pasta
should be thawed in the refrigerator and not on the kitchen counter.
To store, cook the pasta as you normally would and then rinse with cold water
and allow it to drain well.
Add a small amount of olive oil
or butter to help prevent the
pasta from clumping together
while it is stored. Use only
enough oil or butter to lightly
coat the pasta.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
132
To refrigerate, place the pasta in
an airtight plastic bag or an
airtight container and place in
the refrigerator. To freeze, place
in an airtight plastic freezer bag
and press out as much excess
air as possible and place in the
freezer.
If storing sauced pasta, eat
within 1 to 2 days to prevent it
from absorbing too much sauce.
 When refrigerating or freezing cooked pasta, be sure it is stored in a
well-sealed container so that it does not absorb any odor.
Cooked lasagna and baked pasta dishes can be refrigerated or frozen
in the same manner as plain cooked pasta. The lasagna and
casseroles should be first cut into individual servings before placing
them in a sealed bag or container. This will make it easier when
reheating.
If you have an entire
lasagna or pasta dish to
refrigerate or freeze, it can
be left in the baking dish
and tightly covered before
storing.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
133
The lasagna and baked pasta dishes can be refrigerated for 3 or 4
days or they can be placed in a freezer and kept for approximately 3 months.
If frozen, the pasta dish should be thawed in the refrigerator and not on the
kitchen counter.
3. Fresh Pasta.
 Fresh pasta should ideally be used on the same day as manufactured.
This is not always possible, but if it is used within the next two days it will
give adequate results. After this it tends to crack through excess drying. It
must be stored, keep it well-covered in the fridge, to minimize the risk of
this happening. Frozen filled pastas will keep for up to three months if held
at -18oC or lower.
 Fresh pasta can be stored in the refrigerator for 2 or 3 days. If the pasta
will not be used within that time, it can be frozen and stored in the freezer
for 2 to 3 months. Homemade pasta can be stored in the refrigerator for 1
or 2 days or frozen for 2 to 3 months. Homemade pasta can also be
allowed to dry thoroughly and then placed in a plastic bag or airtight
container. The length of time it will take to dry will vary depending on the
type of pasta and its size, shape and thickness. If dried completely, the
pasta can then be stored in a cool dry place for a couple of months. If you
are going to use the pasta on the same day as it is made, you can allow it
to dry on a clean towel for a couple of hours before you cook it unless it is
stuffed pasta. Stuffed pasta, such as ravioli, should be cooked within half
an hour, otherwise it will begin to discolor and become damp.
If it is not going to be cooked
immediately it should be placed on
a lightly floured towel that is placed
on a baking sheet, sprinkled lightly
with flour, and then placed in the
freezer. Once they are frozen they
can be stored in a freezer proof
bag or wrap and then place it in the
freezer for 8 or 9 months.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
134
4. Frozen pasta does not have to be thawed before it is cooked. Just
place the frozen pasta into boiling water and reheat it. It will need to
cook a little longer than unfrozen pasta.
Tips & Warnings
• Store pasta sauce separate from the noodles, otherwise the noodles will
become mushy.
• You can freeze cooked pasta but it may be too soft once thawed. Use
frozen pasta in baked dishes so the softer texture is not noticeable.
Review of Learning Outcome 4
A. Explain the principle behind FIFO.
B. Make a slogan showing the importance of proper storing of food.
Your output will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
SCORE CRITERIA
5 Done creatively and neatly showing much relevance to the given topic
4 Done creatively and neat enough with relevance to the given topic
3 Done creatively and neat enough but no relevance to the given topic
2 Done simply and neat enough but not so relevant to the given topic
1 Done poorly with erasures and irrelevant to the given topic
LM-Cookery Grade 10
135
Prepare and cook any cereal dish from among those recipes which you
have compiled in the previous activity.
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
Dimension
P E R F O R M A N C E L E V E L
Excellent
(4 pts.)
Very
Satisfactory
(3 pts.)
Satisfactory
(2 pts.)
Needs Improvement
(1 pt.)
No
Attempt
(0 pt.)
Points
Earned
1. Use of tools
and equipment
Uses tools and
equipment correctly
and confidently at all
times
Uses tools
and
equipment
correctly and
confidently
most of the
times
Uses tools and
equipment correctly
but less confidently
sometimes
Uses tools and
equipment
incorrectly and less
confidently most of
the time
No
attempt
2. Application
of procedures
Manifests very clear
understanding of the
step- by-step
procedure
Manifests
clear
understandin
g of the step-
by-step
procedure
Manifests
understanding of
the step-by-step
procedure
but sometimes
seeks clarification
Manifests less
understanding of the
step- by-step
procedure seeking
clarification most of
the time
No
attempt
Works independently
with ease and
confidence at all times
Works
independentl
y with ease
and
confidence
most of the
time
Works independently
with ease and
confidence
sometimes
Works independently
but with assistance
from others most of
the time
No
attempt
3. Safety work
habits
Observes safety
precautions at all times
Observes
safety
precautions
most of the
time
Observes safety
precautions
sometimes
Not observing safety
precautions most of
the time
No
attempt
4. Final Output Output is very
presentable and taste
exceeds the standard.
Output is
very
presentable
and taste
meets the
standard.
Output is
presentable and
taste is within the
standard.
Output is not so
presentable and
taste is within the
standard.
No
attempt
5. Time
management
Work completed ahead
of time
Work
completed
within
allotted time
Work completed
(mins./hours/day
s) beyond
Work completed
(mins./hours/day
s) beyond
No
attempt
TOTAL POINTS
LM-Cookery Grade 10
136
Let’s See How Much You Learned
Post Test
A. Multiple Choice.
Directions: Read each question carefully. Choose the letter which
corresponds to the correct answer and write it in your test notebook.
1. Knife is chef‘s best buddy. It is the busiest tool being used by people
assigned inside the kitchen. Which of the following knives is used for
decorative works such as garnishes?
A. Bread knife C. Channel knife
B. Butcher knife D. Paring knife
2. It is a perforated bowl of varying sizes made of stainless steel, aluminum or
plastic used to drain washed or cooked ingredients from liquid.
A. Canister C. Mixing bowl
B. Colander D. Soup bowl
3. It is used for turning and lifting eggs, pan cakes and meats on griddles,
grills, sheet pans, and the likes and also used to scrape and clean griddles.
A. Measuring spoon C. Rubber scraper
B. Offset spatula D. Wooden spoon
4. It is used to scrape off all the contents of bowls and pans from the sides
and fold in beaten eggs in batter or whipped cream.
A. Paring knife C. Wire whisk
B. Rubber spatula D. Wooden spoon
5. It is a screen – type mesh supported by a round metal frame used for
sifting dry ingredients like starch and flour.
A. Colander C. Sieve
B. Funnel D. Skimmer
6. It is a device with loops of stainless steel wire fastened to a handle. It is
used for blending, mixing, whipping eggs or batter, and for blending
gravies, sauces, and soups.
A. Fork C. Spoon
B. Knife D. Whisk
7. It is a miniature Bain Marie with an upper dish containing indentations each
sized to hold an egg or contains separate device for poaching.
A. Egg Poacher C. Frying pan
B. Double boiler D. Omelet pan
8. It is a chamber or compartment used for cooking, baking, heating, or
drying.
A. Blender C. Mixer
B. Burner D. Oven
LM-Cookery Grade 10
137
9. It is the process of washing and sanitizing dishes, glassware, flatware,
pots, and pans either manually or mechanically.
A. Bleaching C. Ware washing
B. Hand washing D. Washing machine
10.A dishwashing machine capable of washing, rinsing, and drying dishes,
flatware, and glassware.
A. Hand washing C. Mechanical ware washing
B. Manual ware washing D. Washing machine
11.It is the egg‘s outer covering which accounts for about 9 to 12 % of its total
weight depending on egg size.
A. Chalaza C. Shell
B. Germinal disc D. Yolk
12.This is the entrance of the latebra, the channel leading to the center of the
yolk.
A. Chalaza C. Shell
B. Germinal disc D. Yolk
13.It is the yellow to yellow - orange portion which makes up to about 33% of
the liquid weight of the egg.
A. Chalaza C. Shell
B. Germinal disc D. Yolk
14.A disease that is carried and transmitted to people by food is referred to
as food borne .
A. Bacteria C. Infection
B. Illness D. Intoxication
15.It is a disease that results from eating food containing harmful micro-
organism.
A. Food-borne bacteria C. Food-borne infection
B. Food-borne illness D. Food-borne intoxication
16.It is a disease that results from eating food containing toxins from bacteria,
molds or certain plants or animals.
A. Food-borne bacteria C. Food-borne infection
B. Food-borne illness D. Food-borne intoxication
17. It is used for mixing creams, butter and for tossing salads.
A. Electric mixer C. Wire whisk
B. Serving spoon D. Wooden spoon
18.It is used for preparing meat, chicken, and other grains or legumes, such
as mongo and white beans in lesser time.
A. Double boiler C. pressure cooker
B. Frying pan D. rice cooker
LM-Cookery Grade 10
138
19.It is a long chainlike molecule, sometimes called the linear fraction, and is
produced by linking together 500 to 2, 000 glucose molecules which
contributes to the gelling characteristics of cooked and cooled starch
mixtures.
A. Amylopectin C. Dextrin
B. Amylose D. mucin
20.This problem is usually encountered when using acid or acid ingredients
such as lemon or vinegar.
A. Scorching C. Thinning of gel.
B. Skin formation D. Weak gelling
21. This results when there is too much liquid in relation to the starch.
A. Scorching C. Thinning of gel.
B. Skin formation D.Weak gelling
22.This problem can be reduced by covering the container of the starch gel
with a waterproof cover.
A. Scorching C. Thinning of gel.
B. Skin formation D. Weak gelling
23.This can be avoided by temperature control and constant stirring so the
starch granules do not settle at the bottom of the cooking pan.
A. Scorching C. Thinning of Gel.
B. Skin formation D.Weak gelling
24.Food stuff has a required shelf life and storing requirement. Which of the
following food item can be stored in the refrigerator for 2 or 3 days?
A.Cooked pasta C. Fresh pasta
B.Dried pasta D. Frozen pasta
25. FIFO stands for
A. Fan In Fan On C. First In First Out
B. First In Fight Out D. Fit In Fit Out
LM-Cookery Grade 10
139
B. Give one risk in the preparation and cooking of starch, cereal dishes and
other foods and give some guidelines pertaining to food safety. (26-30)
Your answer will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
SCORE CRITERIA
4 Explains very clearly the complete guidelines to consider pertaining to food
safety related to the given risk.
3 Explains clearly the complete guidelines to consider pertaining to food
safety related to the given risk.
2 Explains partially the guidelines to consider pertaining to food safety
related to the given risk.
1 Was not able to explain any guidelines to consider pertaining to food
safety related to the given risk.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
140
QUARTER II
PREPARE VEGETABLE AND SEAFOOD DISHES
Overview
This quarter will guide you, learners to acquire the essential knowledge
and competencies and develop your skills with understanding in the
preparation, cooking, presentation, and storing vegetables and seafood
dishes. Products/performances required in every activity will help you to
practice gained understanding.
Objectives
At the end of the lesson, you are expected to:
1. perform Mise‘en place;
2. prepare and cook vegetable and seafood dishes;
3. present vegetable and seafood dishes; and
4. store vegetable and seafood dishes.
Let’s See What You Know
Pretest 2
Multiple Choice.
Directions: Read the following questions carefully and choose the
letter that best describes the statement. Write your answer in your
test notebook.
1. Which of the following vegetables is rich in carbohydrates?
A. legumes, peas, and beans C. Mushroom, tomatoes, and radish
B. Nuts, olives, and avocado D. Seeds, roots, and tubers
2. What is the flavor component of vegetables which gives strong flavor and
odor to some vegetables like onions, leeks, garlic, chives, cabbage, and
broccoli?
A. Flavonoids C. Sugar
C. Glutamic acid D. Sulfur compounds
LM-Cookery Grade 10
141
3. Which tool is used to drain excess water after washing vegetables?
A. Bowls C. Steamer
B. Colander D. Utility tray
4. Which of the following is cooking by placing blanched or raw vegetables in
the pan, adding liquid (stock, water, wine) then covering and cooking it
slowly?
A. Boiling C. Braising
B. Baking D. Sautéing
5. Which fat soluble compound is responsible for the green coloring of plants?
A. Anthocyanins C. Chlorophyll
B. Carotenoids D. Lycopene
6. Mrs. Cabrillas needs more supply of Vitamin A. which of the following will
she eat to give her the nutrient she needs?
A. Alugbati C. Lettuce
B. Potatoes D. Saluyot
7. Which of the following plating styles is not a classic arrangement?
A. The starch or vegetable item is heaped in the center while the main item
is sliced and leaned up against it.
B. The main item in the center, with vegetable distributed around it.
C. The vegetable item in front and main item, starch item and garnish at
the rear.
D. The main item is in the center with neat piles of vegetables carefully
arranged around.
8. Chef Shaneshan will cook chopsuey. She is about to remove the hard core
of a cabbage. Which of the following knife will she use?
A. Butcher knife C. Cutting knife
B. Channel knife D. Paring knife
9. What kind of knife is used in removing the hard core of a cabbage?
A. Butcher knife C. Cutting knife
B. Channel knife D. Paring knife
10. At what temperature in a dry, dark place should potatoes and onions be
stored?
A. 50 – 650F C. 60 – 850F
B. 40 – 450F D. 70 – 950F
11. Which of the following vegetables is cooked uncovered?
A. Fruit vegetables C. Roots and tubers
B. Green vegetables D. Yellow vegetables
12. Which kind of fish has no internal bone structure?
A. Fin fish C. Round fish
B. Freshwater fish D. Shell fish
LM-Cookery Grade 10
142
13. Which of the following fish is high in fat?
A. Bass C. Mackerel
B. Cod D. Red Snapper
14. Which of the following fish is low in fat?
A. Cod C. Trout
B. Salmon D. Tuna
15. Which market form of fish is viscera, head, tail and fins are removed?
A. Butterfly C. Fillet
B. Dressed D. Sticks
16. Which of the following is a freshwater fish?
A. Bluefish C. Grouper
B. Cat fish D. Sole
17. Which market form of fish are both sides of a fish still joined but bones are
removed?
A. Butterfly C. Fillet
B. Drawn D. Steak
18. Which of the following is the second step in scaling whole fish?
A. Begin to rake the scales from the tail towards the head.
B. Remove the scales on both sides of the fish.
C. Hold the fish down firmly with your hand near its head.
D. Lay your fish flat on the board.
19. Which of the following is the third step in opening an oyster?
A. Cut muscle from bottom cup.
B. Insert oyster knife at hinge slowly but firmly
C. Push knife into oyster and slice muscle from top shell
D. Twist knife handle to open the oyster.
20. Which of the following is a characteristic of a fresh fish?
A. With fresh and foul odor
B. Eyes are dull, shiny and bulging
C. Gills are pink or red
D. Flesh shrink when pressed
21. How many colors is suggested on a plate to make it balance?
A. Four to five C. Three to four
B. One to two D. Two to three
22. Which of the following seafood is cooked just enough to heat to keep it
juicy and plump?
A. Fat fish C. Flat fish
B. Lean fish D. Shellfish
23. Which of the following enhances baked fish when served?
A. Butter C. Lemon
B. Cream D. Sauce
LM-Cookery Grade 10
143
24. What cooking method is suited to fat fish.
A. Baking C. Deep -frying
B. Boiling D. Sautéing
25. Which is basted to baked lean fish to help prevent it from drying up.
A. Butter C. Soy sauce
B. Cream D. Tomato sauce
B. Give five characteristics of a fresh fish.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
144
Overview
Vegetables are plants or parts of plants like leaves, fruits, tubers, roots,
bulbs, stems, shoots, and flower used in a dish either raw or cooked.
Vegetables give color, texture and flavor to our meals. They also give
vitamins and minerals.
Vegetables provide nutrients vital for health and maintenance of your
body. Eating vegetables provides health benefits to people like reduced risk
of some chronic diseases including heart attack and stroke, protect them
against certain types of cancers, reduce obesity and type two diabetes, lower
blood pressures, reduce the risk of developing kidney stones and help
decrease bone loss.
Vegetables are important sources of many nutrients, including
potassium, dietary fiber, folate (folic acid), vitamin A, and vitamin C.
 Diets rich in potassium may help maintain normal blood pressure.
Vegetable sources of potassium include sweet potatoes, white
potatoes, white beans, tomato products (paste, sauce, and juice), beet
greens, soybeans, lima beans, spinach, lentils, and kidney beans.
 Dietary fiber from vegetables, as part of an overall healthy diet, helps
reduce blood cholesterol levels and may lower risk of heart disease.
Fiber is important for proper bowel function. It helps reduce
constipation and diverticulosis. Fiber-containing foods such as
vegetables help provide a feeling of fullness with fewer calories.
 Folate (folic acid) helps the body form red blood cells. Women of
childbearing age who may become pregnant should consume
adequate folate from foods, and in addition, 400 mcg of synthetic folic
acid from fortified foods or supplements. This reduces the risk of neural
tube defects, spinal bifida, and anencephaly during fetal development.
 Vitamin A keeps eyes and skin healthy and helps to protect against
infections.
 Vitamin C helps heal cuts and wounds, and keeps teeth and gums
healthy. Vitamin C aids in iron absorption.
LESSON 1 PREPARE VEGETABLE DISHES
LM-Cookery Grade 10
145
Learning Outcome 1 Perform Mise’ En Place
Vegetables need to be prepared before they are ready to serve or
used as an ingredient in a cooked dish. Prior to preparation you need to
identify the various kinds of vegetables and different tools and equipment
needed in the preparation of vegetables. It is an important factor to consider
in the preparation of vegetables.
Classifications of Vegetables
a. According to parts of plants
 Gourd family
- cucumber, pumpkin, chayote
 Seeds and pods
- beans, peas, corn, okra
1. Fruit Vegetables
- avocado, eggplant, sweet pepper, tomato




LM-Cookery Grade 10
146
 Roots and tubers
- beet, carrot, radish, turnip, artichoke, potato, sweet potato
 Cabbage family
- cabbage, broccoli, cauliflower, Brussels sprouts, bokchoy
 Onion family
- onion, scallion, leek, garlic, shallot
 Leafy greens
- spinach, lettuce
LM-Cookery Grade 10
147
 Stalks, stems, and shoots
- artichoke, asparagus, celery, fennel, bamboo, shoots
 Mushrooms
2. According to Chemical Composition
 Carbohydrates-rich vegetables – seeds, roots, tubers
 Protein-rich vegetables –legumes, peas, beans
 Fat-rich vegetables – nuts, olives, avocado
 High moisture content – mushroom, tomatoes, radish, green
leafy vegetables
3. According to Nutritive Value
The following is based on their nutrient content since fruits and
vegetables are good sources of vitamins and minerals.
 Vitamin A-rich vegetables – green leafy and yellow fruits and
vegetables
 Vitamin C-rich vegetables – yellow vegetables
 Vitamin B (complex) – legumes, peas, beans
LM-Cookery Grade 10
148
Tools and Equipment Needed in Preparing Vegetables
paring knife - used in paring
chef knife - used in cutting
chopping board -- used to hold item while
chopping
colander - used to drain excess water
after washing
bowls
- used to hold vegetables
LM-Cookery Grade 10
149
utility tray
- used to hold ingredients
sauté pan - for sautéing or stir frying
vegetables
steamer
- for steaming vegetables
oven - for cooking vegetables oven-
steam or bake
Flavor Components of Vegetables
1. Sugar –
Fructose – the natural sugar that provides the sweetness in
vegetables.
2. Glutamic Acid –
This forms a product called monosodium glutamate when
combined with salt. It is found in large amount from young and
fresh vegetables.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
150
3. Sulfur compounds –
Give the characteristic strong flavor and odor of some
vegetables like onions, leeks, garlic, chives, cabbage and
broccoli.
Color Components
1. Chlorophyll – a fat soluble compound responsible for the green color of
plants. When combined with acid, it forms pheophytin which
produces an olive green color.
When combine with alkali, it forms chlorophyllins which
produces a more intense green color. The addition of baking
soda when cooking that results to brighter green color, is an
example.
2. Carotenoids – the yellow, orange to red soluble pigments found in
plants.
2.1 - beta carotene from carrots and squash
2.2 - lycopene, from tomatoes
3. Flavonoids
3.1 - Anthoxanthin – responsible for the yellow pigments
3.2 - Anthocyanins – responsible for red and blue to violet
pigments (beets) Tube, eggplants
LM-Cookery Grade 10
151
Factors to consider in choosing good quality vegetables
1. Freshness
Fresh vegetables should be crisp and bright in colors.
2. Absence of decay or insect infestation
3. No mechanical damage or injury.
4. Right degree of maturity
5. Variety
Different varieties differ in color,
shape, texture and sometimes flavor.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
152
Vegetables are good sources of food nutrients that are very important in
everyday meals.
Nutritional Value of Vegetables
1. Vitamin A
-Green leafy vegetables are sources of vitamin A.
Example:
alugbati
ampalaya leaves
kalabasa leaves
malunggay
petchay
sili leaves
2. Vitamin C
Example:
cabbage – type vegetables
bell peppers
lettuce
potatoes
dark green and yellow vegetables
3. Vitamin B – complex
Beans and leafy greens are rich sources of vitamin B –
complex
Example:
ampalaya tops
kulitis
pepper leaves
saluyot
dried beans
LM-Cookery Grade 10
153
4. Complex carbohydrates
Complex carbohydrates are carbohydrate molecules with
more than 20 – sugar residue. They are called as
polysaccharide.
Functions of Carbohydrate:
1. Source of energy ( protein sparing and prevents ketosis)
2. Source of B-vitamins for CHO metabolism
3. Type of carbohydrate chosen determines:
 Fiber content
 Glycemic load of diet
 Nutrient density and phytochemical content
Example:
wheat bran
whole grain breads and cereals
cabbage
carrots
Brussels sprouts
Preparing Fresh Vegetables
1. Washing
 Wash all vegetables thoroughly
 Scrub well unpeeled vegetables, like potatoes for baking
 Wash green leafy vegetables in several changes of cold water
 After washing, drain well and refrigerate lightly covered to prevent
drying.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
154
2. Soaking
 Do not soak vegetables for long periods to prevent flavor and nutrient
loss.
 Cabbage, broccoli, cauliflower may be soaked for 30 minutes in cold
salted water to eliminate insects.
 Limp vegetables can be soaked briefly in cold water to restore
crispness.
3. Peeling and Cutting
 Peel vegetables as thinly as possible.
 Cut vegetables into uniform pieces for even cooking
 Treat vegetables that brown easily with acid (potatoes, eggplants,
sweet potato) or hold under water until ready to use.
 Save edible trim for soups, stocks and purees.
Basic Knife Cuts
1. Chopping – done with a straight, downward cutting motion.
2. Chiffonade (shredding) – making very fine parallel cuts.
3. Dicing – producing cube shapes
Diamond (lozenge) – thinly slicing and cutting into strips of appropriate
width
5. Mincing – producing very fine cut usually for onions and garlic
6. Julienne and baton net – making long rectangular cut
Pays Anne (Fermi ere) – making curved or uneven cuts of the same
thickness
8. Rondelle – making cylindrical cut
9. Bias –making diagonal cut
10.Oblique, or roll cuts – making diagonal cut by rolling the long cylindrical
vegetables
Apply safe and accurate cutting techniques in preparing
vegetables according to enterprise standards.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
155
A. Trimming Artichoke bottom
1. Start by filling a bowl with cold
water and lemon into it. (You could also
use a dash of vinegar) this will slow the
browning on the surface of the artichoke
when it is cut and exposed to air.
2. Pull out the tough outer, dark
green leaves of artichoke.
3. Continue removing leaves until
you are left with light colored, tender
leaves. Rub surfaces with lemon.
4. Slice off the top one inch.
5. Trim the remaining dark green
surfaces at the base, including stalk
and continue to rub with lemon.
6.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
156
6. Cut the artichoke in half.
7. Use spoon to remove hairy
fibers in the center of the artichoke.
8. Pull out all of the tough red
fibers, leaving the soft green leaves
in place.
9. Cut the artichokes lengthwise
into sizes that suit your recipe and
place it in the water bath with lemon
before cooking.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
157
B. Trimming Asparagus
1. Hold a spear of asparagus in each hand.
2. Bend
downward with each
end until it breaks
into two.
3. Repeat with the whole bunch of asparagus.
Purplish ends on the left are destined for stock,
and greenish spears to be trimmed.
4. Trim or cut them into one inch length for
cooking.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
158
C. Preparing Avocados
1. Grip the avocado gently on one side with one
hand, cut the avocado lengthwise around the seed.
2. Open the avocado into halves to expose the
seed.
3. Scoop out the seed with the use of spoon or
scooper.
4. Gently tap the seed with a knife and twist to
get the seed out and discard.
5. Scoop out the avocado flesh with a spoon or
scooper.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
159
6. Slice avocado into segments.
D. Cutting and Shredding Cabbage
1. Pull off any bruised or wilted outer leaves from a red or green cabbage
head.
2. Cut the cabbage into halves.
3. Cut the halves into quarters lying flat side
down on the cutting board.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
160
4. Use a paring knife to remove the hard core.
Repeat with remaining cabbage quarters.
5. Cut into slices or shred the cabbage to your
desired thickness.
E. Peeling and crushing garlic
1. To remove the paper skin of garlic, cut off the
base of the clove.
2. Place the clove on a board and gently slam it
with flat side of a knife.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
161
3. The skin will burst and can easily be removed.
4. Cut the garlic into slices as thin as possible.
5. From garlic slices, mince it.
4. Crush the garlic as you want.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
162
F. Cleaning leeks
1. Cut off and discard the dark green leaves.
Trim and discard the roots.
2. Cut the stalk into half lengthwise.
3. Slice them
crosswise.
4. Transfer them to a bowl of cold water and
swish them around a few times.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
163
5. With hands loosely cupped, lift the leeks
out of the bowl and place them on a plate or work
surface (or colander).
6. Discard the water with the remaining grit.
7. Repeat until the water is clear and ready to be cooked.
Review of Learning Outcome 1
Formative Assessment
Directions: Identify and classify the given pictures. Write your answer in the
appropriate column.
Name Classification
1.
2.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
164
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
165
B. Directions: Identify the different methods of preparing fresh vegetables.
Write the correct method on the space provided.
7.
6.
1. 2. 3.
4. 5.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
166
Learning Outcome 2 Prepare Vegetable Dishes
Effects of Cooking Vegetables
1. Changes in texture
- Fibers are either softened or toughened.
A. Cellulose and hemicellulose – heating generally softens fibers
B. Addition of acid toughen fibers
C. Addition of alkali like baking soda soften hemicellulose
D.Addition of lime causes firmness or delay softening due to the
reaction of calcium from lime (―apog‖)
2. Water is either lost or absorbed.
A. Vegetables contain high amount of water, leafy and succulent
vegetables lose water and become limp.
B. Vegetables with significant amount of starch (dried beans, root
crops, tubers) absorb water because of the hygroscopic property of
starch.
3. Changes in color
Cooking for a short time, helps maintain color. The effect of
heat, acid, alkali, and metal on the pigment are summarized below:
Table 1. Effect of Acid, Alkali, and Prolonged Cooking
Pigment Effect of acid Effect of alkali
Effect of
prolonged
cooking
Solubility in
water
Chlorophyll Olive green
Intensifies
green color
Olive green
Slightly
Soluble
Carotene Little effect Little effect
Little effect
unless
excessive
way darkens
Slightly
Soluble
Anthocyanin Color is stable
Deeper red
purple or blue
depending on
alkalinity
Little effect
Very
soluble
Anthoxanthins No effect Yellow
Darken if
excessive in
the presence
of iron
Very
soluble
LM-Cookery Grade 10
167
4. Changes in nutrients
A. Carbohydrate
- moist heat cooking – gelatinization of starch
- dry heat cooking – dextrinization of starch
- carmelization of sugar
B. Protein become more soluble and digestible
C. Vitamin may be destroyed in heat like vitamin C
D. Minerals are washed into the cooking liquid or oxidized
General Rules of Vegetable Cookery
 Don‘t overcook.
 Prepare vegetable as close to service time as possible and in
small quantities.
 If the vegetable must be cooked ahead, undercook slightly and
chill rapidly. Reheat at service time.
 Never use baking soda with green vegetables.
 Cut vegetables uniformly for even cooking.
 Cook green vegetables and strong – flavored vegetables
uncovered.
Standard Quality of Cooked Vegetables
1. Color
Bright, natural color
2. Appearance on plate
Cut neatly and uniformly
Attractively arranged with appropriate combinations and garnishes
3. Texture
Cooked to the right degree of doneness
Crisp – tender, not overcooked and mushy
Potatoes, squash, sweet potatoes, tomatoes should be cooked
through with smooth texture
4. Flavor
Natural flavor and sweetness
Strong – flavored vegetables should be pleasantly mild, with no off
flavors or bitterness
LM-Cookery Grade 10
168
5. Seasonings
Seasonings should not mask the natural flavors
6. Sauces
Do not use heavily. Vegetable should not be greasy
7. Vegetable combinations
Vegetables should be cooked separately for different cooking
times, and then combined
Combine acid vegetables like tomatoes, to green vegetables just
before service to prevent discoloration of greens.
Cooking Frozen and Canned Vegetables
A.) Frozen Vegetables
 Examine all frozen products when received to check quality.
 Frozen vegetable requires shorter time in cooking because they
have been partially cooked.
 Cook from the frozen state. Can cook directly into steamer or
boiling salted water.
 Corn on the cob and vegetables that freeze in solid block like
squash, should be thawed for even cooking.
 Add less salt. Most frozen vegetables are slightly salted during
processing.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
169
B.) Canned Vegetables
 Drain vegetables and place half the liquid in a cooking pot, and
bring to boil.
 Add vegetables and heat to serving time. Do not boil for a long
time.
 Season liquid before adding vegetables to blend flavors of herbs
and spices.
 Use butter to enhance the flavor of most vegetables.
Frozen vegetables Canned vegetables
1. Examine all frozen products
when received to check quality
1. Drain vegetables and place
half the liquid in a cooking pot,
and bring to boil.
2. Frozen vegetable requires
shorter time in cooking because
they have been partially cooked
2. Add vegetables and heat to
serving time. Do not boil for a
long time
3. Cook from the frozen state.
Can be cooked directly into
steamer or boiling salted water.
3. Season liquid before adding
vegetables to blend flavors of
herbs and spices.
4. Corn on the cob and
vegetables frozen in solid block
like squash, should be thawed
for even cooking
4. Use butter to enhance the
flavor of most vegetables
5. Add less salt. Most frozen
vegetables are slightly salted
during processing
LM-Cookery Grade 10
170
Culinary Terms of Vegetables
Assortments of fresh vegetables like carrots, turnips, peas, pearl
onions, green beans, cauliflower, asparagus and artichokes.
Bouquet ere – bouquet of vegetables
Printaniere – spring vegetables
Jardinière – garden vegetables
Primeurs – first spring vegetables
Clamart – peas
Ceecy – carrots
Doria – cucumbers cooked in butter
Dubarry – cauliflower
Fermiere – carrots, turnips, onions, celery cut into
uniform slices
Florentine – spinach
Forestiere – mushrooms
Judic – braised lettuce
Lyonnaise – onions
Nicoise – tomatoes concasse cooked with garlic
Parmientier – potatoes
Princesse – asparagus
Provençale – tomatoes with garlic, parsley and
sometimes mushrooms or olives
Directions: Make a compilation of technical words commonly used in the
world of culinary for vegetable cookery. Follow concrete instructions below:
 Make a personalized and improvised dictionary (half folded
bond paper).
 Include local and foreign terminologies which are used in
vegetable cookery.
 Limit your dictionary to a minimum of 10 pages and a
maximum of 20 pages.
 Bind and cover it.
 You can work in collaboration with others and submit after 1
week.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
171
Your output will be rated using the scoring rubric below.
SCORE CRITERIA
5 Done creatively and neatly with more than twenty pages
4 Done creatively and neat enough with 15 to 20 pages
3 Done creatively and neat enough but with10 to 14 pages
2 Done simply and neat enough but with 10 to 14 pages
1 Done poorly with less than 10 pages
Ways of Cooking Vegetables
1. Boiling and steaming –
Vegetables are drained as soon as they are cooked
and then cool quickly under cold water to prevent
overcooking from the residual heat. They are
reheated quickly by sautéing in butter or other fat.
Seasonings and sauces are added at this stage.
2. Sautéing and Pan – Frying
Both methods may be used to complete cooking
or precooked or blanched vegetables. Also used for
complete cooking of raw vegetables.
3. Braising
The blanched or raw vegetable, is placed in the
pan then liquid is added (stock, water, wine) to cover
vegetables, then cooked slowly.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
172
4. Baking
Cooking starchy vegetables using heat of the
oven, rather than range top. Starchy vegetables are
baked because the dry heat produces a desirable
texture.
5. Deep – frying
Vegetables large enough to coat with breading or
batter may be fried. Quick – cooking vegetables
can be fried raw. Some, may be precooked by
simmering or steaming briefly to reduce the cooking
time in frying.
Directions: Find a partner and perform the different ways of cooking
vegetables. Choose at least 2 from the given recipes.
Boiling Vegetables
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Stove
Pots and pan
Chopping board
Knife
Strainer
Ladle
Ingredients:
Vegetables (any kind)
Water
LM-Cookery Grade 10
173
Procedure:
Boiling Vegetables
1. Trim, peel and cut vegetables as required.
2. Add required amount of water to the pot.
3. Add salt and bring to boil.
4. Place vegetables in the pot and return the water to a boil.
5. Reduce heat to a simmer and cook vegetable, to required
doneness.
 Green vegetables and strong flavored vegetables are
cooked uncovered.
6. Drain vegetables quickly to avoid overcooking.
Steaming Vegetables
1. Trim and cut vegetables as required.
2. Pre-heat the steamer.
3. Arrange vegetables in pan or baskets for cooking. Make a shallow,
even layers for uniform cooking.
4. Steam for required time.
5. Remove vegetables from steamer.
6. Finish vegetables according to recipe and serve at once, or cool
quickly.
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in boiling/steaming vegetables and
performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative
and adaptability to problem situations.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in boiling/steaming vegetables and
performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in boiling/steaming vegetables with minor
errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or
supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in boiling/steaming vegetables and
performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
174
Sautéing Vegetables
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Stove
Pots and pan
Ladle
Strainer
Spatula
Ingredients:
Vegetables (any kind)
Procedure:
Sautéing Vegetables
1. Prepare vegetables as required.
2. Place sauté pan on high heat.
3. When pot is hot, add small amount of clarified butter, oil or other fat
enough to coat the bottom of the pan.
4. Add vegetables. Do not overload the pan, or the temperature will be
lowered too much and the vegetables will simmer instead of sauté.
5. After the heat has recovered, flip the pan to toss vegetables.
6. Continue to flip as necessary.
7. As soon as vegetables are cooked, remove from pan and serve.
Frying Vegetables
1. Prepare mise-en place. Use a griddle if only a small amount of fat is
required.
2. Heat the pan and add fat, and let it heat.
3. Place prepared vegetables in the pan. Cook to desired degree of
browning.
4. Turn vegetables with a spatula and continue to cook until done.
5. Remove from pan, and drain on absorbent paper to eliminate excess
fat.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
175
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in sautéing/frying vegetables and
performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative
and adaptability to problem situations.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in sautéing/frying vegetables and
performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in sautéing/frying vegetables with minor
errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or
supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in sautéing/frying vegetables and
performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
Braising Vegetables
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Stove
Pots and pan
Strainer
Ladle
Ingredients:
Vegetables
Water or wine
Procedure:
1. Heat pan, add fat.
2. Place vegetables in a pan.
(Vegetables may or may not be cooked in fat before adding liquid)
3. Add liquid, stock, water or wine or combination of liquids.
4. Cover the pan and cook vegetables.
5. Remove from heat, and serve vegetables with the cooking liquid, or
drained off the liquid and reduced over high heat before serving to
concentrate flavor.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
176
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in braising vegetables and performs the
skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and
adaptability to problem situations.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in braising vegetables and performs the
skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in braising vegetables with minor errors
and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or
supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in braising vegetables and performs
the skill unsatisfactorily.
Cooking Vegetables by Baking and Deep Frying
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Oven, Stove
Fryer
Pots and pan
Baking pan
Ingredients:
Vegetables
Breading
Oil
Procedure:
Baking Vegetables
1. Collect all equipment and food products.
2. Prepare vegetables as required.
3. Place in appropriate pan and set in pre-heated oven.
4. Bake to desired doneness.
Deep-Frying Vegetables
1. Collect all equipment and food products.
2. Pre-heat fryer to proper temperature (325°F - 350°F).
3. Prepare food items as required. Apply breading or batter if necessary.
4. Place proper amount of food in fryer. Do not overload.
5. Fry to desired doneness.
6. Remove from pan. Drain to remove excess fat.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
177
7. Serve at once or if necessary, hold uncovered in a warm place for the
shortest possible time.
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in baking/deep-frying vegetables and
performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative
and adaptability to problem situations.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in baking/deep-frying vegetables and
performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in baking/deep-frying vegetables with
minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance
and/or supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in baking/deep-frying vegetables
and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
Performance Activity 2
Directions: Given the different recipes, follow the procedures by pair or by
group.
Vegetable Tagliatelle
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Chopping board
Knife
Pots and pan
Coriander
Ladle
LM-Cookery Grade 10
178
Ingredients:
450 grams zucchini, trimmed
450 grams. carrots, peeled and trimmed
450 grams. celery root, peeled
4tbsp. butter
Procedure:
1. Cut vegetables lengthwise into thin slices. About 1/8 inches thick,
cut into long thin strips to resemble flat noodles.
2. Blanch each vegetable separately into boiling salted water.
Refresh under cold water and drain.
3. Just before serving, heat butter in saucepan over moderate heat.
Add vegetables and toss in butter until hot.
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking vegetable
tagliatelle and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and
with initiative and adaptability to problem situations.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking vegetable
tagliatelle and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or
supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking vegetable
tagliatelle with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some
assistance and/or supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking vegetable
tagliatelle and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
179
Sautéed Mushroom
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Pan
Ladle
Plate
Ingredients:
1 1/2kg mushrooms, fresh
10 tbsp. clarified butter or
salt to taste
pepper to taste
Procedure:
1. Rinse the mushrooms quickly and dry them with towels. Trim off
the bottom of the stems and slice the mushrooms.
2. Heat sauté pans over high heat. Add fat to the pan.
3. Place mushrooms in the pan. Do not overload. Sauté over high
heat until browned. Do not overcook.
4. Season with salt and pepper.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
180
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking sautéed
mushroom and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision
and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking sautéed
mushroom and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or
supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking sautéed
mushroom with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some
assistance and/or supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking sautéed
mushroom and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
Braised Celery
Tool/Equipment Needed:
Chopping board
Knife
Pan
Ladle
Ingredients:
1 kg celery
4 tbsp butter
1 ½ pt. brown stock or chicken stock
salt to taste
pepper to taste
LM-Cookery Grade 10
181
Procedure:
1. Trim and wash celery. Peel the outside part and use the tender
inner stems. Cut into 1 ½ inches lengths.
2. Heat the butter in a braising pot and add the celery. Cook over
moderate heat until the celery is just beginning to soften.
3. Add enough stock to cover the celery. Season with salt and pepper
to taste. Cover and cook slowly in an oven or range top until
tender.
4. Drain the celery and keep it warm. Reduce the stock over high
heat. Adjust the seasonings and pour the sauce over the celery.
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking braised celery
and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with
initiative and adaptability to problem situations.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking braised celery
and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking braised celery
with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance
and/or supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking braised
celery and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
182
Glazed Sweet Potatoes
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Pan
Ladle
Knife
Chopping board
Baking pan
Ingredients:
1.8 kg sweet potatoes
6 tbsp. water
¾ c light corn syrup or maple syrup
6 tbsp. brown sugar
8 tbsp. orange juice
2 tbsp. lemon juice
2 tbsp. butter
½ tsp cinnamon
1/8 t ground cloves
¼ t salt
LM-Cookery Grade 10
183
Procedure:
1. Scrub sweet potatoes. Boil or steam until tender. Do not overcook.
2. Spread the potatoes on a sheet pan to cool.
3. Peel the potatoes when they are cool enough to handle. Cut into
uniform pieces. Arrange in a buttered baking pan.
4. Place water, syrup and sugar in a saucepan. Stir over heat until
sugar is dissolved. Add remaining ingredients and boil mixture to
form heavy syrup.
5. Pour syrup over potatoes.
6. Bake at 350°F until potatoes are thoroughly cooked and glazed,
about 45 – 60 minutes.
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking glazed sweet
potatoes and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and
with initiative and adaptability to problem situations.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking glazed sweet
potatoes and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or
supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking glazed sweet
potatoes with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some
assistance and/or supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking glazed
sweet potatoes and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
LumpiangUbod with Egg Wrapper
Materials Needed:
Wok colander
Turner measuring spoon
Knife measuring cups
Chopping board casserole
LM-Cookery Grade 10
184
Ingredients:
½ kl stripped ubod
1 kl stripped sweet potato
½ kl carrot
½ kl cabbage
2 stalk celery
2 cups ground peanut
1 head garlic
2pcs onion
½ kl ground pork
1/4kl shrimps
2T fish sauce
1pc pork bouillon
Procedure:
1. Blanch the ubod first
2. Sauté the garlic and onion, put the ground pork and 2T fish sauce
3. Put sweet potato until tender
4. Put the ubod, carrots, cabbage and celery
5. Put the ground peanut
6. Season to taste
Sauce:
Ingredients:
½ kl sugar
1/4T fish sauce
½ cup ground peanut
¼ cup minced garlic
1 stalk chopped celery
¼ cup cornstarch mixed with ¼ cup water
1.5L water
Procedure:
1. Caramelized sugar, put 1.5 liter of water and let it boil
2. Put the minced garlic, celery and peanut
3. Let it boil
4. Thickened with cornstarch dispensed in water
LM-Cookery Grade 10
185
A. Directions: Make a research on various recipes of the following vegetables:
a. MalunggayLeaves
b. Bell Pepper
c. Sayote
E. Directions: Make a research on the different ways of cooking vegetables in
the Philippines and other countries. Follow the instructions below:
 Group yourselves into 5 groups
 Assign a leader.
 Leaders will assign task to each member.
 Work on your research following the assigned country
a. Group I - Asian Countries
b. Group II - European Countries
c. Group III - American Countries
d. Group IV - African Countries
e. Group V - Ethnic ways of cooking in the Philippines.
Learning Outcome 3 Present Vegetable Dishes
 Presentation of prepared vegetable dishes
 Factors to consider in plating vegetable dishes
Essential Factors of Food Presentation
1. Good preparation and cooking techniques –
Proper cutting and cooking of vegetables
2. Professional Skills
Ability to perform according to required standards
3. Visual Sense
Effective food presentation depends on the understanding of
techniques involving balance, arrangement, and garniture.
 Balance
LM-Cookery Grade 10
186
Select foods and garnishes that offer variety and
contrast. This should be applied to colors, shapes,
textures and flavors.
 Portion size
 Match portion sizes and plates
 Balance the portion sizes of the items on the plate
 Arrangement on the plate
Many chefs display their creativity in plating
presentations. One important thing is, to keep in mind
the convenience and comfort of the diner when plating.
Plating Styles with Vegetable Dishes
Classic arrangement:
1. Main item in front, vegetables, starch items and
garnish at the rear.
2. Main item in the center, with vegetable
distributed around it.
3. Main item in the center with neat piles of
vegetables carefully arranged around.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
187
4. A starch or vegetable item heaped in the center, the main item sliced
and leaning up against it.
Guidelines in Plating
1. Keep food off the rim of the plate.
Select a plate large enough to hold food without hanging off the
edge.
2. Arrange the items for the convenience of the customer.
Always arrange the best side of food on plate to avoid letting the
diner rearrange them before eating.
3. Keep space between items, unless, they are stacked on one another.
Arrange vegetable on plate, that every item should be
identifiable.
4. Maintain unity.
Create a center of attention and relate everything to it.
5. Make every component count.
Garnishes are not added just for color, but sometimes they are
needed to balance a plate by providing an additional element.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
188
6. Add sauce or gravy attractively on plate.
Pour sauce around or under the dish or covering only a part of
the dish. Always think of the sauce as part of the overall design
of the plate.
7. Keep it simple.
Avoid making food too elaborate.
Creative Presentation Techniques
 Vegetable Purees
 Ribbon Vegetables
 Vegetable Rings
1. Cook vegetable until soft, then drain
well.
2.In food processor, process vegetable to
smooth puree.
3. Add melted butter or margarine.
4. Season with salt and pepper and process
again.
5. Add whipping cream.
6.Using ice-cream scoop or spoon, shape puree
on heatproof plate and place in oven or
microwave until hot.
1. With vegetable peeler, shred carrot, corvette
and radish into long ribbons, about 2.5 cm.
wide, pressing lightly with peeler so ribbons
will be very thin.
2.Toss vegetables with melted butter or
margarine.
3. Cook until tender – crisp.
1. With sharp knife, cut 3 peppers, (green, yellow, red) and onion into rings.
2. Remove core, seeds and membranes from peppers.
3. Toss vegetables with melted butter or margarine.
4. Cook until tender – crisp.
5. Serve hot or refrigerate to serve chilled.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
189
Photo Collection
Directions: Follow instructions below:
1. Make a photo album on the creative presentation techniques
for vegetable cookery.
2. It should contain a minimum of 10 pages and a maximum of
15 pages.
3. Label each creative presentation.
4. Your output will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
SCORE CRITERIA
5 Done creatively and neatly showing much relevance to the given
task
4 Done creatively and neat enough with relevance to the given task
3 Done creatively and neat enough but no relevance to the given
task
2 Done simply and neat enough but not so relevant to the given
task
1 Done poorly with erasures and irrelevant to the given task
LM-Cookery Grade 10
190
Directions: Prepare and present creatively a Stir Fried Mixed Vegetables
applying your own presentation design. Follow the procedures and
ingredients given.
Stir Fried Mixed Vegetables
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Pan
Mixing Bowl
Ladle
Chopping Board
Knife
Plate for serving
Ingredients:
350 g Chinese cabbage, cut into chunks
8 dried black mushrooms, cut julienne
4tbsp. carrots, cut julienne
4tbsp baby corn, drained
4 scallions, cut into shreds
4tbsp oil
1 garlic cloves, crushed
2 slices ginger root
½ t salt
12tbsp water or chicken stock
1/8 c cornstarch
12tbsp water, cold
½ t sesame oil
LM-Cookery Grade 10
191
Procedure:
1. Heat oil in a wok.
2. Add garlic.
3. Add ginger and salt.
4. Add cabbage and stir fry.
5. Add the remaining vegetables except shredded cabbage. Continue
to stir fry for 1 -2 minutes, then add shredded cabbage.
6. Add the stock, soy sauce, and cook until vegetables are crispy.
7. Mix cornstarch with cold water, then stir into vegetables to thicken
the sauce.
8. Stir the sesame oil and serve at once.
Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below:
4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing, cooking and presenting stir
fried vegetables and performs the skill very satisfactorily without
supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations.
3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing, cooking and presenting stir
fried vegetables and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or
supervision.
2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing, cooking and presenting stir
fried vegetables with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with
some assistance and/or supervision.
1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing, cooking and
presenting stir fried vegetables and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
192
Learning Outcome 4 Store Vegetable Dishes
Fresh Vegetables
1. Potatoes and onions are stored at cool temperature. (50 -65°F) in a
dry, dark place.
2. Other vegetables must be refrigerated. To prevent drying they should
be kept covered or wrapped.
3. Peeled and cut vegetables should be covered or wrapped, and use
quickly to prevent spoilage.
4. Potatoes, eggplants and other vegetables that brown when cut should
be treated with an acid or blanched them to inactivate the enzyme that
cause browning. Raw, cut potatoes are held in cold water for a short
time.
5. Store all fresh vegetables for a short time.
Frozen Vegetables
1. Store at 0°F (-18°C). or colder in original container until ready for use.
2. Do not refreeze thawed vegetables.
Dried Vegetables
1. Store in a cool (less than 75°F) dry, well ventilated place.
2. Keep well sealed and off the floor.
Canned Vegetables
1. Keep in a cool dry place, away from sunlight and off the floor.
2. Discard cans that show signs of damage (swollen, badly dented rusted
cans).
LM-Cookery Grade 10
193
Leftovers
1. Don‘t mix batches.
2. Store leftover creamed vegetables for one day only. Before storing,
cool rapidly by placing the container on ice.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
194
Overview
Seafood is any form of sea life regarded as food by humans. Seafood
includes fish and shellfish. Shellfish include various species of mollusks,
crustaceans, and echinoderms. A wide variety of fish and seafood are
available in the market from many different sources. There are so many
methods for cooking seafood, most of them are fast and easy, making them
the perfect choice for a quick and healthy meal. This lesson provides
information about fish and shellfish, ways on preparing and cooking fish,
along with some of the most popular seafood recipes, and presenting and
storing seafood.
Learning Outcome 1 Perform Mise’ En Place
You are about to learn the following from this lesson:
 Tools and equipment needed
 Types of seafood-shellfish, fin fish, others
 Variety of fish-structure, body shape, market forms, fat contents, water
source, processed fish, others
 Market forms of fish and fish products
 Fish cuts
 Composition and nutritive value of fish (scaling, cutting of tails and fins,
Eviscerating, cleansing, canning)
LESSON 2 PREPARE AND COOK SEAFOOD DISHES
LM-Cookery Grade 10
195
Classifications of Seafood
Fish products are divided into two categories
1. Fin fish – fish with fins and internal skeletons
A. Saltwater fish –
 Flatfish
 Flounder
 Sole
 Round fish
 Black sea bars
 Bluefish
 Cod
 Grouper
B. Freshwater fish
 Cat fish
 Eel
 Tilapia
2. Shell fish – fish with external shells but no internal bone structure.
They have hard outer shells.
Two classifications of Shellfish
A. Mollusks – are soft sea animals
 Bivalves – they have a pair of hinged shells (clams, oysters)
 Univalves – they have a single shell (abalone)
 Cephalopods – (octopus, squid)
B. Crustaceans – are animals with segmented shells and jointed
legs (shrimps, crabs)
LM-Cookery Grade 10
196
Parts of a Fish
Composition and Structure:
Fish consists of water, protein, fats and small amount of minerals and
vitamins.
Fish has very little connective tissue. It means:
1. Fish cooks very quickly, even at low heat.
2. Fish is naturally tender. High heat will result to toughening of protein.
3. Moist-heat methods are used not to create tenderness but to preserve
moistness and provide variety.
4. Cooked fish must be handled very carefully.
1. Fat Fish -- are those that are high in fat. (salmon, tuna, trout, mackerel)
2. Lean Fish – are those that are low in fat. (sole, cod, red snapper, bass)
LM-Cookery Grade 10
197
Market Forms
1. Whole or round – completely intact, as caught
2. Drawn – viscera removed
3. Dressed -- viscera, scales, head, tail and fins
removed
4. Steaks – cross-section slices, each containing
a section of backbone
5. Fillets – boneless side of fish, with or without
skin
6. Butterflied fillets – both sides of a fish still
joined, but with bones removed
LM-Cookery Grade 10
198
7. Sticks or tranches – cross-section slices of
fillets
Characteristics and Market forms of Shellfish
Shellfish
Characteristics
Mollusks
 Oysters have rough, irregular shells.
 Flesh of oyster is extremely soft and delicate and contains high
percentage of water.
 Hard-shell clams – can be eaten raw
 Soft-shell clams are called steamers. The usual way to cook is
to steam.
 The shells of mussels are not as heavy as clamshells, yellow to
orange in color and firm but tender when cooked.
 Scallops are creamy white in color and have a sweet flavor.
 Squid is somewhat chewy and are cut up or either fried quickly.
Crustaceans
 The lobster shell is dark green or bluish green but turns red
when cooked.
 Live lobster must be alive when cooked.
Market Forms
Mollusks
1. live in the shell
2. shucked – fresh or frozen
3. canned
LM-Cookery Grade 10
199
Crustaceans
1. live
2. cooked meat, fresh or frozen
Review of Learning Outcome 1
Directions: Identify the market forms of fish. Write your answer in your test
notebook.
1. 2.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
200
3.
5.
4.
6.
7.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
201
Learning Outcome 2 Handle Seafood Dishes
Fin Fish
Checking freshness of fish
1. Fresh and mild odor
2. Eyes are clear, shiny and bulging
3. Red or pink gills
4. Texture of flesh is firm or elastic
5. Shiny scales, and tightly cling, on skin
LM-Cookery Grade 10
202
Shellfish
1. Oysters, clams, mussels in the shell must be alive. Tightly closed
shells when jostled.
2. Live or shucked oysters must have a very mild, sweet smell.
3. Discard any mussels that are very light in weight or seem to be hollow.
4. Strong fishy odor or a brownish color is a sign of age or spoilage.
5. Live lobster must be alive when cooked. The
meat will be firm and the tail springs back when straightened.
6. Frozen shrimp should be solidly frozen when received.
7. Glazed shrimp should be shiny with no freezer burn.
8. All shrimps should smell fresh and sweet. A strong fishy or iodine
smell indicates age or spoilage.
9. Live crabs should be kept alive until cooked.
10. Frozen crabmeat should be treated like any other frozen fish.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
203
Handling and Storage of Fish
Fresh Fish
1. Store on crushed ice. Use drip pans to allow for
drainage of melted ice. Change ice daily. Cover
container or store in separate box away from other foods.
Whole fish should be drawn because entrails deteriorate
rapidly.
Cut fish should be wrapped or left in original moisture-
proof wrap.
2. In refrigerated box at 30° to 34°F (-1° to 1°C.
3. Fresh fish may be stored for 1 to 2 days. If kept
longer, wrap and freeze immediately.
4. Check store fish for freshness just before using.
Frozen Fish
1. Frozen products should be frozen, not thawed
when received.
2. Items should be well wrapped, with no freezer
burn.
3. Store at 0°F (-18°C. or colder.
4. Maximum storage time
Fat fish -- 2 months
Lean fish -- 6 months
5. Rotate stock – first in, first out
Thawing and Handling of frozen fish
1. Thaw in refrigerator, never at room temperature.
If pressed for time, keep in original moisture-proof
wrapper and thaw under cold running water.
2. Small pieces like fillets and steaks can be
cooked from frozen state to prevent excessive drip
loss. Large fish should be thawed for even cooking.
3. Fillets that are to be breaded can be partially
thawed.
4. Handle thawed fish as fresh fish. Do not
refreeze.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
204
5. Breaded, battered and other frozen prepared fish items are mostly
cooked from frozen state.
Shellfish
1. MUSSELS
Keep refrigerated (32°F to 35°F/0° to 2°C). and
protect from light. Store in original sack and keep sack
damp.
2. SCALLOPS
 Shucked scallops can be cooked without further
preparation.
 Keep scallops covered and refrigerated (30°F to
34°F). Do not let them rest directly on ice or they
will lose flavor and become watery.
3. LOBSTERS
 Live lobsters are either live or cup up before cooking.
Live lobsters are plunged head first into boiling water, then
simmered for 5 – 6 minutes. If served hot, they are drained
well and split in half, and claws are cracked.
 Live lobsters can be kept in two ways
1. packed in moist seaweed, kept in a cool place
2. in saltwater
 Cooked lobster meat must be covered and
refrigerated at 30° to 34°F. It is very perishable and should
be used in 1 – 2 days.
4. SHRIMPS
 Kept frozen at 0°F (-18°C). or lower
 Thaw in refrigerator
 Peeled shrimp should be wrapped before
placing on ice
 Shrimp served hot must be peeled and
deveined before cooking
 Shrimp to be served cold, must be peeled after
cooking to preserve flavor.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
205
5. CRABS
 Live crabs should be kept alive until cooked.
 Frozen crabmeat is very perishable when
thawed. It must be treated like any other
frozen fish.
Directions: Follow the instructions below:
 Visit at least 2 market/supermarkets and list down the fish/seafood that
they are selling and their characteristics.
 Identify the kind and market forms of fish and other seafood products
available in the market visited.
 Make documentation with picture of each market form. Include
description of each.
Your output will be rated using the given rubric.
SCORE CRITERIA
5 Done creatively and neatly showing much relevance to the given topic
4 Done creatively and neat enough with relevance to the given topic
3 Done creatively and neat enough but no relevance to the given topic
2 Done simply and neat enough but not so relevant to the given topic
1 Done poorly with erasures and irrelevant to the given topic
LM-Cookery Grade 10
206
Learning Outcome 3 Cook Seafood
Are you ready for cooking? Fasten your seatbelt and carry on.
 Principles of cooking fish and seafood dishes (dry heat and moist heat
cookery)
 Variety of shellfish and fish dishes
Cooking Techniques for Fish and Shellfish
Fish is very delicate and easily overcooked. During cooking, test for
doneness must be observed.
1. The fish just separates into flakes
2. If bone is present, the flesh separates from the bone, and the bone is
no longer pink
3. The flesh becomes opaque (usually white)
Lean fish
 Lean fish has almost no fat, so it easily becomes dry. It is best served
with sauces to enhance moistness and gives richness.
 Poaching is the moist heat method suited
 Fish should be basted with butter or oil if broiled or baked.
 Lean fish maybe fried or sautéed to gain palatability from added fat.
Fat fish
 The fat in fish, enables them to tolerate more heat without becoming
dry.
 Fat fish can be cooked by poaching.
 Fat fish are well suited to broiling and baking. The dry heat methods
eliminate excessive oiliness.
 Large fat fish like salmon, and mackerel may be cooked in fat, but care
should be taken to avoid excessive greasiness.
Shellfish
 Cook oyster just enough to heat thoroughly to keep it juicy and plump.
 Clams become tough and rubbery if overcooked
 Shrimps like other shellfish, become tough and rubbery when cooked
at high temperature.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
207
Scaling Whole Fish
Once your work area and fish are ready, you can begin the actual scaling
process.
1. Lay your fish flat on the board or
hold it steady in the water.
2. Hold the fish down firmly with your
hand near its head.
3. Begin to rake the scales from the
tail towards the head. They should
start coming off in clumps.
4. Be sure to remove the scales on
both sides of the fish, as well as
scales near the fins, the collar and
the tail.
5. When you think you have gotten
most of the scales, rinse the fish off
again with water. This will wash away
any loose scales and help you to
identify any remaining scales that
need to be removed.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
208
Filleting Fish
First, cut behind the head while
angling the knife toward the front of
the fish. There is a lot of good flesh
on the top side where the fillet
extends under the bony plate of the
skull and angling the knife will
ensure you don't waste it. Cut down
to the bone and follow the line
through to just behind the fins.
Turn the fish and run the knife just
clear of the fins with a slight
downward angle. When you feel
the knife is down to the bone
reduce the angle and follow the
bone until you come up against the
backbone.
Peel the fillet back and run the knife
over the backbone severing the
small lateral fish bones in the
process. Stop at this point.
Turn the fish over and repeat the
procedure.
Repeat the second cut near the
dorsal fin with the knife angled
slightly down.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
209
Continue this along the length of
the fish
Reverse the direction of the filleting
knife and follow the bones by
"feeling them" with the fillet knife
until the fish backbone is reached
Peel the fillet back and cut around
the backbone and through the
small lateral bones. Run the fillet
knife right through to the skin on
the underside of the fish.
Cut over the belly flap either
through or over the belly bones. It
can be easily cut through here with
the razor sharp filleting knife.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
210
Cut any remaining attached sinew
or skin.
Remove the first fillet.
Flip the fish back to the original
side and cut the bones around the
gut cavity
Release the rest of the fillet from
the backbone.
Skinning Fish
When filleting or skinning fish keep the skinning knife clean and wet,
this lubricates the blade and gives a much cleaner cut, more control of the
knife and far less drag on the sides of the blade.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
211
Stop when you have an inch or two (25 to
50mm) of fillet released.
Change your grip on the fillet to a secure
grip on the tab of fish skin you created with
the first cut
Firmly hold the knife still and at a fixed
angle.
Wriggle the skin from side to side while
pulling backwards on the tab of fish skin
Continue this motion through the fillet. You
can see that even though the skin in the left
hand is creased under the tension it has no
effect where the fillet knife is separating the
fish skin from the flesh.
The fillet and skin are parted and no fleshes
have been wasted nor have left any skin or
scales on the fillet. If you scroll up you will
note the knife has not moved over the last
four fish skinning pictures.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
212
Deboning Fish
Gentle strokes of a knife angled towards
the gut cavity will reveal the position and
lay of the fine bones. Follow this line,
cutting completely through, to release
the top part of the fillet.
The line of fine bones stops around two
thirds of the way down the fillet. At this
point put the knife on the other side of
the line of bones and run the knife up
the fillet until the point is well under the
bones around the gut cavity.
Separate the two and reinsert the knife
at an angle suitable to cut the flesh from
the underside of the gut bones
Keep the knife following close to the fish
bones to recover as much flesh as
possible
LM-Cookery Grade 10
213
The fillet is now deboned and the piece on the right of the picture
above is discarded or washed and put aside with the fish heads and back
bones for making fish stock
Open oysters and clams for waste minimization techniques and
environmental considerations in relation to seafood.
A. Opening Oyster
Hold oyster cup side down and hinge pointed towards you.
1. Insert oyster knife at hinge slowly but
firmly and push the knife between the shells.
Use a slight side to side rocking movement
with your knife as you push in.
2. Work tip of knife into the oyster (about 1/2
inch).
3. Twist knife handle to pop oyster open.
4. Push knife into oyster and slice muscle
from top shell.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
214
5. Open top shell.
6. Cut muscle from bottom cup. Turn the
meat over for most professional appearance.
B. Opening Clams
Scrub clams under cool running water using a
stiff kitchen brush.
Over a bowl, hold the clam firmly in your hand
and insert the clam knife between the top
shell and bottom shell. A towel can be used to
protect your hand. Work the knife around to
cut through the hinge muscle. The bowl will
catch the liquor from the clam.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
215
Open the shell. Slide the knife between
the clam and the shell. Detach the
clam.
The clam is now ready to be cooked or
eaten raw.
Cleaning a Squid
Pull off the head Remove the ink sac.
Cut Tentacles.
Remove beak from tentacles
LM-Cookery Grade 10
216
Pull out the tail tube and cartilage
Pull off the skin
Cut into rings
Splitting a Lobster
How to Cut Lobster in Lengthwise
1. Place the lobster on its back on a
tea towel to prevent slipping.
2.Using a heavy sharp knife, cut
right through the underside of the
body and tail, down the center.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
217
A lobster split is not only an attractive style for presentation, but also
enables easy access to the delicious meat inside. Turn the lobster around
and continue the cut through the center of the head.
The following will be the different activities that you need to undertake:
 By group you will do collaborative learning and study the step by step
procedures on how to perform scaling, filleting, skinning, deboning,
opening oyster, opening clams, cleaning a squid, and splitting lobster.
Be ready for a demonstration.
 You can watch a video in You Tube or visit markets to see actual
demonstration for deeper learning.
 Bring the materials needed for the purpose of demonstration of the
lesson.
 You will demonstrate the different ways of preparing fish and seafood
prior to the cooking activities.
4. Turn the lobster around and
continue the cut through the
center of the head. Place the
lobster on its back on a tea
towel to prevent slipping.
4. Using a heavy sharp knife, cut
right through the underside of the
body and tail, down the center.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
218
Guidelines for Baking Fish
1. Fat fish are best for baking because they are less likely to dry out.
2. Lean fish may be baked but care should be taken not to overcook it.
Basting with butter or oil helps prevent drying.
3. Baking temperature is 350°F to 400°F.
4. Served baked fish with a sauce or seasoned butter to enhance
moistness and improve palatability.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
219
Guidelines for Broiling or Grilling Fish
1. Overcooking should be avoided in cooking fish.
2. Select appropriate fish for broiling or grilling.
3. Fat fish and lean fish should be coated with fat before broiling to
reduce drying.
4. Lean fish may be dredged in flour before dipping in oil or melted butter.
The flour helps form a flavorful browned crust.
5. To prevent splitting during cooking, score the skin with a sharp knife.
For small fillets, scoring may not be necessary.
6. Broil fish to order and serve immediately.
7. Broiled fish may be garnished lightly with paprika if more color is
desired.
8. Thick cuts should be turned once during broiling in order to cook
evenly. Thin pieces may be arranged on an oiled pan and broiled on
one side only. Lobster is also broiled without turning.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
220
Directions: Perform the given recipe. Your performance will be rated using the
given rubric below.
Broiled Shrimp Campy
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Broiler, griller
Brush
Baking Sheet
Ingredients:
680 g large shrimp, peeled and deveined, tails left on, patted dry
1 tablespoon olive oil
2 cloves garlic, minced
Coarse salt and ground pepper
2 tablespoons freshly squeezed lemon juice
2 tablespoons chopped fresh parsley
Lemon wedges, for serving
LM-Cookery Grade 10
221
Procedure:
1. Heat broiler with rack set 4 inches from heat. Place shrimp on a large
broiler proof rimmed baking sheet.
2. Sprinkle with oil and garlic, and season generously with salt and
pepper; toss to coat. Arrange shrimp in a single layer.
3. Broil until opaque throughout, 3 to 4 minutes. Sprinkle with lemon juice
and parsley; toss to combine. Serve immediately; garnish with lemon
wedges.
4 Can perform the skill without supervision and with initiative and
adaptability to problem situations.
3 Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or
supervision.
2 Can perform the skill satisfactorily but requires some assistance
and/or supervision.
1 Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, but requires
considerable assistance and/or supervision.
Guidelines for Sautéing and Pan Frying Fish and Shellfish
1. Lean fish are suited to sautéing because of the added fat.
2. Fat fish can be sautéed with care so as not to become greasy.
3. Breading the fish with flour or starchy products forms a crust that
browns attractively, enhances flavor, helps hold the fish and prevent
sticking.
4. Use fat, enough to cover the bottom of the pan.
5. Be sure the pan is hot before adding fish. Small items are sautéed
over high heat, larger items require lower heat to cook evenly.
6. Very large fish may be browned in fat, and finished in an oven,
uncovered.
7. Brown the most attractive side – the presentation side.
8. Handle fish carefully during and after cooking to avoid breaking the
fish.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
222
9. Sauté or fry to order and serve immediately.
Directions: Given the different recipes by group prepare and cook fish and
shellfish. Your performance will be evaluated using the given rubric.
Fillet of Sole Meniere
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Mixing bowl
Ladle
Pan
Spatula
Ingredients:
Fish
Emeril's Fish Rub (or any combination of seasonings you like)
2 tbs. butter
Lemon juice
LM-Cookery Grade 10
223
Procedure:
1. Season all the fillets by sprinkling the seasoning and pressing it into
the meat.
2. Get a spatula to handle the fish. If you have 10-12" filets cut them in
half unless you're using a fish spatula
3. Heat the pan on medium heat and add the butter. When the butter is
melted put some fish in the pan. Leave it on one side for about three to
four minutes.
4. Move them around often to assure they're not sticking.
5. Flip one piece to check the brownness. If it's partially browned flip them
all and continue to cook until the other side is browned.
6. Add more oil as needed.
7. Once it's out of the pan put six or eight drops of lemon juice on each
piece. You may use other sauces if you want.
Note: Testing the degree of doneness is as simple as taking your
spatula and gently pushing on the thickest part of the fillet in the spinal
bone line. When done, meat separates when you gently push with
spatula.
4 Can perform the skill without supervision and with initiative and
adaptability to problem situations.
3 Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or
supervision.
2 Can perform the skill satisfactorily but requires some assistance
and/or supervision.
1 Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, but requires
considerable assistance and/or supervision.
Guidelines in Deep-Frying
1. Lean fish, both whole or small portions, and shellfish like shrimps,
clams and oysters are best for deep-frying.
2. Fish to be fried is breaded or buttered to prevent sticking from frying
pan. The batter also provides a crisp, flavorful, and attractive coating.
3. Frozen breaded fish can be fried without thawing.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
224
4. Fried fish is usually served with lemon or cold sauce such as tartar,
remoulade or cocktail sauce on the side.
5. The oil used should be enough to submerge the food item during
frying.
Cooking fish or shellfish by deep frying using the standard breading
procedure.
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Stove
Mixing bowls
Ladle
Refrigerator
Baking sheet
Food tong
Ingredients:
1 cup self-rising cornmeal
1/2 cup self-rising flour
3/4 tsp table salt
1/2 tsp powdered white pepper
1/3 tsp cayenne pepper (optional)
1/4 tsp garlic salt
2 tbsp. peanut oil
1 large egg
1 tsp cool tap water
LM-Cookery Grade 10
225
Procedure:
1. Use a small bowl and prepare an egg wash by mixing 1 large egg with 1
tsp of water.
2. In another bowl, place the cornmeal, flour, salt, pepper, cayenne pepper,
garlic salt, and blend well. This breading recipe will bread about 2 pounds
of fillets.
3. Rinse the fillets and pat dry, then place them into the refrigerator for about
30 minutes.
4. Place the fillets in the egg wash, then the Breading Mix before placing them
on the prepared cookie sheet.
5. Prepare the cookie sheet by spreading the peanut oil evenly on the sheet.
6. The oven should be pre-heated to 375. Cook the fillets 5 minutes on each
side
4 Can perform the skill without supervision and with initiative and
adaptability to problem situations.
3 Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or
supervision.
2 Can perform the skill satisfactorily but requires some assistance
and/or supervision.
1 Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, but requires
considerable assistance and/or supervision.
You did a great cooking. It‘s time to plate and present your dish. Go on
and enjoy learning and doing.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
226
Learning Outcome 4 Plate/Present Seafood Dishes
Part of serving any kind of food is presentation. You don‘t have to be a
trained chef to learn the basics of plating, which is the art of presenting food
in an attractive way. The following topics and activities will help you learn the
fundamentals of plating and perform it for better understanding.
Fundamental of Plating
1. Balance – select foods and garnishes that offer variety and contrast
 color – two or three colors on a plate
 shapes – variety of shapes
 textures – variety of textures
 flavors –
2. Portion size
 match portion sizes and plates – select plates large enough to hold
all the items without crowding
 balance the portion sizes of the items on the plate – don‘t let the
main item get lost with excessive garnish
 arrangement on the plate –
Guidelines to help plating attractive
1. Keep food off the rim of the plate.
2. Arrange the items for the convenience of the customer.
3. Keep space between items. Each item should have its own
identity.
4. Maintain unity. Create a center of attention and relate everything to
it
5. Make every component count.
6. Add gravy or sauce attractively.
7. Keep it simple.
3. Serve hot foods hot, on hot plates
Serve cold foods cold, on cold plates
Examples of Garnishes or Accompaniment for Plating
 Bouqetiere - bouquet of vegetables
 Jardinière - garden vegetables
 Clamart - peas
 Crecy - carrots
LM-Cookery Grade 10
227
 Doria - cucumbers (cooked in butter)
 Dubarry - cauliflower
 Fermiere - carrots, turnips, onions and celery cut into
uniformslices
 Forestiere - mushrooms
 Lyonnaise - onions
 Nicoise - tomatoes concasse cooked with garlic
Serving Baked Fish
 Serve baked fish with a sauce or
seasoned butter to enhance moistness
and improves palatability. Serving with
lemon also enhances the fish.
 For service, the fish is removed from the
dish, the liquid is strained, degreased,
reduced and finished by adding butter,
cream or veloute sauce.
Serving Broiled Lobster
Serve immediately with melted butter or
appropriate sauce and garnish.
Serving Sautéed and Pan Fried
 Remove the fish with spatula and place
on serving plate with presentation side
up.
 Sprinkle fish with lemon juice and
chopped parsley.
 Heat raw butter in the sauté pan until it
turns light brown. Pour over fish
immediately and serve at once.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
228
Serving Poached or Simmered Fish in
Court bouillon
Served poached fish with appropriate
sauce, such as hollandaise for hot fish
and a mayonnaise – based sauce for
cold fish. Mild vinaigrette go well with
both hot and cold poached fish.
Serving Poached Fish in Fumet and
Wine
 Reduce the cuision over high heat to
about ¼ of its volume.
 Add fish veloute and heavy cream
and bring to boil.
 Adjust seasoning with salt, white
pepper and lemon juice.
 Strain the sauce.
 Arrange the fish on plates for
service, coat with sauce and serve
immediately.
Glazing
Poached fish is sometimes glazed before
serving
1. Combine the finished sauce with
eggyolk, hollandaise sauce or lightly
whipped cream.
2. Coat the fish with the sauce and run
the plate under a broiler until the
sauce is golden brown.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
229
Review of Learning Outcome 4
A. Directions: Briefly explain the relationships of the following in food
preparation. Write your answers in your test notebook.
1. Balance
2. Portion size
3. Serving hot food on hot plates
4. Serving cold foods on cold plates
5. Garnishes
LM-Cookery Grade 10
230
Directions: Given the recipe, perform the following by group:
Broiled Fish Steaks
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Oven
Baking sheet
Brush
Fork
Plate
Ingredients:
3 fish steaks, 1‖ thick
½ tsp. salt
Dash of pepper
2 tsp. lemon juice
2 tbsp. butter, melted
Procedure:
1. Sprinkle both sides of fish with salt, pepper and lemon juice.
2. Brush with half of the butter.
3. Put fish in broiler pan in 550 degree oven, don‘t cover.
4. Broil with tops about 4 inches from heat until light brown.
5. Brush fish with butter turn very carefully.
6. Brush with rest of the butter.
7. Broil until fish flakes easily with fork, 4 – 6 more minutes.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
231
Poached Fillet of Sole in White Wine Sauce
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Pan
Baking dish
Food tong
Spoon
Broiler/oven
Ingredients:
2 lbs. sole fillets
2 lbs. spinach, cooked and drained
½ C. dry white wine
1 C. fish stock
3 tbsp. butter
4 tbsp. flour
1 C. grated cheese
Salt and pepper
Procedure:
1. Roll and secure each fillet with toothpicks
2. Poached for 8 minutes in wine/fish stock
3. Drain and save liquid
Sauce
1. Melt butter
2. Blend in flour, salt and pepper and fish liquid
3. Assemble butter in shallow serving dish
4. Arrange spinach on bottom
5. Cover with poached fish (remove toothpicks
6. Spoon sauce over fish
7. Sprinkle with cheese
8. Broil under hot broiler a few minutes
LM-Cookery Grade 10
232
4 Can perform the skill without supervision and with initiative and
adaptability to problem situations.
3 Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or
supervision.
2 Can perform the skill satisfactorily but requires some assistance
and/or supervision.
1 Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, but requires
considerable assistance and/or supervision.
Learning Outcome 5 Store Seafood
Storing of Fish and Shellfish
Fresh Fish
1. On crushed ice – use drip pans to allow for
drainage of melted ice. Change ice daily.
Cover container or store in separate box
away from other foods.
a. Whole fish should be drawn (that is
viscera removed) as soon as possible
because the entrails deteriorate quickly.
b. Cut fish (fillets, steaks, portions) should
be wrapped or left in original moisture
proof wrap.
2. Refrigerate at 30° to 34°F (-1° to 1°C...
3. Fish may be stored for 1 to 2 days. If it
must be kept longer, you must wrap and
freeze it immediately.
4. Check stored fish for freshness just before
you use it. Even if it was fresh when
received, it may not be fresh after few days
in storage.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
233
Frozen Fish
1. Store at 0°F (-18°C. or colder.
2. Keep well wrapped to prevent freezer burn
3. Maximum storage time: Fat fish – 2
months; Lean fish – 6 months.
4. Rotate stock – first in, first out.
Shellfish
A. Oyster
1. Keep live oyster in a cold, wet place in the
cartons or sacks.
2. Store fresh shucked oysters in original
container in refrigerator at 30° to 34°F (-1°
to 1°C). They will keep up to 1 week.
3. Keep frozen oysters in freezer at 0°F (-
18°C. or colder, until ready for use.
Lobster and Shrimp 1. Store at 0°F (-18°C. or colder).
2. Fresh or thawed shrimp in shell are stored
on crushed ice, like whole fish.
3. Peeled shrimp lose soluble nutrients and
flavor when stored unwrapped on ice. They
should be wrapped before placing on ice or
covered and simply refrigerated.
4. Packed in moist seaweed or in moist, heavy
paper, kept in a cool place.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
234
Review of Learning Outcome 5
Directions: Match Column A with Column B. Write the letter of the correct
letter of your answer in your test notebook. Items in column B may be
answered twice or more.
Column A Column B
1. Removed viscera first before storing A. fresh fish
2. Wrapped to prevent freezer burns B. frozen fish
3. Kept in cold, wet cartons C. lobster and shrimp
4. Packed in moist seaweed D. shellfish
5. First in, first out e. all of the above
6. Wrapped before freezing
7. Left in original moisture proof wrapped
8. Refrigerate at 30° to 34°F (-1° to 1°C)
9. Store at 0°F ( -18°C. or colder)
10. Stored for 1 to 2 days
Directions: Perform experimental fish cookery. Make your own recipe and
prepare, cook and present the product. Explain how to properly store your
output. Your performance will be evaluated using the given rubric.
4 Can perform the skill without supervision and with initiative and
adaptability to problem situations.
3 Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or
supervision.
2 Can perform the skill satisfactorily but requires some assistance
and/or supervision.
1 Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, but requires
considerable assistance and/or supervision.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
235
Post Test 2
Multiple Choice.
Directions: Read the following questions carefully and choose the
letter that best describes the statement. Write your answer in your
test notebook.
1. Which of the following vegetables is rich in carbohydrates?
A. legumes, peas, and beans C. Mushroom, tomatoes, and radish
B. Nuts, olives, and avocado D. Seeds, roots, and tubers
2. What is the flavor component of vegetables which gives strong flavor and
odor to some vegetables like onions, leeks, garlic, chives, cabbage, and
broccoli?
A. Flavonoids C. Sugar
C. Glutamic acid D. Sulfur compounds
3. Which tool is used to drain excess water after washing vegetables?
A. Bowls C. Steamer
B. Colander D. Utility tray
4. Which of the following is cooking by placing blanched or raw vegetables in
the pan, adding liquid (stock, water, wine) then covering and cooking it
slowly?
A. Boiling C. Braising
B. Baking D. Sautéing
5. Which fat soluble compound is responsible for the green coloring of plants?
A. Anthocyanins C. Chlorophyll
B. Carotenoids D. Lycopene
6. Mrs. Cabrillas needs more supply of Vitamin A. which of the following will
she eat to give her the nutrient she needs?
A.Alugbati C. Lettuce
B. Potatoes D.Saluyot
7. Which of the following plating styles is not a classic arrangement?
A. The starch or vegetable item is heaped in the center while the main item
is sliced and leaned up against it.
B. The main item in the center, with vegetable distributed around it.
C. The vegetable item in front and main item, starch item and garnish at
the rear.
D. The main item is in the center with neat piles of vegetables carefully
arranged around.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
236
8. Chef Shaneshan will cook chopsuey. She is about to remove the hard core
of a cabbage. Which of the following knife will she use?
A. Butcher knife C. Cutting knife
B. Channel knife D. Paring knife
9. What kind of knife is used in removing the hard core of a cabbage?
A. Butcher knife C. Cutting knife
B. Channel knife D. Paring knife
10. At what temperature in a dry, dark place should potatoes and onions be
stored?
A. 50 – 650F C. 60 – 850F
B. 40 – 450F D. 70 – 950F
11. Which of the following vegetables is cooked uncovered?
A. Fruit vegetables C. Roots and tubers
B. Green vegetables D. Yellow vegetables
12. Which kind of fish has no internal bone structure?
A. Fin fish C. Round fish
B. Freshwater fish D. Shell fish
13. Which of the following fish is high in fat?
A. Bass C. Mackerel
B. Cod D. Red Snapper
14. Which of the following fish is low in fat?
A. Cod C. Trout
B. Salmon D. Tuna
15. Which market form of fish is viscera, head, tail and fins are removed?
A. Butterfly C. Fillet
B. Dressed D. Sticks
16. Which of the following is a freshwater fish?
A. Bluefish C. Grouper
B. Cat fish D. Sole
17. Which market form of fish are both sides of a fish still joined but bones are
removed?
A. Butterfly C. Fillet
B. Drawn D. Steak
18. Which of the following is the second step in scaling whole fish?
A. Begin to rake the scales from the tail towards the head.
B. Remove the scales on both sides of the fish.
C. Hold the fish down firmly with your hand near its head.
D. Lay your fish flat on the board.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
237
19. Which of the following is the third step in opening an oyster?
A. Cut muscle from bottom cup.
B. Insert oyster knife at hinge slowly but firmly
C. Push knife into oyster and slice muscle from top shell
D. Twist knife handle to open the oyster.
20. Which of the following is a characteristic of a fresh fish?
A. With fresh and foul odor
B. Eyes are dull, shiny and bulging
C. Gills are pink or red
D. Flesh shrink when pressed
21. How many colors is suggested on a plate to make it balance?
A. Four to five C. Three to four
B. One to two D. Two to three
22. Which of the following seafood is cooked just enough to heat to keep it
juicy and plump?
A. Fat fish C. Flat fish
B. Lean fish D. Shellfish
23. Which of the following enhances baked fish when served?
A. Butter C. Lemon
B. Cream D. Sauce
24. What cooking method is suited to fat fish.
A. Baking C. Deep -frying
B. Boiling D. Sautéing
25. Which is basted to baked lean fish to help prevent it from drying up.
A. Butter C. Soy sauce
B. Cream D. Tomato sauce
B. Give five characteristics of a fresh fish.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
238
QUARTER 3
PREPARE STOCKS, SAUCES AND SOUPS, AND
POULTRY AND GAME DISHES
Overview
This quarter will enable students or learners to acquire competencies
in: preparing, storing, reconstituting and evaluating stocks, sauces and soups;
cooking, plating/presenting, and storing poultry and game dishes, preparing,
cooking, plating/presenting and storing meat dishes.
Objectives:
At the end of the quarter students are expected to:
1. prepare stocks required for menu item;
2. prepare soups required for menu item;
3. prepare sauce required for menu item;
4. store and reconstitute stocks, sauces and soups;
5. perform mise‘en place;
6. cook poultry and meat dishes;
7. plate and present poultry and meat dishes;
8. evaluate finished products; and
9. store poultry and meat.
Pre-Test
Directions: Read and understand the statements/questions below. Choose
the letter of the correct answer and write it in your test notebook.
1. As a chef of a fine dining restaurant, Genie simmers meat, fish, and
vegetables. Which of the following liquids is a by-product after the different
food stuffs have been simmered?
A. glaze C. stock
B. sauce D. water
LM-Cookery Grade 10
239
2. Which of the following stocks uses veal bone as its main ingredient?
A. brown stock C. prawn stock
B. ham stock D. white stock
3. What kind of stock uses fish as its main ingredient?
A. brown stock C. glace viande
B. fish stock D. ham stock
4. What stock uses chicken bone as its main ingredient?
A. fish stock C. prawn stock
B. ham stock D. chicken stock
5. Among the different types of stock, which one is the easiest to prepare?
A. brown stock C. white stock
B. fish stock D. vegetable stock
6. What stock is made by boiling prawn shell?
A. fish stock C. prawn stock
B. ham stock D. vegetable stock
7. As a rule, which should not be added to the stock because it causes
saltiness?
A. MSG C. spices
B. salt D. sugar
8. Mrs. Sante will be having visitors for dinner. If she will prepare stock for
their dinner, which of the following flavoring agents will she use to give
aroma to the stock?
A. aromatic flavoring C. ginger
B. garlic D. smoke
9. What makes the stock tasty and appetizing?
A. appearance C. ingredients
B. color D. smell
10. Which of the following is a clear soup?
A. bisques C. cream
B. bouillon D. puree
11. Which of the following examples is a thick soup?
A. bisques C. consommé
B. bouillon D. fruit
12. Which of the following is not a thickening agent?
A. flour C. rice
B. grain D. salt
13. Which of the four basic sauces whose basic ingredient is milk is thickened
with flour enriched with butter?
A. Hollandaise sauce C. veloute sauce
B. savory butter D. white sauce
LM-Cookery Grade 10
240
14. Which among the four basic sauces has a chief ingredient of chicken
broth thickened with flour and enriched with butter seasoning?
A. Hollandaise sauce C. veloute sauce
B. savory butter D. white sauce
15. Which of the four basic sauces has three basic ingredients like butter,
egg yolk, and lemon juice with seasoning for accent?
A. Hollandaise sauce C. white sauce
B. savory butter D. veloute sauce
16. Which of the four basic sauces has a basic ingredient like butter that is
creamed and blended with other ingredients to give individual flavor?
A. Hollandaise sauce C. veloute sauce
B. savory butter D. white sauce
17. Which of the following is not a thickening agent?
A. dairy cream C. flour
B. egg D. spice
18. What do you call birds that are hunted for food?
A. game C. poultry
B. livestock D. swine
19. Which of the following poultry originated from China and is noted for its
tender and flavorful meat?
A. chicken C. itik
B. goose D. pecking duck
20. What do you call to young immature pigeon of either sex with extra
tender meat is called .
A. duck C. rooster
B. fryer D. squab
21. Poultry is composed of different parts. Which of the following do breast
meat belong?
A. dark meat C. variety meat
B. tough meat D. white meat
22. Which of the following characteristics is a good quality of a live poultry?
A. free from pin feathers and shows no cuts
B. has clear eye
C. heavy and the skin is watery
D. well-develop thighs
23. What do you call to young chicken that is usually 9 to 12 weeks of age?
A. fryer C. roaster
B. hen D. stag
24. How many days should a whole chicken should be refrigerated?
A. 1 day C. 2 to 4 days
B. 1 to 2 days D. 3 to 4 days
LM-Cookery Grade 10
241
25. How do you classify the fleshy part of chicken like breast?
A. entrails C. viscera
B. dark meat D. white meat
26. In cookery, we apply different cooking methods depending on the
ingredients that we have. If you will cook a matured poultry, which of the
following methods will you apply?
A. boiling C. roasting
B. frying D. stewing
27. What cookery method is suitable for the less tender cuts?
A. boiling C. roasting
B. frying D. stewing
28. What is the best cooking temperature for poultry?
A. high temperature C. low to moderate temperature
B. low temperature D. moderate temperature
29. What factor affects the poultry meat‘s tenderness and juiciness?
A. age C. cuts
B. cookery D. sex
30. Which of the following can be done to prevent drying when reheating?
A. cook using sauces and gravy
B. overcook the poultry meat
C. remove fat before cooking
D. none of the above
LM-Cookery Grade 10
242
Overview:
This lesson covers the skills, knowledge, and attitudes required to
prepare various stocks, sauces, and soup in a commercial kitchen or catering
operation
Learning Outcomes:
At the end of this Lesson you are expected to do the following:
1. prepare stocks for required menu items;
2. prepare soups required for menu items;
3. prepare sauces required for menu items;
4. store and reconstitute stocks, sauces and soups; and
5. evaluate the finished product
Learning Outcome 1 Prepare Stocks for Required Menu Items
Principles of Preparing Stocks
Stocks- are among the most basic preparations found in professional
kitchen. They are referred to in French as fonds de cuisine, or ―the
foundation of cooking.” It is a flavorful liquid prepared by simmering meaty
bones from meat or poultry, seafood and/or vegetables in water with
aromatics until their flavor, aroma, color and body, and nutritive value are
extracted.
- a clear, thin liquid flavored by soluble substances extracted from
meat, poultry, and fish; and their bones, and from vegetables and
seasonings.
LESSON 1 PREPARE STOCKS, SAUCES AND SOUPS
LM-Cookery Grade 10
243
Chicken stock –made from the
chicken bones.
White stock – made from beef or veal
bones.
Brown stock – made from
beef or veal bones that
have been browned in
an oven.
Fish stock – made from fish bones
and trimmings left over after filleting
Classification of Stocks
LM-Cookery Grade 10
244
Ingredients in Preparing Stocks
1. Bones
Most of the flavor and body of
stocks are derived from the
bones of beef, veal, chicken,
fish, and pork. The kinds of
bones used determine the kind
of stock, except vegetable
stock.
2. Mirepoix
- is the French term for the
combination of coarsely
chopped onions, carrots and
celery used to flavor stocks.
Basic formula for Mirepoix –
used to flavor white stocks and
soups, tomato paste or puree
is often included for brown
stock, gravy, stew or soup.
2 parts onion
1 part celery
1 part carrot
3. Acid products - Acid helps dissolve connective tissues, and extract
flavor and body from bones.
4. Scraps and left-over -Scraps may be used in stocks if they are clear,
wholesome, and appropriate to the stock being made.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
245
5. Seasoning and spices
6. Bouquet garni – assortment of fresh herbs and aromatic
ingredients tied in a bundle with string so it can be removed easily from
the stock.
Guidelines for preparing stock
1. Follow the correct procedures for cooling and storing stock and
make sure that any stock you use is flavorful and wholesome.
2. Follow the cooking time for stock
The following are approximate cooking time for different stocks;
the time will vary according to numerous factors such as
ingredients quality, volume and cooking temperature.
White beef stock - 8 to 10 hours
White and brown Veal Game stock – 6 to 8 hours
White poultry and Game Bird Stocks – 3 to 4 hours
Fish Stock – 45 minutes to 1 hour
Vegetables Stock – 45 minutes to 1 hour, depending on the
specific ingredients and the size of vegetables cut
3. The stock ingredients are boiled starting with cold water. This
promotes the extraction of protein which may be sealed in by hot
water.
4. Stocks are simmered gently, with small bubbles at the bottom but
not breaking at the surface. If a stock is boiled, it will be cloudy.
5. Salt is not usually added to a stock, as this causes it to become too
salty, since most stocks are preserved to make soup and sauces.
6. Meat is added to the stock before the vegetables and the ―scum‖that
rises to the surface is skimmed off before further ingredients are
added
LM-Cookery Grade 10
246
Different Kinds of Spices and Seasoning
LM-Cookery Grade 10
247
LM-Cookery Grade 10
248
Activity 1. PREPARE STOCK (Group Activity)
Directions: Choose any of the given stocks and prepare following the given
procedure. Your performance and output will be rated using the given rubric.
White stock
Basic White stock
Tools and Equipment:
 Stove
 Stock pot
 Chopping board
 Knife
 Skimmer/Strainer
 Ladle
 Container
Ingredients:
4 -5 kg bones; chicken, veal or beef
1 L water, cold
Mirepoix
450 g onion, chopped
16 tbsp. carrot, chopped
16 tbsp. celery, chopped
LM-Cookery Grade 10
249
Bouquet Garni
1 pc dried bay leaf
¼ tsp Dried thyme
¼ tsp peppercorns
6-8 stems parsley
2 whole cloves
Procedure:
1. Cut the bones into pieces, 3 to 4 inches long for easy extraction.
2. Rinse in cold water to remove impurities that cloud the stock.
3. Place the bones in the stockpot and cover with cold water to speed
extraction.
4. Bring water to a boil and then, reduce to simmer. Skim the scum that
comes from the surface for a clear stock. Do not let the stock boil
because it makes the stock cloudy.
5. Keep the water level above the bones because bones cooked while
exposed to air will turn dark and darken the stock. Also, bones will not
release flavor into the water.
6. Add the mirepoix.
7. Simmer for recommended length of time:
8. Strain through several layers of cheesecloth.
9. Cool the stock as quickly as possible by:
 Setting the pot in a sink and allow cold water to flow under the pot
and around it.
 Stirring the pot occasionally so all the stock cools evenly.
10. When cooled, refrigerate the stock properly in covered containers for 2-3
days. If properly frozen, it will last for several months.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
250
Directions:
Ask your teacher to assess
your performance in the
following critical task and
performance criteria below
You will be rated based on the
evaluation on the right side.
OVERALL EVALUATION
Level
Achieved PERFORMANCE LEVELS
4 - Can perform the skill very
satisfactorily without supervision and
with initiative and adaptability to
problem situations.
3 - Can perform the skill satisfactorily
without assistance or supervision.
2 - Can perform the skill less
satisfactorily but requires some
assistance and/or supervision.
1 - Can perform parts of the skill
satisfactorily, and requires
considerable assistance and/or
supervision.
Teacher will initial level achieved.
PERFORMANCE STANDARDS
For acceptable achievement, all items should
receive an answer.
1 2 3 4
1. Cut the bones into pieces, 3 to 4 inches long.
2. Rinse in cold water to remove impurities that
cloud the stock.
3. Place the bones in the stockpot and cover with
cold water to speed extraction
4. Bring water to boil and then reduce to simmer.
Skim the scum.
5. Keep the water level above the bones
6. Add mirepoix
LM-Cookery Grade 10
251
7 Simmer for recommended length of time
8 Strain through several layers of cheesecloth
9. Cool the stock as quickly as possible
10. When cool, refrigerate the stock properly in
covered containers to keep for 2-3 days.
Basic Brown Stock
Tools and Equipment:
Stove
Stock pot
Chopping board
Knife
Skimmer/Strainer
Ladle
Container
Ingredients:
4 ½ kg. bones; chicken, veal or beef
10-12 qtr. water, cold
Mirepoix
450 g onion, chopped
16 tbsp. carrot, chopped
16 tbsp. celery, chopped
450 g tomato puree
LM-Cookery Grade 10
252
Bouquet Garni
1 pc dried bay leaf
¼ tsp Dried thyme
¼ tsp peppercorns
6-8 stems parsley
2 whole cloves
Procedure:
1. Cut the bones into pieces, 3-4 inches long. Use veal or beef bones.
2. Do not wash or blanch the bones. The moisture would hinder browning.
3. Place the bones in a roasting pan in one layer, and brown in a hot oven at
375°F (190°C. or higher. The bones must be well browned to color the
stock sufficiently. Bones may be oiled lightly before browning.
4. When the bones are well browned, remove from pan and place in a
stockpot. Cover with cold water and bring to simmer.
5. Drain and reserve the fat from the roasting pan. Deglaze the pan by
adding water and stirring over heat until all the brown drippings are
dissolved or loosened. Add to stockpot.
6. While the stock is getting started, place the mirepoix in the roasting pan
with some of the reserved fat and brown the vegetable well in the oven.
7. When the water in the stockpot comes to a simmer, skim the scum at the
surface.
8. Add the browned vegetable and tomato puree to the stockpot.
9. Put the bouquet garni by tying it to the handle of the pot for easy removal.
10. Continue to simmer for recommended length of time, 6-8 hours.
11. Strain through several layers of cheesecloth.
12.Cool the stock and refrigerate properly in a covered container to keep for
2-3 days. If properly frozen, it will last for several months.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
253
How Well Did You Perform?
Find out by accomplishing the Scoring Rubric honestly and sincerely.
Remember it is your learning at stake!
Directions:
Ask your teacher to assess
your performance in the
following critical task and
performance criteria below
You will be rated based on the
evaluation on the right side.
OVERALL EVALUATION
Level
Achieved PERFORMANCE LEVELS
4 - Can perform the skill satisfactorily
without supervision and with initiative
and adaptability to problem situations.
3 - Can perform the skill satisfactorily
without assistance or supervision.
2 - Can perform the skill satisfactorily
but requires some assistance and/or
supervision.
1 - Can perform parts of the skill
satisfactorily, but requires
considerable assistance and/or
supervision.
Teacher will initial level achieved.
PERFORMANCE STANDARDS
For acceptable achievement, all items should
receive an answer.
1 2 3 4
1. Cut the bones into pieces, 3 to 4 inches long.
2. Rinse in cold water to remove impurities that
cloud the stock.
3. Place the bones in the stockpot and cover with
cold water to speed extraction
4. Bring water to boil and then reduce to simmer.
Skim the scum.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
254
5. Keep the water level above the bones
6. Add mirepoix
7 Simmer for recommended length of time
8 Strain through several layers of cheesecloth
9. Cool the stock as quickly as possible
10. When cool, refrigerate the stock properly in
covered containers to keep for 2-3 days.
Review of Learning Outcome 1
Directions: Read the following questions carefully and choose the letter of the
correct answer. Write your answer in your test notebook.
1. What do you call the liquid in which meat, fish, and sometimes
vegetables have been cooked?
A. glaze C. stock
B. sauce D. water
2. Which of the following stocks uses veal bone as its main ingredient?
A. brown stock C. prawn stock
B. ham stock D. white stock
3. What kind of stock uses fish as its main ingredient?
A. brown stock C. glace viands
B. fish stock D. ham stock
4. What stock uses chicken bone as its main ingredient?
A. fish stock
B. ham stock
C. prawn stocks
D. chicken stocks
5. Which one is the easiest to prepare?
A. brown stock C. white stock
B. fish stock D. vegetable stock
LM-Cookery Grade 10
255
Learning Outcome 2 Prepare Soups Required for Menu Item
Soups
Soups are based on stocks added with other ingredients for variety of
flavor, consistency, appearance and aroma
A well-prepared soup always makes a memorable impression.
Soups offer a full array of flavoring ingredients and garnishing opportunities.
Soups also allow the use of trimmings and leftover creatively.
Classifications of Soups
1. Clear Soups
Clear Soups. They are soups based on a clear, unthickened broth or
stock. They may be served plain or garnished with a variety of vegetables
and meats. They are very similar to stocks, except that broths are based on
meats rather than bones so they are richer and have a more defined flavor.
Broths can be used as a liquid in preparing soups. A good quality broth
should be clear, aromatic and rich-tasting with a very evident flavor of the
major ingredient. One strong and clear broth or stock is a consommé. It is
made by combining lean chopped meat, egg whites, mirepoix, herbs and
spices and an acidic ingredient like tomatoes, wine, or lemon juice. The
combination is called ―clarification‖ since the particles that make the broth
appear cloudy are trapped as it cooks. A good quality consommé is crystal –
clear, has a good body, amber to brown in color, and completely fat-free.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
256
 Broth and bouillon simple clear soup without solid ingredients.
Broth and bouillon are similar to stock in technique and in
cooking time. The major distinction between broth and stock is that
broths can be served as is, whereas stocks are used in production of
other dishes.
 Vegetable soup – clear seasoned stock or broth with the addition of
one or more vegetable, meat, or poultry.
 Consommé‘ – rich, flavorful stock or broth that has been clarified to
make it perfectly clear and transparent.
2. Thick Soups
Thick Soups are soups that are thickened to provide a heavier
consistency. Thick soup is a cream soup based on béchamel sauce and is
finished with a heavy cream. A béchamel sauce is milk thickened with roux.
But some thick soups are veloute sauce-based, stock thickened with roux. A
veloute sauce base is usually finished with a liaison of heavy cream egg yolk.
A thick soup should have a velvety smooth texture and the thickness of heavy
cream. It is always essential to strain out the solids and at times to puree and
put back in the soup. Cream soups may be served hot or cold.
A kind of cream soup based on crustaceans like shrimps and lobsters
is bisque. It is made by simmering a crustacean in a stock or a fish fumet.
Another thick vegetable soup is the chowder made with broth, milk or
water as base, then thickened with roux. Cold, thick soups such as
vichyssoise are simply cream soups served cold. Others like gazpacho or a
chilled cantaloupe soup are based on a puree of cooked or raw ingredients
brought to the correct consistency by adding fruits or vegetable juice as a
liquid
LM-Cookery Grade 10
257
 Cream soups – are soups thickened with roux, beurremanie,
liaison or other thickening agents, plus milk, or cream.
 Purees – vegetable soup thickened with starch
 Bisques – are thickened soups made from shellfish.
 Chowders – are hearty soups made from fish, shellfish or
vegetables usually contain milk and potatoes.
 Veloutes – soup thickened with egg, butter and cream.
3. Other types of soup
a. Dessert soup
A. Ginataan – a Filipino soup made from coconut milk, milk, fruit,
and tapioca pearl served hot or cold.
B. Osheriku – a Japanese asuki bean soup
C.Tonge sui – a Chinese soup
b. Fruit Soup can be served hot or cold depending on the recipe
where dried fruits are used like raisins and prunes. Fruit soup may
include milk, sweet or savory dumplings, spices or alcoholic
beverages like brandy and champagne.
c. Cold soup is variations on the traditional soup wherein the
temperature when served is kept at or below temperature.
d. Asian soup is a traditional soup which is typical broth, clear
soup, or starch thickened soup.
Other thickening agents for soup
1. rice
2. flour
3. grain
4. corn starch
LM-Cookery Grade 10
258
Ingredients of soup
• Meat (chicken, beef, pork, lamb, fish)
• Salt
• Pepper
• Vegetables (carrots, string beans, turnips, tomatoes, mushrooms,
celery, leak)
• Onion
• Garlic
• Water
• Eggs
• Cornstarch
• Seasoning (MSG, convenience products)
• Butter
• Cream
• Garnishes (slices of lemon, egg, shredded vegetables,
pimiento strips)
Basic Principles of Preparing Soup
1stPrinciple. Starting with Cold Water
Why cold water? Most protein, vitamins and minerals dissolve in cold
water. Part of the flavor comes from these components. Using hot water
would lessen the flavor and nutritive content of stock
2ndPrinciple. Cutting vegetable to appropriate size for the type of stock.
The size of cut helps the maximum flavor to be extracted.
Example 1: A fish stock only simmer for a half hour (30 minutes) so the cut
should be julienne (thin strips: ¼ inch thick 2-3 inches long)
Example 2: A brown stock simmers for 4-6 hours and sometimes 24 hours, so
the cut should be 1‖ cubed so that stock will have time to extract the flavor
and will not fall apart after a long cooking.
3rd Principle. Select your protein based. Beef, Chicken, Pork and Fish
All bones are washed, roasted or blanched. Roasted for brown sauce
and blanched for white stock.
4th Principle. Simmering
Gentle extractions aid in flavor and nutrition. Boiling causes cloudiness
through agitation of the ingredients.
5th Principle. Skimming
Keep the stock clear. The scum on top of stocks contains impurities.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
259
Cooking soups
Meats, Poultry and Fish
 Cuts of meat that are less tender should be added early in the cooking
process
 Poultry needs to be added early enough so that it cooks thoroughly
 Add fish closed to the end of the cooking process to keep it from
overcooking.
Grains and Pasta
 Allow a little more time in cooking.
Beans and Legumes
 Soaked beans, lentils and black-eyed peas should be added with the
liquid so they will fully cook
Dense or Starchy Vegetables
 A small-diced cut of potatoes, carrots, and winter squashes will require
30–45 minutes to cook.
Green Vegetables:
 These vegetables should be added during the final 15–20 minutes of
cooking the soup
Adjusting Consistency
Thick soups may continue to thicken during cooking and may need
additional stock or water added to adjust the consistency
Degreasing
Broth-based soups maybe prepared in advance, cooled and refrigerated.
This facilitates removing of congealed fat from the surface. Skim the top
layer of fat from a hot soup with a ladle, alternately.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
260
Perform the Suggested Soup Recipes
Directions: Find a partner and perform the given soup recipe.
CREAM OF POTATO SOUP
TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT
INGRIDIENTS
QUANTITY DESCRIPTION
casserole ½ cup chopped bacon
gas or electric stove ¾ kg potatoes
knife 3 cups water
chopping board 2 bulbs onions, chopped
strainer 1 whole chicken bouillon cube
saucepot 2 cups hot water
measuring cup ¼ cups butter
measuring spoon ¼ tsp. pepper
wooden spoon 2tbsp. Gold Medal all-purpose flour
soup ladle ½ tsp. salt
1½ c all-purpose cream
PROCEDURE:
1. Cook bacon until crispy. Cool. Set aside, peel potatoes and cut into
cubes, place in a saucepot and add water and chopped onions. Bring
to a boil and cook until potatoes are tender. Remove potatoes and
sear the broth.
2. Add chicken bouillon cube to the reserved potato broth to make potato
chicken broth and stir until dissolved. Add the hot water. Place
cooked potatoes in blender in 2 batches, adding ¾ cup of the potato-
chicken broth with each batch. Cover and blend for 1 minute or until
smooth. Set aside.
3. Melt butter in a saucepan. Add flour, salt and pepper. Add all-purpose
cream at once. Stir while cooking until slightly thickened and bubbly.
Cook for 1 minute more. Stir until heated through. If necessary, stir in
LM-Cookery Grade 10
261
additional milk to make the desired consistency. Serve with sprinkled
bacon bits.
Find out how well you performed by accomplishing the Scoring Rubric honestly and
sincerely. Remember it is your learning at stake!
Direction: Evaluate your finished product, using the given score sheet.
Criteria for Evaluating and Presenting Soup
I. Products:
Good
(3)
Fair
(2)
Poor
(1)
1. General Appearance
a. attractive and appealing to appetite
b. pleasing and good color combination
c. ingredients cooked just right
d. correct consistency
2. Palatability
a. delicious
b. taste just right
3. Nutritive value
a. highly nutritious
II. Procedures:
1. Use of Resources:
a. kept working table is kept orderly while preparing
the ingredients
b. used only the proper and needed utensils and
dishes
c. used time-saving techniques and devices
2. Cleanliness and sanitation
a. was well- groomed and properly dressed for
cooking, used clean apron, hair nets, hand towel
and pot holder
b. Observed sanitary handling of food
3. Conservation of nutrients
a. followed proper preparation and cooking
procedures
b. followed the recipe correctly
Score: (maximum 42 points)
Comments:
LM-Cookery Grade 10
262
Show that you learned something by doing this activity
CONSOMME A LA MADRILENE
TOOLS AND
EQUIPMENT
INGRIDIENTS
QUANTITY DESCRIPTION
casserole 1kg. Lean beef, cut in 3 portion
gas or electric stove ½ kg bone marrow
knife 3 ½ liter cold water
chopping board 3 large carrots, cut up
measuring cup 2 cloves onion, stuck with 3 cloves
measuring spoon 2 stalks celery w/leaves.
wooden spoon 3 leeks, sliced lengthwise and
soup ladle 1½ tbsp. wash salt
6 peppercorns
2 spring parsley
pinch basil
1 clove clove garlic
1pc bay leaf
3 large egg whites, beaten
3 crushed eggshells
2 cup tomato puree
2tbsp finely chopped onions
½ tsp dried basil
LM-Cookery Grade 10
263
PROCEDURE:
1. Combine the beef, bone and water in a stockpot and bring to a boil.
Simmer for 5 minutes and skim. Cover and simmer for 1 hour.
2. Add to the onion stock with cloves, the carrots, celery, leeks, salt
peppercorns, parsley, thyme, garlic and bay leaf. Cover and cook
slowly for 4 – 5 hours.
3. Strain through a double thickness of cheesecloth and skim off fat. Use
absorbent paper towels. Remove the remaining particles and reserve
the meat for another purpose.
4. To clarify the consommé, return it to the heat and add beaten egg
whites and eggshells.
5. Bring to a rolling boil and strain once more through 3 thickness
cheesecloth.
6. Pour 6 cups of consommé into a saucepan and reserve the remainder
for another use.
7. Add the tomato puree, onion, and dried basil. Simmer for 20 minutes,
remove from the heat and strain through cheesecloth.
8. Serve hot.
Find out how well you performed by accomplishing the Scoring Rubric
honestly and sincerely. Remember it is your learning at stake!
Direction: Evaluate your finished product, using the given score sheet.
Criteria for Evaluating and Presenting Soup
I. Products:
Good
(3)
Fair
(2)
Poor
(1)
1. General Appearance
a. attractive and appealing to appetite
b. pleasing and good color combination
c. ingredients cooked just right
d. correct consistency
2. Palatability
a. delicious
b. taste just right
3. Nutritive value
a. highly nutritious
II. Procedures:
1. Use of Resources:
LM-Cookery Grade 10
264
a. kept working table is kept orderly while
preparing the ingredients
b. used only the proper and needed utensils and
dishes
c. used time-saving techniques and devices
2. Cleanliness and sanitation
a. was well- groomed and properly dressed for
cooking, used clean apron, hair nets, hand
towel and
pot holder
b. Observed sanitary handling of food
3. Conservation of nutrients
a. followed proper preparation and cooking
procedures
b. followed the recipe correctly
Score: (maximum 42 points)
Comments:
EGG DROP SOUP
TOOLS AND
EQUIPMENT
INGRIDIENTS
QUANTITY DESCRIPTION
casserole 6 ½ cups prepared basic chicken stock
stockpot with cover 2 tbsp. light soy sauce
gas or electric stove 2 tbsp. sherry
knife ¼ tsp. white pepper
chopping board 2 large egg whites
mortar and pestle 1 tbsp. salt
strainer 2 tbsp. sesame oil
measuring cup 1/8 tsp cornstarch
measuring spoon 2 large eggs
wooden spoon 1 tbsp. scallions , thinly sliced
soup ladle
LM-Cookery Grade 10
265
PROCEDURE:
1. In a 2-quart soup pot, pour 6 cups of chicken broth to a simmer. Add
the soy sauce, sherry, pepper, and salt.
2. Beat the egg whites lightly. Drizzle into the chicken broth mixture
3. Mix the cornstarch with the remaining ½ cup chicken stock until lump
free. Add to the soup. Stir in the sesame oil, garnish with scallions
and serve hot.
Evaluate your finished product, using the given score sheet.
Criteria for Evaluating and Presenting Soup
I. Products:
Good
(3)
Fair
(2)
Poor
(1)
1. General Appearance
a. attractive and appealing to appetite
b. pleasing and good color combination
c. ingredients cooked just right
d. correct consistency
2. Palatability
a. delicious
b. taste just right
3. Nutritive value
a. highly nutritious
II. Procedures:
1. Use of Resources:
a. kept working table is kept orderly while
preparing the ingredients
b. used only the proper and needed utensils
and dishes
c. used time-saving techniques and devices
2. Cleanliness and sanitation
a. was well- groomed and properly dressed for
cooking, used clean apron, hair nets, hand towel
and
pot holder
b. Observed sanitary handling of food
3. Conservation of nutrients
a. followed proper preparation and cooking
procedures
b. followed the recipe correctly
Score: (maximum 42 points)
LM-Cookery Grade 10
266
CREAMY CARROT SOUP
TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT
INGRIDIENTS
QUANTITY DESCRIPTION
casserole 22 grams butter
stockpot with cover 1 medium onion, chopped
gas or electric stove 3 strips bacon, chopped
knife 600 grams carrots, cubed
chopping board 1 pc small chicken cube
measuring cup ½ cup cream
measuring spoon dash salt/ pepper
wooden spoon
soup ladle
PROCEDURE:
1. Melt butter in a large saucepan, add onion and bacon, stir constantly
over heat until onion is soft.
2. Add carrots to pan, then chicken stock and cube, bring to a boil,
reduce heat, cover, simmer for about 30 minutes or until carrots are
tender. Remove saucepan from heat.
3. Blend or process mixture in several batches until smooth.
4. Return mixture to pan, stir in cream, reheat, and stir constantly without
boiling.
5. Season with salt and pepper. Serve hot
LM-Cookery Grade 10
267
Directions: Evaluate your finished product, using the given score sheet.
Criteria for Evaluating and Presenting Soup
I. Products:
Good
(3)
Fair
(2)
Poor
(1)
1. General Appearance
a. attractive and appealing to appetite
b. pleasing and good color combination
c. ingredients cooked just right
d. correct consistency
2. Palatability
a. delicious
b. taste just right
3. Nutritive value
a. highly nutritious
II. Procedures:
1. Use of Resources:
a. kept working table is kept orderly while
preparing the ingredients
b. used only the proper and needed utensils
and dishes
c. used time-saving techniques and devices
2. Cleanliness and sanitation
a. was well- groomed and properly dressed for
cooking, used clean apron, hair nets, hand
towel and
pot holder
b. Observed sanitary handling of food
3. Conservation of nutrients
a. followed proper preparation and cooking
procedures
b. followed the recipe correctly
Score: (maximum 42 points)
Comments:
LM-Cookery Grade 10
268
CHICKEN AND CORN CHOWDER
TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT
INGRIDIENTS
QUANTITY DESCRIPTION
saucepan
saucepot 200 grams butter
gas or electric stove 1 tsp. salt
knife 1 pc carrot, strips
chopping board 1 pc onion, sliced
mortar and pestle 6 cup water
strainer 6 strips bacon strips
measuring cup ½ cup chopped onion
measuring spoon ½ cup cubed celery
wooden spoon ½ cup cube carrot
soup ladle 7 cup chicken stock
½ cup gold medal all-purpose flour
1 can small corn kernels
PROCEDURE:
1. In a saucepan, put chicken breast, salt, carrot, onion, and water. Bring
to a boil. Cook for 20 minutes.
2. Strain out chicken stock. Set aside. Remove chicken breast. Slice
meat into cubes. Set aside.
3. In a saucepan, put bacon strips. Cook until brown. Set aside.
4. Retain about 2 tablespoons of the bacon drippings.
5. In a saucepan, using the bacon drippings, sauté onions until soft. Add
chicken meat. Mix well. Add flour. Stir well.
6. Add the chicken mixture. Let it simmer. Stir until thick.
To serve: Put soup in a bowl, top with chopped bacon. Serve while hot.
It may be served with barley-garlic, bread, and bacon at the side.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
269
Evaluate your finished product, using the given score sheet.
Criteria for Evaluating and PresentingSoup
I. Products:
Good
(3)
Fair
(2)
Poor
(1)
1. General Appearance
a. attractive and appealing to appetite
b. pleasing and good color combination
c. ingredients cooked just right
d. correct consistency
2. Palatability
a. delicious
b. taste just right
3. Nutritive value
a. highly nutritious
II. Procedures:
1. Use of Resources:
a. kept working table is kept orderly while
preparing the ingredients
b. used only the proper and needed utensils
and dishes
c. used time-saving techniques and devices
2. Cleanliness and sanitation
a. was well- groomed and properly dressed for
cooking, used clean apron, hair nets, hand
towel and pot holder
b. Observed sanitary handling of food
3. Conservation of nutrients
a. followed proper preparation and cooking
procedures
b. followed the recipe correctly
Score: (maximum 42 points)
Comments:
LM-Cookery Grade 10
270
Review of Learning Outcome 2
Directions: Read the question carefully and choose the letter of the correct
answer. Write your answer in your test booklet.
1. Which of the following is a clear soup?
A. bisque C. cream
B. bouillon D. puree
2. What substance is added that gives taste to the food?
A. decoration C. seasoning
B. flavoring D. thickening
3. What type of soup can be served either hot or cold?
A. ancient soup C. dessert soup
B. cold soup D. fruit soup
4. What utensil is appropriate in serving hot soup?
A. bowl C. soup bowl
B. basin D. tray
5. What makes a soup appetizing?
A. garnish C. taste
B. ingredients D. all of the above
Photo Gallery
Directions:
 Make a photo album of different soups creatively served here and
abroad.
 It should contain minimum of 10 pages and maximum of 15 pages
 Label each creative presentation
LM-Cookery Grade 10
271
Learning Outcome 3 Prepare Sauces Required for Menu Item
Sauces
One of the important components of a dish is the sauce. Saucesserve
a particular function in the composition of a dish. These enhance the taste of
the food to be served as well as add moisture or succulence to food that are
cooked dry. Sauces also enhance the appearance of a dish by adding luster
and sheen. A sauce that includes a flavor complementary to a food brings
out the flavor of that food. It defines and enriches the overall taste and its
texture. Sauce is a fluid dressing for poultry, meat, fish, dessert and other
culinary products.
Sauce is a flavorful liquid, usually thickened that is used to season,
flavor and enhance other foods. It adds:
1. Moistness 4. Appearance (color and shine)
2. Flavor 5. Appeal
3. Richness
Basic Sauces for Meat, Vegetables, and Fish
1. White sauce - Its basic ingredient is milk which is thickened with flour
enriched with butter.
2. Veloute sauce- Its chief ingredients are veal, chicken and fish broth,
thickened with blonde roux.
3. Hollandaise – It is a rich emulsified sauce made from butter, egg yolks,
lemon juice and cayenne.
Emulsion – (as fat in milk) consists of liquid dispersed with or without
an emulsifier in another liquid that usually would not mix together.
4. Brown sauce / Espagnole – It is a brown roux-based sauce made with
margarine or butter, flavor and brown stock.
5. Tomato – It is made from stock (ham/pork) and tomato products
seasoned with spices and herbs.
A. Variation of Sauces
1. Hot Sauces – made just before they are to be used.
2. Cold sauces – cooked ahead of time, then cooled, covered, and
placed in the refrigerator to chill.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
272
B. Thickening Agents
Thickening agent – thickens sauce to the right consistency. The
sauce must be thick enough to cling lightly to the food.
Starches are the most commonly used thickeners for sauce
making. Flour is the principal starch used. Other products include
cornstarch, arrowroot, waxy maize, pre-gelatinized starch, bread crumbs,
and other vegetables and grain products like potato starch and rice flour.
Starches thicken by gelatinization, which is the process by which
starch granules absorb water and swell many times their original sizes.
Starch granules must be separated before heating in liquid to avoid
lumping. Lumping occurs because the starch on the outside of the lump
quickly gelatinizes into a coating that prevents the liquid from reaching the
starch inside.
Starch granules are separated in two ways:
 Mixing the starch with fat. Example: roux
 Mixing the starch with a cold liquid. Example: slurry
Roux – is a cooked mixture of equal parts by weight of fat and flour.
1. Fat
A. Clarified butter. Using clarified
butter results to finest sauces
because of its flavor.
B. Margarine. Used as a substitute for
butter because of its lower cost.
C. Animal fat. Chicken fat, beef
drippings and lard.
D. Vegetable oil and shortening. Can
be used for roux, but it adds no
flavor.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
273
2. Flour
The thickening power of flour depends on its starch
content. Bread flour is commonly used in
commercial cooking. It is sometimes browned for
use in brown roux. Heavily browned flour has only
1/3 the thickening power of not brown flour.
A roux must be cooked so that the sauce does not have a raw,
starchy taste of flour. The kinds of roux differ on how much they are
cooked.
 White roux – cooked just enough to cook the raw taste of
flour; used for béchamel and other white sauces based
on milk.
 Blond roux – cooked little longer to a slightly darker color;
used for veloutes´.
 Brown roux – cooked to a light brown color and a nutty
aroma. Flour may be browned before adding to the fat.
It contributes flavor and color to brown sauces.
C. Common Problems in Sauce
1. Discarding 3. poor texture 5. oil streaking
2. oiling-off 4. synersis (weeping)
LM-Cookery Grade 10
274
METHODS OF PREPARING SAUCES
Sauces Blanches
(White Sauce)
Purpose Butter Flour Liquid: Milk or Stock or Cream
Light Sauce 1 tbsp. 1 tbsp. 1 cup
General Sauce 1½ tbsps. 1 ½ tbsp. 1 cup
Thick Sauce 5 tsps. 2 tbsps. 1 cup
Soufflé Sauce 2 tbsps. 2 tbsps. 1 cup
Hygienic Principles and Practices in Sauce Making
1. Make sure all equipment is perfectly clean.
2. Hold sauce no longer than 1 ½ hours. Make only enough to serve in
this time, and discard any that is left over.
3. Never mix an old batch of sauce with a new batch.
4. Never hold hollandaise or béarnaise or any other acid product in
aluminum. Use stainless-steel containers.
Making Roux
Procedure
1. Melt fat.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
275
2. Add correct amount of flour, and stir until fat and
flour is thoroughly mixed.
3. Cook to the desired degree of white,
blond or brown roux.
Basic Finishing Techniques in Sauce Making
1. Reduction
 Using reduction to concentrate basic flavors.
The water evaporates when simmered. The sauce becomes more
concentrated and more flavorful.
 Using reduction to adjust textures
The sauce may be simmered until it reaches the desired thickness.
Stock or other liquid may be added to thickened sauce to thin it out, then
simmer to reduce to the right consistency.
 Using reduction to add new flavors.
Glazes or reduced stocks are added to sauces to give flavor.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
276
2. Straining
This is very important in order to produce a
smooth, lump free sauce. Straining through a china
cap lined with several layers of cheesecloth is
effective.
3. Deglazing
To deglaze means to swirl a liquid
in a sauté pan to cooked particles of food
remaining on the bottom.
Liquid such as wine or stock is used
to deglaze then reduced by one-half or
three-fourths. This reduction, with the
added flavor of the pan drippings, is then
added to the sauce.
4. Enriching with butter and
cream
 Liaison mixture of egg yolks and cream added to sauce to give extra
richness and smoothness.
 Heavy cream- added to give flavor and richness to sauce
 Butter - Add softened butter to hot sauce and swirl until it melts. Serve
immediately to prevent separation of butter.
Butter gives extra shine and smoothness to the sauce.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
277
5. Seasoning – adds and develop flavor
Ex: salt
lemon juice
cayenne
white pepper
sherry and Madeira
Perform the following activity:
MAKING PAN GRAVY
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Roasting pan
Saucepan
Strainer
Ladle
Procedure:
Method 1
1. Remove the roast from the roasting pan.
2. Clarify the fat.
3. Deglaze the pan.
4. Combine with stock and simmer.
5. Make a roux or a slurry of arrowroot or cornstarch and water.
6. Thicken the gravy with the roux or cornstarch slurry.
7. Strain.
8. Adjust seasoning.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
278
Method 2
1. Remove the roast from the roasting pan.
2. Clarify the fat.
3. Add flour to the roasting pan and make a roux.
4. Add stock. Stir until thickened and the pan is deglaze.
5. Strain. Skim excess fat.
6. Adjust consistency, if necessary, with more stock or more roux.
7. Season.
Directions: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet.
I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1)
1. General Appearance
a. Color combination is attractive and
appealing
b. ingredients cooked just right
c. correct consistency not mushy/ very
thick/thin consistency
2. Palatability
a. delicious
b. tastes just right
3.Nutritive Value
a. highly nutritious
II. Procedure:
1. Use of Resources:
a. kept working table orderly while
preparing the ingredients
b. used only the proper and needed
utensils and dishes
c. used time-saving techniques and
devices
2. Cleanliness and Sanitation
a. observed well-groomed and
properly dressed for cooking, use
clean apron, hair nets, hand towel
and pot holders
b. observed sanitary handling of food
LM-Cookery Grade 10
279
3. Conservation of Nutrients
a. followed proper preparation and
cooking procedures
SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.)
COMMENTS:
BÉCHAMEL SAUCE
Purpose: Prepare and cook béchamel sauce using ingredients and
procedures listed below:
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Saucepan
Ladle
Cheesecloth
Spoon
Ingredients:
4 tbsp. clarified butter
4 tbsp. bread flour
¼ gal milk
¼ pc bay leaf
¼ pc onions
Salt to taste
Nutmeg to taste
White pepper to taste
LM-Cookery Grade 10
280
Procedure:
1. Heat the butter in a heavy sauce pan in a very low heat. Add the flour
and make a white roux. Cool the roux slightly.
2. In another sauce pan, scald the milk. Gradually add it to the roux,
beating constantly.
3. Bring the sauce to a boil, stirring constantly. Reduce heat to simmer.
4. Stick the bay leaf and onions and add to the sauce. Simmer at least
15 - 30 minutes or more. Stir occasionally while cooking.
5. Adjust the consistency with more hot milk if necessary.
6. Season lightly with salt, nutmeg and white pepper. Spice flavor should
not dominate.
.
Directions: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet.
I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1)
1. General Appearance
a. Color combination is attractive and
appealing
b. ingredients cooked just right
c. correct consistency not mushy/ very
thick/thin consistency
2. Palatability
a. delicious
b. tastes just right
3.Nutritive Value
a. highly nutritious
II. Procedure:
4. Use of Resources:
a. kept working table orderly while
preparing the ingredients
b. used only the proper and needed
utensils and dishes
c. used time-saving techniques and
devices
5. Cleanliness and Sanitation
a. observed well-groomed and
LM-Cookery Grade 10
281
properly dressed for cooking, use
clean apron, hair nets, hand towel
and pot holders
b. observed sanitary handling of food
6. Conservation of Nutrients
a. followed proper preparation and
cooking procedures
SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.)
COMMENTS:
HOLLANDAISE SAUCE
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Saucepan
Beater
Ladle
Spoon
Strainer
Mixing bowl
Ingredients:
1 kg. butter
12pcs egg yolks
4 tbsp. cold water
6tbsp . lemon juice
Salt to taste
Cayenne to taste
LM-Cookery Grade 10
282
Procedure:
1. Clarify the butter. Keep the butter warm but not hot.
2. Place the egg yolks and cold water in a stainless steel bowl and beat
well. Beat in a few drops of lemon juice.
3. Hold the bowl over a hot water bath and continue to beat until the yolks
are thickened and creamy.
4. Remove the bowl from the heat. Using a ladle, slowly and gradually
beat in the warm butter. Add the butter drop by drop at first. If the
sauce becomes too thick to beat before all the butter is added, beat in
a little of the lemon juice.
5. When all the butter has been added, beat in lemon juice to taste and
adjust seasoning with salt and cayenne. Keep warm for service. Hold
no longer than 1 ½ hours.
Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet.
I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1)
1. General Appearance
a. Color combination is attractive and
appealing
b. ingredients cooked just right
c. correct consistency not mushy/ very
thick/thin consistency
2. Palatability
a. delicious
b. tastes just right
3.Nutritive Value
a. highly nutritious
II. Procedure:
1. Use of Resources:
a. kept working table orderly while
preparing the ingredients
b. used only the proper and needed
utensils and dishes
c. used time-saving techniques and
LM-Cookery Grade 10
283
devices
2. Cleanliness and Sanitation
a. observed well-groomed and
properly dressed for cooking, use
clean apron, hair nets, hand towel
and pot holders
b. observed sanitary handling of food
3. Conservation of Nutrients
a. followed proper preparation and
cooking procedures
SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.)
COMMENTS:
Review of Learning Outcome 3
Directions: Choose the correct answer from the given choices. Write the
letter of your answer in your test notebook.
1. A roux-based sauce made with margarine or butter, flavor, and brown
stock.
A.brown sauce
B. butter sauce
C. Hollandaise sauce
D. Tomato sauce
2. Sauce made from melted butter or margarine to which seasonings are
added.
A. brown sauce
B. Butter sauce
C. Hollandaise sauce
D. Tomato sauce
3. Sauce made by forming an emulsion with fat such as margarine, butter
or salad oil and egg.
A. Brown sauced
B. Butter sauce
C. Hollandaise or a Dutch
D. Tomato sauce
LM-Cookery Grade 10
284
4. Sauce made with tomatoes and seasoned with spices and herbs.
A. Brown sauce
B. Butter sauce
C. Hollandaise sauce
D. Tomato sauce
5. Sauce made from a blend of salad oil, vinegar and seasoning.
A. Brown sauce
B. Butter sauce
C. Tomato sauce
D..White sauce
Research Hour
Directions: Make a research on at least ten sauces and the food where it is
commonly used in the Philippines, and ten from different countries. Include
pictures and descriptions.
Learning Outcome 4 Store and Reconstitute Stocks, Sauces and Soups
Storage of Stocks/Sauces and Soups
Stock is a clear, flavored liquid that freezes well. Chilled stock can be
frozen in 1 gallon amounts to be used for sauces. However, once a stock has
been used to make a sauce, the sauce itself should not be frozen. Sauces do
not freeze well and should be made in amounts needed on the day of
production.
The stock should never be put in the refrigerator while it is hot. The
large volume of hot liquid can raise the internal temperature of the refrigerator
to the point that the stock will cool sufficiently within two hours and may warm
everything else in the refrigerator. A good way to cool the stock is to place the
hot stock pot in a sink full of cold water and ice cubes until it is lukewarm but it
should not exceed one hour. After leaving it uncovered for the first half hour
and stirring occasionally to cool, it should be covered with an upside down
plate to prevent evaporation which would cause the stock to become too
LM-Cookery Grade 10
285
concentrated. Refrigerated stock cools better in shallow pans. If covered,
stock lasts up to five days but it is best if used in two days.
Storage of Starch and Sauces
Sauces and starches should be kept in airtight container and stored in a
cool dry place away from the moisture, oxygen, lights, and pests. Food made
with starches contains egg, milk, cream of other dairy products all of which
make them prone to bacterial contamination and to food-borne illnesses.
Sauces made with these ingredients should be kept out of the temperature
danger zone. Thickened sauce should also be prepared, served, and stored
with caution. These products should be stored in the refrigerator and never
left to stay for long at room temperature.
Storing Equipment
1. Glass/Plastic Container
2. Stock pot
3. Refrigerator
Ways to Reconstitute Stocks
1. Skim the surface and strain off the stock through a china cup lined
with several layers of cheesecloth.
2. Cool the stock as quickly as possible as follows:
 Set the pot in a sink with blocks, rack or some other object
under it. This is called venting. This allows cold water to flow
under the pot or around it.
 Run cold water into the sink, but not higher than the level of the
stock.
 Stir the pot occasionally so the stocks cool evenly
Cooling stock quickly and properly is important. Improperly
cooled stock may spoil in 6 to 8 hrs.
3. When cool, refrigerate the stock in covered containers. Stock will keep
2 to 3 days if properly refrigerated. Stock can also be frozen and will
last for several months.
Ways to Reconstitute Stocks, Sauce and Soup
1. by adding water
2. By using other liquid like evaporating milk, coconut milk, and fruit juices
LM-Cookery Grade 10
286
Photo Grid
Make an album (collage or scrapbook) of different stocks, sauces, and soups.
Includes description, ingredients, and procedures, storing procedures and
how it isreconstituted. Your output will be evaluated using rubrics.
Congratulations! You did a great job!
Rest and relax a while then move on to the next lesson. Good
luck!
LM-Cookery Grade 10
287
Overview
This lesson deals with the selection, preparation, cooking, presentation, and
storage of poultry and game in a commercial kitchen or catering operation.
At the end of lesson you are expected to do the following:
1. perform mise‘ en place;
2. cook poultry and game dishes;
3. plates/present and evaluate poultry and game bird dishes; and
4. store poultry and game bird
Learning Outcome 1 Perform Mise’en Place
Selecting and Purchasing Poultry and Game
Poultry consumption in the Philippines has increased remarkably in the
last decade. This is evident in the popularity of chicken dishes in restaurants
all over the country.
Poultry refers to several kinds of fowl that are used as food and the
term includes chicken, turkey, duck, pigeon, and quail. These are usually
domesticated raised mainly for meat and/or eggs. Birds such as smites that
are hunted for food are games.
Classification of Poultry and Games
Bird Uses
Chicken
Duck
Turkey
Goose
Quail
Pigeon
Meat, eggs
Meat, eggs feathers
Meat
Meat, feather, eggs
Meat, eggs
Meat
LESSON 2 PREPARE POULTRY AND GAME DISHES
LM-Cookery Grade 10
288
Guinea fowl
Wild duck
Pheasant
Meat
Meat, feather
Meat
Chickens and other poultry may be divided into classes which are
essentially of the same physical characteristics associated with age, sex, live
weight and/or breed.
1. Broiler or Fryer. A broiler or fryer is young chicken, usually 9 to 12
weeks of age, of either sex, is tender-meat with soft, pliable, smooth-
textured skin.
2. Roaster. A roaster is usually 5 to 6 months of age.
3. Capon. A capon is a surgically desexed male chicken usually under 8
months of age.
4. Stag. A stag is a male chicken, usually under 10 months of age, with
coarse skin, with somewhat toughened and darkened flesh.
5. Hen or Stewing Chicken. It is a mature female chicken which is
usually more than 10 months of age. It can also be a culled layer.
6. Cock or Rooster. It is a mature male chicken with coarse skin,
toughened and darkened meat and hardened breastbone tip.
7. Jumbo Broiler. This is a large chicken about 4 kg. dressed weight
which are on sale especially during the Christmas holiday.
Other Poultry
1. Peking duck. This is a breed of duck that originated from China and is
noted for its tender and flavorful meat.
2. Duck or Itik is available and popular in many towns of Rizal as fried itik.
3. Squab. This is a young immature pigeon of either sex and has extra
tender meat.
Selecting Good Quality Poultry and Game
1. Live Poultry
a. It has clear eyes.
b. A young chicken has fine and soft feet. If it is old, the feet are
thick and scaly.
c. The bone at the tip of the breast is soft in younger chicken and
thick in older one.
d. Small feathers indicate that the chicken is young.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
289
2. Whole Poultry. These are slaughtered birds that have been bled and
de-feathered.
a. Their head, feet and viscera are still intact.
b. They are clean, well fleshed.
c. They have moderate fat coverings.
d. They are free from pin feathers and show no cuts, scars or
missing skin.
3. Dressed Poultry. These are slaughtered birds that have been bled, de-
feathered, and the visceral organs are removed.
a. The skin is smooth and yellow in color
b. The breast is plump
c. The thighs are well-developed
d. It has no objectionable odor
e. It is heavy and the skin is not watery
4. Ready-to-Cook. The dressed birds may be cut up and marinated or
seasoned.
5. Poultry Parts. Several pieces of a single poultry part are usually
packed in one carton, wrapped and chilled or frozen. The various
poultry parts are divided into any of the following:
a. dark meat – drumsticks, thighs, wings, neck, backs, and rib
cage
b. white meat – breasts
c. giblets – gizzard and heart
Nutritional Value/Components of Poultry and Game
Like meat, poultry contains high quality proteins. Chicken, the most
consumed among the fowls, has 22.6% protein, 76.3% water and traces of
fat, vitamins and minerals.
Poultry meat consists of dark and white muscles. Dark muscles are
those found in parts of fowl‘s body which are always used. These are the
legs, thigh, wings, neck and rib cage. These are richer in fat, have more
connective tissues, and have higher riboflavin and myoglobin content. Most
people prefer the dark meat than white meat (from the breast) because of its
juiciness and flavor. Variety meats refer to the meat of such organs as the
gizzard, heart, kidneys and liver.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
290
Preparation of poultry for cooking
 Slaughter and bleeding
 Scaldding
 Defeathering
 Evisceration
 Deboning
Market forms of poultry
Live poultry
Live poultry should be healthy, alert, and well-feathered. Avoid
poultry which have bruises, blisters and broken bones.
Whole poultry
Though not alive, the criteria for selecting live poultry also apply
to whole poultry.
Dressed poultry
This is the most available poultry form in the market. Dressed
poultry are actually slaughtered poultry with the head, feet, blood,
feathers and internal organs removed. Good quality dressed poultry
should be free from slime, off-odors and discoloration.
Drawn poultry
These are dressed poultry that have been chilled or frozen.
They are usually available in groceries.
Ready-to cook
These are poultry parts such as wings, breast, thighs, or
drumsticks which have been separately packed in a single container
and frozen or chilled.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
291
Different Cuts of Poultry
Whole Chicken
Whole Chickens are marketed either fresh or frozen.
Halves
The bird is split from front to back through the
backbone and keel to produce 2 halves of
approximately equal weight.
Breast Quarters
Halves may be further cut into which include the
wing. A breast quarter, including portions of the back,
is all white meat.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
292
Split Breast
A breast quarter with the wing removed.
Split Breast without Back
A breast quarter with wing and back portion removed.
Boneless, Skinless Breast
Split breast that has been skinned and deboned.
8-Piece Cut
The whole bird is cut into 2 breast halves with ribs
and back portion, 2 wings, 2 thighs with back portion
and 2 drumsticks. The parts may be packaged
together and labelled as whole cut-up chicken. These
are usually sold without giblets.
Whole Chicken Wing
The whole chicken wing is an all-white meat portion
composed of three sections; the drumette, mid-
section, and tip.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
293
Wing Drummettes
The first section between the shoulder and the elbow.
Wing Mid-Section with Tip
The flat center section and the flipper (wing tip).
Wing Mid-Section
The section between the elbow and the tip,
sometimes called the wing flat or mid-joint.
Whole Chicken Leg Whole Chicken Leg
The whole chicken leg is the drumstick-thigh
combination. The whole leg differs from the leg
quarter and does not contain a portion of the back.
Boneless, Skinless Leg
Whole chicken leg with skin and bone removed.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
294
Thigh
The thigh is the portion of the leg above the knee
joint.
Boneless, Skinless Thigh
Thigh with skin and bone removed.
Drumsticks
Drumsticks include the lower portion of the leg
quarter (the portion between the knee joint and the
hock).
Giblets
Includes heart, liver, and neck.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
295
Directions: Read each of the following questions carefully and choose the
letter of the correct answer. Write your answer in your test notebook
1. What do you call the birds that are hunted for food?
A. game C. poultry
B. livestock D. swine
2. What do you call a desexed male chicken usually under 8 months old?
A. broiler C. hen
B. capon D. rooster
3. Which of the following poultry originated from China and is noted for its
tender and flavorful meat?
A. chicken C. itik
B. goose D. pecking duck
4. What do you call the young immature pigeon of either sex with extra tender
meat?
A. duck C. rooster
B. fryer D. squab
5. Which of the following classes of poultry is on sale especially during the
Christmas Holiday?
A. broiler C. jumbo broiler
B. capon D. roaster
6. To what part of poultry does breast meat belong?
A. dark meat C. variety meat
B. tough meat D. white meat
7. Which of the following characteristics is a good quality of a live poultry?
A. free from pin feathers and shows no cuts
B. has clear eye
C. heavy and the skin is watery
D. thighs well develop
8. What do you call a young chicken that is usually 9 to 12 weeks of age ?
A. fryer C. roaster
B. hen D. stag
9. How many days should a whole chicken be refrigerated?
A. 1 day C. 2 to 4 days
B. 1 to 2 days D. 3 to 4 days
10. What is a male chicken under 10 months old?
A. fryer C. rooster
B. hen D. stag
LM-Cookery Grade 10
296
Directions: Make a research on the following:
 Market forms of poultry
 Different cuts of poultry
 Characteristics of good quality poultry
 Preparation of poultry for cooking
LM-Cookery Grade 10
297
Learning Outcome 2 Cook Poultry and Game Dishes
Principles of Poultry Cookery
1. The fat distribution and maturity of the fowl affect the quality of the
product. Mature birds are best cooked using moist heat. Dry heat is
suitable for young birds.
2. The best cooking temperature for poultry is at low to moderate heat.
This temperature range produces a more flavorful and tender product.
This also minimizes nutrient loss and shrinkage of meat.
3. To prevent the risk of microbial contamination, stuffing of turkey and
chickens should be done immediately before roasting. It is best not to
fill the cavity completely as this will prevent the poultry from being
thoroughly cooked.
4. Because of its susceptibility to microbial growth, cooked poultry should
be eaten immediately or refrigerated if not consumed. Leftover stuffing
should be stored separately to prevent contamination.
5. Because poultry meat is pale-colored, it is best to employ dry heat
cooking with fat for a brown color.
6. When roasting chicken, cuts should be placed with the breast-side
down to produce a juicier and tenderer product.
7. To improve the palatability of lean poultry meat, basting can be done.
Causes of Food Spoilage and Contamination
All food should be safe and free from contamination and spoilage at all
points in its journey from its source until it reaches the consumers. However,
food contamination is a serious public health problem resulting in foodborne
diseases that affect many people every year. Hence, awareness of potential
sources of food contamination is an important component of good nutrition
and good health.
Food may be contaminated by different microorganisms or by
chemicals that can cause health problems for anyone who eats it.
The common causes of food contamination and food spoilage are:
1. Failure to properly refrigerate food
2. Failure to thoroughly heat or cook food
3. Infected employees/workers because of poor personal hygiene
practices
4. Foods prepared a day or more before they are served
LM-Cookery Grade 10
298
5. Raw, contaminated ingredients incorporated into foods that receive no
further cooking
6. Cross-contamination of cooked foods through improperly cleaned
equipment
7. Failure to reheat foods to temperature that kills bacteria
8. Prolonged exposure to temperatures favorable to bacterial growth
Poultry Cookery
Poultry, like meat may be cooked by either dry or moist heat method.
The choice of method depends mainly upon the age of the bird instead of
location of the part in the carcass as in the case of meats. Fat content should
also be taken into consideration.
1. Moist Heat Method
As discussed earlier in this lesson, chicken are categorized into
classes. All classes of chicken and other poultry for that matter may be
cooked by moist-heat cookery. Common Filipino dishes are tinola,
sinampalukang manok, manok na pinaupo, and relyeno.
2. Dry Heat Method
The dry method is usually reserved for young tender poultry.
The poultry class of these chickens is specially termed ―broilers and
fryers‖ Somewhat older but still immature birds such as capons and
roasters are also suitable for roasting. They are still tender but have
more fat than the broilers or fryers.
Older birds need to be tenderized by moist cooking prior to dry
heat cooking.
One point to remember in poultry cookery; moist heat cookery
may be applied to all classes and kinds of poultry but dry heat cookery
is reserved for tender birds.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
299
Steps in Fabricating Chicken
1. Cut along center of breast bone
2. Here you can view the cut made
LM-Cookery Grade 10
300
3. Using the knife, scimitar may be preferred but a fillet knife would work well
too. Cut along one side of the breast bone to the base of the chicken.
4. Separate skin that is attached to breast from leg quarter
5. With your thumb under the wing joint press upward and out to separate
joint
LM-Cookery Grade 10
301
6. With knife, cut between joint to remove and cut any skin not separated
from carcass yet.
7. Here is a picture of detached breast and wing.
8. Cut around wing joint to remove wing.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
302
9. A small thin piece of meat located on underside of breast that can be
removed by pulling the tenderloin, good for chicken tenders. Repeat steps
3-9 for the other side of breast.
10. Cut around leg quarter going up high towards backbone then circling down
toward other side.
11. Halfway through you will hit the joint.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
303
12. Using your thumb push up and out to snap apart joint.
13. Finish cut through joint to remove leg quarter. Repeat steps 10-13 for
other leg quarter.
Deboning Chicken
STEP 1: Place the chicken, breast
side up, on a clean cutting surface.
Stretch out each wing flat against the
board by pulling the tip. With a boning
knife, cut off the wing tip and next
joint, leaving the largest wing bone
still attached.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
304
STEP 2: At the neck, cut out the
wishbone by pulling the skin up and
out of the way and sliding the knife
along the underside of the wishbone.
Continue cutting around and under
the wishbone until it is free and can
be pulled out with your fingers.
STEP 3: Turn the bird over, and with
breast side down, cut along the
backbone from the neck to the tail.
STEP 4: With short sharp strokes of
your knife, keeping the knife close to
the bones cut the flesh and skin,
carefully using your fingers to pull the
flesh away from the carcass.
Cut through the ball-and-socket joints
connecting the wing and thigh bones
to the carcass, so that they are
separated from the carcass but still
attached to the skin. When step is
completed on both sides, meat will be
attached only along the ridge of the
breastbone. Gently (the skin tears
easily) pull to separate the
breastbone and carcass from the
flesh.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
305
STEP 5: Cut the flesh from the
curved (saber) bone near the
wing and remove the bone.
STEP 6: The partially-boned bird with
leg and wing bones left in, is now
ready for stuffing.
STEP 7: While holding the wing bone
from inside the bird, cut through the
tendons and scrape the meat from
the bone with the knife. Pull out the
bone, using the knife to free it.
STEP 8: Cut off end of the leg bone
using a cleaver or thick-bladed cook‘s
knife. Note: The use of a cook‘s knife
for chopping through chicken bone is
acceptable for this application but not
recommended for cutting through
other bone.
STEP 9: Repeat step #7 to remove
the leg bone. Reposition wing and leg
meat so skin side is out.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
306
STEP 10: The whole chicken is now
completely deboned, with the skin
intact and ready to be stuffed, rolled,
and roasted.
Now, you are ready for Rellenong
Manok Recipe (Stuffed deboned
Chicken)
Activity No.2 – Market Visit
Directions: This will be a collaborative activity. Follow the instructions below:
 Find a partner
 Visit a supermarket or a wet market near you and do the following:
 List down the market forms of poultry being sold
 Take note of the appearance, color, odor and its cuts
 Make a report of your activity
 Submit your report in a short bond paper with folder
LM-Cookery Grade 10
307
Directions: Demonstrate the steps in fabricating and deboning chicken by
following the procedures on page 279.
Your performance will be evaluated using the rubric below:
Directions:
Ask the teacher to
assess your
performance in the
following critical task
and performance criteria
below
You will be rated based
on the overall evaluation
on the right side.
SCORING RUBRICS
Level
Achieved PERFORMANCE LEVELS
10 - Can perform the skill very satisfactorily
without supervision and with initiative
and adaptability to problem situations.
7 - Can perform the skill satisfactorily
without assistance or supervision.
4 - Can perform the skill less satisfactorily
but requires some assistance and/or
supervision.
1 - Can perform parts of the skill
satisfactorily, but requires considerable
assistance and/or supervision.
Instructor will initial level achieved.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
308
Preparation and Cooking of Chicken
Chicken Galantina/Relleno
Direction: Find a partner and perform the given chicken recipe. Performance
activity will be evaluated based on the given rubric
TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT
INGREDIENTS
QUANTITY DESCRIPTION
knife
chopping board
measuring cup
measuring spoon
oven
wooden spoon
pinoykitchenette.blogspot.com
1
½ k
½ k
300 g
4 pieces
3 tbsp.
1/2 cup
2 pieces
3/4 cup
3/4 cup
1/2 cup
1/2 cup
1/2 cup
5 tbsp.
3/4 cup
1 1/2 tsp.
1/2 tsp.
whole chicken, deboned
ground pork
ground beef
ground chicken
sausage
sweet pickle relish
raisins
hard boiled eggs
minced ham
cup chopped Vienna sausage
minced onion
grated carrot
chopped red bell pepper
bread crumbs
soy sauce
Juice of 1 lemon
salt
ground black pepper
LM-Cookery Grade 10
309
Cooking Procedure
1. Combine ground pork, ham, sausage, bell pepper, carrot, onion,
raisins, sweet pickle relish, salt, and pepper. Mix well.
2. Add the bread crumbs and then continue mixing. Set aside.
3. Combine lemon juice and soy sauce in a large container. Stir.
4. Marinate the whole chicken in the lemon and soy sauce mixture for 30
minutes.
5. Remove the chicken from the mixture and then stuff with half of the
meat and vegetable mixture.
6. Arrange the boiled eggs inside the chicken and then continue to put-in
the rest of the meat mixture.
7. Secure the chicken by wrapping it in aluminum foil
8. Meanwhile pre heat oven at 350 degree Fahrenheit.
9. Bake the Chicken Relleno for about 1 hour
10. Remove from oven. Remove aluminum foil on the surface then brush
with butter on top and on side
11. Bake again for 15-20 minutes or until golden brown.
12. Allow to cool
13. Slice into serving pieces.
14. Serve. Share and enjoy!
LM-Cookery Grade 10
310
Direction: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet.
I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1)
1. General Appearance
a. Color combination is attractive and
appealing
b. ingredients cooked just right
c. correct consistency not mushy/ very
thick/thin consistency
2. Palatability
A. delicious
B. tastes just right
3.Nutritive Value
A. highly nutritious
II. Procedure:
2. Use of Resources:
a. kept working table orderly while
preparing the ingredients
b. used only the proper and needed
utensils and dishes
c. used time-saving techniques and
devices
2. Cleanliness and Sanitation
a. observed well-groomed and
properly dressed for cooking, use
clean apron, hair nets, hand towel
and pot holders
b. observed sanitary handling of food
3. Conservation of Nutrients
A. followed proper preparation and cooking
procedures
SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.)
COMMENTS:
LM-Cookery Grade 10
311
Italian Chicken Roll-Ups
TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT
INGREDIENTS
QUANTITY DESCRIPTION
casserole 8 boneless skinless chicken breast
halves (4 ounces each)
thin slices (4 ounces) ham
slices cheese, halved
cup seasoned bread crumbs
cup grated cheese
cup minced fresh parsley
cup milk
Cooking spray
gas or electric stove
knife
chopping board 8
measuring cup
measuring spoon 4
wooden spoon
2/3
1/2
.1/4
1/2
frying pan
Procedure
1. Preheat oven to 425°.
2. Flatten chicken to 1/4-in. thickness.
3. Place a slice of ham and half slice of provolone cheese on each piece of
chicken.
4. Roll up from a short side and tuck in ends; secure with a toothpick.
5. In a shallow bowl, combine crumbs, Romano cheese and parsley.
6. Pour milk into another bowl. Dip chicken rolls in milk, then roll in crumb
mixture.
7. Place roll-ups, seam side down, on a greased baking sheet. Spritz chicken
with cooking spray.
8. Bake, uncovered, 25 minutes or until meat is no longer pink.
9. Remove toothpicks. Yield: 8 servings.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
312
Direction: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet below.
I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1)
1. General Appearance
A. Color combination is attractive and appealing
B. ingredients cooked just right
C. correct consistency not mushy/ very thick/thin
consistency
2. Palatability
A. delicious
B. tastes just right
3.Nutritive Value
A. highly nutritious
II. Procedure:
3. Use of Resources:
a. kept working table orderly while
preparing the ingredients
b. used only the proper and needed
utensils and dishes
c. used time-saving techniques and
devices
4. Cleanliness and Sanitation
a. observed well-groomed and properly
dressed for cooking, use clean
apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot
holders
b. observed sanitary handling of food
5. Conservation of Nutrients
A. followed proper preparation and cooking
procedures
SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.)
COMMENTS:
LM-Cookery Grade 10
313
Learning Outcome 3 Plate/Present Poultry and Game Dishes
Portion Control for Cooked Poultry and Game
Chicken
 Meat shrinks about 25% when cooked. A quarter-pound hamburger
(4 oz.) will actually yield a 3 ounce portion after cooking. An 8
ounce steak will yield about 6 ounces of cooked meat.
 A chicken breast is generally 3 - 4 ounces.
 A chicken thigh is usually 2 ounces, while a leg is 1 - 2 ounces.
 Chicken wings are high in fat. It takes 2 wings to equal a 1 ounce
choice (or exchange) with that.
How to Do Control Portion Sizes – Portion Control Secrets
It‘s not always what you eat, but how much you eat - It‘s the size of your
servings that really counts!
Most of us tend to underestimate the amount of food we eat and tend
to overestimate the recommended portion sizes for many foods. Almost
everyone underestimates the amount of calories they consume, and
people who weigh more do so, to a greater degree.
Portion: A ―portion‖ is how much food you choose to eat at one time
(breakfast, lunch, dinner, or snack), whether in a restaurant, from a
package, or in your own kitchen. Portions can be bigger or smaller than
the recommended food servings. There is no standard portion size and
no single right or wrong portion size.
Serving: A ―serving‖ size is the amount of food listed (and
recommended) on a product‘s Nutrition Facts (panel of packaged food)
or the amount of food recommended in the Food Guide Pyramid and the
Dietary Guidelines* for Americans. Sometimes, the portion size and
serving size match; sometimes they do not. A serving is a standard
amount used to help give advice about how much to eat, or to identify
how many calories and nutrients are in a food.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
314
How to Control Portion Sizes:
Eating smaller portions of food is one of the easiest ways to cut
back on calories—but it can also be one of the most challenging, with
the current trend of super-sizing. How do you know a reasonable portion
of food when you see it? Visualize the objects mentioned below when
eating out, planning a meal, or grabbing a snack.
Factors to consider in presenting/plating poultry dishes
Types of service wares
Plating
Garnishing
Sauces
Accompaniments
Plating/ Presenting Poultry Dishes
Creative Food Presentation Techniques
The way food is presented affects a person‘s perception of how it will taste.
People instinctively reject bruised apples and browned bananas, and recognize
well-marbled beef and perfectly ripe produce. Prepared dishes work in the
same manner. The perfect dish includes food that tastes as good as it looks.
Much of the artistry of cooking comes after the food has been cooked and
it is time to transfer it from pot to plate. Here, chefs rise above cooks as they
LM-Cookery Grade 10
315
arrange the different components on a plate like interior designers place
furniture to create culinary masterpieces.
The home chef faces similar circumstances on a nightly basis. Whether
you‘re entertaining, preparing a special meal or jazzing up an old favorite, these
food presentation tips will set your dishes apart from the crowd.
Plating the Food
Plating is the act of arranging the meal on the individual plate
immediately before it‘s served. Presentation should look natural. It
should feel as though everything that is on the plate is meant to be
should feel as though everything that is on the plate is meant to be
exactly where it is. Try to strike a balance between having enough food
on the plate to convey hospitality without overcrowding the plate—and
potentially offending your guest. Try to leave one-third of the plate
empty, and plate your dish immediately before you serve it. It goes
without saying that hot food should be hot and cold food should be
cold; always check the temperature of your food before you serve it to
a guest. After you have put the food on the plate, check to see that the
plate is clean. Plate edges should be especially immaculate. Clean
spills or sauces away with a moistened clean sponge or paper towel.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
316
Decorate the Frame
If the food is the masterpiece, then the plate is its frame. Adapt artistic
framing strategies to your cooking for a quick way to improve your food‘s
presentation. Buy beautiful bowls and plates in a variety of shapes and colors.
The same bowl of soup looks dramatically different in a small Asian ceramic
cup and an oversized, shallow white French consommé bowl.
You can also decorate the rim of a plate, just as you‘d decorate a frame.
Use culinary elements like colorful spices or confectioner‘s sugar; specialty
salts like Hawaiian alaea or Himalayan pink salt which also lend themselves
wonderfully to this purpose.
For small appetizers, part of the presentation is making the display platter
look beautiful. Make a bed of uncooked soba noodles or flat rice sticks, shafts
of wheat, or large sprigs of fresh herbs like rosemary and thyme. This is also
a good trick to use if you are preparing a hors d‘oeuvre platter.
If you‘re decorating a plate that will hold hot food, be aware that by the
time you‘re finished garnishing the plate, the food may not be hot. In some
cases, you can garnish the plate before you plate the food. If this is
impossible, work quickly and have all of your garnishes close by.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
317
Mix Shapes, Colors and Textures
Food is naturally beautiful. Combine foods with different shapes, colors
and textures on the same plate. Grilled filet mignon becomes even more
decadent when it appears on the plate with stark white mashed potatoes and
a bright green steamed vegetable.
In this case, these different elements combine for a dish that catches
the eye. If your plate will contain multiple elements, use an odd number of
dishes rather than an even number for further interest. Grilled filet mignon
with mashed potatoes and steamed asparagus looks great, but add a stack of
sliced tomatoes and the combination becomes regimented and less
remarkable.
Try to integrate a variety of shapes in each dish. Risotto is boring when
paired with rice, as the two are nearly identical in shape, color and size.
Meatballs and Brussels sprouts are different colors but the same shape. But
meatballs and rice make an interesting combination, as do risotto and
Brussels sprouts.
For a restaurant-worthy twist on traditional side-by-side plating, stack
the components of your dish vertically. Arrange asparagus into a teepee on
the plate, with a dipping sauce in the center; make salads more cylindrical
than vertical. This approach can make any plate instantly more interesting.
Keep in mind that sometimes the most aesthetically pleasing plate of
food does not include a garnish. For example, crème brulee features a
delicate, crunchy top layer. While its appearance can certainly be improved
with a small garnish or beautiful brulee dish, the texture and color of the
caramelized sugar is beautiful enough on its own.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
318
Garnishes
Garnishes can be as simple or intricate as you like. For a twist on the
traditional parsley sprig, use a sprig or two of an herb or spice that was used
in the dish. A ham flavored with rosemary might feature a sprig of rosemary
on each plate. Spicy pad Thai can include a wedge of lemon or lime and a
dash of paprika sprinkled around the plate.
You can also garnish with small fans of fruits and vegetables like
cucumber, pineapple, avocado, citrus, kiwi or apple. Slice the fruit or
vegetable into thin rounds, leaving ¼‖ of flesh connected on one side to hold
the rounds together. Gently spread out the slices and arrange them neatly in
an arc. Several kitchen tools are available that will help you transform nearly
any fruit into an attractive garnish for a plate.
The key to selecting a garnish is picking a garnish that will improve the
dish. Garnishes add color and continue a theme, such as a brightly colored
orchid on top of passion fruit crème brulee. They can accent a dish‘s color,
like chives on top of a baked potato, or a dish‘s flavor.
Garnishes can provide complementary flavor, like peanuts in pad Thai,
or contrasting flavor, like a lemon wedge with seafood. An entrée‘s sauce also
makes a delicious garnish. Swirl it around or atop the plate for visual and
gustatory interest.
The way food looks on the plate is the most commonly ignored facet of
cooking at home. Too often, other considerations such as time, money, and
food allergies push presentation out of mind. Since most children and their
families eat their main meals at home, attractive food presentation is just as
important at home as it is in a restaurant. A dish that looks good is more likely
LM-Cookery Grade 10
319
to be eaten. Even picky kids will forego sugary cereal in favor of Mickey
Mouse-shaped waffles or a plate with over easy egg eyes, a bacon smile and
potato cheeks. You can even trick your own palate into liking Brussels
sprouts, zucchini and other healthy produce with a beautiful arrangement on a
dish.
Review of Learning Outcome 3
Direction: Choose the correct answer from the given choices. Write the letter
on your answer sheet.
1. Act of arranging the meal on the individual plate immediately before it‘s
serving
A. Garnishing
B. Cooking
C. Plating
D. Serving
2. If the food is the masterpiece, then the plate is its
A. Accessories
B. Base
C. body
D. Frame
3. To enhance in appearance by adding decorative touches
A. Plating
B. Presenting
C. Garnishing
D. Serving
LM-Cookery Grade 10
320
Learning Outcome 4 Store Poultry and Game Bird
Techniques in Storing Poultry
Poultry may be frozen whole, in halves, cut into pieces, or parts after
they are dressed. Parts can be packed separately, ready to cook, or for easy
meal preparation and thawing.
Handling and Storage of Poultry
Poultry spoils very quickly unless it is properly handled and stored.
After being brought home from the market, it should be unwrapped as quickly
as possible and wiped off with a damp cloth. Then it should be lightly covered
with waxed paper, placed in shallow utensils and stored in a cold part of the
refrigerator near the freezing unit or ice. Cooked poultry should be cooled as
quickly as possible, covered to prevent drying and refrigerated. Removing the
bones saves space. Frozen poultry must be kept in the freezing unit until it is
thawed for cooking.
Freezing and Thawing Poultry
To prepare poultry properly for freezing, it should be wrapped tightly in
a moisture-vapor proof film, foil or paper and then frozen at -170oC (0oF) or
lower. Although there are no abrupt changes in quality during the first few
months of poultry storage, it has always been a good practice to use these
chickens first which have been in storage longest and those with torn
wrapper.
Storage Time for Poultry and Game
Product
Refrigerator
(35-40oF)
Freezer ( 0oF)
Chicken and turkey (Whole)
Chicken (pieces)
Turkey ( pieces )
Duck and Goose ( whole )
Giblets
Wild duck, pheasant. Goose
( whole)
1 – 2 days
1 – 2 days
1 – 2 days
1 – 2 days
1 – 2 days
1 – 2 days
12 months
9 months
6 months
6 months
3 – 4 months
6 months
LM-Cookery Grade 10
321
Cooked poultry dishes
Canned poultry, opened
2 – 4 days
1 day
4 – 6 months
NR
It is not recommended to refreeze poultry after it has been thawed.
Freezing and thawing release fluids called drip and the chances of bacterial
spoilage are increased. Water holding capacity of meat is also affected by
subsequent thawing.
When thawing, it is advisable to thaw slowly inside the refrigerator to
give tissues a better chance to rehydrate. Immediately cook the thawed meat
since bacterial growth is rapid upon thawing. Slow thawing may be effected
by placing the 1 to 2 kg. chicken in the refrigerator for 12 to 24 hours or to
place it under running tap water for ½ to 1 hour, in their original wrap In both
cases. However, frozen poultry or any other market forms of poultry should
not be allowed to thaw or soak in a bowl of water because of possible
bacterial build.
Safety Practices in Handling and Storing Poultry and Game Products
How to Handle Chicken Safely
Raw chicken and poultry can carry the salmonella bacteria, which is
responsible for more cases of food poisoning than any other pathogen.
Fortunately, it's easy to avoid getting sick from chicken and poultry, as long as
you follow safe food handling practices.
Safe Shopping for Chicken and Poultry
During distribution to retail stores, fresh chicken is kept cold in order to
extend its shelf life as well as to prevent bacteria growth. Packages of chicken
should feel cold to the touch, and should be among the last items you select
before checking out.
Packages of chicken should be wrapped in plastic bags to prevent
leakage onto other items in your grocery cart.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
322
Once you're home, you should immediately place your chicken in a
refrigerator that maintains a temperature of 40°F or colder, and use it within 2
days. Otherwise, it should be frozen at 0°F.
Safe Handling of Chicken and Poultry
Just like meat, fish or any animal-based food product, raw or
undercooked chicken carry certain bacteria. These bacteria can cause illness
in large numbers.
Therefore, to avoid illness we need to limit bacteria's ability to multiply,
or kill them altogether. Limiting their ability to multiply requires making sure
that food products are not left at room temperatures — or specifically,
temperatures between 40°F and 140°F — for more than an hour.
And remember, freezing doesn't kill bacteria, either — it just makes
them cold. The only way to kill food-borne pathogens is by thoroughly cooking
the food.
Another concern with respect to working with uncooked poultry is cross-
contamination. Cross-contamination can happen when raw poultry — or even
just its juices — somehow come into contact with any other food products but
especially ones that are already cooked or ones that will be eaten raw, such
as salad vegetables or greens.
Fresh vs. Frozen Chicken and Poultry
If the label on a raw poultry product bears the term "fresh," that
indicates that it has never been colder than 26°F. Poultry that has at any time
been kept at 0°F or colder must have a label indicating that it is "frozen" or
"previously frozen," whatever the case may be.
Interestingly, poultry that has been kept at temperatures colder than
26°F but warmer than 0°F can be labeled neither fresh nor frozen.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
323
Chicken and Poultry Product Dating
Federal regulations don't require poultry products to be dated.
However, most retailers will date the chicken products that they sell.
If they do opt to date the product, regulations do require that there be a
phrase signifying whether the date is a "sell by" date or a "use before" date,
and the explanation must appear right next to the date.
Basics for Handling Food Safely
 Shopping
 Storage
 Preparation
 Thawing
 Cooking
 Serving
 Leftovers
 Refreezing
Safe steps in food handling, cooking, and storage are essential to
prevent foodborne illness. You can't see, smell, or taste harmful bacteria that
may cause illness. In every step of food preparation, follow the four Fight
BAC! ™ guidelines to keep food safe:
 Clean — Wash hands and surfaces often.
 Separate — Don't cross-contaminate.
 Cook — Cook to proper temperatures.
 Chill — Refrigerate promptly.
Shopping
 Purchase refrigerated or frozen items after selecting your non-
perishables.
 Never choose meat or poultry in packaging that is torn or leaking.
 Do not buy food without expiration dates
LM-Cookery Grade 10
324
Storage
 Always refrigerate perishable food within 2 hours (1 hour when the
temperature is above 90 °F).
 Check the temperature of your refrigerator and freezer with an
appliance thermometer. The refrigerator should be at 40 °F or below
and the freezer at 0 °F or below.
Cook or freeze fresh poultry, fish, ground meats, and variety meats
within 2 days; other beef, veal, lamb, or pork, within 3 to 5 days.
Perishable food such as meat and poultry should be wrapped securely
to maintain quality and to prevent meat juices from getting onto other
food.
To maintain quality when freezing meat and poultry in its original
package, wrap the package again with foil or plastic wrap that is
recommended for the freezer.
 In general, high-acid canned food such as tomatoes, grapefruit, and
pineapple can be stored on the shelf for 12 to 18 months. Low-acid
canned food such as meat, poultry, fish, and most vegetables will keep
2 to 5 years — if the can remains in good condition and has been
stored in a cool, clean, and dry place. Discard cans that are dented,
leaking, bulging, or rusted.
Preparation
Always wash hands with warm water and soap for 20 seconds before and
after handling food.
Don't cross-contaminate. Keep raw meat, poultry, fish, and their juices
away from other food. After cutting raw meats, wash cutting board,
utensils, and countertops with hot, soapy water.
Cutting boards, utensils, and countertops can be sanitized by using a
solution of 1 tablespoon of unscented, liquid chlorine bleach in 1 gallon
of water.
Marinate meat and poultry in a covered dish in the refrigerator.
Thawing
Refrigerator: The refrigerator allows slow, safe thawing. Make sure
thawing meat and poultry juices do not drip onto other food.
Cold Water: For faster thawing, place food in a leak-proof plastic bag.
Submerge in cold tap water. Change the water every 30 minutes. Cook
immediately after thawing.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
325
 Microwave: Cook meat and poultry immediately after microwave
thawing
Cooking
Cook all raw poultry, beef, pork, lamb and veal steaks, chops, and roasts to a
minimum internal temperature of 145 °F as measured with a food
thermometer before removing meat from the heat source. For safety and
quality, allow meat to rest for at least three minutes before carving or
consuming. For reasons of personal preference, consumers may choose to
cook meat to higher temperatures.
Poultry: Cook all poultry to an internal temperature of 165 °F as measured
with a food thermometer.
Serving
 Hot food should be held at 140 °F or warmer.
 Cold food should be held at 40 °F or colder.
 When serving food at a buffet, keep food hot with chafing dishes, slow
cookers, and warming trays. Keep food cold by nesting dishes in bowls
of ice or use small serving trays and replace them often.
 Perishable food should not be left out more than 2 hours at room
temperature (1 hour when the temperature is above 90 °F).
Left overs
 Discard any food left out at room temperature for more than 2 hours (1
hour if the temperature was above 90 °F).
 Place food into shallow containers and immediately put in the
refrigerator or freezer for rapid cooling.
 Use cooked leftovers within 4 days.
 Reheat leftovers to 165 °F.
Refreezing
Meat and poultry defrosted in the refrigerator may be refrozen before or after
cooking. If thawed by other methods, cook before refreezing.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
326
Post-Test
Directions: Read and understand the statements/questions below. Choose
the letter of the correct answer and write it on your test notebook.
1. As a chef of a fine dining restaurant, Genie simmers meat, fish, and
vegetables. Which of the following liquids is a by-product after the different
food stuffs have been simmered?
A. glaze C. stock
B. sauce D. water
2. Which of the following stocks uses veal bone as its main ingredient?
A. brown stock C. prawn stock
B. ham stock D. white stock
3. What kind of stock uses fish as its main ingredient?
A. brown stock C. glace viande
B. fish stock D. ham stock
4. What stock uses chicken bone as its main ingredient?
A. fish stock C. prawn stock
B. ham stock D. chicken stock
5. Among the different types of stock, which one is the easiest to prepare?
A. brown stock C. white stock
B. fish stock D. vegetable stock
6. What stock is made by boiling prawn shell?
A. fish stock C. prawn stock
B. ham stock D. vegetable stock
7. As a rule, which should not be added to the stock because it causes
saltiness?
A. MSG C. spices
B. salt D. sugar
8. Mrs. Sante will be having visitors for dinner. If she will prepare stock for
their dinner, which of the following flavoring agents will she use to give
aroma to the stock?
A. aromatic flavoring C. ginger
B. garlic D. smoke
LM-Cookery Grade 10
327
9. What makes the stock tasty and appetizing?
A. appearance C. ingredients
B. color D. smell
10. Which of the following is a clear soup?
A. bisques C. cream
B. bouillon D. puree
11. Which of the following examples is a thick soup?
A. bisques C. consommé
B. bouillon D. fruit
12. Which of the following is not a thickening agent?
A. flour C. rice
B. grain D. salt
13. Which of the four basic sauces whose basic ingredient is milk is thickened
with flour enriched with butter?
A. Hollandaise sauce C. veloute sauce
B. savory butter D. white sauce
14. Which among the four basic sauces has a chief ingredient of chicken
broth thickened with flour and enriched with butter seasoning?
A. Hollandaise sauce C. veloute sauce
B. savory butter D. white sauce
15. Which of the four basic sauces has three basic ingredients like butter,
egg yolk, and lemon juice with seasoning for accent?
A. Hollandaise sauce C. white sauce
B. savory butter D. veloute sauce
16. Which of the four basic sauces has a basic ingredient like butter that is
creamed and blended with other ingredients to give individual flavor?
A. Hollandaise sauce C. veloute sauce
B. savory butter D. white sauce
17. Which of the following is not a thickening agent?
A. dairy cream C. flour
B. egg D. spice
18. What do you call birds that are hunted for food?
A. game C. poultry
B. livestock D. swine
19. Which of the following poultry originated from China and is noted for its
tender and flavorful meat?
A. chicken C. itik
B. goose D. pecking duck
LM-Cookery Grade 10
328
20. What do you call to young immature pigeon of either sex with extra
tender meat is called .
A. duck C. rooster
B. fryer D. squab
21. Poultry is composed of different parts. Which of the following do breast
meat belong?
A. dark meat C. variety meat
B. tough meat D. white meat
22. Which of the following characteristics is a good quality of a live poultry?
A. free from pin feathers and shows no cuts
B. has clear eye
C. heavy and the skin is watery
D. well-develop thighs
23. What do you call to young chicken that is usually 9 to 12 weeks of age?
A. fryer C. roaster
B. hen D. stag
24. How many days should a whole chicken should be refrigerated?
A. 1 day C. 2 to 4 days
B. 1 to 2 days D. 3 to 4 days
25. How do you classify the fleshy part of chicken like breast?
A. entrails C. viscera
B. dark meat D. white meat
26. In cookery, we apply different cooking methods depending on the
ingredients that we have. If you will cook a matured poultry, which of the
following methods will you apply?
A. boiling C. roasting
B. frying D. stewing
27. What cookery method is suitable for the less tender cuts?
A. boiling C. roasting
B. frying D. stewing
28. What is the best cooking temperature for poultry?
A. high temperature C. low to moderate temperature
B. low temperature D. moderate temperature
29. What factor affects the poultry meat‘s tenderness and juiciness?
A. age C. cuts
B. cookery D. sex
30. Which of the following can be done to prevent drying when reheating?
A. cook using sauces and gravy
B. overcook the poultry meat
C. remove fat before cooking
D. none of the above
LM-Cookery Grade 10
329
QUARTER 4
PREPARING AND COOKING MEAT
Overview
This quarter will enable students or learners to acquire competencies
in: preparing and cooking meat which includes: performing mise‘ en place,
cooking and evaluating meat dishes, presenting/plating meat dishes, and
storing meat.
Objectives:
At the end of the quarter students are expected to:
1. perform mise ‗en place;
2. cook meat cuts;
3. present and evaluate meat dishes; and
4. store meat.
Pre-Test
Directions: Read the following statements/questions carefully and choose the
letter with the correct answer. Write your answer in your test note book.
1. What animal produces veal meat?
A. calf C. hog
B. deer D. sheep
2. Which of the following market forms of meat does not undergo chilling?
A. cured meat C. frozen meat
B. fresh meat D. processed meat
3. What part of the meat helps you identify the less tender cuts?
A. bone C. flesh
B. fat D. ligament
4. What part of the meat has the greatest amount of quality protein?
A. Bone C. Flesh
B. Fat D. Ligament
LM-Cookery Grade 10
330
5. Which of the following meat cuts requires long and slow cooking
temperature?
A. less tender C. tender
B. slightly tough D. tough
6. What is a long – bladed hatchet or a heavy knife used by a butcher?
A. butchers knife C. cleaver knife
B. chopper knife D. set of slicing knife
7. Which of the cooking methods does not belong to dry heat method?
A. baking C. roasting
B. broiling D. stewing
8. What do you call the cooking method when meat is cooked in steaming
liquid in which bubbles are breaking on the surface?
A. boiling C. roasting
B. broiling D. stewing
9. What is an oil-acid mixture which is used to enhance the flavor of meat?
A. brine solution C. soy sauce and vinegar
B. marinade D. salt and calamansi
10. Which of the following tools is used for carving?
A. cleaver knife C. slicer
B. fork D. razor knife
11. To which meat cut do internal organs belong?
A. less tender cuts C. tough cuts
B. tender cuts D. variety cuts
12. Where should meat products be stored?
A. crisper C. dry shelf
B. cold shelf D. freezer
13. Which of the following is the tenderest cut of beef?
A. chunk C. sirloin
B. round cut D. tenderloin
14. When buying meat, what should you consider first?
A. brand C. quality
B. price D. round cut
15. What is your primary consideration when storing goods?
A. expiration date C. quantity
B. fragility D. size
16. These are taken from the internal organs of animals.
A. less tender cuts C. tough cuts
B. tender cuts D. variety cuts
17. A slaughtered animal is called .
A. a carabeef C. a pork
B. a carcass D. a poultry
LM-Cookery Grade 10
331
18. The most common method of preserving meat is .
A. curing C. refrigerating
B. drying D. salting
19. In this method, salt, sugar, potassium, or sodium nitrate etc. are used
in preserving meat by drying
A. curing C. freezing
B. dehydration D. salting
20. The following are the characteristics of good quality pork, except
A. breast is plump C. no foul odor
B. flesh is pink D. texture is fine and firm
21. A tool used for cutting through bones.
A. butcher knife C. cleaver
B. chef knife D. utility knife
22. Used for carving and slicing cooked meats.
A. butcher knife C. slicer
B. chef knife D. utility knife
23. A knife used for general purposes.
A. Butcher knife C. Cleaver
B. Chef knife D. Utility knife
24. It is used in carving roasts chicken and duck.
A. Carving knife C. Slicer
B. Cleaver knife D. Utility knife
25. Used for cutting, trimming raw meats.
A. butcher knife C. cleaver
B. chef knife D. utility knife
26. Meat of swine is called:
A. Beef C. Chevon
B. Carabeef D. Pork
27. Veal is the meat of:
A. Cattle over 1 year old C. Sheep
B. Goat D. Young calf
28. Deer meat is called:
A. Beef C. Chevon
B. Carabeef D. Pork
29. Meat of cattle over 1 year old
A. Beef C. Pork
B. Carabeef D. Chevon
30. Meat of sheep is called:
A. Lamb C. Pork
B. Carabeef D. Chevon
LM-Cookery Grade 10
332
Overview:
This lesson covers the skills, knowledge, and attitudes required to
prepare and cook meat.
Learning Outcomes:
At the end of the lesson you are expected to do the following:
1. perform mise‘n place;
2. cook meat cuts;
3. present and evaluate meat dishes; and
4. store meat.
Introduction of Meat
Meat is a term for the flesh of cattle (beef and veal), sheep (lamb) and
pigs (pork). Meat comprises water, protein, fat, and various amounts of
minerals and vitamins.
Beef is divided into large sections called primal cuts. These beef
primal cuts or ―primal‖ are then broken down further into individual steak and
other retail cuts. A ―side‖ of beef is literally one side of the beef carcass that
is split through the backbone. Each side is then halved between the 12th and
13th ribs into sections called the forequarter and hindquarter.
Pork is divided into large sections called primal cuts. These primal cuts
are then broken down further into individual retail cuts.
Pork is another choice, as far as meat types are concerned. Pork is
derived from pig and is classified as red meat. However, this meat is less fatty
than beef.
Beef is very popular and is used across the globe. This meat is
obtained from cow and is one of the much sought-after types of red meat.
Sheep meat is also a staple food in some parts of the world and is
consumed in many regions. Sheep meat is otherwise known as mutton (meat
of mature sheep) or lamb (immature sheep) also classified as red meat.
LESSON 1 PREPARE AND COOK MEAT
LM-Cookery Grade 10
333
Learning Outcome 1 Perform Mise’en Place
Types of Knives and their Uses
1. French knife or chef‘s knife – for general
purpose chopping, slicing, and dicing.
2. Utility knife – used for carving roast
chicken and duck.
3. Boning knife – used for boning raw meats and
poultry.
4. Slicer – used for carving and slicing
cooked meats.
5. Butcher knife – used for cutting, sectioning,
and trimming raw meats in the butcher shop.
6. Scimitar or steak knife - used for accurate
cutting of steaks.
7. Cleaver – used for cutting through bones.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
334
Composition of Meat
1. Water – 70% of muscle tissue.
Water Content of Meat and Poultry
Product Name Percentage Water
Raw Cooked
Chicken fryer, whole 66% 60%
White meat chicken, with skin 69% 61%
Dark meat chicken, with skin 66% 59%
Ground beef, 85% lean 64% 60%
Ground beef, 73% lean 56% 55%
Beef, eye of round 73% 65%
Beef, whole brisket 71% 56%
2. Protein – 20% of muscle tissue. Protein coagulates when it is heated. It
becomes firmer and loses moisture. When protein has coagulated to the
desired degree, the meat is said to be done.
3. Fat – 5% of the muscle tissue. The fat in meat contributes to:
A. Juiciness
Marbling is fat that is deposited within the muscle tissue.
Surface fats protect the meat from drying out during
cooking. Adding surface fat is called barding.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
335
B. Tenderness
Marbling separates muscle fibers, making meat easier to
chew.
C. Flavor- Fat is the main source of flavor in meat.
4. Carbohydrates – it plays a necessary part in the complex reaction,
called the maillard reaction, which takes
place when meats are browned by roasting,
broiling or sautéing. Without carbohydrates,
desirable flavor-appearance of browned
meats would not be achieved.
Structure of Meat
1. Muscle fibers
Lean meat is composed of long, thin muscle
fibers bound together in bundles. These
determine the texture or grain of a piece of
meat.
 Fine – grained meat is composed of small fibers bound in small
fibers.
 Course – textured meat has large fibers.
2. Connective tissue
These are network of proteins that bind the muscle fibers together.
Connective tissue is tough. Meats are high in connective tissue if the
muscles are more exercised like meat from legs and the meat comes from
older animals.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
336
Two Kinds of Connective Tissue
A. Collagen – white connective tissue that
dissolves or breaks down by long, slow
cooking with liquid. Moist-heat cooking
methods at low temperature are not effective
for turning a meat high in connective tissue
into a tender, juicy finished product. Acid
helps dissolve collagen.
J. Elastin – yellow connective tissue
and is not broken down in cooking.
Tenderizing can be accomplished only by
removing the elastin, by pounding and by
slicing and grinding.
Basic Preparation Methods of Meat
1. Washing
Generally, the only occasion in which you will have to wash meat is when
it comes into contact with blood during preparation. After washing, dry the
food thoroughly with absorbent kitchen paper.
2. Skinning
Most of the meat you dealt with has been already skinned by the supplier.
3. Dicing
Meat are diced when it is cut into cubes for various types of casseroles,
stems, curries, and dishes such as steak, kidney pie and pudding.
4. Trimming
Reasons for trimming:
a. Improve the appearance of the cut or joint
b. Leave as much of the meat intact as possible.
c. Leave an even thickness of fat (where fat is to be left). How
much fat you trim off will depend on the type of meat,
preference, and the cooking process to be used.
d. Remove as much gristles and sinews as possible.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
337
5. Slicing
It is the cutting of meat by determining the direction of the grain (the
muscle fibers), and cut across the grain. This is particularly important with
tougher cuts such as steak, in which the grain is also quite obvious.You
slice meat with―instead of against―the grain.
6. Seasoning
It is the addition of salt and white or black pepper to improve the flavor of
food.
a. Use white pepper or cayenne pepper on food which you want to
keep attractive with white color.
b. Add salt to roast and grill after the meat has browned. Adding
salt before cooking will extract the juices of the meat to the
surface, and slows down the browning reactions (which need
high temperature and dry heat).
7. Coating
The two basic coatings are:
a. Flour – coat the meat before cooking, otherwise the flour
becomes sticky and unpleasant.
b. Bread crumbs – coat the meat in flour, then egg wash (egg
wash is made of lightly beaten whole egg with a little water/milk)
and finally with the bread crumbs.
Different kinds of meat and its source
1. Pork – meat from domesticated pigs, typically high in fat, commonly
slaughtered one year or less of age to ensure tender cuts
.
.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
338
2. Beef -meat from cattle over one year old
3. Lamb – meats of domesticated sheep. Its texture is a direct result of
what it consumes and the age at which it is slaughtered.
4. Carabeef – meat from carabao.
5. Chevon – meat from deer/goat.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
339
5. Veal – flesh of a young calf, 4-5 months old. Because of its age, it is
considered by some to be the finest meat.
Directions : Match Column A with Column B. Write the letter of your answer in
separate sheet.
A.
Column A Column B
1. Used for cutting through bones. A. Butcher knife
2. Used for carving and slicing
cooked meats B. Chef knife
3. For general purposes. C. Cleaver
4. Carving roast chicken and duck. D. Utility knife
5. Used for cutting, trimming raw meats. E. Slicer
B. Column A Column B
1. Young calf A. beef
2. goat B. carabeef
3. Sheep C. veal
4. Cattle over one year old D. lamb
5. Carabao E. chevon
LM-Cookery Grade 10
340
Learning Outcome 2 Cook Meat Cuts
Meat Dishes and Entrees
In the classical menu, the term entrée refers to the courses after the
Grosse piece. Basically, entrees are divided into cold entrees and hot
entrees. Today, however, the entrees are usually served as the main dish
with suitable vegetable and salad garnishes. Both hot and cold entrees are
frequently described as simple dishes on the menu, where they appear in
various categories, such as hot snacks garnishes for main dishes and
specialties of the day. The main difference between main grosses piece is
that the entries are cut up before being cooked. They do not require the same
methods of preparation as the grosses pieces which are prepared in single
large pieces. It is, therefore, not possible to group the two types of dishes in
the same category.
Four kinds of doneness in meat
1. Rare – when pressed with a finger, the meat is very soft with jelly like
texture.
2. Medium Rare – when pressed with a finger, meat feels springy and
resistant
3. Medium – when pressed with a finger, meat feels firm and there is a
definite resistance.
4. Well Done – when pressed with a finger the meat feels hard and
rough.
Nutrient Content of Meat
Meat consists of water protein and fat, with a few minerals and some B
vitamins.
1. Protein – High-quality protein is the major constituent of meat after
water, accounting for about 20 percent of its weight. Meat contains 7
grams of protein per ounce.
2. Fat –content can vary widely, according to the grade of meat and its
cut.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
341
3. Carbohydrates – Meat contains very little carbohydrates, glycogen,
found in liver and muscle tissue is present when the animal is alive,
but the glucose that makes up the glycogen is broken down to lactic
acid during and after slaughter.
4. Vitamins – Meat is an excellent source of certain B vitamins – thiamin
(B., riboflavin (B2), pyridoxine (B6), vitamin (B12) niacin and some
folate. Niacin is obtained from tryptophan, an amino acid plentiful in
meats and milk.
5. Minerals – Meat is an excellent source of iron, zinc, copper, phosphorous,
and a few other trace minerals.
Safe Cooking Temperatures for Various Meat
MEAT °C °F
Beef, rare 52 125
Beef, medium 57 135
Beef, medium well 68 155
Beef, well done 71 160
Ground beef 74 165
Pork 71 160
Market forms of meat
Fresh meat – meat that is recently slaughtered, has not been preserved,
frozen
Chilled meat – meat that is placed in chiller or slightly cold
Cured meat – meat preserved by salting, smoking or aging
Processed meat –meat preserved by chemical process
LM-Cookery Grade 10
342
Meat cuts
Primary Cuts of Meat
Beef
Veal
LM-Cookery Grade 10
343
Lamb
Pork
LM-Cookery Grade 10
344
Marinades
` Good marinade will add flavor to your favorite meat and make it more
tender and juicy. Making a marinade is very simple. All you need are three
basic components. The first, is an acid, such as lemon juice, vinegar, yogurt,
or wine. The acid is important as it breaks down the meat and tenderizes it.
The second, is oil. This protects and preserves the food while marinated and
also when it‘s being cooked. The third, is any herb and/or spice. This is what
gives a marinade its unique flavor and zest. Feel free to experiment by
grouping one or more ingredients from each component.
Here are some general guidelines for marinating:
 Meat and poultry are generally marinated for 2 hours up to 2 days.
 Seafood and fish should be marinated for no longer than one hour.
 Use a non-reactive container - steer clear of aluminum, copper, or cast
iron.
 Wait for your marinade to cool down before pouring over the meat of
your choice.
 Always refrigerate your meat while it's marinating.
 Never reuse marinades!
Types of Marinades
Pineapple Marinade - http://bbq.about.com/od/marinaderecipes/tp/Top-10-
Pork-Marinade-Recipes.htm
This sweet, fruity marinade works great on any cut of pork or chicken. What
you get with this marinade is a great Hawaiian Teriyaki flavor. Try this
marinade when you are simply placing cut strips of pork or chicken over rice.
You can make extra marinade to use as a sauce as long as you keep it
separate from the meat
LM-Cookery Grade 10
345
Pork Chop Marinade
This is a great Asian style marinade that works well on all cuts of pork,
particularly pork chops, reminiscent of a Teriyaki marinade with a hint of heat
from the chili sauce. You can, if you like, heat this up with some extra chili
sauce or perhaps a pinch of cayenne.
Jamaican Jerk Marinade
You've heard of Jerk seasonings and Jerk rubs, well this is a jerk marinade
that gets that jerk flavor deep into the meat. You can use this marinade on all
kinds of meat and poultry.
Pork Rib Marinade
BBQ Guru posted this marinade recipe to the forum. It uses a pork rub for the
seasoning with vinegar and water to turn it into a marinade.
Teriyaki Marinade
Want to get that great Teriyaki flavor into your favorite dish? This marinade
will surely add flavor to whatever you're grilling. This marinade works
particularly well with pork and poultry.
Pork Chop and Tenderloin Marinade
Doug Freeman sent in this marinade recipe for grilled pork. You may leave
out the liquid smoke if you are so inclined.
Bourbon Marinade
This is a great, sweet bourbon marinade that works perfectly on any food.
This is a mild marinade so you will want several hours marinating time with it
before you grill.
Mustard-Vinegar Marinade
This is a simple mustard marinade that tenderizes and adds flavor. It works
well on pork or poultry.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
346
Effects of Heat to Meat
1. It tenderizes connective tissue if moisture is present and cooking is slow.
2. It coagulates protein. Even meats low in connective tissue can be
tough and dry if cooked at excessively high heats for too long.
3. High heat toughens and shrinks protein and results in excessive
moisture lost.
4. Roasts cooked at low temperature shrink less and loss less moisture.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
347
5 Moist heat penetrates meat quickly. To avoid over cooking, meat
should be simmered, never boiled.
Methods of cooking meat
1. Dry heat cooking, such as roasting, broiling, or sautéing.
2. Moist heat cooking, like braising, steaming, or poaching.
Choosing the Right Cooking Technique
Using the appropriate cooking method for the type of food being
prepared is a major part of the culinary arts. Tough cuts of meat like beef
brisket or lamb shank need to be cooked slowly, at low heat, for a long time,
and with plenty of moisture. Prepared properly, these cuts can be incredibly
tender and delicious. On the other hand, dry-heat methods typically involve
very high temperatures and short cooking times. A piece of brisket cooked in
this way — on a grill, let's say would be tough, chewy and largely inedible.
Interestingly enough, a beef tenderloin steak cooked using a slow, moist-heat
method such as braising would also turn out tough, chewy and inedible
Dry heat cooking
Dry heat cooking refers to any cooking technique where the heat is
transferred to the food item without using any moisture. Dry-heat cooking
typically involves high heat, with temperatures of 300°F or hotter.
Baking or roasting in an oven is a dry heat method because it uses hot air to
conduct the heat. Pan-searing a steak is considered dry-heat cooking
because the heat transfer takes place through the hot metal of the pan.
Note: The browning of food (including the process by which meat is browned,
called the Maillard reaction) can only be achieved through dry-heat cooking.
Examples of dry-heat methods include:
LM-Cookery Grade 10
348
Roasting & Baking
Forms of dry-heat cooking that use hot, dry air to cook food
roasting and baking. Like other dry-heat cooking methods, roasting and
baking brown the surface of the food, which in turn develops complex
flavors and aromas.
Both words describe a method of cooking an item by enveloping it
in hot, dry air, generally inside an oven and at temperatures of at least
300°F and often much hotter. A convection oven, which circulates hot air
throughout the oven, can enhance the browning reaction.
Grilling & Broiling
http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/dryheatcooking/a/grilling.htm
Dry-heat cooking methods that rely on heat being conducted
through the air from an open flame are grilling and broiling. This type of
cooking produces browning reactions on the surface of the food, thus
encouraging the development of complex flavors and aromas. Grilling
cooks hot and fast, because air is a poor conductor of heat. Broiling and
grilling require the food to be quite close to the heat source, which in this
case, is likely to be an open flame.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
349
Sautéing & Pan-Frying
Sautéing is a form of dry-heat cooking that uses a very hot pan
and a small amount of fat to cook the food very quickly. Like other dry-
heat cooking methods, sautéing browns the food's surface as it cooks
and develops complex flavors and aromas.
Sautéing requires a very hot pan.
When sautéing, it's important to heat the pan for a minute, then
add a small amount of fat and let it gets hot as well, before adding the
food to the pan. This hot fat helps brown the surface of the food.
Another key is to avoid overloading or overcrowding the pan.
Deep-Frying
Since deep-frying involves submerging food in hot, liquid fat, it
might take some time to get used to the idea that it's actually a form
of dry-heat cooking.
But if you've ever seen the violent reaction of hot oil to even a
tiny drop of water, you know that oil and water are a couple of
opposites that has nothing to do with each other.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
350
Moist heat cooking
Moist heat cooking methods include any technique that involves
cooking with moisture — whether it's steam, water, stock, wine or some other
liquid. Cooking temperatures are much lower, anywhere from 140°F to a
maximum of 212°F, because water doesn't get any hotter than that. Examples
of moist-heat cooking methods include:
Simmering
With simmering, the cooking liquid is a bit hotter than poaching from
180°F to 205°F. Here we will see bubbles forming and gently rising to the
surface of the water, but the water still isn't at a full rolling boil.
Because it surrounds the food in water that maintains a more or less
constant temperature, simmering cooks food very evenly. It's an excellent
choice for culinary preparations including stocks or soups, starchy items such
as potatoes or pastas, and many others.
Boiling
The hottest of these three stages is boiling, where the water reaches
its highest possible temperature of 212°F. It's actually the least likely of the
three to be used for cooking. That's because the violent agitation caused by
the rolling boil can be too rough on food and will often damage it.
Water at a full boil would be a bad choice for cooking an egg outside
its shell, as we do when preparing poached eggs, because the agitation
would cause the egg to fall apart. The same holds true for delicate fish as well
as some pastas.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
351
Steaming
Steaming is a moist-heat cooking technique that employs hot steam to
conduct the heat to the food item.
Cooking With Steam
Steaming can be done on a stovetop, with a pot containing a small
amount of liquid that is brought to a simmer. The item to be cooked is then
placed in a basket suspended above the liquid and the pot covered.
Braising & Stewing
Braising is a form of moist-heat cooking in which the item to be
cooked is partially covered with liquid and then simmered slowly at a low
temperature.
Though it can be done on the stovetop, braising is best done in the
oven, because the heat fully surrounds the pot and causes the food to cook
more evenly than if it were only heated from below.
Begin by Searing
Because moist heat does not permit the various browning reactions
that dry heat produces, giving cooked meats the brown, outer crust that also
helps to develop complex flavors and aromas, it's customary to sear meat in a
LM-Cookery Grade 10
352
pan with a small amount of hot fat before braising it. This step helps to
develop flavors as well as making the meat more appealing visually. Read
more about how to braise meat
How Braising Works
Braising is a good choice of cooking method for cuts of meat that are
tougher or from older animals. The connective tissues that are more prevalent
in cuts like this, and which can make meats tough and chewy when
improperly cooked, are slowly dissolved through long, slow application of
moist heat. So you end up with a tender piece of meat.
Factors Affecting Choice of Cooking Methods in Meat
1. Cuts of meat
 Tender cuts like ribs and loin cuts are used for roasting, broiling
and grilling
 Less tender cuts from leg or round are used for braising
 Tougher cuts from chuck or shoulder are usually braced
 Least tender cuts from shanks, breast, brisket, and flank are
cooked by moist heat.
 Ground meat and cubed usually made from trimmings can be
cooked by dry heat or moist heat.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
353
2. Fat content
 Meats high in fat are cooked without added fat, such as roasting or broiling
 Meats low in fat are often cooked with added fat to prevent dryness, like
sautéing, pan frying or braising.
3. Desired quality
 Tenderness is not the only goal of cooking. To develop flavor and
appearance is also one of the objectives to get the desired quality.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
354
PREPARE AND COOK MEAT
This will be a group collaboration activity. Perform recipes using
different methods of cooking meat. Your outputs will be evaluated using a
performance score sheet.
Roasted Meat
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Knife
Chopping board
Roasting pan
Rack
Oven
Pan
Serving plate
Materials/ingredients needed:
Meat (any kind)
Seasoning
Brown Stock
Mirepoix
LM-Cookery Grade 10
355
Procedure:
1. Collect all equipment and food supplies. Use roasting pans that have
low side and just large enough to hold the roast.
2. Prepare a trim meat for roasting.
3. Season meat several hours or the day before.
4. Place meat fat side up on a rack in the roasting pan.
5. Place meat in preheated oven.
6. Roast to desired doneness.
7. Remove roast from oven and let stand in a warm place for 15-30
minutes.
8. Prepare pan gravy from drippings by;
a. degrees pan used in roasting meat
b. add mirepoix and let brown
c. deglaze with brown stock
d. simmer for desired time
e. strain and skim fat
9. Slice roast meat across the grain and serve with gravy.
Direction: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet.
I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1)
1. General Appearance
a. Color combination is attractive
and appealing
b. ingredients cooked just right
c. correct consistency not mushy/
very thick/thin consistency
2.Palatability
a. delicious
b. tastes just right
3.Nutritive Value
a. highly nutritious
LM-Cookery Grade 10
356
II. Procedure:
1. Use of Resources:
a. kept working table
orderly while preparing
the ingredients
b. used only the proper
and needed utensils
and dishes
c. used time-saving
techniques and devices
2. Cleanliness and Sanitation
a. was well-groomed and
properly dressed for
cooking, use of clean
apron, hair nets, hand
towel and pot holders
b. used sanitary handling
of food
3. Conservation of Nutrients
a. followed proper
preparation and
cooking procedures
SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.)
LM-Cookery Grade 10
357
Braised Short Ribs
Purpose: Prepare and cook braised short ribs
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Oven
String for tying
Pan
Ladle
Strainer
Ingredients Needed:
25 kg short rib sections
250 ml oil
300 g onions
150 g celery
150 g carrots
150 g bread flour
25 l brown stock
150 ml tomato puree
2 pcs. Bay leaves
Salt to taste
Pepper to taste
Procedure:
1. Tie the short ribs so the meat will stay on the bone during cooking.
2. Dry the meat so it will brown easily.
3. Heat the oil in a heavy skillet until very hot. Brown the meat on all
sides. Transfer browned meat to a browning pan.
4. Sauté onions, celery and carrot to the skillet until lightly
browned.
5. Stir in the bread flour to make a roux.
6. Add the brown stock and tomato puree. Simmer until thickens.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
358
7. Add bay leaf and season to taste with salt and pepper.
8. Pour the sauce over the steaks. Cover and braise until tender.
9. Transfer the steaks in a serving plate.
10. Strain the sauce and pour over steaks.
Direction: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet.
I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1)
1. General Appearance
a. color combination is attractive
and appealing
b. ingredients cooked just right
c. correct consistency not mushy/
very thick/thin consistency
2.Palatability
a. delicious
b. tastes just right
3. Nutritive Value
a. highly nutritious
II. Procedure:
4. Use of Resources:
a. kept working table orderly while
preparing the ingredients
b. used only the proper and
needed utensils and dishes
c. used time-saving techniques
and devices
5. Cleanliness and Sanitation
a. was well-groomed and properly
dressed for cooking, use of
clean apron, hair nets, hand
LM-Cookery Grade 10
359
towel and pot holders
b. observed sanitary handling of
food
6. Conservation of Nutrients
a. followed proper preparation
and cooking procedures
SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.)
Broiling/Grilling Meats
Purpose: To prepare and cook meat for broiling or grilling.
Tools/Equipment Needed:
Broiler or Griller
Brush for meat
Fork
Knife
Tong
Ladle
Ingredients Needed:
Meat
Oil
Salt and pepper to taste
LM-Cookery Grade 10
360
Procedure:
1. Collect and prepare all equipment and supplies. Trim excess fat
from meats to avoid flare-ups.
2. Preheat the broiler or grill.
3. Brush the meat with oil, or dip it in oil and let excess drip off. Place
the meat on the broiler or grill. The oil helps prevent sticking and
keeps the product moist.
4. When one side is brown and the meat is cooked halfway, turn it
over with a fork (piercing only the fat, not the meat, or juices will be
lost) or tongs.
5. Cook the second side until the meat is cooked to the desired
doneness. If the meat is to be brushed with a glaze or sauce, it is
usually best to wait until the product is partially cooked on each
side before applying the first coat. After the meat has been cooked
on both sides ½ to ¾ done, brush the top with a light coat of the
sauce. Turnover and repeat as necessary.
6. Remove from broiler or grill and serve immediately.
Direction: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet.
I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1)
1. General Appearance
a. color combination is attractive
and appealing
b. ingredients cooked just right
c. correct consistency not mushy/
very thick/thin consistency
2. Palatability
a. delicious
b. tastes just right
3. Nutritive Value
a. highly nutritious
LM-Cookery Grade 10
361
II. Procedure:
4. Use of Resources:
a. kept working table
orderly while preparing
the ingredients
b. used only the proper
and needed utensils and
dishes
c. used time-saving
techniques and devices
5. Cleanliness and Sanitation
a. was well-groomed and
properly dressed for
cooking, use of clean
apron, hair nets, hand
towel and pot holders
b. observed sanitary
handling of food
6. Conservation of Nutrients
a. followed proper
preparation and cooking
procedures
SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.)
LM-Cookery Grade 10
362
MORCON
TOOLS AND
EQUIPMENT
INGRIDIENTS
QUANTITY DESCRIPTION
Measuring spoon 1k beef, sliced 1/4 inch thick (3 pcs.)
Measuring cup ¼ k ground beef liver
Knife 200 grams sliced sausages or ham
Weighing scale 200 grams pork fat (cut is strips)
Pot or pressure cooker 3 pcs. hard boiled eggs, sliced
100 grams
100 grams
2
5 pcs.
½ tsp
½ cup
cheddar cheese in strips
grated cheddar cheese
onions, chopped
bay leaf (laurel)
ground black pepper
vinegar
2 tsp.
salt
2 cups
water
2 meters
thread or string (for tying)
PROCEDURE:
1. Spread and stretch the sliced beef on your working table.
2. Arrange the filling on the sliced beef: sausage strips, cheese strips,
sliced eggs, pork fat and some ground liver.
3. Roll the sliced beef with all the filling inside and secure with a thread
or string.
4. Repeat the procedure for the two remaining beef slices.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
363
5. On a pot, place the beef rolls and put the water, the remaining ground
liver, grated cheese, chopped onions, bay leaves, ground black
pepper and salt.
6. Cover the pot and bring to a boil. Simmer for one hour.
7. Add the vinegar and continue to simmer for another hour or until beef
is tender.
8. Slice the beef morcon, arrange on a platter, and top with the sauce/
gravy.
(Estimated cooking time: 2 to 3 hours.)
Cooking Tips:
 A spoon or two of flour can be added to water to thicken the sauce.
 Instead of boiling in a pot, you can use a pressure cooker for faster
cooking.
 Optional: Garnish with olives before serving.
Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet.
I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1)
1. General Appearance
a. color combination is attractive
and appealing
b. ingredients cooked just right
c. correct consistency not mushy/
very thick/thin consistency
2.Palatability
a. delicious
b. tastes just right
3.Nutritive Value
a. highly nutritious
LM-Cookery Grade 10
364
II. Procedure:
1.Use of Resources:
b. kept working table
orderly while preparing
the ingredients
c. used only the proper
and needed utensils and
dishes
d. used time-saving
techniques and devices
2. Cleanliness and Sanitation
a. was well-groomed and
properly dressed for
cooking, use of clean
apron, hair nets, hand
towel and pot holders
b. observed sanitary
handling of food
3. Conservation of Nutrients
a. followed proper
preparation and cooking
procedures
SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.)
LM-Cookery Grade 10
365
Learning Outcome 3 Plate/Present Meat Dishes
Basic Principles of Platter Presentation
1. .Presentation must have three elements.
 Centerpiece may be an uncut portion of the main food item.
 Slices or serving portions of the main food item, arrange artistically.
 Garnish, arranged artistically in proportion to the cut slices.
2. The food should be easy to handle and serve, so one portion can be
removed without ruining the arrangement.
3. Simple arrangements are easier to serve, and more likely to be still
attractive when they are half demolished by the guests
LM-Cookery Grade 10
366
4. Attractive platter are made of metals, mirrors, china, plastic or woods,
presentable and suitable for use with food.
5 .It must look attractive and appropriate not only by itself, but among other
presentations on the table.
How to Present Food on a Plate
When you're plating food, the goal is to create a dining experience that
tempts all of the senses, not just the palate. When food looks appetizing the
body actually produces more fluids that aid in nutrient absorption - so you
might even say that beautiful food is more wholesome than food that doesn't
look appealing. To achieve restaurant-quality presentation, start with brightly-
colored, well-cooked food. Layer the food and play with contrasting colors and
textures to increase its visual appeal. Finally, garnish the plate with flavorful
herbs or spices to take it to the next level. See Step 1 and beyond to learn
how to make the next meal you will cook look irresistible.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
367
Starting With Beautiful Food
Avoid a monochromatic color scheme. A plate
appealing when there's a high level of contrast in colors.
of food looks most
 When you're planning meals, think ahead about the colors you want to
feature on the plate. You might not be able to represent all the colors of
the rainbow at every meal, but challenge yourself to have as much color
as possible.
 If you're about to serve several like-colored foods, like grilled chicken
and mashed potatoes, adding a serving or two of fruits and vegetables
is a fantastic and easy way to add pops of color. The richest greens,
oranges, reds, purples, blues, pinks and yellows on your plate probably
take the form of fruits and vegetables.
 If you're not sure how to add color, utilize garnishes. Nearly any savory
dish is well-served by a sprinkling of fresh chives, parsley, dill, or mint.
Lemon and lime wedges are welcome alongside poultry and seafood
dishes.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
368
Bring out vegetables' brightest colors. The way you cook your vegetables
has a lot of bearing on the overall visual effect of a meal
 Lightly steam instead of boiling. Steaming vegetables makes them look
appetizing and flavorful, while boiling creates the opposite effect.
 Roast or sauté them with a little oil or butter. Roasted or sautéed
vegetables look quite appetizing when they're allowed to caramelize a
little in oil or butter.
Sear your meat and let it rest. Many meat dishes look most appetizing when
the meat has been seared. The sight of a steak or piece of grilled salmon with
a brown, crispy sear will make your dinner guests' mouths start to water. In
addition to searing your meat, you should let it rest for several minutes before
cutting it. This allows the juices to absorb back into the meat, so that they don't
end up running all over the plate.
 There are exceptions to the rule of searing your meat. For example, if
you're serving braised beef, you'll have to think of creative ways to
make the meat look appetizing even though it doesn't have a crispy
crust. Serving it with a sauce is a good way to add visual interest.
Cook fried foods carefully. Underdone or overcooked fried foods are
difficult to present in an appealing way. Fried foods can look beautiful
on a plate, but it's important to fry them well and have a plan for dealing
with the oil so it doesn't muck up the rest of the dish. Cook fried foods
until they're golden brown, then let them drain on a plate lined with
paper towels to absorb the extra oil. Otherwise, the food will leave
streaks of grease on the plates.
 Fried foods often continue browning a bit after they've been removed
from the hot oil.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
369
Take texture into account. Texture and color go hand in hand when it
comes to how appetizing food looks on the plate. If your food looks too
oily, too dry, mushy, tough, or otherwise difficult to chew and swallow,
it won't matter how perfectly colorful it looks. Take pains to cook food
well so that it comes out to the right texture.
 The way you handle the food just after it has been cooked, and before it
is plated, can really affect the texture. Pasta, for example, should be
kept in water or tossed in a bit of oil just after cooking so that it doesn't
start to clump. Fried foods should not be covered with airtight lids,
because the heat from the food will end up steaming the breading and
causing the food to get soggy.
 Once the food is on the plate, a spritz of oil or water can improve its
visual appeal if it looks too dry.
Experiment with interesting shapes.
 Cutting vegetables in interesting shapes can make the simple become
special. You can cook and serve vegetables, desserts, pot pies and
other foods inside unique-shaped dishes to create attractive shapes.
Plating it with Care
•When in doubt, choose white plates. White plates don't compete
visually with the food you're serving. They provide contrast, making
colors appear brighter and textures more interesting. . If you have a set
of special plates with a pattern or a certain color scheme, it's fine to use
LM-Cookery Grade 10
370
them. Just make sure they complement the food you're serving instead
of vying for attention.
•Don't forget to take the rest of the table into consideration, too. Cutlery,
glasses and linens will enhance the overall appearance of the dish upon
the table.
Visualize the finished plate.
 Consider how to present the main portion in relation to the side dishes.
Consider where it will look best on the plate with the other elements of
the dish. Consider also how to get best impact––the appearance and
symmetry are all affected by whether the food is sliced thinly, thickly or
left whole.
Limit portion sizes.
 Only fill about two thirds of each plate with food. The rest of the plate
should be left empty. The negative space will provide contrast with the
food, making it look more appetizing. If the plate is loaded with food, the
food itself won't look as visually pleasing. Keep standard serving sizes
in mind and aim to serve just the right amount of each part of the dish.
 As a general rule, half of the food on the plate should comprise of
vegetables, one fourth meat or another protein, and one fourth starch.
 Start plating food in the center of the dish and work outward from there,
so that the food is centered in the middle of the plate.
Follow the rule of odds.
 Having an odd number of elements on a dish is more visually appealing
than having an even number. It creates the impression that piece of
food is being framed by the others. Keep this in mind whether you're
LM-Cookery Grade 10
371
serving different types of food or more than one piece of the same food.
For example, if you're serving scallops, serve either 3 or 5 instead of 4.
Play with different textures
 Creating a texture contrast is a good way to draw the eye. Too many
soft or crunchy foods on a plate are unappealing, but a combination of
both is delicious. Different textures harmonize to create a pleasing
dining experience. Leaving one of the elements out would result in a
less appealing dish.
 To quickly add some crunch to a dish, try topping it with some crushed,
roasted walnuts and almonds
Layer foods to add height.
 It's common to see food layering in restaurants, but home cooks don't
usually try it. Adding height to a dish can take it from ordinary to
stunning. Don't be afraid to show off your culinary skills by using
stacking and layering methods to make your presentation more
professional.
 An easy way to start layering food is to serve the protein on a bed of
starch. For example, serve a kabob on a heap of rice, or serve grilled
swordfish on a pile of mashed potatoes.
 Aim to make foods look bigger, not smaller. Fluff up your salads. For
example, instead of smooching them down. Create a little cross-
hatched stack of cooked asparagus instead of presenting it in one flat
layer.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
372
Use sauce wisely
 If you're serving a curry, stew or soupy casserole, you might want to
drain the food of its sauce before serving, then pour on just the right
amount when you plate the dish. That way you can control the amount
of sauce and use it to make the dish look decorative.
Keep up with food styling trends.
 Remember that styles change even within the space of a few years or
even months, so keep up-to-date by checking out cooking magazines,
cooking or foodie websites and cooking shows for current ideas.
Adding Appetizing Touches
Use garnishes that enhance the flavor of the meal. No matter what
you're serving, make sure the garnish actually makes the dish better
instead of just cluttering up the plate.
Employ drizzles and swirls.
 Another way to finish food is with a drizzle or swirl of a concentrated
sauce or liquid. For savory dishes, this might be a small squeeze of
remoulade, pesto, or flavored oil. For sweet dishes, adding chocolate
sauce, fruit jam, or crème anglaise might be the most delicious way to
add that finishing touch.
 Rather than just pouring a sauce over your food, consider putting it in a
squeeze bottle so you can create a pretty swirl or pattern. If you don't
LM-Cookery Grade 10
373
have a squeeze bottle, put the sauce in a plastic food storage bag, cut a
small piece off one of the corners, and squeeze the sauce through the
bag.
 Don't overdo it. The key is to add a touch of color, flavor and texture
without overpowering the main part of the dish.
Make sure the plate is clean
 Examine the edges of the plate for fingerprints and smudges. A great
way to clean up the edges of a plate is to dip a paper towel in a cup of
water with a dash of white vinegar. Wipe the rim of the plate so that no
food residue or prints are visible. This gives your presentation a
professional touch.
The 5 Basic Elements of Plating
1. Create a Framework
Start with drawings and sketches to visualize the plate. Find inspiration
from a picture or object. Assemble a ‗practice‘ plate to work on executing
your vision.
2. Keep It Simple
Select one ingredient to focus on and use space to simplify the
presentation. Clutter distracts from the main elements of your dish that
might confuse the diners on what to focus on.
3. Balance the Dish
Play with colors, shapes and textures to ensure diners are not
overwhelmed. The presentation should never overpower flavor and
function.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
374
4. Get the Right Portion Size
Ensure that there is the right amount of ingredients and the plate
complements the dish, not too big or too small. Strike the right proportion of
protein, carbohydrates and vegetables to create a nutritionally balanced
meal.
5. Highlight the Key Ingredient
Ensure that the main ingredient stands out and pay equal attention to
the ‗support‘. This refers to the other elements on the plate such as
garnishes, sauces and even the plate itself.
Review of Learning Outcome 3
Direction: Select the best answer. Write only the letter on your answer sheet
1. In platter presentation uncut portion of the main food item is
A. garnish B. serving portions C. centerpiece
2. It is arranged artistically in proportion to the cut slices.
A. slices B. serving portions C. garnish
3. The food should be easy to handle and
A. garnish B. serve C. arrangement
4. Use attractive platter presentation made of metals, mirrors, plastic or
wood, and
A. china B. pan C. platter
5. The act of serving or arranging portions of the main food item
artistically.
A. slicing B. garnishing C. setting
LM-Cookery Grade 10
375
Learning Outcome 4 Store meat
Methods of Preserving Meat
There are different methods of preserving meat. These include drying
or dehydration, smoking, salting, curing, refrigerating, freezing, canning and
freeze drying.
A. Drying – This is the most common method of preserving meat. Drying
involves the reduction of the original 70% of water content of the meat
to about 15%. The removal of the moisture content does three things,
namely:
 Enzymatic changes are retarded;
 Growth of microorganisms is much hampered
 Microbes lose water and become inert.
Ways of Drying Meat
1. Natural sun drying – Natural sunlight is used to reduce the
amount of moisture content of meat. Portable solar dyers can
provide sanitary means of drying meat. Dryers with screen
covers are recommended for outdoor use and lengthens the
storage life of meat
2. Dehydration or artificial drying – Oven is used for drying the
meat. Although this is more expensive than sun drying,
dehydration is a more efficient method of removing moisture
from meat. Products dried in this way are of higher quality and
can be sold at better prices.
B. Smoking – Meat is smoked to create a distinctive color and flavor,
thus helping its preservation. The flavor, color, and attractive glaze on
the surface of the meat is desired like in ham, bacon, and tinapA. The
heat generated during smoking destroys the enzymes and dries the
product artificially, thus preventing the growth of molds and vegetative
bacteria on the surface. Cold and hot smoking are the two types of
smoking. Smoked meats include ham, bacon, and chicken.
 Cold Smoking – The temperature is held between 26 to 43ºC
and the products are smoked over a period of days or weeks.
The products thus pick up a strong smoked flavor and are
dehydrated as well.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
376
 Hot Smoking – The temperature is higher, from 71 to
79ºC.The high temperature speed up the drying process, giving
the product a mild smoked flavor.
2. Salting – Salt improves the keeping quality of meat. It removes
the water from the tissue of the meat and the cells of spoilage
organisms that may be present in the meat.
C. Curing – In this method, salt, sugar, potassium or sodium nitrate, and
other curing elements such as ascorbic acid, phosphate blend, and
spices are used to prolong the keeping quality of meat. Curing agents
also help improve the flavor and appearance of meat and retain its
original color. Sugar minimizes the hardness of the straight cure
process. It also makes the product more appetizing and provides
energy to the nitrate-reducing bacteria which gives the red color.
Spices give the desired flavor and aroma.
D. Refrigerating – Meat is stored at a temperature range of 2 to 10ºC to
retard mold and bacterial growth for a limited period.
E. Freezing – Meat is preserved at a temperature of 10ºC and below.
Freezing deactivates enzymes and bacteria. Meat can be preserved
for two months to one year using this method.
F. Canning – Meat preserved by canning is packed in sealed cans or
jars which are subjected to a temperature of 100ºC and above 5-7 kilo
pressured for a specific period of time. This process destroys the
organism that causes spoilage. It maintains the high quality of meat
product and extends its life for about a year.
G. Freeze Drying – The process involves the removal of moisture from
the meat tissues by transforming the moisture content into ice and
gas. The product to be dried is first frozen and the ice is sublimed
from the frozen mass, removing 98% of the water content. The
remaining moisture is further reduced to 0.5% or lower by subjecting
the product to high temperature as possible without destroying it.
The texture, appearance, flavor, and nutritive value of freeze
dried products are comparable to frozen foods. The products have a
long shelf life and require no refrigeration. This method needs special
equipment such as modern freeze dryer.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
377
Evaluating the Quality of Preserved Meat Products
Good quality pork has less than 1 ¼ cm of golden brown fat that
covers the surface of the meat and a thoroughly cooked interior where meat
has even pinkish color. It has also a juicy and tender texture, a pleasing
aroma and a tender seasoned and pleasing taste with a slight hint of smoky
flavor.
Sausages of good quality are uniform in size and length. Each
sausage in a whole piece has no rupture of casing even when pricked. The
interior has a pinkish color when thoroughly cooked. A combination of juicy
meat with spicy seasoning marks their flavor.
Proper Storage of Preserved Meat
Many processed items prepared for future use may be stored in the
freezer. These should be wrapped in plastic or foil to prevent the occurrence
of freezer burn and avoid having a pulpy texture that comes from loss of
moisture. Each item should be labeled with the name of the product, date of
expiry, and quantity.
Processed food held in storage should be well-covered or wrapped to keep
them from absorbing odors and flavors from other foods. They should be held
below danger zone temperatures. Processed meat should be packed in
desired and easy to thaw market units. Thawing a 25kilo pack of ground
meat, for example, will be difficult. Systematic freezing of food in quantity for
long-term storage requires special freezing equipment.
Food Storage Chart
Food
Suggested
Maximum
Temperature (ºC.
Recommended Maximum
Storage
Canned Products
Frozen Products
beef poultry
Fresh Pork
(not ground)
Sausage,
ground meat
Cold cuts, Sliced
Cured bacon
21
-18 to -29
-18 to 29
18 to 29
3 to 4
3 to 4
12 months
6–12 months, in original package
3-6 months, in original package
1-3 months, in original package
3-5 days, in semi-moisture proof
paper
1-4 weeks, tightly wrapped
LM-Cookery Grade 10
378
Ham (tender
cured)
Ham (Canned)
Dried Beef
3 to 4
3 to 4
3 to 4
1-6 weeks, tightly wrapped
6 weeks, in original container
(unopened)
6 weeks, tightly wrapped
Most canned foods can be stored at room temperature in a cold place
and hold their eating quality for several months. They are safe to eat as long
as there is no bulge on the can. Below 24ºC is a good temperature for
storage. Canned ham and other perishable meats should be stored in the
refrigerator unless storage recommendations on the can state otherwise.
These meats should not be frozen.
Hygiene Practices in Storing Meat products
To achieve high standards of sanitation, the following measures should be
strictly observed:
1. See to it that physical equipment and layout are conducive to
sanitary practices.
2. Handle, store, and refrigerate food properly to prevent spoilage and
contamination.
3. Safeguard the food during distribution and service.
4. Wash and sanitize dishes, glasses, utensils, and equipment.
5. Clean floors walls, ceilings, counters, tables, and chairs regularly.
6. Eliminate vermin and rodents from food areas.
7. Maintain adequate employer supervision and a constant program of
education in sanitation for food service workers.
8. Make sure that food service employees are in good health, and are
not carriers of communicable diseases. The three principal groups
of communicable diseases that must be guarded against in public
feeding operations are respiratory, intestinal, and skin diseases.
Require medical examinations for food service employees.
9. Provide a regular employee education on food service sanitation.
Techniques in storing meat
Storage Procedures for Meat Products
Safe Storage - Meat is among the most perishable foods. This perishable
ability makes it a potentially hazardous food. At ambient temperatures, meat
spoils so fast. It is therefore necessary to keep it in chilled storage.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
379
Storing - take time to store the food items. Store new purchases
behind old ones and always use the old stock first. It is easy to put new
purchases at the front. However, older stocks are overlooked and thus cause
spoilage. These may include cereal and cereal products, sweeteners, oils,
seasonings, and unopened cans and jars.Do not use kitchen cabinets above
the refrigerator, stove, or oven for food storage.
Never use the area under the sink for storing food because openings
around water and drain pipes are impossible to seal. Pipes may leak and
damage the food.
If you reuse glass jars, wash them thoroughly, wipe, and air-dry before
using. This helps remove any trace of odors that may remain.
1. Refrigerator storage. A refrigerator provides cold temperature for
storing perishable foods such as dairy products, meat, fish, poultry,
eggs, fruits, and vegetables.
Protein foods should be stored in the coldest part of the
refrigerator. Fruits and vegetables can be stored in less cold sections
or in a special compartment such as the crisper.
If refrigerated foods are not properly wrapped, they will dry out
and lose nutrients and flavor. Food should be well covered with plastic,
foil or wax paper, or should be put in tightly covered containers. Garlic
and sausages are strong-flavored foods and should be wrapped tightly
in plastic or foil and stored in an air-tight container to prevent the
transfer of aromas to other foods.
2. Freezer storage. For proper freezing and storage, the temperature
inside the freezer should be 18ºC or lower.
Store frozen foods in their original packages. Foods to be frozen
should be put in moisture-vapor proof wrapping.
If plastic containers are used, allow about 2.5 cm of headspace
at the top between the food and the lid so the food can expand when if
freezes.
Thaw frozen foods in the refrigerator. Do not allow food to thaw
at room temperature. At this point, microorganisms will begin to grow.
Our sanitary laws and regulations are so designed to safeguard
and promote health.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
380
Bacteria are all around us, but they are so small that they
cannot be seen by the naked eye. There are hundreds of different
kinds of bacteria. Some harmless bacteria are useful and necessary
such as those essential in preparing cheese. Other bacteria are
essential in agriculture and industry. However, many types of bacteria
are dangerous and cause diseases if allowed to multiply and be
transmitted to humans.
Food contaminated with bacteria can make people sick. Some
of the common illnesses are salmonellosis, perfringens poisoning,
staphylococcal poisoning, and botulism.
Sanitation is the best preventive measure against food-borne
diseases. Sanitation means keeping bacteria out of food through
personal hygiene and proper handling procedures. It also means
keeping the food at proper temperatures so bacteria already present
do not have much chance to multiply.
Bacteria enter food in two ways. Some are naturally present in
food when you buy it. Others get in because of careless handling when
food is prepared and served. Bacteria cannot travel by themselves;
they are carried about by people, animals, and insects as well as
objects. Salmonella bacteria, for instance, can be found in food such
as raw meat, poultry, eggs, and dairy products. From these foods, the
bacteria contaminate other foods in the kitchen.
Staphylococcus bacteria are found not only in raw meat but in
food handlers with poor personal hygiene. The bacteria from food
handlers can be transmitted to the food through sneezing and
coughing.
Bacteria thrive on food, moisture, and the right temperature in
order to grow. With careless handling these growing conditions can
occur in any kitchen
LM-Cookery Grade 10
381
PORK TOCINO
Standard recipe developed by Calamba Manpower
TOOLS AND
EQUIPMENT
INGRIDIENTS
QUANTITY DESCRIPTION
knife
chopping board
mortar and pestle
strainer
measuring cup
measuring spoon
wooden spoon
mixing bowl
1 k
1 tbsp.
½ tsp.
1 tbsp.
¼ cup
Second mixture
1 cup
2 tbsp.
2 tbsp.
1 tsp
¼ cup
2 tsp.
1 tsp
Pork , slice thinly
salt
curing salt
phosphate
water
sugar
Garlic
Anisado wine or Rhum
Meat enhancer (optional)
Pineapple juice
Oyster sauce
Worcestershire sauce
PROCEDURE:
1. In a bowl, combine all ingredients for the 1st mixture together. Set
aside.
2. On another bowl, mix all ingredients for the 2nd mixture.
3. Combine 1st and 2nd mixture
4. Pack it by 250 grams.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
382
Posttest
Directions: Read the following statements/questions carefully and choose the
letter with the correct answer. Write your answer in your test note book.
1. What animal produces veal meat?
A. calf
B. deer
C. hog
D. sheep
2. Which of the following market forms of meat does not undergo chilling?
A. cured meat
B. fresh meat
C. frozen meat
D. processed meat
3. What part of the meat helps you identify the less tender cuts?
A. bone
B. fat
C. flesh
D. ligament
4. What part of the meat has the greatest amount of quality protein?
A. Bone
B. Fat
C. Flesh
D. Ligament
5. Which of the following meat cuts requires long and slow cooking
temperature?
A. less tender C. tender
B. slightly tough D. tough
6. What is a long – bladed hatchet or a heavy knife used by a butcher?
A. butchers knife
B. chopper knife
C. cleaver knife
D. set of slicing knife
LM-Cookery Grade 10
383
7. Which of the cooking methods does not belong to dry heat method?
A. baking
B. broiling
C. roasting
D. stewing
8. What do you call the cooking method when meat is cooked in steaming
liquid, and bubbles are breaking on the surface?
A. boiling
B. broiling
C. roasting
D. stewing
9. What is an oil-acid mixture which is used to enhance the flavor of
meat.
A. brine solution
B. marinade
C. soy sauce and vinegar
D. salt and calamansi
10. Which of the following tools is used for carving?
A. cleaver knife
B. fork
C. slicer
D. razor knife
11. To which meat cut do internal organs belong?
A. less tender cuts
B. tender cuts
C. tough cuts
D. variety cuts
12. Where should meat products be stored?
A. crisper
B. cold shelf
C. dry shelf
D. freezer
13. Which of the following is the tenderest cut of beef?
A. chunk
B. round cut
C. sirloin
D. tenderloin
14. When buying meat, what should you first consider?
A. brand
B. price
C. quality
D. round cut
LM-Cookery Grade 10
384
15. What is your primary consideration when storing goods?
A. expiration date
B. fragility
C. quantity
D. size
16. These are taken from the internal organs of animals.
A. less tender cuts
B. tender cuts
C. tough cuts
D. variety cuts
17. A slaughtered animal is called .
A. a carabeef
B. a carcass
C. a pork
D. a poultry
18. The most common method of preserving meat is .
A. Curing
B. drying
C. refrigerating
D. salting
19. In this method, salt, sugar, potassium or sodium nitrate etc. are used in
preserving meat by drying
A. curing
B. dehydration
C. freezing
D. salting
20. The following are the characteristics of good quality pork, except .
A. breast is plump
B. flesh is pink
C. no foul odor
D. texture is fine and firm
21. A tool used for cutting through bones.
A. butcher knife
B. chef knife
C. cleaver
D. utility knife
22. Used for carving and slicing cooked meats.
A. butcher knife
B. chef knife
C. slicer
D. utility knife
LM-Cookery Grade 10
385
23. A knife used for general purposes.
A. Butcher knife
B. Chef knife
C. Cleaver
D. Utility knife
24. It is used in carving roasts chicken and duck.
A. Carving knife
B. Cleaver knife
C. Slicer
D. Utility knife
25. Used for cutting, trimming raw meats.
A. butcher knife
B. chef knife
C. cleaver
D. utility knife
26. Meat of swine is called:
A. Beef
B. Carabeef
C. Chevon
D. Pork
27. Veal is the meat of:
A. Cattle over 1 year old
B. Goat
C. Sheep
D. Young calf
28. Deer meat is called:
A. Beef
B. Carabeef
C. Chevon
D. Pork
29. Meat of cattle over 1 year old
A. Beef
B. Carabeef
C. Pork
D. Chevon
30. Meat of sheep is called:
A. Lamb
B. Carabeef
C. Pork
D. Chevon
LM-Cookery Grade 10
386
A. Multiple Choice.
Directions: Read the following questions carefully and choose the
letter that best describes the statement. Write your answer on your
test notebook.
1. Which of the following sources of starch is rarely used in manufacturing
food starch?
A. Cassava C. Potato
B. Corn D. Rice
2. Which of the following starch properties/reactions is the resistance to flow;
increase in thickness or consistency.
A. Dextrinization C. Retrogadation
B. Gelatinization D. Viscosity
3. Which of the following is suggested if you will hold pasta for a short time
for later service?
A. Cook pasta ahead of time and chilled
B. Drain and add sauce
C. Drain, toss with a small amount of oil, cover and hold in warmer
D. Slightly undercook the pasta
4. Which is the process of making a new product to be sold to the customers.
A. Product Analysis C. Product Development
B. Product Conceptualization D. Product Implementation
5. Which is a meaningful and unforgettable statement that captures the
essence of your brand.
A. Branding C. Tagline
B. Product Naming D. Unique Selling Proposition
6. What managerial tool is used to assess the environment to gather
important information used for strategic planning.
A. Environmental Scanning C.Survey Analysis
B. SWOT Analysis D.WOTS Analysis
LM-Cookery Grade 10
387
7. Which of the following are the right step by step procedures in manual
dishwashing?
A. Drain and air-dry, scrape and pre-rinse, rinse, sanitize, and wash
dishes.
B. Rinse, scrape and pre-rinse, wash, drain, air-dry and sanitize dishes
C. Scrape and pre-rinse, rinse, wash, sanitize, drain and air-dry dishes
D. Scrape and pre-rinse, wash, rinse, sanitize, drain and air-dry dishes
8. Which of the following parts of an egg is produced by the oviduct and
consist of four alternating layers of thick and thin consistencies.
A. Air cell C. Chalaza
B. Albumen D. Yolk
9. Egg contains high quality protein with all the essential amino acids. Which
of the following vitamins not found in eggs?
A. B1 C. D
B. C D. K
10. The appearance of egg is important for consumer appeal. How are egg
shells evaluated?
A. cleanliness, shape, texture and soundness
B. grade, texture, cleanliness, shape
C. shape, texture, cleanliness and size
D. texture, soundness, size and cleanliness
11. Which of the following market forms of eggs is seldom used in cooking.
A. Dried egg C. Frozen egg
B. Fresh egg D. Shelled egg
12. Which of the following raises coagulation temperature producing softer,
weaker gel when added to egg used in culinary.
A. Alkali C. Sugar
B. Salt D. Vinegar
13. What kind of egg dish is prepared by slipping shelled eggs into barely
simmering water and gently cooking until the egg holds its shape?
A. Fried egg C. Scrambled egg
B. Poached egg D. Soft-boiled egg
14. Which of the following tools is not used in cooking omelet?
A. Bowls C. Sauté pan
B. Fork D. Skimmer
15. Which of the following is true in plating egg dishes?
A. Choose serving dish small enough to let each food item stand out
B. Play with color and texture
C. Protein dish should cover half of the plate
D. Use even numbers in setting the dish.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
388
16. What animal produces veal meat?
A. Calf C. Hog
B. Deer D. Sheep
17. Which of the following market forms of meat does not undergo chilling?
A. Cured meat
B. Fresh meat
C. Frozen meat
D. Processed meat
18. What part of the meat helps you identify the less tender cuts?
A. Bone
B. Fat
C. Flesh
D. Ligament
19. What part of the meat has the greatest amount of quality protein?
A. Bone
B. Fat
C. Flesh
D. Ligament
20. Which of the following meat cuts requires long and slow cooking
temperature?
A. Less tender C. Tender
B. Slightly tough D. Tough
21. What do you call the young immature pigeon of either sex with extra
tender meat?
A. Duck C. Rooster
B. Fryer D. Squab
22. What part of poultry does breast meat belongs?
A. Dark meat C. Variety meat
B. Tough meat D. White meat
23. Which of the following characteristics is a good quality of a live poultry?
A. Free from pin feathers and shows no cuts
B. Eyes are clear
C. Skin is heavy and watery
D. Thighs well develop
24. What do you call young chicken that is usually 9 to 12 weeks of age?
A. Fryer C. Roaster
B. Hen D. Stag
25. How many days should a whole chicken be refrigerated?
A. 1 day C. 2 to 4 days
B. 1 to 2 days D. 3 to 4 days
LM-Cookery Grade 10
389
26. How do you classify fleshy part of chicken like breast?
A. Entrails C. Viscera
B. Dark meat D. White meat
27. What cookery method is used for a matured poultry?
A. Boiling C. Roasting
B. Frying D. Stewing
28. What cookery method is suitable for the less tender cuts?
A. Boiling C. Roasting
B. Frying D. Stewing
29. What is the best cooking temperature for poultry?
A. High temperature C. Low to moderate temperature
B. Low temperature D. Moderate temperature
30. What factor affects the poultry meat‘s tenderness and juiciness?
A. Age C. Cuts
B. Cookery D. Sex
31. What do you call a long – bladed hatchet or a heavy knife used by a
butcher?
A. Butchers knife
B. Chopper knife
C. Cleaver knife
D. Set of slicing knife
32. Which of the cooking methods does not belong to dry heat method?
A. Baking
B. Broiling
C. Roasting
D. Stewing
33. What do you call the cooking method when meat is cooked in steaming
liquid and bubbles are breaking on the surface?
A. Boiling
B. Broiling
C. Roasting
D. Stewing
34. What is an oil-acid mixture which is use to enhance the flavor of meat.
A. Brine solution
B. Marinade
C .Soy sauce and vinegar
D. Salt and calamansi
LM-Cookery Grade 10
390
35. Which of the following tools is used for carving?
A. Cleaver knife
B. Fork
C. Slicer
D. Razor knife
36. To which meat cut do internal organs belong?
A. Less tender cuts
B. Tender cuts
C.Tough cuts
D.Variety cuts
37. Where should meat products be stored?
A. Crisper
B. Cold shelf
C. Dry shelf
D. Freezer
38. Which of the following is the tenderest cut of beef?
A. Chunk
B. Round cut
C. Sirloin
D. Tenderloin
39. When buying meat, what should you first consider?
A. Brand
B. Price
C. Quality
D. Round cut
40. What is your primary consideration when storing goods?
A. Expiration date
B. Fragility
C. Quantity
D. Size
41. What is the flavor component of vegetables which gives strong flavor and
odor to some vegetables like onions, leeks, garlic, chives, cabbage, and
broccoli?
A. Flavonoids C. Sugar
C. Glutamic acid D. Sulfur compounds
42. Which is a way of cooking by placing blanched or raw vegetables in the
pan, adding liquid (stock, water, wine) then covering and cooking it slowly?
A. Boiling C. Braising
B. Baking D. Sautéing
LM-Cookery Grade 10
391
43. Which of the following plating styles is not a classic arrangement?
A. The starch or vegetable item is heaped in the center while the main
item is sliced and leaned up against it.
B. The main item is in the center, with vegetable distributed around it.
C. The vegetable item is in front and main item, starch item and
garnish at the rear.
D. The main item is in the center with neat piles of vegetables carefully
arranged around.
44. Which of the following vegetables is cooked uncovered?
A. Fruit vegetables C. Roots and tubers
B. Green vegetables D. Yellow vegetables
45. Which of the following is a freshwater fish?
A. Bluefish C. Grouper
B. Cat fish D. Sole
46. Which is the market form of fish where both sides of a fish are still joined
but bones are removed?
A. Butterfly C. Fillet
B. Drawn D. Steak
47. Which of the following is a characteristic of a fresh fish?
A. Fresh and foul odor
B. Eyes are dull, shiny and bulging
C. Red or pink gills
D. Flesh shrinks when pressed
48. Which of the following seafood is cooked just enough to heat to keep juicy
and plump?
A. Fat fish C. Flat fish
B. lean fish D. Shellfish
49. What is the cooking method suited to fat fish?
A. Baking C. Deep -frying
B. Boiling D. Sautéing
50. What is used to baste lean fish to help prevent from drying up?
A. Butter C. Soy sauce
B. Cream D. Tomato sauce
LM-Cookery Grade 10
392
SYNTHESIS
Over the past years, a transition in cooking and food preparation skills
has been observed. This transition in cooking and food preparation skills
involves the increased use of readily prepared or cooked food, which require
less preparation and time than the traditional way of cooking. But cooking is
an expression of creativity, happiness, magic, and culture. The satisfaction
gained by the chef and other persons preparing, cooking, serving and storing
the food is unquestionable; not to mention the pleasure it gives to the
customer.
Different food products may come and go but the demand for food
cooked in traditional way, in restaurants, food chains, and others is
indispensable. Varieties of foods such as egg, cereal and starch, vegetables,
seafood, red meat, poultry dishes and also stocks, soups and sauces are still
made available to meet the customer‘s satisfaction.
Taste is not the only sense that can motivate customers but touch also
play with contrasts of temperatures and textures, and so with smell and sight
for colors, shapes and others, whereby the five senses become one of the
main points of reference in the creative cooking process.
Now, if you have a passion for delicious food and love for cooking gain
applicable and practical guidance that will teach you to become successful
chef or businessman in the field of cookery someday.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
393
GLOSSARY
aromatic– having a smell of fragrant spicy
béchamel sauce – a white sauce made of cream, butter, flour and flavored
with onion and seasoning.
Birefringence - When starch granules are viewed under the microscope
using polarized light, they exhibit a phenomenon known
as birefringence. The refraction of polarized light by the
intact crystalline regions in starch give characteristic
"Maltese cross" patterns on each granule. The
disappearance of these crosses on heating a starch
suspension can be used to determine gelatinization
temperature.
bouillon – a clear soup from beef, chicken, and other meat.
broth – a fluid food made by boiling meat and vegetable in water
butcher – a person who slaughters animals for food
chowder – a soup usually of clams or fish, stewed vegetables often
in milk.
clarification – to make or become clear
coating – to cover with flour
combine– to mix the ingredients in the bowl
consommé – a clear soup made of meat and sometimes vegetables
boiled in water.
contamination – unintended presence of harmful substances or disease
causing microorganisms in food
damp - moist slightly wet
LM-Cookery Grade 10
394
dark meat- the dark meat parts which include the legs, drumstick,
wings and neck.
decomposition – the state of being rotten or spoiled
dressed - slaughtered birds that have been bled, defeathered and
the organs are removed
drip – to fall or let fall in drops
drippings- the juice that drips from roasting or baking meat or a
sauce made from it.
entrails- the animals internal organs such as liver, heart and
gizzard
entrees – main course
foodhandling – any operation in the production, preparation, processing,
packaging, storage, transport, distribution and sale of
food
freeze– to preserve meat by refrigeration below freezing point
frozen – subject to long and serve cold, chilly or cold manner
fumet – the savory color of meat while cooking
games – birds that are hunted for food.
Haugh – unit for describing egg freshness, based on the thickness
of the albumen
Leavener - substances that are used to make bread and other baked
goods rise
marinade – an oil-acid mixture used to give flavor and to tenderize
meat.
mirepoix – a mixture of vegetable, herbs, and spices with or without
meat, used to enhance flavor of meat, fish and shell fish.
perishable food – subject to decay or spoilage
LM-Cookery Grade 10
395
pheasant– long tailed domesticated bird
plump – fleshy
poach – to cook food in hot liquid in such a manner that it
retains its original shape
portion- a part of whole or to divide into parts
processed food – meat processed by curing ingredients
quality – characteristics
reconstitute– to add appropriate amount of water to sauce or
soup.
roux- a melted butter mixed with brown flour for
thickening soup and grains.
sanitation – keeping the food equipment, utensils, and work
area clean.
.sauce – a thickened liquid used to flavor and enhance
other food
savory – a hardy, annual aromatic culinary herb of the mint
family
scum – a firmly layer of impure matters on the surface of a
liquid
seasoning – a spice for enhancing the flavor of food
simmer – to cook very gently in water just below the boiling
point
skim – to remove floating water from the surface with a
ladle
slaughter – to butcher an animal for food.
spice- an aromatic, pungent vegetable substance used to
flavor food and beverages.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
396
spoilage – to become rotten or decayed
stew – to simmer or boil in a small quantity of liquid.
Stock- a liquid in which meat fish and sometimes vegetables
have been cooked
storage– a space for storing
stripped off - to remove or to take away
suitable– appropriate
tender cut– part of meat that requires less period of cooking
thaw – to change from a frozen solid to a liquid by gradual
warming.
tough cut– part of meat that requires longer period of cooking
veloutes – a rich white sauce made by thickening chicken or veal
stock with flour and water.
vermin– various small animals or insects such as rats or
cockroaches that are destructive, annoying or hazardous
to health.
wastage - loss by use
white meat- includes the white, fleshy part of the chicken such as the
breast.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
397
REFERENCE
Food service and Catering Management: A Practical Guide
Copyright Liberty Commodities Corporation., 2004
ANVIL Publishing Incorporated
8007-B Pioneer Street., Barangay Kapitoloyo, Pasig City 1603 Philippines
Editing by Rory C. Subida pp. 1- 19, 57 – 58
Managing A Food – Safe Kitchen
A Guide On Sanitation For Food Service Professionals
The Maya Kitchen Culinary Arts Center
Copyright Liberty Commodities Corp., 2007
Published and Exclusively Distributed by
ANVIL PUBLISHING, INC.
8007-B Pioneer St., Brgy. Kapitoloyo
Pasig City 1603, Philippines
www.anvil.anvilpublishing.com
Edited by Rory C. Subida pp. 33 – 37
Chavez, Libia L., et.al., (2006). Basic Foods for Filipinos, 4th edition. Copyright by
Merriam and Webbster Bookstore, InC. pp. 299 – 322
Practical Technology and Home Economics
Home Economics III
Rojo. Duran. Cruz. Marquez.Agustin. SilvA. Reyes. Quitoriano. Bautista
Philippine copyright 1998 by Adriana Publishing p. 103
http://www.fnri.dost.gov.ph/index.php?option=content&task=view&id=916
Copyright © 2008 FNRI-DOST. All Rights ReserveD.
Updated January 2014
DOST Compound, Bicutan, Taguig City
Tel. Nos. (02) 837-2934/837-3164
Catch That Daily Egg Habit
FNRI DIGEST
Written by ADORACION U. MONDALA, Supervising Science Research
Specialist
The Professional Chef 8th Edition
The Culinary Institute of America
Copyright 2006 by The Culinary Institute of America
p. 290
LM-Cookery Grade 10
398
Competency-based Learning Materials
Food Trades Level III
Fourth Year
PUBLIC TECHNICAL-VOCATIONAL HIGH SCHOOLS
Department of Education
Republic of the Philippines
http://startcooking.com/seven-ways-to-present-food-like-a-chef
Seven Ways to Present Food Like a Chef
posted in Around the Kitchen
by Emily Chapelle
https://www.incredibleegg.org/health-and-nutrition/egg-nutrients/nutrient-chart
Handbook on Food Safety in Schools, Health and Nutrition Center,
Department of Education
http://www.eggs.ca/eggs101/view/39/egg-storage-freshness-and-food-safety
Eggs 101
Filter by Category
Egg Storage, Freshness & Food Safety
http://eu.foodinnovation.com/dictionary/B.asp
The National Starch Food Innovation Logo is a trademark of National
Starch LLC
All rights reserveD. All contents Copyright © 2014
Carson, Byrta, M.S., et.al., How you Plan and Prepare Meals, Third edition
copyright 1980 by McGraw-Hill, InC. pp. 353 -363
Bennion, Marion and Scheule, Barbara, Introductory Foods, Twelfth Edition
Copyright 2004 by Pearson education, InC., Upper Saddle River, New Jersey
http://fooD.oregonstate.edu/learn/starch.html
Starch
Updated: Wednesday, May 23, 2012.
Johnson, J.M., E.A. Davis, and J. Gordon. 1990. Interactions of starch and
sugar water measured by electron spin resonance and differential scanning
calorimetry. Cereal Chemistry 67(3): 286-291.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
399
Bean, M.M. and W.T. Yamazaki. 1978. Wheat starch gelatinization in sugar
soutions. I. Scurose: Microscopy and viscosity effects. Cereal Chemistry
55(6): 936-944.
Tadle, Julieta D. Technology and Home Economics, Culinary Arts Fourth
Year. Phoenix Publishing House, InC. Copyright 1995 reprinting 2002 pp. 90-
103
http://chestofbooks.com/health/nutrition/Dietetics-3/Principles-In-Cooking-
Cereals.html#.UxVQwOPuIvg
This section is from the book "Practical Dietetics: With Reference To Diet In
Disease", by Alida Frances Pattee. Also available from Amazon: Practical
Dietetics: With Reference to Diet in Disease.
Tabbada, Epifania V.,et.al.,Technology and Home Economics. Reprinted
1997, copyright 1993 by Phoenix Publishing House, InC. pp. 77 - 80
Home Technology-Food Management and Service,Meat and Storage of
Food, pp. 62-113
Chavez, Lilia C., Basic Foods for Filipinos-4th Edition, Meat Safety,2006, pp.
323-350
Chavez, Lilia L. & de Leon, Sonia; BASIC FOODS FOR FILIPINOS
4th Edition
The Major Kitchen Culinary Arts Center; MANAGING A FOOD –SAFE
KITCHEN PP. 50 – 60
Ingram, Gays G.;ESSENTIAL DICTIONARY OF CULINARY ARTS
pp. 190 – 195
Sandoval, Maria Teresa G., Culinary Arts I and II, 1993, pp. 87-89
Navarro, Leticia S. et al., Homemaking for You and Me III; Food Management
and Consumerism, pp. 33-34
De Leon, Sonia Y., Ph.D et al., Basic Foods for Filipino, 1999,
pp. 231-253
Lewis, Dora S. et al., FAMILY MEALS HOSPITALITY, 224-237
LM-Cookery Grade 10
400
Navarro, Leticia S., HOMEMAKING FOR YOU AND ME III, 27-29
Gisslen, Wayne; PROFESSIONAL COOKING, COPYRIGHT 2007
pp. 154
Home Technology-Food Management and Service,Meat and Storage
of Food, pp. 62-113
Chavez, Lilia C., Basic Foods for Filipinos-4th Edition, Meat Safety, 2006,
pp. 323-350
Sonia Y. De Leon, Ph. D. et al, Basic Basic Food for Filipinos,
Copyright 1999, pp. 258 – 268
Leonard M. Belmonte, Perla B. Del Mundo, Philippine Fiesta Recipe
Copyright 1993, pp. 82, 87 and 146
Maya Kitchen; Food Service and Catering Management pp. 65 - 66
Home Technology-Food Management and Service,Meat and Storage of
Food, pp. 62-113
Chavez, Lilia C., Basic Foods for Filipinos-4th Edition, Meat Safety, 2006,
pp. 323-350
The professional Chef, 8th edition
The Culinary Institute of America
Copyright 2006 by the The Culinary Institute of America
Published by John Wiley and Sons, Inc, Hoboken New Jersey Pages 343-351
Tabbada, Epifania V., et.al. Technology and Home Economics. Reprinted
1997, copyright 1993 by Phoenix Publishing House, Inc. pp. 77 – 80
Ingram, Gays G.;Essential Dictionary of Culinary Arts
pp. 190 – 195
Gisslen, Wayne; Professional Cooking, Copyright 2007
pp. 154
Ingram, Gays G.;Essential Dictionary of Culinary Arts
pp. 190 - 195
Gisslen, Wayne; Professional Cooking, Copyright 2007
LM-Cookery Grade 10
401
pp. 154
Dora S. Lewis, et al, FAMILY MEALS AND HOSPITALITY Copyright 1955
240 – 253
Sonia Y. De Leon, Ph. D. et al, BASIC FOODS FOR FILIPINOS Copyright
1999
pp. 258 – 268
http://www.ifooD.tv/recipe/white-chicken-stock
http://ayeshahaq.files.wordpress.com/2009/08/chicken-stock.jpg
http://www.videojug.com/film/how-to-make-beef-stock
http://howtocook.casaveneracion.com/how-to-make-fish-stock/
http://1.bp.blogspot.com/-
3lQhBUSQkFU/TnihLsD8GbI/AAAAAAAAAIU/hw26OiyEPS4/s1600/DSC_48
14.JPG
http://www.blisstree.com/2010/02/26/food/cooking-essentials-mirepoix/
http://mouthyhousewives.com/wendi/hey-hey-hey-its-a-cooking-planit-spice-
giveaway
http://www.amazon.com/b?node=16310281
http://www.itslife.in/vegetarian-recipes/soups/carrot-cucumber-clear-
vegetable-soup
http://cbsop.com/recipes/thick-and-creamy-potato-bacon-soup/
http://www.nfsmi.org/documentlibraryfiles/PDF/20100210101846.pdf
http://www.nfsmi.org/documentlibraryfiles/PDF/20100210101846.pdf
http://www.lakusinA.com/wp-content/uploads/2011/10/image15.png
http://www.chicken.org.au/page.php?id=12
LM-Cookery Grade 10
402
http://www.vitaille.com/reference/techniques/fabricatechicken/fabri
catechicke n.php
http://bbq.about.com/od/marinaderecipes/tp/Top-10-Pork-Marinade-
Recipes.htm
http://www.spike.com/articles/clyn4o/the-top-10-marinades-every-
man-must- know
http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/cookingmethods/a/dryhea
tmoist.htm
http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/dryheatcooking/a/roasting
.htm
http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/dryheatcooking/a/grilling.h
tm
http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/dryheatcooking/a/sauteing
.htm
http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/dryheatcooking/a/deepfryi
ng.htm
http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/cookingmethods/a/dryhea
tmoist.htm
http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/moistheatcooking/a/boilin
g.htm
http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/moistheatcooking/a/steam
ing.htm
http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/moistheatcooking/a/braisi
LM-Cookery Grade 10
403
ng.htm http://startcooking.com/seven-ways-to-present-
food-like-a-chef
http://www.unileverfoodsolutions.com.sg/our-services/your-
menu/food- presentation
http://www.tasteofhome.com/recipes/ham-and-cheese-
frittata#ixzz36CpQIoa7
http://panlasangpinoy.com/2013/02/12/chicken-galantina-recipe/
LM-Cookery Grade 10
404
Things to Remember Before You Begin
Plating Food
Before you begin preparing your dish, you should consider the kind of cuisine you're
serving. Are you making a hearty steak dinner, or are you preparing a delicate side
dish or appetizer? You can't start building your plate until all of your flavors are
finalized, so it's wise to have your ingredients prepared before you begin the actual
plating process.
Additionally, you'll want to consider portion sizes before you begin plating. To do so,
focus on balancing your protein, carbohydrate, and vegetable to create a nutritionally
balanced meal. Ultimately, carefully placed ingredients create art, but presentation
should never overshadow taste.
Guidelines for Plating Food
For tips and tricks on how to create a beautiful plate, consider the steps below:
1. Choose the Perfect Plate
Selecting the right plate for your meal is key to attractive food presentation. Here are
some things to keep in mind:
LM-Cookery Grade 10
405
Choose the right plate. One way to conceptualize plating is to think of yourself as an
artist, the plate as your canvas, and the food as your medium.
Choose the right size plate. Choose your plate wisely by making sure it's big enough
to allow your food to stand out, but small enough that your portions don't look too
small.
Choose a complementary plate color. The color of your plate is also significant.
White plates are popular because they create high contrast and provide a neutral
background for your colorful creations. Utilize white space by thinking of the rim as
your frame, and consider using the rule of thirds to highlight your plate's focal
point(s). When applied to cooking, the rule of thirds prescribes placing the focal point
of your dish to either the left or right side of the plate, rather than the center.
2. Placing Your Ingredients
Here are a few of the most important aspects to consider as you build your dish:
Plate with a clock in mind. As you begin plating your ingredients, picture the face of
a clock. From the diner's point of view, your protein should be between 3 and 9, your
starch or carbohydrate from 9 and 12, and your vegetable from 12 and 3.
Use moist ingredients as your base. Another rule of thumb is to plate moist or
runny ingredients first, as they tend to move during delivery if they aren't held down
LM-Cookery Grade 10
406
by other foods. One way to anchor runny ingredients is by placing other foods on top
of them. For example, you can angle sliced meat or vegetables against purees and
mashed vegetables.
Serve odd amounts of food. If you're serving small foods like shrimp, scallops, or
bite-sized appetizers, always give guests odd quantities. Serving 7 brussels sprouts
instead of 6 creates more visual appeal, and diners will also perceive that they're
getting more food.
Place food to create flavor bites. Essentially, flavor bites are forkfuls of food that
combine all of the ingredients in your dish into one bite. Creating flavor bites is the
perfect accompaniment to creative plating as it pleases both the eye and the taste
buds.
Don't overcrowd your plate. Be sure to never overcrowd your canvas, and keep it
simple by focusing on one ingredient - usually the protein. Finding a focal point also
ensures that the accompanying ingredients will play a complementary, supporting
role.
Mercer Culinary M35136 6 1/2" Offset Precision / Plating Tongs
ITEM #: 470M35136
$6.89 /Each
Add to Cart
LM-Cookery Grade 10
407
3. Pay Attention to the Details
As you plate your dish, you'll also want to pay attention to the details:
Think about color and contrast. One of the best-kept secrets to beautiful plating is
paying close attention to the details. While your focus will obviously be on the
protein, considering how the other elements of the plate create color and contrast is
also very important.
You can create a beautiful background for your plate by adding green vegetables or
brightly colored fruits as accent points. Similarly, try to pair ingredients with
complementary colors as this will further enhance your dish's visual appeal.
Create height on your plate. Another way to catch your guests' eyes is to utilize the
power of height. While compactly stacking ingredients isn't as popular as it was 5-10
years ago, creating a tall plate can go a long way towards enhancing visual appeal.
You can also balance out taller ingredients by leaning long, flat items against them.
For example, you can plate your steak on top of polenta and lean asparagus spears
against them at a 45-degree angle.
Use texture to enhance your dish. Finally, don't forget about texture. Contrasting a
smooth vegetable puree with crunchy onion straws or topping a steak with crumbled
blue cheese creates appealing texture combinations that are classic in high-end
cuisine.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
408
4. Design and Create with Sauces
Once you've plated your main ingredients, you're ready to top your dish with
delicious sauces. Don't just pour the sauce carelessly all over the plate, though.
Instead, think of your squeeze bottle or spoon as a paintbrush, and your sauce as a
medium. Then, use them to enhance your plate.
One way to do this is to create accent dots on one side of your plate (while
considering the rule of thirds) or by lightly drizzling sauce over the main ingredients
so guests get a little bit of sauce in every bite.
Mercer Culinary M35615 6 Piece Silicone Brush Plating Set
ITEM #: 470M35615
$30.49 /Each
Add to Cart
5. Use Garnishes Purposefully
LM-Cookery Grade 10
409
In the past, chefs casually threw a piece of kale and an orange slice onto every plate
as it left their kitchen. However, these garnishes didn't add anything exciting to the
dish, and few guests even ate them in the first place. Here are a few examples of
smart garnishes and how to incorporate them:
Choose edible garnishes. As you finish plating, remember that garnishes must be
related to the dish and should always be edible. Ultimately, they're designed to
enhance and complement the flavors of the entree you've created, not distract from
them.
Place garnishes purposefully. Similarly, never heap garnishes in one corner of the
plate. Instead, disperse them thoughtfully in order to add color or texture. Also, avoid
using unappetizing garnishes like raw herbs, large chunks of citrus, and anything with
a strong odor. Lastly, make sure your garnishes are quick and easy to apply, so food
still goes out piping hot.
Plating Tools of the Trade
Having the proper food presentation and plating tools is essential to high-quality
plating. Here are a few items you should be sure to purchase if you don't already own
them:
Decorating Brushes
LM-Cookery Grade 10
410
As one of the most important products in any chef's toolkit, decorating brushes have
a variety of applications. You can use them for both detailed line work and broad
strokes as you apply sauces, or when plating purees and coulis beneath meat or
vegetables.
Garnishing Kits
Garnishing kits come with everything you need to garnish all of your signature
dishes, including plating wedges, tongs, squeeze bottles, and brushes.
Molds
Molds are also very important when plating food. By cutting ingredients to a specific
shape and size, you'll provide visual appeal and keep your plate tidy. Ring molds also
help you develop height and structure when stacking ingredients.
Plating and Precision Tongs
Last but not least, you'll want to have precision tongs on hand for placing garnishes
or small, delicate foods. Many tongs also feature micro-serrations for improved grip
and stability.
Plating Wedges
Plating wedges come pre-cut with flat, round, or pointed edges and are perfect for
smearing sauces and other soft ingredients into designs on your plate.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
411
Shavers
Shavers work well when shaving or grating chocolate, hard cheeses, or soft
vegetables on top of your finished creations.
Spoons
You'll also want to have a variety of spoons on hand. Saucier spoons help you drag
smears of sauce across your plate, and you can also choose a utensil with a tapered
bowl that's perfect for drizzling and pouring. Additionally, slotted spoons quickly
separate solids from liquids as you complete your presentation.
Squeeze Bottles
Squeeze bottles are ideal when applying sauces or aiolis to your finished plate. Many
of these items come with adjustable, precision control tips that allow you to apply the
perfect amount of product.
Examples of Plating Styles
Here are examples of three popular plating styles: classic, free form, and landscape.
To demonstrate them, we used filet mignon, potato puree, carrots, a demi-glace, a
pea puree, a lima bean and pea blend, thyme, and fried leeks.
Classic Plating
LM-Cookery Grade 10
412
 1.
Pipe the potato puree onto the plate using a pastry bag.
 2.
Place the carrots next to the puree using precision tongs.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
413
 3.
Garnish the carrots with thyme using precision tongs.
 4.
Plate the steak using precision tongs.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
414
 5.
Garnish the steak with fried leeks using precision tongs.
 6.
Drizzle the demi-glace around the plate using a spouted saucier.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
415
 7.
Wipe the edges of the plate with a clean towel.
 8.
Finished classic plate.
Free Form Plating
LM-Cookery Grade 10
416
 1.
Pipe dots of potato puree onto the plate using a pastry bag.
 2.
Slice the steak into three pieces using a chef's knife.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
417
 3.
Plate the pieces of steak using precision tongs.
 4.
Place the lima bean and pea blend around the plate using a spoon.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
418
 5.
Plate the carrots using precision tongs.
 6.
Place dots of pea puree around the plate using a large squeeze bottle.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
419
 7.
Place dots of the demi-glace around the plate using a small squeeze bottle.
 8.
Garnish the plate with fried leeks using precision tongs.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
420
 9.
Wipe the edges of the plate with a clean towel.
 10.
Finished free form plate.
Landscape Plating
LM-Cookery Grade 10
421
 1.
Place dots of pea puree around the plate using a large squeeze bottle.
 2.
Paint the pea puree onto the plate using a brush.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
422
 3.
Pipe the potato puree onto the plate using a pastry bag.
 4.
Plate the carrots using precision tongs.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
423
 5.
Lean the steak against the puree and carrots using precision tongs.
 6.
Place the lima bean and pea blend around the plate using a spoon.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
424
 7.
Drizzle the demi-glace around the plate using a spouted saucier.
 8.
Garnish the steak with fried leeks using precision tongs.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
425
 9.
Wipe the edges of the plate with a clean towel.
 10.
Finished landscape plate.
Whether you own a fine dining establishment, upscale restaurant, or eclectic cafe,
thoughtful and attentive plating is sure to improve customers' impressions of your
business. An awareness of food presentation also allows you to demonstrate your
chefs' skills to customers and helps you highlight all of your restaurant's delicious
offerings. With an awareness of these basic principles, techniques, and tools, you're
sure to enhance your business' plating and increase sales.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
426
Does food plating and presentation actually matter?
In short, yes.
The way you present your food is what tempts customers to try a dish. We eat with our
senses: what we see, smell, and feel. And in the age of Instagrammers and food bloggers,
food plating and presentation matters more than ever.
A study from Oxford gastrophysicist, Professor Charles Spence, suggests that the food
presentation can actually make a dish taste better.
In the study, Spence gave 60 people 3 salads and asked them to rate each one before and
after they ate them. The salads each used the same ingredients but presented them in
different ways. One salad was put together with no regard given to presentation, one was
neatly arranged, and the third was plated to resemble a painting by artist Wassily Kandinsky.
Can you guess which salad diners liked best?
It was the salad that resembled a painting.
Diners thought it tasted better (29% tastier to be precise), even though it used the exact
same ingredients. Spence’s study concluded that consumers were willing to spend as much
as three times more on a well-plated dish.
Even basic dishes like a salad can benefit from thoughtful presentation—it makes the dish
seem more appetizing and valuable.
So how can you use that information to your advantage?
LM-Cookery Grade 10
427
We talked to chefs Daniel England, Joyce Tang, Tanner Agar, Jim Solomon, Michael Welch,
and Brian Poe to learn their favorite food plating and presentation techniques. Each
technique focuses on five key food presentation factors: color, arrangement, balance,
texture, and how easy it is for guests to eat.
The top food presentation and plating techniques
1. Create height on the plate
2. Cut meat horizontally
3. Play with textures
4. Use contrasting colors
5. Match presentation to the restaurant theme
6. Choose the right plates
7. Serve smaller portion sizes
8. Use edible garnishes and decorations
9. When in doubt, keep it simple
10.Express yourself
Simplify your kitchen workflows
With Lightspeed's Kitchen Display System, cooks spend less time on order logistics; time
they can use to create beautifully-plated dishes.
Learn more
1. Create height on the plate
Daniel England, corporate chef with San Diego’s OMG Hospitality Group, likes to create
height as he plates food.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
428
“It’s important that you don’t separate the food trying to fill the plate—build from the bottom
up,” he says. “If you could use a little structure, you can always purchase a ring mold to start
with a base. Simply pack some food in the mold and gently lift it up. Now you have a base to
build on.”
2. Cut meat horizontally
England also recommends “fanning” or shingling out slices of meat to show off its quality.
“Slice your meats on a 45-degree bias, and also slice against the grain of the meat for a
more tender cut,” he says. “Show off that perfect medium-rare steak!”
LM-Cookery Grade 10
429
3. Play with textures
Joyce Tang, chief baking officer at Oakland, California’s La Chinoserie, suggests playing
with textures, foams, and sauces to make the dish look more interesting.
“I like to play up contrasting textures on my plate,” she adds. “Foams are usually really
helpful in plating and can be really easily done, playing around with different sauces and
textures.”
4. Use contrasting colors
Tang also stresses the importance of playing with contrasting colors. She avoids artificial
colors and uses matcha, powdered sugar, or natural colors to catch the eye instead.
“The way you present your food is hyper-important” she adds. “The more time you spend on
how you present each dish, the more visual interest you can stimulate in folks.”
Tanner Agar, owner and chief experience officer at Rye Restaurant in McKinney, Texas,
echos that sentiment.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
430
Agar recommends using bold colors to create appealing visuals. “The easiest way to add
color is to start working with more colorful ingredients. Items like carrots, potatoes,
cauliflower, lettuces, beans, and more come in a variety of gorgeous colors,” he says. “The
difference a purple cauliflower puree makes on a plate is striking.”
5. Match food presentation to your restaurant theme
Jim Solomon, chef and former owner of The Fireplace in Brookline, Massachusetts, says
that the style of plating should match the restaurant’s atmosphere.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
431
“Small ethnic restaurants, where it appears grandma is cooking in the kitchen, can’t serve
plates that try to emphasize vertical, architectural compositions,” he says.
“Your guests expect a simple, welcoming presentation that stresses straightforward flavor
cooked with heart and served with an unfussy, rustic quality. At relatively pricey, hip and
high-end restaurants, guests want to see a degree of artistry and care taken in constructing
the dishes.”
The way you plate your food should directly reflect your restaurant type.
Solomon adds that “food should have an element of height or visual texture, the balance of
color and thoughtful garnishes—both carefully placed and intentional in flavor and texture.”
6. Choose the right plates
Michael Welch, the executive chef at Backyard Kitchen & Tap in Pacific Beach, California,
preaches using the right plate size, color, and style. The color of plate matters as the plate
serves as the canvas for your food.
“Typically, chefs will stay away from blue plates as there isn’t any naturally blue food and it is
thought to be an unappetizing color,” he says. “If you have something with a lot of vibrant
color, it might stand out better on a white plate.”
10
LM-Cookery Grade 10
432
Jim Solomon echos the importance of choosing the right vessel to present your dish.
“Choose a dish vessel that makes it easy for your guest to eat. This is also an opportunity for
your chefs to show their personality in the dishes they create.”
7. Serve smaller portion sizes
Smaller portion sizes were named by the National Restaurant Association as one of the top
five hottest restaurant concepts for 2019.
Of course, you still want to serve enough food to satisfy your guests and portion sizes can
vary depending on the type of establishment you’re operating, but smaller portions are
typically easier to style.
Stick to no more than six elements on each dish to prevent them from looking overcrowded.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
433
Related read:8 Benefits to Serving Smaller Portion Sizes
8. Use edible garnishes and decorations
Garnishes and decorations are a great way of styling your dish, but there are some
guidelines you should follow when using them.
Whatever you use—whether it’s a herb, spice, or a flower—it needs to be edible. Everything
on your plate should be placed with the intention of elevating the dishes taste first, and the
way it looks second.
9. When in doubt, keep it simple
LM-Cookery Grade 10
434
Michael Welch also emphasizes the value of simplicity.
“Overcrowding the plate with unnecessary oils or spices or microgreens just takes away from
the food you worked so hard to make,” he explains. “Subtraction is your best ingredient.”
Rather than piling on a zillion garnishes or swirls of sauce, let the quality of the cooking
speak for itself.
“A properly seared steak with some fresh watercress and perfectly roasted baby potatoes
will look better than the fanciest of plates with subpar cookery,” Welch says. “Proper cooking
will give you a lot of contrast within your ingredients with both texture and color.”
10. Express yourself
There’s an art in plating food; it’s where chefs can allow themselves to be creative and have
a high impact on how guests perceive the dishes they’re eating.
Chef Brian Poe of Bukowski Tavern in Cambridge, and Parish Café and Tip Tap Room in
Boston, believes that chefs should approach food plating and presentation just as an artist
would approach their next piece.
“Presentation should be approached just like art, cooking, and music,” says Poe. “Take a
moment to relax and look at what the others are doing, learn a bit of the technique and then
find your own voice and style.”
LM-Cookery Grade 10
435
One of Poe’s favorite approaches is to go “Jackson Pollock,” holding out the plate like a
canvas and splattering it with sauce. “Other times we might look toward a more linear
approach with could either be Picasso or street graffiti style,” he adds. “Other times the
negative space technique might work.”
Time-saving tools to help your food preparation
Beautifully plating food takes time. While you want it to look great, you need to plate your
food fast as possible—especially if it’s a hot dish that you don’t want to go cold before it
reaches your guests.
Now, you can’t help how long it takes to properly cook and prepare a meal, but you can give
your chefs more time to prepare dishes by streamlining your ordering process.
Lightspeed point of sale enables service staff to quickly take a guest’s order and send it to
the appropriate kitchen workstation in seconds.
Kitchen staff see orders in real-time on their kitchen display system and can notify servers as
soon as the dish is ready to be run to guests. Over the course of a service, those saved
seconds compound and enable kitchen staff to spend time getting food plating and
presentation just right.
The right restaurant technology can streamline your ordering and food preparation, which
gives your cooks more time to create dishes with strong visual appeal
LM-Cookery Grade 10
436
PLATE PRESENTATIONS
Chefs labor over their food for countless hours to create a moment of
pleasure for their guests. Plate presentation is the final step that
showcases their creations. Often taken for granted or left as an
afterthought, plate presentation should highlight the quality of the food
and preparation techniques while engaging the diner’s senses.
Effective plating should be simple enough to execute on a busy night,
yet stylish and visually appealing to the guest. Consider the plate with
the eye of a photographer to create a composition that brings the
various elements of the dish together in harmony. A winning plate
presentation is rarely achieved on the first try. Imagination, trial-and-
error, and brainstorming in a collaborative fashion often help to
achieve successful results. Plate presentations begin with the
mastering the basic of proper culinary techniques, high quality food,
and plate selections that fit the style of the dish. Numerous plate
traditional, contemporary, and international concepts and templates
are presented here that have
ELEMENTS OF THE PLATE
A plate should engage the senses and draw the diner into it much as
a painting will draw in the observer. The dish should be carefully
planned to balance tastes, textures, colors, and cooking methods.
Intertwine the components to bring a sense of composition and
harmony. The process begins by incorporating the best and freshest
ingredients, executing accurate knife cuts, and using precise cooking
techniques that highlight the quality of the food and the talents of the
chef. The dish is pulled together by the sauces and other
complementary ingredients. The final touch is the judicious use of
garnishes. Each element should be there for a reason, adding
dimensions of flavor, texture, and color that is in harmony with the
finished plate.
Main Item
The main item is usually the focal point of the plate. On a savory dish
this is often a protein such as meat, fish, or poultry that requires
LM-Cookery Grade 10
437
butchering skills, portion control, and cooking techniques of the
highest caliber, to achieve the desired results that are essential to the
success of the plate presentation. Vegetarian dishes frequently
highlight pasta, risotto, grains, and legumes, which are delicate items
that, once prepared and plated, must be served immediately to retain
their fresh appeal. Appetizers, including soups, salads, charcuterie, or
small shared plates, should be plated with care and precision for
maximum visual impact. Fresh, crisp, colorful salad greens with
attractive garnishes, soups presented with the proper consistency and
adornments, and charcuterie precisely prepared and sliced, are
important for the opening of the meal. Desserts, as the closing
chapter of the dining experience, should include fresh, rich, and sweet
flavors with textural variety including cookies, crusts and garnishes,
bright color variance from the use of fruits, herbs, and sauces, and
visual appeal. Proper execution requires the crisp textures of pastry,
the smooth and creamy consistency of a gelato or mousse, and
colorful garnishes of herbs. For appetizers and desserts that serve as
bookends of a meal, there may be one single focal point or several, in
which case creative plating will achieve the best results.
Supporting Elements
Vegetables and fruits often constitute the supporting elements of a
dish. Whereas proteins tend to be various shades of brown, beige,
and white, fruits and vegetables add color and provide a high visual
impact. Precise cuts help to create an elegant presentation. Carefully
controlled cooking techniques will yield vibrant colors and accents.
Textures achieved through variety in cooking techniques include
starches, grains, and legumes prepared as smooth purees, al dente
pastas, and creamy risottos; or as crisp textured frites, chips, and
croquettes. Supporting components provide height in the form of
mounded purees, pastas, and grains to support the main item. They
contribute to the overall appearance by providing variety in taste,
color, shapes, and textures.
Sauces
Sauces tie the elements of the dish together providing color and
luster. They should be of the correct color, consistency, and texture.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
438
Sauces variations include compotes, chutneys, or salsas, as well as
the traditional brown, white, and butter sauces. Cold sauces include
vinaigrette, mayonnaise emulsions, purees, pesto, and coulis. Sauces
may be served under, over, or alongside the item and should have a
light consistency yet flavorful punch. The combination of 2 sauces on
a plate, for example a chocolate sauce paired with a raspberry coulis
adds
Garnishes
Garnishes provide color and a finished touch to the dish. Choose
items that are appropriate to the dish and that echo some of the
ingredients. They should be functional, not merely a sprig of rosemary
or a wedge of lemon, but incorporated as part of the plate concept. A
tuile cookie for enhancing a gelato dessert, a tempura fried Meyer
lemon slice to complement a sautéed fillet of fish, or delicate micro-
greens to garnish a salad are all examples of functional garnishes. As
the final touch of the plate presentation, garnishes must be precisely
prepped to maximize their impact and give the plate the final visual
pop.
PLATE SELECTION
We often speak of plates when plating food but service ware includes
plates of varying sizes, bowls, cups, and other vessels used to hold
the food. Plates and serving vessels come in a variety of colors,
shapes, and sizes. They may be simple white, starkly black, or earth
tone colors. Other materials may also be incorporated including metal
or wood. The style of dinnerware used depends on the type of
operation whether causal or formal. Plating choices also are
influenced by the style of food, the chefs vision, and the overall image
the operation is trying to convey.
Styles
Bambu Veneerware
LM-Cookery Grade 10
439
Carefully consider your audience and the venue when choosing the
style of service ware. For example, a fine dining restaurant might
consider china or porcelain that conveys a sense of elegance. A
casual restaurant may choose ceramic or stoneware that matches a
more rustic dining experience, while a quick service operation could
opt for economical plastic and melamine. An off-premise catered
venue might decide that eco-friendly, disposable and compostable
service ware made of bamboo or other recycled materials is a good
fit. Service ware also includes materials like glass, wood, slate, tile,
and metals of cast iron or stainless steel. Some chefs choose custom-
made plates as a way to distinguish their cuisine using natural
materials, reclaimed wood, or architecturally unique designs that are
as artistic as the food itself. Plates and service ware come in a variety
of geometric shapes including classic round, as well as square, oval,
or rectangular. They may be teardrop shaped, oblong, or spoon-
shaped.
Plate Size
https://savorjapan.com
The size of the plate is dependent on the style of restaurant; for
example a family-style restaurant might use larger plates, while a
restaurant that features small plates for sharing would logically use
small plates. Fine dining restaurants tend to use oversized plates, for
example a 12 inch/30 cm dinner plate or a 7-9 inch/18-23 cm
appetizer plate. Oversized plates act as a canvas providing negative
space that frames the items, provides focus, and brings out the colors
and characteristics of the food. Large plates also prevent crowding
and food overflowing on the rim. The size of the plate affects the
perception of quantity and portion size because the larger the plate,
the smaller the portion appears to the guest. Smaller plates, bowls, or
ramekins can be nested to accent or highlight components. Japanese
Kaiseiki presentations use dishes of various shapes set on a
rectangular underliner that emphasizes an asymmetrical or
unbalanced, yet organic plate composition.
Colors
Wild Honey, London
LM-Cookery Grade 10
440
The color of service ware affects the overall presentation as well as
our taste perceptions and even our appetite. White plates are a
traditional color favored by chefs because it makes the vibrant colors
of the food more visually appealing to the guest. White plates are like
a blank canvas that chefs can design without concern for color
clashes from contrasting plate colors. Black plates provide an
opposite contrast that can be used effectively with brightly colored
foods. However, earth tones of brown, tan, warm gray, and greens
that emulate the natural colors found in dirt, moss, trees and rocks
can be used when paired with the right food colors. Green foods,
including salads and vegetables pair well with yellow plates. Beige
foods including pasta, chicken and potatoes pairs well with black and
brown plates. Red foods including tomatoes, beef, and red sauces
pair well on white plates, while yellow and orange foods including
eggs, corn, and curries pair well with blue colors. Solid colors tend to
dominate but some restaurants use patterns as a signature style.
Some chefs today commission and even help design custom serving
pieces and tableware.
Colors affect not only how the food appears but also how appetizing it
looks to us. Foods with high contrast, for example a grilled steak with
asparagus, sweet potato puree, and béarnaise sauce on a white plate,
usually appears more appetizing than those with low contrast, for
example pasta with a white sauce on a white plate. Foods served on
white plates tend to enhance sweet flavors in food, while black
plates bring out more savory flavors, and serving food on a red
plate has shown to reduce the amount diners eat. Service ware
should be chosen to match the food, it’s shapes, and colors.
Tools for Plating
There are a broad variety of tools that are used for plate
presentations including squeeze bottles, spoons, thin-offset
spatulas, and brushes for applying sauces on the plate. Tweezers
and chop sticks assist in placement of components and delicate
garnishes. Slotted, flexible fish spatulas work well for delicate fish
and similar items. Stacking rings and geometric molds help to keep
the food contained and add height to the layout. Although tongs are
LM-Cookery Grade 10
441
useful for sturdy items like steaks and chops, small serving spoons
should be used when plating delicate foods including vegetables.
Mercer Cutlery, Ateco
ELEMENTARY PLATING TIPS
Before beginning the plating process determine the focal point by
visualizing how it will appear or draw out a plate diagram. The focal
point should be the highlight of the plate and where the eye is drawn
to first. Bright or contrasting colors, elevation, and food placement
helps to highlight items. Usually our eyes scan a food plate much like
a picture, from the lower left to the upper right. Photographer’s use
this idea setting up a photo, called the rule-of-thirds, that divides a
picture into thirds both horizontally and vertically and uses the
intersecting lines as focal points. The alignment of the subject should
be somewhere at one of these focal points and usually off-center. This
template can also be used when apportioning the quantity of food on
the plate, which as a general rule means no more than 2/3 of the plate
should be filled with food, while the other 1/3 of the plate is negative
or empty space.
Avoid the rim while creating a buffer zone of ½ inch/13 mm of space
from the rim to the flat of the plate. Play with symmetry, geometry,
and sequencing of the foods. Use color contrasts to add visual impact
and interest to the plate. Odd numbers are more pleasing to the eye
than even numbers, so 3 asparagus spears versus four is better.
Remember to keep the components of the plate in proportion to each
other to balance the presentation. Determine the focal points, lines,
and flow, as you apportion space to each element. Don’t crowd the
plate; empty space will reinforce the focal point. Plate the foods
simply without too much fuss or busyness.
Practical Plate Presentations
Food plating starts with the basics of functionality and practicality.
Remember that the dish must be easily assembled on a busy night.
The vision of a plate presentation is only possible to the extent of the
quality of the food and the expertise of the kitchen. The food must be
prepared and seasoned properly with a fresh, appetizing appearance.
LM-Cookery Grade 10
442
Vegetable cuts should be clean and uniform and retain their bright
colors, sauces must have a proper consistency, and proteins must be
browned and cooked to the correct degree of doneness.
Fundamentals for plating start with serving foods on plates that are
the correct temperature; hot food on pre-heated plates, and cold food
on chilled plates.
Establish a focal point, and compose the plate based on a central
component. Create variety in shapes, textures, colors, and flavors.
Use molded forms when appropriate, but avoid too many geometric
and precise shapes that can make the plate look like it was stamped
with a cookie cutter. Odd numbers bring unity and harmony to the
plate and pull in the surrounding elements. Height creates drama so,
much like a sculpture, design the plate with a 3-D approach.
Simple techniques like fluffing salad greens, or overlapping slices of
meat are simple ways to create height. Use sauces to add color
accents to the dish. Garnishes should be relevant to the plate so
avoid the use of whole sprigs of rosemary. Spices and herbs on the
edge of the plate should be avoided, however the discreet use of
chopped herbs that are relevant to the dish are fine for adding color to
the composition.
Before the plate is presented to the guest, it must be examined and
cleaned as needed of excess food and smudges. Use mildly
acidulated water with lemon or vinegar and a clean, lint-free cloth to
wipe the plate. The kitchen’s responsibility includes how the plate is
presented to the guest. In kitchen language this is referred to as the 6
o’clock plate position or the edge of the plate placed closest to the
guest.
Traditional Plating
Traditional plating presents the food simply by using a clock face as
a guide. The entrée or main focal point is served between 4 and 8
o’clock. The starch is plated between 9 and 10 o’clock and the
vegetables are plated between 2 and 3 o’clock. The sauce is served
either under or over the main item. This simple presentation can be
effective as long as the elements are balanced. Use the rule-of-thirds
LM-Cookery Grade 10
443
concept, overlapping the components, and the plate as a backdrop to
frame it. Gain height by leaning the protein on the starch. The sauce
will also act as a tying element too.
Vertical and Horizontal Lines
Strong, clean lines that are vertical, horizontal, or angled, provide
neat and logical dimension to the plate. Lines can be created by the
placement of proteins, vegetables, or sauces. Patterns emerge by
repeating these lines, and variety is introduced through intersecting or
overlapping lines. The monotony of repetitive lines is interrupted by
the addition of other food shapes and carefully placed garnishes.
Arcs, Swooshes, and Swirls
Arcs, swooshes, and swirls soften hard angular lines of the plate
giving them fluidity and movement in appearance. Sauces and purees
are commonly used to create curves. They may be juxtaposed with
other plating designs including straight lines, or they may be layered
to add height and dimension to the plate. Some styles of arcs use an
off-centered approach that creates tension and drawing the diner’s
attention to them. Another example of an arc is the golden ratio, a
spiral pattern that is found in nature, including snail shells and
sunflowers, and used in art and architecture.
Stacked Plating
Stacked plating brings height and drama to the presentation by
layering the components in a vertical style. Items can be layered
either free-form or with a mold, but to avoid the cookie cutter effect,
vary the ingredients to create different shapes and colors. The focal
point of the stack should be off-center, usually to the left, with added
garnishes and sauces to create variety and strength in the
presentation. Crisp textures can be added at the base, in the form of
pastry or vegetables, or as a garnish, in the form of vegetable chips or
crisps.
Soft textures, purees of root vegetables, provide a base, and double
as an anchor to support the main item. Break up round or square
LM-Cookery Grade 10
444
geometric shapes with vegetables, pasta, grains or other items.
Sauces provide accent and help to pull the dish together. Avoid the
bull’s-eye effect when stacking by adding garnished elements cut into
various shapes or use a saucing technique that breaks the round
shape.
Trios
Popular for small plates and samplers, trios are another approach to
plating that uses odd numbers and negative space. A plate of trios
may include a seasonal item prepared three different ways. It may
incorporate hot and cold temperatures. It also is an opportunity for a
chef to display multiple creative pairings and preparations. Trio
plating can be done in a linear fashion, a triangular pattern, or even
free form style.
Deconstructed Plating
The concept of deconstruction re-imagines the elements of a dish in
a new light. When presenting a deconstructed dish, it should hold the
flavors and textures of the original inspiration (often a classic
preparation), while creating a connection to the modern interpretation.
Deconstruction is not merely serving separate elements of a dish on a
single plate; rather a unified concept is woven throughout the plate.
Desserts are good candidates for the deconstructed approach; for
example, a strawberry shortcake can be broken down and recreated
as a strawberry sorbet, dehydrated shortcake crumbles, crème fraiche
sauce, and fresh strawberries.
Free Form Plating
The organized randomness of free-form plating presents an arbitrary
yet natural appearance, however it still requires thought and planning
using similar visual rules of composition. Free-form plating,
sometimes referred to as organic, gives credence to the concept of
“what grows together goes together”. This approach uses a flattened
design that is more relaxed. Free form plating, like the deconstructed
approach, can be used to create a more fluid approach to food layout
LM-Cookery Grade 10
445
and design. This style of plating often uses wood, slate or stone
plates to lend a natural element to the presentation
Japanese Kaiseki
Kaiseki, a formal dining tradition that dates back 400 years to
Buddhist monk traditions, balances the tastes, textures, appearance,
and colors of the food. Seasonality is important in the cooking as well
as in the type of dishes, which are selected to enhance the seasonal
nature of the dish using a variety of different shapes, colors, textures,
sizes. Each meal is represented by five colors, red, white, green,
black, and yellow which contributes to the eye appeal as well as
ensuring the nutritional healthiness of the food. Each menu also
includes items prepared raw, simmered, fried, steamed, and roasted
or grilled. Foods are precisely cut into bite-sized slices or pieces to be
easily eaten with chopsticks, and served in small, individual portions
in separate dishes. Plate presentations emphasize a slightly askew
approach and use height to add for dramatic affect. Negative space is
emphasized in the plating philosophy. Kaiseki has influenced western
plating styles from Europe to North and South America. Tasting
menus available in fine dining restaurants around the world draw
inspiration from the Japanese concept of small multi-course plates
that showcase a chef’s repertoire emphasizing seasonal and local
foods

More Related Content

PPTX
DOCX
DESSERT-4TH-grading-FINAL-EDIT.docx
PPTX
CLASSIFICATIONS OF APPETIZERS.pptx
PPTX
SHS Decorate and Present Pastry Products.pptx
PPTX
BASIC COOKING METHOD
PPTX
Presenting, Serving, and Storing Baked Products
PPTX
Factors in presenting
PDF
Learning Module Cookery Grade 10
DESSERT-4TH-grading-FINAL-EDIT.docx
CLASSIFICATIONS OF APPETIZERS.pptx
SHS Decorate and Present Pastry Products.pptx
BASIC COOKING METHOD
Presenting, Serving, and Storing Baked Products
Factors in presenting
Learning Module Cookery Grade 10

What's hot (20)

PDF
K to 12 commercial cooking techer's guide
PPTX
Sponge- Types and Preparation.pptx
PDF
LM_Dressmaking G10 with watermarks.pdf
PPTX
Kinds of meat
PPTX
Use of tools and bakery equipment
PPTX
TLE 10 4th LESSON 1
PPTX
Lesson 6 Physical Structure and Composition of Egg
PPTX
Principles of preparing stocks
PPTX
Lesson 9 Starch Cookery
PPTX
Appetizers
PPTX
DEMONSTRATION TEACHING IN TLE 7 and 8.pptx
PPTX
ppt on different cutting techniques.pptx
PPTX
TLE 9 LESSON 4
PPTX
NAPKIN FOLDING STYLES.pptx
PPTX
Lesson 2 Methods of Meat Preservation
PPTX
Fish & seafood
PPT
Fish and shellfish
PDF
Tle 7 afa food (fish) processing module 6
PPTX
Prepare egg dishes
PPTX
WEEK 4- PRESENT EGG DISHES.pptx
K to 12 commercial cooking techer's guide
Sponge- Types and Preparation.pptx
LM_Dressmaking G10 with watermarks.pdf
Kinds of meat
Use of tools and bakery equipment
TLE 10 4th LESSON 1
Lesson 6 Physical Structure and Composition of Egg
Principles of preparing stocks
Lesson 9 Starch Cookery
Appetizers
DEMONSTRATION TEACHING IN TLE 7 and 8.pptx
ppt on different cutting techniques.pptx
TLE 9 LESSON 4
NAPKIN FOLDING STYLES.pptx
Lesson 2 Methods of Meat Preservation
Fish & seafood
Fish and shellfish
Tle 7 afa food (fish) processing module 6
Prepare egg dishes
WEEK 4- PRESENT EGG DISHES.pptx
Ad

Similar to cookery_g10_learning_module-1-).docx (20)

DOCX
LM_Cookery G10.docx
DOCX
LM_Cookery G10.docx
PDF
LM Cookery G10
PDF
Commercial cooking-learning-module-130713090917-phpapp01
PDF
Commercial cooking-learning-module
PDF
Commercial cooking-learning-module-130713090917-phpapp01
PDF
1428321527 master edcmg
PDF
BREAD AND PASTRY PRODUCTION - CBLM
PDF
K to 12_commercial_cooking_learning_module - copy
PDF
K to 12_commercial_cooking_learning_module
PDF
K to 12_commercial_cooking_learning_module
PDF
K to-12-commercial-cooking-learning-module
PDF
K to 12_commercial_cooking_learning_module
PDF
K TO 12 COMMERCIAL COOKING LEARNING MODULE.pdf
PDF
K to 12 commercial cooking learning module
DOCX
Olit 501 ccp final design document
PDF
Health and Physical Education Hand PE.pdf
DOC
CBC COOKERY NC II UNDER TOURISM SECTOR HOME ECONOMICS
PDF
Fet business studies gr 10 12 - we_b#c0fc
PDF
caps document
LM_Cookery G10.docx
LM_Cookery G10.docx
LM Cookery G10
Commercial cooking-learning-module-130713090917-phpapp01
Commercial cooking-learning-module
Commercial cooking-learning-module-130713090917-phpapp01
1428321527 master edcmg
BREAD AND PASTRY PRODUCTION - CBLM
K to 12_commercial_cooking_learning_module - copy
K to 12_commercial_cooking_learning_module
K to 12_commercial_cooking_learning_module
K to-12-commercial-cooking-learning-module
K to 12_commercial_cooking_learning_module
K TO 12 COMMERCIAL COOKING LEARNING MODULE.pdf
K to 12 commercial cooking learning module
Olit 501 ccp final design document
Health and Physical Education Hand PE.pdf
CBC COOKERY NC II UNDER TOURISM SECTOR HOME ECONOMICS
Fet business studies gr 10 12 - we_b#c0fc
caps document
Ad

Recently uploaded (20)

PPTX
Sesame Seeds: Expert Insights on Farming
PDF
Chapter 04 - Osseous Systefsdm - Copy.pdf
PPTX
personal_storytelling_presentation_570af2a4___.pptx
PDF
Junk Food: Understanding Its Impact on Health and Society
DOC
Millersville毕业证学历认证,奥古斯塔娜大学毕业证全套证件文凭
PPTX
STRUCTURE_AND_COMPOSITION_OF_EGGS(Layers).pptx
PPTX
FST-401 lecture # 7 Food Chemistry.pptx
PPTX
634512141-Untitledgggjjkhhjjkjjjuytffghjjjhrrfgh fffrrttttt uuuujjikkkkkhfdgh...
PPTX
water supply and waste disposal in food industry pptx
PPTX
February 02-2024Daily quality report..pptx
PPTX
Vitamin A .pptxjdjdksmxnenxmdmdmdmxmemmxms
PPTX
ONLINE_BOOK_STORE[1].pptxyut87t8t8ttt8668
PDF
Marinate Container for Effortless Meal Preparation
PPTX
ACHARYA NARENDRA DEV UNIVERSITY OF AGRICUULTURE AND TECHNOLOGY , KUMARGANJ, A...
PPTX
HEALTHY EATING HABITS A BRIEF PRESENTATION
PDF
Chapter 13 - Urinary System -dcsd Copy.pdf
PPT
Module 02 - Introduction to Food Safety 3.3.18 (3).ppt
PPT
PRODUCTION PRACTICES FOR ANNUAL CROPS.ppt
PPTX
Subordinate_Clauses_BlueGradient_Optimized.pptxeiidi
PPTX
Altered metabolism (Warburg effect, glutamine addiction, lipid metabolism)
Sesame Seeds: Expert Insights on Farming
Chapter 04 - Osseous Systefsdm - Copy.pdf
personal_storytelling_presentation_570af2a4___.pptx
Junk Food: Understanding Its Impact on Health and Society
Millersville毕业证学历认证,奥古斯塔娜大学毕业证全套证件文凭
STRUCTURE_AND_COMPOSITION_OF_EGGS(Layers).pptx
FST-401 lecture # 7 Food Chemistry.pptx
634512141-Untitledgggjjkhhjjkjjjuytffghjjjhrrfgh fffrrttttt uuuujjikkkkkhfdgh...
water supply and waste disposal in food industry pptx
February 02-2024Daily quality report..pptx
Vitamin A .pptxjdjdksmxnenxmdmdmdmxmemmxms
ONLINE_BOOK_STORE[1].pptxyut87t8t8ttt8668
Marinate Container for Effortless Meal Preparation
ACHARYA NARENDRA DEV UNIVERSITY OF AGRICUULTURE AND TECHNOLOGY , KUMARGANJ, A...
HEALTHY EATING HABITS A BRIEF PRESENTATION
Chapter 13 - Urinary System -dcsd Copy.pdf
Module 02 - Introduction to Food Safety 3.3.18 (3).ppt
PRODUCTION PRACTICES FOR ANNUAL CROPS.ppt
Subordinate_Clauses_BlueGradient_Optimized.pptxeiidi
Altered metabolism (Warburg effect, glutamine addiction, lipid metabolism)

cookery_g10_learning_module-1-).docx

  • 1. LM-Cookery Grade 10 1 TABLE OF CONTENTS Page Cover Page Table of Contents Introduction......................................................................................4 Content Standard and Performance Standard............................5 Objectives...................................................................................5 Program Requirements...............................................................5 Learning Episodes ......................................................................6 How to Use the Module...............................................................7 Diagnostic Assessment ..................................................................8 Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies (PECs)..........................13 Environment and Market (EM)........................................................27 Quarter I Egg, Cereal, and Starch Dishes Overview.....................................................................................49 Objectives...................................................................................49 Pre-Test 1...................................................................................49 Lesson 1 Prepare Egg Dishes LO 1 Perform Mise‘en Place.................................................53 LO 2 Prepare and Cook egg Dishes…..................................64 LO 3 Present Egg dishes… ..................................................85 LO 4 Storing Egg Dishes…...................................................100 Lesson 2 Prepare Cereals and Starch Dishes LO 1 Perform Mise‘en Place.................................................103 LO 2 Prepare Starch and Cereal Dishes… ...........................113 LO 3 Present Starch and Cereal Dishes… ...........................124 LO 4 Store Starch and Cereal Dishes… ...............................131 Enhancement Activity… ................................................................135 Post Test 1...................................................................................137 Quarter II Vegetable and Seafood Dishes Overview .....................................................................................141 Objectives ...................................................................................141 Pre-Test 2 ...................................................................................141 Lesson 1 Prepare Vegetable Dishes LO 1 Perform Mise‘ En Place................................................145 LO 2 Prepare Vegetable Dishes…........................................166
  • 2. LM-Cookery Grade 10 2 LO 3 Present Vegetable Dishes ........................................... 185 LO 4 Store Vegetable Dishes ............................................... 191 Lesson 2 Prepare and Cook Seafood Dishes LO 1 Perform Mise‘ En Place………………………………… 193 LO 2 Handle Seafood Dishes……………………………….. 200 LO 3 Cook Seafood...………………………… ……………… 205 LO 4 Plate/Present Seafood Dishes…………………………. 226 LO 5 Store Seafood……………….…………………………… 232 Enhancement Activity .................................................................234 Post Test 2 ............................................................................... 235 Quarter III Stocks, Sauces, Soups and Poultry Dishes Overview ………………………………………………………… 238 Objectives................................................................................... 238 Pre-Test 3................................................................................... 238 Lesson 1 Prepare Stocks, Sauces and Soups LO 1 Prepare Stocks Required for Menu Items…................. 242 LO 2 Prepare Soups Required for Menu Items..................... 255 LO 3 Prepare Sauces Required for Menu Items… ............... 271 LO 4 Store and Reconstitute Stocks, Sauces and Soups… 284 Lesson 2 Prepare Poultry Dishes LO 1 Perform Mise‘ En Place ............................................... 287 LO 2 Cook Poultry Dishes…................................................. 297 LO 3 Plate/Present Poultry Dishes….................................... 313 LO 4 Store Poultry................................................................ 320 Enhancement Activity……………………………………………. Post Test 3.................................................................................. 326 Quarter IV Meat Dishes Overview .................................................................................... 329 Objectives................................................................................... 329 Pre-Test 4................................................................................... 329 Lesson 1 Prepare and Cook Meat Dishes LO 1 Perform Mise‘en Place………………………………. 333 LO 2 Cook Meat………………….…..…………………….. 340 LO 3 Plate/Present desserts………….……..……………. 365 LO 4 Store Meat……………………………………………. 375 Enhancement Activity……………………………………………. Post Test ……………………………………………………….. 382
  • 3. LM-Cookery Grade 10 3 Summative Test…………………………………………………….. 387 Synthesis ………..………………………………………………. 392 Glossary ………………………………………………………… 393 References…….…………………………………………………… 397 Key to Correction ………………………………………………… 403
  • 4. LM-Cookery Grade 10 4 Introduction Technology and Livelihood Education (TLE) is one nomenclature in the implementation of the K to 12 Basic Education Program (BEP). It is composed of four components, namely, Agri-Fishery Arts, Home Economics, Industrial Arts and Information and Communication Technology. In this learning material, the focus is on a course in Home Economics – Cookery. The course provides varied and relevant activities and opportunities to determine your understanding of the key concepts and to demonstrate core competencies as prescribed in TESDA Training Regulation in Cookery. Thus, it aims to provide quality service to target clients alongside of assessing yourself as to the aspects of business that you may consider to strengthen and become part of the food provider sector. The world of work today presents a picture of available jobs that are getting scarcer each year. To address this reality, the Department of Education is stretching its available resources, prioritizing needs, and developing sustainable programs to lead and to prepare the young minds as future skillful chef or any related job. The department further believes that it is in honing the skills that the learner can have an edge over other job seekers. DepEd endeavors to equip the learners with the appropriate knowledge, attitudes, values and skills necessary to become productive citizen of our society. This learner‘s material is specifically crafted to focus on the different activities that will assess your level in terms of skills and knowledge necessary to get a Certificate of Competency and/or National Certification. This learner‘s material will surely make you a certified food provider.
  • 5. LM-Cookery Grade 10 5 Content Standard The learner demonstrates understanding of core concepts and theories in cookery lessons. Performance Standard The learner independently demonstrates core competencies in cookery as prescribed in the TESDA Training Regulation. Objectives Learners are expected to become proficient in performing skills on the following competencies: 1. develop personal entrepreneurial skills; 2. prepare egg dishes; 3. prepare cereals and starch dishes; 4. prepare vegetables dishes; 5. prepare and cook seafood dishes; 6. prepare stocks, sauces and soups; 7. prepare poultry and game dishes; and 8. prepare and cook meat. Program Requirements Grade 10 students who will take Cookery course as their specialization in Technology and Livelihood Education (TLE) – Home Economics should have successfully taken the exploratory course in Commercial Cooking in Grade 7/8 and have successfully completed the competencies indicated in Grade 9. The student of this course must possess the following characteristic: 1. incline in cooking and other cooking-related activities; 2. can communicate both in oral and written; 3. physically and mentally fit; 4. with good moral character; and 5. can perform basic mathematical computation. Learners are expected to develop their knowledge and skills in Cookery, demonstrate mise ‘en place, cook, present and evaluate egg, starch and cereal, vegetable, stocks, sauces and soups, poultry and game, and meat dishes.
  • 6. LM-Cookery Grade 10 6 This learner‘s material should be taken for one school year for a total of 160 hours. Lessons should be taken one at a time, following the correct sequence being presented and should accomplish the assessment or enhancement activities before proceeding to the next lesson. Along the learning process, learners of this course are required to complete the 25-hour industry involvement to different food services to experience the actual workplace. Learning Episodes This learner‘s material is subdivided into four (4) quarters which may serve as the recommended scope and limit for every academic grading period. In every quarter there are lessons that comprise the learning outcomes. Before exploring the core competencies of Cookery, you will be guided on how to assess your own Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies and Skills (PECS) and demonstrate your understanding about the Environment and Market. Quarter I is compose of two lessons. Lesson I is all about preparation, cooking and presenting different kinds of egg dishes while Lesson II is on cereals and starch dishes. Quarter II has two lessons, the preparation of vegetable dishes and seafood dishes. Learn the different kinds and classifications of vegetables and seafood, cooking, plating dishes and storing food items. Quarter III consists of lessons on preparing stocks, sauces and soups, and poultry and game dishes. Quarter IV covers lessons on how to prepare and cook different kinds of meat like pork, beef, carabeef and others. Enjoy using this learner‘s material as your guide to become a successful chef in the future.
  • 7. LM-Cookery Grade 10 7 HOW TO USE THIS LEARNER’S MATERIAL? Here are some reminders on how to use this material. 1. Answer the diagnostic assessment before you proceed to the different activities. The diagnostic assessment determines how much you know about the lessons and identifies the areas you ought to learn more. Your teacher will check and analyze your score to determine your learning needs. 2. This learner‘s material contains relevant information and activities. Go over each activity carefully. If you encounter difficulties, do not hesitate to consult your teacher for assistance. Do not skip any topic unless you are told to do so. REMEMBER that each activity is a preparation for the succeeding activities. 3. For every lesson/learning outcomes, perform the enhancement activities to enrich the knowledge and skills. 4. After successfully finished the tasks, answer the post-test to be given by your teacher. Your score will be analyzed and will be used by your teacher for the computation of your grades. 5. Lastly, DO NOT marks the learner‘s material in any way.
  • 8. LM-Cookery Grade 10 8 A. Multiple Choice. Directions: Read the following questions carefully and choose the letter that best describes the statement. Write your answer on your test notebook. 1. Which of the following is the right step by step procedures in manual dishwashing. A. Drain and air-dry, scrape and pre-rinse, rinse, sanitize, and wash dishes. B. Rinse, scrape and pre-rinse, wash, drain, air-dry and sanitize dishes C.Scrape and pre-rinse, rinse, wash, sanitize, drain and air-dry dishes D.Scrape and pre-rinse, wash, rinse, sanitize, drain and air-dry dishes 2. Which of the following parts of an egg is produced by the oviduct and consist of four alternating layers of thick and thin consistencies. A. Air cell C. Chalaza B. Albumen D. Yolk 3. Which of the following vitamins is found in eggs? A. B1 C. D B. C D. K 4. The appearance of egg is important for consumer appeal. ON what basis are shells evaluated? A. cleanliness, shape, texture and soundness B. grade, texture, cleanliness, shape C. shape, texture, cleanliness and size D. texture, soundness, size and cleanliness 5. Which of the following market forms of eggs is seldom used in cooking. A. Dried egg C. Frozen egg B. Fresh egg D. Shelled egg 6. Which of the following raises coagulation temperature producing softer, weaker gel when added to egg used in culinary. A. Alkali C. Sugar B. Salt D. Vinegar 7. Which kind of egg dish is prepared by slipping shelled eggs into barely simmering water and gently cooking until the egg holds its shape? A. Fried egg C. Scrambled egg B. Poached egg D. Soft-boiled egg DIAGNOSTIC ASSESSMENT
  • 9. LM-Cookery Grade 10 9 8. Which of the following tools is not used in cooking omelet? A. Bowls C. Sauté pan B. Fork D. Skimmer 9. Which of the following is true in plating egg dishes? A. Choose serving dish small enough to let each food item stand out B. Play with color and texture C. Protein dish should cover half of the plate D. Use even numbers in setting the dish. 10.Which of the following sources of starch is rarely used in manufacturing food starch? A. Cassava C. Potato B. Corn D. Rice 11. Which of the following changes in starch during cooking is the resistance to flow; increase in thickness or consistency. A. Dextrinization C. Retrogadation B. Gelatinization D. Viscosity 12. Which of the following is suggested if you will hold pasta for a short time for later service? A. Cook pasta ahead of time and chill B. Drain and add sauce C. Drain, toss with a small amount of oil, cover and hold in warmer D. Undercook slightly the pasta 13.Which is the process of making a new product to be sold to the customers? A. Product Analysis C. Product Development B. Product Conceptualization D. Product Implementation 14. This is a meaningful and unforgettable statement that captures the essence of your brand. A. Branding C. Tagline B. Product Naming D. Unique Selling Proposition 15.What managerial tool is used to assess the environment to gather important information for strategic planning? A. Environmental Scanning C. Survey Analysis B. SWOT Analysis D.WOTS Analysis 16. What animal produces veal meat? A. Calf C. Hog B. Deer D. Sheep 17. Which of the following market forms of meat does not undergo chilling? A. Cured meat C. Frozen meat B. Fresh meat D. Processed meat
  • 10. LM-Cookery Grade 10 10 18. What part of the meat helps you identify the less tender cuts? A. Bone C. Flesh B. Fat D. Ligament 19. What part of the meat has the greatest amount of quality protein? A. Bone C. Flesh B. Fat D. Ligament 20. Which of the following meat cuts requires long and slow cooking temperature? A. Less tender C. Tender B. Slightly tough D. Tough 21. Which of the following is a long – bladed hatchet or a heavy knife used by a butcher? A. Butchers knife C. Cleaver knife B. Chopper knife D. Set of slicing knife 22. Which of the cooking methods does not belong to dry heat method? A. Baking C. Roasting B. Broiling D. Stewing 23. What do you call to the cooking method when meat is cooked in steaming liquid in which bubbles are breaking on the surface. A. Boiling C. Roasting B. Broiling D. Stewing 24. Which is an oil-acid mixture used to enhance the flavor of meat. A. Brine solution C. Soy sauce and vinegar B. Marinade D. Salt and calamansi 25. Which of the following tools is used for carving? A. Cleaver knife C. Slicer B. Fork D. Razor knife 26. To which meat cut do internal organs belong? A. Less tender cuts C. Tough cuts B. Tender cuts D. Variety cuts 27. Where should meat products be stored? A. Crisper C. Dry shelf B. Cold shelf D. Freezer 28. Which of the following is the tenderest cut of beef? A. Chunk C. Sirloin B. Round cut D. Tenderloin 29. Which will you consider first when buying meats? A. Brand C. Quality B. Price D. Round cut 30. What is your primary consideration when storing goods? A. Expiration date C. Quantity B. Fragility D. Size
  • 11. LM-Cookery Grade 10 11 31. What do ou call to young immature pigeon of either sex with extra tender meat? A. Duck C. Rooster B. Fryer D. Squab 32. To what part of poultry does breast meat belong? A. Dark meat C. Variety meat B. Tough meat D. White meat 33. Which of the following characteristics is a good quality of a live poultry? A. Free from pin feathers and shows no cuts B. Eyes are clear C.Is heavy and the skin is watery D.Thighs are well-developed 34. What do you call to a young chicken that is usually 9 to 12 weeks of? A. Fryer C. Roaster B. Hen D. Stag 35. How many days should a whole chicken be refrigerated? A. 1 day C. 2 to 4 days B. 1 to 2 days D. 3 to 4 days 36. How do you classify the fleshy part of chicken like breast? A. Entrails C. Viscera B. Dark meat D. White meat 37. What cookery method is used for a matured poultry? A. Boiling C. Roasting B. Frying D. Stewing 38. What cookery method is suitable for the less tender cuts? A. Boiling C. Roasting B. Frying D. Stewing 39. What is the best cooking temperature for poultry? A. High temperature C. Low to moderate temperature B. Low temperature D. Moderate temperature 40. What factor affects the poultry meat‘s tenderness and juiciness? A. Age C. Cuts B. Cookery D. Sex 41. What is the flavor component of vegetables which gives strong flavor and odor to some vegetables like onions, leeks, garlic, chives, cabbage, and broccoli? A. Flavonoids C. Sugar C. Glutamic acid D. Sulfur compounds 42. What is a way of cooking by placing blanched or raw vegetables in the pan, adding liquid (stock, water, wine) then covering and cooking it slowly. A. Boiling C. Braising B. Baking D. Sautéing
  • 12. LM-Cookery Grade 10 12 43. Which of the following plating styles is not a classic arrangement? A. Starch or vegetable item is heaped in the center while the main item is sliced and lean up against it. B. The main item is in the center, with vegetable distributed around it. C. The vegetable item is n the rear and main item, starch item and garnish at the front. D.The main item is in the center with neat piles of vegetables carefully arranged around. 44. Which of the following vegetables is cooked uncovered? A. Fruit vegetables C. Roots and tubers B. Green vegetables D. Yellow vegetables 45. Which of the following is a freshwater fish? A. Bluefish C. Grouper B. Cat fish D. Sole 46. Which is the market form of fish where both sides of a fish is still joined but bones are removed? A. Butterfly C. Fillet B. Drawn D. Steak 47. Which of the following is a characteristic of a fresh fish? A. With fresh and foul odor B. Eyes are dull, shiny and bulging C. Gills are red or pink D. Flesh shrink when pressed 48. Which of the following seafood is cooked just enough to heat to keep juicy and plump? A. Fat fish C. Flat fish B. lean fish D. Shellfish 49. Which of the following is a cooking method suited to fat fish? A. Baking C. Deep -frying B. Boiling D. Sautéing 50. What is used to baste lean fish to help prevent them from drying up. A. Butter C. Soy sauce B. Cream D. Tomato sauce
  • 13. LM-Cookery Grade 10 13 Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies (PECs) Content Standards Performance Standards The learner demonstrates understanding of one‘s PECs in Cookery. The learner independently creates a plan of action that strengthens and or further develops his/her PECs in Cookery Quarter I Time Allotment: 4 hours Module 1 Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies Introduction In this module, you will learn more about entrepreneurship and the entrepreneurial competencies related to Cookery. You will have a first-hand experience in educational activities leading to personal assessment of your entrepreneurial competencies and assessment of entrepreneurial competencies of a successful chef within your area. You will also have some activities that will align your competencies those of successful practitioners. Moreover, this module will stimulate your mind to think about entrepreneurship and its role in the business community, as well as in the economic and social development. To start with this module, let us first understand entrepreneurs and entrepreneurship. Entrepreneurs are people with skills and capabilities to see and evaluate business opportunities. They are individuals that can strategically identify products or services needed by the community and they have the capacity to deliver these at the right time and at the right place. Entrepreneurs are agents of economic change; they organize, manage and assume risks of a business. Some of the good qualities of an entrepreneur are opportunity seeker, risk taker, goal setter, excellent planner, a confident problem solver, hardworking, persistent, and a committed worker.
  • 14. LM-Cookery Grade 10 14 Entrepreneurship, on the other hand, is not just a simple business activity. It is a strategic process of innovation and new venture creation. Basically, entrepreneurship is both an art and science of converting business ideas into marketable products or services to improve the quality of living. Now that you have a little background knowledge about entrepreneurs and entrepreneurship, can you now walk through in assessing your PECs? Always remember that ―Successful entrepreneurs continuously develop and improve their PECs.‖ To begin with, let us first try to find out the competencies you will master as you finish this module. OBJECTIVES At the end of this module, you are expected to:  identify areas for improvement, development and growth;  align your PECs according to your business or career choice; and  create a plan of action that ensures success in your business or career choice. Now that you have an idea about the knowledge and skill that you will develop and master, take the first challenge in this module – the pre- assessment.
  • 15. LM-Cookery Grade 10 15 PRE-ASSESSMENT As part of your initial activity, you will be challenged to dig deeper on your knowledge and previous experiences on the topic. Try to diagnose or assess what you already know about PECs by answering Task 1. Task 1: Matching Type Direction: Match the entrepreneurial competencies in column A with their meaning in column B. Write the letter of the correct answer on the space provided before each number. A B 1. Creative A. make a wise decision towards the set objectives 2. Profit-oriented B. strategic thinking and setting of goals 3. Discipline C. trust in one‘s ability 4. Decision Making D. adoptable to change 5. People Skill E. innovative to have edge over other competitors 6. Planner F. solid dedication 7. Self-confidence G. skillful in record keeping 8. Hardworking H. always stick to the plan 9. Ability to accept change I. working diligently 10. Committed J effective and efficient communication and relation to people K. always looking for income Task 2: Guide Questions Direction: The following are guide questions which encapsulate the entire module. Write your answers on your assignment notebook, and then share these to the class. A. Explain why entrepreneurial activities are important to social development and progress of the economy. B. What entrepreneurial activities do you know and capable of doing which are related to Cookery? C. Given the opportunity to own a business that relates with Cookery are you confident to manage it? Explain your answer. D. What do you think are the most important competencies you must possess in order to be successful in running your chosen business?
  • 16. LM-Cookery Grade 10 16 Goals and Targets Learning Activities Ultimate Goal After answering all the guide questions to the best of your knowledge and skills, share those with your classmates. You too, may compare your insights, personal knowledge, and relevant experiences on the topic to make it more exciting and engaging. E. Name successful entrepreneurs from your area whose business is related to Cookery. Be able to share to the class their PECs that made them successful. LEARNING GOALS AND TARGET After understanding the objectives of this module, having gone through pre-assessment, and answering the guide questions, you will be asked to set your own personal goals. These goals will trigger you to further achieve the ultimate objective of this module. In the end, these goals will motivate you to learn more about PECs. Figure 1: Strategic process to achieve the objectives of this module READING RESOURCES AND INSTRUCTIONAL ACTIVITIES After setting your own personal goals and targets in achieving the objectives of this module, check your inherent knowledge of PECs. Answer the following guide questions with the help of your classmates.
  • 17. LM-Cookery Grade 10 17 Task 3: Group Activity Direction: Answer the following guide questions on a separate sheet of paper. Share your answers to the class. 1. Explain the importance of assessing one‘s PECs before engaging in a particular entrepreneurial activity. 2. Are there other strategies or approaches where you can assess your PECs? Explain how those strategies will become more useful in selecting a viable business venture. 3. What are the desirable personal characteristics, attributes, lifestyles, skills and traits of a prospective entrepreneur? Why are these important? 4. Why there is a need to assess one‘s PECs in terms of characteristics, attributes, lifestyles, skills, and traits before starting a particular business?
  • 18. LM-Cookery Grade 10 18 Know 5. What is the significance of evaluating PECs of a successful entrepreneur? What helpful insights can you draw from this activity? _ . How was your experience in answering the guide questions with your classmates? Were you able to benefit from them? What were the insights you have realized? This time you‘re going to study the different topics that will enrich your knowledge of PECs. Read carefully all the important details about the succeeding topic. Assessment of Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies (PECs) and Skills vis- à-vis a Practicing Entrepreneur or Employee in a Province Entrepreneurial competencies refer to the important characteristics that should be possessed by an individual in order to perform entrepreneurial functions effectively. In this module, you will learn some of the most important characteristics, attributes, lifestyle, skills and traits of a successful entrepreneur in order to be successful in a chosen career. Below are few important characteristics / traits / attributes of a good entrepreneur: Hardworking: One of the important characteristics of a good entrepreneur is hardworking. This means habitually working diligently for a long period of time. Hardworking people keep on improving their performance to produce good products and/or provide good services.
  • 19. LM-Cookery Grade 10 19  Self-confidence: Entrepreneurs have confidence in one‘s ability and own judgment. They exhibit self-confidence in order to cope with all the risks of operating their own business. Discipline: Successful entrepreneurs always stick on the plan and fight the temptation to do what is unimportant. Committed: A good entrepreneur accepts full responsibility of everything in his/her business. He/she gives full commitment and solid dedication to make the business successful. Ability to accept change: Nothing is permanent but change. Change occurs frequently. When you own a business, you should cope-up and thrive on changes. Capitalize on positive changes to make your business grow. Creative: An entrepreneur should be creative and innovative to stay in the business and in order to have an edge over the other competitors. Has the Initiative: An entrepreneur takes the initiative. You must put yourself in a position where you are responsible for the failure or success of your business. Profit-Oriented: An entrepreneur enters into the world of business to generate profit or additional income. This shall become the bread and butter for you and for your family as well. Therefore, you must see to it that the business can generate income. Listed below are the important skills of a successful entrepreneur: Planner: Planning is strategic thinking and setting of goals to achieve objectives by carefully maximizing all the available resources. A good entrepreneur develops and applies step-by-step plans to realize goals. A good entrepreneur knows that planning is an effective skill only when combined with action.  People Skills: It‘s a very important skill in order to be successful in any kind of business. People skills refer to effective and efficient communication and relation to people working in and out of your
  • 20. LM-Cookery Grade 10 20 Process business. In day-to-day business transactions, you need to deal with people. A well-developed people skill can spell out the difference between success and failure of the business. Decision Making: Successful entrepreneurs have the ability to think quickly, and to make a wise decision towards pre-determined set objectives. No one can deny that the ability to make wise decisions is an important skill that an entrepreneur should possess. Sound decision should spring out from given facts and information and should be towards the pre-determined objectives. In order to firm up what you have learned and to have a better appreciation of the different entrepreneurial competencies, read the PECs checklist presented below, then answer the same. Task 4: PECs Checklist Directions: Using the PECs checklist, assess yourself by indicating a check (/) mark in either strengths or development areas column. Interpret the results by counting the total number of check marks in each of the columns. After accomplishing the checklist, form a group and share your insights and experiences why you came up with that personal assessment.
  • 21. LM-Cookery Grade 10 21 Table 1: PECs Checklist Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies of an Entrepreneur Personal Assessment in terms of: Strengths Development Areas Hardworking - Working diligently Self-confidence - Confidence in one‘s ability Discipline - Always stick to the plan Committed - Solid dedication Ability to accept changes - Adoptable to change Creative - Innovative to have edge over other competitors Profit-oriented - Always looking for income Planner - Strategic thinking and setting of goals People Skill - effective and efficient communication and relation to people Decision Making - make a wise decision towards the set objectives TOTAL
  • 22. LM-Cookery Grade 10 22 Interpretation or Insights: . How was your experience in discovering your strengths and the areas to be developed? Did you gain valuable experience in exchanging insights with your classmates? To learn more and deepen your understanding of PECs, do Task 5 below. Task 5: Interview Interview a successful chef or entrepreneur in your area whose type of business is related with Cookery. Focus your interview on PECs and other business-related attributes that helped them become successful. Analyze the result of the interview and reflect on the similarities and/or differences. Write your answer on a separate sheet of paper. Sample Interview Guide Name of Proprietor/Practitioner: Age: Number of Years in Business: Business Name: Business Address: 1. What are your preparations before you engaged in this type of business or job? Reflect and Understand
  • 23. LM-Cookery Grade 10 23 2. What are your special skills and characteristics that are related with your business or job? 3. How did you solve business-related problems during the early years of your business operation? 4. Did you follow the tips from a successful businessman or practitioner before you engage in your business? 5. What are your best business practices that you can share with aspiring students? 6. What are the salient characteristics, attributes, lifestyle, skills and traits that made you successful in your business or job? Note: Cull the needed information from the interview to supply answer/s to Row 1 in the table below. Meanwhile, fill out the second row with your PECs.
  • 24. LM-Cookery Grade 10 24 Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies Characteristics Attributes Lifestyles Skills Traits Successful Entrepreneur in the place My PECs Using the information on the table above, analyze and reflect on the similarities and differences in your answers. Put your reflection on the table below. Write your conclusion on the space provided. Personal Entrepreneurial Competencies Similarities Differences Characteristics Attributes Lifestyles Skills Traits Conclusion: .
  • 25. LM-Cookery Grade 10 25 After performing the activities on the importance of PECs, let‘s determine how much you have learned. Perform Task 6 to determine how well you have understood the lesson. Task 6: Preparation of a Plan of Action Directions: Using the table below and the information generated from Task 5 (Interview), prepare an action plan that indicates how you would align your PECs to the PECs of a successful entrepreneur in Cookery in your place. Objective Area Activities Strategies Time Frame Expected Outcome To align my PECs with the PECs of a successful entrepreneur in Cookery. Characteristics Skills Attribute Traits Transfer
  • 26. LM-Cookery Grade 10 26 Task 7: Essential Questions Directions: Read and study the following questions below. You may use a separate sheet of paper or your notebook to write your answers. 1. Why is there a need to compare and align one‘s PECs with the PECs of a successful entrepreneur? . 2. How does your action plan help sustain your strong PECs and/or address your development areas? . 3. What plan of action would you prepare to address your development areas? .
  • 27. LM-Cookery Grade 10 27 ENVIRONMENT AND MARKET(EM) Content Standards Performance Standards The learner demonstrates understanding of environment and market in Cookery in one‘s area. The learner independently creates a business vicinity map reflective of potential market in Cookery in a province. Quarter I Time Allotment: 4 hours Introduction Module 2 Environment and Market People who aspire to start a business need to explore the economic, cultural and social conditions prevailing in an area. Needs and wants of the people in a certain area that are not met may be considered as business opportunities. Identifying the needs of the community, its resources, available raw materials, skills, and appropriate technology can help a new entrepreneur in seizing a business opportunity. To be successful in any kind of business venture, potential entrepreneurs should always look closely at the environment and market. They should always be watchful on the existing opportunities and constraints. The opportunities in the business environment are those factors that provide possibilities for a business to expand and make more profits. Constraints, on the other hand, are that factor that limit the business to grow, hence reduces the chance of generating profit. One of the best ways to evaluate the opportunities and constraints is to conduct SWOT (Strengths, Weaknesses, Opportunities and Threats) Analysis. SWOT Analysis is a managerial tool to assess the environment. This gathers important information which in turn is used in strategic planning. Strengths and weaknesses are internal in an organization. Basically, they relate to resources owned by the organization, by the things that you have control over, and as well as to the extent of its marketing.
  • 28. LM-Cookery Grade 10 28 Opportunities and threats exist in the external environment. Opportunities relate to the market, to the development of new technologies, and external factors such as government policies, climate, and trends. Threats relate to what the competition is doing, as well as legal and other constraints. Now that you have read some important considerations to look into to be successful in any business, you are now ready to explore more about the environment and market. To begin with, let‘s find out the competencies that you will master as you finish this module. OBJECTIVES At the end of this module, you are expected to:  identify what is of ―value‖ to the customer;  identify the customer to sell to;  explain what makes a product unique and competitive;  apply creativity and innovative techniques to develop marketable product; and  employ a unique selling proposition (USP) to the product and/or service. Now that you have an idea about the things you will learn, take the first challenge in this module – the pre-assessment.
  • 29. LM-Cookery Grade 10 29 PRE-ASSESSMENT Task 1: Multiple-Choice Directions: Choose the letter of the best answer. Write your answer on a separate sheet of paper. 1. This is generated by examining the goods and services sold in the community. A. business creation C. business concept B. business pricing D. business idea 2. A process of making a new product to be sold to the customers. A. product analysis C. product development B. product conceptualization D. productimplementation 3. These are luxuries, advantages and desires that every individual considers beyond necessity. A. wants C. requirements B. desires D. needs 4. This is the factor or consideration presented by a seller as the reason that one product or service is different from and better than that of the competition. A. unique selling plan C. unique pricing policy B. unique selling proposition D. finding value-added 5. In this stage, the needs of the target market are identified, reviewed and evaluated. A. concept development C. project development B. economic analysis D. refine specification 6. This is the introduction of new ideas to make the product and services more attractive and saleable to the target customers. A. new idea C. product development B. creativity D. innovation 7. A managerial tool used to assess the environment and to gather important information that can be used for strategic planning. A. environmental scanning C. WOTS Analysis B. SWOT Analysis D. survey analysis 8. A marketing practice of creating name, symbol or design that identifies and differentiate a product from the other products. A. product naming C. branding B. unique selling proposition D. tagline 9. This is a meaningful and unforgettable statement that captures the essence of the brand. A. product naming C. branding B. unique selling proposition D. tagline
  • 30. LM-Cookery Grade 10 30 10. These are the things that people cannot live without in a society. A. wants C. requirements B. desires D. needs Task 2: Guide Questions: Directions: Read and study the guide questions below. Use a separate sheet of paper to write your answer. 1. How does one determine the product or services to be produced and or to be offered or delivered to the target customers? 2. How does one select an entrepreneurial activity? 3. When can one say that a certain product has a ―value‖? 4. Are innovation and creativity to your product or services important? Why? 5. How can one effectively respond to the needs of the target customer? 6. Express from the viewpoint of business owner the importance of scanning the environment and market in generating business ideas.
  • 31. LM-Cookery Grade 10 31 7. Using self-assessment, explain your level of confidence in formulating a business idea. LEARNING GOALS AND TARGET After reading and understanding the objectives of this module and having gone through the pre-assessment and guide questions, you will be asked to set your own personal goals. These goals will trigger you to further achieve the ultimate objective of this module. In the end, these goals will motivate you to learn more about Environment and Market. Figure 2: Strategic process to achieve the objectives of this module. READING RESOURCES AND INSTRUCTIONAL ACTIVITIES After setting your own personal goals and targets in achieving the objectives of this module, you will have the opportunity to read and learn more about environment and market. You will also be given a chance to do practical exercises and activities to deepen your understanding of the topic. After all the guide questions have been answered and skills have been mastered, share those with your classmates. Discuss your insights, personal knowledge, and relevant experiences on the topic to make it more exciting and engaging. Goals and Targets Learning Activities Ultimate Goal
  • 32. LM-Cookery Grade 10 32 Product Development When we talk of product development, we are referring to a process of making a new product to be sold by a business or enterprise to its customers. The product development may involve modification of an existing product or its presentation, or formulation of an entirely new product that satisfies a newly defined customer‘s needs, wants and/or a market place. The term development in this module refers collectively to the entire process of identifying a market opportunity, creating a product to appeal to the identified market, and finally, testing, modifying and refining the product until it becomes ready for production. There are basic, yet vital questions that you can ask yourself about product development. When you find acceptable answers to these, you may now say that you are ready to develop a product and/or render services: 1. For whom are the product services aimed at? 2. What benefits will the customers expect from it? 3. How will the product differ from the existing brand? From its competitor? Likewise, needs and wants of the people within an area should also be taken into big consideration. Everyone has his/her own needs and wants. However, everyone has different concepts of needs and wants. Needs in business are important things that every individual cannot live without in a society. These include: 1. basic commodities for consumption; 2. clothing and other personal belongings; 3. shelter, sanitation and health; and 4. education. Basic needs are essential to an individual to live with dignity and pride in a community. These needs can obviously help you generate business ideas and subsequently to product development. Know
  • 33. LM-Cookery Grade 10 33 Wants are desires, luxury and extravagance that signify wealth and expensive way of living. Wants or desires are considered above all the basic necessities of life. Some examples of wants or desires: fashion accessories, expensive shoes and clothes, travelling around the world, eating in an expensive restaurant; watching movies, concerts, having luxurious cars, wearing expensive jewelries, perfume, living in impressive homes, among others. Needs and wants of people are the basic indicators of the kind of business that you may engage into because it can serve as the measure of your success. Some other good points that might be considered in business undertakings are the kind of people, their needs, wants, lifestyle, culture and tradition, and social orientation that they belong to. To summarize, product development entirely depends on the needs and wants of the customers. Another important issue to deal with is the key concepts of developing a product. The succeeding topic will enlighten you about the procedure in coming up with a product. Concepts of Developing a Product Concept development is a critical phase in the development of a product. In this stage, the needs of the target market are identified and competitive products are reviewed before the product specifications are defined. The product concept is selected along with an economic analysis to come up with an outline of how a product is being developed. Below is a figure that shows the stages of concept development of a product.
  • 34. LM-Cookery Grade 10 34 Concept Development Figure 3: Concept Development The process of product development follows the following steps: A. Identify Customer Needs: Using survey forms, interviews, researches, focus group discussions, and observations, an entrepreneur can easily identify customers‘ needs and wants. In this stage, the information that can be possibly gathered are product specifications (performance, taste, size, color, shape, life span of the product, etc.). This stage is very important because this would determine the product to be produced or provided. B. Establish Target Specifications: Based on customers' needs and reviews of competitive products, you may now establish target specifications of the prospective new product and/or services. Target specifications are essentially a wish-list. Establish Target Specifications Perform Economic Analysis Analyze Competitive Products Plan Remaining Developme nt Project Refine Specifications Selecta Product Concept Generate Product Concepts Identify Customer Needs
  • 35. LM-Cookery Grade 10 35 C. Analyze Competitive Products: It is imperative to analyze existing competitive products to provide important information in establishing product or services specifications. Other products may exhibit successful design attributes that should be emulated or improved upon in the new product or services. D. Generate Product Concepts:After having gone through with the previous processes, you may now develop a number of product concepts to illustrate what types of product or services are both technically feasible and would best meet the requirements of the target specifications. E. Select a Product Concept: Through the process of evaluation between attributes, a final concept is selected. After the final selection, additional market research can be applied to obtain feedback from certain key customers. F. Refine Product Specifications: In this stage, product or services specifications are refined on the basis of input from the foregoing activities. Final specification as the results of extensive study, expected service life, projected selling price and among others are being considered in this stage. G. Perform Economic Analysis: Throughout the process of product development, it is very important to always review and estimate the economic implications regarding development expenses, manufacturing costs, and selling price of the product or services to be offered or provided. H. Plan the Remaining Development Project: In this final stage of concept development, you may prepare a detailed development plan which includes list of activities, the necessary resources and expenses, and development schedule with milestones for tracking progress.
  • 36. LM-Cookery Grade 10 36 Finding Value People buy for a reason. There should be something in your product or service that would give consumers a good reason to go back and buy for more. There must be something that has to make you the best option for your target customers; otherwise they have no reason to buy what you‘re selling. This implies further, that you offer something to your customers that they will make them value or treasure your product or service. The value that you incorporate to your product is called value proposition. Value proposition is ―a believable collection of the most persuasive reasons people should notice you and take the action you‘re asking for.‖ Value is created by fulfilling deep desires and solving deep problems. This is what gets people moving, what people getsspending for your product or service. Innovation Innovation is the introduction of something new in your product or service. This may be a new idea, a new method or a device. If you want to increase your sales and profit, you must innovate. Some of the possible innovations in your products are change of packaging, improve taste, color, size, shape and perhaps price. Some of the possible innovations in providing services are application of new improved methods, additional featured services and possibly freebees. Unique Selling Proposition (USP) Unique Selling Proposition is the factor or consideration presented by a seller as the reason that one product or service is different from and better than that of the competitions. Before you can begin to sell your product or service to your target customers, you have to sell yourself on it. This is especially important when your product or service is similar to those around you. USP would require careful analysis of other businesses' ads and marketing messages. If you analyze what they say or what they sell, not just their product or service characteristics, you can learn a great deal about how companies distinguish themselves from competitors.
  • 37. LM-Cookery Grade 10 37 Here's how to discover your USP and use it to increase your sales and profit:  Use empathy: Put yourself in the shoes of your customers. Always focus on the needs of the target customers and forget falling in love with your own product or service. Always remember, you are making this product or providing for the target customers to eventually increase sales and earn profit and not making this product or service for you. Essential question such as what could make them come back again and ignore competition should be asked to oneself. Most possible answers may be focused on quality, availability, convenience, cleanliness, and reliability of the product or service.  Identify what motivates your customers. It is very important for you to understand and find out what drives and motivates your customers to buy your product or service. Make some efforts to find out, analyze and utilize the information that motivates the customers in their decisions to purchase the product or service.  Discover the actual and genuine reasons why customers buy your product instead of a competitor's. Information is very important in decision making. A competitive entrepreneur always improve this products or services to provide satisfaction and of course retention of customers. As your business grows, you should always consider the process of asking your customers important information and questions that you can use to improve your product or service.
  • 38. LM-Cookery Grade 10 38 In order to firm up your understanding of the topic previously presented, you will be tasked to form a group and conduct an interview with a successful entrepreneur or practitioner. You have to document this interview and present this to the whole class for reflection and appreciation. Task 3: Interview Directions: Select a successful entrepreneur or practitioner. Conduct an interview using the set of questions below. Document the interview and present this to the class. 1. How did you identify your customers? 2. What were your considerations in selecting your customers? 3. Explain how your product or service becomes unique compared to other products. 4. Did you consult somebody before you engage in this business? Cite sample insights that you gained from the consultation. Process
  • 39. LM-Cookery Grade 10 39 5. What were your preparations before you started the actual business? 6. What creative and innovative techniques did you adopt to your product or service? What was the effect of the innovative techniques to the sales and profits of your business? 7. What strategy did you consider to have a unique selling proposition to your product or service? Task 4: Video Viewing In order to deepen your understanding of the lesson, perform the following tasks: 1. Browse the internet and view the topics related to: a. customers‘ needs and wants b. techniques in identifying customers‘ needs and wants c. creativity or innovations in products and services d. unique selling proposition e. product development 2. Prepare a short narrative report about the aforementioned topics. You may highlight the ―aspect‖ that increases your knowledge of product development. Reflect and Understand
  • 40. LM-Cookery Grade 10 40 3. Analyze a Competitive Product - - 4. Generate Product Concept - - Task 5: Product Conceptualization Direction: Using the space and figures below, develop your own concept for your product or service. Utilize bullets in every stage of product conceptualization in listing important key ideas. Transfer 7. Prepare a Development Plan - - - 6.RefineProduct Specification - - 5. Select A product Concept - - 2. Target Specifications - - - 1. Identify Customers Need - -
  • 41. LM-Cookery Grade 10 41 Generating Ideas for Business The process of developing and generating business idea is not a simple process. Some people just come with a bunch of business ideas but are not really feasible. There are two problems that arise; first is the excessive generation of ideas that can forever remain in the dreaming stage and the second is when they don‘t have ideas and don‘t want to become entrepreneurs. The most optimal way is to have a systematic approach in generating and selecting business idea that will be transferred in real business. Here are some basic yet very important considerations that may be used to generate possible ideas for business: 1. Examine existing goods and services. Are you satisfied with the product? What do other people who use the product say about it? How can it be improved? There are many ways of improving a product from the way it is made to the way it is packed and sold. You can also improve the materials used in crafting the product. In addition, you can introduce new ways of using the product, making it more useful and adaptable to the customers‘ many needs. When you are improving the product or enhancing it, you are doing an innovation. You can also do an invention by introducing an entirely new product to replace the old one. Business ideas may also be generated by examining what goods and services are sold outside of the community. Very often, these products are sold in a form that can still be enhanced or improved. 2. Examine the present and future needs. Look and listen to what the customers, institutions, and communities are missing in terms of goods and services. Sometimes, these needs are already obvious and felt at the moment. Other needs are not that obvious because they can only be felt in the future, in the event of certain developments in the community. For example, an area will have its electrification facility in the next six months. Only by that time will the entrepreneur could think of electrically-powered Know
  • 42. LM-Cookery Grade 10 42 or generated business such as photo copier, computer service, digital printing, etc. 3. Examine how the needs are being satisfied. Needs for the products and services are referred to as market demand. To satisfy these needs is to supply the products and services that meet the demands of the market. The term market refers to whoever will use or buy the products or services, and these may be people or institutions such as other businesses, establishments, organizations, or government agencies. There is a very good business opportunity when there is absolutely no supply to a pressing market demand. Businesses or industries in the locality also have needs for goods and services. Their needs for raw materials, maintenance, and other services such as selling and distribution are good sources of ideas for business. 4. Examine the available resources around you. Observe what materials or skills are available in abundance in your area. A business can be started out of available raw materials by selling them in raw form and by processing and manufacturing them into finished products. For example, in a copra-producing town, there will be many coconut husks and shells available as ―waste‖ products. These can be collected and made into coco rags or doormat and charcoal bricks and sold profitably outside the community. A group of people in your neighborhood may have some special skills that can be harnessed for business. For example, women in the Mountain Province possess loom weaving skills that have been passed on from one generation to another. Some communities there set up weaving businesses to produce blankets, decorative and various souvenir items for sale to tourists and lowland communities. Business ideas can come from your own skills. The work and experience you may have in agricultural arts, industrial arts, home economics, and ICT classes will provide you with business opportunities to acquire the needed skills which will give you extra income, should you decide to engage in income-generating activities. With your skills, you may also tinker around with various things in your spare time. Many products were invented this way.
  • 43. LM-Cookery Grade 10 43 5. Read magazines, news articles, and other publications on new products and techniques or advances in technology. You can pick up new business ideas from Newsweek, Reader‘s Digest, Business Magazines, ―Go Negosyo‖, KAB materials, and Small-Industry Journal. The Internet also serves as a library where you may browse and surf on possible businesses. It will also guide you on how to put the right product in the right place, at the right price, at the right time. Key Concepts of Selecting a Business Idea Once you have embarked on identifying business opportunities, you will eventually see that there are many possibilities that are available for you. It is very unlikely that you will have enough resources to pursue all of them at once. You have to select the most promising one among hundreds of ideas. It will be good to do this in stages. In the first stage, you screen your ideas to narrow them down to about few choices. In the next stage, trim down the choices to two options. In the final stage, choose between the two and decide which business idea is worth pursuing. In screening your ideas, examine each one in terms of the following factors: 1. How much capital is needed to put up the business? 2. How big is the demand for the product? Do many people need this product and will continue to need it for a long time? 3. How is the demand met? Who are processing the products to meet the needs (competition or demand)? How much of the need is now being met (supply)? 4. Do you have the background and experiences needed to run this particular business? 5. Will the business be legal, not going against any existing or foreseeable government regulation? 6. Is the business in line with your interest and expertise? Your answers to these questions will be helpful in screening which ones among your many ideas are worth examining further and worth pursuing.
  • 44. LM-Cookery Grade 10 44 Branding Branding is a marketing practice of creating name, symbol or designs that identifies and differentiates product or services from the rest. It is also a promise to your customers. It tells them what they can expect from your product or service and it differentiates your offerings from other competitors. Your brand is derived from who you are, who you want to be and what people perceive you to be. Branding is one of the most important aspects of any business. An effective brand strategy gives you a major edge in increasingly competitive markets. The features of a good product brand are as follows: - Delivers the message clearly - Confirms your credibility - Connects your target prospects emotionally - Motivates the buyer - Concretizes user loyalty Here are some simple tips to publicize your brand: .  Develop a tagline. Write a meaningful, unforgettable, and easy to remember statement that captures the essence of your brand.  Get a great logo. Create a logo suitable to your business and consistent with your tagline and place it everywhere.  Write down your brand messaging. Select key messages you want to communicate about your brand.  Be true to your brand. Deliver your brand promise.  Be consistent. Be reliable and consistent every time.
  • 45. LM-Cookery Grade 10 45 In generating business idea, you should first identify what type of business is suited to your business idea. You should analyze and scan the potential environment, study the marketing practices and strategies of your competitors, analyze the strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and the threats in your environment to ensure that the products or services you are planning to offer will be patronized within the easy reach by your target consumers. Bear in mind these simple rules for successful SWOT Analysis:  Be realistic about the strengths and weaknesses of your business when conducting SWOT Analysis.  SWOT Analysis should distinguish between where your business is today, and where it could be in the future.  SWOT Analysis should always be specific. Avoid any grey area.  Always apply SWOT Analysis in relation to your competition‘ i.e. better than or worse than your competitions.  Keep your SWOT Analysis short and simple. Avoid complexity and over analysis.  SWOT Analysis is subjective. Process
  • 46. LM-Cookery Grade 10 46 Task 6: SWOT Analysis Directions: Utilize the SWOT Analysis table below to list up all your observations. Be guided by the strategies in analyzing and formulating realistic and attainable activities. Write down the activities on the available spaces provided to create the best business idea. Strength (S) Weaknesses (W) - - - - - - - - - - - - Opportunities (O) Threats (T) - - - - - - - - - - - - Strategies:  SW - Maximize on the strengths to overcome the internal weakness.  OW - Capitalize on the opportunities to eliminate the internal weakness.  ST - Maximize on your strengths to eliminate the external threats.  OT - Take advantage of the available opportunities to eliminate the external threats.
  • 47. LM-Cookery Grade 10 47 Analysis: Activities: My Best Business Idea: In order to deepen your understanding of the topics previously discussed, you will be asked to perform the following activities: Reflect and Understand
  • 48. LM-Cookery Grade 10 48 QUARTER I Prepare Egg, Cereal, and Starch Dishes Task 7: Extra Readings and Video Viewing Reading books and watching videos have been considered as one of the most effective educational activities that can help learners deepen their understanding on a certain topic. In this particular task, you will be asked to conduct extra readings and video viewings in the Internet on the following topics: A. Steps in Selecting Business Idea B. Criteria of a Viable Business Idea C. Benefits of a Good Brand D. Ways on Developing a Brand After successfully performing the assigned task, make a narrative report about it and share it to the class. Task 9: Making My Own Logo Direction: Generate a clear and appealing product brand with a logo and a tagline. TransferTr Logo Logo
  • 49. LM-Cookery Grade 10 49 QUARTER I Prepare Egg, Cereal, and Starch Dishes Overview This quarter will provide you learners the essential knowledge and opportunities to develop your skills and gained understanding in the preparation, cooking, presentation, and storing egg, cereal, and starch dishes. You will be able to know the needed tools and equipment and learn how to clean and sanitize them after each use. Differentiated activities and hands – on activities were given to give you opportunities to transfer what you have learned. Objectives At the end of the lesson, you are expected to: 1. perform Mise‘en place; 2. prepare and cook egg, cereal and starch dishes; 3. present egg, cereal and starch dishes; and 4. store egg, cereal and starch dishes. Let’s See What You Know Pretest 1 A. Multiple Choice. Directions: Read each question carefully. Choose the letter which corresponds to the correct answer and write it in your test notebook. 1. It is a small hand tool used generally in decorative works such as making garnishes. A. bread knife C. channel knife B. butcher knife D. paring knife
  • 50. LM-Cookery Grade 10 50 2. It is a perforated bowl of varying sizes made of stainless steel, aluminum or plastic used to drain, wash or cook ingredients from liquid. A. Canister C. Mixing bowl B. Colander D. Soup bowl 3. It is used for turning and lifting eggs, pan cakes and meats on griddles, grills, sheet pans, and the likes and also used to scrape and clean griddles. A. Measuring spoon C. Rubber scraper B. Offset spatula D. Wooden spoon 4. It is used to scrape off all the contents of bowls and pans from the sides and fold in beaten eggs in batter or whipped cream. A. Paring knife C. Wire whisk B. Rubber spatula D. Wooden spoon 5. It is a screen – type mesh supported by a round metal frame used for sifting dry ingredients like starch and flour. A. Colander C. Sieve B. Funnel D. Skimmer 6. It is a device with loops of stainless steel wire fastened to a handle. It is used for blending, mixing, whipping eggs or batter, and for blending gravies, sauces, and soups. A. Fork C. Spoon B. Knife D. Whisk 7. It is a miniature Bain Marie with an upper dish containing indentations each sized to hold an egg or contains separate device for poaching. A. Egg Poacher C. Frying pan B. Double boiler D. Omelet pan 8. It is a chamber or compartment used for cooking, baking, heating, or drying. A. Blender C. Mixer B. Burner D. Oven 9. It is the process of washing and sanitizing dishes, glassware, flatware, and pots and pans either manually or mechanically. A. Bleaching C. Ware washing B. Hand washing D. Washing machine 10. It requires a dishwashing machine capable of washing, rinsing, and drying dishes, flatware, and glassware. A. Hand washing C. Mechanical ware washing B. Manual ware washing D. Washing machine 11. It is the egg‘s outer covering which accounts for about 9 to 12 % of its total weight depending on egg size. A. Chalaza C. Shell B. Germinal disc D. Yolk
  • 51. LM-Cookery Grade 10 51 12. This is the entrance of the latebra, the channel leading to the center of the yolk. A. Chalaza C. Shell B. Germinal disc D. Yolk 13. It is the yellow to yellow - orange portion which makes up to about 33% of the liquid weight of the egg. A. Chalaza C. Shell B. Germinal disc D. Yolk 14. A disease that is carried and transmitted to people by food is referred to as food borne . A. Bacteria C. Infection B. Illness D Intoxication 15. It is a disease that results from eating food containing harmful micro- organism. A. Food borne bacteria C. Food borne infection B. Food borne illness D. Food borne intoxication 16. It is a disease that results from eating food containing toxins from bacteria, molds or certain plants or animals. A. Food borne bacteria C. Food borne infection B. Food borne illness D. Food borne intoxication 17. It is used for mixing creams, butter and for tossing salads. A. Electric mixer C. Wire whisk B. Serving spoon D. Wooden spoon 18. It is used for preparing meat, chicken, and other grains or legumes, such as mongo and white beans in lesser time. A. Double boiler C. pressure cooker B. Frying pan D. rice cooker 19. It is a long chainlike molecule, sometimes called the linear fraction, and is produced by linking together 500 to 2, 000 glucose molecules which contributes to the gelling characteristics to cooked and cooled starch mixtures. A. Amylopectin C. Dextrin B. Amylose D. Mucin 20. This problem is usually encountered when using acid or acid ingredients such as lemon or vinegar. A. Scorching C. Thinning of gel. B. Skin formation D. Weak gelling 21. This results when there is too much liquid in relation to the starch. A. Scorching C. Thinning of gel. B. Skin formation D. Weak gelling
  • 52. LM-Cookery Grade 10 52 22. This problem can be reduced by covering the container of the starch gel with a waterproof cover. A. Scorching C. Thinning of gel. B. Skin formation D. Weak gelling 23. This can be avoided by temperature control and constant stirring so the starch granules do not settle at the bottom of the cooking pan. A. Scorching C. Thinning of Gel. B. Skin formation D. Weak gelling 24. It can be stored in the refrigerator for 2 or 3 days. A. Cooked pasta C. Fresh pasta B. Dried pasta D. Frozen pasta 25. FIFO stands for A. Fan In Fan On C. First In First Out B. First In Fight Out D. Fit In Fit Out B. Give one risk in the preparation and cooking of starch, cereal dishes and other foods, and give some guidelines pertaining to food safety. Your answer will be rated using the scoring rubric below: SCORE CRITERIA 4 Explains very clearly the complete guidelines to consider pertaining to food safety related to the given risk. 3 Explains clearly the complete guidelines to consider pertaining to food safety related to the given risk. 2 Explains partially the guidelines to consider pertaining to food safety related to the given risk. 1 Was not able to explain any guidelines to consider pertaining to food safety related to the given risk.
  • 53. LM-Cookery Grade 10 53 Overview In cookery, egg refers to poultry or fowl products. The versatility of eggs is evident in its presence in numerous food items. Eggs may be eaten cooked in its shell, fried or poached or may be combined with other ingredients to produce another dish. In baking, egg acts both as an emulsifier and leavener. The egg‘s protective coating or mucin layer which aids in the maintenance of its freshness by covering the small holes in the shell is called bloom. Bloom is removed during washing so it is not advisable to wash eggs prior to storage unless it is very dirty. Removal of the mucin layer will expose the holes making the egg susceptible to bacterial penetration and dehydration, thus hastening deterioration of its quality. Eggs are produced commercially in farms with a few hundred laying chickens, or in large laying complexes with thousands of layers. Small and micro-sized backyard poultry either in small poultry cages or as free range chicken are also producing eggs. Egg is indeed a convenient food for any meal in and out of the house. Learning Outcome 1 Perform Mise’en Place At the end of the lesson, you are expected to: 1. identify tools, utensils and equipment needed in egg preparation; 2. clean, sanitize and prepare tools, utensils and equipment needed in preparing egg dishes; 3. identify egg components and its nutritive value; and 4. identify and prepare ingredients according to standard recipe. In the preparation of egg dishes, the first consideration is to identify the needed tools and equipment and how to clean and sanitize them after each use. LESSON 1 PREPARE EGG DISHES
  • 54. LM-Cookery Grade 10 54 Tools, Utensils and Equipment Needed In Egg Preparation Kitchen Tools 1. Channel Knife – a small hand tool used generally in decorative works such as making garnishes. 2. Colander – a perforated bowl of varying sizes made of stainless steel, aluminum or plastic, used to drain, wash or cook ingredients from liquid. 3. Offset spatula – a broad – bladed implement bent to keep the hand off hot surfaces. It is used for turning and lifting eggs, pan cakes, and meats on griddles, grills, sheet pans, and the likes and also used to scrape and clean griddles. 4. Pastry Brush – a small implement used to brush the surface of unbaked pastries or cookies with egg white, egg yolk or glaze. 5. Rubber spatula or scraper – a broad flexible plastic or rubber scraper, that is rectangular in shape with a curve on one side. It is used to scrape off all the contents of bowls and pans from the sides and fold in beaten eggs in batter or whipped cream. 6. Sieve – a screen – type mesh supported by a round metal frame used for sifting dry ingredients like starch and flour. 7. Spoons: solid, slotted and perforated – large stainless spoons holding about 3 ounces used for mixing, stirring, and serving. Slotted and perforated spoons are large, long-handled spoons with holes in the bowl used to remove larger solid particles from liquids. 8. Wire whip or Whisk – a device with loops of stainless steel wire fastened to a handle. It is used for blending, mixing, whipping eggs or batter, and for blending gravies, sauces, and soups. Kitchen Utensils 1. Egg Poacher – A miniature Bain Marie with an upper dish containing indentations each sized to hold an egg or contains separate device for poaching. 2. Omelet Pan – a heavy-based frying usually of cast iron or copper, with rounded sloping sides used exclusively for omelets and never washed after used but cleaned with absorbent paper. 3. Measuring cup- a kitchen utensil used for measuring liquid or bulksolid cooking ingredients such as flour and sugar 4. Measuring spoon- used to measure an amount of an ingredient, either liquid or dry, when cooking. Measuring spoons may be made of plastic, metal, and other materials. 5. Sauce pan- deep cooking pan with a handle used primarily for cooking sauce.
  • 55. LM-Cookery Grade 10 55 6. Mixing bowl - these containers have smooth, rounded interior surfaces with no creases to retain some mixture and is used for mixing ingredients. Kitchen Equipment 1. Oven - a chamber or compartment used for cooking, baking, heating, or drying. 2. Electric mixer - A hand-held mixer which usually comes with various attachments including a whisk attachment for whisking cream, batters and egg whites, and sugar. 3. Refrigerator - a kitchen appliance where you store food at a cool temperature. Cleaning and Sanitizing Tools and Equipment A cleaning program that is an overall system should be prepared to organize all your cleaning and sanitizing tasks. The program should also help identify your cleaning needs, set up a master cleaning schedule, select the supplies and tools to use, and train yourselves to make the best of your skills. Cleaning is the removal of visible soil while sanitizing means reducing the number of harmful microorganisms by using very hot water or a chemical sanitizing solution. To be effective, cleaning and sanitizing must be two-step process. Surfaces must first be cleaned and rinsed before being sanitized. There are many cleaning products or agents and a variety of equipment in the market. Choose the best for your workplace and follow instructions in the label. Here are some points to support your workplace training: 1. Clean in a logical order. 2. Different cleaning tasks require different methods. Getting things wrong can cause damage to surface, harm to yourself, and spread bacteria and dirt. 3. Many cleaning agents are harmful. Their contact with your skin or eyes or breathing in the fumes can cause a serious illness. 4. Mixing one agent with another can be very dangerous. A chemical reaction can be set up, or in some cases, produce poisonous fumes.
  • 56. LM-Cookery Grade 10 56 Ware washing Ware washing is the process of washing and sanitizing dishes, glassware, flatware, and pots and pans either manually or mechanically. Manual ware washing uses a three-compartment sink and is used primarily for pots and pans. It may be used for dishes and flatware in small operations. Mechanical ware washing requires a dishwashing machine capable of washing, rinsing, and drying dishes, flatware, and glassware. In large operations, heavy-duty pot and pan washing machines have been designed to remove cooked-on food. Manual Dishwashing Procedure 1. Scrape and pre-rinse. The purpose of this step is to keep the wash water cleaner longer. 2. Wash. Use warm water at 1100F to 1200F and a good detergent. Scrub well with a brush to remove all traces of leftover and grease. 3. Rinse. Use clean warm water to rinse off detergent. Change the water frequently, or use running water with an overflow. 4. Sanitize. Place utensils in rack and immerse in hot water at 1700F for thirty seconds. (A gas or electric heating element is needed to hold water at this temperature.) 5. Drain and air-dry. Do not towel-dry. This may contaminate utensils. Mechanical Dishwashing The steps in washing dishes by machine are the same as in the manual methods. Except that the machine does the washing, rinsing, and sanitizing. Procedure 1. Scrape and pre-rinse. 2. Rack dishes so that the dishwasher spray will strike all surfaces. 3. Run machine for a full cycle. 4. Set the sanitizing temperatures at 1800F for machine that sanitizes by heat and at 1400F for machine that sanitizes by chemical disinfectant. 5. Air-dry and inspect dishes. Do not touch food – contact surfaces.
  • 57. LM-Cookery Grade 10 57 Review of Learning Outcome 1 A. YES/NO Cards. Directions: Using a 4 x 6 inches Index Card, do the activity below: a. Write YES on one side and NO on the other side b. When the teacher shows you a kitchen tool, a kitchen utensil or equipment with label, raise the index card showing YES if the label is correct and NO if it is wrong. c. Do the same in the succeeding questions. Performance Activity 1 B. Clean and sanitize tools and equipment by performing the given activity. You will be asked to clean and sanitize the tools and equipment in the food laboratory. Follow the procedures properly in performing the task. Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in cleaning and sanitizing tools and equipment and performs the skill without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in cleaning and sanitizing tools and equipment and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Follows the procedures in cleaning and sanitizing tools and equipment with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in cleaning and sanitizing tools and equipment and performs the skill unsatisfactorily. After knowing the needed tools and equipment needed in the preparation of egg dishes and on how to clean and sanitize them after each use, the next consideration is to know what makes up an egg and appreciate other things about egg.
  • 58. LM-Cookery Grade 10 58 Physical Structure and Composition of Eggs We normally distinguish 3 parts of an egg, the shell, the egg white, and the egg yolk, but a closer scrutiny reveals a much more detailed structure of an egg. Structure 1. Shell. The egg‘s outer covering, the shell, accounts for about 9 to 12 % of its total weight depending on egg size. The shell is the egg‘s first line of defense against bacterial contamination. The shell is produced by the shell gland (uterus) of the oviduct, and has an outer coating, the bloom or cuticle. The cuticle somewhat seals the pores and is useful in reducing moisture losses and in preventing bacterial penetration of the egg shell. 2. Air cell. This is the empty space between the white and shell at the large end of the egg which is barely existent in newly laid egg. When an egg is first laid, it is warm. As it cools, the contents contract and the inner shell membrane separate from the outer shell membrane to form the air cell. 3. Albumen/Egg white. Albumen, also called egg white, accounts for most of an egg‘s liquid weight, about 67%. This is produced by the oviduct and consists of four alternating layers of thick and thin consistencies. From the yolk outward, they are designated as the inner thick or chalaziferous white, the inner thin white, the outer thick white and the outer thin white. The outer thin white is a narrow fluid layer next to the shell membrane. The outer thick white is a gel that forms the center of the albumen. The inner thin white is a fluid layer located next to the yolk. The inner thick white (chalasiferous layer) is a dense, matted, fibrous capsule terminates on each end in the chalazae, which are twisted in opposite directions and serve to keep the yolk centered.
  • 59. LM-Cookery Grade 10 59 4. Chalaza. This is the ropey strands of egg white at both sides of the egg, which anchor the yolk in place in the center of the thick white. They are sometimes mistaken for egg imperfections or beginning embryos, which of course they are not. The twist in the chalaza is meant to keep the germinal disc always on top whichever way the egg may turn. The more prominent the chalazae the fresher is the egg. 5. Germinal Disc. This is the entrance of the latebra, the channel leading to the center of the yolk. The germinal disc is barely noticeable as a slight depression on the surface of the yolk. When the egg is fertilized, sperm enter by way of the germinal disc, travel to the center and a chick embryo starts to form. Since table eggs are not fertilized, this is not as easy to recognize as when the egg is fertilized. 6. Membranes. There are two kinds of membranes, one just under the shell and the other covering the yolk. These are the shell membrane and the vitelline membrane. Just inside the shell are two shell membranes, inner and outer. The air cell formed due to the contraction of egg as it cools, is found between the two layers of this shell membrane. The outer membrane sticks to the shell while the inner membrane sticks to the albumen. During storage, the egg losses water by evaporation, causing the air cell to enlarge. The vitelline membrane is the covering that protects the yolk from breaking. The vitelline membrane is weakest at the germinal disc and tends to become more fragile as the egg ages. Every cook has experienced that the yolk of eggs that are no longer fresh easily break. 7. Yolk. The yolk or the yellow to yellow- orange portion makes up about 33% of the liquid weight of the egg. The egg yolk is formed in the ovary. On the surface of the yolk, there is a small white spot about 2 mm in diameter. This is the germinal disc and it is present even if the egg is infertile. In infertile eggs, the germinal disc contains the genetic material from the hen only but when fertilized, it contains the zygote that will eventually develop into a chick. The yolk material serves as a food source for embryonic development. It contains all the fat in the egg and a little less than half of the protein. The main protein in the egg yolk is vitelline, a lipoprotein. It also contains phosvitin which is high in phosphorus and has antioxidant properties, and livetin which is high in sulfur.
  • 60. LM-Cookery Grade 10 60 Composition of an Egg % % Water % Protein % Fat % Ash Whole Egg 100 65.5 11.8 11.0 11.7 Albumen 58 88 11.0 0.2 0.8 Yolk 31 48 17.5 32.5 2.0 Nutritive Value of Egg Egg is indeed one of nature‘s complete food. It contains high quality protein with all the essential amino acids, all of the vitamins except vitamin C, and many minerals. Egg products are particularly good for fortifying food low in protein quality. Except for mother‘s milk, eggs provide the best protein naturally available. Egg protein is often used as a reference standard for biological values of their proteins. Egg Nutrient Chart Nutrient Content of a Large Egg Nutrient (unit) Whole Egg Egg White Egg Yolk Calories (kcal) 72 17 55 Protein (g) 6.3 3.6 2.7 Carbohydrate (g) 0.36 0.24 0.61 Carbohydrate (g) 0.36 0.24 0.61 Total fat (g) 4.8 0.06 4.5 Monounsaturated fat (g) 1.8 0 2 Polyunsaturated fat (g) 1 0 0.72 Saturated fat (g) 1.6 0 1.6 Trans fat (g) 0.02 0 0.02 Cholesterol (mg) 186 0 184 Choline (mg) 126 0.4 116 Riboflavin (mg) 0.2 0.15 0.09 Vitamin B12 (mcg) 0.45 0.03 0.33 Folate (mcg) 24 1 25 Vitamin D (IU) 41 0 37 Vitamin A (IU) 270 0 245 Vitamin B 6 (mg) 0.09 0 0.06 Thiamin (mg) 0.02 0 0.03 Vitamin E (mg) 0.5 0 0.44 Selenium (mcg) 15.4 6.6 9.5 Phosphorous (mg) 99 5 66
  • 61. LM-Cookery Grade 10 61 Iron (mg) 0.88 0.03 0.46 Zinc (mg) 0.65 0.01 0.39 Calcium (mg) 28 2 22 Sodium (mg) 71 55 8 Potassium (mg) 69 54 19 Magnesium (mg) 6 4 1 Source: U.S. Department of Agriculture, Agricultural Research Service, 2010. USDA National Nutrient Database for Standard Reference, Release 23. Nutrient Data Laboratory Home Page: http://www.ars.usdA.gov/nutrientdata Egg quality Egg quality has two general components: shell quality (exterior quality) and interior egg quality. Interior egg quality has direct bearing on the functional properties of eggs while shell quality has direct influence on microbiological quality. Egg Grading. Grading is a form of quality control used to classify eggs for exterior and interior quality. In the Philippines, the grade designations are A, B, C, and D. Egg Size. Several factors influence the size of the egg: breed, age of hen, weight, feed and environmental factors. Native chickens have much smaller eggs than commercial breeds. Some commercial breeds have bigger eggs than others. Of the same breed, new layers tend to have smaller eggs compared to older hens. Pullets that are significantly underweight at sexual maturity will also produce small eggs. Better fed hens lay larger eggs than underfed ones. The environmental factors that lead to smaller eggs are heat, stress and overcrowding. The egg sizes are Jumbo, Extra Large, Large, Medium, Small and Peewee. Medium, Large, and Extra Large are the sizes commonly available. Egg Size Classification Size Jumbo Extra large Large Medium Small Peewee Weight of 12 eggs in grams 840 756 672 588 504 420 Average weight per egg in grams 70 63 56 49 42 35
  • 62. LM-Cookery Grade 10 62 Philippine Standard of Quality for Chicken Eggs Quality Factor A B C D Shell Clean Unbroken Normal shape Clean Unbroken Normal shape Moderately stained Unbroken Slightly abnormal shape Moderately stained Unbroken May be abnormal shape Air Cell Depth of 0.3cm or less Practically regular Depth of 0.5cm or less Practically regular Depth of 1.0 cm or less May be loose or bubbly Depth of 1cm May be loose or bubbly Egg White Clear Firm 72 Haigh units or higher Clear Reasonably Firm 60 - 71 Haugh units Clear May be slightly weak 31-59 haugh units May be weak and watery Small clots or spots may be present Less than 31 Haugh units Egg Yolk Outlined defined Round and firm Free from defects Outline fairly well defined Round and firm Free from defects Outline may be well defined. May be slightly enlarged and flattened. Practically free from defects. May have embryonic development Outline may be well defined. May be enlarged and flattened. May have embryonic development The appearance of the egg, as influenced by severity of defects, is important for consumer appeal. Egg shells are evaluated on the basis of cleanliness, shape, texture, and soundness. The unit for describing egg freshness, based on the thickness of the albumen is called Haugh unit with a symbol of HU named before Raymond Haugh in 1937.
  • 63. LM-Cookery Grade 10 63 E En nh ha an nc ce em me en nt t A. Minute to Write It Directions: In your test notebook write whether you agree or disagree to the following statements and justify your answer. 1. Egg is a complete food. 2. Egg is composed of the shell, egg white and egg yolk. B. Pictorial Report Directions: Make a pictorial report with illustration showing the qualities of a fresh egg in terms of egg size and grading. Your output will be rated using the scoring rubric below: SCORE CRITERIA 5 Compiled pictures properly and illustrate the qualities of a fresh egg in terms of egg size and grading in a very attractive manner. 4 Compiled pictures properly and illustrate the qualities of a fresh egg in terms of egg size and grading in an attractive manner. 3 Compiled pictures properly and illustrate the qualities of a fresh egg in terms of egg size and grading in a less attractive manner. 2 Compiled pictures properly and illustrate the qualities of a fresh egg in terms of egg size and grading in a less attractive manner. 1 Improperly compiled pictures but were not able to illustrate the qualities of a fresh egg in terms of egg size and grading in disorderly manner.
  • 64. LM-Cookery Grade 10 64 Learning Outcome 2 Prepare and Cook Egg Dishes At the end of the lesson, you are expected to: 1. identify and prepare ingredients according to standard recipes; 2. identify the market forms of eggs; 3. explain the uses of eggs in culinary; and 4. cook egg dishes with appropriate taste and seasoned in accordance with the prescribed standard. Market Forms of Egg There are three market forms of eggs namely: fresh, dried (whole, egg whites/egg yolks), and frozen (whole, egg whites/egg yolks). 1. Fresh Eggs or shell eggs may be purchased individually, by dozen or in trays of 36 pieces. 2. Frozen Eggs – are made of high quality fresh eggs. They come in the form of whole eggs with extra yolks and whites. Frozen eggs are pasteurized and must be thawed before use. 3. Dried Eggs – are seldom used. Their whites are used for preparing meringue. Dried eggs are used primarily as ingredients in food industry. They are not commonly sold directly to consumers. Eggs are also sold in several processed forms: bulk or fluid whole eggs (which sometimes includes a percentage of extra yolks to obtain a specific blend), egg whites, and egg yolks. Pasteurized eggs are used in preparations such as salad dressings, eggnog, or desserts, where the traditional recipe may have indicated that the eggs should be raw. These products generally are available in liquid or frozen form. Frozen egg products on the other hand are used as ingredients by food processors. Products containing egg yolk usually have salt, sugar or corn syrup added to prevent gelation or increased viscosity during freezing. They are packed in 30- lB.containers and in 4-, 5-, 8-, and 10-lB.pouches or waxed or plastic cartons. Dried powdered eggs are also sold and may be useful for some baked goods or in certain circumstances. For food service use, they are generally sold in 6-oz. pouches, and 3-lB.and 25-lB.poly packs. Egg substitutes may be entirely egg-free or may be produced from egg whites, with dairy or vegetable products substituted by yolks. These substitutes are important for people with reduced-cholesterol diet requirement.
  • 65. LM-Cookery Grade 10 65 Uses of Eggs in culinary Egg is cooked in many ways. It can be the main protein dish; it can be a main or accessory ingredient in dishes from appetizers to desserts. It can be cooked by dry heat, moist heat, with or without oil, as simply or as elaborately as one‘s inclination for the moment. Indeed it can be eaten anywhere. Effect of Heat on Eggs 1. Coagulation of proteins: white at 60-65 0C, yolk at 65-700C.  Beyond this temperature, over coagulation occurs and water is squeezed out causing shrinkage resulting in a tough product. 2. Formation of greenish discoloration at the interface of the yolk and white when egg is overcooked  Due to the reaction between the iron in the yolk and the hydrogen sulfide liberated from the sulfur containing ferrous sulfide.  Reaction is favored by - High cooking temperature - Prolonged cooking  Reaction is prevented by immediate cooling of the egg (e.g. immersing in cold water) after cooking Uses of Egg 1. Cooked and served ―as is‖, e.g.  in the shell – soft cooked ( 5 minutes simmering) or hard cooked (15 minutes simmering)  poached – cooked in simmering water; addition of salt and vinegar hastens coagulation  fried – keep low to moderate temperature  scrambled – addition of sugar delays coagulation; addition of liquids and acids decreases coagulation point  omelet 2. Eggs as emulsifier  Lecithin and lysolecithin are responsible for the remarkable ability of egg yolk to act as an emulsifying agent; both are phosphoproteins containing polar and non-polar ends such that the polar end holds water while the non-polar end holds the fat, thus, prevent oil droplets in suspension from coalescing.
  • 66. LM-Cookery Grade 10 66 3. As binding, thickening agent, and gelling agents  Eggs are useful as binding, thickening and gelling agents because they contain proteins that are easily denatured by heat  Using whole egg requires lower coagulation temperatures resulting in a stiffer gel  Addition of sugar, raises coagulation temperature producing softer, weaker gel  Softer gel is produced with the addition of scalded milk and acid  In cooking custards, Bain Marie, double boiler or steamer is used to avoid boiling which can produce a porous custard  Soft custards are produced by constant stirring. 4. As foam  When egg is beaten albumen is denatured, air is incorporated as white is stretched into thin films  With continued beating, the air cells are subdivided and volume is increased  Protein network dries up and stabilizes the gas or air foams - If only egg whites are used, the color turns white and soft peaks are formed. The egg proteins collect at the air/liquid interface of the air bubble and undergo surface denaturation. - If whole eggs or only egg yolks are used, the color becomes pale yellow with continued beating; volume is increased (but not as much as when only whites are used); no surface denaturation occurs. - With further beating of egg whites, liquid drains out, air bubbles coalesce and foam breaks. - The same changes occur when the foam is allowed to stand too long. - Maximum stability is reached at soft stage while maximum volume attained is at stiff stage - Stages in foam formation A. frothy – large air bubbles that flow easily B. soft foam – air cells are smaller and more numerous; foam becomes whiter; soft peaks are formed when beater is lifted C.stiff foam – peaks hold their shape; when bowl is tipped, it holds, moist and glossy D.dry – moistness and glossiness disappear; specks of egg white are seen
  • 67. LM-Cookery Grade 10 67  Factors to be considered in foam formation (leavening agent) a. Beating time and temperature: as the time of beating increases, both volume and stability of the foam increases initially, then, decreases; white can be beaten/whipped more readily at room temperature than at refrigerator temperature – refrigerated eggs are more viscous, thus, hard to beat/whip. b. Eggs beaten at room temperature whip better resulting in bigger volume and finer texture. c. Whole eggs or egg yolk require more beating to produce a good foam d. Stored eggs foam faster but produce smaller volume than fresh eggs. e. Acids (e.g. cream of tartar, 1 t per cup) increase the stability of foams, but when added too early, delay foam formation (reduced volume) thus, increases the time necessary for beating f. Sugar also increases the stability of foams but delays foams formation (reduced volume), thus, it should be added after foaming has started and soft peaks are formed; sugar retards the denaturation of egg white g. Addition of soda increases stability and volume h. Addition of salt lowers quality of the foam i. Type of egg: duck eggs do not foam well because they lack ovumucin j. Dilution of egg white by water produces bigger volume but lesser foam; this produces more tender cakes, but in meringues, syneresis occurs. k. Applications of foam in cookery  as leavening e.g. in angel cake, sponge cake, chiffon cakes  as meringue, e.g. (a) soft meringue for topping of cream, chocolate, or lemon pie, requires a proportion of two tablespoons sugar per egg white (b) hard meringue for confections, base of fruit pies or Sans Rival Cake, requires a proportion of ¼ cup sugar per egg white  structural and textural agent – tenderness and fluffiness to products, e.g. fluffy or foamy, soufflé, divinity, foam cakes, popovers
  • 68. LM-Cookery Grade 10 68 5. As coloring and flavoring agent Egg Products 1. Balut from duck eggs 2. Pidan eggs 3. Century eggs 4. Pickled eggs Eggs may be cooked in a lot of ways: Egg Dishes  Eggs cooked in a shell Hard and soft-cooked eggs are cooked this way. Eggs should only be simmered and not boiled to prevent overcoagulation which would cause the eggs to be tough. The optimum cooking time for eggs in shells is 20 to 25 minutes. To avoid cracking of the eggs during cooking, refrigerated eggs should be warmed at ambient temperature before cooking. Before boiling, water at room temperature should be used. Sometimes yolks of eggs may become greenish during cooking. This color is due to the formation of iron sulfide. Darkening often occurs in eggs wherein the pH of the albumen is high. It may also be a result of cooking too long at very high temperature. To avoid this, fresh eggs should always be used. Eggs should be cooked within a minimum period and cooled immediately in running water after cooking.  Eggs prepared out of the shell This method involves breaking the egg and using both the yolk and white during cooking. Poaching, frying, and the process of making scrambled eggs or omelet are some of the common methods done. Culinary Uses:  Eggs as a thickening agent and binder When used as a binder or thickener, the hydrophilic colloids of yolks and whites, due to the presence of proteins are converted into a hydrophobic colloid thus turning it into a gel. At high temperature, the gel toughens. This explains why the white becomes an opaque mass when cooked at a temperature of 620C. For egg yolk, coagulation starts at 650C.
  • 69. LM-Cookery Grade 10 69  Eggs as leavening agent Baked products such as sponge cakes, chiffon cakes, meringues, and soufflés make use of eggs as leavened resulting in a light, airy texture. This is explained by the incorporation of air during the beating of eggs. Foam is formed when the albumen surrounds a colloidal system of air bubbles. When beating eggwhites, overbeating must be avoided as this tends to stretch the albumen and would result in a dry, watery appearance. Why do you need to eat eggs? Eggs may be considered as "functional foods". Functional foods are foods that may have health benefits beyond their traditional nutritional value. Eggs as functional foods contain lutein and zeaxanthin that reduce the risk of cataracts and macular degeneration. Eggs may also belong to "designer foods". Designer foods are foods that have been modified through biotechnology to enhance their quality or nutritional value. Eggs as designer foods contain omega-3-polyunsaturated fatty acids and vitamin E. So learn now and explore the various egg dishes below. Variety of Egg Dishes Cooking Eggs in the Shell Although the term boiled may appear in the name, eggs prepared in the shell should actually be cooked at a bare simmer for best results. Eggs are cooked in the shell to make hard- and soft-cooked and coddled eggs. They may be served directly in the shell or they may be shelled and used to make another preparation, such as deviled eggs, or as a garnish for salads or vegetable dishes. Select a pot deep enough for the eggs to be submerged in water. Have on hand a slotted spoon, skimmer, or spider to remove eggs from the water once they are cooked.
  • 70. LM-Cookery Grade 10 70 Directions: Given the different recipes in preparing and cooking egg dishes, perform the suggested activities below. Your product and performance will be evaluated using the given rubric after each activity. Hard – Cooked Eggs Makes 10 servings Tools/Equipment Needed: Gas range Saucepan Ladle Ingredients Needed: 20 Eggs Cold water Procedure: 1. Prepare tools, equipment and food items. 2. Place the eggs in a pot. Fill the pot with enough cold water to cover the eggs by 2in/5in. 3. Bring the water to a boil and immediately lower the temperature to a simmer. Begin timing the cooking at this point. 4. Cook small eggs for 12 minutes, medium eggs for 13 minutes, large eggs for 14 to 15 minutes, and extra-large eggs for 15 minutes. 5. Drain immediately and cool under cold running water to stop cooking. 6. Peel as soon as possible by cracking the shell starting from the large end. For easier peeling, peel while still warm, and hold under running water to help loosen the shell. 7. Serve the eggs or refrigerate until needed. Coddled Eggs. Put cold eggs into already simmering water and simmer for 30 seconds. Soft-Cooked Eggs. Put cold eggs into already simmering water and simmer for 3 to 4 minutes. Medium-Cooked Eggs. Put cold eggs into already simmering water and simmer for 5 to 7 minutes. Poached Eggs
  • 71. LM-Cookery Grade 10 71 Poached eggs are prepared by slipping shelled eggs into barely simmering water and gently cooking until the egg holds its shape. The fresher the egg, the more centered the yolk, the less likely the white is spread and become ragged. Poached eggs can be prepared in advance and held safely throughout a typical service period to make the workload easier during service. Slightly under poach the eggs, shock them in ice water to arrest the cooking process, trim them, and hold them in cold water. At the time of service, reheat the eggs in simmering water. Eggs are most often poached in water, though other liquids, such as red wine, stock, or cream, can also be used. Add vinegar and salt to the water to encourage the egg protein to set faster. Otherwise, the egg whites can spread too much before they coagulate. Standard Qualities of Poached Eggs and Cooked Eggs in the Shell 1. Bright, shiny appearance 2. Compact, round shore, not spread or flattened 3. Firm but tender whites 4. Warm, liquid yolks Poached Eggs Makes 10 servings Tools/Equipment Needed: Saucepan Skimmer Ingredients Needed: 1 gal/3.84L water 1tbsp/15g salt 1 floz. /30ml distilled white vinegar 20 eggs Procedure: 1. Prepare tools, equipment and food items. Be sure that eggs are chilled until ready to poach. 2. Combine the water, salt and vinegar, in a deep pan and bring it to a bare simmer. 3. Break each egg into a clean cup, and then slide the egg carefully into the poaching water. 4. Cook for 3 to 5 minutes, or until the whites are set and opaque. 5. Remove the eggs from the water with a slotted spoon, blot them on absorbent toweling, and trim the edges if desired.
  • 72. LM-Cookery Grade 10 72 6. Serve or chill and refrigerate for later use. A good-cooked poached egg has a compact, glossy, tender white, and unbroken, thickened yolk Critical factors:  quality of the egg  temperature  amount of liquid  the way the egg is put in the pan Fried Eggs Fried eggs call for perfectly fresh eggs, the correct heat level, an appropriate amount of cooking fat, and a deft hand. Fried eggs may be served sunny side up (not turned) or over (turned once). Fried eggs may be basted with fat as they fry. Using very fresh eggs is the only way to ensure a rich flavor and good appearance of the finished dish. Standard Qualities of Fried Eggs 1. White should be shiny, uniformly set, and tender, not browned, blistered or crisp at edges. 2. Yolk should be set properly according to desired doneness. Sunny side-up yolks should be yellow and well rounded. In other styles, the yolk is covered with a thin layer of coagulated white. 3. Relatively compact, standing high. Not spread out and thin. 5. A fried egg should have a yolk covered with a thin film of coagulated egg white and still remain slightly fluid. 6. The egg white should be opaque, firm and tender, not chewy, crisp or brown. 7. A perfectly fried egg is a glory to behold – crispy edges and a wobbly, pinkish yolk. 8. It will provide a fried egg with a slightly crispy, frilly edge; the white will be set and the yolk soft and runny
  • 73. LM-Cookery Grade 10 73 Types of Fried Eggs 1. Sunny side up Cook slowly without flipping until white is completely set but yolk is still soft and yellow. Heat must be low or bottom will toughen or burn before top is completely set. 2. Basted Do not flip. Add a few drops of water to pan and cover to steam cook the top. A thin film of coagulated white will cover the yolk which should remain liquid. 3. Over easy Fry and flip over. Cook just until the white is just set but the yolk is still liquid. 4. Over medium Fry and flip over. Cook until the yolk is partially set.
  • 74. LM-Cookery Grade 10 74 5. Over hard Fry and flip over. Cook until the yolk is completely set. Fried Eggs Tools/Equipment Needed: Sauté pan (preferably non-stick) Dish, turner Ingredients Needed: Fresh egg Oil or clarified or whole butter, as needed for frying Salt, as needed Ground black pepper, as needed Procedure: 1. Select very fresh grade AA eggs for best results. 2. Break the eggs into a dish. 3. Add about 1/8 inch fat to the sauté pan and set it to a moderate heat. Too much fat will make the eggs greasy. Less fat will cause them to stick, unless a pan with the nonstick coating is used. 4. When the fat is hot enough, slide the egg into the pan. 5. Tilt the pan, allowing the fat to collect at the side of the pan, and baste the eggs with the fat as they cook.
  • 75. LM-Cookery Grade 10 75 6. Season the eggs with salt and pepper and serve at once. Eggs over Easy, Medium or Hard: turn the eggs over near the end of their cooking time with a spatula and cook them on the other side until done as desired, 20 to 30 seconds for over easy, 1 minute for over medium, 2 minutes for over hard. Desirable Qualities of Fried Eggs  glossy  moist  tender Common pitfalls:  eggs brown and crisp  eggs white blistered  eggs odd-shaped  eggs sticking Scrambled Eggs Scrambled eggs can be made in two ways: the eggs can be stirred constantly over low heat for a soft delicate curd and a creamy texture, or stirred less frequently as they cook for a larger curd and a firm texture. Whether prepared to order or to serve on a buffet line, scrambled eggs must be served hot, fresh and moist. Choose eggs that are fresh, with intact shells. Adding a small amount of water or stock (about 2tsp/10ml per egg) to the beaten eggs will make them puffier as the water turns to steam. Milk or cream may be used to enrich the eggs. Scrambled eggs can be seasoned with salt and pepper, and/or flavored or garnished with fresh herbs, cheese, sautéed vegetables, smoked fish, or truffles. Eggs can be scrambled in a sauté pan or on a griddle. Nonstick surfaces make it easy to prepare scrambled eggs with a minimum amount of added fat. Pans used for eggs should be reserved for that use only, if possible. A table fork, wooden spoon, or spatula is needed for stirring the eggs in cooking. Do not overcook scrambled eggs or hold them too long. Overcooked eggs are tough and watery and will turn green in steam table. Scrambled eggs should be soft and moist.
  • 76. LM-Cookery Grade 10 76 For flavor variations, the following ingredients may be added to scrambled eggs before serving. Chopped parsley or other herbs Grated cheese Diced ham Crumbled bacon Sautéed diced onions and green bell pepper Diced smoked salmon Sliced cooked breakfast sausage A good scrambled egg must not be tough nor burned but completely coagulated Preparing and Cooking Egg Dishes Directions: Given the different recipes in preparing and cooking egg dishes, perform each of the activity and you will be evaluated using a rubric. Scrambled Eggs Tools/Equipment Needed: Stainless bowl Fork or egg beater Sauté pan, steam kettle or tilting skillets Ingredients Needed: 30 Eggs 1 tbsp. /15g salt 1 tsp/2g ground pepper 5 floz. /50ml water or milk (optional) 2 ½ floz. /75 ml clarified butter or oil
  • 77. LM-Cookery Grade 10 77 Procedure: 1. Collect equipment and food items. 2. Break eggs into a stainless steel bowl and beat until well blended. Season with salt and pepper. 3. Add small amount of milk or cream about 1 to 1 ½ t, if desired. 4. Heat butter in a small sauté pan or heat nonstick pan over medium heat and add butter or oil, tilting the pan to coat the entire surface. The pan should be hot but not smoking. 5. Pour the egg mixture into the pan. 6. Cook over low heat, stirring frequently with the back of the fork or wooden spoon until the eggs are soft and creamy. 7. Remove the eggs from the heat when fully cooked, but still moist. 8. Serve at once. Omelets The rolled, or French-style, omelets start out like scrambled eggs, but when the eggs start to set, they are rolled over. A folded or American style, omelet is prepared in much the same manner, though it is often cooked on a griddle rather than in a pan, and instead of being rolled, the American omelet is folded in half. There are two other styles of omelets, both based upon a beaten mixture of eggs, cooked either over direct heat or in an oven. Choose eggs that are fresh, with intact shells. As with scrambled eggs, the ability of the egg to hold its shape is irrelevant, but fresh eggs are preferable. Omelets can be seasoned with salt, pepper, and herbs. Clarified butter or oil is the most common cooking fat. Omelets may be filled or garnished with cheese, sautéed vegetables or potatoes, meats, and smoked fish, among other things. These fillings and garnishes are incorporated at the appropriate point to be certain they are fully cooked and hot when the eggs have been cooked. Grated or crumbled cheeses will melt sufficiently from the heat of the eggs, and are often added just before an omelet is rolled or folded. Two Factors for Making Quality Omelets 1. High Heat. This is an opposite to the basic principle of low temperature egg cookery. The omelet cooks so fast that its internal temperature never has time to get too high.
  • 78. LM-Cookery Grade 10 78 2. A conditioned omelet pan. The pan must have sloping sides and be of the right size so the omelet can be shaped properly. It must be well seasoned or conditioned to avoid sticking. Suggested Omelet Fillings Cheese Sautéed or creamed mushrooms Creamed or curried chicken Creamed or buttered spinach Sautéed onions with or without bacon Sautéed onions and diced potatoes
  • 79. LM-Cookery Grade 10 79 Plain Rolled Omelet Tools/Equipment Needed: Small bowls Sauté pan Fork Ingredients Needed: 30 eggs 1tbsp/15g salt 1tsp/2g ground pepper 5fl oz. /150 ml water, stock, milk, or cream (optional) 2 ½ fl.oz. /175 ml, as needed clarified butter or oil Procedure 1. Prepare equipment and food items. 2. For each portion, beat 3 eggs well and season with salt and pepper. Add the liquid, if using. 3. Heat a nonstick omelet pan over high heat and add the butter or oil, tilting the pan to coat the entire surface. 4. Pour the entire egg mixture into the pan and scramble it with the back of the fork or wooden spoon. 5. Move the pan and the utensil at the same time until the egg mixture has coagulated slightly. Smooth the eggs into an even layer. 6. Let the egg mixture finish cooking without stirring. 7. Tilt the pan and slide a fork or a spoon around the lip of the pan, under the omelet, to be sure it is not sticking. Slide the omelet to the front of the pan and use a fork or a wooden spoon to fold it inside to the center. 8. Turn the pan upside down, rolling the omelet onto the plate. The finished omelet should be oval shaped.
  • 80. LM-Cookery Grade 10 80 Notes: Options for filling an omelet: A pre-cooked filling may be added to the eggs after they have been smoothed into an even layer and before the omelet is rolled. Alternatively, the rolled omelet can be slit open at the top, and a pre- cooked filling can be spooned into the pocket. To give the omelet, additional sheen, rub the surface lightly with butter. A perfect omelet is fluffy, moist and tender, soft in the center, yellow in color with no brown at all or just a hint of it, oval in shape, and all in one continuous piece Ham and Cheese Frittata Tools/Equipment Needed: Skillet/Non-stick pan Knife Non-stick turner Fork or wire whisk Small bowl Chopping board Ingredients: 1 cup diced cooked ham ½ cup sliced tomato 1pc white onion (cut into ring) ½ cup stripped sweet bell pepper 10pcs lightly beaten egg ¼ tsp ground black pepper ¼ cup shredded cheddar cheese ¼ cup evaporated milk ¼ tsp iodized salt Procedure 1. In a skillet coated non-stick turner, put little oil, sauté the ham, onion, tomato, red bell pepper and season to taste. 2. In a bowl, combine the egg and milk, salt, black pepper and pour over ham mixture. Let eggs set on the bottom, then lift the edges to allow any uncooked egg to flow underneath. Cover and cook until the eggs
  • 81. LM-Cookery Grade 10 81 are set for about 3 minutes. Sprinkle with cheese and cut into wedges to serve. Read more: http://www.tasteofhome.com/recipes/ham-and-cheese- frittata#ixzz36CpQIoa7 Standard Recipe CMDC Baked Eggs Baked eggs are also quick and easy to prepare. 1. Place a little butter in a custard cup. Put the cup in 1750C (3500F) oven until the butter melts. 2. Break an egg into the cup, and sprinkle with salt and pepper, then top the egg with a little milk. 3. Bake 15 to 20 minutes or until the egg white is set. Review of Learning Outcome 2 Formative Assessment: Direction: Label the types of fried eggs. 1. 2.
  • 82. LM-Cookery Grade 10 82 3. 4. 5. A. Direction: Prepare poached egg individually following the procedures below. Tools/Equipment Needed: Saucepan Skimmer Ingredients Needed: Eggs Distilled vinegar
  • 83. LM-Cookery Grade 10 83 Water Procedure: 1. Prepare mise‘en place 2. Add 1 teaspoon salt and 2 teaspoons distilled vinegar per quart of water if eggs are not very fresh. This will help to coagulate the egg white faster and keeps a better shape. 3. Bring water to a simmer. 4. Break eggs one at a time, into a dish or a small plate and slide into the simmering water. 5. Simmer 3 to 5 minutes, until whites are coagulated but yolks are still soft. 6. Remove eggs from pan with slotted spoon or skimmer. 7. Drain well and trim off ragged edges. 8. Serve immediately. (To hold for later service, plunge immediately into cold water to stop cooking. Reheat briefly in hot water at service time).
  • 84. LM-Cookery Grade 10 84 Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking poached egg and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking poached egg and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking poached egg with minor errors and performs the skill less satisfactorily with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking poached egg and performs the skill unsatisfactorily. Learning Outcome 3 Present Egg Dishes Part of serving food is presentation. It should appeal to your mouth, nose, and eyes. You don‘t have to be a trained chef to learn the basics of plating, which is the art of presenting food in an attractive way. Seven Simple Ways to Present Food like a Chef 1. Set the table properly. Your day- to-day meals might be free-for- all, but if you‘ve got guests coming over, it‘s nice to have the knives and forks in the right places. http://startcooking.com/public/images/IMG
  • 85. LM-Cookery Grade 10 85 P4143.JPG 2. Choose your plates wisely. Make sure your serving plates are big enough to let each food item stand out, but small enough that the portions don‘t look tiny. 3. Read the clock! A fool proof way to arrange food on a plate is to place the carbohydrate (rice, pasta, bread, etc.) at ―11 o‘clock,‖ the vegetables at ―2 o‘clock,‖ and the protein at ―6 o‘clock‖ from the diner‘s point of view. This will also help you portion correctly, if you remember that vegetables should cover about half of the plate, starch one fourth, and protein one fourth. http://startcooking.com/public/IMG_1389.J PG
  • 86. LM-Cookery Grade 10 86 4. Just like with centerpieces, it‘s good to have a little bit of height, but don‘t overdo it or your guests won‘t know how to proceed! If you have a mound of mashed potatoes (mid-height), you may want to lean your pork chop against it so that it is standing up (high), with a row of snow peas (low) in front. Or, top some rice (low) with sliced grilled chicken (cut into a few diagonal slices, and fan them out) (mid-height) and cross asparagus over top of it (high). 5. Be odd. Don‘t be strange, but things generally look more interesting when they‘re in sets of odd numbers, rather than even numbers. 6. Play with color and texture. Even if you‘re just serving Tomato Soup and Grilled Cheese Sandwiches, a green paper napkin can make this simple meal look really special! http://startcooking.com/public/IMG_480 9.jpg
  • 87. LM-Cookery Grade 10 87 7. Play with Height. This Chicken Stir-fry with Broccoli looks more interesting because of the high mound of rice sitting next to it. 8. Garnish appropriately. Don‘t lose sight of the recipe you made in the first place! Any garnish on the plate should be edible and should enhance the flavor of the main dishes. Grilled salmon might be served with a lemon wedge, for example. Garnishes, like the cut-up fruit with the fried egg below, are also a great way to add color or texture. http://startcooking.com/public/IMG_783 5-1.JPG
  • 88. LM-Cookery Grade 10 88 Different Techniques in Presenting Egg Dishes Attractively. Scrambled egg and bun on a plate Boiled eggs on white plate with with cereal bread garnish Scrambled egg with herbs Fried egg with bacon and toasted bread Egg in a sandwich Hard-boiled eggs in different sizes and shape
  • 89. LM-Cookery Grade 10 89 Scrambled egg in Manhattan plate Deviled eggs Stuffed egg Salad egg Poached egg Stir-fried eggs
  • 90. LM-Cookery Grade 10 90 Baked eggs Hard boiled Easter eggs Fried egg toppings Soft boiled egg Shaped poached egg Baked eggs in potato bowls
  • 91. LM-Cookery Grade 10 91 Occupational Health and Safety (OHS) Occupational Health and Safety (OHS) is a cross-disciplinary area concerned with protecting the safety, health and welfare of people engaged in work or employment. Knowing OHS is essential to minimize the hazards and risks not only to students, trainers and other people within the training institution but also to others who will be affected. Good OHS Practice 1. Disaster Plan - there should be plan in place to deal with any emergency. 2. Training and Providing Relevant Information 3. Work and storage areas should be designed, constructed, and equipped to ensure that there is minimum risk to archive material or staff. It should be kept free of food and drinks, harmful contaminants, pollutants or vermin radiation. 4. Near Miss and Hazardous Incidents and Accident Investigation 5. Report of Notifiable Accidents, Incidents and Dangerous Occurrences 6. First Aid 7. Personal Protective Equipment (PPE) Basic Food Microbiology Certain microscopic organisms, such as bacteria, are able to invade the human body and cause illness and sometimes death. Because contaminated foods are the major sources of organisms transmitted to people, it is essential that food production must have a clear understanding of food microbiology and the conditions involve in it. What is food borne illness? Food borne infection? Food borne intoxication? Food-borne illness is a disease that is carried and transmitted to people by food. Food-borne infection is a disease that results from eating food containing harmful micro-organism. Food-borne intoxication is a disease that results from eating food containing toxins from bacteria, molds or certain plants or animals. The common causes of outbreaks of food borne illness are: 1. Failure to properly refrigerate food 2. Failure to thoroughly heat or cook food 3. Infected employees/workers because of poor personal hygiene practices
  • 92. LM-Cookery Grade 10 92 4. Foods prepared a day or more before they are served 5. Raw, contaminated ingredients incorporated into foods that receive no further cooking 6. Cross-contamination of cooked food through improperly cleaned equipment 7. Failure to reheat food to temperature that kills bacteria 8. Prolonged exposure to temperatures favorable to bacterial growth. Aside from food safety we should also be aware of the different hazards in our workplace such as kitchen hazards, electrical hazards and others. To avoid or control these kind of hazards the following should be observed: 1. Use caution when working around hot oil. 2. Get trained in the proper use and maintenance of your deep fryer. 3. Observe all safety procedures and wear all protective equipment provided for your use while preparing hot items. 4. Use gloves, scrapers, and other cleaning tools with handles. 5. Use the correct grease level and cooking temperatures for your deep fryer. 6. Keep stove surfaces clean to prevent grease flare-ups. 7. Avoid reaching over or climbing on top of fryers and other hot surfaces. Clean vents when oil is cool. 8. Keep floor surfaces clean and dry to prevent slipping or falling onto hot surfaces. 9. Wear slip-resistant shoes. Floors should be cleaned often with grease- cutting solutions. 10. Do not work closely to hot fryers when the floor is wet. 11. Do not spill water or ice into hot oil as this may cause a flare-up. 12. Do not overfill or pour excessive amount of frozen fries into deep fryer at one time. 13. Overfilling causes excessive splashing and bubbling over of hot oil. 14. Do not pour excess ice from fry packages into the fryer. 15. Do not overheat the oil; use only manufacturers recommended cooking temperatures. 16. Do not move or strain hot oil containers; wait until the oil is cool! 17. Extinguish hot oil/grease fires by using a class K fire extinguisher.
  • 93. LM-Cookery Grade 10 93 Here are some tips on how to handle eggs: Purchasing: Do not buy dirty, cracked, or outdated eggs. Storage: 1. Store at 45 o F or below. 2. Store in closed container. 3. Store away from strong odors. 4. Refrigerate leftover egg dishes in shallow containers. 5. Do not allow drippings to contaminate eggs. Preparation/Cooking: 1. Keep refrigerated before and after cooking. 2. Keep everything clean. 3. Use only clean, not cracked eggs. 4. Cook thoroughly. 5. Wash container used for egg thoroughly. 6. Use egg separator Service/Transport: 1. Serve promptly after cooking. 2. Keep cold food cold, hot food hot. 3. Use ice or cold packs when transporting. 4. Avoid eating raw eggs or food that contain raw eggs.
  • 94. LM-Cookery Grade 10 94 Review of Learning Outcome 3 Formative Assessment (Learning Outcome 3) A. Directions: Identify the different ways in presenting cooked eggs. Write your answer in your test notebook. 1. 3. 5. 2. 4. 6.
  • 95. LM-Cookery Grade 10 95 7. 8. 9. 10. B. Directions: Prepare and cook French omelet individually using the given recipe. Present your product in an artistic way. Your product and performance will be evaluated using the given rubric. Tools/Equipment Needed: Small bowls Sauté pan Fork
  • 96. LM-Cookery Grade 10 96 Ingredients Needed: Three eggs Salt and pepper Clarified butter Fillings Procedure: 1. Prepare the necessary equipment. 2. Beat two or three eggs on a small bowl first until well-mixed. Do not whip until frothy. Season with salt and pepper. A tablespoon water may be added to make the omelet lighter. 3. Place an omelet pan over high heat. 4. When the pan is hot, add one tablespoon clarified butter to coat the inside of the pan. Give it a second to get hot. 5. Add eggs to the pan. 6. With one hand, vigorously shake the pan back and forth. At the same time, stir the eggs with a circular motion with the bottom side of the fork, but do not let the fork scrape the pan.
  • 97. LM-Cookery Grade 10 97 8. Tilt the handle up and shake the pan so the omelet slides to the opposite side. 9. For filled omelet, spoon the filling across the center of the egg. 10. With the fork, fold the sides of the omelet over the center. 11. Grasp the handle of the pan, and tilt the omelet into the plate so it inverts and keeps an oval shape.
  • 98. LM-Cookery Grade 10 98 Your output will be rated using the scoring rubric below: Dimension P E R F O R M A N C E L E V E L Excellent (4 pts.) Very Satisfactory (3 pts.) Satisfactory (2 pts.) Needs Improvement (1 pt.) No Attempt (0 pt.) Points Earned 1. Use of tools and equipment Uses tools and equipment correctly and confidently at all times Uses tools and equipment correctly and confidently most of the times Uses tools and equipment correctly but less confidently sometimes Uses tools and equipment incorrectly and less confidently most of the time No attempt 2. Application of procedures Manifests very clear understanding of the step- by-step procedure Manifests clear understandin g of the step- by-step procedure Manifests understanding of the step-by-step procedure but sometimes seeks clarification Manifests less understanding of the step- by-step procedure seeking clarification most of the time No attempt Works independently with ease and confidence at all times Works independentl y with ease and confidence most of the time Works independently with ease and confidence sometimes Works independently but with assistance from others most of the time No attempt 3. Safety work habits Observes safety precautions at all times Observes safety precautions most of the time Observes safety precautions sometimes Not observing safety precautions most of the time No attempt 4. Final Output Output is very presentable and taste exceeds the standard. Output is very presentable and taste meets the standard. Output is presentable and taste is little below the standard. Output is not so presentable and taste is not within the standard. No attempt 5. Time management Work completed ahead of time Work completed within allotted time Work completed (mins./hours/day s) beyond Work completed (mins./hours/day s) beyond No attempt TOTAL POINTS
  • 99. LM-Cookery Grade 10 99 Learning Outcome 4 Store Egg Dishes Storage is done to maintain the quality of food, prolong the shelf-life, maintain an adequate supply of food and ensure its safety for consumption. Proper storage of food is very crucial in keeping food safe because the manner and temperature of storage will affect the food‘s susceptibility to bacterial growth, other contaminants and infestation. Storing food will not improve its quality, it will only delay the rate of deterioration, and thus the proper period of storage should also be observed. Eggs should be stored properly to prevent increase in alkalinity and bacterial growth. They should be stored in an oval, dry place to retard deterioration, as enzymatic activity is greater at room temperature. Keeping eggs as fresh as possible depends on the care taken by the farmer, wholesaler, and grocer to refrigerate them at all times. After you have chosen your eggs by size, grade, freshness, and type, proper storage will help maintain their quality. Kind of Storage  Cold Storage (refrigerated storage, deep chilling, freezer storage) keeping potentially hazardous foods cold enough to prevent bacteria from growing. The temperature of the freezer compartment must be at 0°F or less, and the eggs should be stored in an area of the freezer where there is the least amount of temperature fluctuation.  Dry Storage should be dry, cool, well-ventilated, free from insects and rodents, clean and orderly. In the absence of refrigerators, eggs may be stored at room temperature for about seven days. Left-over egg yolks and egg whites should be kept in containers that will prevent drying. Tips for Storing Raw and Cooked Eggs:  Put eggs in the refrigerator as soon as possible after purchase.  Keep them in their covered carton (large end up) to preserve moisture and assure darkness. Do not put them in the egg box at the door of the refrigerator.  Keep eggs away from strong odors. These can be absorbed through the shells, which are porous.
  • 100. LM-Cookery Grade 10 100  Whole eggs can be beaten slightly and placed in a container with a tight seal and stored in the freezer for up to one year.  Egg whites also can be stored for up to a year in a tightly sealed container in the freezer.  When storing egg yolks in the freezer, a small amount of sugar or salt should be added to prevent the yolks from becoming too thick and gelatinous over time.  Add a pinch of salt per yolk if the yolks will be used for savory dishes, or add about a ¼ teaspoon of sugar per yolk if the yolks will be used for sweet dishes.  Do not wash eggs before storing them. This destroys the mineral-oil film that coats the shells and helps keep them fresh.  Dip the eggs in oil to cover the pores and to delay its deteriorative changes, reduce mold penetration and retard spoilage.  Do not keep eggs longer than 2 weeks in the refrigerator.  Left-over raw yolks can be refrigerated for several days when covered with water, milk, or oil. Two yolks can be used in place of 1 whole egg in a recipe.  Left-over raw whites can be stored in a tightly covered plastic or glass container in the refrigerator for several days or as long as they do not have any odor. They can also be frozen, although when thawed the white is thinner. However, you can use them successfully in recipes calling for egg whites. Recommended Storage Time for Eggs Fresh shell eggs Buy best before date Left-over yolks or whites Within 2 to 4 days Hard-Cooked eggs Within 1 week Prepared egg dishes Within 3 to 4 days Pickled eggs Within 1 month Frozen whole eggs (blended) Within 4 months Carson, Byrta, M.S., et.al., How you Plan and Prepare Meals, third edition copyright 1980 by McGraw-Hill, Inc. pp. 353 -363
  • 101. LM-Cookery Grade 10 101 Review of Learning Outcome 4 A. Directions: Write true if the statement is correct and false if it is incorrect. Write your answer on your test notebook. 1. Eggs should be stored properly to prevent increase in alkalinity and bacterial growth. 2. Fresh eggs can be kept more than two weeks. 3. When storing egg yolks in the freezer, a small amount of sugar or salt should be added to prevent the yolks from becoming too thick and thin over time. 4. To delay the deteriorative changes, reduce the penetration of mold and retard spoilage of eggs, cover the pores by dipping the eggs in oil. 5. In the absence of refrigerator, eggs may be stored at room temperature for about two weeks.
  • 102. LM-Cookery Grade 10 102 Cereals are usually starchy pods or grains. Cereal grains are the most important group of food crops in the world named after the Roman goddess of harvest, Ceres. Rice, wheat and corn are the three most cultivated cereals in the world. Starch on the other hand, exists in nature as the main component of cereals and tubers. In manufactured and processed foods, it plays an obvious role in achieving the desired viscosity in such products as cornstarch pudding, sauces, pie fillings, and gravies. Starch is the second most abundant organic substance on earth. It is found in all forms of leafy green plants, located in the roots, fruits or grains. Many of the food staples of man throughout the world are basically starchy foods, such as rice, corn, cassava, wheat, potato and others. Starch is the source of up to 80% of calories worldwide. Besides this significant role, starches have been used in food manufacture, cosmetics, pharmaceuticals, textiles, paper, construction materials, and other industries. Objectives At the end of the module the learners are expected to: 1. perform mise‘en place; 2. prepare starch and cereal dishes; 3. present starch and cereal dishes; and 4. store starch and cereal dishes. Learning Outcome 1 Perform Mise’en Place Tools and Equipment Needed The success of cooking starch and cereal dishes depends on the proper tools and equipment used in the preparation of food. The preparation of starch and cereal dishes requires the various tools and equipment below. Each tool must be used according to its function. 1. Mixing bowl – used when preparing cake mixture, salads, creams, and sauces. 2. Sifter – used for separating coarse particles of flour, sugar, baking powder, and powdered ingredients to retain finer textures. LESSON 2 PREPARE CEREALS AND STARCH
  • 103. LM-Cookery Grade 10 103 3. Wire whip – used for beating egg whites, egg yolk, creams and mayonnaise. 4. Wooden spoon – used for mixing creams, butter, and for tossing salads. 5. Slotted spoon – used to separate solid particles from soup; also for stirring purposes, such as making egg white fine in texture for bird‘s nest soup and mock nido soup. 6. Blending fork – used for testing the tenderness of meat, combining big cuts and particles of meat and vegetables, and for blending other ingredients with flour. 7. Rubber scraper – used for scraping off mixtures of butter, sugar, and egg from the sides of the mixing bowl. 8. Strainer – used for separating liquids from fine or solid food particles, such as coco cream from coconut and tamarind extract. 9. Tongs – used for handling hot foods. 10. Measuring Cups – used for measuring dry and liquid ingredients 11. Measuring spoon – used for measuring dry and liquid ingredients which require a little amount 12. Sauce pan and pots – used for cooking meat and fish dishes with gravy and sauce. 13. Kettle and rice cooker – used for cooking rice and other foods. 14. Pressure cooker – used for tenderizing or cooking meat, chicken, and other grains or legumes, such as mongo and white beans in lesser time.. 15. Double boiler – used for preparing sauces which easily get scorched when cooked directly on the stove. 16. Steamer – used for cooking food by steaming. 17. Colander - a perforated bowl of varying sizes made of stainless steel, aluminum or plastic, used to drain, wash, or cook ingredients from liquid 18. Canister - a plastic or metal container with a lid that is used for keeping dry products 19. Butcher knife – used for cutting, sectioning, and trimming raw meats 20. Channel knife – a small hand tool used generally in decorative works such as making garnishes.
  • 104. LM-Cookery Grade 10 104 Sources of Starch The parts of plants that store most starch are seeds, roots, and tubers. Thus, the most common sources of food starch are:  cereal grains, including corn, wheat, rice, grain, sorghum, and oats;  legumes; and  roots or tubers, including potato, sweet potato, arrowroot, and the tropical cassava plant (marketed as tapioca) Common Source of Manufactured Food Starch 1. corn 2. potato 3. Tapioca (cassava) Starches are named after its plant sources  corn starch from corn  rice starch from rice  tapioca from cassava Classification of Starch 1. Native or Natural Starch refers to the starches as originally derived from its plant source. 2. Modified Starches are starches that have been altered physically or chemically, to modify one or more of its key chemicals and/or physical property. 3. Purified starch may be separated from grains and tubers by a process called wet milling. This procedure employs various techniques of grinding, screening, and centrifuging to separate the starch from fiber, oil, and protein.
  • 105. LM-Cookery Grade 10 105 Starch Composition and Structure The Starch Molecule Starch is polysaccharide made up of hundreds or even thousands of glucose molecules joined together. The molecules of starch are two general types, called fractions: amylose and amylopectin. Amylose is a long chain-like molecule, sometimes called the linear fraction, and is produced by linking together 500 to 2, 000 glucose molecules. The amylose fraction of starch contributes gelling characteristics to cooked and cooled starch mixtures. A gel is rigid to a certain degree and holds a shape when molded. Amylopectin has a highly branched, bushy type of structure, very different from the long, string-like molecules of amylose. In both, amylose and amylopectin, however, the basic building unit is glucose. Cohesion or thickening properties are contributed by amylopectin when a starch mixture is cooked in the presence of water, but this fraction does not produce a gel. Most natural starches are mixtures of the two fractions. Corn, wheat, rice, potato, and tapioca starches contains 24 to 16 percent amylose, with the remainder being amylopectin. The root starches of tapioca and potato are lower in amylose content than the cereal starches of corn, wheat, and rice. The Starch Granule In the storage areas of plants, notably the seeds and roots, molecules of starch are deposited in tiny, organized units called granules. Amylose and amylopectin molecules are placed together in tightly packed stratified layers formed around a central spot in the granule called the hilum. The starch molecules are systematically structured in the granule to form crystalline-like patterns. If the starch granules, in a water suspension, are observed microscopically under polarized light, the highly oriented structure causes the light to be rotated so that a Maltese cross pattern on each granule is observed. This phenomenon is called birefringence. The pattern disappears when the starch mixture is heated and the structure disrupted. The sizes and shapes of granules differ among starches from various sources, but all starch granules are microscopic in size.
  • 106. LM-Cookery Grade 10 106 Composition of Starch Potato Cassava Wheat Cornstarch Moisture,% 19 13 13 Ash,% 0.4 0.2 0.2 Protein, % 0.06 0.1 0.4 Lipid,% 0.05 0.1 0.8 Phosphorus% 0.08 0.01 0.06 Amylose,% 21 17 28 Micrograph 1. Muhrbeck, P. and A.-C.Eliasson. 1987. Influence of pH and ionic strength on the viscoelastic properties of starch gels- a comparison of potato and cassava starches. Carbohydrate Polymers 7: 291-300. Starch Properties and Reactions 1. Gelatinization.The sum of changes that occur in the first stages of heating starch granules in a moist environment which includes swelling of granules as water is absorbed and disruption of the organized granule structure. 2. Viscosity. The resistance to flow; increase in thickness or consistency. When the newly gelatinized starch is stirred, more swollen granules break and more starch molecules spill causing increase in viscosity or thickness. Changes in Gelatinization of Starch hydration and swelling to several times original size loss of birefringence increase in clarity marked, rapid increase in consistency and attainment of peak "dissolution" of linear molecules and diffusion from ruptured granules. with heat removal, retro gradation of mixture to a paste-like mass of gel.
  • 107. LM-Cookery Grade 10 107 The type of sugar influences the temperature and rate of gelatinization. The effect of sugar is attributed to competition for water. It was observed that sugar actually interacts with the amorphous areas of the starch granules. Different Sweeteners Added to Starch Gel Preparation.  honey  molasses  panutsa or granulated sugar 3. Retrogadationis the process in which starch molecules, particularly the amylose fraction, re-associate or bond together in an ordered structure after disruption by gelatinization; ultimately a crystalline order appears. 4. Syneresis. Oozing of liquid from gel when cut and allowed to stand (e.g. jelly or baked custard). The oozing of liquid from a rigid gel; sometimes called weeping. This reaction occurs in all kinds of gels: puddings jellies custards gelatin agar 5. Dextrinization. It is the process of forming dextrin. Dextrins – are partially hydrolyzed starches that are prepared by dry roasting. In home kitchens, dextrinization is achieved by toasting flour for polvoron, rice flour for kare- kare sauce, and bread slices for breakfast. 6. Hydrolysis Starches undergo hydrolysis during cooking or processing and during storage of food where a chemical reaction in which a molecular linkage is broken and a molecule of water is utilized. a. Prolonged heating of starches with acid will promote hydrolysis. This can happen when cooking an acidic food, such as: Pineapple pie resulting in reduced viscosity or firmness of the pie filling.
  • 108. LM-Cookery Grade 10 108 Functional Properties of Starches Starch plays various roles in food, a typical multi-tasker 1. Thickeners in gravies, sauces and pudding. It absorbs water and become a gel when cooked. 2. Colloidal stabilizers 3. Moisture retainer 4. Gel forming agents 5. Binders 6. Package 7. Flavor carriers– its ability to trap oils and fats, which absorb flavoring substances more efficiently. Starches – are added to processed meats (luncheon meats, hot dogs, sausages, etc.) as a filler, binder, moisture, retainer, and fat substitute. The quality characteristics of the starch itself depends upon which role or function it was used. Cereal. Cereal is any grain that is used for food. Grains especially whole grain are not just empty calories. These are very valuable and can contribute a great deal to our health. You should include at least four servings from this food group each day. Cereal-processed food:  A whole grain cereal is a grain product that has retained the specific nutrients of the whole, unprocessed grain and contains natural proportions of bran, germ and endosperm.  Enriched cereals are excellent sources of thiamine, niacin, riboflavin, and iron.  A restored cereal is one made from either the entire grain or portions of one or more grains to which there have been added sufficient amounts of thiamine, niacin, and iron to attain the accepted whole grain levels of these three nutrients found in the original grain from which the cereal is prepared. Cereals provide the body with:  Carbohydrates  Protein  Fat  Vitamins  Minerals  Water  Cellulose or roughage
  • 109. LM-Cookery Grade 10 109 Nutritional Significance of Noodles and Pasta or Alimentary Paste The physiological function of noodles and pasta will depend on its starch and other constituents. Since it is basically a starchy food, the nutritional significance discussed for starches also applies. In addition to starches, including resistant starches I (RS), noodles and pasta may contain other fibers and some proteins and fat as well. Nutritive value:  Water  Protein  Fat  Carbon  Calcium  Phosphorous  Iron  Thiamin  Riboflavin  Niacin Dried Noodles and Pasta  Macaroni • Miki  Spaghetti • Chicken Mami  Pancit Canton • Linguini  Bihon • Lasagňa  Sotanghon  Miswa
  • 110. LM-Cookery Grade 10 110 Review of Learning Outcome 1 A. Directions: Complete the table by writing the appropriate tool and equipment in column B to perform the task given in column A. Write your answer in your test notebook. A B 1. Used for separating coarse particles of flour, sugar, baking powder, and powdered ingredients to retain finer textures. 2. Used for cooking meat and fish dishes with gravy and sauce. 3. Used for cooking food by steaming 4. Used for tenderizing meat, chicken, and other grains or legumes, such as mongo and white beans in lesser time. 5. Used for separating liquids from fine or solid food particles, such as coco cream from coconut and tamarind extract.
  • 111. LM-Cookery Grade 10 111 B. Directions: Enumerate the different kinds of starch and give its nutritional value 1. 2. 3. 4. C.Give at least three starch properties and reactions and describe it in one sentence. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
  • 112. LM-Cookery Grade 10 112 Learning Outcome 2 Prepare and Cook Starch and Cereal Dishes One of the properties of starch is viscosity which is the resistance to flow of starch and modified starch paste. In the preparation and cooking of starch and cereal dishes, factors affecting starch paste viscosity and starch gel strength should be considered. Factors Affecting Starch Paste Viscosity and Starch Gel Strength  Stress or other factor. Stirring Amount and Type. This is a gelatinized cornstarch dispersion that is likely to break; the granules broke apart due to stirring.  Kind and Amount of Starch. Certain type of starch will influence the characteristics of the starch paste viscosity and gel strength. Generally speaking, with "native starches" the greater the amount of amylopectin the more viscous the starch paste, whereas, the greater the amount of amylase, the firmer the gel is (greater the gel strength).  Heating rate. The faster starch-water dispersion is heated; the thicker it will be at the identical endpoint temperature.  Endpoint Temperature  Each type of starch has a specific endpoint temperature at which it will undergo optimum gelatinization.  Incompletely gelatinized starch will not attain optimum starch paste viscosity or gel strength.  Over gelatinization results in decreased starch paste viscosity and gel strength because the swollen granules fragmented with stirring and/or imploded due to the extensive loss of amylase from the granule.  Cooling and storage conditions  If cooled too fast, the amylase will not have time to form the vital micelles necessary for the three dimensional structure.  If cooled too slowly, the amylase fractions will have a chance to align too much and become too close together and the liquid portion will not be trapped in the micelles. In both instances there will be weeping and syneresis (the contraction of a gel accompanied by the separating out of liquid.).
  • 113. LM-Cookery Grade 10 113  Ingredients added (acid, enzyme, sugar, fat and emulsifiers a. Addition of acid or enzyme can also cause dextrinization (the process of forming dextrins).  Dextrin – a pale powder obtained from starch, used mainly as an adhesive.  In making kalamansi pudding or pie, if the juice is added early in the gelatinization process, dextrinization of the starch will occur resulting in decreased viscosity and gel strength.  Sugar will delay or inhibit gelatinization of starch.  Starch pudding with excess sugar will be less viscous or form less firm gel.  A cake may collapse as the structural contribution of starch is delayed or inhibited.  Decreased starch paste viscosity and gel strength because the sugar added to water won‘t be available for gelatinization. The kind of sugar used also affect viscosity.  Fat and surfactants, will serve to ―waterproof‖ the starch granules so that water will not penetrate as readily during the gelatinization process. Functions of Starch and Application in Filipino Dishes Functions of Starch Type of Food Preparation Recipes Thickening Sauces, Gravies, Pie fillings and soups Sauces: Sweet sour, lechon, lumpia, kare-kare, palabok Pie filling: mango, buko, apple, pineapple Soups: Arrozcaldo, cream soups. Gelling Puddings, kakanin Bread pudding, majaBlanca, sapin-sapin, kutchinta, cassava bibingka Binding and filling Meat loaves and meat emulsions Luncheon meat, hot dogs, Vienna sausage, chicken nuggets, chicken balls, Ukoy, tempura
  • 114. LM-Cookery Grade 10 114 Stabilizing Beverage, syrup, salad dressing Chocolate drinks, fruits drinks, yogurt drinks, cooked dressings Moisture retaining Cake fillings, candies Cake rolls, cream fillings Coating or ducting Breads, confectionery, pastries Pan de sal, Biscuits, candies, espasol Diluent Baking powder, Cupcake Coloring Toasts, bread crumbs Polvoron, Lechon sauce, Kare-kare sauce, breadings Common Problems in Starch Cookery 1. Thinning of Gel. This problem is usually encountered when using acid or acid ingredients such as lemon or vinegar. 2. Weak Gel. Weak gel results if there is too much liquid in relation to the starch 3. Skin Formation. Skin formation is due to loss of water from the starch and protein molecules near the surface of the mixture. To reduce this problem, cover container of the starch gel with a waterproof cover. 4. Scorching. This can be avoided by temperature control and constant stirring so the starch granules do not settle at the bottom of the cooking pan. 5. Raw Starch Flavor. This is due to ungelatinized starch. Principles in Cooking Cereals In cooking all cereal products, the following points should be observed: 1. Use a double boiler. 2. Observe carefully the correct proportions of cereal, water and salt. 3. Cook at boiling temperature (212° F.). 4. Watch the time by the clock, and always cook the full time prescribed, preferably longer. 5. Serve attractively. 6. Improper cooking and poor serving are largely responsible for unpopularity of cereal foods.
  • 115. LM-Cookery Grade 10 115 Cooking Pasta Pasta should be cooked al dente, or ―to the tooth‖. This means the cooking should be stopped when the pasta still feels firm to the bite, not soft and mushy. The pleasure of cooking pasta is its texture, and this is lost if it is overcooked. To test for doneness, break pasta into small piece and taste it. As soon as pasta is al dente, cooking must be stopped at once. Half a minute extra is enough to overcook it. Cooking times differ for every shape and size of pasta. Timing also depends on the kind of flour used, and the moisture content. Fresh egg pasta, if it has not been allowed to dry, takes only 1 to 1 ½ minutes to cook after the water has returned to a boil. Italian practice is to toss the pasta with the sauce the minute it is drained, the sauce immediately coats all surfaces of the pasta, and the cheese, melts in the heat of the boiling hot noodles. This picture is to be replaced.
  • 116. LM-Cookery Grade 10 116 Basic Principles in Preparing Pasta Pasta Shapes There are hundreds of shapes and sizes of pasta with each shape used for different preparations based on how the sauce will cling, the texture desired, or how the product will be used. For example: • Pasta shapes with holes or ridges, such as wagon wheels or rotini, are perfect for chunkier sauces. • Thin, delicate pastas, such as angel hair or vermicelli, are better served with light, thin sauces. • Thicker pasta shapes, such as fettuccine, work well with heavier sauces. • Very small pasta shapes, like alphabet shapes and acini di pepe, are good for soups. Flavored pasta is available in a variety of shapes in both the dried and fresh forms. Vegetable ingredients are added to pasta to provide both color and flavor. An example of flavored pasta is spinach noodles that are green. Follow the package directions for cooking flavored pastas. Cooking Time Depends on the Shape It is important to be familiar with different shapes of pasta so cooking times can be adjusted. The larger and fuller the pasta shape, the longer the cooking time. Most pasta recipes specify cooking times for pasta cooked al dente, tender but firm. Al dente is an Italian phrase that means ―to the tooth.‖ Some of the pasta shapes and cooking times are shown in the ―Cooking Chart for Various Pasta Shapes.‖ Just seeing this chart helps to emphasize how important it is to follow the recipe and cook pasta the right way.
  • 117. LM-Cookery Grade 10 117 Pasta Gets Bigger and Heavier when Cooked Generally, pasta doubles or triples in weight when it is cooked. Likewise, the volume increases 2 to 2 ½ times during cooking. Follow the Recipe The general rule for cooking pasta in boiling water is for 1 pound of pasta, use 1 gallon of water, 1 teaspoon of salt, and 1 teaspoon of oil. For 100 servings of spaghetti, 6 gallons of water, 2 tablespoons of salt, and 2 tablespoons of oil are needed to cook 6 pounds of dried spaghetti. When pasta is to be used as an ingredient in a recipe that will be cooked more, like macaroni and cheese, it should be slightly undercooked. This means reducing the cooking time by about 2 minutes. Pasta that is not cooked enough is tough and chewy. Pasta that is overcooked is soft and pasty. When overcooked pasta is combined with a sauce, it often breaks apart. Handle pasta the right way after it is cooked. Like most foods, pasta is best when it is cooked and served right away. However, it is sometimes necessary to cook it ahead and hold it until time for service. Suggestions for Holding Pasta To serve immediately Drain, add sauce, and serve. To hold for a short time for service later Drain, toss with a small amount of oil to prevent sticking, cover, and hold in warmer. To serve as part of a salad Cook pasta a day ahead so it will be chilled when combined with the other salad ingredients. Do not combine hot pasta with cold ingredients. Drain and cover with cold water just long enough to cool. The pasta does not need refrigeration for a short time, it is cooled in the water. When pasta is cool, drain and toss lightly with oil to prevent sticking or drying out. Cover and refrigerate. To cook a day ahead for service in a heated dish Drain and cover with cold water just long enough to cool. When pasta is cool, drain and toss lightly with oil to prevent sticking or drying out. Cover and refrigerate. When it is time to use the pasta, immerse it in boiling water until just heated through. Drain immediately and use according to
  • 118. LM-Cookery Grade 10 118 the recipe. The pasta should not be cooked more, just heated to serving temperature. To use in a cooked dish Slightly undercook the pasta. Cooking Chart for Various Pasta Shapes Pasta Name Cooking Time for al dente Pasta Name Cooking Time for al dente Lasagna 15 minutes Ziti 10 minutes Bow Ties 11 minutes Fettuccine 8 minutes Wagon Wheels 11 minutes Rotini 8 minutes Linguine 10 minutes Elbow Macaroni 6 minutes Rigatoni 10 minutes Noodles 6 minutes Spaghetti 10 minutes Directions: Given the recipe, by pair or by group cook pasta following the procedures. Your product and performance will be evaluated using the given rubric. How to Cook Pasta? Materials needed:  500g pasta  Salt  Water
  • 119. LM-Cookery Grade 10 119 Tools/equipment needed  Burner  Kettle  Ladle  Colander Procedure for Cooking Pasta 1. Put 4 quarter water per 500 g of pasta in a kettle. Add 1 ½ teaspoon salt. 2. Boil the water rapidly and drop in the pasta. As it softens, stir gently to keep it from sticking together and to the bottom. Continue to boil, stirring a few times. 3. Drain immediately in a colander as soon as it is al dente, and rinse with cold running water until the pasta is completely cooled. If serve immediately, just drain well from hot water. Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking pasta and performs the skill without supervision. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking pasta and performs the skill with some assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking pasta with minor errors and performs the skill with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking pasta and was not able to perform the skill. Risk in the preparation and cooking of starch and cereal dishes and other food  Food handlers;  Kitchen facilities;  Food selection and preparation; and  Safe temperatures.
  • 120. LM-Cookery Grade 10 120 Guidelines on proper and safe handling of food 1. Food handlers  Undergo training on food safety and obtain medical certificates from the local/provincial/city/municipal health office.  Observe proper hand washing technique  Wear complete cooking outfit and use disposable gloves for direct food contact.  Observe personal hygiene at all times.  Avoid handling food if you are sick. 2. Kitchen facilities  Use separate equipment and utensils for handling raw foods  Sanitize all surfaces and equipment used for food preparation  Clean thoroughly the cutting-boards and work areas after each use  Protect the kitchen areas and food from insects, pests and other animals  Maintain the highest standards of sanitation in the kitchen at all times  Repair immediately broken but still serviceable kitchen tools, utensils and equipment to be ready for next use  Sanitize completely all kitchen utensils especially cups, saucers, flatware after each use  Provide for adequate space, proper ventilation and window screens in the area  Provide garbage receptacle for proper waste disposal 3. Food Preparation and Cooking  Check expiry dates of food commodities bought and those in stock  Use iodized salt as a must in salt-seasoned preparations  Cover the food properly.  Practice segregation of materials  Store food properly 4. Safe temperature  Do not leave cooked food at room temperature for more than two hours  Refrigerate promptly all cooked and perishable food preferably below 50C within four hours
  • 121. LM-Cookery Grade 10 121  Do not store food too long even in the refrigerator.  Thaw food inside the refrigerator, not at room temperature.  Check internal temperature during cooking to assure proper end-point time and temperature has been met to at least 700C/1650F  Reheat cooked food thoroughly to 700C/1650F within two hours B. Directions: Collect at least 20 different recipes of starch and cereal dishes and compile it using any kind of paper, any decorating materials, glue, and coloring materials. Your output will be rated using the scoring rubric below: SCORE CRITERIA 5 Compiled properly (20) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in a very attractive manner 4 Compiled properly (16-19) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in an attractive manner 3 Compiled properly (10-15) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in simple manner 2 Compiled properly (6-9) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in simple manner 1 Compiled less than 6 recipes of starch and cereal dishes in disorganized manner
  • 122. LM-Cookery Grade 10 122 s: C. Directions: Given the recipe, prepare and present Fettuccine Alfredo following the procedures. Ingredient 1 cup heavy cream 2 tbsp butter 1 ½ lb. fresh fettuccine 1 cup heavy cream 6 tbsp. freshly grated parmesan cheese salt to taste pepper to taste Procedure: 1. Combine the cream and butter in a sauté pan. Bring to simmer, reduce by ¼ and remove from heat. 2. Drop the noodles into boiling salted water, return to a full boil and drain. Undercook slightly the noodles because they will cook further in the cream. 3. Put the noodles in the pan with hot cream and butter. Toss the noodles with two forks until they are well coated with the cream, over low heat. 4. Add the remainder of the cream and cheese and toss to mix well. 5. Add salt and pepper to taste. 6. Plate and serve immediately.
  • 123. LM-Cookery Grade 10 123 Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking starch dish and performs the skill without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking starch dish and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking starch dish with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking starch dish and performs the skill unsatisfactorily. Learning Outcome 3 Present Starch and Cereal Dishes Techniques in Preparing Pasta before Plating 1. Pasta is best if cooked and served immediately. Try to cook pasta upon order. 2. If pasta is to be served immediately, just drain and do not rinse in cold water. 3. If pasta is to be used cold in salad, it is ready to be incorporated in the recipe as soon as it has cooled. 4. If pasta is to be held, toss gently with a small amount of oil to keep it from sticking. 5. Measure portions into mounds on trays. Cover with plastic film and refrigerate until service time. 6. To serve, place the desired number of portions in a china cap and immerse in simmering water to reheat. Drain, plate, and add sauce.
  • 124. LM-Cookery Grade 10 124 PLATING AND PRESENTING PASTA DISHES
  • 125. LM-Cookery Grade 10 125 D. Make an album of twenty different kinds of starch and cereal dish presentations with recipes. Your output will be rated using the rubric below: SCORE CRITERIA 5 Compiled properly (20) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in a very attractive manner 4 Compiled properly (16-19) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in an attractive manner 3 Compiled properly (10-15) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in simple manner 2 Compiled properly (6-9) recipes of starch and cereal dishes in simple manner 1 Compiled less than 6 recipes of starch and cereal dishes in disorganized manner
  • 126. LM-Cookery Grade 10 126 B. Directions: Given the needed tools and equipment, prepare and present Baked Lasagna following the recipe below: Baked Lasagna Ingredients: ¾ lb. ricotta cheese 2 tbsp. parmesan cheese, grated 1 pc egg salt to taste pepper to taste 1 lb. lasagna 6 cups meat sauce ¾ lb. mozzarella cheese, shredded 4 tbsp. parmesan cheese, grated
  • 127. LM-Cookery Grade 10 127 Procedure: 1. Mix together the ricotta, parmesan and eggs then season to taste with salt and pepper. 2. Cook lasagna noodles. Lay them out in a single layer on oiled sheet pans. 3. Ladle a little meat sauce into the pan. Spread it across the bottom. 4. Arrange a layer of noodles in the pan. Add a layer of ricotta mixture, a layer of noodles, a layer of sauce and a layer mozzarella. 5. Continue making layers of noodles, ricotta, sauce and mozzarella until all ingredients are used. Top with parmesan cheese. 6. Bake at 375°F (190°C. for about 30-45 minutes. Cover lightly with foil, then remove after 15 minutes of baking time. Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: I. Products: Very Good (4) Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. attractive and appealing to appetite b. pleasing and good color combination c. ingredients cooked just right 2. Palatability a. delicious b. taste just right 3. Nutritive value a. highly nutritious II. Procedures: 1. Use of Resources: a. keep working table orderly while preparing the ingredients b. use only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. use time-saving techniques and devices 2. Cleanliness and sanitation a. is well- groomed and properly dressed for cooking, use clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holder b. observe sanitary handling of food 3. Conservation of nutrients a. follow proper preparation and cooking procedures
  • 128. LM-Cookery Grade 10 128 A. Directions: Watch a video in the YouTube showing how to make a homemade pasta. Note down the procedures in your notebook and make a narrative observation on a short bond paper for submission next meeting. Review procedures and prepare for actual preparation. B. Directions: Make your homemade pasta using your bare hands. You may include other ingredients. Your products, performance and presentation will be rated using the given rubric. How to Make Homemade Pasta by Hand Tools & Utensils: Rolling pin Mixing bowl Measuring cup/spoon Sharp cutter/knife Ingredients: 2 cups all-purpose flour ¼ tsp salt 3 pcs egg 1tbsp milk 1tsp olive oil Procedure: 1. Combine 2 cups all-purpose flour and 1/4 teaspoon salt on pastry board, culling board, or countertop; make well in center. Whisk 3 eggs, 1 tablespoon milk, and 1 teaspoon olive oil in small bowl until well blended; gradually pour into the flour mixture while mixing with fork or fingertips to form ball of dough. 2. Gradually add the mixture to the flour to make a ball of dough. 3. Place dough on lightly floured surface; flatten slightly. To knead dough, fold dough in half toward you and press dough away from you with heels of hands. Give dough a quarter turn and continue folding, pushing, and turning. Continue kneading for 5 minutes until smooth and elastic, adding more flour to prevent sticking if necessary. Wrap dough in plastic and let it stand for 15 minutes. 4. Knead the dough until it becomes smooth and elastic. 5. Unwrap dough and knead briefly (as described in step 2) on lightly floured surface. Using lightly floured rolling pin, roll out dough to 1/8-inch-thick circle on lightly floured surface. Gently pick up dough circle with both
  • 129. LM-Cookery Grade 10 129 hands. Hold it up to the light to check for places where dough is too thick. Return to board. Let rest until dough is slightly dry but can be handled without breaking. 6. Lightly flour dough circle; roll loosely on rolling pin. 7. Loosely roll the dough on a rolling pin. 8. Slide rolling pin out; press dough roll gently with hand and cut into strips of desired width with sharp knife. Carefully unfold strips. 9. Cut the dough into strips of desired width. 10 Pasta can be dried and stored at this point. Hang strips over pasta rack or clean broom handle covered with plastic wrap and propped between two chairs. Dry for at least 3 hours; store in airtight container at room temperature for 4 days. To serve, cook pasta in large pot of boiling salted water 3 to 4 minutes just until al dente. Drain well. 11. Dry the pasta using a drying rack. Your performance will be rated using the rubric below. 4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking homemade pasta and performs the skill without supervision. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking homemade pasta and performs the skill without some assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking homemade pasta with minor errors and performs the skill with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking homemade pasta and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
  • 130. LM-Cookery Grade 10 130 Learning Outcome 4 Store Starch and Cereal Dishes Introduction Proper storage of food is very crucial in keeping food safe because the manner and temperature of storage will affect the food‘s susceptibility to bacterial growth, other contaminants, and infestation. Storing food will not improve its quality, it will only delay the rate of deterioration, and thus, the proper period of storage should also be observed. FIFO (First In, First Out) in storing food is very important. Though it is a long-time method in store-keeping where the first food stored should be the first food to be out from the storage it is high time to make it a habit or put into practice. Write the expiry date, date received and date of storage to the food package and regularly check the expiration date. How to Store Pasta Noodles Pasta is stored in airtight containers. Pasta noodles are usually sold dry at the grocery store, allowing you to store them with other staples in your pantry. Dry noodles have a long storage life when properly packaged. Improper storage causes the pasta to become moist, which leads to mildew. Even without moisture, pasta can become stale if it's not stored correctly. Proper storage ensures your pasta to always taste its best. 1. Dry Pasta  Remove the pasta from the store packaging if the noodles come in a box or other non-airtight container.  Place the noodles in a sealable plastic bag or other container that closes tightly. For long noodles, such as spaghetti, use a tall plastic storage container.  Seal the bag or screw the lid on tightly. Store the pasta in a cool, dry place. Dry pasta stores indefinitely, but should be used within two years to prevent loss of flavor. Store dried egg noodles for up to six months. Dried pasta need not to be refrigerated. It can be stored on the shelf in an airtight container in a dry area that is not exposed to extreme temperature. Dried pasta can be stored indefinitely and still be safe to eat but the USDA recommends storing dried pasta for no more than two years to obtain the best quality. Some manufacturers will stamp their packages with a "best if used by" date, which indicates that the flavor, color and nutritional value may be affected if used beyond that date.
  • 131. LM-Cookery Grade 10 131 2. Cooked Pasta  Pour the noodles into a colander. Allow as much moisture as possible to drain. Noodles left in standing water become overly soft and mushy.  Sprinkle 1 tsp. salad oil over the noodles. Toss the pasta so the noodles are evenly coated in the oil. Salad oil prevents the pastafrom sticking together.  Place the pasta in a tight-sealed container. Store in the refrigerator for three to five days.  Cooked pasta can be stored unsauced in an airtight container and refrigerated for 4 or 5 days. The sauce should be refrigerated separate from the pasta and can be stored for 6 or 7 days. This prevents the pasta from soaking up too much flavor and oil from the sauce, which causes the taste of the pasta to be drowned out. If the pasta is stored together with the sauce, it should be eaten within 1 or 2 days to limit the amount of sauce that is absorbed. If cooked pasta is not going to be used within the suggested time period, it should be frozen and then it can be stored for approximately 3 months. Frozen cooked pasta should be thawed in the refrigerator and not on the kitchen counter. To store, cook the pasta as you normally would and then rinse with cold water and allow it to drain well. Add a small amount of olive oil or butter to help prevent the pasta from clumping together while it is stored. Use only enough oil or butter to lightly coat the pasta.
  • 132. LM-Cookery Grade 10 132 To refrigerate, place the pasta in an airtight plastic bag or an airtight container and place in the refrigerator. To freeze, place in an airtight plastic freezer bag and press out as much excess air as possible and place in the freezer. If storing sauced pasta, eat within 1 to 2 days to prevent it from absorbing too much sauce.  When refrigerating or freezing cooked pasta, be sure it is stored in a well-sealed container so that it does not absorb any odor. Cooked lasagna and baked pasta dishes can be refrigerated or frozen in the same manner as plain cooked pasta. The lasagna and casseroles should be first cut into individual servings before placing them in a sealed bag or container. This will make it easier when reheating. If you have an entire lasagna or pasta dish to refrigerate or freeze, it can be left in the baking dish and tightly covered before storing.
  • 133. LM-Cookery Grade 10 133 The lasagna and baked pasta dishes can be refrigerated for 3 or 4 days or they can be placed in a freezer and kept for approximately 3 months. If frozen, the pasta dish should be thawed in the refrigerator and not on the kitchen counter. 3. Fresh Pasta.  Fresh pasta should ideally be used on the same day as manufactured. This is not always possible, but if it is used within the next two days it will give adequate results. After this it tends to crack through excess drying. It must be stored, keep it well-covered in the fridge, to minimize the risk of this happening. Frozen filled pastas will keep for up to three months if held at -18oC or lower.  Fresh pasta can be stored in the refrigerator for 2 or 3 days. If the pasta will not be used within that time, it can be frozen and stored in the freezer for 2 to 3 months. Homemade pasta can be stored in the refrigerator for 1 or 2 days or frozen for 2 to 3 months. Homemade pasta can also be allowed to dry thoroughly and then placed in a plastic bag or airtight container. The length of time it will take to dry will vary depending on the type of pasta and its size, shape and thickness. If dried completely, the pasta can then be stored in a cool dry place for a couple of months. If you are going to use the pasta on the same day as it is made, you can allow it to dry on a clean towel for a couple of hours before you cook it unless it is stuffed pasta. Stuffed pasta, such as ravioli, should be cooked within half an hour, otherwise it will begin to discolor and become damp. If it is not going to be cooked immediately it should be placed on a lightly floured towel that is placed on a baking sheet, sprinkled lightly with flour, and then placed in the freezer. Once they are frozen they can be stored in a freezer proof bag or wrap and then place it in the freezer for 8 or 9 months.
  • 134. LM-Cookery Grade 10 134 4. Frozen pasta does not have to be thawed before it is cooked. Just place the frozen pasta into boiling water and reheat it. It will need to cook a little longer than unfrozen pasta. Tips & Warnings • Store pasta sauce separate from the noodles, otherwise the noodles will become mushy. • You can freeze cooked pasta but it may be too soft once thawed. Use frozen pasta in baked dishes so the softer texture is not noticeable. Review of Learning Outcome 4 A. Explain the principle behind FIFO. B. Make a slogan showing the importance of proper storing of food. Your output will be rated using the scoring rubric below: SCORE CRITERIA 5 Done creatively and neatly showing much relevance to the given topic 4 Done creatively and neat enough with relevance to the given topic 3 Done creatively and neat enough but no relevance to the given topic 2 Done simply and neat enough but not so relevant to the given topic 1 Done poorly with erasures and irrelevant to the given topic
  • 135. LM-Cookery Grade 10 135 Prepare and cook any cereal dish from among those recipes which you have compiled in the previous activity. Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: Dimension P E R F O R M A N C E L E V E L Excellent (4 pts.) Very Satisfactory (3 pts.) Satisfactory (2 pts.) Needs Improvement (1 pt.) No Attempt (0 pt.) Points Earned 1. Use of tools and equipment Uses tools and equipment correctly and confidently at all times Uses tools and equipment correctly and confidently most of the times Uses tools and equipment correctly but less confidently sometimes Uses tools and equipment incorrectly and less confidently most of the time No attempt 2. Application of procedures Manifests very clear understanding of the step- by-step procedure Manifests clear understandin g of the step- by-step procedure Manifests understanding of the step-by-step procedure but sometimes seeks clarification Manifests less understanding of the step- by-step procedure seeking clarification most of the time No attempt Works independently with ease and confidence at all times Works independentl y with ease and confidence most of the time Works independently with ease and confidence sometimes Works independently but with assistance from others most of the time No attempt 3. Safety work habits Observes safety precautions at all times Observes safety precautions most of the time Observes safety precautions sometimes Not observing safety precautions most of the time No attempt 4. Final Output Output is very presentable and taste exceeds the standard. Output is very presentable and taste meets the standard. Output is presentable and taste is within the standard. Output is not so presentable and taste is within the standard. No attempt 5. Time management Work completed ahead of time Work completed within allotted time Work completed (mins./hours/day s) beyond Work completed (mins./hours/day s) beyond No attempt TOTAL POINTS
  • 136. LM-Cookery Grade 10 136 Let’s See How Much You Learned Post Test A. Multiple Choice. Directions: Read each question carefully. Choose the letter which corresponds to the correct answer and write it in your test notebook. 1. Knife is chef‘s best buddy. It is the busiest tool being used by people assigned inside the kitchen. Which of the following knives is used for decorative works such as garnishes? A. Bread knife C. Channel knife B. Butcher knife D. Paring knife 2. It is a perforated bowl of varying sizes made of stainless steel, aluminum or plastic used to drain washed or cooked ingredients from liquid. A. Canister C. Mixing bowl B. Colander D. Soup bowl 3. It is used for turning and lifting eggs, pan cakes and meats on griddles, grills, sheet pans, and the likes and also used to scrape and clean griddles. A. Measuring spoon C. Rubber scraper B. Offset spatula D. Wooden spoon 4. It is used to scrape off all the contents of bowls and pans from the sides and fold in beaten eggs in batter or whipped cream. A. Paring knife C. Wire whisk B. Rubber spatula D. Wooden spoon 5. It is a screen – type mesh supported by a round metal frame used for sifting dry ingredients like starch and flour. A. Colander C. Sieve B. Funnel D. Skimmer 6. It is a device with loops of stainless steel wire fastened to a handle. It is used for blending, mixing, whipping eggs or batter, and for blending gravies, sauces, and soups. A. Fork C. Spoon B. Knife D. Whisk 7. It is a miniature Bain Marie with an upper dish containing indentations each sized to hold an egg or contains separate device for poaching. A. Egg Poacher C. Frying pan B. Double boiler D. Omelet pan 8. It is a chamber or compartment used for cooking, baking, heating, or drying. A. Blender C. Mixer B. Burner D. Oven
  • 137. LM-Cookery Grade 10 137 9. It is the process of washing and sanitizing dishes, glassware, flatware, pots, and pans either manually or mechanically. A. Bleaching C. Ware washing B. Hand washing D. Washing machine 10.A dishwashing machine capable of washing, rinsing, and drying dishes, flatware, and glassware. A. Hand washing C. Mechanical ware washing B. Manual ware washing D. Washing machine 11.It is the egg‘s outer covering which accounts for about 9 to 12 % of its total weight depending on egg size. A. Chalaza C. Shell B. Germinal disc D. Yolk 12.This is the entrance of the latebra, the channel leading to the center of the yolk. A. Chalaza C. Shell B. Germinal disc D. Yolk 13.It is the yellow to yellow - orange portion which makes up to about 33% of the liquid weight of the egg. A. Chalaza C. Shell B. Germinal disc D. Yolk 14.A disease that is carried and transmitted to people by food is referred to as food borne . A. Bacteria C. Infection B. Illness D. Intoxication 15.It is a disease that results from eating food containing harmful micro- organism. A. Food-borne bacteria C. Food-borne infection B. Food-borne illness D. Food-borne intoxication 16.It is a disease that results from eating food containing toxins from bacteria, molds or certain plants or animals. A. Food-borne bacteria C. Food-borne infection B. Food-borne illness D. Food-borne intoxication 17. It is used for mixing creams, butter and for tossing salads. A. Electric mixer C. Wire whisk B. Serving spoon D. Wooden spoon 18.It is used for preparing meat, chicken, and other grains or legumes, such as mongo and white beans in lesser time. A. Double boiler C. pressure cooker B. Frying pan D. rice cooker
  • 138. LM-Cookery Grade 10 138 19.It is a long chainlike molecule, sometimes called the linear fraction, and is produced by linking together 500 to 2, 000 glucose molecules which contributes to the gelling characteristics of cooked and cooled starch mixtures. A. Amylopectin C. Dextrin B. Amylose D. mucin 20.This problem is usually encountered when using acid or acid ingredients such as lemon or vinegar. A. Scorching C. Thinning of gel. B. Skin formation D. Weak gelling 21. This results when there is too much liquid in relation to the starch. A. Scorching C. Thinning of gel. B. Skin formation D.Weak gelling 22.This problem can be reduced by covering the container of the starch gel with a waterproof cover. A. Scorching C. Thinning of gel. B. Skin formation D. Weak gelling 23.This can be avoided by temperature control and constant stirring so the starch granules do not settle at the bottom of the cooking pan. A. Scorching C. Thinning of Gel. B. Skin formation D.Weak gelling 24.Food stuff has a required shelf life and storing requirement. Which of the following food item can be stored in the refrigerator for 2 or 3 days? A.Cooked pasta C. Fresh pasta B.Dried pasta D. Frozen pasta 25. FIFO stands for A. Fan In Fan On C. First In First Out B. First In Fight Out D. Fit In Fit Out
  • 139. LM-Cookery Grade 10 139 B. Give one risk in the preparation and cooking of starch, cereal dishes and other foods and give some guidelines pertaining to food safety. (26-30) Your answer will be rated using the scoring rubric below: SCORE CRITERIA 4 Explains very clearly the complete guidelines to consider pertaining to food safety related to the given risk. 3 Explains clearly the complete guidelines to consider pertaining to food safety related to the given risk. 2 Explains partially the guidelines to consider pertaining to food safety related to the given risk. 1 Was not able to explain any guidelines to consider pertaining to food safety related to the given risk.
  • 140. LM-Cookery Grade 10 140 QUARTER II PREPARE VEGETABLE AND SEAFOOD DISHES Overview This quarter will guide you, learners to acquire the essential knowledge and competencies and develop your skills with understanding in the preparation, cooking, presentation, and storing vegetables and seafood dishes. Products/performances required in every activity will help you to practice gained understanding. Objectives At the end of the lesson, you are expected to: 1. perform Mise‘en place; 2. prepare and cook vegetable and seafood dishes; 3. present vegetable and seafood dishes; and 4. store vegetable and seafood dishes. Let’s See What You Know Pretest 2 Multiple Choice. Directions: Read the following questions carefully and choose the letter that best describes the statement. Write your answer in your test notebook. 1. Which of the following vegetables is rich in carbohydrates? A. legumes, peas, and beans C. Mushroom, tomatoes, and radish B. Nuts, olives, and avocado D. Seeds, roots, and tubers 2. What is the flavor component of vegetables which gives strong flavor and odor to some vegetables like onions, leeks, garlic, chives, cabbage, and broccoli? A. Flavonoids C. Sugar C. Glutamic acid D. Sulfur compounds
  • 141. LM-Cookery Grade 10 141 3. Which tool is used to drain excess water after washing vegetables? A. Bowls C. Steamer B. Colander D. Utility tray 4. Which of the following is cooking by placing blanched or raw vegetables in the pan, adding liquid (stock, water, wine) then covering and cooking it slowly? A. Boiling C. Braising B. Baking D. Sautéing 5. Which fat soluble compound is responsible for the green coloring of plants? A. Anthocyanins C. Chlorophyll B. Carotenoids D. Lycopene 6. Mrs. Cabrillas needs more supply of Vitamin A. which of the following will she eat to give her the nutrient she needs? A. Alugbati C. Lettuce B. Potatoes D. Saluyot 7. Which of the following plating styles is not a classic arrangement? A. The starch or vegetable item is heaped in the center while the main item is sliced and leaned up against it. B. The main item in the center, with vegetable distributed around it. C. The vegetable item in front and main item, starch item and garnish at the rear. D. The main item is in the center with neat piles of vegetables carefully arranged around. 8. Chef Shaneshan will cook chopsuey. She is about to remove the hard core of a cabbage. Which of the following knife will she use? A. Butcher knife C. Cutting knife B. Channel knife D. Paring knife 9. What kind of knife is used in removing the hard core of a cabbage? A. Butcher knife C. Cutting knife B. Channel knife D. Paring knife 10. At what temperature in a dry, dark place should potatoes and onions be stored? A. 50 – 650F C. 60 – 850F B. 40 – 450F D. 70 – 950F 11. Which of the following vegetables is cooked uncovered? A. Fruit vegetables C. Roots and tubers B. Green vegetables D. Yellow vegetables 12. Which kind of fish has no internal bone structure? A. Fin fish C. Round fish B. Freshwater fish D. Shell fish
  • 142. LM-Cookery Grade 10 142 13. Which of the following fish is high in fat? A. Bass C. Mackerel B. Cod D. Red Snapper 14. Which of the following fish is low in fat? A. Cod C. Trout B. Salmon D. Tuna 15. Which market form of fish is viscera, head, tail and fins are removed? A. Butterfly C. Fillet B. Dressed D. Sticks 16. Which of the following is a freshwater fish? A. Bluefish C. Grouper B. Cat fish D. Sole 17. Which market form of fish are both sides of a fish still joined but bones are removed? A. Butterfly C. Fillet B. Drawn D. Steak 18. Which of the following is the second step in scaling whole fish? A. Begin to rake the scales from the tail towards the head. B. Remove the scales on both sides of the fish. C. Hold the fish down firmly with your hand near its head. D. Lay your fish flat on the board. 19. Which of the following is the third step in opening an oyster? A. Cut muscle from bottom cup. B. Insert oyster knife at hinge slowly but firmly C. Push knife into oyster and slice muscle from top shell D. Twist knife handle to open the oyster. 20. Which of the following is a characteristic of a fresh fish? A. With fresh and foul odor B. Eyes are dull, shiny and bulging C. Gills are pink or red D. Flesh shrink when pressed 21. How many colors is suggested on a plate to make it balance? A. Four to five C. Three to four B. One to two D. Two to three 22. Which of the following seafood is cooked just enough to heat to keep it juicy and plump? A. Fat fish C. Flat fish B. Lean fish D. Shellfish 23. Which of the following enhances baked fish when served? A. Butter C. Lemon B. Cream D. Sauce
  • 143. LM-Cookery Grade 10 143 24. What cooking method is suited to fat fish. A. Baking C. Deep -frying B. Boiling D. Sautéing 25. Which is basted to baked lean fish to help prevent it from drying up. A. Butter C. Soy sauce B. Cream D. Tomato sauce B. Give five characteristics of a fresh fish. 26. 27. 28. 29. 30.
  • 144. LM-Cookery Grade 10 144 Overview Vegetables are plants or parts of plants like leaves, fruits, tubers, roots, bulbs, stems, shoots, and flower used in a dish either raw or cooked. Vegetables give color, texture and flavor to our meals. They also give vitamins and minerals. Vegetables provide nutrients vital for health and maintenance of your body. Eating vegetables provides health benefits to people like reduced risk of some chronic diseases including heart attack and stroke, protect them against certain types of cancers, reduce obesity and type two diabetes, lower blood pressures, reduce the risk of developing kidney stones and help decrease bone loss. Vegetables are important sources of many nutrients, including potassium, dietary fiber, folate (folic acid), vitamin A, and vitamin C.  Diets rich in potassium may help maintain normal blood pressure. Vegetable sources of potassium include sweet potatoes, white potatoes, white beans, tomato products (paste, sauce, and juice), beet greens, soybeans, lima beans, spinach, lentils, and kidney beans.  Dietary fiber from vegetables, as part of an overall healthy diet, helps reduce blood cholesterol levels and may lower risk of heart disease. Fiber is important for proper bowel function. It helps reduce constipation and diverticulosis. Fiber-containing foods such as vegetables help provide a feeling of fullness with fewer calories.  Folate (folic acid) helps the body form red blood cells. Women of childbearing age who may become pregnant should consume adequate folate from foods, and in addition, 400 mcg of synthetic folic acid from fortified foods or supplements. This reduces the risk of neural tube defects, spinal bifida, and anencephaly during fetal development.  Vitamin A keeps eyes and skin healthy and helps to protect against infections.  Vitamin C helps heal cuts and wounds, and keeps teeth and gums healthy. Vitamin C aids in iron absorption. LESSON 1 PREPARE VEGETABLE DISHES
  • 145. LM-Cookery Grade 10 145 Learning Outcome 1 Perform Mise’ En Place Vegetables need to be prepared before they are ready to serve or used as an ingredient in a cooked dish. Prior to preparation you need to identify the various kinds of vegetables and different tools and equipment needed in the preparation of vegetables. It is an important factor to consider in the preparation of vegetables. Classifications of Vegetables a. According to parts of plants  Gourd family - cucumber, pumpkin, chayote  Seeds and pods - beans, peas, corn, okra 1. Fruit Vegetables - avocado, eggplant, sweet pepper, tomato    
  • 146. LM-Cookery Grade 10 146  Roots and tubers - beet, carrot, radish, turnip, artichoke, potato, sweet potato  Cabbage family - cabbage, broccoli, cauliflower, Brussels sprouts, bokchoy  Onion family - onion, scallion, leek, garlic, shallot  Leafy greens - spinach, lettuce
  • 147. LM-Cookery Grade 10 147  Stalks, stems, and shoots - artichoke, asparagus, celery, fennel, bamboo, shoots  Mushrooms 2. According to Chemical Composition  Carbohydrates-rich vegetables – seeds, roots, tubers  Protein-rich vegetables –legumes, peas, beans  Fat-rich vegetables – nuts, olives, avocado  High moisture content – mushroom, tomatoes, radish, green leafy vegetables 3. According to Nutritive Value The following is based on their nutrient content since fruits and vegetables are good sources of vitamins and minerals.  Vitamin A-rich vegetables – green leafy and yellow fruits and vegetables  Vitamin C-rich vegetables – yellow vegetables  Vitamin B (complex) – legumes, peas, beans
  • 148. LM-Cookery Grade 10 148 Tools and Equipment Needed in Preparing Vegetables paring knife - used in paring chef knife - used in cutting chopping board -- used to hold item while chopping colander - used to drain excess water after washing bowls - used to hold vegetables
  • 149. LM-Cookery Grade 10 149 utility tray - used to hold ingredients sauté pan - for sautéing or stir frying vegetables steamer - for steaming vegetables oven - for cooking vegetables oven- steam or bake Flavor Components of Vegetables 1. Sugar – Fructose – the natural sugar that provides the sweetness in vegetables. 2. Glutamic Acid – This forms a product called monosodium glutamate when combined with salt. It is found in large amount from young and fresh vegetables.
  • 150. LM-Cookery Grade 10 150 3. Sulfur compounds – Give the characteristic strong flavor and odor of some vegetables like onions, leeks, garlic, chives, cabbage and broccoli. Color Components 1. Chlorophyll – a fat soluble compound responsible for the green color of plants. When combined with acid, it forms pheophytin which produces an olive green color. When combine with alkali, it forms chlorophyllins which produces a more intense green color. The addition of baking soda when cooking that results to brighter green color, is an example. 2. Carotenoids – the yellow, orange to red soluble pigments found in plants. 2.1 - beta carotene from carrots and squash 2.2 - lycopene, from tomatoes 3. Flavonoids 3.1 - Anthoxanthin – responsible for the yellow pigments 3.2 - Anthocyanins – responsible for red and blue to violet pigments (beets) Tube, eggplants
  • 151. LM-Cookery Grade 10 151 Factors to consider in choosing good quality vegetables 1. Freshness Fresh vegetables should be crisp and bright in colors. 2. Absence of decay or insect infestation 3. No mechanical damage or injury. 4. Right degree of maturity 5. Variety Different varieties differ in color, shape, texture and sometimes flavor.
  • 152. LM-Cookery Grade 10 152 Vegetables are good sources of food nutrients that are very important in everyday meals. Nutritional Value of Vegetables 1. Vitamin A -Green leafy vegetables are sources of vitamin A. Example: alugbati ampalaya leaves kalabasa leaves malunggay petchay sili leaves 2. Vitamin C Example: cabbage – type vegetables bell peppers lettuce potatoes dark green and yellow vegetables 3. Vitamin B – complex Beans and leafy greens are rich sources of vitamin B – complex Example: ampalaya tops kulitis pepper leaves saluyot dried beans
  • 153. LM-Cookery Grade 10 153 4. Complex carbohydrates Complex carbohydrates are carbohydrate molecules with more than 20 – sugar residue. They are called as polysaccharide. Functions of Carbohydrate: 1. Source of energy ( protein sparing and prevents ketosis) 2. Source of B-vitamins for CHO metabolism 3. Type of carbohydrate chosen determines:  Fiber content  Glycemic load of diet  Nutrient density and phytochemical content Example: wheat bran whole grain breads and cereals cabbage carrots Brussels sprouts Preparing Fresh Vegetables 1. Washing  Wash all vegetables thoroughly  Scrub well unpeeled vegetables, like potatoes for baking  Wash green leafy vegetables in several changes of cold water  After washing, drain well and refrigerate lightly covered to prevent drying.
  • 154. LM-Cookery Grade 10 154 2. Soaking  Do not soak vegetables for long periods to prevent flavor and nutrient loss.  Cabbage, broccoli, cauliflower may be soaked for 30 minutes in cold salted water to eliminate insects.  Limp vegetables can be soaked briefly in cold water to restore crispness. 3. Peeling and Cutting  Peel vegetables as thinly as possible.  Cut vegetables into uniform pieces for even cooking  Treat vegetables that brown easily with acid (potatoes, eggplants, sweet potato) or hold under water until ready to use.  Save edible trim for soups, stocks and purees. Basic Knife Cuts 1. Chopping – done with a straight, downward cutting motion. 2. Chiffonade (shredding) – making very fine parallel cuts. 3. Dicing – producing cube shapes Diamond (lozenge) – thinly slicing and cutting into strips of appropriate width 5. Mincing – producing very fine cut usually for onions and garlic 6. Julienne and baton net – making long rectangular cut Pays Anne (Fermi ere) – making curved or uneven cuts of the same thickness 8. Rondelle – making cylindrical cut 9. Bias –making diagonal cut 10.Oblique, or roll cuts – making diagonal cut by rolling the long cylindrical vegetables Apply safe and accurate cutting techniques in preparing vegetables according to enterprise standards.
  • 155. LM-Cookery Grade 10 155 A. Trimming Artichoke bottom 1. Start by filling a bowl with cold water and lemon into it. (You could also use a dash of vinegar) this will slow the browning on the surface of the artichoke when it is cut and exposed to air. 2. Pull out the tough outer, dark green leaves of artichoke. 3. Continue removing leaves until you are left with light colored, tender leaves. Rub surfaces with lemon. 4. Slice off the top one inch. 5. Trim the remaining dark green surfaces at the base, including stalk and continue to rub with lemon. 6.
  • 156. LM-Cookery Grade 10 156 6. Cut the artichoke in half. 7. Use spoon to remove hairy fibers in the center of the artichoke. 8. Pull out all of the tough red fibers, leaving the soft green leaves in place. 9. Cut the artichokes lengthwise into sizes that suit your recipe and place it in the water bath with lemon before cooking.
  • 157. LM-Cookery Grade 10 157 B. Trimming Asparagus 1. Hold a spear of asparagus in each hand. 2. Bend downward with each end until it breaks into two. 3. Repeat with the whole bunch of asparagus. Purplish ends on the left are destined for stock, and greenish spears to be trimmed. 4. Trim or cut them into one inch length for cooking.
  • 158. LM-Cookery Grade 10 158 C. Preparing Avocados 1. Grip the avocado gently on one side with one hand, cut the avocado lengthwise around the seed. 2. Open the avocado into halves to expose the seed. 3. Scoop out the seed with the use of spoon or scooper. 4. Gently tap the seed with a knife and twist to get the seed out and discard. 5. Scoop out the avocado flesh with a spoon or scooper.
  • 159. LM-Cookery Grade 10 159 6. Slice avocado into segments. D. Cutting and Shredding Cabbage 1. Pull off any bruised or wilted outer leaves from a red or green cabbage head. 2. Cut the cabbage into halves. 3. Cut the halves into quarters lying flat side down on the cutting board.
  • 160. LM-Cookery Grade 10 160 4. Use a paring knife to remove the hard core. Repeat with remaining cabbage quarters. 5. Cut into slices or shred the cabbage to your desired thickness. E. Peeling and crushing garlic 1. To remove the paper skin of garlic, cut off the base of the clove. 2. Place the clove on a board and gently slam it with flat side of a knife.
  • 161. LM-Cookery Grade 10 161 3. The skin will burst and can easily be removed. 4. Cut the garlic into slices as thin as possible. 5. From garlic slices, mince it. 4. Crush the garlic as you want.
  • 162. LM-Cookery Grade 10 162 F. Cleaning leeks 1. Cut off and discard the dark green leaves. Trim and discard the roots. 2. Cut the stalk into half lengthwise. 3. Slice them crosswise. 4. Transfer them to a bowl of cold water and swish them around a few times.
  • 163. LM-Cookery Grade 10 163 5. With hands loosely cupped, lift the leeks out of the bowl and place them on a plate or work surface (or colander). 6. Discard the water with the remaining grit. 7. Repeat until the water is clear and ready to be cooked. Review of Learning Outcome 1 Formative Assessment Directions: Identify and classify the given pictures. Write your answer in the appropriate column. Name Classification 1. 2.
  • 165. LM-Cookery Grade 10 165 B. Directions: Identify the different methods of preparing fresh vegetables. Write the correct method on the space provided. 7. 6. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
  • 166. LM-Cookery Grade 10 166 Learning Outcome 2 Prepare Vegetable Dishes Effects of Cooking Vegetables 1. Changes in texture - Fibers are either softened or toughened. A. Cellulose and hemicellulose – heating generally softens fibers B. Addition of acid toughen fibers C. Addition of alkali like baking soda soften hemicellulose D.Addition of lime causes firmness or delay softening due to the reaction of calcium from lime (―apog‖) 2. Water is either lost or absorbed. A. Vegetables contain high amount of water, leafy and succulent vegetables lose water and become limp. B. Vegetables with significant amount of starch (dried beans, root crops, tubers) absorb water because of the hygroscopic property of starch. 3. Changes in color Cooking for a short time, helps maintain color. The effect of heat, acid, alkali, and metal on the pigment are summarized below: Table 1. Effect of Acid, Alkali, and Prolonged Cooking Pigment Effect of acid Effect of alkali Effect of prolonged cooking Solubility in water Chlorophyll Olive green Intensifies green color Olive green Slightly Soluble Carotene Little effect Little effect Little effect unless excessive way darkens Slightly Soluble Anthocyanin Color is stable Deeper red purple or blue depending on alkalinity Little effect Very soluble Anthoxanthins No effect Yellow Darken if excessive in the presence of iron Very soluble
  • 167. LM-Cookery Grade 10 167 4. Changes in nutrients A. Carbohydrate - moist heat cooking – gelatinization of starch - dry heat cooking – dextrinization of starch - carmelization of sugar B. Protein become more soluble and digestible C. Vitamin may be destroyed in heat like vitamin C D. Minerals are washed into the cooking liquid or oxidized General Rules of Vegetable Cookery  Don‘t overcook.  Prepare vegetable as close to service time as possible and in small quantities.  If the vegetable must be cooked ahead, undercook slightly and chill rapidly. Reheat at service time.  Never use baking soda with green vegetables.  Cut vegetables uniformly for even cooking.  Cook green vegetables and strong – flavored vegetables uncovered. Standard Quality of Cooked Vegetables 1. Color Bright, natural color 2. Appearance on plate Cut neatly and uniformly Attractively arranged with appropriate combinations and garnishes 3. Texture Cooked to the right degree of doneness Crisp – tender, not overcooked and mushy Potatoes, squash, sweet potatoes, tomatoes should be cooked through with smooth texture 4. Flavor Natural flavor and sweetness Strong – flavored vegetables should be pleasantly mild, with no off flavors or bitterness
  • 168. LM-Cookery Grade 10 168 5. Seasonings Seasonings should not mask the natural flavors 6. Sauces Do not use heavily. Vegetable should not be greasy 7. Vegetable combinations Vegetables should be cooked separately for different cooking times, and then combined Combine acid vegetables like tomatoes, to green vegetables just before service to prevent discoloration of greens. Cooking Frozen and Canned Vegetables A.) Frozen Vegetables  Examine all frozen products when received to check quality.  Frozen vegetable requires shorter time in cooking because they have been partially cooked.  Cook from the frozen state. Can cook directly into steamer or boiling salted water.  Corn on the cob and vegetables that freeze in solid block like squash, should be thawed for even cooking.  Add less salt. Most frozen vegetables are slightly salted during processing.
  • 169. LM-Cookery Grade 10 169 B.) Canned Vegetables  Drain vegetables and place half the liquid in a cooking pot, and bring to boil.  Add vegetables and heat to serving time. Do not boil for a long time.  Season liquid before adding vegetables to blend flavors of herbs and spices.  Use butter to enhance the flavor of most vegetables. Frozen vegetables Canned vegetables 1. Examine all frozen products when received to check quality 1. Drain vegetables and place half the liquid in a cooking pot, and bring to boil. 2. Frozen vegetable requires shorter time in cooking because they have been partially cooked 2. Add vegetables and heat to serving time. Do not boil for a long time 3. Cook from the frozen state. Can be cooked directly into steamer or boiling salted water. 3. Season liquid before adding vegetables to blend flavors of herbs and spices. 4. Corn on the cob and vegetables frozen in solid block like squash, should be thawed for even cooking 4. Use butter to enhance the flavor of most vegetables 5. Add less salt. Most frozen vegetables are slightly salted during processing
  • 170. LM-Cookery Grade 10 170 Culinary Terms of Vegetables Assortments of fresh vegetables like carrots, turnips, peas, pearl onions, green beans, cauliflower, asparagus and artichokes. Bouquet ere – bouquet of vegetables Printaniere – spring vegetables Jardinière – garden vegetables Primeurs – first spring vegetables Clamart – peas Ceecy – carrots Doria – cucumbers cooked in butter Dubarry – cauliflower Fermiere – carrots, turnips, onions, celery cut into uniform slices Florentine – spinach Forestiere – mushrooms Judic – braised lettuce Lyonnaise – onions Nicoise – tomatoes concasse cooked with garlic Parmientier – potatoes Princesse – asparagus Provençale – tomatoes with garlic, parsley and sometimes mushrooms or olives Directions: Make a compilation of technical words commonly used in the world of culinary for vegetable cookery. Follow concrete instructions below:  Make a personalized and improvised dictionary (half folded bond paper).  Include local and foreign terminologies which are used in vegetable cookery.  Limit your dictionary to a minimum of 10 pages and a maximum of 20 pages.  Bind and cover it.  You can work in collaboration with others and submit after 1 week.
  • 171. LM-Cookery Grade 10 171 Your output will be rated using the scoring rubric below. SCORE CRITERIA 5 Done creatively and neatly with more than twenty pages 4 Done creatively and neat enough with 15 to 20 pages 3 Done creatively and neat enough but with10 to 14 pages 2 Done simply and neat enough but with 10 to 14 pages 1 Done poorly with less than 10 pages Ways of Cooking Vegetables 1. Boiling and steaming – Vegetables are drained as soon as they are cooked and then cool quickly under cold water to prevent overcooking from the residual heat. They are reheated quickly by sautéing in butter or other fat. Seasonings and sauces are added at this stage. 2. Sautéing and Pan – Frying Both methods may be used to complete cooking or precooked or blanched vegetables. Also used for complete cooking of raw vegetables. 3. Braising The blanched or raw vegetable, is placed in the pan then liquid is added (stock, water, wine) to cover vegetables, then cooked slowly.
  • 172. LM-Cookery Grade 10 172 4. Baking Cooking starchy vegetables using heat of the oven, rather than range top. Starchy vegetables are baked because the dry heat produces a desirable texture. 5. Deep – frying Vegetables large enough to coat with breading or batter may be fried. Quick – cooking vegetables can be fried raw. Some, may be precooked by simmering or steaming briefly to reduce the cooking time in frying. Directions: Find a partner and perform the different ways of cooking vegetables. Choose at least 2 from the given recipes. Boiling Vegetables Tools/Equipment Needed: Stove Pots and pan Chopping board Knife Strainer Ladle Ingredients: Vegetables (any kind) Water
  • 173. LM-Cookery Grade 10 173 Procedure: Boiling Vegetables 1. Trim, peel and cut vegetables as required. 2. Add required amount of water to the pot. 3. Add salt and bring to boil. 4. Place vegetables in the pot and return the water to a boil. 5. Reduce heat to a simmer and cook vegetable, to required doneness.  Green vegetables and strong flavored vegetables are cooked uncovered. 6. Drain vegetables quickly to avoid overcooking. Steaming Vegetables 1. Trim and cut vegetables as required. 2. Pre-heat the steamer. 3. Arrange vegetables in pan or baskets for cooking. Make a shallow, even layers for uniform cooking. 4. Steam for required time. 5. Remove vegetables from steamer. 6. Finish vegetables according to recipe and serve at once, or cool quickly. Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in boiling/steaming vegetables and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in boiling/steaming vegetables and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in boiling/steaming vegetables with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in boiling/steaming vegetables and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
  • 174. LM-Cookery Grade 10 174 Sautéing Vegetables Tools/Equipment Needed: Stove Pots and pan Ladle Strainer Spatula Ingredients: Vegetables (any kind) Procedure: Sautéing Vegetables 1. Prepare vegetables as required. 2. Place sauté pan on high heat. 3. When pot is hot, add small amount of clarified butter, oil or other fat enough to coat the bottom of the pan. 4. Add vegetables. Do not overload the pan, or the temperature will be lowered too much and the vegetables will simmer instead of sauté. 5. After the heat has recovered, flip the pan to toss vegetables. 6. Continue to flip as necessary. 7. As soon as vegetables are cooked, remove from pan and serve. Frying Vegetables 1. Prepare mise-en place. Use a griddle if only a small amount of fat is required. 2. Heat the pan and add fat, and let it heat. 3. Place prepared vegetables in the pan. Cook to desired degree of browning. 4. Turn vegetables with a spatula and continue to cook until done. 5. Remove from pan, and drain on absorbent paper to eliminate excess fat.
  • 175. LM-Cookery Grade 10 175 Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in sautéing/frying vegetables and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in sautéing/frying vegetables and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in sautéing/frying vegetables with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in sautéing/frying vegetables and performs the skill unsatisfactorily. Braising Vegetables Tools/Equipment Needed: Stove Pots and pan Strainer Ladle Ingredients: Vegetables Water or wine Procedure: 1. Heat pan, add fat. 2. Place vegetables in a pan. (Vegetables may or may not be cooked in fat before adding liquid) 3. Add liquid, stock, water or wine or combination of liquids. 4. Cover the pan and cook vegetables. 5. Remove from heat, and serve vegetables with the cooking liquid, or drained off the liquid and reduced over high heat before serving to concentrate flavor.
  • 176. LM-Cookery Grade 10 176 Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in braising vegetables and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in braising vegetables and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in braising vegetables with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in braising vegetables and performs the skill unsatisfactorily. Cooking Vegetables by Baking and Deep Frying Tools/Equipment Needed: Oven, Stove Fryer Pots and pan Baking pan Ingredients: Vegetables Breading Oil Procedure: Baking Vegetables 1. Collect all equipment and food products. 2. Prepare vegetables as required. 3. Place in appropriate pan and set in pre-heated oven. 4. Bake to desired doneness. Deep-Frying Vegetables 1. Collect all equipment and food products. 2. Pre-heat fryer to proper temperature (325°F - 350°F). 3. Prepare food items as required. Apply breading or batter if necessary. 4. Place proper amount of food in fryer. Do not overload. 5. Fry to desired doneness. 6. Remove from pan. Drain to remove excess fat.
  • 177. LM-Cookery Grade 10 177 7. Serve at once or if necessary, hold uncovered in a warm place for the shortest possible time. Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in baking/deep-frying vegetables and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in baking/deep-frying vegetables and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in baking/deep-frying vegetables with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in baking/deep-frying vegetables and performs the skill unsatisfactorily. Performance Activity 2 Directions: Given the different recipes, follow the procedures by pair or by group. Vegetable Tagliatelle Tools/Equipment Needed: Chopping board Knife Pots and pan Coriander Ladle
  • 178. LM-Cookery Grade 10 178 Ingredients: 450 grams zucchini, trimmed 450 grams. carrots, peeled and trimmed 450 grams. celery root, peeled 4tbsp. butter Procedure: 1. Cut vegetables lengthwise into thin slices. About 1/8 inches thick, cut into long thin strips to resemble flat noodles. 2. Blanch each vegetable separately into boiling salted water. Refresh under cold water and drain. 3. Just before serving, heat butter in saucepan over moderate heat. Add vegetables and toss in butter until hot. Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking vegetable tagliatelle and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking vegetable tagliatelle and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking vegetable tagliatelle with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking vegetable tagliatelle and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
  • 179. LM-Cookery Grade 10 179 Sautéed Mushroom Tools/Equipment Needed: Pan Ladle Plate Ingredients: 1 1/2kg mushrooms, fresh 10 tbsp. clarified butter or salt to taste pepper to taste Procedure: 1. Rinse the mushrooms quickly and dry them with towels. Trim off the bottom of the stems and slice the mushrooms. 2. Heat sauté pans over high heat. Add fat to the pan. 3. Place mushrooms in the pan. Do not overload. Sauté over high heat until browned. Do not overcook. 4. Season with salt and pepper.
  • 180. LM-Cookery Grade 10 180 Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking sautéed mushroom and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking sautéed mushroom and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking sautéed mushroom with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking sautéed mushroom and performs the skill unsatisfactorily. Braised Celery Tool/Equipment Needed: Chopping board Knife Pan Ladle Ingredients: 1 kg celery 4 tbsp butter 1 ½ pt. brown stock or chicken stock salt to taste pepper to taste
  • 181. LM-Cookery Grade 10 181 Procedure: 1. Trim and wash celery. Peel the outside part and use the tender inner stems. Cut into 1 ½ inches lengths. 2. Heat the butter in a braising pot and add the celery. Cook over moderate heat until the celery is just beginning to soften. 3. Add enough stock to cover the celery. Season with salt and pepper to taste. Cover and cook slowly in an oven or range top until tender. 4. Drain the celery and keep it warm. Reduce the stock over high heat. Adjust the seasonings and pour the sauce over the celery. Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking braised celery and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking braised celery and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking braised celery with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking braised celery and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
  • 182. LM-Cookery Grade 10 182 Glazed Sweet Potatoes Tools/Equipment Needed: Pan Ladle Knife Chopping board Baking pan Ingredients: 1.8 kg sweet potatoes 6 tbsp. water ¾ c light corn syrup or maple syrup 6 tbsp. brown sugar 8 tbsp. orange juice 2 tbsp. lemon juice 2 tbsp. butter ½ tsp cinnamon 1/8 t ground cloves ¼ t salt
  • 183. LM-Cookery Grade 10 183 Procedure: 1. Scrub sweet potatoes. Boil or steam until tender. Do not overcook. 2. Spread the potatoes on a sheet pan to cool. 3. Peel the potatoes when they are cool enough to handle. Cut into uniform pieces. Arrange in a buttered baking pan. 4. Place water, syrup and sugar in a saucepan. Stir over heat until sugar is dissolved. Add remaining ingredients and boil mixture to form heavy syrup. 5. Pour syrup over potatoes. 6. Bake at 350°F until potatoes are thoroughly cooked and glazed, about 45 – 60 minutes. Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking glazed sweet potatoes and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking glazed sweet potatoes and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing and cooking glazed sweet potatoes with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing and cooking glazed sweet potatoes and performs the skill unsatisfactorily. LumpiangUbod with Egg Wrapper Materials Needed: Wok colander Turner measuring spoon Knife measuring cups Chopping board casserole
  • 184. LM-Cookery Grade 10 184 Ingredients: ½ kl stripped ubod 1 kl stripped sweet potato ½ kl carrot ½ kl cabbage 2 stalk celery 2 cups ground peanut 1 head garlic 2pcs onion ½ kl ground pork 1/4kl shrimps 2T fish sauce 1pc pork bouillon Procedure: 1. Blanch the ubod first 2. Sauté the garlic and onion, put the ground pork and 2T fish sauce 3. Put sweet potato until tender 4. Put the ubod, carrots, cabbage and celery 5. Put the ground peanut 6. Season to taste Sauce: Ingredients: ½ kl sugar 1/4T fish sauce ½ cup ground peanut ¼ cup minced garlic 1 stalk chopped celery ¼ cup cornstarch mixed with ¼ cup water 1.5L water Procedure: 1. Caramelized sugar, put 1.5 liter of water and let it boil 2. Put the minced garlic, celery and peanut 3. Let it boil 4. Thickened with cornstarch dispensed in water
  • 185. LM-Cookery Grade 10 185 A. Directions: Make a research on various recipes of the following vegetables: a. MalunggayLeaves b. Bell Pepper c. Sayote E. Directions: Make a research on the different ways of cooking vegetables in the Philippines and other countries. Follow the instructions below:  Group yourselves into 5 groups  Assign a leader.  Leaders will assign task to each member.  Work on your research following the assigned country a. Group I - Asian Countries b. Group II - European Countries c. Group III - American Countries d. Group IV - African Countries e. Group V - Ethnic ways of cooking in the Philippines. Learning Outcome 3 Present Vegetable Dishes  Presentation of prepared vegetable dishes  Factors to consider in plating vegetable dishes Essential Factors of Food Presentation 1. Good preparation and cooking techniques – Proper cutting and cooking of vegetables 2. Professional Skills Ability to perform according to required standards 3. Visual Sense Effective food presentation depends on the understanding of techniques involving balance, arrangement, and garniture.  Balance
  • 186. LM-Cookery Grade 10 186 Select foods and garnishes that offer variety and contrast. This should be applied to colors, shapes, textures and flavors.  Portion size  Match portion sizes and plates  Balance the portion sizes of the items on the plate  Arrangement on the plate Many chefs display their creativity in plating presentations. One important thing is, to keep in mind the convenience and comfort of the diner when plating. Plating Styles with Vegetable Dishes Classic arrangement: 1. Main item in front, vegetables, starch items and garnish at the rear. 2. Main item in the center, with vegetable distributed around it. 3. Main item in the center with neat piles of vegetables carefully arranged around.
  • 187. LM-Cookery Grade 10 187 4. A starch or vegetable item heaped in the center, the main item sliced and leaning up against it. Guidelines in Plating 1. Keep food off the rim of the plate. Select a plate large enough to hold food without hanging off the edge. 2. Arrange the items for the convenience of the customer. Always arrange the best side of food on plate to avoid letting the diner rearrange them before eating. 3. Keep space between items, unless, they are stacked on one another. Arrange vegetable on plate, that every item should be identifiable. 4. Maintain unity. Create a center of attention and relate everything to it. 5. Make every component count. Garnishes are not added just for color, but sometimes they are needed to balance a plate by providing an additional element.
  • 188. LM-Cookery Grade 10 188 6. Add sauce or gravy attractively on plate. Pour sauce around or under the dish or covering only a part of the dish. Always think of the sauce as part of the overall design of the plate. 7. Keep it simple. Avoid making food too elaborate. Creative Presentation Techniques  Vegetable Purees  Ribbon Vegetables  Vegetable Rings 1. Cook vegetable until soft, then drain well. 2.In food processor, process vegetable to smooth puree. 3. Add melted butter or margarine. 4. Season with salt and pepper and process again. 5. Add whipping cream. 6.Using ice-cream scoop or spoon, shape puree on heatproof plate and place in oven or microwave until hot. 1. With vegetable peeler, shred carrot, corvette and radish into long ribbons, about 2.5 cm. wide, pressing lightly with peeler so ribbons will be very thin. 2.Toss vegetables with melted butter or margarine. 3. Cook until tender – crisp. 1. With sharp knife, cut 3 peppers, (green, yellow, red) and onion into rings. 2. Remove core, seeds and membranes from peppers. 3. Toss vegetables with melted butter or margarine. 4. Cook until tender – crisp. 5. Serve hot or refrigerate to serve chilled.
  • 189. LM-Cookery Grade 10 189 Photo Collection Directions: Follow instructions below: 1. Make a photo album on the creative presentation techniques for vegetable cookery. 2. It should contain a minimum of 10 pages and a maximum of 15 pages. 3. Label each creative presentation. 4. Your output will be rated using the scoring rubric below: SCORE CRITERIA 5 Done creatively and neatly showing much relevance to the given task 4 Done creatively and neat enough with relevance to the given task 3 Done creatively and neat enough but no relevance to the given task 2 Done simply and neat enough but not so relevant to the given task 1 Done poorly with erasures and irrelevant to the given task
  • 190. LM-Cookery Grade 10 190 Directions: Prepare and present creatively a Stir Fried Mixed Vegetables applying your own presentation design. Follow the procedures and ingredients given. Stir Fried Mixed Vegetables Tools/Equipment Needed: Pan Mixing Bowl Ladle Chopping Board Knife Plate for serving Ingredients: 350 g Chinese cabbage, cut into chunks 8 dried black mushrooms, cut julienne 4tbsp. carrots, cut julienne 4tbsp baby corn, drained 4 scallions, cut into shreds 4tbsp oil 1 garlic cloves, crushed 2 slices ginger root ½ t salt 12tbsp water or chicken stock 1/8 c cornstarch 12tbsp water, cold ½ t sesame oil
  • 191. LM-Cookery Grade 10 191 Procedure: 1. Heat oil in a wok. 2. Add garlic. 3. Add ginger and salt. 4. Add cabbage and stir fry. 5. Add the remaining vegetables except shredded cabbage. Continue to stir fry for 1 -2 minutes, then add shredded cabbage. 6. Add the stock, soy sauce, and cook until vegetables are crispy. 7. Mix cornstarch with cold water, then stir into vegetables to thicken the sauce. 8. Stir the sesame oil and serve at once. Your performance will be rated using the scoring rubric below: 4 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing, cooking and presenting stir fried vegetables and performs the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing, cooking and presenting stir fried vegetables and performs the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Follows correctly the procedures in preparing, cooking and presenting stir fried vegetables with minor errors and performs the skill satisfactorily with some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Was not able to follow the procedures in preparing, cooking and presenting stir fried vegetables and performs the skill unsatisfactorily.
  • 192. LM-Cookery Grade 10 192 Learning Outcome 4 Store Vegetable Dishes Fresh Vegetables 1. Potatoes and onions are stored at cool temperature. (50 -65°F) in a dry, dark place. 2. Other vegetables must be refrigerated. To prevent drying they should be kept covered or wrapped. 3. Peeled and cut vegetables should be covered or wrapped, and use quickly to prevent spoilage. 4. Potatoes, eggplants and other vegetables that brown when cut should be treated with an acid or blanched them to inactivate the enzyme that cause browning. Raw, cut potatoes are held in cold water for a short time. 5. Store all fresh vegetables for a short time. Frozen Vegetables 1. Store at 0°F (-18°C). or colder in original container until ready for use. 2. Do not refreeze thawed vegetables. Dried Vegetables 1. Store in a cool (less than 75°F) dry, well ventilated place. 2. Keep well sealed and off the floor. Canned Vegetables 1. Keep in a cool dry place, away from sunlight and off the floor. 2. Discard cans that show signs of damage (swollen, badly dented rusted cans).
  • 193. LM-Cookery Grade 10 193 Leftovers 1. Don‘t mix batches. 2. Store leftover creamed vegetables for one day only. Before storing, cool rapidly by placing the container on ice.
  • 194. LM-Cookery Grade 10 194 Overview Seafood is any form of sea life regarded as food by humans. Seafood includes fish and shellfish. Shellfish include various species of mollusks, crustaceans, and echinoderms. A wide variety of fish and seafood are available in the market from many different sources. There are so many methods for cooking seafood, most of them are fast and easy, making them the perfect choice for a quick and healthy meal. This lesson provides information about fish and shellfish, ways on preparing and cooking fish, along with some of the most popular seafood recipes, and presenting and storing seafood. Learning Outcome 1 Perform Mise’ En Place You are about to learn the following from this lesson:  Tools and equipment needed  Types of seafood-shellfish, fin fish, others  Variety of fish-structure, body shape, market forms, fat contents, water source, processed fish, others  Market forms of fish and fish products  Fish cuts  Composition and nutritive value of fish (scaling, cutting of tails and fins, Eviscerating, cleansing, canning) LESSON 2 PREPARE AND COOK SEAFOOD DISHES
  • 195. LM-Cookery Grade 10 195 Classifications of Seafood Fish products are divided into two categories 1. Fin fish – fish with fins and internal skeletons A. Saltwater fish –  Flatfish  Flounder  Sole  Round fish  Black sea bars  Bluefish  Cod  Grouper B. Freshwater fish  Cat fish  Eel  Tilapia 2. Shell fish – fish with external shells but no internal bone structure. They have hard outer shells. Two classifications of Shellfish A. Mollusks – are soft sea animals  Bivalves – they have a pair of hinged shells (clams, oysters)  Univalves – they have a single shell (abalone)  Cephalopods – (octopus, squid) B. Crustaceans – are animals with segmented shells and jointed legs (shrimps, crabs)
  • 196. LM-Cookery Grade 10 196 Parts of a Fish Composition and Structure: Fish consists of water, protein, fats and small amount of minerals and vitamins. Fish has very little connective tissue. It means: 1. Fish cooks very quickly, even at low heat. 2. Fish is naturally tender. High heat will result to toughening of protein. 3. Moist-heat methods are used not to create tenderness but to preserve moistness and provide variety. 4. Cooked fish must be handled very carefully. 1. Fat Fish -- are those that are high in fat. (salmon, tuna, trout, mackerel) 2. Lean Fish – are those that are low in fat. (sole, cod, red snapper, bass)
  • 197. LM-Cookery Grade 10 197 Market Forms 1. Whole or round – completely intact, as caught 2. Drawn – viscera removed 3. Dressed -- viscera, scales, head, tail and fins removed 4. Steaks – cross-section slices, each containing a section of backbone 5. Fillets – boneless side of fish, with or without skin 6. Butterflied fillets – both sides of a fish still joined, but with bones removed
  • 198. LM-Cookery Grade 10 198 7. Sticks or tranches – cross-section slices of fillets Characteristics and Market forms of Shellfish Shellfish Characteristics Mollusks  Oysters have rough, irregular shells.  Flesh of oyster is extremely soft and delicate and contains high percentage of water.  Hard-shell clams – can be eaten raw  Soft-shell clams are called steamers. The usual way to cook is to steam.  The shells of mussels are not as heavy as clamshells, yellow to orange in color and firm but tender when cooked.  Scallops are creamy white in color and have a sweet flavor.  Squid is somewhat chewy and are cut up or either fried quickly. Crustaceans  The lobster shell is dark green or bluish green but turns red when cooked.  Live lobster must be alive when cooked. Market Forms Mollusks 1. live in the shell 2. shucked – fresh or frozen 3. canned
  • 199. LM-Cookery Grade 10 199 Crustaceans 1. live 2. cooked meat, fresh or frozen Review of Learning Outcome 1 Directions: Identify the market forms of fish. Write your answer in your test notebook. 1. 2.
  • 201. LM-Cookery Grade 10 201 Learning Outcome 2 Handle Seafood Dishes Fin Fish Checking freshness of fish 1. Fresh and mild odor 2. Eyes are clear, shiny and bulging 3. Red or pink gills 4. Texture of flesh is firm or elastic 5. Shiny scales, and tightly cling, on skin
  • 202. LM-Cookery Grade 10 202 Shellfish 1. Oysters, clams, mussels in the shell must be alive. Tightly closed shells when jostled. 2. Live or shucked oysters must have a very mild, sweet smell. 3. Discard any mussels that are very light in weight or seem to be hollow. 4. Strong fishy odor or a brownish color is a sign of age or spoilage. 5. Live lobster must be alive when cooked. The meat will be firm and the tail springs back when straightened. 6. Frozen shrimp should be solidly frozen when received. 7. Glazed shrimp should be shiny with no freezer burn. 8. All shrimps should smell fresh and sweet. A strong fishy or iodine smell indicates age or spoilage. 9. Live crabs should be kept alive until cooked. 10. Frozen crabmeat should be treated like any other frozen fish.
  • 203. LM-Cookery Grade 10 203 Handling and Storage of Fish Fresh Fish 1. Store on crushed ice. Use drip pans to allow for drainage of melted ice. Change ice daily. Cover container or store in separate box away from other foods. Whole fish should be drawn because entrails deteriorate rapidly. Cut fish should be wrapped or left in original moisture- proof wrap. 2. In refrigerated box at 30° to 34°F (-1° to 1°C. 3. Fresh fish may be stored for 1 to 2 days. If kept longer, wrap and freeze immediately. 4. Check store fish for freshness just before using. Frozen Fish 1. Frozen products should be frozen, not thawed when received. 2. Items should be well wrapped, with no freezer burn. 3. Store at 0°F (-18°C. or colder. 4. Maximum storage time Fat fish -- 2 months Lean fish -- 6 months 5. Rotate stock – first in, first out Thawing and Handling of frozen fish 1. Thaw in refrigerator, never at room temperature. If pressed for time, keep in original moisture-proof wrapper and thaw under cold running water. 2. Small pieces like fillets and steaks can be cooked from frozen state to prevent excessive drip loss. Large fish should be thawed for even cooking. 3. Fillets that are to be breaded can be partially thawed. 4. Handle thawed fish as fresh fish. Do not refreeze.
  • 204. LM-Cookery Grade 10 204 5. Breaded, battered and other frozen prepared fish items are mostly cooked from frozen state. Shellfish 1. MUSSELS Keep refrigerated (32°F to 35°F/0° to 2°C). and protect from light. Store in original sack and keep sack damp. 2. SCALLOPS  Shucked scallops can be cooked without further preparation.  Keep scallops covered and refrigerated (30°F to 34°F). Do not let them rest directly on ice or they will lose flavor and become watery. 3. LOBSTERS  Live lobsters are either live or cup up before cooking. Live lobsters are plunged head first into boiling water, then simmered for 5 – 6 minutes. If served hot, they are drained well and split in half, and claws are cracked.  Live lobsters can be kept in two ways 1. packed in moist seaweed, kept in a cool place 2. in saltwater  Cooked lobster meat must be covered and refrigerated at 30° to 34°F. It is very perishable and should be used in 1 – 2 days. 4. SHRIMPS  Kept frozen at 0°F (-18°C). or lower  Thaw in refrigerator  Peeled shrimp should be wrapped before placing on ice  Shrimp served hot must be peeled and deveined before cooking  Shrimp to be served cold, must be peeled after cooking to preserve flavor.
  • 205. LM-Cookery Grade 10 205 5. CRABS  Live crabs should be kept alive until cooked.  Frozen crabmeat is very perishable when thawed. It must be treated like any other frozen fish. Directions: Follow the instructions below:  Visit at least 2 market/supermarkets and list down the fish/seafood that they are selling and their characteristics.  Identify the kind and market forms of fish and other seafood products available in the market visited.  Make documentation with picture of each market form. Include description of each. Your output will be rated using the given rubric. SCORE CRITERIA 5 Done creatively and neatly showing much relevance to the given topic 4 Done creatively and neat enough with relevance to the given topic 3 Done creatively and neat enough but no relevance to the given topic 2 Done simply and neat enough but not so relevant to the given topic 1 Done poorly with erasures and irrelevant to the given topic
  • 206. LM-Cookery Grade 10 206 Learning Outcome 3 Cook Seafood Are you ready for cooking? Fasten your seatbelt and carry on.  Principles of cooking fish and seafood dishes (dry heat and moist heat cookery)  Variety of shellfish and fish dishes Cooking Techniques for Fish and Shellfish Fish is very delicate and easily overcooked. During cooking, test for doneness must be observed. 1. The fish just separates into flakes 2. If bone is present, the flesh separates from the bone, and the bone is no longer pink 3. The flesh becomes opaque (usually white) Lean fish  Lean fish has almost no fat, so it easily becomes dry. It is best served with sauces to enhance moistness and gives richness.  Poaching is the moist heat method suited  Fish should be basted with butter or oil if broiled or baked.  Lean fish maybe fried or sautéed to gain palatability from added fat. Fat fish  The fat in fish, enables them to tolerate more heat without becoming dry.  Fat fish can be cooked by poaching.  Fat fish are well suited to broiling and baking. The dry heat methods eliminate excessive oiliness.  Large fat fish like salmon, and mackerel may be cooked in fat, but care should be taken to avoid excessive greasiness. Shellfish  Cook oyster just enough to heat thoroughly to keep it juicy and plump.  Clams become tough and rubbery if overcooked  Shrimps like other shellfish, become tough and rubbery when cooked at high temperature.
  • 207. LM-Cookery Grade 10 207 Scaling Whole Fish Once your work area and fish are ready, you can begin the actual scaling process. 1. Lay your fish flat on the board or hold it steady in the water. 2. Hold the fish down firmly with your hand near its head. 3. Begin to rake the scales from the tail towards the head. They should start coming off in clumps. 4. Be sure to remove the scales on both sides of the fish, as well as scales near the fins, the collar and the tail. 5. When you think you have gotten most of the scales, rinse the fish off again with water. This will wash away any loose scales and help you to identify any remaining scales that need to be removed.
  • 208. LM-Cookery Grade 10 208 Filleting Fish First, cut behind the head while angling the knife toward the front of the fish. There is a lot of good flesh on the top side where the fillet extends under the bony plate of the skull and angling the knife will ensure you don't waste it. Cut down to the bone and follow the line through to just behind the fins. Turn the fish and run the knife just clear of the fins with a slight downward angle. When you feel the knife is down to the bone reduce the angle and follow the bone until you come up against the backbone. Peel the fillet back and run the knife over the backbone severing the small lateral fish bones in the process. Stop at this point. Turn the fish over and repeat the procedure. Repeat the second cut near the dorsal fin with the knife angled slightly down.
  • 209. LM-Cookery Grade 10 209 Continue this along the length of the fish Reverse the direction of the filleting knife and follow the bones by "feeling them" with the fillet knife until the fish backbone is reached Peel the fillet back and cut around the backbone and through the small lateral bones. Run the fillet knife right through to the skin on the underside of the fish. Cut over the belly flap either through or over the belly bones. It can be easily cut through here with the razor sharp filleting knife.
  • 210. LM-Cookery Grade 10 210 Cut any remaining attached sinew or skin. Remove the first fillet. Flip the fish back to the original side and cut the bones around the gut cavity Release the rest of the fillet from the backbone. Skinning Fish When filleting or skinning fish keep the skinning knife clean and wet, this lubricates the blade and gives a much cleaner cut, more control of the knife and far less drag on the sides of the blade.
  • 211. LM-Cookery Grade 10 211 Stop when you have an inch or two (25 to 50mm) of fillet released. Change your grip on the fillet to a secure grip on the tab of fish skin you created with the first cut Firmly hold the knife still and at a fixed angle. Wriggle the skin from side to side while pulling backwards on the tab of fish skin Continue this motion through the fillet. You can see that even though the skin in the left hand is creased under the tension it has no effect where the fillet knife is separating the fish skin from the flesh. The fillet and skin are parted and no fleshes have been wasted nor have left any skin or scales on the fillet. If you scroll up you will note the knife has not moved over the last four fish skinning pictures.
  • 212. LM-Cookery Grade 10 212 Deboning Fish Gentle strokes of a knife angled towards the gut cavity will reveal the position and lay of the fine bones. Follow this line, cutting completely through, to release the top part of the fillet. The line of fine bones stops around two thirds of the way down the fillet. At this point put the knife on the other side of the line of bones and run the knife up the fillet until the point is well under the bones around the gut cavity. Separate the two and reinsert the knife at an angle suitable to cut the flesh from the underside of the gut bones Keep the knife following close to the fish bones to recover as much flesh as possible
  • 213. LM-Cookery Grade 10 213 The fillet is now deboned and the piece on the right of the picture above is discarded or washed and put aside with the fish heads and back bones for making fish stock Open oysters and clams for waste minimization techniques and environmental considerations in relation to seafood. A. Opening Oyster Hold oyster cup side down and hinge pointed towards you. 1. Insert oyster knife at hinge slowly but firmly and push the knife between the shells. Use a slight side to side rocking movement with your knife as you push in. 2. Work tip of knife into the oyster (about 1/2 inch). 3. Twist knife handle to pop oyster open. 4. Push knife into oyster and slice muscle from top shell.
  • 214. LM-Cookery Grade 10 214 5. Open top shell. 6. Cut muscle from bottom cup. Turn the meat over for most professional appearance. B. Opening Clams Scrub clams under cool running water using a stiff kitchen brush. Over a bowl, hold the clam firmly in your hand and insert the clam knife between the top shell and bottom shell. A towel can be used to protect your hand. Work the knife around to cut through the hinge muscle. The bowl will catch the liquor from the clam.
  • 215. LM-Cookery Grade 10 215 Open the shell. Slide the knife between the clam and the shell. Detach the clam. The clam is now ready to be cooked or eaten raw. Cleaning a Squid Pull off the head Remove the ink sac. Cut Tentacles. Remove beak from tentacles
  • 216. LM-Cookery Grade 10 216 Pull out the tail tube and cartilage Pull off the skin Cut into rings Splitting a Lobster How to Cut Lobster in Lengthwise 1. Place the lobster on its back on a tea towel to prevent slipping. 2.Using a heavy sharp knife, cut right through the underside of the body and tail, down the center.
  • 217. LM-Cookery Grade 10 217 A lobster split is not only an attractive style for presentation, but also enables easy access to the delicious meat inside. Turn the lobster around and continue the cut through the center of the head. The following will be the different activities that you need to undertake:  By group you will do collaborative learning and study the step by step procedures on how to perform scaling, filleting, skinning, deboning, opening oyster, opening clams, cleaning a squid, and splitting lobster. Be ready for a demonstration.  You can watch a video in You Tube or visit markets to see actual demonstration for deeper learning.  Bring the materials needed for the purpose of demonstration of the lesson.  You will demonstrate the different ways of preparing fish and seafood prior to the cooking activities. 4. Turn the lobster around and continue the cut through the center of the head. Place the lobster on its back on a tea towel to prevent slipping. 4. Using a heavy sharp knife, cut right through the underside of the body and tail, down the center.
  • 218. LM-Cookery Grade 10 218 Guidelines for Baking Fish 1. Fat fish are best for baking because they are less likely to dry out. 2. Lean fish may be baked but care should be taken not to overcook it. Basting with butter or oil helps prevent drying. 3. Baking temperature is 350°F to 400°F. 4. Served baked fish with a sauce or seasoned butter to enhance moistness and improve palatability.
  • 219. LM-Cookery Grade 10 219 Guidelines for Broiling or Grilling Fish 1. Overcooking should be avoided in cooking fish. 2. Select appropriate fish for broiling or grilling. 3. Fat fish and lean fish should be coated with fat before broiling to reduce drying. 4. Lean fish may be dredged in flour before dipping in oil or melted butter. The flour helps form a flavorful browned crust. 5. To prevent splitting during cooking, score the skin with a sharp knife. For small fillets, scoring may not be necessary. 6. Broil fish to order and serve immediately. 7. Broiled fish may be garnished lightly with paprika if more color is desired. 8. Thick cuts should be turned once during broiling in order to cook evenly. Thin pieces may be arranged on an oiled pan and broiled on one side only. Lobster is also broiled without turning.
  • 220. LM-Cookery Grade 10 220 Directions: Perform the given recipe. Your performance will be rated using the given rubric below. Broiled Shrimp Campy Tools/Equipment Needed: Broiler, griller Brush Baking Sheet Ingredients: 680 g large shrimp, peeled and deveined, tails left on, patted dry 1 tablespoon olive oil 2 cloves garlic, minced Coarse salt and ground pepper 2 tablespoons freshly squeezed lemon juice 2 tablespoons chopped fresh parsley Lemon wedges, for serving
  • 221. LM-Cookery Grade 10 221 Procedure: 1. Heat broiler with rack set 4 inches from heat. Place shrimp on a large broiler proof rimmed baking sheet. 2. Sprinkle with oil and garlic, and season generously with salt and pepper; toss to coat. Arrange shrimp in a single layer. 3. Broil until opaque throughout, 3 to 4 minutes. Sprinkle with lemon juice and parsley; toss to combine. Serve immediately; garnish with lemon wedges. 4 Can perform the skill without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Can perform the skill satisfactorily but requires some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, but requires considerable assistance and/or supervision. Guidelines for Sautéing and Pan Frying Fish and Shellfish 1. Lean fish are suited to sautéing because of the added fat. 2. Fat fish can be sautéed with care so as not to become greasy. 3. Breading the fish with flour or starchy products forms a crust that browns attractively, enhances flavor, helps hold the fish and prevent sticking. 4. Use fat, enough to cover the bottom of the pan. 5. Be sure the pan is hot before adding fish. Small items are sautéed over high heat, larger items require lower heat to cook evenly. 6. Very large fish may be browned in fat, and finished in an oven, uncovered. 7. Brown the most attractive side – the presentation side. 8. Handle fish carefully during and after cooking to avoid breaking the fish.
  • 222. LM-Cookery Grade 10 222 9. Sauté or fry to order and serve immediately. Directions: Given the different recipes by group prepare and cook fish and shellfish. Your performance will be evaluated using the given rubric. Fillet of Sole Meniere Tools/Equipment Needed: Mixing bowl Ladle Pan Spatula Ingredients: Fish Emeril's Fish Rub (or any combination of seasonings you like) 2 tbs. butter Lemon juice
  • 223. LM-Cookery Grade 10 223 Procedure: 1. Season all the fillets by sprinkling the seasoning and pressing it into the meat. 2. Get a spatula to handle the fish. If you have 10-12" filets cut them in half unless you're using a fish spatula 3. Heat the pan on medium heat and add the butter. When the butter is melted put some fish in the pan. Leave it on one side for about three to four minutes. 4. Move them around often to assure they're not sticking. 5. Flip one piece to check the brownness. If it's partially browned flip them all and continue to cook until the other side is browned. 6. Add more oil as needed. 7. Once it's out of the pan put six or eight drops of lemon juice on each piece. You may use other sauces if you want. Note: Testing the degree of doneness is as simple as taking your spatula and gently pushing on the thickest part of the fillet in the spinal bone line. When done, meat separates when you gently push with spatula. 4 Can perform the skill without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Can perform the skill satisfactorily but requires some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, but requires considerable assistance and/or supervision. Guidelines in Deep-Frying 1. Lean fish, both whole or small portions, and shellfish like shrimps, clams and oysters are best for deep-frying. 2. Fish to be fried is breaded or buttered to prevent sticking from frying pan. The batter also provides a crisp, flavorful, and attractive coating. 3. Frozen breaded fish can be fried without thawing.
  • 224. LM-Cookery Grade 10 224 4. Fried fish is usually served with lemon or cold sauce such as tartar, remoulade or cocktail sauce on the side. 5. The oil used should be enough to submerge the food item during frying. Cooking fish or shellfish by deep frying using the standard breading procedure. Tools/Equipment Needed: Stove Mixing bowls Ladle Refrigerator Baking sheet Food tong Ingredients: 1 cup self-rising cornmeal 1/2 cup self-rising flour 3/4 tsp table salt 1/2 tsp powdered white pepper 1/3 tsp cayenne pepper (optional) 1/4 tsp garlic salt 2 tbsp. peanut oil 1 large egg 1 tsp cool tap water
  • 225. LM-Cookery Grade 10 225 Procedure: 1. Use a small bowl and prepare an egg wash by mixing 1 large egg with 1 tsp of water. 2. In another bowl, place the cornmeal, flour, salt, pepper, cayenne pepper, garlic salt, and blend well. This breading recipe will bread about 2 pounds of fillets. 3. Rinse the fillets and pat dry, then place them into the refrigerator for about 30 minutes. 4. Place the fillets in the egg wash, then the Breading Mix before placing them on the prepared cookie sheet. 5. Prepare the cookie sheet by spreading the peanut oil evenly on the sheet. 6. The oven should be pre-heated to 375. Cook the fillets 5 minutes on each side 4 Can perform the skill without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Can perform the skill satisfactorily but requires some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, but requires considerable assistance and/or supervision. You did a great cooking. It‘s time to plate and present your dish. Go on and enjoy learning and doing.
  • 226. LM-Cookery Grade 10 226 Learning Outcome 4 Plate/Present Seafood Dishes Part of serving any kind of food is presentation. You don‘t have to be a trained chef to learn the basics of plating, which is the art of presenting food in an attractive way. The following topics and activities will help you learn the fundamentals of plating and perform it for better understanding. Fundamental of Plating 1. Balance – select foods and garnishes that offer variety and contrast  color – two or three colors on a plate  shapes – variety of shapes  textures – variety of textures  flavors – 2. Portion size  match portion sizes and plates – select plates large enough to hold all the items without crowding  balance the portion sizes of the items on the plate – don‘t let the main item get lost with excessive garnish  arrangement on the plate – Guidelines to help plating attractive 1. Keep food off the rim of the plate. 2. Arrange the items for the convenience of the customer. 3. Keep space between items. Each item should have its own identity. 4. Maintain unity. Create a center of attention and relate everything to it 5. Make every component count. 6. Add gravy or sauce attractively. 7. Keep it simple. 3. Serve hot foods hot, on hot plates Serve cold foods cold, on cold plates Examples of Garnishes or Accompaniment for Plating  Bouqetiere - bouquet of vegetables  Jardinière - garden vegetables  Clamart - peas  Crecy - carrots
  • 227. LM-Cookery Grade 10 227  Doria - cucumbers (cooked in butter)  Dubarry - cauliflower  Fermiere - carrots, turnips, onions and celery cut into uniformslices  Forestiere - mushrooms  Lyonnaise - onions  Nicoise - tomatoes concasse cooked with garlic Serving Baked Fish  Serve baked fish with a sauce or seasoned butter to enhance moistness and improves palatability. Serving with lemon also enhances the fish.  For service, the fish is removed from the dish, the liquid is strained, degreased, reduced and finished by adding butter, cream or veloute sauce. Serving Broiled Lobster Serve immediately with melted butter or appropriate sauce and garnish. Serving Sautéed and Pan Fried  Remove the fish with spatula and place on serving plate with presentation side up.  Sprinkle fish with lemon juice and chopped parsley.  Heat raw butter in the sauté pan until it turns light brown. Pour over fish immediately and serve at once.
  • 228. LM-Cookery Grade 10 228 Serving Poached or Simmered Fish in Court bouillon Served poached fish with appropriate sauce, such as hollandaise for hot fish and a mayonnaise – based sauce for cold fish. Mild vinaigrette go well with both hot and cold poached fish. Serving Poached Fish in Fumet and Wine  Reduce the cuision over high heat to about ¼ of its volume.  Add fish veloute and heavy cream and bring to boil.  Adjust seasoning with salt, white pepper and lemon juice.  Strain the sauce.  Arrange the fish on plates for service, coat with sauce and serve immediately. Glazing Poached fish is sometimes glazed before serving 1. Combine the finished sauce with eggyolk, hollandaise sauce or lightly whipped cream. 2. Coat the fish with the sauce and run the plate under a broiler until the sauce is golden brown.
  • 229. LM-Cookery Grade 10 229 Review of Learning Outcome 4 A. Directions: Briefly explain the relationships of the following in food preparation. Write your answers in your test notebook. 1. Balance 2. Portion size 3. Serving hot food on hot plates 4. Serving cold foods on cold plates 5. Garnishes
  • 230. LM-Cookery Grade 10 230 Directions: Given the recipe, perform the following by group: Broiled Fish Steaks Tools/Equipment Needed: Oven Baking sheet Brush Fork Plate Ingredients: 3 fish steaks, 1‖ thick ½ tsp. salt Dash of pepper 2 tsp. lemon juice 2 tbsp. butter, melted Procedure: 1. Sprinkle both sides of fish with salt, pepper and lemon juice. 2. Brush with half of the butter. 3. Put fish in broiler pan in 550 degree oven, don‘t cover. 4. Broil with tops about 4 inches from heat until light brown. 5. Brush fish with butter turn very carefully. 6. Brush with rest of the butter. 7. Broil until fish flakes easily with fork, 4 – 6 more minutes.
  • 231. LM-Cookery Grade 10 231 Poached Fillet of Sole in White Wine Sauce Tools/Equipment Needed: Pan Baking dish Food tong Spoon Broiler/oven Ingredients: 2 lbs. sole fillets 2 lbs. spinach, cooked and drained ½ C. dry white wine 1 C. fish stock 3 tbsp. butter 4 tbsp. flour 1 C. grated cheese Salt and pepper Procedure: 1. Roll and secure each fillet with toothpicks 2. Poached for 8 minutes in wine/fish stock 3. Drain and save liquid Sauce 1. Melt butter 2. Blend in flour, salt and pepper and fish liquid 3. Assemble butter in shallow serving dish 4. Arrange spinach on bottom 5. Cover with poached fish (remove toothpicks 6. Spoon sauce over fish 7. Sprinkle with cheese 8. Broil under hot broiler a few minutes
  • 232. LM-Cookery Grade 10 232 4 Can perform the skill without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Can perform the skill satisfactorily but requires some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, but requires considerable assistance and/or supervision. Learning Outcome 5 Store Seafood Storing of Fish and Shellfish Fresh Fish 1. On crushed ice – use drip pans to allow for drainage of melted ice. Change ice daily. Cover container or store in separate box away from other foods. a. Whole fish should be drawn (that is viscera removed) as soon as possible because the entrails deteriorate quickly. b. Cut fish (fillets, steaks, portions) should be wrapped or left in original moisture proof wrap. 2. Refrigerate at 30° to 34°F (-1° to 1°C... 3. Fish may be stored for 1 to 2 days. If it must be kept longer, you must wrap and freeze it immediately. 4. Check stored fish for freshness just before you use it. Even if it was fresh when received, it may not be fresh after few days in storage.
  • 233. LM-Cookery Grade 10 233 Frozen Fish 1. Store at 0°F (-18°C. or colder. 2. Keep well wrapped to prevent freezer burn 3. Maximum storage time: Fat fish – 2 months; Lean fish – 6 months. 4. Rotate stock – first in, first out. Shellfish A. Oyster 1. Keep live oyster in a cold, wet place in the cartons or sacks. 2. Store fresh shucked oysters in original container in refrigerator at 30° to 34°F (-1° to 1°C). They will keep up to 1 week. 3. Keep frozen oysters in freezer at 0°F (- 18°C. or colder, until ready for use. Lobster and Shrimp 1. Store at 0°F (-18°C. or colder). 2. Fresh or thawed shrimp in shell are stored on crushed ice, like whole fish. 3. Peeled shrimp lose soluble nutrients and flavor when stored unwrapped on ice. They should be wrapped before placing on ice or covered and simply refrigerated. 4. Packed in moist seaweed or in moist, heavy paper, kept in a cool place.
  • 234. LM-Cookery Grade 10 234 Review of Learning Outcome 5 Directions: Match Column A with Column B. Write the letter of the correct letter of your answer in your test notebook. Items in column B may be answered twice or more. Column A Column B 1. Removed viscera first before storing A. fresh fish 2. Wrapped to prevent freezer burns B. frozen fish 3. Kept in cold, wet cartons C. lobster and shrimp 4. Packed in moist seaweed D. shellfish 5. First in, first out e. all of the above 6. Wrapped before freezing 7. Left in original moisture proof wrapped 8. Refrigerate at 30° to 34°F (-1° to 1°C) 9. Store at 0°F ( -18°C. or colder) 10. Stored for 1 to 2 days Directions: Perform experimental fish cookery. Make your own recipe and prepare, cook and present the product. Explain how to properly store your output. Your performance will be evaluated using the given rubric. 4 Can perform the skill without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 Can perform the skill satisfactorily but requires some assistance and/or supervision. 1 Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, but requires considerable assistance and/or supervision.
  • 235. LM-Cookery Grade 10 235 Post Test 2 Multiple Choice. Directions: Read the following questions carefully and choose the letter that best describes the statement. Write your answer in your test notebook. 1. Which of the following vegetables is rich in carbohydrates? A. legumes, peas, and beans C. Mushroom, tomatoes, and radish B. Nuts, olives, and avocado D. Seeds, roots, and tubers 2. What is the flavor component of vegetables which gives strong flavor and odor to some vegetables like onions, leeks, garlic, chives, cabbage, and broccoli? A. Flavonoids C. Sugar C. Glutamic acid D. Sulfur compounds 3. Which tool is used to drain excess water after washing vegetables? A. Bowls C. Steamer B. Colander D. Utility tray 4. Which of the following is cooking by placing blanched or raw vegetables in the pan, adding liquid (stock, water, wine) then covering and cooking it slowly? A. Boiling C. Braising B. Baking D. Sautéing 5. Which fat soluble compound is responsible for the green coloring of plants? A. Anthocyanins C. Chlorophyll B. Carotenoids D. Lycopene 6. Mrs. Cabrillas needs more supply of Vitamin A. which of the following will she eat to give her the nutrient she needs? A.Alugbati C. Lettuce B. Potatoes D.Saluyot 7. Which of the following plating styles is not a classic arrangement? A. The starch or vegetable item is heaped in the center while the main item is sliced and leaned up against it. B. The main item in the center, with vegetable distributed around it. C. The vegetable item in front and main item, starch item and garnish at the rear. D. The main item is in the center with neat piles of vegetables carefully arranged around.
  • 236. LM-Cookery Grade 10 236 8. Chef Shaneshan will cook chopsuey. She is about to remove the hard core of a cabbage. Which of the following knife will she use? A. Butcher knife C. Cutting knife B. Channel knife D. Paring knife 9. What kind of knife is used in removing the hard core of a cabbage? A. Butcher knife C. Cutting knife B. Channel knife D. Paring knife 10. At what temperature in a dry, dark place should potatoes and onions be stored? A. 50 – 650F C. 60 – 850F B. 40 – 450F D. 70 – 950F 11. Which of the following vegetables is cooked uncovered? A. Fruit vegetables C. Roots and tubers B. Green vegetables D. Yellow vegetables 12. Which kind of fish has no internal bone structure? A. Fin fish C. Round fish B. Freshwater fish D. Shell fish 13. Which of the following fish is high in fat? A. Bass C. Mackerel B. Cod D. Red Snapper 14. Which of the following fish is low in fat? A. Cod C. Trout B. Salmon D. Tuna 15. Which market form of fish is viscera, head, tail and fins are removed? A. Butterfly C. Fillet B. Dressed D. Sticks 16. Which of the following is a freshwater fish? A. Bluefish C. Grouper B. Cat fish D. Sole 17. Which market form of fish are both sides of a fish still joined but bones are removed? A. Butterfly C. Fillet B. Drawn D. Steak 18. Which of the following is the second step in scaling whole fish? A. Begin to rake the scales from the tail towards the head. B. Remove the scales on both sides of the fish. C. Hold the fish down firmly with your hand near its head. D. Lay your fish flat on the board.
  • 237. LM-Cookery Grade 10 237 19. Which of the following is the third step in opening an oyster? A. Cut muscle from bottom cup. B. Insert oyster knife at hinge slowly but firmly C. Push knife into oyster and slice muscle from top shell D. Twist knife handle to open the oyster. 20. Which of the following is a characteristic of a fresh fish? A. With fresh and foul odor B. Eyes are dull, shiny and bulging C. Gills are pink or red D. Flesh shrink when pressed 21. How many colors is suggested on a plate to make it balance? A. Four to five C. Three to four B. One to two D. Two to three 22. Which of the following seafood is cooked just enough to heat to keep it juicy and plump? A. Fat fish C. Flat fish B. Lean fish D. Shellfish 23. Which of the following enhances baked fish when served? A. Butter C. Lemon B. Cream D. Sauce 24. What cooking method is suited to fat fish. A. Baking C. Deep -frying B. Boiling D. Sautéing 25. Which is basted to baked lean fish to help prevent it from drying up. A. Butter C. Soy sauce B. Cream D. Tomato sauce B. Give five characteristics of a fresh fish. 26. 27. 28. 29. 30.
  • 238. LM-Cookery Grade 10 238 QUARTER 3 PREPARE STOCKS, SAUCES AND SOUPS, AND POULTRY AND GAME DISHES Overview This quarter will enable students or learners to acquire competencies in: preparing, storing, reconstituting and evaluating stocks, sauces and soups; cooking, plating/presenting, and storing poultry and game dishes, preparing, cooking, plating/presenting and storing meat dishes. Objectives: At the end of the quarter students are expected to: 1. prepare stocks required for menu item; 2. prepare soups required for menu item; 3. prepare sauce required for menu item; 4. store and reconstitute stocks, sauces and soups; 5. perform mise‘en place; 6. cook poultry and meat dishes; 7. plate and present poultry and meat dishes; 8. evaluate finished products; and 9. store poultry and meat. Pre-Test Directions: Read and understand the statements/questions below. Choose the letter of the correct answer and write it in your test notebook. 1. As a chef of a fine dining restaurant, Genie simmers meat, fish, and vegetables. Which of the following liquids is a by-product after the different food stuffs have been simmered? A. glaze C. stock B. sauce D. water
  • 239. LM-Cookery Grade 10 239 2. Which of the following stocks uses veal bone as its main ingredient? A. brown stock C. prawn stock B. ham stock D. white stock 3. What kind of stock uses fish as its main ingredient? A. brown stock C. glace viande B. fish stock D. ham stock 4. What stock uses chicken bone as its main ingredient? A. fish stock C. prawn stock B. ham stock D. chicken stock 5. Among the different types of stock, which one is the easiest to prepare? A. brown stock C. white stock B. fish stock D. vegetable stock 6. What stock is made by boiling prawn shell? A. fish stock C. prawn stock B. ham stock D. vegetable stock 7. As a rule, which should not be added to the stock because it causes saltiness? A. MSG C. spices B. salt D. sugar 8. Mrs. Sante will be having visitors for dinner. If she will prepare stock for their dinner, which of the following flavoring agents will she use to give aroma to the stock? A. aromatic flavoring C. ginger B. garlic D. smoke 9. What makes the stock tasty and appetizing? A. appearance C. ingredients B. color D. smell 10. Which of the following is a clear soup? A. bisques C. cream B. bouillon D. puree 11. Which of the following examples is a thick soup? A. bisques C. consommé B. bouillon D. fruit 12. Which of the following is not a thickening agent? A. flour C. rice B. grain D. salt 13. Which of the four basic sauces whose basic ingredient is milk is thickened with flour enriched with butter? A. Hollandaise sauce C. veloute sauce B. savory butter D. white sauce
  • 240. LM-Cookery Grade 10 240 14. Which among the four basic sauces has a chief ingredient of chicken broth thickened with flour and enriched with butter seasoning? A. Hollandaise sauce C. veloute sauce B. savory butter D. white sauce 15. Which of the four basic sauces has three basic ingredients like butter, egg yolk, and lemon juice with seasoning for accent? A. Hollandaise sauce C. white sauce B. savory butter D. veloute sauce 16. Which of the four basic sauces has a basic ingredient like butter that is creamed and blended with other ingredients to give individual flavor? A. Hollandaise sauce C. veloute sauce B. savory butter D. white sauce 17. Which of the following is not a thickening agent? A. dairy cream C. flour B. egg D. spice 18. What do you call birds that are hunted for food? A. game C. poultry B. livestock D. swine 19. Which of the following poultry originated from China and is noted for its tender and flavorful meat? A. chicken C. itik B. goose D. pecking duck 20. What do you call to young immature pigeon of either sex with extra tender meat is called . A. duck C. rooster B. fryer D. squab 21. Poultry is composed of different parts. Which of the following do breast meat belong? A. dark meat C. variety meat B. tough meat D. white meat 22. Which of the following characteristics is a good quality of a live poultry? A. free from pin feathers and shows no cuts B. has clear eye C. heavy and the skin is watery D. well-develop thighs 23. What do you call to young chicken that is usually 9 to 12 weeks of age? A. fryer C. roaster B. hen D. stag 24. How many days should a whole chicken should be refrigerated? A. 1 day C. 2 to 4 days B. 1 to 2 days D. 3 to 4 days
  • 241. LM-Cookery Grade 10 241 25. How do you classify the fleshy part of chicken like breast? A. entrails C. viscera B. dark meat D. white meat 26. In cookery, we apply different cooking methods depending on the ingredients that we have. If you will cook a matured poultry, which of the following methods will you apply? A. boiling C. roasting B. frying D. stewing 27. What cookery method is suitable for the less tender cuts? A. boiling C. roasting B. frying D. stewing 28. What is the best cooking temperature for poultry? A. high temperature C. low to moderate temperature B. low temperature D. moderate temperature 29. What factor affects the poultry meat‘s tenderness and juiciness? A. age C. cuts B. cookery D. sex 30. Which of the following can be done to prevent drying when reheating? A. cook using sauces and gravy B. overcook the poultry meat C. remove fat before cooking D. none of the above
  • 242. LM-Cookery Grade 10 242 Overview: This lesson covers the skills, knowledge, and attitudes required to prepare various stocks, sauces, and soup in a commercial kitchen or catering operation Learning Outcomes: At the end of this Lesson you are expected to do the following: 1. prepare stocks for required menu items; 2. prepare soups required for menu items; 3. prepare sauces required for menu items; 4. store and reconstitute stocks, sauces and soups; and 5. evaluate the finished product Learning Outcome 1 Prepare Stocks for Required Menu Items Principles of Preparing Stocks Stocks- are among the most basic preparations found in professional kitchen. They are referred to in French as fonds de cuisine, or ―the foundation of cooking.” It is a flavorful liquid prepared by simmering meaty bones from meat or poultry, seafood and/or vegetables in water with aromatics until their flavor, aroma, color and body, and nutritive value are extracted. - a clear, thin liquid flavored by soluble substances extracted from meat, poultry, and fish; and their bones, and from vegetables and seasonings. LESSON 1 PREPARE STOCKS, SAUCES AND SOUPS
  • 243. LM-Cookery Grade 10 243 Chicken stock –made from the chicken bones. White stock – made from beef or veal bones. Brown stock – made from beef or veal bones that have been browned in an oven. Fish stock – made from fish bones and trimmings left over after filleting Classification of Stocks
  • 244. LM-Cookery Grade 10 244 Ingredients in Preparing Stocks 1. Bones Most of the flavor and body of stocks are derived from the bones of beef, veal, chicken, fish, and pork. The kinds of bones used determine the kind of stock, except vegetable stock. 2. Mirepoix - is the French term for the combination of coarsely chopped onions, carrots and celery used to flavor stocks. Basic formula for Mirepoix – used to flavor white stocks and soups, tomato paste or puree is often included for brown stock, gravy, stew or soup. 2 parts onion 1 part celery 1 part carrot 3. Acid products - Acid helps dissolve connective tissues, and extract flavor and body from bones. 4. Scraps and left-over -Scraps may be used in stocks if they are clear, wholesome, and appropriate to the stock being made.
  • 245. LM-Cookery Grade 10 245 5. Seasoning and spices 6. Bouquet garni – assortment of fresh herbs and aromatic ingredients tied in a bundle with string so it can be removed easily from the stock. Guidelines for preparing stock 1. Follow the correct procedures for cooling and storing stock and make sure that any stock you use is flavorful and wholesome. 2. Follow the cooking time for stock The following are approximate cooking time for different stocks; the time will vary according to numerous factors such as ingredients quality, volume and cooking temperature. White beef stock - 8 to 10 hours White and brown Veal Game stock – 6 to 8 hours White poultry and Game Bird Stocks – 3 to 4 hours Fish Stock – 45 minutes to 1 hour Vegetables Stock – 45 minutes to 1 hour, depending on the specific ingredients and the size of vegetables cut 3. The stock ingredients are boiled starting with cold water. This promotes the extraction of protein which may be sealed in by hot water. 4. Stocks are simmered gently, with small bubbles at the bottom but not breaking at the surface. If a stock is boiled, it will be cloudy. 5. Salt is not usually added to a stock, as this causes it to become too salty, since most stocks are preserved to make soup and sauces. 6. Meat is added to the stock before the vegetables and the ―scum‖that rises to the surface is skimmed off before further ingredients are added
  • 246. LM-Cookery Grade 10 246 Different Kinds of Spices and Seasoning
  • 248. LM-Cookery Grade 10 248 Activity 1. PREPARE STOCK (Group Activity) Directions: Choose any of the given stocks and prepare following the given procedure. Your performance and output will be rated using the given rubric. White stock Basic White stock Tools and Equipment:  Stove  Stock pot  Chopping board  Knife  Skimmer/Strainer  Ladle  Container Ingredients: 4 -5 kg bones; chicken, veal or beef 1 L water, cold Mirepoix 450 g onion, chopped 16 tbsp. carrot, chopped 16 tbsp. celery, chopped
  • 249. LM-Cookery Grade 10 249 Bouquet Garni 1 pc dried bay leaf ¼ tsp Dried thyme ¼ tsp peppercorns 6-8 stems parsley 2 whole cloves Procedure: 1. Cut the bones into pieces, 3 to 4 inches long for easy extraction. 2. Rinse in cold water to remove impurities that cloud the stock. 3. Place the bones in the stockpot and cover with cold water to speed extraction. 4. Bring water to a boil and then, reduce to simmer. Skim the scum that comes from the surface for a clear stock. Do not let the stock boil because it makes the stock cloudy. 5. Keep the water level above the bones because bones cooked while exposed to air will turn dark and darken the stock. Also, bones will not release flavor into the water. 6. Add the mirepoix. 7. Simmer for recommended length of time: 8. Strain through several layers of cheesecloth. 9. Cool the stock as quickly as possible by:  Setting the pot in a sink and allow cold water to flow under the pot and around it.  Stirring the pot occasionally so all the stock cools evenly. 10. When cooled, refrigerate the stock properly in covered containers for 2-3 days. If properly frozen, it will last for several months.
  • 250. LM-Cookery Grade 10 250 Directions: Ask your teacher to assess your performance in the following critical task and performance criteria below You will be rated based on the evaluation on the right side. OVERALL EVALUATION Level Achieved PERFORMANCE LEVELS 4 - Can perform the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 - Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 - Can perform the skill less satisfactorily but requires some assistance and/or supervision. 1 - Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, and requires considerable assistance and/or supervision. Teacher will initial level achieved. PERFORMANCE STANDARDS For acceptable achievement, all items should receive an answer. 1 2 3 4 1. Cut the bones into pieces, 3 to 4 inches long. 2. Rinse in cold water to remove impurities that cloud the stock. 3. Place the bones in the stockpot and cover with cold water to speed extraction 4. Bring water to boil and then reduce to simmer. Skim the scum. 5. Keep the water level above the bones 6. Add mirepoix
  • 251. LM-Cookery Grade 10 251 7 Simmer for recommended length of time 8 Strain through several layers of cheesecloth 9. Cool the stock as quickly as possible 10. When cool, refrigerate the stock properly in covered containers to keep for 2-3 days. Basic Brown Stock Tools and Equipment: Stove Stock pot Chopping board Knife Skimmer/Strainer Ladle Container Ingredients: 4 ½ kg. bones; chicken, veal or beef 10-12 qtr. water, cold Mirepoix 450 g onion, chopped 16 tbsp. carrot, chopped 16 tbsp. celery, chopped 450 g tomato puree
  • 252. LM-Cookery Grade 10 252 Bouquet Garni 1 pc dried bay leaf ¼ tsp Dried thyme ¼ tsp peppercorns 6-8 stems parsley 2 whole cloves Procedure: 1. Cut the bones into pieces, 3-4 inches long. Use veal or beef bones. 2. Do not wash or blanch the bones. The moisture would hinder browning. 3. Place the bones in a roasting pan in one layer, and brown in a hot oven at 375°F (190°C. or higher. The bones must be well browned to color the stock sufficiently. Bones may be oiled lightly before browning. 4. When the bones are well browned, remove from pan and place in a stockpot. Cover with cold water and bring to simmer. 5. Drain and reserve the fat from the roasting pan. Deglaze the pan by adding water and stirring over heat until all the brown drippings are dissolved or loosened. Add to stockpot. 6. While the stock is getting started, place the mirepoix in the roasting pan with some of the reserved fat and brown the vegetable well in the oven. 7. When the water in the stockpot comes to a simmer, skim the scum at the surface. 8. Add the browned vegetable and tomato puree to the stockpot. 9. Put the bouquet garni by tying it to the handle of the pot for easy removal. 10. Continue to simmer for recommended length of time, 6-8 hours. 11. Strain through several layers of cheesecloth. 12.Cool the stock and refrigerate properly in a covered container to keep for 2-3 days. If properly frozen, it will last for several months.
  • 253. LM-Cookery Grade 10 253 How Well Did You Perform? Find out by accomplishing the Scoring Rubric honestly and sincerely. Remember it is your learning at stake! Directions: Ask your teacher to assess your performance in the following critical task and performance criteria below You will be rated based on the evaluation on the right side. OVERALL EVALUATION Level Achieved PERFORMANCE LEVELS 4 - Can perform the skill satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 3 - Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 2 - Can perform the skill satisfactorily but requires some assistance and/or supervision. 1 - Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, but requires considerable assistance and/or supervision. Teacher will initial level achieved. PERFORMANCE STANDARDS For acceptable achievement, all items should receive an answer. 1 2 3 4 1. Cut the bones into pieces, 3 to 4 inches long. 2. Rinse in cold water to remove impurities that cloud the stock. 3. Place the bones in the stockpot and cover with cold water to speed extraction 4. Bring water to boil and then reduce to simmer. Skim the scum.
  • 254. LM-Cookery Grade 10 254 5. Keep the water level above the bones 6. Add mirepoix 7 Simmer for recommended length of time 8 Strain through several layers of cheesecloth 9. Cool the stock as quickly as possible 10. When cool, refrigerate the stock properly in covered containers to keep for 2-3 days. Review of Learning Outcome 1 Directions: Read the following questions carefully and choose the letter of the correct answer. Write your answer in your test notebook. 1. What do you call the liquid in which meat, fish, and sometimes vegetables have been cooked? A. glaze C. stock B. sauce D. water 2. Which of the following stocks uses veal bone as its main ingredient? A. brown stock C. prawn stock B. ham stock D. white stock 3. What kind of stock uses fish as its main ingredient? A. brown stock C. glace viands B. fish stock D. ham stock 4. What stock uses chicken bone as its main ingredient? A. fish stock B. ham stock C. prawn stocks D. chicken stocks 5. Which one is the easiest to prepare? A. brown stock C. white stock B. fish stock D. vegetable stock
  • 255. LM-Cookery Grade 10 255 Learning Outcome 2 Prepare Soups Required for Menu Item Soups Soups are based on stocks added with other ingredients for variety of flavor, consistency, appearance and aroma A well-prepared soup always makes a memorable impression. Soups offer a full array of flavoring ingredients and garnishing opportunities. Soups also allow the use of trimmings and leftover creatively. Classifications of Soups 1. Clear Soups Clear Soups. They are soups based on a clear, unthickened broth or stock. They may be served plain or garnished with a variety of vegetables and meats. They are very similar to stocks, except that broths are based on meats rather than bones so they are richer and have a more defined flavor. Broths can be used as a liquid in preparing soups. A good quality broth should be clear, aromatic and rich-tasting with a very evident flavor of the major ingredient. One strong and clear broth or stock is a consommé. It is made by combining lean chopped meat, egg whites, mirepoix, herbs and spices and an acidic ingredient like tomatoes, wine, or lemon juice. The combination is called ―clarification‖ since the particles that make the broth appear cloudy are trapped as it cooks. A good quality consommé is crystal – clear, has a good body, amber to brown in color, and completely fat-free.
  • 256. LM-Cookery Grade 10 256  Broth and bouillon simple clear soup without solid ingredients. Broth and bouillon are similar to stock in technique and in cooking time. The major distinction between broth and stock is that broths can be served as is, whereas stocks are used in production of other dishes.  Vegetable soup – clear seasoned stock or broth with the addition of one or more vegetable, meat, or poultry.  Consommé‘ – rich, flavorful stock or broth that has been clarified to make it perfectly clear and transparent. 2. Thick Soups Thick Soups are soups that are thickened to provide a heavier consistency. Thick soup is a cream soup based on béchamel sauce and is finished with a heavy cream. A béchamel sauce is milk thickened with roux. But some thick soups are veloute sauce-based, stock thickened with roux. A veloute sauce base is usually finished with a liaison of heavy cream egg yolk. A thick soup should have a velvety smooth texture and the thickness of heavy cream. It is always essential to strain out the solids and at times to puree and put back in the soup. Cream soups may be served hot or cold. A kind of cream soup based on crustaceans like shrimps and lobsters is bisque. It is made by simmering a crustacean in a stock or a fish fumet. Another thick vegetable soup is the chowder made with broth, milk or water as base, then thickened with roux. Cold, thick soups such as vichyssoise are simply cream soups served cold. Others like gazpacho or a chilled cantaloupe soup are based on a puree of cooked or raw ingredients brought to the correct consistency by adding fruits or vegetable juice as a liquid
  • 257. LM-Cookery Grade 10 257  Cream soups – are soups thickened with roux, beurremanie, liaison or other thickening agents, plus milk, or cream.  Purees – vegetable soup thickened with starch  Bisques – are thickened soups made from shellfish.  Chowders – are hearty soups made from fish, shellfish or vegetables usually contain milk and potatoes.  Veloutes – soup thickened with egg, butter and cream. 3. Other types of soup a. Dessert soup A. Ginataan – a Filipino soup made from coconut milk, milk, fruit, and tapioca pearl served hot or cold. B. Osheriku – a Japanese asuki bean soup C.Tonge sui – a Chinese soup b. Fruit Soup can be served hot or cold depending on the recipe where dried fruits are used like raisins and prunes. Fruit soup may include milk, sweet or savory dumplings, spices or alcoholic beverages like brandy and champagne. c. Cold soup is variations on the traditional soup wherein the temperature when served is kept at or below temperature. d. Asian soup is a traditional soup which is typical broth, clear soup, or starch thickened soup. Other thickening agents for soup 1. rice 2. flour 3. grain 4. corn starch
  • 258. LM-Cookery Grade 10 258 Ingredients of soup • Meat (chicken, beef, pork, lamb, fish) • Salt • Pepper • Vegetables (carrots, string beans, turnips, tomatoes, mushrooms, celery, leak) • Onion • Garlic • Water • Eggs • Cornstarch • Seasoning (MSG, convenience products) • Butter • Cream • Garnishes (slices of lemon, egg, shredded vegetables, pimiento strips) Basic Principles of Preparing Soup 1stPrinciple. Starting with Cold Water Why cold water? Most protein, vitamins and minerals dissolve in cold water. Part of the flavor comes from these components. Using hot water would lessen the flavor and nutritive content of stock 2ndPrinciple. Cutting vegetable to appropriate size for the type of stock. The size of cut helps the maximum flavor to be extracted. Example 1: A fish stock only simmer for a half hour (30 minutes) so the cut should be julienne (thin strips: ¼ inch thick 2-3 inches long) Example 2: A brown stock simmers for 4-6 hours and sometimes 24 hours, so the cut should be 1‖ cubed so that stock will have time to extract the flavor and will not fall apart after a long cooking. 3rd Principle. Select your protein based. Beef, Chicken, Pork and Fish All bones are washed, roasted or blanched. Roasted for brown sauce and blanched for white stock. 4th Principle. Simmering Gentle extractions aid in flavor and nutrition. Boiling causes cloudiness through agitation of the ingredients. 5th Principle. Skimming Keep the stock clear. The scum on top of stocks contains impurities.
  • 259. LM-Cookery Grade 10 259 Cooking soups Meats, Poultry and Fish  Cuts of meat that are less tender should be added early in the cooking process  Poultry needs to be added early enough so that it cooks thoroughly  Add fish closed to the end of the cooking process to keep it from overcooking. Grains and Pasta  Allow a little more time in cooking. Beans and Legumes  Soaked beans, lentils and black-eyed peas should be added with the liquid so they will fully cook Dense or Starchy Vegetables  A small-diced cut of potatoes, carrots, and winter squashes will require 30–45 minutes to cook. Green Vegetables:  These vegetables should be added during the final 15–20 minutes of cooking the soup Adjusting Consistency Thick soups may continue to thicken during cooking and may need additional stock or water added to adjust the consistency Degreasing Broth-based soups maybe prepared in advance, cooled and refrigerated. This facilitates removing of congealed fat from the surface. Skim the top layer of fat from a hot soup with a ladle, alternately.
  • 260. LM-Cookery Grade 10 260 Perform the Suggested Soup Recipes Directions: Find a partner and perform the given soup recipe. CREAM OF POTATO SOUP TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT INGRIDIENTS QUANTITY DESCRIPTION casserole ½ cup chopped bacon gas or electric stove ¾ kg potatoes knife 3 cups water chopping board 2 bulbs onions, chopped strainer 1 whole chicken bouillon cube saucepot 2 cups hot water measuring cup ¼ cups butter measuring spoon ¼ tsp. pepper wooden spoon 2tbsp. Gold Medal all-purpose flour soup ladle ½ tsp. salt 1½ c all-purpose cream PROCEDURE: 1. Cook bacon until crispy. Cool. Set aside, peel potatoes and cut into cubes, place in a saucepot and add water and chopped onions. Bring to a boil and cook until potatoes are tender. Remove potatoes and sear the broth. 2. Add chicken bouillon cube to the reserved potato broth to make potato chicken broth and stir until dissolved. Add the hot water. Place cooked potatoes in blender in 2 batches, adding ¾ cup of the potato- chicken broth with each batch. Cover and blend for 1 minute or until smooth. Set aside. 3. Melt butter in a saucepan. Add flour, salt and pepper. Add all-purpose cream at once. Stir while cooking until slightly thickened and bubbly. Cook for 1 minute more. Stir until heated through. If necessary, stir in
  • 261. LM-Cookery Grade 10 261 additional milk to make the desired consistency. Serve with sprinkled bacon bits. Find out how well you performed by accomplishing the Scoring Rubric honestly and sincerely. Remember it is your learning at stake! Direction: Evaluate your finished product, using the given score sheet. Criteria for Evaluating and Presenting Soup I. Products: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. attractive and appealing to appetite b. pleasing and good color combination c. ingredients cooked just right d. correct consistency 2. Palatability a. delicious b. taste just right 3. Nutritive value a. highly nutritious II. Procedures: 1. Use of Resources: a. kept working table is kept orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and devices 2. Cleanliness and sanitation a. was well- groomed and properly dressed for cooking, used clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holder b. Observed sanitary handling of food 3. Conservation of nutrients a. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures b. followed the recipe correctly Score: (maximum 42 points) Comments:
  • 262. LM-Cookery Grade 10 262 Show that you learned something by doing this activity CONSOMME A LA MADRILENE TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT INGRIDIENTS QUANTITY DESCRIPTION casserole 1kg. Lean beef, cut in 3 portion gas or electric stove ½ kg bone marrow knife 3 ½ liter cold water chopping board 3 large carrots, cut up measuring cup 2 cloves onion, stuck with 3 cloves measuring spoon 2 stalks celery w/leaves. wooden spoon 3 leeks, sliced lengthwise and soup ladle 1½ tbsp. wash salt 6 peppercorns 2 spring parsley pinch basil 1 clove clove garlic 1pc bay leaf 3 large egg whites, beaten 3 crushed eggshells 2 cup tomato puree 2tbsp finely chopped onions ½ tsp dried basil
  • 263. LM-Cookery Grade 10 263 PROCEDURE: 1. Combine the beef, bone and water in a stockpot and bring to a boil. Simmer for 5 minutes and skim. Cover and simmer for 1 hour. 2. Add to the onion stock with cloves, the carrots, celery, leeks, salt peppercorns, parsley, thyme, garlic and bay leaf. Cover and cook slowly for 4 – 5 hours. 3. Strain through a double thickness of cheesecloth and skim off fat. Use absorbent paper towels. Remove the remaining particles and reserve the meat for another purpose. 4. To clarify the consommé, return it to the heat and add beaten egg whites and eggshells. 5. Bring to a rolling boil and strain once more through 3 thickness cheesecloth. 6. Pour 6 cups of consommé into a saucepan and reserve the remainder for another use. 7. Add the tomato puree, onion, and dried basil. Simmer for 20 minutes, remove from the heat and strain through cheesecloth. 8. Serve hot. Find out how well you performed by accomplishing the Scoring Rubric honestly and sincerely. Remember it is your learning at stake! Direction: Evaluate your finished product, using the given score sheet. Criteria for Evaluating and Presenting Soup I. Products: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. attractive and appealing to appetite b. pleasing and good color combination c. ingredients cooked just right d. correct consistency 2. Palatability a. delicious b. taste just right 3. Nutritive value a. highly nutritious II. Procedures: 1. Use of Resources:
  • 264. LM-Cookery Grade 10 264 a. kept working table is kept orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and devices 2. Cleanliness and sanitation a. was well- groomed and properly dressed for cooking, used clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holder b. Observed sanitary handling of food 3. Conservation of nutrients a. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures b. followed the recipe correctly Score: (maximum 42 points) Comments: EGG DROP SOUP TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT INGRIDIENTS QUANTITY DESCRIPTION casserole 6 ½ cups prepared basic chicken stock stockpot with cover 2 tbsp. light soy sauce gas or electric stove 2 tbsp. sherry knife ¼ tsp. white pepper chopping board 2 large egg whites mortar and pestle 1 tbsp. salt strainer 2 tbsp. sesame oil measuring cup 1/8 tsp cornstarch measuring spoon 2 large eggs wooden spoon 1 tbsp. scallions , thinly sliced soup ladle
  • 265. LM-Cookery Grade 10 265 PROCEDURE: 1. In a 2-quart soup pot, pour 6 cups of chicken broth to a simmer. Add the soy sauce, sherry, pepper, and salt. 2. Beat the egg whites lightly. Drizzle into the chicken broth mixture 3. Mix the cornstarch with the remaining ½ cup chicken stock until lump free. Add to the soup. Stir in the sesame oil, garnish with scallions and serve hot. Evaluate your finished product, using the given score sheet. Criteria for Evaluating and Presenting Soup I. Products: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. attractive and appealing to appetite b. pleasing and good color combination c. ingredients cooked just right d. correct consistency 2. Palatability a. delicious b. taste just right 3. Nutritive value a. highly nutritious II. Procedures: 1. Use of Resources: a. kept working table is kept orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and devices 2. Cleanliness and sanitation a. was well- groomed and properly dressed for cooking, used clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holder b. Observed sanitary handling of food 3. Conservation of nutrients a. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures b. followed the recipe correctly Score: (maximum 42 points)
  • 266. LM-Cookery Grade 10 266 CREAMY CARROT SOUP TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT INGRIDIENTS QUANTITY DESCRIPTION casserole 22 grams butter stockpot with cover 1 medium onion, chopped gas or electric stove 3 strips bacon, chopped knife 600 grams carrots, cubed chopping board 1 pc small chicken cube measuring cup ½ cup cream measuring spoon dash salt/ pepper wooden spoon soup ladle PROCEDURE: 1. Melt butter in a large saucepan, add onion and bacon, stir constantly over heat until onion is soft. 2. Add carrots to pan, then chicken stock and cube, bring to a boil, reduce heat, cover, simmer for about 30 minutes or until carrots are tender. Remove saucepan from heat. 3. Blend or process mixture in several batches until smooth. 4. Return mixture to pan, stir in cream, reheat, and stir constantly without boiling. 5. Season with salt and pepper. Serve hot
  • 267. LM-Cookery Grade 10 267 Directions: Evaluate your finished product, using the given score sheet. Criteria for Evaluating and Presenting Soup I. Products: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. attractive and appealing to appetite b. pleasing and good color combination c. ingredients cooked just right d. correct consistency 2. Palatability a. delicious b. taste just right 3. Nutritive value a. highly nutritious II. Procedures: 1. Use of Resources: a. kept working table is kept orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and devices 2. Cleanliness and sanitation a. was well- groomed and properly dressed for cooking, used clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holder b. Observed sanitary handling of food 3. Conservation of nutrients a. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures b. followed the recipe correctly Score: (maximum 42 points) Comments:
  • 268. LM-Cookery Grade 10 268 CHICKEN AND CORN CHOWDER TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT INGRIDIENTS QUANTITY DESCRIPTION saucepan saucepot 200 grams butter gas or electric stove 1 tsp. salt knife 1 pc carrot, strips chopping board 1 pc onion, sliced mortar and pestle 6 cup water strainer 6 strips bacon strips measuring cup ½ cup chopped onion measuring spoon ½ cup cubed celery wooden spoon ½ cup cube carrot soup ladle 7 cup chicken stock ½ cup gold medal all-purpose flour 1 can small corn kernels PROCEDURE: 1. In a saucepan, put chicken breast, salt, carrot, onion, and water. Bring to a boil. Cook for 20 minutes. 2. Strain out chicken stock. Set aside. Remove chicken breast. Slice meat into cubes. Set aside. 3. In a saucepan, put bacon strips. Cook until brown. Set aside. 4. Retain about 2 tablespoons of the bacon drippings. 5. In a saucepan, using the bacon drippings, sauté onions until soft. Add chicken meat. Mix well. Add flour. Stir well. 6. Add the chicken mixture. Let it simmer. Stir until thick. To serve: Put soup in a bowl, top with chopped bacon. Serve while hot. It may be served with barley-garlic, bread, and bacon at the side.
  • 269. LM-Cookery Grade 10 269 Evaluate your finished product, using the given score sheet. Criteria for Evaluating and PresentingSoup I. Products: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. attractive and appealing to appetite b. pleasing and good color combination c. ingredients cooked just right d. correct consistency 2. Palatability a. delicious b. taste just right 3. Nutritive value a. highly nutritious II. Procedures: 1. Use of Resources: a. kept working table is kept orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and devices 2. Cleanliness and sanitation a. was well- groomed and properly dressed for cooking, used clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holder b. Observed sanitary handling of food 3. Conservation of nutrients a. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures b. followed the recipe correctly Score: (maximum 42 points) Comments:
  • 270. LM-Cookery Grade 10 270 Review of Learning Outcome 2 Directions: Read the question carefully and choose the letter of the correct answer. Write your answer in your test booklet. 1. Which of the following is a clear soup? A. bisque C. cream B. bouillon D. puree 2. What substance is added that gives taste to the food? A. decoration C. seasoning B. flavoring D. thickening 3. What type of soup can be served either hot or cold? A. ancient soup C. dessert soup B. cold soup D. fruit soup 4. What utensil is appropriate in serving hot soup? A. bowl C. soup bowl B. basin D. tray 5. What makes a soup appetizing? A. garnish C. taste B. ingredients D. all of the above Photo Gallery Directions:  Make a photo album of different soups creatively served here and abroad.  It should contain minimum of 10 pages and maximum of 15 pages  Label each creative presentation
  • 271. LM-Cookery Grade 10 271 Learning Outcome 3 Prepare Sauces Required for Menu Item Sauces One of the important components of a dish is the sauce. Saucesserve a particular function in the composition of a dish. These enhance the taste of the food to be served as well as add moisture or succulence to food that are cooked dry. Sauces also enhance the appearance of a dish by adding luster and sheen. A sauce that includes a flavor complementary to a food brings out the flavor of that food. It defines and enriches the overall taste and its texture. Sauce is a fluid dressing for poultry, meat, fish, dessert and other culinary products. Sauce is a flavorful liquid, usually thickened that is used to season, flavor and enhance other foods. It adds: 1. Moistness 4. Appearance (color and shine) 2. Flavor 5. Appeal 3. Richness Basic Sauces for Meat, Vegetables, and Fish 1. White sauce - Its basic ingredient is milk which is thickened with flour enriched with butter. 2. Veloute sauce- Its chief ingredients are veal, chicken and fish broth, thickened with blonde roux. 3. Hollandaise – It is a rich emulsified sauce made from butter, egg yolks, lemon juice and cayenne. Emulsion – (as fat in milk) consists of liquid dispersed with or without an emulsifier in another liquid that usually would not mix together. 4. Brown sauce / Espagnole – It is a brown roux-based sauce made with margarine or butter, flavor and brown stock. 5. Tomato – It is made from stock (ham/pork) and tomato products seasoned with spices and herbs. A. Variation of Sauces 1. Hot Sauces – made just before they are to be used. 2. Cold sauces – cooked ahead of time, then cooled, covered, and placed in the refrigerator to chill.
  • 272. LM-Cookery Grade 10 272 B. Thickening Agents Thickening agent – thickens sauce to the right consistency. The sauce must be thick enough to cling lightly to the food. Starches are the most commonly used thickeners for sauce making. Flour is the principal starch used. Other products include cornstarch, arrowroot, waxy maize, pre-gelatinized starch, bread crumbs, and other vegetables and grain products like potato starch and rice flour. Starches thicken by gelatinization, which is the process by which starch granules absorb water and swell many times their original sizes. Starch granules must be separated before heating in liquid to avoid lumping. Lumping occurs because the starch on the outside of the lump quickly gelatinizes into a coating that prevents the liquid from reaching the starch inside. Starch granules are separated in two ways:  Mixing the starch with fat. Example: roux  Mixing the starch with a cold liquid. Example: slurry Roux – is a cooked mixture of equal parts by weight of fat and flour. 1. Fat A. Clarified butter. Using clarified butter results to finest sauces because of its flavor. B. Margarine. Used as a substitute for butter because of its lower cost. C. Animal fat. Chicken fat, beef drippings and lard. D. Vegetable oil and shortening. Can be used for roux, but it adds no flavor.
  • 273. LM-Cookery Grade 10 273 2. Flour The thickening power of flour depends on its starch content. Bread flour is commonly used in commercial cooking. It is sometimes browned for use in brown roux. Heavily browned flour has only 1/3 the thickening power of not brown flour. A roux must be cooked so that the sauce does not have a raw, starchy taste of flour. The kinds of roux differ on how much they are cooked.  White roux – cooked just enough to cook the raw taste of flour; used for béchamel and other white sauces based on milk.  Blond roux – cooked little longer to a slightly darker color; used for veloutes´.  Brown roux – cooked to a light brown color and a nutty aroma. Flour may be browned before adding to the fat. It contributes flavor and color to brown sauces. C. Common Problems in Sauce 1. Discarding 3. poor texture 5. oil streaking 2. oiling-off 4. synersis (weeping)
  • 274. LM-Cookery Grade 10 274 METHODS OF PREPARING SAUCES Sauces Blanches (White Sauce) Purpose Butter Flour Liquid: Milk or Stock or Cream Light Sauce 1 tbsp. 1 tbsp. 1 cup General Sauce 1½ tbsps. 1 ½ tbsp. 1 cup Thick Sauce 5 tsps. 2 tbsps. 1 cup Soufflé Sauce 2 tbsps. 2 tbsps. 1 cup Hygienic Principles and Practices in Sauce Making 1. Make sure all equipment is perfectly clean. 2. Hold sauce no longer than 1 ½ hours. Make only enough to serve in this time, and discard any that is left over. 3. Never mix an old batch of sauce with a new batch. 4. Never hold hollandaise or béarnaise or any other acid product in aluminum. Use stainless-steel containers. Making Roux Procedure 1. Melt fat.
  • 275. LM-Cookery Grade 10 275 2. Add correct amount of flour, and stir until fat and flour is thoroughly mixed. 3. Cook to the desired degree of white, blond or brown roux. Basic Finishing Techniques in Sauce Making 1. Reduction  Using reduction to concentrate basic flavors. The water evaporates when simmered. The sauce becomes more concentrated and more flavorful.  Using reduction to adjust textures The sauce may be simmered until it reaches the desired thickness. Stock or other liquid may be added to thickened sauce to thin it out, then simmer to reduce to the right consistency.  Using reduction to add new flavors. Glazes or reduced stocks are added to sauces to give flavor.
  • 276. LM-Cookery Grade 10 276 2. Straining This is very important in order to produce a smooth, lump free sauce. Straining through a china cap lined with several layers of cheesecloth is effective. 3. Deglazing To deglaze means to swirl a liquid in a sauté pan to cooked particles of food remaining on the bottom. Liquid such as wine or stock is used to deglaze then reduced by one-half or three-fourths. This reduction, with the added flavor of the pan drippings, is then added to the sauce. 4. Enriching with butter and cream  Liaison mixture of egg yolks and cream added to sauce to give extra richness and smoothness.  Heavy cream- added to give flavor and richness to sauce  Butter - Add softened butter to hot sauce and swirl until it melts. Serve immediately to prevent separation of butter. Butter gives extra shine and smoothness to the sauce.
  • 277. LM-Cookery Grade 10 277 5. Seasoning – adds and develop flavor Ex: salt lemon juice cayenne white pepper sherry and Madeira Perform the following activity: MAKING PAN GRAVY Tools/Equipment Needed: Roasting pan Saucepan Strainer Ladle Procedure: Method 1 1. Remove the roast from the roasting pan. 2. Clarify the fat. 3. Deglaze the pan. 4. Combine with stock and simmer. 5. Make a roux or a slurry of arrowroot or cornstarch and water. 6. Thicken the gravy with the roux or cornstarch slurry. 7. Strain. 8. Adjust seasoning.
  • 278. LM-Cookery Grade 10 278 Method 2 1. Remove the roast from the roasting pan. 2. Clarify the fat. 3. Add flour to the roasting pan and make a roux. 4. Add stock. Stir until thickened and the pan is deglaze. 5. Strain. Skim excess fat. 6. Adjust consistency, if necessary, with more stock or more roux. 7. Season. Directions: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet. I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. Color combination is attractive and appealing b. ingredients cooked just right c. correct consistency not mushy/ very thick/thin consistency 2. Palatability a. delicious b. tastes just right 3.Nutritive Value a. highly nutritious II. Procedure: 1. Use of Resources: a. kept working table orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and devices 2. Cleanliness and Sanitation a. observed well-groomed and properly dressed for cooking, use clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holders b. observed sanitary handling of food
  • 279. LM-Cookery Grade 10 279 3. Conservation of Nutrients a. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.) COMMENTS: BÉCHAMEL SAUCE Purpose: Prepare and cook béchamel sauce using ingredients and procedures listed below: Tools/Equipment Needed: Saucepan Ladle Cheesecloth Spoon Ingredients: 4 tbsp. clarified butter 4 tbsp. bread flour ¼ gal milk ¼ pc bay leaf ¼ pc onions Salt to taste Nutmeg to taste White pepper to taste
  • 280. LM-Cookery Grade 10 280 Procedure: 1. Heat the butter in a heavy sauce pan in a very low heat. Add the flour and make a white roux. Cool the roux slightly. 2. In another sauce pan, scald the milk. Gradually add it to the roux, beating constantly. 3. Bring the sauce to a boil, stirring constantly. Reduce heat to simmer. 4. Stick the bay leaf and onions and add to the sauce. Simmer at least 15 - 30 minutes or more. Stir occasionally while cooking. 5. Adjust the consistency with more hot milk if necessary. 6. Season lightly with salt, nutmeg and white pepper. Spice flavor should not dominate. . Directions: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet. I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. Color combination is attractive and appealing b. ingredients cooked just right c. correct consistency not mushy/ very thick/thin consistency 2. Palatability a. delicious b. tastes just right 3.Nutritive Value a. highly nutritious II. Procedure: 4. Use of Resources: a. kept working table orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and devices 5. Cleanliness and Sanitation a. observed well-groomed and
  • 281. LM-Cookery Grade 10 281 properly dressed for cooking, use clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holders b. observed sanitary handling of food 6. Conservation of Nutrients a. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.) COMMENTS: HOLLANDAISE SAUCE Tools/Equipment Needed: Saucepan Beater Ladle Spoon Strainer Mixing bowl Ingredients: 1 kg. butter 12pcs egg yolks 4 tbsp. cold water 6tbsp . lemon juice Salt to taste Cayenne to taste
  • 282. LM-Cookery Grade 10 282 Procedure: 1. Clarify the butter. Keep the butter warm but not hot. 2. Place the egg yolks and cold water in a stainless steel bowl and beat well. Beat in a few drops of lemon juice. 3. Hold the bowl over a hot water bath and continue to beat until the yolks are thickened and creamy. 4. Remove the bowl from the heat. Using a ladle, slowly and gradually beat in the warm butter. Add the butter drop by drop at first. If the sauce becomes too thick to beat before all the butter is added, beat in a little of the lemon juice. 5. When all the butter has been added, beat in lemon juice to taste and adjust seasoning with salt and cayenne. Keep warm for service. Hold no longer than 1 ½ hours. Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet. I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. Color combination is attractive and appealing b. ingredients cooked just right c. correct consistency not mushy/ very thick/thin consistency 2. Palatability a. delicious b. tastes just right 3.Nutritive Value a. highly nutritious II. Procedure: 1. Use of Resources: a. kept working table orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and
  • 283. LM-Cookery Grade 10 283 devices 2. Cleanliness and Sanitation a. observed well-groomed and properly dressed for cooking, use clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holders b. observed sanitary handling of food 3. Conservation of Nutrients a. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.) COMMENTS: Review of Learning Outcome 3 Directions: Choose the correct answer from the given choices. Write the letter of your answer in your test notebook. 1. A roux-based sauce made with margarine or butter, flavor, and brown stock. A.brown sauce B. butter sauce C. Hollandaise sauce D. Tomato sauce 2. Sauce made from melted butter or margarine to which seasonings are added. A. brown sauce B. Butter sauce C. Hollandaise sauce D. Tomato sauce 3. Sauce made by forming an emulsion with fat such as margarine, butter or salad oil and egg. A. Brown sauced B. Butter sauce C. Hollandaise or a Dutch D. Tomato sauce
  • 284. LM-Cookery Grade 10 284 4. Sauce made with tomatoes and seasoned with spices and herbs. A. Brown sauce B. Butter sauce C. Hollandaise sauce D. Tomato sauce 5. Sauce made from a blend of salad oil, vinegar and seasoning. A. Brown sauce B. Butter sauce C. Tomato sauce D..White sauce Research Hour Directions: Make a research on at least ten sauces and the food where it is commonly used in the Philippines, and ten from different countries. Include pictures and descriptions. Learning Outcome 4 Store and Reconstitute Stocks, Sauces and Soups Storage of Stocks/Sauces and Soups Stock is a clear, flavored liquid that freezes well. Chilled stock can be frozen in 1 gallon amounts to be used for sauces. However, once a stock has been used to make a sauce, the sauce itself should not be frozen. Sauces do not freeze well and should be made in amounts needed on the day of production. The stock should never be put in the refrigerator while it is hot. The large volume of hot liquid can raise the internal temperature of the refrigerator to the point that the stock will cool sufficiently within two hours and may warm everything else in the refrigerator. A good way to cool the stock is to place the hot stock pot in a sink full of cold water and ice cubes until it is lukewarm but it should not exceed one hour. After leaving it uncovered for the first half hour and stirring occasionally to cool, it should be covered with an upside down plate to prevent evaporation which would cause the stock to become too
  • 285. LM-Cookery Grade 10 285 concentrated. Refrigerated stock cools better in shallow pans. If covered, stock lasts up to five days but it is best if used in two days. Storage of Starch and Sauces Sauces and starches should be kept in airtight container and stored in a cool dry place away from the moisture, oxygen, lights, and pests. Food made with starches contains egg, milk, cream of other dairy products all of which make them prone to bacterial contamination and to food-borne illnesses. Sauces made with these ingredients should be kept out of the temperature danger zone. Thickened sauce should also be prepared, served, and stored with caution. These products should be stored in the refrigerator and never left to stay for long at room temperature. Storing Equipment 1. Glass/Plastic Container 2. Stock pot 3. Refrigerator Ways to Reconstitute Stocks 1. Skim the surface and strain off the stock through a china cup lined with several layers of cheesecloth. 2. Cool the stock as quickly as possible as follows:  Set the pot in a sink with blocks, rack or some other object under it. This is called venting. This allows cold water to flow under the pot or around it.  Run cold water into the sink, but not higher than the level of the stock.  Stir the pot occasionally so the stocks cool evenly Cooling stock quickly and properly is important. Improperly cooled stock may spoil in 6 to 8 hrs. 3. When cool, refrigerate the stock in covered containers. Stock will keep 2 to 3 days if properly refrigerated. Stock can also be frozen and will last for several months. Ways to Reconstitute Stocks, Sauce and Soup 1. by adding water 2. By using other liquid like evaporating milk, coconut milk, and fruit juices
  • 286. LM-Cookery Grade 10 286 Photo Grid Make an album (collage or scrapbook) of different stocks, sauces, and soups. Includes description, ingredients, and procedures, storing procedures and how it isreconstituted. Your output will be evaluated using rubrics. Congratulations! You did a great job! Rest and relax a while then move on to the next lesson. Good luck!
  • 287. LM-Cookery Grade 10 287 Overview This lesson deals with the selection, preparation, cooking, presentation, and storage of poultry and game in a commercial kitchen or catering operation. At the end of lesson you are expected to do the following: 1. perform mise‘ en place; 2. cook poultry and game dishes; 3. plates/present and evaluate poultry and game bird dishes; and 4. store poultry and game bird Learning Outcome 1 Perform Mise’en Place Selecting and Purchasing Poultry and Game Poultry consumption in the Philippines has increased remarkably in the last decade. This is evident in the popularity of chicken dishes in restaurants all over the country. Poultry refers to several kinds of fowl that are used as food and the term includes chicken, turkey, duck, pigeon, and quail. These are usually domesticated raised mainly for meat and/or eggs. Birds such as smites that are hunted for food are games. Classification of Poultry and Games Bird Uses Chicken Duck Turkey Goose Quail Pigeon Meat, eggs Meat, eggs feathers Meat Meat, feather, eggs Meat, eggs Meat LESSON 2 PREPARE POULTRY AND GAME DISHES
  • 288. LM-Cookery Grade 10 288 Guinea fowl Wild duck Pheasant Meat Meat, feather Meat Chickens and other poultry may be divided into classes which are essentially of the same physical characteristics associated with age, sex, live weight and/or breed. 1. Broiler or Fryer. A broiler or fryer is young chicken, usually 9 to 12 weeks of age, of either sex, is tender-meat with soft, pliable, smooth- textured skin. 2. Roaster. A roaster is usually 5 to 6 months of age. 3. Capon. A capon is a surgically desexed male chicken usually under 8 months of age. 4. Stag. A stag is a male chicken, usually under 10 months of age, with coarse skin, with somewhat toughened and darkened flesh. 5. Hen or Stewing Chicken. It is a mature female chicken which is usually more than 10 months of age. It can also be a culled layer. 6. Cock or Rooster. It is a mature male chicken with coarse skin, toughened and darkened meat and hardened breastbone tip. 7. Jumbo Broiler. This is a large chicken about 4 kg. dressed weight which are on sale especially during the Christmas holiday. Other Poultry 1. Peking duck. This is a breed of duck that originated from China and is noted for its tender and flavorful meat. 2. Duck or Itik is available and popular in many towns of Rizal as fried itik. 3. Squab. This is a young immature pigeon of either sex and has extra tender meat. Selecting Good Quality Poultry and Game 1. Live Poultry a. It has clear eyes. b. A young chicken has fine and soft feet. If it is old, the feet are thick and scaly. c. The bone at the tip of the breast is soft in younger chicken and thick in older one. d. Small feathers indicate that the chicken is young.
  • 289. LM-Cookery Grade 10 289 2. Whole Poultry. These are slaughtered birds that have been bled and de-feathered. a. Their head, feet and viscera are still intact. b. They are clean, well fleshed. c. They have moderate fat coverings. d. They are free from pin feathers and show no cuts, scars or missing skin. 3. Dressed Poultry. These are slaughtered birds that have been bled, de- feathered, and the visceral organs are removed. a. The skin is smooth and yellow in color b. The breast is plump c. The thighs are well-developed d. It has no objectionable odor e. It is heavy and the skin is not watery 4. Ready-to-Cook. The dressed birds may be cut up and marinated or seasoned. 5. Poultry Parts. Several pieces of a single poultry part are usually packed in one carton, wrapped and chilled or frozen. The various poultry parts are divided into any of the following: a. dark meat – drumsticks, thighs, wings, neck, backs, and rib cage b. white meat – breasts c. giblets – gizzard and heart Nutritional Value/Components of Poultry and Game Like meat, poultry contains high quality proteins. Chicken, the most consumed among the fowls, has 22.6% protein, 76.3% water and traces of fat, vitamins and minerals. Poultry meat consists of dark and white muscles. Dark muscles are those found in parts of fowl‘s body which are always used. These are the legs, thigh, wings, neck and rib cage. These are richer in fat, have more connective tissues, and have higher riboflavin and myoglobin content. Most people prefer the dark meat than white meat (from the breast) because of its juiciness and flavor. Variety meats refer to the meat of such organs as the gizzard, heart, kidneys and liver.
  • 290. LM-Cookery Grade 10 290 Preparation of poultry for cooking  Slaughter and bleeding  Scaldding  Defeathering  Evisceration  Deboning Market forms of poultry Live poultry Live poultry should be healthy, alert, and well-feathered. Avoid poultry which have bruises, blisters and broken bones. Whole poultry Though not alive, the criteria for selecting live poultry also apply to whole poultry. Dressed poultry This is the most available poultry form in the market. Dressed poultry are actually slaughtered poultry with the head, feet, blood, feathers and internal organs removed. Good quality dressed poultry should be free from slime, off-odors and discoloration. Drawn poultry These are dressed poultry that have been chilled or frozen. They are usually available in groceries. Ready-to cook These are poultry parts such as wings, breast, thighs, or drumsticks which have been separately packed in a single container and frozen or chilled.
  • 291. LM-Cookery Grade 10 291 Different Cuts of Poultry Whole Chicken Whole Chickens are marketed either fresh or frozen. Halves The bird is split from front to back through the backbone and keel to produce 2 halves of approximately equal weight. Breast Quarters Halves may be further cut into which include the wing. A breast quarter, including portions of the back, is all white meat.
  • 292. LM-Cookery Grade 10 292 Split Breast A breast quarter with the wing removed. Split Breast without Back A breast quarter with wing and back portion removed. Boneless, Skinless Breast Split breast that has been skinned and deboned. 8-Piece Cut The whole bird is cut into 2 breast halves with ribs and back portion, 2 wings, 2 thighs with back portion and 2 drumsticks. The parts may be packaged together and labelled as whole cut-up chicken. These are usually sold without giblets. Whole Chicken Wing The whole chicken wing is an all-white meat portion composed of three sections; the drumette, mid- section, and tip.
  • 293. LM-Cookery Grade 10 293 Wing Drummettes The first section between the shoulder and the elbow. Wing Mid-Section with Tip The flat center section and the flipper (wing tip). Wing Mid-Section The section between the elbow and the tip, sometimes called the wing flat or mid-joint. Whole Chicken Leg Whole Chicken Leg The whole chicken leg is the drumstick-thigh combination. The whole leg differs from the leg quarter and does not contain a portion of the back. Boneless, Skinless Leg Whole chicken leg with skin and bone removed.
  • 294. LM-Cookery Grade 10 294 Thigh The thigh is the portion of the leg above the knee joint. Boneless, Skinless Thigh Thigh with skin and bone removed. Drumsticks Drumsticks include the lower portion of the leg quarter (the portion between the knee joint and the hock). Giblets Includes heart, liver, and neck.
  • 295. LM-Cookery Grade 10 295 Directions: Read each of the following questions carefully and choose the letter of the correct answer. Write your answer in your test notebook 1. What do you call the birds that are hunted for food? A. game C. poultry B. livestock D. swine 2. What do you call a desexed male chicken usually under 8 months old? A. broiler C. hen B. capon D. rooster 3. Which of the following poultry originated from China and is noted for its tender and flavorful meat? A. chicken C. itik B. goose D. pecking duck 4. What do you call the young immature pigeon of either sex with extra tender meat? A. duck C. rooster B. fryer D. squab 5. Which of the following classes of poultry is on sale especially during the Christmas Holiday? A. broiler C. jumbo broiler B. capon D. roaster 6. To what part of poultry does breast meat belong? A. dark meat C. variety meat B. tough meat D. white meat 7. Which of the following characteristics is a good quality of a live poultry? A. free from pin feathers and shows no cuts B. has clear eye C. heavy and the skin is watery D. thighs well develop 8. What do you call a young chicken that is usually 9 to 12 weeks of age ? A. fryer C. roaster B. hen D. stag 9. How many days should a whole chicken be refrigerated? A. 1 day C. 2 to 4 days B. 1 to 2 days D. 3 to 4 days 10. What is a male chicken under 10 months old? A. fryer C. rooster B. hen D. stag
  • 296. LM-Cookery Grade 10 296 Directions: Make a research on the following:  Market forms of poultry  Different cuts of poultry  Characteristics of good quality poultry  Preparation of poultry for cooking
  • 297. LM-Cookery Grade 10 297 Learning Outcome 2 Cook Poultry and Game Dishes Principles of Poultry Cookery 1. The fat distribution and maturity of the fowl affect the quality of the product. Mature birds are best cooked using moist heat. Dry heat is suitable for young birds. 2. The best cooking temperature for poultry is at low to moderate heat. This temperature range produces a more flavorful and tender product. This also minimizes nutrient loss and shrinkage of meat. 3. To prevent the risk of microbial contamination, stuffing of turkey and chickens should be done immediately before roasting. It is best not to fill the cavity completely as this will prevent the poultry from being thoroughly cooked. 4. Because of its susceptibility to microbial growth, cooked poultry should be eaten immediately or refrigerated if not consumed. Leftover stuffing should be stored separately to prevent contamination. 5. Because poultry meat is pale-colored, it is best to employ dry heat cooking with fat for a brown color. 6. When roasting chicken, cuts should be placed with the breast-side down to produce a juicier and tenderer product. 7. To improve the palatability of lean poultry meat, basting can be done. Causes of Food Spoilage and Contamination All food should be safe and free from contamination and spoilage at all points in its journey from its source until it reaches the consumers. However, food contamination is a serious public health problem resulting in foodborne diseases that affect many people every year. Hence, awareness of potential sources of food contamination is an important component of good nutrition and good health. Food may be contaminated by different microorganisms or by chemicals that can cause health problems for anyone who eats it. The common causes of food contamination and food spoilage are: 1. Failure to properly refrigerate food 2. Failure to thoroughly heat or cook food 3. Infected employees/workers because of poor personal hygiene practices 4. Foods prepared a day or more before they are served
  • 298. LM-Cookery Grade 10 298 5. Raw, contaminated ingredients incorporated into foods that receive no further cooking 6. Cross-contamination of cooked foods through improperly cleaned equipment 7. Failure to reheat foods to temperature that kills bacteria 8. Prolonged exposure to temperatures favorable to bacterial growth Poultry Cookery Poultry, like meat may be cooked by either dry or moist heat method. The choice of method depends mainly upon the age of the bird instead of location of the part in the carcass as in the case of meats. Fat content should also be taken into consideration. 1. Moist Heat Method As discussed earlier in this lesson, chicken are categorized into classes. All classes of chicken and other poultry for that matter may be cooked by moist-heat cookery. Common Filipino dishes are tinola, sinampalukang manok, manok na pinaupo, and relyeno. 2. Dry Heat Method The dry method is usually reserved for young tender poultry. The poultry class of these chickens is specially termed ―broilers and fryers‖ Somewhat older but still immature birds such as capons and roasters are also suitable for roasting. They are still tender but have more fat than the broilers or fryers. Older birds need to be tenderized by moist cooking prior to dry heat cooking. One point to remember in poultry cookery; moist heat cookery may be applied to all classes and kinds of poultry but dry heat cookery is reserved for tender birds.
  • 299. LM-Cookery Grade 10 299 Steps in Fabricating Chicken 1. Cut along center of breast bone 2. Here you can view the cut made
  • 300. LM-Cookery Grade 10 300 3. Using the knife, scimitar may be preferred but a fillet knife would work well too. Cut along one side of the breast bone to the base of the chicken. 4. Separate skin that is attached to breast from leg quarter 5. With your thumb under the wing joint press upward and out to separate joint
  • 301. LM-Cookery Grade 10 301 6. With knife, cut between joint to remove and cut any skin not separated from carcass yet. 7. Here is a picture of detached breast and wing. 8. Cut around wing joint to remove wing.
  • 302. LM-Cookery Grade 10 302 9. A small thin piece of meat located on underside of breast that can be removed by pulling the tenderloin, good for chicken tenders. Repeat steps 3-9 for the other side of breast. 10. Cut around leg quarter going up high towards backbone then circling down toward other side. 11. Halfway through you will hit the joint.
  • 303. LM-Cookery Grade 10 303 12. Using your thumb push up and out to snap apart joint. 13. Finish cut through joint to remove leg quarter. Repeat steps 10-13 for other leg quarter. Deboning Chicken STEP 1: Place the chicken, breast side up, on a clean cutting surface. Stretch out each wing flat against the board by pulling the tip. With a boning knife, cut off the wing tip and next joint, leaving the largest wing bone still attached.
  • 304. LM-Cookery Grade 10 304 STEP 2: At the neck, cut out the wishbone by pulling the skin up and out of the way and sliding the knife along the underside of the wishbone. Continue cutting around and under the wishbone until it is free and can be pulled out with your fingers. STEP 3: Turn the bird over, and with breast side down, cut along the backbone from the neck to the tail. STEP 4: With short sharp strokes of your knife, keeping the knife close to the bones cut the flesh and skin, carefully using your fingers to pull the flesh away from the carcass. Cut through the ball-and-socket joints connecting the wing and thigh bones to the carcass, so that they are separated from the carcass but still attached to the skin. When step is completed on both sides, meat will be attached only along the ridge of the breastbone. Gently (the skin tears easily) pull to separate the breastbone and carcass from the flesh.
  • 305. LM-Cookery Grade 10 305 STEP 5: Cut the flesh from the curved (saber) bone near the wing and remove the bone. STEP 6: The partially-boned bird with leg and wing bones left in, is now ready for stuffing. STEP 7: While holding the wing bone from inside the bird, cut through the tendons and scrape the meat from the bone with the knife. Pull out the bone, using the knife to free it. STEP 8: Cut off end of the leg bone using a cleaver or thick-bladed cook‘s knife. Note: The use of a cook‘s knife for chopping through chicken bone is acceptable for this application but not recommended for cutting through other bone. STEP 9: Repeat step #7 to remove the leg bone. Reposition wing and leg meat so skin side is out.
  • 306. LM-Cookery Grade 10 306 STEP 10: The whole chicken is now completely deboned, with the skin intact and ready to be stuffed, rolled, and roasted. Now, you are ready for Rellenong Manok Recipe (Stuffed deboned Chicken) Activity No.2 – Market Visit Directions: This will be a collaborative activity. Follow the instructions below:  Find a partner  Visit a supermarket or a wet market near you and do the following:  List down the market forms of poultry being sold  Take note of the appearance, color, odor and its cuts  Make a report of your activity  Submit your report in a short bond paper with folder
  • 307. LM-Cookery Grade 10 307 Directions: Demonstrate the steps in fabricating and deboning chicken by following the procedures on page 279. Your performance will be evaluated using the rubric below: Directions: Ask the teacher to assess your performance in the following critical task and performance criteria below You will be rated based on the overall evaluation on the right side. SCORING RUBRICS Level Achieved PERFORMANCE LEVELS 10 - Can perform the skill very satisfactorily without supervision and with initiative and adaptability to problem situations. 7 - Can perform the skill satisfactorily without assistance or supervision. 4 - Can perform the skill less satisfactorily but requires some assistance and/or supervision. 1 - Can perform parts of the skill satisfactorily, but requires considerable assistance and/or supervision. Instructor will initial level achieved.
  • 308. LM-Cookery Grade 10 308 Preparation and Cooking of Chicken Chicken Galantina/Relleno Direction: Find a partner and perform the given chicken recipe. Performance activity will be evaluated based on the given rubric TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT INGREDIENTS QUANTITY DESCRIPTION knife chopping board measuring cup measuring spoon oven wooden spoon pinoykitchenette.blogspot.com 1 ½ k ½ k 300 g 4 pieces 3 tbsp. 1/2 cup 2 pieces 3/4 cup 3/4 cup 1/2 cup 1/2 cup 1/2 cup 5 tbsp. 3/4 cup 1 1/2 tsp. 1/2 tsp. whole chicken, deboned ground pork ground beef ground chicken sausage sweet pickle relish raisins hard boiled eggs minced ham cup chopped Vienna sausage minced onion grated carrot chopped red bell pepper bread crumbs soy sauce Juice of 1 lemon salt ground black pepper
  • 309. LM-Cookery Grade 10 309 Cooking Procedure 1. Combine ground pork, ham, sausage, bell pepper, carrot, onion, raisins, sweet pickle relish, salt, and pepper. Mix well. 2. Add the bread crumbs and then continue mixing. Set aside. 3. Combine lemon juice and soy sauce in a large container. Stir. 4. Marinate the whole chicken in the lemon and soy sauce mixture for 30 minutes. 5. Remove the chicken from the mixture and then stuff with half of the meat and vegetable mixture. 6. Arrange the boiled eggs inside the chicken and then continue to put-in the rest of the meat mixture. 7. Secure the chicken by wrapping it in aluminum foil 8. Meanwhile pre heat oven at 350 degree Fahrenheit. 9. Bake the Chicken Relleno for about 1 hour 10. Remove from oven. Remove aluminum foil on the surface then brush with butter on top and on side 11. Bake again for 15-20 minutes or until golden brown. 12. Allow to cool 13. Slice into serving pieces. 14. Serve. Share and enjoy!
  • 310. LM-Cookery Grade 10 310 Direction: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet. I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. Color combination is attractive and appealing b. ingredients cooked just right c. correct consistency not mushy/ very thick/thin consistency 2. Palatability A. delicious B. tastes just right 3.Nutritive Value A. highly nutritious II. Procedure: 2. Use of Resources: a. kept working table orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and devices 2. Cleanliness and Sanitation a. observed well-groomed and properly dressed for cooking, use clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holders b. observed sanitary handling of food 3. Conservation of Nutrients A. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.) COMMENTS:
  • 311. LM-Cookery Grade 10 311 Italian Chicken Roll-Ups TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT INGREDIENTS QUANTITY DESCRIPTION casserole 8 boneless skinless chicken breast halves (4 ounces each) thin slices (4 ounces) ham slices cheese, halved cup seasoned bread crumbs cup grated cheese cup minced fresh parsley cup milk Cooking spray gas or electric stove knife chopping board 8 measuring cup measuring spoon 4 wooden spoon 2/3 1/2 .1/4 1/2 frying pan Procedure 1. Preheat oven to 425°. 2. Flatten chicken to 1/4-in. thickness. 3. Place a slice of ham and half slice of provolone cheese on each piece of chicken. 4. Roll up from a short side and tuck in ends; secure with a toothpick. 5. In a shallow bowl, combine crumbs, Romano cheese and parsley. 6. Pour milk into another bowl. Dip chicken rolls in milk, then roll in crumb mixture. 7. Place roll-ups, seam side down, on a greased baking sheet. Spritz chicken with cooking spray. 8. Bake, uncovered, 25 minutes or until meat is no longer pink. 9. Remove toothpicks. Yield: 8 servings.
  • 312. LM-Cookery Grade 10 312 Direction: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet below. I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance A. Color combination is attractive and appealing B. ingredients cooked just right C. correct consistency not mushy/ very thick/thin consistency 2. Palatability A. delicious B. tastes just right 3.Nutritive Value A. highly nutritious II. Procedure: 3. Use of Resources: a. kept working table orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and devices 4. Cleanliness and Sanitation a. observed well-groomed and properly dressed for cooking, use clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holders b. observed sanitary handling of food 5. Conservation of Nutrients A. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.) COMMENTS:
  • 313. LM-Cookery Grade 10 313 Learning Outcome 3 Plate/Present Poultry and Game Dishes Portion Control for Cooked Poultry and Game Chicken  Meat shrinks about 25% when cooked. A quarter-pound hamburger (4 oz.) will actually yield a 3 ounce portion after cooking. An 8 ounce steak will yield about 6 ounces of cooked meat.  A chicken breast is generally 3 - 4 ounces.  A chicken thigh is usually 2 ounces, while a leg is 1 - 2 ounces.  Chicken wings are high in fat. It takes 2 wings to equal a 1 ounce choice (or exchange) with that. How to Do Control Portion Sizes – Portion Control Secrets It‘s not always what you eat, but how much you eat - It‘s the size of your servings that really counts! Most of us tend to underestimate the amount of food we eat and tend to overestimate the recommended portion sizes for many foods. Almost everyone underestimates the amount of calories they consume, and people who weigh more do so, to a greater degree. Portion: A ―portion‖ is how much food you choose to eat at one time (breakfast, lunch, dinner, or snack), whether in a restaurant, from a package, or in your own kitchen. Portions can be bigger or smaller than the recommended food servings. There is no standard portion size and no single right or wrong portion size. Serving: A ―serving‖ size is the amount of food listed (and recommended) on a product‘s Nutrition Facts (panel of packaged food) or the amount of food recommended in the Food Guide Pyramid and the Dietary Guidelines* for Americans. Sometimes, the portion size and serving size match; sometimes they do not. A serving is a standard amount used to help give advice about how much to eat, or to identify how many calories and nutrients are in a food.
  • 314. LM-Cookery Grade 10 314 How to Control Portion Sizes: Eating smaller portions of food is one of the easiest ways to cut back on calories—but it can also be one of the most challenging, with the current trend of super-sizing. How do you know a reasonable portion of food when you see it? Visualize the objects mentioned below when eating out, planning a meal, or grabbing a snack. Factors to consider in presenting/plating poultry dishes Types of service wares Plating Garnishing Sauces Accompaniments Plating/ Presenting Poultry Dishes Creative Food Presentation Techniques The way food is presented affects a person‘s perception of how it will taste. People instinctively reject bruised apples and browned bananas, and recognize well-marbled beef and perfectly ripe produce. Prepared dishes work in the same manner. The perfect dish includes food that tastes as good as it looks. Much of the artistry of cooking comes after the food has been cooked and it is time to transfer it from pot to plate. Here, chefs rise above cooks as they
  • 315. LM-Cookery Grade 10 315 arrange the different components on a plate like interior designers place furniture to create culinary masterpieces. The home chef faces similar circumstances on a nightly basis. Whether you‘re entertaining, preparing a special meal or jazzing up an old favorite, these food presentation tips will set your dishes apart from the crowd. Plating the Food Plating is the act of arranging the meal on the individual plate immediately before it‘s served. Presentation should look natural. It should feel as though everything that is on the plate is meant to be should feel as though everything that is on the plate is meant to be exactly where it is. Try to strike a balance between having enough food on the plate to convey hospitality without overcrowding the plate—and potentially offending your guest. Try to leave one-third of the plate empty, and plate your dish immediately before you serve it. It goes without saying that hot food should be hot and cold food should be cold; always check the temperature of your food before you serve it to a guest. After you have put the food on the plate, check to see that the plate is clean. Plate edges should be especially immaculate. Clean spills or sauces away with a moistened clean sponge or paper towel.
  • 316. LM-Cookery Grade 10 316 Decorate the Frame If the food is the masterpiece, then the plate is its frame. Adapt artistic framing strategies to your cooking for a quick way to improve your food‘s presentation. Buy beautiful bowls and plates in a variety of shapes and colors. The same bowl of soup looks dramatically different in a small Asian ceramic cup and an oversized, shallow white French consommé bowl. You can also decorate the rim of a plate, just as you‘d decorate a frame. Use culinary elements like colorful spices or confectioner‘s sugar; specialty salts like Hawaiian alaea or Himalayan pink salt which also lend themselves wonderfully to this purpose. For small appetizers, part of the presentation is making the display platter look beautiful. Make a bed of uncooked soba noodles or flat rice sticks, shafts of wheat, or large sprigs of fresh herbs like rosemary and thyme. This is also a good trick to use if you are preparing a hors d‘oeuvre platter. If you‘re decorating a plate that will hold hot food, be aware that by the time you‘re finished garnishing the plate, the food may not be hot. In some cases, you can garnish the plate before you plate the food. If this is impossible, work quickly and have all of your garnishes close by.
  • 317. LM-Cookery Grade 10 317 Mix Shapes, Colors and Textures Food is naturally beautiful. Combine foods with different shapes, colors and textures on the same plate. Grilled filet mignon becomes even more decadent when it appears on the plate with stark white mashed potatoes and a bright green steamed vegetable. In this case, these different elements combine for a dish that catches the eye. If your plate will contain multiple elements, use an odd number of dishes rather than an even number for further interest. Grilled filet mignon with mashed potatoes and steamed asparagus looks great, but add a stack of sliced tomatoes and the combination becomes regimented and less remarkable. Try to integrate a variety of shapes in each dish. Risotto is boring when paired with rice, as the two are nearly identical in shape, color and size. Meatballs and Brussels sprouts are different colors but the same shape. But meatballs and rice make an interesting combination, as do risotto and Brussels sprouts. For a restaurant-worthy twist on traditional side-by-side plating, stack the components of your dish vertically. Arrange asparagus into a teepee on the plate, with a dipping sauce in the center; make salads more cylindrical than vertical. This approach can make any plate instantly more interesting. Keep in mind that sometimes the most aesthetically pleasing plate of food does not include a garnish. For example, crème brulee features a delicate, crunchy top layer. While its appearance can certainly be improved with a small garnish or beautiful brulee dish, the texture and color of the caramelized sugar is beautiful enough on its own.
  • 318. LM-Cookery Grade 10 318 Garnishes Garnishes can be as simple or intricate as you like. For a twist on the traditional parsley sprig, use a sprig or two of an herb or spice that was used in the dish. A ham flavored with rosemary might feature a sprig of rosemary on each plate. Spicy pad Thai can include a wedge of lemon or lime and a dash of paprika sprinkled around the plate. You can also garnish with small fans of fruits and vegetables like cucumber, pineapple, avocado, citrus, kiwi or apple. Slice the fruit or vegetable into thin rounds, leaving ¼‖ of flesh connected on one side to hold the rounds together. Gently spread out the slices and arrange them neatly in an arc. Several kitchen tools are available that will help you transform nearly any fruit into an attractive garnish for a plate. The key to selecting a garnish is picking a garnish that will improve the dish. Garnishes add color and continue a theme, such as a brightly colored orchid on top of passion fruit crème brulee. They can accent a dish‘s color, like chives on top of a baked potato, or a dish‘s flavor. Garnishes can provide complementary flavor, like peanuts in pad Thai, or contrasting flavor, like a lemon wedge with seafood. An entrée‘s sauce also makes a delicious garnish. Swirl it around or atop the plate for visual and gustatory interest. The way food looks on the plate is the most commonly ignored facet of cooking at home. Too often, other considerations such as time, money, and food allergies push presentation out of mind. Since most children and their families eat their main meals at home, attractive food presentation is just as important at home as it is in a restaurant. A dish that looks good is more likely
  • 319. LM-Cookery Grade 10 319 to be eaten. Even picky kids will forego sugary cereal in favor of Mickey Mouse-shaped waffles or a plate with over easy egg eyes, a bacon smile and potato cheeks. You can even trick your own palate into liking Brussels sprouts, zucchini and other healthy produce with a beautiful arrangement on a dish. Review of Learning Outcome 3 Direction: Choose the correct answer from the given choices. Write the letter on your answer sheet. 1. Act of arranging the meal on the individual plate immediately before it‘s serving A. Garnishing B. Cooking C. Plating D. Serving 2. If the food is the masterpiece, then the plate is its A. Accessories B. Base C. body D. Frame 3. To enhance in appearance by adding decorative touches A. Plating B. Presenting C. Garnishing D. Serving
  • 320. LM-Cookery Grade 10 320 Learning Outcome 4 Store Poultry and Game Bird Techniques in Storing Poultry Poultry may be frozen whole, in halves, cut into pieces, or parts after they are dressed. Parts can be packed separately, ready to cook, or for easy meal preparation and thawing. Handling and Storage of Poultry Poultry spoils very quickly unless it is properly handled and stored. After being brought home from the market, it should be unwrapped as quickly as possible and wiped off with a damp cloth. Then it should be lightly covered with waxed paper, placed in shallow utensils and stored in a cold part of the refrigerator near the freezing unit or ice. Cooked poultry should be cooled as quickly as possible, covered to prevent drying and refrigerated. Removing the bones saves space. Frozen poultry must be kept in the freezing unit until it is thawed for cooking. Freezing and Thawing Poultry To prepare poultry properly for freezing, it should be wrapped tightly in a moisture-vapor proof film, foil or paper and then frozen at -170oC (0oF) or lower. Although there are no abrupt changes in quality during the first few months of poultry storage, it has always been a good practice to use these chickens first which have been in storage longest and those with torn wrapper. Storage Time for Poultry and Game Product Refrigerator (35-40oF) Freezer ( 0oF) Chicken and turkey (Whole) Chicken (pieces) Turkey ( pieces ) Duck and Goose ( whole ) Giblets Wild duck, pheasant. Goose ( whole) 1 – 2 days 1 – 2 days 1 – 2 days 1 – 2 days 1 – 2 days 1 – 2 days 12 months 9 months 6 months 6 months 3 – 4 months 6 months
  • 321. LM-Cookery Grade 10 321 Cooked poultry dishes Canned poultry, opened 2 – 4 days 1 day 4 – 6 months NR It is not recommended to refreeze poultry after it has been thawed. Freezing and thawing release fluids called drip and the chances of bacterial spoilage are increased. Water holding capacity of meat is also affected by subsequent thawing. When thawing, it is advisable to thaw slowly inside the refrigerator to give tissues a better chance to rehydrate. Immediately cook the thawed meat since bacterial growth is rapid upon thawing. Slow thawing may be effected by placing the 1 to 2 kg. chicken in the refrigerator for 12 to 24 hours or to place it under running tap water for ½ to 1 hour, in their original wrap In both cases. However, frozen poultry or any other market forms of poultry should not be allowed to thaw or soak in a bowl of water because of possible bacterial build. Safety Practices in Handling and Storing Poultry and Game Products How to Handle Chicken Safely Raw chicken and poultry can carry the salmonella bacteria, which is responsible for more cases of food poisoning than any other pathogen. Fortunately, it's easy to avoid getting sick from chicken and poultry, as long as you follow safe food handling practices. Safe Shopping for Chicken and Poultry During distribution to retail stores, fresh chicken is kept cold in order to extend its shelf life as well as to prevent bacteria growth. Packages of chicken should feel cold to the touch, and should be among the last items you select before checking out. Packages of chicken should be wrapped in plastic bags to prevent leakage onto other items in your grocery cart.
  • 322. LM-Cookery Grade 10 322 Once you're home, you should immediately place your chicken in a refrigerator that maintains a temperature of 40°F or colder, and use it within 2 days. Otherwise, it should be frozen at 0°F. Safe Handling of Chicken and Poultry Just like meat, fish or any animal-based food product, raw or undercooked chicken carry certain bacteria. These bacteria can cause illness in large numbers. Therefore, to avoid illness we need to limit bacteria's ability to multiply, or kill them altogether. Limiting their ability to multiply requires making sure that food products are not left at room temperatures — or specifically, temperatures between 40°F and 140°F — for more than an hour. And remember, freezing doesn't kill bacteria, either — it just makes them cold. The only way to kill food-borne pathogens is by thoroughly cooking the food. Another concern with respect to working with uncooked poultry is cross- contamination. Cross-contamination can happen when raw poultry — or even just its juices — somehow come into contact with any other food products but especially ones that are already cooked or ones that will be eaten raw, such as salad vegetables or greens. Fresh vs. Frozen Chicken and Poultry If the label on a raw poultry product bears the term "fresh," that indicates that it has never been colder than 26°F. Poultry that has at any time been kept at 0°F or colder must have a label indicating that it is "frozen" or "previously frozen," whatever the case may be. Interestingly, poultry that has been kept at temperatures colder than 26°F but warmer than 0°F can be labeled neither fresh nor frozen.
  • 323. LM-Cookery Grade 10 323 Chicken and Poultry Product Dating Federal regulations don't require poultry products to be dated. However, most retailers will date the chicken products that they sell. If they do opt to date the product, regulations do require that there be a phrase signifying whether the date is a "sell by" date or a "use before" date, and the explanation must appear right next to the date. Basics for Handling Food Safely  Shopping  Storage  Preparation  Thawing  Cooking  Serving  Leftovers  Refreezing Safe steps in food handling, cooking, and storage are essential to prevent foodborne illness. You can't see, smell, or taste harmful bacteria that may cause illness. In every step of food preparation, follow the four Fight BAC! ™ guidelines to keep food safe:  Clean — Wash hands and surfaces often.  Separate — Don't cross-contaminate.  Cook — Cook to proper temperatures.  Chill — Refrigerate promptly. Shopping  Purchase refrigerated or frozen items after selecting your non- perishables.  Never choose meat or poultry in packaging that is torn or leaking.  Do not buy food without expiration dates
  • 324. LM-Cookery Grade 10 324 Storage  Always refrigerate perishable food within 2 hours (1 hour when the temperature is above 90 °F).  Check the temperature of your refrigerator and freezer with an appliance thermometer. The refrigerator should be at 40 °F or below and the freezer at 0 °F or below. Cook or freeze fresh poultry, fish, ground meats, and variety meats within 2 days; other beef, veal, lamb, or pork, within 3 to 5 days. Perishable food such as meat and poultry should be wrapped securely to maintain quality and to prevent meat juices from getting onto other food. To maintain quality when freezing meat and poultry in its original package, wrap the package again with foil or plastic wrap that is recommended for the freezer.  In general, high-acid canned food such as tomatoes, grapefruit, and pineapple can be stored on the shelf for 12 to 18 months. Low-acid canned food such as meat, poultry, fish, and most vegetables will keep 2 to 5 years — if the can remains in good condition and has been stored in a cool, clean, and dry place. Discard cans that are dented, leaking, bulging, or rusted. Preparation Always wash hands with warm water and soap for 20 seconds before and after handling food. Don't cross-contaminate. Keep raw meat, poultry, fish, and their juices away from other food. After cutting raw meats, wash cutting board, utensils, and countertops with hot, soapy water. Cutting boards, utensils, and countertops can be sanitized by using a solution of 1 tablespoon of unscented, liquid chlorine bleach in 1 gallon of water. Marinate meat and poultry in a covered dish in the refrigerator. Thawing Refrigerator: The refrigerator allows slow, safe thawing. Make sure thawing meat and poultry juices do not drip onto other food. Cold Water: For faster thawing, place food in a leak-proof plastic bag. Submerge in cold tap water. Change the water every 30 minutes. Cook immediately after thawing.
  • 325. LM-Cookery Grade 10 325  Microwave: Cook meat and poultry immediately after microwave thawing Cooking Cook all raw poultry, beef, pork, lamb and veal steaks, chops, and roasts to a minimum internal temperature of 145 °F as measured with a food thermometer before removing meat from the heat source. For safety and quality, allow meat to rest for at least three minutes before carving or consuming. For reasons of personal preference, consumers may choose to cook meat to higher temperatures. Poultry: Cook all poultry to an internal temperature of 165 °F as measured with a food thermometer. Serving  Hot food should be held at 140 °F or warmer.  Cold food should be held at 40 °F or colder.  When serving food at a buffet, keep food hot with chafing dishes, slow cookers, and warming trays. Keep food cold by nesting dishes in bowls of ice or use small serving trays and replace them often.  Perishable food should not be left out more than 2 hours at room temperature (1 hour when the temperature is above 90 °F). Left overs  Discard any food left out at room temperature for more than 2 hours (1 hour if the temperature was above 90 °F).  Place food into shallow containers and immediately put in the refrigerator or freezer for rapid cooling.  Use cooked leftovers within 4 days.  Reheat leftovers to 165 °F. Refreezing Meat and poultry defrosted in the refrigerator may be refrozen before or after cooking. If thawed by other methods, cook before refreezing.
  • 326. LM-Cookery Grade 10 326 Post-Test Directions: Read and understand the statements/questions below. Choose the letter of the correct answer and write it on your test notebook. 1. As a chef of a fine dining restaurant, Genie simmers meat, fish, and vegetables. Which of the following liquids is a by-product after the different food stuffs have been simmered? A. glaze C. stock B. sauce D. water 2. Which of the following stocks uses veal bone as its main ingredient? A. brown stock C. prawn stock B. ham stock D. white stock 3. What kind of stock uses fish as its main ingredient? A. brown stock C. glace viande B. fish stock D. ham stock 4. What stock uses chicken bone as its main ingredient? A. fish stock C. prawn stock B. ham stock D. chicken stock 5. Among the different types of stock, which one is the easiest to prepare? A. brown stock C. white stock B. fish stock D. vegetable stock 6. What stock is made by boiling prawn shell? A. fish stock C. prawn stock B. ham stock D. vegetable stock 7. As a rule, which should not be added to the stock because it causes saltiness? A. MSG C. spices B. salt D. sugar 8. Mrs. Sante will be having visitors for dinner. If she will prepare stock for their dinner, which of the following flavoring agents will she use to give aroma to the stock? A. aromatic flavoring C. ginger B. garlic D. smoke
  • 327. LM-Cookery Grade 10 327 9. What makes the stock tasty and appetizing? A. appearance C. ingredients B. color D. smell 10. Which of the following is a clear soup? A. bisques C. cream B. bouillon D. puree 11. Which of the following examples is a thick soup? A. bisques C. consommé B. bouillon D. fruit 12. Which of the following is not a thickening agent? A. flour C. rice B. grain D. salt 13. Which of the four basic sauces whose basic ingredient is milk is thickened with flour enriched with butter? A. Hollandaise sauce C. veloute sauce B. savory butter D. white sauce 14. Which among the four basic sauces has a chief ingredient of chicken broth thickened with flour and enriched with butter seasoning? A. Hollandaise sauce C. veloute sauce B. savory butter D. white sauce 15. Which of the four basic sauces has three basic ingredients like butter, egg yolk, and lemon juice with seasoning for accent? A. Hollandaise sauce C. white sauce B. savory butter D. veloute sauce 16. Which of the four basic sauces has a basic ingredient like butter that is creamed and blended with other ingredients to give individual flavor? A. Hollandaise sauce C. veloute sauce B. savory butter D. white sauce 17. Which of the following is not a thickening agent? A. dairy cream C. flour B. egg D. spice 18. What do you call birds that are hunted for food? A. game C. poultry B. livestock D. swine 19. Which of the following poultry originated from China and is noted for its tender and flavorful meat? A. chicken C. itik B. goose D. pecking duck
  • 328. LM-Cookery Grade 10 328 20. What do you call to young immature pigeon of either sex with extra tender meat is called . A. duck C. rooster B. fryer D. squab 21. Poultry is composed of different parts. Which of the following do breast meat belong? A. dark meat C. variety meat B. tough meat D. white meat 22. Which of the following characteristics is a good quality of a live poultry? A. free from pin feathers and shows no cuts B. has clear eye C. heavy and the skin is watery D. well-develop thighs 23. What do you call to young chicken that is usually 9 to 12 weeks of age? A. fryer C. roaster B. hen D. stag 24. How many days should a whole chicken should be refrigerated? A. 1 day C. 2 to 4 days B. 1 to 2 days D. 3 to 4 days 25. How do you classify the fleshy part of chicken like breast? A. entrails C. viscera B. dark meat D. white meat 26. In cookery, we apply different cooking methods depending on the ingredients that we have. If you will cook a matured poultry, which of the following methods will you apply? A. boiling C. roasting B. frying D. stewing 27. What cookery method is suitable for the less tender cuts? A. boiling C. roasting B. frying D. stewing 28. What is the best cooking temperature for poultry? A. high temperature C. low to moderate temperature B. low temperature D. moderate temperature 29. What factor affects the poultry meat‘s tenderness and juiciness? A. age C. cuts B. cookery D. sex 30. Which of the following can be done to prevent drying when reheating? A. cook using sauces and gravy B. overcook the poultry meat C. remove fat before cooking D. none of the above
  • 329. LM-Cookery Grade 10 329 QUARTER 4 PREPARING AND COOKING MEAT Overview This quarter will enable students or learners to acquire competencies in: preparing and cooking meat which includes: performing mise‘ en place, cooking and evaluating meat dishes, presenting/plating meat dishes, and storing meat. Objectives: At the end of the quarter students are expected to: 1. perform mise ‗en place; 2. cook meat cuts; 3. present and evaluate meat dishes; and 4. store meat. Pre-Test Directions: Read the following statements/questions carefully and choose the letter with the correct answer. Write your answer in your test note book. 1. What animal produces veal meat? A. calf C. hog B. deer D. sheep 2. Which of the following market forms of meat does not undergo chilling? A. cured meat C. frozen meat B. fresh meat D. processed meat 3. What part of the meat helps you identify the less tender cuts? A. bone C. flesh B. fat D. ligament 4. What part of the meat has the greatest amount of quality protein? A. Bone C. Flesh B. Fat D. Ligament
  • 330. LM-Cookery Grade 10 330 5. Which of the following meat cuts requires long and slow cooking temperature? A. less tender C. tender B. slightly tough D. tough 6. What is a long – bladed hatchet or a heavy knife used by a butcher? A. butchers knife C. cleaver knife B. chopper knife D. set of slicing knife 7. Which of the cooking methods does not belong to dry heat method? A. baking C. roasting B. broiling D. stewing 8. What do you call the cooking method when meat is cooked in steaming liquid in which bubbles are breaking on the surface? A. boiling C. roasting B. broiling D. stewing 9. What is an oil-acid mixture which is used to enhance the flavor of meat? A. brine solution C. soy sauce and vinegar B. marinade D. salt and calamansi 10. Which of the following tools is used for carving? A. cleaver knife C. slicer B. fork D. razor knife 11. To which meat cut do internal organs belong? A. less tender cuts C. tough cuts B. tender cuts D. variety cuts 12. Where should meat products be stored? A. crisper C. dry shelf B. cold shelf D. freezer 13. Which of the following is the tenderest cut of beef? A. chunk C. sirloin B. round cut D. tenderloin 14. When buying meat, what should you consider first? A. brand C. quality B. price D. round cut 15. What is your primary consideration when storing goods? A. expiration date C. quantity B. fragility D. size 16. These are taken from the internal organs of animals. A. less tender cuts C. tough cuts B. tender cuts D. variety cuts 17. A slaughtered animal is called . A. a carabeef C. a pork B. a carcass D. a poultry
  • 331. LM-Cookery Grade 10 331 18. The most common method of preserving meat is . A. curing C. refrigerating B. drying D. salting 19. In this method, salt, sugar, potassium, or sodium nitrate etc. are used in preserving meat by drying A. curing C. freezing B. dehydration D. salting 20. The following are the characteristics of good quality pork, except A. breast is plump C. no foul odor B. flesh is pink D. texture is fine and firm 21. A tool used for cutting through bones. A. butcher knife C. cleaver B. chef knife D. utility knife 22. Used for carving and slicing cooked meats. A. butcher knife C. slicer B. chef knife D. utility knife 23. A knife used for general purposes. A. Butcher knife C. Cleaver B. Chef knife D. Utility knife 24. It is used in carving roasts chicken and duck. A. Carving knife C. Slicer B. Cleaver knife D. Utility knife 25. Used for cutting, trimming raw meats. A. butcher knife C. cleaver B. chef knife D. utility knife 26. Meat of swine is called: A. Beef C. Chevon B. Carabeef D. Pork 27. Veal is the meat of: A. Cattle over 1 year old C. Sheep B. Goat D. Young calf 28. Deer meat is called: A. Beef C. Chevon B. Carabeef D. Pork 29. Meat of cattle over 1 year old A. Beef C. Pork B. Carabeef D. Chevon 30. Meat of sheep is called: A. Lamb C. Pork B. Carabeef D. Chevon
  • 332. LM-Cookery Grade 10 332 Overview: This lesson covers the skills, knowledge, and attitudes required to prepare and cook meat. Learning Outcomes: At the end of the lesson you are expected to do the following: 1. perform mise‘n place; 2. cook meat cuts; 3. present and evaluate meat dishes; and 4. store meat. Introduction of Meat Meat is a term for the flesh of cattle (beef and veal), sheep (lamb) and pigs (pork). Meat comprises water, protein, fat, and various amounts of minerals and vitamins. Beef is divided into large sections called primal cuts. These beef primal cuts or ―primal‖ are then broken down further into individual steak and other retail cuts. A ―side‖ of beef is literally one side of the beef carcass that is split through the backbone. Each side is then halved between the 12th and 13th ribs into sections called the forequarter and hindquarter. Pork is divided into large sections called primal cuts. These primal cuts are then broken down further into individual retail cuts. Pork is another choice, as far as meat types are concerned. Pork is derived from pig and is classified as red meat. However, this meat is less fatty than beef. Beef is very popular and is used across the globe. This meat is obtained from cow and is one of the much sought-after types of red meat. Sheep meat is also a staple food in some parts of the world and is consumed in many regions. Sheep meat is otherwise known as mutton (meat of mature sheep) or lamb (immature sheep) also classified as red meat. LESSON 1 PREPARE AND COOK MEAT
  • 333. LM-Cookery Grade 10 333 Learning Outcome 1 Perform Mise’en Place Types of Knives and their Uses 1. French knife or chef‘s knife – for general purpose chopping, slicing, and dicing. 2. Utility knife – used for carving roast chicken and duck. 3. Boning knife – used for boning raw meats and poultry. 4. Slicer – used for carving and slicing cooked meats. 5. Butcher knife – used for cutting, sectioning, and trimming raw meats in the butcher shop. 6. Scimitar or steak knife - used for accurate cutting of steaks. 7. Cleaver – used for cutting through bones.
  • 334. LM-Cookery Grade 10 334 Composition of Meat 1. Water – 70% of muscle tissue. Water Content of Meat and Poultry Product Name Percentage Water Raw Cooked Chicken fryer, whole 66% 60% White meat chicken, with skin 69% 61% Dark meat chicken, with skin 66% 59% Ground beef, 85% lean 64% 60% Ground beef, 73% lean 56% 55% Beef, eye of round 73% 65% Beef, whole brisket 71% 56% 2. Protein – 20% of muscle tissue. Protein coagulates when it is heated. It becomes firmer and loses moisture. When protein has coagulated to the desired degree, the meat is said to be done. 3. Fat – 5% of the muscle tissue. The fat in meat contributes to: A. Juiciness Marbling is fat that is deposited within the muscle tissue. Surface fats protect the meat from drying out during cooking. Adding surface fat is called barding.
  • 335. LM-Cookery Grade 10 335 B. Tenderness Marbling separates muscle fibers, making meat easier to chew. C. Flavor- Fat is the main source of flavor in meat. 4. Carbohydrates – it plays a necessary part in the complex reaction, called the maillard reaction, which takes place when meats are browned by roasting, broiling or sautéing. Without carbohydrates, desirable flavor-appearance of browned meats would not be achieved. Structure of Meat 1. Muscle fibers Lean meat is composed of long, thin muscle fibers bound together in bundles. These determine the texture or grain of a piece of meat.  Fine – grained meat is composed of small fibers bound in small fibers.  Course – textured meat has large fibers. 2. Connective tissue These are network of proteins that bind the muscle fibers together. Connective tissue is tough. Meats are high in connective tissue if the muscles are more exercised like meat from legs and the meat comes from older animals.
  • 336. LM-Cookery Grade 10 336 Two Kinds of Connective Tissue A. Collagen – white connective tissue that dissolves or breaks down by long, slow cooking with liquid. Moist-heat cooking methods at low temperature are not effective for turning a meat high in connective tissue into a tender, juicy finished product. Acid helps dissolve collagen. J. Elastin – yellow connective tissue and is not broken down in cooking. Tenderizing can be accomplished only by removing the elastin, by pounding and by slicing and grinding. Basic Preparation Methods of Meat 1. Washing Generally, the only occasion in which you will have to wash meat is when it comes into contact with blood during preparation. After washing, dry the food thoroughly with absorbent kitchen paper. 2. Skinning Most of the meat you dealt with has been already skinned by the supplier. 3. Dicing Meat are diced when it is cut into cubes for various types of casseroles, stems, curries, and dishes such as steak, kidney pie and pudding. 4. Trimming Reasons for trimming: a. Improve the appearance of the cut or joint b. Leave as much of the meat intact as possible. c. Leave an even thickness of fat (where fat is to be left). How much fat you trim off will depend on the type of meat, preference, and the cooking process to be used. d. Remove as much gristles and sinews as possible.
  • 337. LM-Cookery Grade 10 337 5. Slicing It is the cutting of meat by determining the direction of the grain (the muscle fibers), and cut across the grain. This is particularly important with tougher cuts such as steak, in which the grain is also quite obvious.You slice meat with―instead of against―the grain. 6. Seasoning It is the addition of salt and white or black pepper to improve the flavor of food. a. Use white pepper or cayenne pepper on food which you want to keep attractive with white color. b. Add salt to roast and grill after the meat has browned. Adding salt before cooking will extract the juices of the meat to the surface, and slows down the browning reactions (which need high temperature and dry heat). 7. Coating The two basic coatings are: a. Flour – coat the meat before cooking, otherwise the flour becomes sticky and unpleasant. b. Bread crumbs – coat the meat in flour, then egg wash (egg wash is made of lightly beaten whole egg with a little water/milk) and finally with the bread crumbs. Different kinds of meat and its source 1. Pork – meat from domesticated pigs, typically high in fat, commonly slaughtered one year or less of age to ensure tender cuts . .
  • 338. LM-Cookery Grade 10 338 2. Beef -meat from cattle over one year old 3. Lamb – meats of domesticated sheep. Its texture is a direct result of what it consumes and the age at which it is slaughtered. 4. Carabeef – meat from carabao. 5. Chevon – meat from deer/goat.
  • 339. LM-Cookery Grade 10 339 5. Veal – flesh of a young calf, 4-5 months old. Because of its age, it is considered by some to be the finest meat. Directions : Match Column A with Column B. Write the letter of your answer in separate sheet. A. Column A Column B 1. Used for cutting through bones. A. Butcher knife 2. Used for carving and slicing cooked meats B. Chef knife 3. For general purposes. C. Cleaver 4. Carving roast chicken and duck. D. Utility knife 5. Used for cutting, trimming raw meats. E. Slicer B. Column A Column B 1. Young calf A. beef 2. goat B. carabeef 3. Sheep C. veal 4. Cattle over one year old D. lamb 5. Carabao E. chevon
  • 340. LM-Cookery Grade 10 340 Learning Outcome 2 Cook Meat Cuts Meat Dishes and Entrees In the classical menu, the term entrée refers to the courses after the Grosse piece. Basically, entrees are divided into cold entrees and hot entrees. Today, however, the entrees are usually served as the main dish with suitable vegetable and salad garnishes. Both hot and cold entrees are frequently described as simple dishes on the menu, where they appear in various categories, such as hot snacks garnishes for main dishes and specialties of the day. The main difference between main grosses piece is that the entries are cut up before being cooked. They do not require the same methods of preparation as the grosses pieces which are prepared in single large pieces. It is, therefore, not possible to group the two types of dishes in the same category. Four kinds of doneness in meat 1. Rare – when pressed with a finger, the meat is very soft with jelly like texture. 2. Medium Rare – when pressed with a finger, meat feels springy and resistant 3. Medium – when pressed with a finger, meat feels firm and there is a definite resistance. 4. Well Done – when pressed with a finger the meat feels hard and rough. Nutrient Content of Meat Meat consists of water protein and fat, with a few minerals and some B vitamins. 1. Protein – High-quality protein is the major constituent of meat after water, accounting for about 20 percent of its weight. Meat contains 7 grams of protein per ounce. 2. Fat –content can vary widely, according to the grade of meat and its cut.
  • 341. LM-Cookery Grade 10 341 3. Carbohydrates – Meat contains very little carbohydrates, glycogen, found in liver and muscle tissue is present when the animal is alive, but the glucose that makes up the glycogen is broken down to lactic acid during and after slaughter. 4. Vitamins – Meat is an excellent source of certain B vitamins – thiamin (B., riboflavin (B2), pyridoxine (B6), vitamin (B12) niacin and some folate. Niacin is obtained from tryptophan, an amino acid plentiful in meats and milk. 5. Minerals – Meat is an excellent source of iron, zinc, copper, phosphorous, and a few other trace minerals. Safe Cooking Temperatures for Various Meat MEAT °C °F Beef, rare 52 125 Beef, medium 57 135 Beef, medium well 68 155 Beef, well done 71 160 Ground beef 74 165 Pork 71 160 Market forms of meat Fresh meat – meat that is recently slaughtered, has not been preserved, frozen Chilled meat – meat that is placed in chiller or slightly cold Cured meat – meat preserved by salting, smoking or aging Processed meat –meat preserved by chemical process
  • 342. LM-Cookery Grade 10 342 Meat cuts Primary Cuts of Meat Beef Veal
  • 344. LM-Cookery Grade 10 344 Marinades ` Good marinade will add flavor to your favorite meat and make it more tender and juicy. Making a marinade is very simple. All you need are three basic components. The first, is an acid, such as lemon juice, vinegar, yogurt, or wine. The acid is important as it breaks down the meat and tenderizes it. The second, is oil. This protects and preserves the food while marinated and also when it‘s being cooked. The third, is any herb and/or spice. This is what gives a marinade its unique flavor and zest. Feel free to experiment by grouping one or more ingredients from each component. Here are some general guidelines for marinating:  Meat and poultry are generally marinated for 2 hours up to 2 days.  Seafood and fish should be marinated for no longer than one hour.  Use a non-reactive container - steer clear of aluminum, copper, or cast iron.  Wait for your marinade to cool down before pouring over the meat of your choice.  Always refrigerate your meat while it's marinating.  Never reuse marinades! Types of Marinades Pineapple Marinade - http://bbq.about.com/od/marinaderecipes/tp/Top-10- Pork-Marinade-Recipes.htm This sweet, fruity marinade works great on any cut of pork or chicken. What you get with this marinade is a great Hawaiian Teriyaki flavor. Try this marinade when you are simply placing cut strips of pork or chicken over rice. You can make extra marinade to use as a sauce as long as you keep it separate from the meat
  • 345. LM-Cookery Grade 10 345 Pork Chop Marinade This is a great Asian style marinade that works well on all cuts of pork, particularly pork chops, reminiscent of a Teriyaki marinade with a hint of heat from the chili sauce. You can, if you like, heat this up with some extra chili sauce or perhaps a pinch of cayenne. Jamaican Jerk Marinade You've heard of Jerk seasonings and Jerk rubs, well this is a jerk marinade that gets that jerk flavor deep into the meat. You can use this marinade on all kinds of meat and poultry. Pork Rib Marinade BBQ Guru posted this marinade recipe to the forum. It uses a pork rub for the seasoning with vinegar and water to turn it into a marinade. Teriyaki Marinade Want to get that great Teriyaki flavor into your favorite dish? This marinade will surely add flavor to whatever you're grilling. This marinade works particularly well with pork and poultry. Pork Chop and Tenderloin Marinade Doug Freeman sent in this marinade recipe for grilled pork. You may leave out the liquid smoke if you are so inclined. Bourbon Marinade This is a great, sweet bourbon marinade that works perfectly on any food. This is a mild marinade so you will want several hours marinating time with it before you grill. Mustard-Vinegar Marinade This is a simple mustard marinade that tenderizes and adds flavor. It works well on pork or poultry.
  • 346. LM-Cookery Grade 10 346 Effects of Heat to Meat 1. It tenderizes connective tissue if moisture is present and cooking is slow. 2. It coagulates protein. Even meats low in connective tissue can be tough and dry if cooked at excessively high heats for too long. 3. High heat toughens and shrinks protein and results in excessive moisture lost. 4. Roasts cooked at low temperature shrink less and loss less moisture.
  • 347. LM-Cookery Grade 10 347 5 Moist heat penetrates meat quickly. To avoid over cooking, meat should be simmered, never boiled. Methods of cooking meat 1. Dry heat cooking, such as roasting, broiling, or sautéing. 2. Moist heat cooking, like braising, steaming, or poaching. Choosing the Right Cooking Technique Using the appropriate cooking method for the type of food being prepared is a major part of the culinary arts. Tough cuts of meat like beef brisket or lamb shank need to be cooked slowly, at low heat, for a long time, and with plenty of moisture. Prepared properly, these cuts can be incredibly tender and delicious. On the other hand, dry-heat methods typically involve very high temperatures and short cooking times. A piece of brisket cooked in this way — on a grill, let's say would be tough, chewy and largely inedible. Interestingly enough, a beef tenderloin steak cooked using a slow, moist-heat method such as braising would also turn out tough, chewy and inedible Dry heat cooking Dry heat cooking refers to any cooking technique where the heat is transferred to the food item without using any moisture. Dry-heat cooking typically involves high heat, with temperatures of 300°F or hotter. Baking or roasting in an oven is a dry heat method because it uses hot air to conduct the heat. Pan-searing a steak is considered dry-heat cooking because the heat transfer takes place through the hot metal of the pan. Note: The browning of food (including the process by which meat is browned, called the Maillard reaction) can only be achieved through dry-heat cooking. Examples of dry-heat methods include:
  • 348. LM-Cookery Grade 10 348 Roasting & Baking Forms of dry-heat cooking that use hot, dry air to cook food roasting and baking. Like other dry-heat cooking methods, roasting and baking brown the surface of the food, which in turn develops complex flavors and aromas. Both words describe a method of cooking an item by enveloping it in hot, dry air, generally inside an oven and at temperatures of at least 300°F and often much hotter. A convection oven, which circulates hot air throughout the oven, can enhance the browning reaction. Grilling & Broiling http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/dryheatcooking/a/grilling.htm Dry-heat cooking methods that rely on heat being conducted through the air from an open flame are grilling and broiling. This type of cooking produces browning reactions on the surface of the food, thus encouraging the development of complex flavors and aromas. Grilling cooks hot and fast, because air is a poor conductor of heat. Broiling and grilling require the food to be quite close to the heat source, which in this case, is likely to be an open flame.
  • 349. LM-Cookery Grade 10 349 Sautéing & Pan-Frying Sautéing is a form of dry-heat cooking that uses a very hot pan and a small amount of fat to cook the food very quickly. Like other dry- heat cooking methods, sautéing browns the food's surface as it cooks and develops complex flavors and aromas. Sautéing requires a very hot pan. When sautéing, it's important to heat the pan for a minute, then add a small amount of fat and let it gets hot as well, before adding the food to the pan. This hot fat helps brown the surface of the food. Another key is to avoid overloading or overcrowding the pan. Deep-Frying Since deep-frying involves submerging food in hot, liquid fat, it might take some time to get used to the idea that it's actually a form of dry-heat cooking. But if you've ever seen the violent reaction of hot oil to even a tiny drop of water, you know that oil and water are a couple of opposites that has nothing to do with each other.
  • 350. LM-Cookery Grade 10 350 Moist heat cooking Moist heat cooking methods include any technique that involves cooking with moisture — whether it's steam, water, stock, wine or some other liquid. Cooking temperatures are much lower, anywhere from 140°F to a maximum of 212°F, because water doesn't get any hotter than that. Examples of moist-heat cooking methods include: Simmering With simmering, the cooking liquid is a bit hotter than poaching from 180°F to 205°F. Here we will see bubbles forming and gently rising to the surface of the water, but the water still isn't at a full rolling boil. Because it surrounds the food in water that maintains a more or less constant temperature, simmering cooks food very evenly. It's an excellent choice for culinary preparations including stocks or soups, starchy items such as potatoes or pastas, and many others. Boiling The hottest of these three stages is boiling, where the water reaches its highest possible temperature of 212°F. It's actually the least likely of the three to be used for cooking. That's because the violent agitation caused by the rolling boil can be too rough on food and will often damage it. Water at a full boil would be a bad choice for cooking an egg outside its shell, as we do when preparing poached eggs, because the agitation would cause the egg to fall apart. The same holds true for delicate fish as well as some pastas.
  • 351. LM-Cookery Grade 10 351 Steaming Steaming is a moist-heat cooking technique that employs hot steam to conduct the heat to the food item. Cooking With Steam Steaming can be done on a stovetop, with a pot containing a small amount of liquid that is brought to a simmer. The item to be cooked is then placed in a basket suspended above the liquid and the pot covered. Braising & Stewing Braising is a form of moist-heat cooking in which the item to be cooked is partially covered with liquid and then simmered slowly at a low temperature. Though it can be done on the stovetop, braising is best done in the oven, because the heat fully surrounds the pot and causes the food to cook more evenly than if it were only heated from below. Begin by Searing Because moist heat does not permit the various browning reactions that dry heat produces, giving cooked meats the brown, outer crust that also helps to develop complex flavors and aromas, it's customary to sear meat in a
  • 352. LM-Cookery Grade 10 352 pan with a small amount of hot fat before braising it. This step helps to develop flavors as well as making the meat more appealing visually. Read more about how to braise meat How Braising Works Braising is a good choice of cooking method for cuts of meat that are tougher or from older animals. The connective tissues that are more prevalent in cuts like this, and which can make meats tough and chewy when improperly cooked, are slowly dissolved through long, slow application of moist heat. So you end up with a tender piece of meat. Factors Affecting Choice of Cooking Methods in Meat 1. Cuts of meat  Tender cuts like ribs and loin cuts are used for roasting, broiling and grilling  Less tender cuts from leg or round are used for braising  Tougher cuts from chuck or shoulder are usually braced  Least tender cuts from shanks, breast, brisket, and flank are cooked by moist heat.  Ground meat and cubed usually made from trimmings can be cooked by dry heat or moist heat.
  • 353. LM-Cookery Grade 10 353 2. Fat content  Meats high in fat are cooked without added fat, such as roasting or broiling  Meats low in fat are often cooked with added fat to prevent dryness, like sautéing, pan frying or braising. 3. Desired quality  Tenderness is not the only goal of cooking. To develop flavor and appearance is also one of the objectives to get the desired quality.
  • 354. LM-Cookery Grade 10 354 PREPARE AND COOK MEAT This will be a group collaboration activity. Perform recipes using different methods of cooking meat. Your outputs will be evaluated using a performance score sheet. Roasted Meat Tools/Equipment Needed: Knife Chopping board Roasting pan Rack Oven Pan Serving plate Materials/ingredients needed: Meat (any kind) Seasoning Brown Stock Mirepoix
  • 355. LM-Cookery Grade 10 355 Procedure: 1. Collect all equipment and food supplies. Use roasting pans that have low side and just large enough to hold the roast. 2. Prepare a trim meat for roasting. 3. Season meat several hours or the day before. 4. Place meat fat side up on a rack in the roasting pan. 5. Place meat in preheated oven. 6. Roast to desired doneness. 7. Remove roast from oven and let stand in a warm place for 15-30 minutes. 8. Prepare pan gravy from drippings by; a. degrees pan used in roasting meat b. add mirepoix and let brown c. deglaze with brown stock d. simmer for desired time e. strain and skim fat 9. Slice roast meat across the grain and serve with gravy. Direction: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet. I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. Color combination is attractive and appealing b. ingredients cooked just right c. correct consistency not mushy/ very thick/thin consistency 2.Palatability a. delicious b. tastes just right 3.Nutritive Value a. highly nutritious
  • 356. LM-Cookery Grade 10 356 II. Procedure: 1. Use of Resources: a. kept working table orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and devices 2. Cleanliness and Sanitation a. was well-groomed and properly dressed for cooking, use of clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holders b. used sanitary handling of food 3. Conservation of Nutrients a. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.)
  • 357. LM-Cookery Grade 10 357 Braised Short Ribs Purpose: Prepare and cook braised short ribs Tools/Equipment Needed: Oven String for tying Pan Ladle Strainer Ingredients Needed: 25 kg short rib sections 250 ml oil 300 g onions 150 g celery 150 g carrots 150 g bread flour 25 l brown stock 150 ml tomato puree 2 pcs. Bay leaves Salt to taste Pepper to taste Procedure: 1. Tie the short ribs so the meat will stay on the bone during cooking. 2. Dry the meat so it will brown easily. 3. Heat the oil in a heavy skillet until very hot. Brown the meat on all sides. Transfer browned meat to a browning pan. 4. Sauté onions, celery and carrot to the skillet until lightly browned. 5. Stir in the bread flour to make a roux. 6. Add the brown stock and tomato puree. Simmer until thickens.
  • 358. LM-Cookery Grade 10 358 7. Add bay leaf and season to taste with salt and pepper. 8. Pour the sauce over the steaks. Cover and braise until tender. 9. Transfer the steaks in a serving plate. 10. Strain the sauce and pour over steaks. Direction: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet. I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. color combination is attractive and appealing b. ingredients cooked just right c. correct consistency not mushy/ very thick/thin consistency 2.Palatability a. delicious b. tastes just right 3. Nutritive Value a. highly nutritious II. Procedure: 4. Use of Resources: a. kept working table orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and devices 5. Cleanliness and Sanitation a. was well-groomed and properly dressed for cooking, use of clean apron, hair nets, hand
  • 359. LM-Cookery Grade 10 359 towel and pot holders b. observed sanitary handling of food 6. Conservation of Nutrients a. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.) Broiling/Grilling Meats Purpose: To prepare and cook meat for broiling or grilling. Tools/Equipment Needed: Broiler or Griller Brush for meat Fork Knife Tong Ladle Ingredients Needed: Meat Oil Salt and pepper to taste
  • 360. LM-Cookery Grade 10 360 Procedure: 1. Collect and prepare all equipment and supplies. Trim excess fat from meats to avoid flare-ups. 2. Preheat the broiler or grill. 3. Brush the meat with oil, or dip it in oil and let excess drip off. Place the meat on the broiler or grill. The oil helps prevent sticking and keeps the product moist. 4. When one side is brown and the meat is cooked halfway, turn it over with a fork (piercing only the fat, not the meat, or juices will be lost) or tongs. 5. Cook the second side until the meat is cooked to the desired doneness. If the meat is to be brushed with a glaze or sauce, it is usually best to wait until the product is partially cooked on each side before applying the first coat. After the meat has been cooked on both sides ½ to ¾ done, brush the top with a light coat of the sauce. Turnover and repeat as necessary. 6. Remove from broiler or grill and serve immediately. Direction: Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet. I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. color combination is attractive and appealing b. ingredients cooked just right c. correct consistency not mushy/ very thick/thin consistency 2. Palatability a. delicious b. tastes just right 3. Nutritive Value a. highly nutritious
  • 361. LM-Cookery Grade 10 361 II. Procedure: 4. Use of Resources: a. kept working table orderly while preparing the ingredients b. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes c. used time-saving techniques and devices 5. Cleanliness and Sanitation a. was well-groomed and properly dressed for cooking, use of clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holders b. observed sanitary handling of food 6. Conservation of Nutrients a. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.)
  • 362. LM-Cookery Grade 10 362 MORCON TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT INGRIDIENTS QUANTITY DESCRIPTION Measuring spoon 1k beef, sliced 1/4 inch thick (3 pcs.) Measuring cup ¼ k ground beef liver Knife 200 grams sliced sausages or ham Weighing scale 200 grams pork fat (cut is strips) Pot or pressure cooker 3 pcs. hard boiled eggs, sliced 100 grams 100 grams 2 5 pcs. ½ tsp ½ cup cheddar cheese in strips grated cheddar cheese onions, chopped bay leaf (laurel) ground black pepper vinegar 2 tsp. salt 2 cups water 2 meters thread or string (for tying) PROCEDURE: 1. Spread and stretch the sliced beef on your working table. 2. Arrange the filling on the sliced beef: sausage strips, cheese strips, sliced eggs, pork fat and some ground liver. 3. Roll the sliced beef with all the filling inside and secure with a thread or string. 4. Repeat the procedure for the two remaining beef slices.
  • 363. LM-Cookery Grade 10 363 5. On a pot, place the beef rolls and put the water, the remaining ground liver, grated cheese, chopped onions, bay leaves, ground black pepper and salt. 6. Cover the pot and bring to a boil. Simmer for one hour. 7. Add the vinegar and continue to simmer for another hour or until beef is tender. 8. Slice the beef morcon, arrange on a platter, and top with the sauce/ gravy. (Estimated cooking time: 2 to 3 hours.) Cooking Tips:  A spoon or two of flour can be added to water to thicken the sauce.  Instead of boiling in a pot, you can use a pressure cooker for faster cooking.  Optional: Garnish with olives before serving. Evaluate your finished products using the score sheet. I. Product: Good (3) Fair (2) Poor (1) 1. General Appearance a. color combination is attractive and appealing b. ingredients cooked just right c. correct consistency not mushy/ very thick/thin consistency 2.Palatability a. delicious b. tastes just right 3.Nutritive Value a. highly nutritious
  • 364. LM-Cookery Grade 10 364 II. Procedure: 1.Use of Resources: b. kept working table orderly while preparing the ingredients c. used only the proper and needed utensils and dishes d. used time-saving techniques and devices 2. Cleanliness and Sanitation a. was well-groomed and properly dressed for cooking, use of clean apron, hair nets, hand towel and pot holders b. observed sanitary handling of food 3. Conservation of Nutrients a. followed proper preparation and cooking procedures SCORE: (maximum of 42 pts.)
  • 365. LM-Cookery Grade 10 365 Learning Outcome 3 Plate/Present Meat Dishes Basic Principles of Platter Presentation 1. .Presentation must have three elements.  Centerpiece may be an uncut portion of the main food item.  Slices or serving portions of the main food item, arrange artistically.  Garnish, arranged artistically in proportion to the cut slices. 2. The food should be easy to handle and serve, so one portion can be removed without ruining the arrangement. 3. Simple arrangements are easier to serve, and more likely to be still attractive when they are half demolished by the guests
  • 366. LM-Cookery Grade 10 366 4. Attractive platter are made of metals, mirrors, china, plastic or woods, presentable and suitable for use with food. 5 .It must look attractive and appropriate not only by itself, but among other presentations on the table. How to Present Food on a Plate When you're plating food, the goal is to create a dining experience that tempts all of the senses, not just the palate. When food looks appetizing the body actually produces more fluids that aid in nutrient absorption - so you might even say that beautiful food is more wholesome than food that doesn't look appealing. To achieve restaurant-quality presentation, start with brightly- colored, well-cooked food. Layer the food and play with contrasting colors and textures to increase its visual appeal. Finally, garnish the plate with flavorful herbs or spices to take it to the next level. See Step 1 and beyond to learn how to make the next meal you will cook look irresistible.
  • 367. LM-Cookery Grade 10 367 Starting With Beautiful Food Avoid a monochromatic color scheme. A plate appealing when there's a high level of contrast in colors. of food looks most  When you're planning meals, think ahead about the colors you want to feature on the plate. You might not be able to represent all the colors of the rainbow at every meal, but challenge yourself to have as much color as possible.  If you're about to serve several like-colored foods, like grilled chicken and mashed potatoes, adding a serving or two of fruits and vegetables is a fantastic and easy way to add pops of color. The richest greens, oranges, reds, purples, blues, pinks and yellows on your plate probably take the form of fruits and vegetables.  If you're not sure how to add color, utilize garnishes. Nearly any savory dish is well-served by a sprinkling of fresh chives, parsley, dill, or mint. Lemon and lime wedges are welcome alongside poultry and seafood dishes.
  • 368. LM-Cookery Grade 10 368 Bring out vegetables' brightest colors. The way you cook your vegetables has a lot of bearing on the overall visual effect of a meal  Lightly steam instead of boiling. Steaming vegetables makes them look appetizing and flavorful, while boiling creates the opposite effect.  Roast or sauté them with a little oil or butter. Roasted or sautéed vegetables look quite appetizing when they're allowed to caramelize a little in oil or butter. Sear your meat and let it rest. Many meat dishes look most appetizing when the meat has been seared. The sight of a steak or piece of grilled salmon with a brown, crispy sear will make your dinner guests' mouths start to water. In addition to searing your meat, you should let it rest for several minutes before cutting it. This allows the juices to absorb back into the meat, so that they don't end up running all over the plate.  There are exceptions to the rule of searing your meat. For example, if you're serving braised beef, you'll have to think of creative ways to make the meat look appetizing even though it doesn't have a crispy crust. Serving it with a sauce is a good way to add visual interest. Cook fried foods carefully. Underdone or overcooked fried foods are difficult to present in an appealing way. Fried foods can look beautiful on a plate, but it's important to fry them well and have a plan for dealing with the oil so it doesn't muck up the rest of the dish. Cook fried foods until they're golden brown, then let them drain on a plate lined with paper towels to absorb the extra oil. Otherwise, the food will leave streaks of grease on the plates.  Fried foods often continue browning a bit after they've been removed from the hot oil.
  • 369. LM-Cookery Grade 10 369 Take texture into account. Texture and color go hand in hand when it comes to how appetizing food looks on the plate. If your food looks too oily, too dry, mushy, tough, or otherwise difficult to chew and swallow, it won't matter how perfectly colorful it looks. Take pains to cook food well so that it comes out to the right texture.  The way you handle the food just after it has been cooked, and before it is plated, can really affect the texture. Pasta, for example, should be kept in water or tossed in a bit of oil just after cooking so that it doesn't start to clump. Fried foods should not be covered with airtight lids, because the heat from the food will end up steaming the breading and causing the food to get soggy.  Once the food is on the plate, a spritz of oil or water can improve its visual appeal if it looks too dry. Experiment with interesting shapes.  Cutting vegetables in interesting shapes can make the simple become special. You can cook and serve vegetables, desserts, pot pies and other foods inside unique-shaped dishes to create attractive shapes. Plating it with Care •When in doubt, choose white plates. White plates don't compete visually with the food you're serving. They provide contrast, making colors appear brighter and textures more interesting. . If you have a set of special plates with a pattern or a certain color scheme, it's fine to use
  • 370. LM-Cookery Grade 10 370 them. Just make sure they complement the food you're serving instead of vying for attention. •Don't forget to take the rest of the table into consideration, too. Cutlery, glasses and linens will enhance the overall appearance of the dish upon the table. Visualize the finished plate.  Consider how to present the main portion in relation to the side dishes. Consider where it will look best on the plate with the other elements of the dish. Consider also how to get best impact––the appearance and symmetry are all affected by whether the food is sliced thinly, thickly or left whole. Limit portion sizes.  Only fill about two thirds of each plate with food. The rest of the plate should be left empty. The negative space will provide contrast with the food, making it look more appetizing. If the plate is loaded with food, the food itself won't look as visually pleasing. Keep standard serving sizes in mind and aim to serve just the right amount of each part of the dish.  As a general rule, half of the food on the plate should comprise of vegetables, one fourth meat or another protein, and one fourth starch.  Start plating food in the center of the dish and work outward from there, so that the food is centered in the middle of the plate. Follow the rule of odds.  Having an odd number of elements on a dish is more visually appealing than having an even number. It creates the impression that piece of food is being framed by the others. Keep this in mind whether you're
  • 371. LM-Cookery Grade 10 371 serving different types of food or more than one piece of the same food. For example, if you're serving scallops, serve either 3 or 5 instead of 4. Play with different textures  Creating a texture contrast is a good way to draw the eye. Too many soft or crunchy foods on a plate are unappealing, but a combination of both is delicious. Different textures harmonize to create a pleasing dining experience. Leaving one of the elements out would result in a less appealing dish.  To quickly add some crunch to a dish, try topping it with some crushed, roasted walnuts and almonds Layer foods to add height.  It's common to see food layering in restaurants, but home cooks don't usually try it. Adding height to a dish can take it from ordinary to stunning. Don't be afraid to show off your culinary skills by using stacking and layering methods to make your presentation more professional.  An easy way to start layering food is to serve the protein on a bed of starch. For example, serve a kabob on a heap of rice, or serve grilled swordfish on a pile of mashed potatoes.  Aim to make foods look bigger, not smaller. Fluff up your salads. For example, instead of smooching them down. Create a little cross- hatched stack of cooked asparagus instead of presenting it in one flat layer.
  • 372. LM-Cookery Grade 10 372 Use sauce wisely  If you're serving a curry, stew or soupy casserole, you might want to drain the food of its sauce before serving, then pour on just the right amount when you plate the dish. That way you can control the amount of sauce and use it to make the dish look decorative. Keep up with food styling trends.  Remember that styles change even within the space of a few years or even months, so keep up-to-date by checking out cooking magazines, cooking or foodie websites and cooking shows for current ideas. Adding Appetizing Touches Use garnishes that enhance the flavor of the meal. No matter what you're serving, make sure the garnish actually makes the dish better instead of just cluttering up the plate. Employ drizzles and swirls.  Another way to finish food is with a drizzle or swirl of a concentrated sauce or liquid. For savory dishes, this might be a small squeeze of remoulade, pesto, or flavored oil. For sweet dishes, adding chocolate sauce, fruit jam, or crème anglaise might be the most delicious way to add that finishing touch.  Rather than just pouring a sauce over your food, consider putting it in a squeeze bottle so you can create a pretty swirl or pattern. If you don't
  • 373. LM-Cookery Grade 10 373 have a squeeze bottle, put the sauce in a plastic food storage bag, cut a small piece off one of the corners, and squeeze the sauce through the bag.  Don't overdo it. The key is to add a touch of color, flavor and texture without overpowering the main part of the dish. Make sure the plate is clean  Examine the edges of the plate for fingerprints and smudges. A great way to clean up the edges of a plate is to dip a paper towel in a cup of water with a dash of white vinegar. Wipe the rim of the plate so that no food residue or prints are visible. This gives your presentation a professional touch. The 5 Basic Elements of Plating 1. Create a Framework Start with drawings and sketches to visualize the plate. Find inspiration from a picture or object. Assemble a ‗practice‘ plate to work on executing your vision. 2. Keep It Simple Select one ingredient to focus on and use space to simplify the presentation. Clutter distracts from the main elements of your dish that might confuse the diners on what to focus on. 3. Balance the Dish Play with colors, shapes and textures to ensure diners are not overwhelmed. The presentation should never overpower flavor and function.
  • 374. LM-Cookery Grade 10 374 4. Get the Right Portion Size Ensure that there is the right amount of ingredients and the plate complements the dish, not too big or too small. Strike the right proportion of protein, carbohydrates and vegetables to create a nutritionally balanced meal. 5. Highlight the Key Ingredient Ensure that the main ingredient stands out and pay equal attention to the ‗support‘. This refers to the other elements on the plate such as garnishes, sauces and even the plate itself. Review of Learning Outcome 3 Direction: Select the best answer. Write only the letter on your answer sheet 1. In platter presentation uncut portion of the main food item is A. garnish B. serving portions C. centerpiece 2. It is arranged artistically in proportion to the cut slices. A. slices B. serving portions C. garnish 3. The food should be easy to handle and A. garnish B. serve C. arrangement 4. Use attractive platter presentation made of metals, mirrors, plastic or wood, and A. china B. pan C. platter 5. The act of serving or arranging portions of the main food item artistically. A. slicing B. garnishing C. setting
  • 375. LM-Cookery Grade 10 375 Learning Outcome 4 Store meat Methods of Preserving Meat There are different methods of preserving meat. These include drying or dehydration, smoking, salting, curing, refrigerating, freezing, canning and freeze drying. A. Drying – This is the most common method of preserving meat. Drying involves the reduction of the original 70% of water content of the meat to about 15%. The removal of the moisture content does three things, namely:  Enzymatic changes are retarded;  Growth of microorganisms is much hampered  Microbes lose water and become inert. Ways of Drying Meat 1. Natural sun drying – Natural sunlight is used to reduce the amount of moisture content of meat. Portable solar dyers can provide sanitary means of drying meat. Dryers with screen covers are recommended for outdoor use and lengthens the storage life of meat 2. Dehydration or artificial drying – Oven is used for drying the meat. Although this is more expensive than sun drying, dehydration is a more efficient method of removing moisture from meat. Products dried in this way are of higher quality and can be sold at better prices. B. Smoking – Meat is smoked to create a distinctive color and flavor, thus helping its preservation. The flavor, color, and attractive glaze on the surface of the meat is desired like in ham, bacon, and tinapA. The heat generated during smoking destroys the enzymes and dries the product artificially, thus preventing the growth of molds and vegetative bacteria on the surface. Cold and hot smoking are the two types of smoking. Smoked meats include ham, bacon, and chicken.  Cold Smoking – The temperature is held between 26 to 43ºC and the products are smoked over a period of days or weeks. The products thus pick up a strong smoked flavor and are dehydrated as well.
  • 376. LM-Cookery Grade 10 376  Hot Smoking – The temperature is higher, from 71 to 79ºC.The high temperature speed up the drying process, giving the product a mild smoked flavor. 2. Salting – Salt improves the keeping quality of meat. It removes the water from the tissue of the meat and the cells of spoilage organisms that may be present in the meat. C. Curing – In this method, salt, sugar, potassium or sodium nitrate, and other curing elements such as ascorbic acid, phosphate blend, and spices are used to prolong the keeping quality of meat. Curing agents also help improve the flavor and appearance of meat and retain its original color. Sugar minimizes the hardness of the straight cure process. It also makes the product more appetizing and provides energy to the nitrate-reducing bacteria which gives the red color. Spices give the desired flavor and aroma. D. Refrigerating – Meat is stored at a temperature range of 2 to 10ºC to retard mold and bacterial growth for a limited period. E. Freezing – Meat is preserved at a temperature of 10ºC and below. Freezing deactivates enzymes and bacteria. Meat can be preserved for two months to one year using this method. F. Canning – Meat preserved by canning is packed in sealed cans or jars which are subjected to a temperature of 100ºC and above 5-7 kilo pressured for a specific period of time. This process destroys the organism that causes spoilage. It maintains the high quality of meat product and extends its life for about a year. G. Freeze Drying – The process involves the removal of moisture from the meat tissues by transforming the moisture content into ice and gas. The product to be dried is first frozen and the ice is sublimed from the frozen mass, removing 98% of the water content. The remaining moisture is further reduced to 0.5% or lower by subjecting the product to high temperature as possible without destroying it. The texture, appearance, flavor, and nutritive value of freeze dried products are comparable to frozen foods. The products have a long shelf life and require no refrigeration. This method needs special equipment such as modern freeze dryer.
  • 377. LM-Cookery Grade 10 377 Evaluating the Quality of Preserved Meat Products Good quality pork has less than 1 ¼ cm of golden brown fat that covers the surface of the meat and a thoroughly cooked interior where meat has even pinkish color. It has also a juicy and tender texture, a pleasing aroma and a tender seasoned and pleasing taste with a slight hint of smoky flavor. Sausages of good quality are uniform in size and length. Each sausage in a whole piece has no rupture of casing even when pricked. The interior has a pinkish color when thoroughly cooked. A combination of juicy meat with spicy seasoning marks their flavor. Proper Storage of Preserved Meat Many processed items prepared for future use may be stored in the freezer. These should be wrapped in plastic or foil to prevent the occurrence of freezer burn and avoid having a pulpy texture that comes from loss of moisture. Each item should be labeled with the name of the product, date of expiry, and quantity. Processed food held in storage should be well-covered or wrapped to keep them from absorbing odors and flavors from other foods. They should be held below danger zone temperatures. Processed meat should be packed in desired and easy to thaw market units. Thawing a 25kilo pack of ground meat, for example, will be difficult. Systematic freezing of food in quantity for long-term storage requires special freezing equipment. Food Storage Chart Food Suggested Maximum Temperature (ºC. Recommended Maximum Storage Canned Products Frozen Products beef poultry Fresh Pork (not ground) Sausage, ground meat Cold cuts, Sliced Cured bacon 21 -18 to -29 -18 to 29 18 to 29 3 to 4 3 to 4 12 months 6–12 months, in original package 3-6 months, in original package 1-3 months, in original package 3-5 days, in semi-moisture proof paper 1-4 weeks, tightly wrapped
  • 378. LM-Cookery Grade 10 378 Ham (tender cured) Ham (Canned) Dried Beef 3 to 4 3 to 4 3 to 4 1-6 weeks, tightly wrapped 6 weeks, in original container (unopened) 6 weeks, tightly wrapped Most canned foods can be stored at room temperature in a cold place and hold their eating quality for several months. They are safe to eat as long as there is no bulge on the can. Below 24ºC is a good temperature for storage. Canned ham and other perishable meats should be stored in the refrigerator unless storage recommendations on the can state otherwise. These meats should not be frozen. Hygiene Practices in Storing Meat products To achieve high standards of sanitation, the following measures should be strictly observed: 1. See to it that physical equipment and layout are conducive to sanitary practices. 2. Handle, store, and refrigerate food properly to prevent spoilage and contamination. 3. Safeguard the food during distribution and service. 4. Wash and sanitize dishes, glasses, utensils, and equipment. 5. Clean floors walls, ceilings, counters, tables, and chairs regularly. 6. Eliminate vermin and rodents from food areas. 7. Maintain adequate employer supervision and a constant program of education in sanitation for food service workers. 8. Make sure that food service employees are in good health, and are not carriers of communicable diseases. The three principal groups of communicable diseases that must be guarded against in public feeding operations are respiratory, intestinal, and skin diseases. Require medical examinations for food service employees. 9. Provide a regular employee education on food service sanitation. Techniques in storing meat Storage Procedures for Meat Products Safe Storage - Meat is among the most perishable foods. This perishable ability makes it a potentially hazardous food. At ambient temperatures, meat spoils so fast. It is therefore necessary to keep it in chilled storage.
  • 379. LM-Cookery Grade 10 379 Storing - take time to store the food items. Store new purchases behind old ones and always use the old stock first. It is easy to put new purchases at the front. However, older stocks are overlooked and thus cause spoilage. These may include cereal and cereal products, sweeteners, oils, seasonings, and unopened cans and jars.Do not use kitchen cabinets above the refrigerator, stove, or oven for food storage. Never use the area under the sink for storing food because openings around water and drain pipes are impossible to seal. Pipes may leak and damage the food. If you reuse glass jars, wash them thoroughly, wipe, and air-dry before using. This helps remove any trace of odors that may remain. 1. Refrigerator storage. A refrigerator provides cold temperature for storing perishable foods such as dairy products, meat, fish, poultry, eggs, fruits, and vegetables. Protein foods should be stored in the coldest part of the refrigerator. Fruits and vegetables can be stored in less cold sections or in a special compartment such as the crisper. If refrigerated foods are not properly wrapped, they will dry out and lose nutrients and flavor. Food should be well covered with plastic, foil or wax paper, or should be put in tightly covered containers. Garlic and sausages are strong-flavored foods and should be wrapped tightly in plastic or foil and stored in an air-tight container to prevent the transfer of aromas to other foods. 2. Freezer storage. For proper freezing and storage, the temperature inside the freezer should be 18ºC or lower. Store frozen foods in their original packages. Foods to be frozen should be put in moisture-vapor proof wrapping. If plastic containers are used, allow about 2.5 cm of headspace at the top between the food and the lid so the food can expand when if freezes. Thaw frozen foods in the refrigerator. Do not allow food to thaw at room temperature. At this point, microorganisms will begin to grow. Our sanitary laws and regulations are so designed to safeguard and promote health.
  • 380. LM-Cookery Grade 10 380 Bacteria are all around us, but they are so small that they cannot be seen by the naked eye. There are hundreds of different kinds of bacteria. Some harmless bacteria are useful and necessary such as those essential in preparing cheese. Other bacteria are essential in agriculture and industry. However, many types of bacteria are dangerous and cause diseases if allowed to multiply and be transmitted to humans. Food contaminated with bacteria can make people sick. Some of the common illnesses are salmonellosis, perfringens poisoning, staphylococcal poisoning, and botulism. Sanitation is the best preventive measure against food-borne diseases. Sanitation means keeping bacteria out of food through personal hygiene and proper handling procedures. It also means keeping the food at proper temperatures so bacteria already present do not have much chance to multiply. Bacteria enter food in two ways. Some are naturally present in food when you buy it. Others get in because of careless handling when food is prepared and served. Bacteria cannot travel by themselves; they are carried about by people, animals, and insects as well as objects. Salmonella bacteria, for instance, can be found in food such as raw meat, poultry, eggs, and dairy products. From these foods, the bacteria contaminate other foods in the kitchen. Staphylococcus bacteria are found not only in raw meat but in food handlers with poor personal hygiene. The bacteria from food handlers can be transmitted to the food through sneezing and coughing. Bacteria thrive on food, moisture, and the right temperature in order to grow. With careless handling these growing conditions can occur in any kitchen
  • 381. LM-Cookery Grade 10 381 PORK TOCINO Standard recipe developed by Calamba Manpower TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT INGRIDIENTS QUANTITY DESCRIPTION knife chopping board mortar and pestle strainer measuring cup measuring spoon wooden spoon mixing bowl 1 k 1 tbsp. ½ tsp. 1 tbsp. ¼ cup Second mixture 1 cup 2 tbsp. 2 tbsp. 1 tsp ¼ cup 2 tsp. 1 tsp Pork , slice thinly salt curing salt phosphate water sugar Garlic Anisado wine or Rhum Meat enhancer (optional) Pineapple juice Oyster sauce Worcestershire sauce PROCEDURE: 1. In a bowl, combine all ingredients for the 1st mixture together. Set aside. 2. On another bowl, mix all ingredients for the 2nd mixture. 3. Combine 1st and 2nd mixture 4. Pack it by 250 grams.
  • 382. LM-Cookery Grade 10 382 Posttest Directions: Read the following statements/questions carefully and choose the letter with the correct answer. Write your answer in your test note book. 1. What animal produces veal meat? A. calf B. deer C. hog D. sheep 2. Which of the following market forms of meat does not undergo chilling? A. cured meat B. fresh meat C. frozen meat D. processed meat 3. What part of the meat helps you identify the less tender cuts? A. bone B. fat C. flesh D. ligament 4. What part of the meat has the greatest amount of quality protein? A. Bone B. Fat C. Flesh D. Ligament 5. Which of the following meat cuts requires long and slow cooking temperature? A. less tender C. tender B. slightly tough D. tough 6. What is a long – bladed hatchet or a heavy knife used by a butcher? A. butchers knife B. chopper knife C. cleaver knife D. set of slicing knife
  • 383. LM-Cookery Grade 10 383 7. Which of the cooking methods does not belong to dry heat method? A. baking B. broiling C. roasting D. stewing 8. What do you call the cooking method when meat is cooked in steaming liquid, and bubbles are breaking on the surface? A. boiling B. broiling C. roasting D. stewing 9. What is an oil-acid mixture which is used to enhance the flavor of meat. A. brine solution B. marinade C. soy sauce and vinegar D. salt and calamansi 10. Which of the following tools is used for carving? A. cleaver knife B. fork C. slicer D. razor knife 11. To which meat cut do internal organs belong? A. less tender cuts B. tender cuts C. tough cuts D. variety cuts 12. Where should meat products be stored? A. crisper B. cold shelf C. dry shelf D. freezer 13. Which of the following is the tenderest cut of beef? A. chunk B. round cut C. sirloin D. tenderloin 14. When buying meat, what should you first consider? A. brand B. price C. quality D. round cut
  • 384. LM-Cookery Grade 10 384 15. What is your primary consideration when storing goods? A. expiration date B. fragility C. quantity D. size 16. These are taken from the internal organs of animals. A. less tender cuts B. tender cuts C. tough cuts D. variety cuts 17. A slaughtered animal is called . A. a carabeef B. a carcass C. a pork D. a poultry 18. The most common method of preserving meat is . A. Curing B. drying C. refrigerating D. salting 19. In this method, salt, sugar, potassium or sodium nitrate etc. are used in preserving meat by drying A. curing B. dehydration C. freezing D. salting 20. The following are the characteristics of good quality pork, except . A. breast is plump B. flesh is pink C. no foul odor D. texture is fine and firm 21. A tool used for cutting through bones. A. butcher knife B. chef knife C. cleaver D. utility knife 22. Used for carving and slicing cooked meats. A. butcher knife B. chef knife C. slicer D. utility knife
  • 385. LM-Cookery Grade 10 385 23. A knife used for general purposes. A. Butcher knife B. Chef knife C. Cleaver D. Utility knife 24. It is used in carving roasts chicken and duck. A. Carving knife B. Cleaver knife C. Slicer D. Utility knife 25. Used for cutting, trimming raw meats. A. butcher knife B. chef knife C. cleaver D. utility knife 26. Meat of swine is called: A. Beef B. Carabeef C. Chevon D. Pork 27. Veal is the meat of: A. Cattle over 1 year old B. Goat C. Sheep D. Young calf 28. Deer meat is called: A. Beef B. Carabeef C. Chevon D. Pork 29. Meat of cattle over 1 year old A. Beef B. Carabeef C. Pork D. Chevon 30. Meat of sheep is called: A. Lamb B. Carabeef C. Pork D. Chevon
  • 386. LM-Cookery Grade 10 386 A. Multiple Choice. Directions: Read the following questions carefully and choose the letter that best describes the statement. Write your answer on your test notebook. 1. Which of the following sources of starch is rarely used in manufacturing food starch? A. Cassava C. Potato B. Corn D. Rice 2. Which of the following starch properties/reactions is the resistance to flow; increase in thickness or consistency. A. Dextrinization C. Retrogadation B. Gelatinization D. Viscosity 3. Which of the following is suggested if you will hold pasta for a short time for later service? A. Cook pasta ahead of time and chilled B. Drain and add sauce C. Drain, toss with a small amount of oil, cover and hold in warmer D. Slightly undercook the pasta 4. Which is the process of making a new product to be sold to the customers. A. Product Analysis C. Product Development B. Product Conceptualization D. Product Implementation 5. Which is a meaningful and unforgettable statement that captures the essence of your brand. A. Branding C. Tagline B. Product Naming D. Unique Selling Proposition 6. What managerial tool is used to assess the environment to gather important information used for strategic planning. A. Environmental Scanning C.Survey Analysis B. SWOT Analysis D.WOTS Analysis
  • 387. LM-Cookery Grade 10 387 7. Which of the following are the right step by step procedures in manual dishwashing? A. Drain and air-dry, scrape and pre-rinse, rinse, sanitize, and wash dishes. B. Rinse, scrape and pre-rinse, wash, drain, air-dry and sanitize dishes C. Scrape and pre-rinse, rinse, wash, sanitize, drain and air-dry dishes D. Scrape and pre-rinse, wash, rinse, sanitize, drain and air-dry dishes 8. Which of the following parts of an egg is produced by the oviduct and consist of four alternating layers of thick and thin consistencies. A. Air cell C. Chalaza B. Albumen D. Yolk 9. Egg contains high quality protein with all the essential amino acids. Which of the following vitamins not found in eggs? A. B1 C. D B. C D. K 10. The appearance of egg is important for consumer appeal. How are egg shells evaluated? A. cleanliness, shape, texture and soundness B. grade, texture, cleanliness, shape C. shape, texture, cleanliness and size D. texture, soundness, size and cleanliness 11. Which of the following market forms of eggs is seldom used in cooking. A. Dried egg C. Frozen egg B. Fresh egg D. Shelled egg 12. Which of the following raises coagulation temperature producing softer, weaker gel when added to egg used in culinary. A. Alkali C. Sugar B. Salt D. Vinegar 13. What kind of egg dish is prepared by slipping shelled eggs into barely simmering water and gently cooking until the egg holds its shape? A. Fried egg C. Scrambled egg B. Poached egg D. Soft-boiled egg 14. Which of the following tools is not used in cooking omelet? A. Bowls C. Sauté pan B. Fork D. Skimmer 15. Which of the following is true in plating egg dishes? A. Choose serving dish small enough to let each food item stand out B. Play with color and texture C. Protein dish should cover half of the plate D. Use even numbers in setting the dish.
  • 388. LM-Cookery Grade 10 388 16. What animal produces veal meat? A. Calf C. Hog B. Deer D. Sheep 17. Which of the following market forms of meat does not undergo chilling? A. Cured meat B. Fresh meat C. Frozen meat D. Processed meat 18. What part of the meat helps you identify the less tender cuts? A. Bone B. Fat C. Flesh D. Ligament 19. What part of the meat has the greatest amount of quality protein? A. Bone B. Fat C. Flesh D. Ligament 20. Which of the following meat cuts requires long and slow cooking temperature? A. Less tender C. Tender B. Slightly tough D. Tough 21. What do you call the young immature pigeon of either sex with extra tender meat? A. Duck C. Rooster B. Fryer D. Squab 22. What part of poultry does breast meat belongs? A. Dark meat C. Variety meat B. Tough meat D. White meat 23. Which of the following characteristics is a good quality of a live poultry? A. Free from pin feathers and shows no cuts B. Eyes are clear C. Skin is heavy and watery D. Thighs well develop 24. What do you call young chicken that is usually 9 to 12 weeks of age? A. Fryer C. Roaster B. Hen D. Stag 25. How many days should a whole chicken be refrigerated? A. 1 day C. 2 to 4 days B. 1 to 2 days D. 3 to 4 days
  • 389. LM-Cookery Grade 10 389 26. How do you classify fleshy part of chicken like breast? A. Entrails C. Viscera B. Dark meat D. White meat 27. What cookery method is used for a matured poultry? A. Boiling C. Roasting B. Frying D. Stewing 28. What cookery method is suitable for the less tender cuts? A. Boiling C. Roasting B. Frying D. Stewing 29. What is the best cooking temperature for poultry? A. High temperature C. Low to moderate temperature B. Low temperature D. Moderate temperature 30. What factor affects the poultry meat‘s tenderness and juiciness? A. Age C. Cuts B. Cookery D. Sex 31. What do you call a long – bladed hatchet or a heavy knife used by a butcher? A. Butchers knife B. Chopper knife C. Cleaver knife D. Set of slicing knife 32. Which of the cooking methods does not belong to dry heat method? A. Baking B. Broiling C. Roasting D. Stewing 33. What do you call the cooking method when meat is cooked in steaming liquid and bubbles are breaking on the surface? A. Boiling B. Broiling C. Roasting D. Stewing 34. What is an oil-acid mixture which is use to enhance the flavor of meat. A. Brine solution B. Marinade C .Soy sauce and vinegar D. Salt and calamansi
  • 390. LM-Cookery Grade 10 390 35. Which of the following tools is used for carving? A. Cleaver knife B. Fork C. Slicer D. Razor knife 36. To which meat cut do internal organs belong? A. Less tender cuts B. Tender cuts C.Tough cuts D.Variety cuts 37. Where should meat products be stored? A. Crisper B. Cold shelf C. Dry shelf D. Freezer 38. Which of the following is the tenderest cut of beef? A. Chunk B. Round cut C. Sirloin D. Tenderloin 39. When buying meat, what should you first consider? A. Brand B. Price C. Quality D. Round cut 40. What is your primary consideration when storing goods? A. Expiration date B. Fragility C. Quantity D. Size 41. What is the flavor component of vegetables which gives strong flavor and odor to some vegetables like onions, leeks, garlic, chives, cabbage, and broccoli? A. Flavonoids C. Sugar C. Glutamic acid D. Sulfur compounds 42. Which is a way of cooking by placing blanched or raw vegetables in the pan, adding liquid (stock, water, wine) then covering and cooking it slowly? A. Boiling C. Braising B. Baking D. Sautéing
  • 391. LM-Cookery Grade 10 391 43. Which of the following plating styles is not a classic arrangement? A. The starch or vegetable item is heaped in the center while the main item is sliced and leaned up against it. B. The main item is in the center, with vegetable distributed around it. C. The vegetable item is in front and main item, starch item and garnish at the rear. D. The main item is in the center with neat piles of vegetables carefully arranged around. 44. Which of the following vegetables is cooked uncovered? A. Fruit vegetables C. Roots and tubers B. Green vegetables D. Yellow vegetables 45. Which of the following is a freshwater fish? A. Bluefish C. Grouper B. Cat fish D. Sole 46. Which is the market form of fish where both sides of a fish are still joined but bones are removed? A. Butterfly C. Fillet B. Drawn D. Steak 47. Which of the following is a characteristic of a fresh fish? A. Fresh and foul odor B. Eyes are dull, shiny and bulging C. Red or pink gills D. Flesh shrinks when pressed 48. Which of the following seafood is cooked just enough to heat to keep juicy and plump? A. Fat fish C. Flat fish B. lean fish D. Shellfish 49. What is the cooking method suited to fat fish? A. Baking C. Deep -frying B. Boiling D. Sautéing 50. What is used to baste lean fish to help prevent from drying up? A. Butter C. Soy sauce B. Cream D. Tomato sauce
  • 392. LM-Cookery Grade 10 392 SYNTHESIS Over the past years, a transition in cooking and food preparation skills has been observed. This transition in cooking and food preparation skills involves the increased use of readily prepared or cooked food, which require less preparation and time than the traditional way of cooking. But cooking is an expression of creativity, happiness, magic, and culture. The satisfaction gained by the chef and other persons preparing, cooking, serving and storing the food is unquestionable; not to mention the pleasure it gives to the customer. Different food products may come and go but the demand for food cooked in traditional way, in restaurants, food chains, and others is indispensable. Varieties of foods such as egg, cereal and starch, vegetables, seafood, red meat, poultry dishes and also stocks, soups and sauces are still made available to meet the customer‘s satisfaction. Taste is not the only sense that can motivate customers but touch also play with contrasts of temperatures and textures, and so with smell and sight for colors, shapes and others, whereby the five senses become one of the main points of reference in the creative cooking process. Now, if you have a passion for delicious food and love for cooking gain applicable and practical guidance that will teach you to become successful chef or businessman in the field of cookery someday.
  • 393. LM-Cookery Grade 10 393 GLOSSARY aromatic– having a smell of fragrant spicy béchamel sauce – a white sauce made of cream, butter, flour and flavored with onion and seasoning. Birefringence - When starch granules are viewed under the microscope using polarized light, they exhibit a phenomenon known as birefringence. The refraction of polarized light by the intact crystalline regions in starch give characteristic "Maltese cross" patterns on each granule. The disappearance of these crosses on heating a starch suspension can be used to determine gelatinization temperature. bouillon – a clear soup from beef, chicken, and other meat. broth – a fluid food made by boiling meat and vegetable in water butcher – a person who slaughters animals for food chowder – a soup usually of clams or fish, stewed vegetables often in milk. clarification – to make or become clear coating – to cover with flour combine– to mix the ingredients in the bowl consommé – a clear soup made of meat and sometimes vegetables boiled in water. contamination – unintended presence of harmful substances or disease causing microorganisms in food damp - moist slightly wet
  • 394. LM-Cookery Grade 10 394 dark meat- the dark meat parts which include the legs, drumstick, wings and neck. decomposition – the state of being rotten or spoiled dressed - slaughtered birds that have been bled, defeathered and the organs are removed drip – to fall or let fall in drops drippings- the juice that drips from roasting or baking meat or a sauce made from it. entrails- the animals internal organs such as liver, heart and gizzard entrees – main course foodhandling – any operation in the production, preparation, processing, packaging, storage, transport, distribution and sale of food freeze– to preserve meat by refrigeration below freezing point frozen – subject to long and serve cold, chilly or cold manner fumet – the savory color of meat while cooking games – birds that are hunted for food. Haugh – unit for describing egg freshness, based on the thickness of the albumen Leavener - substances that are used to make bread and other baked goods rise marinade – an oil-acid mixture used to give flavor and to tenderize meat. mirepoix – a mixture of vegetable, herbs, and spices with or without meat, used to enhance flavor of meat, fish and shell fish. perishable food – subject to decay or spoilage
  • 395. LM-Cookery Grade 10 395 pheasant– long tailed domesticated bird plump – fleshy poach – to cook food in hot liquid in such a manner that it retains its original shape portion- a part of whole or to divide into parts processed food – meat processed by curing ingredients quality – characteristics reconstitute– to add appropriate amount of water to sauce or soup. roux- a melted butter mixed with brown flour for thickening soup and grains. sanitation – keeping the food equipment, utensils, and work area clean. .sauce – a thickened liquid used to flavor and enhance other food savory – a hardy, annual aromatic culinary herb of the mint family scum – a firmly layer of impure matters on the surface of a liquid seasoning – a spice for enhancing the flavor of food simmer – to cook very gently in water just below the boiling point skim – to remove floating water from the surface with a ladle slaughter – to butcher an animal for food. spice- an aromatic, pungent vegetable substance used to flavor food and beverages.
  • 396. LM-Cookery Grade 10 396 spoilage – to become rotten or decayed stew – to simmer or boil in a small quantity of liquid. Stock- a liquid in which meat fish and sometimes vegetables have been cooked storage– a space for storing stripped off - to remove or to take away suitable– appropriate tender cut– part of meat that requires less period of cooking thaw – to change from a frozen solid to a liquid by gradual warming. tough cut– part of meat that requires longer period of cooking veloutes – a rich white sauce made by thickening chicken or veal stock with flour and water. vermin– various small animals or insects such as rats or cockroaches that are destructive, annoying or hazardous to health. wastage - loss by use white meat- includes the white, fleshy part of the chicken such as the breast.
  • 397. LM-Cookery Grade 10 397 REFERENCE Food service and Catering Management: A Practical Guide Copyright Liberty Commodities Corporation., 2004 ANVIL Publishing Incorporated 8007-B Pioneer Street., Barangay Kapitoloyo, Pasig City 1603 Philippines Editing by Rory C. Subida pp. 1- 19, 57 – 58 Managing A Food – Safe Kitchen A Guide On Sanitation For Food Service Professionals The Maya Kitchen Culinary Arts Center Copyright Liberty Commodities Corp., 2007 Published and Exclusively Distributed by ANVIL PUBLISHING, INC. 8007-B Pioneer St., Brgy. Kapitoloyo Pasig City 1603, Philippines www.anvil.anvilpublishing.com Edited by Rory C. Subida pp. 33 – 37 Chavez, Libia L., et.al., (2006). Basic Foods for Filipinos, 4th edition. Copyright by Merriam and Webbster Bookstore, InC. pp. 299 – 322 Practical Technology and Home Economics Home Economics III Rojo. Duran. Cruz. Marquez.Agustin. SilvA. Reyes. Quitoriano. Bautista Philippine copyright 1998 by Adriana Publishing p. 103 http://www.fnri.dost.gov.ph/index.php?option=content&task=view&id=916 Copyright © 2008 FNRI-DOST. All Rights ReserveD. Updated January 2014 DOST Compound, Bicutan, Taguig City Tel. Nos. (02) 837-2934/837-3164 Catch That Daily Egg Habit FNRI DIGEST Written by ADORACION U. MONDALA, Supervising Science Research Specialist The Professional Chef 8th Edition The Culinary Institute of America Copyright 2006 by The Culinary Institute of America p. 290
  • 398. LM-Cookery Grade 10 398 Competency-based Learning Materials Food Trades Level III Fourth Year PUBLIC TECHNICAL-VOCATIONAL HIGH SCHOOLS Department of Education Republic of the Philippines http://startcooking.com/seven-ways-to-present-food-like-a-chef Seven Ways to Present Food Like a Chef posted in Around the Kitchen by Emily Chapelle https://www.incredibleegg.org/health-and-nutrition/egg-nutrients/nutrient-chart Handbook on Food Safety in Schools, Health and Nutrition Center, Department of Education http://www.eggs.ca/eggs101/view/39/egg-storage-freshness-and-food-safety Eggs 101 Filter by Category Egg Storage, Freshness & Food Safety http://eu.foodinnovation.com/dictionary/B.asp The National Starch Food Innovation Logo is a trademark of National Starch LLC All rights reserveD. All contents Copyright © 2014 Carson, Byrta, M.S., et.al., How you Plan and Prepare Meals, Third edition copyright 1980 by McGraw-Hill, InC. pp. 353 -363 Bennion, Marion and Scheule, Barbara, Introductory Foods, Twelfth Edition Copyright 2004 by Pearson education, InC., Upper Saddle River, New Jersey http://fooD.oregonstate.edu/learn/starch.html Starch Updated: Wednesday, May 23, 2012. Johnson, J.M., E.A. Davis, and J. Gordon. 1990. Interactions of starch and sugar water measured by electron spin resonance and differential scanning calorimetry. Cereal Chemistry 67(3): 286-291.
  • 399. LM-Cookery Grade 10 399 Bean, M.M. and W.T. Yamazaki. 1978. Wheat starch gelatinization in sugar soutions. I. Scurose: Microscopy and viscosity effects. Cereal Chemistry 55(6): 936-944. Tadle, Julieta D. Technology and Home Economics, Culinary Arts Fourth Year. Phoenix Publishing House, InC. Copyright 1995 reprinting 2002 pp. 90- 103 http://chestofbooks.com/health/nutrition/Dietetics-3/Principles-In-Cooking- Cereals.html#.UxVQwOPuIvg This section is from the book "Practical Dietetics: With Reference To Diet In Disease", by Alida Frances Pattee. Also available from Amazon: Practical Dietetics: With Reference to Diet in Disease. Tabbada, Epifania V.,et.al.,Technology and Home Economics. Reprinted 1997, copyright 1993 by Phoenix Publishing House, InC. pp. 77 - 80 Home Technology-Food Management and Service,Meat and Storage of Food, pp. 62-113 Chavez, Lilia C., Basic Foods for Filipinos-4th Edition, Meat Safety,2006, pp. 323-350 Chavez, Lilia L. & de Leon, Sonia; BASIC FOODS FOR FILIPINOS 4th Edition The Major Kitchen Culinary Arts Center; MANAGING A FOOD –SAFE KITCHEN PP. 50 – 60 Ingram, Gays G.;ESSENTIAL DICTIONARY OF CULINARY ARTS pp. 190 – 195 Sandoval, Maria Teresa G., Culinary Arts I and II, 1993, pp. 87-89 Navarro, Leticia S. et al., Homemaking for You and Me III; Food Management and Consumerism, pp. 33-34 De Leon, Sonia Y., Ph.D et al., Basic Foods for Filipino, 1999, pp. 231-253 Lewis, Dora S. et al., FAMILY MEALS HOSPITALITY, 224-237
  • 400. LM-Cookery Grade 10 400 Navarro, Leticia S., HOMEMAKING FOR YOU AND ME III, 27-29 Gisslen, Wayne; PROFESSIONAL COOKING, COPYRIGHT 2007 pp. 154 Home Technology-Food Management and Service,Meat and Storage of Food, pp. 62-113 Chavez, Lilia C., Basic Foods for Filipinos-4th Edition, Meat Safety, 2006, pp. 323-350 Sonia Y. De Leon, Ph. D. et al, Basic Basic Food for Filipinos, Copyright 1999, pp. 258 – 268 Leonard M. Belmonte, Perla B. Del Mundo, Philippine Fiesta Recipe Copyright 1993, pp. 82, 87 and 146 Maya Kitchen; Food Service and Catering Management pp. 65 - 66 Home Technology-Food Management and Service,Meat and Storage of Food, pp. 62-113 Chavez, Lilia C., Basic Foods for Filipinos-4th Edition, Meat Safety, 2006, pp. 323-350 The professional Chef, 8th edition The Culinary Institute of America Copyright 2006 by the The Culinary Institute of America Published by John Wiley and Sons, Inc, Hoboken New Jersey Pages 343-351 Tabbada, Epifania V., et.al. Technology and Home Economics. Reprinted 1997, copyright 1993 by Phoenix Publishing House, Inc. pp. 77 – 80 Ingram, Gays G.;Essential Dictionary of Culinary Arts pp. 190 – 195 Gisslen, Wayne; Professional Cooking, Copyright 2007 pp. 154 Ingram, Gays G.;Essential Dictionary of Culinary Arts pp. 190 - 195 Gisslen, Wayne; Professional Cooking, Copyright 2007
  • 401. LM-Cookery Grade 10 401 pp. 154 Dora S. Lewis, et al, FAMILY MEALS AND HOSPITALITY Copyright 1955 240 – 253 Sonia Y. De Leon, Ph. D. et al, BASIC FOODS FOR FILIPINOS Copyright 1999 pp. 258 – 268 http://www.ifooD.tv/recipe/white-chicken-stock http://ayeshahaq.files.wordpress.com/2009/08/chicken-stock.jpg http://www.videojug.com/film/how-to-make-beef-stock http://howtocook.casaveneracion.com/how-to-make-fish-stock/ http://1.bp.blogspot.com/- 3lQhBUSQkFU/TnihLsD8GbI/AAAAAAAAAIU/hw26OiyEPS4/s1600/DSC_48 14.JPG http://www.blisstree.com/2010/02/26/food/cooking-essentials-mirepoix/ http://mouthyhousewives.com/wendi/hey-hey-hey-its-a-cooking-planit-spice- giveaway http://www.amazon.com/b?node=16310281 http://www.itslife.in/vegetarian-recipes/soups/carrot-cucumber-clear- vegetable-soup http://cbsop.com/recipes/thick-and-creamy-potato-bacon-soup/ http://www.nfsmi.org/documentlibraryfiles/PDF/20100210101846.pdf http://www.nfsmi.org/documentlibraryfiles/PDF/20100210101846.pdf http://www.lakusinA.com/wp-content/uploads/2011/10/image15.png http://www.chicken.org.au/page.php?id=12
  • 402. LM-Cookery Grade 10 402 http://www.vitaille.com/reference/techniques/fabricatechicken/fabri catechicke n.php http://bbq.about.com/od/marinaderecipes/tp/Top-10-Pork-Marinade- Recipes.htm http://www.spike.com/articles/clyn4o/the-top-10-marinades-every- man-must- know http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/cookingmethods/a/dryhea tmoist.htm http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/dryheatcooking/a/roasting .htm http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/dryheatcooking/a/grilling.h tm http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/dryheatcooking/a/sauteing .htm http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/dryheatcooking/a/deepfryi ng.htm http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/cookingmethods/a/dryhea tmoist.htm http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/moistheatcooking/a/boilin g.htm http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/moistheatcooking/a/steam ing.htm http://culinaryarts.about.com/od/moistheatcooking/a/braisi
  • 403. LM-Cookery Grade 10 403 ng.htm http://startcooking.com/seven-ways-to-present- food-like-a-chef http://www.unileverfoodsolutions.com.sg/our-services/your- menu/food- presentation http://www.tasteofhome.com/recipes/ham-and-cheese- frittata#ixzz36CpQIoa7 http://panlasangpinoy.com/2013/02/12/chicken-galantina-recipe/
  • 404. LM-Cookery Grade 10 404 Things to Remember Before You Begin Plating Food Before you begin preparing your dish, you should consider the kind of cuisine you're serving. Are you making a hearty steak dinner, or are you preparing a delicate side dish or appetizer? You can't start building your plate until all of your flavors are finalized, so it's wise to have your ingredients prepared before you begin the actual plating process. Additionally, you'll want to consider portion sizes before you begin plating. To do so, focus on balancing your protein, carbohydrate, and vegetable to create a nutritionally balanced meal. Ultimately, carefully placed ingredients create art, but presentation should never overshadow taste. Guidelines for Plating Food For tips and tricks on how to create a beautiful plate, consider the steps below: 1. Choose the Perfect Plate Selecting the right plate for your meal is key to attractive food presentation. Here are some things to keep in mind:
  • 405. LM-Cookery Grade 10 405 Choose the right plate. One way to conceptualize plating is to think of yourself as an artist, the plate as your canvas, and the food as your medium. Choose the right size plate. Choose your plate wisely by making sure it's big enough to allow your food to stand out, but small enough that your portions don't look too small. Choose a complementary plate color. The color of your plate is also significant. White plates are popular because they create high contrast and provide a neutral background for your colorful creations. Utilize white space by thinking of the rim as your frame, and consider using the rule of thirds to highlight your plate's focal point(s). When applied to cooking, the rule of thirds prescribes placing the focal point of your dish to either the left or right side of the plate, rather than the center. 2. Placing Your Ingredients Here are a few of the most important aspects to consider as you build your dish: Plate with a clock in mind. As you begin plating your ingredients, picture the face of a clock. From the diner's point of view, your protein should be between 3 and 9, your starch or carbohydrate from 9 and 12, and your vegetable from 12 and 3. Use moist ingredients as your base. Another rule of thumb is to plate moist or runny ingredients first, as they tend to move during delivery if they aren't held down
  • 406. LM-Cookery Grade 10 406 by other foods. One way to anchor runny ingredients is by placing other foods on top of them. For example, you can angle sliced meat or vegetables against purees and mashed vegetables. Serve odd amounts of food. If you're serving small foods like shrimp, scallops, or bite-sized appetizers, always give guests odd quantities. Serving 7 brussels sprouts instead of 6 creates more visual appeal, and diners will also perceive that they're getting more food. Place food to create flavor bites. Essentially, flavor bites are forkfuls of food that combine all of the ingredients in your dish into one bite. Creating flavor bites is the perfect accompaniment to creative plating as it pleases both the eye and the taste buds. Don't overcrowd your plate. Be sure to never overcrowd your canvas, and keep it simple by focusing on one ingredient - usually the protein. Finding a focal point also ensures that the accompanying ingredients will play a complementary, supporting role. Mercer Culinary M35136 6 1/2" Offset Precision / Plating Tongs ITEM #: 470M35136 $6.89 /Each Add to Cart
  • 407. LM-Cookery Grade 10 407 3. Pay Attention to the Details As you plate your dish, you'll also want to pay attention to the details: Think about color and contrast. One of the best-kept secrets to beautiful plating is paying close attention to the details. While your focus will obviously be on the protein, considering how the other elements of the plate create color and contrast is also very important. You can create a beautiful background for your plate by adding green vegetables or brightly colored fruits as accent points. Similarly, try to pair ingredients with complementary colors as this will further enhance your dish's visual appeal. Create height on your plate. Another way to catch your guests' eyes is to utilize the power of height. While compactly stacking ingredients isn't as popular as it was 5-10 years ago, creating a tall plate can go a long way towards enhancing visual appeal. You can also balance out taller ingredients by leaning long, flat items against them. For example, you can plate your steak on top of polenta and lean asparagus spears against them at a 45-degree angle. Use texture to enhance your dish. Finally, don't forget about texture. Contrasting a smooth vegetable puree with crunchy onion straws or topping a steak with crumbled blue cheese creates appealing texture combinations that are classic in high-end cuisine.
  • 408. LM-Cookery Grade 10 408 4. Design and Create with Sauces Once you've plated your main ingredients, you're ready to top your dish with delicious sauces. Don't just pour the sauce carelessly all over the plate, though. Instead, think of your squeeze bottle or spoon as a paintbrush, and your sauce as a medium. Then, use them to enhance your plate. One way to do this is to create accent dots on one side of your plate (while considering the rule of thirds) or by lightly drizzling sauce over the main ingredients so guests get a little bit of sauce in every bite. Mercer Culinary M35615 6 Piece Silicone Brush Plating Set ITEM #: 470M35615 $30.49 /Each Add to Cart 5. Use Garnishes Purposefully
  • 409. LM-Cookery Grade 10 409 In the past, chefs casually threw a piece of kale and an orange slice onto every plate as it left their kitchen. However, these garnishes didn't add anything exciting to the dish, and few guests even ate them in the first place. Here are a few examples of smart garnishes and how to incorporate them: Choose edible garnishes. As you finish plating, remember that garnishes must be related to the dish and should always be edible. Ultimately, they're designed to enhance and complement the flavors of the entree you've created, not distract from them. Place garnishes purposefully. Similarly, never heap garnishes in one corner of the plate. Instead, disperse them thoughtfully in order to add color or texture. Also, avoid using unappetizing garnishes like raw herbs, large chunks of citrus, and anything with a strong odor. Lastly, make sure your garnishes are quick and easy to apply, so food still goes out piping hot. Plating Tools of the Trade Having the proper food presentation and plating tools is essential to high-quality plating. Here are a few items you should be sure to purchase if you don't already own them: Decorating Brushes
  • 410. LM-Cookery Grade 10 410 As one of the most important products in any chef's toolkit, decorating brushes have a variety of applications. You can use them for both detailed line work and broad strokes as you apply sauces, or when plating purees and coulis beneath meat or vegetables. Garnishing Kits Garnishing kits come with everything you need to garnish all of your signature dishes, including plating wedges, tongs, squeeze bottles, and brushes. Molds Molds are also very important when plating food. By cutting ingredients to a specific shape and size, you'll provide visual appeal and keep your plate tidy. Ring molds also help you develop height and structure when stacking ingredients. Plating and Precision Tongs Last but not least, you'll want to have precision tongs on hand for placing garnishes or small, delicate foods. Many tongs also feature micro-serrations for improved grip and stability. Plating Wedges Plating wedges come pre-cut with flat, round, or pointed edges and are perfect for smearing sauces and other soft ingredients into designs on your plate.
  • 411. LM-Cookery Grade 10 411 Shavers Shavers work well when shaving or grating chocolate, hard cheeses, or soft vegetables on top of your finished creations. Spoons You'll also want to have a variety of spoons on hand. Saucier spoons help you drag smears of sauce across your plate, and you can also choose a utensil with a tapered bowl that's perfect for drizzling and pouring. Additionally, slotted spoons quickly separate solids from liquids as you complete your presentation. Squeeze Bottles Squeeze bottles are ideal when applying sauces or aiolis to your finished plate. Many of these items come with adjustable, precision control tips that allow you to apply the perfect amount of product. Examples of Plating Styles Here are examples of three popular plating styles: classic, free form, and landscape. To demonstrate them, we used filet mignon, potato puree, carrots, a demi-glace, a pea puree, a lima bean and pea blend, thyme, and fried leeks. Classic Plating
  • 412. LM-Cookery Grade 10 412  1. Pipe the potato puree onto the plate using a pastry bag.  2. Place the carrots next to the puree using precision tongs.
  • 413. LM-Cookery Grade 10 413  3. Garnish the carrots with thyme using precision tongs.  4. Plate the steak using precision tongs.
  • 414. LM-Cookery Grade 10 414  5. Garnish the steak with fried leeks using precision tongs.  6. Drizzle the demi-glace around the plate using a spouted saucier.
  • 415. LM-Cookery Grade 10 415  7. Wipe the edges of the plate with a clean towel.  8. Finished classic plate. Free Form Plating
  • 416. LM-Cookery Grade 10 416  1. Pipe dots of potato puree onto the plate using a pastry bag.  2. Slice the steak into three pieces using a chef's knife.
  • 417. LM-Cookery Grade 10 417  3. Plate the pieces of steak using precision tongs.  4. Place the lima bean and pea blend around the plate using a spoon.
  • 418. LM-Cookery Grade 10 418  5. Plate the carrots using precision tongs.  6. Place dots of pea puree around the plate using a large squeeze bottle.
  • 419. LM-Cookery Grade 10 419  7. Place dots of the demi-glace around the plate using a small squeeze bottle.  8. Garnish the plate with fried leeks using precision tongs.
  • 420. LM-Cookery Grade 10 420  9. Wipe the edges of the plate with a clean towel.  10. Finished free form plate. Landscape Plating
  • 421. LM-Cookery Grade 10 421  1. Place dots of pea puree around the plate using a large squeeze bottle.  2. Paint the pea puree onto the plate using a brush.
  • 422. LM-Cookery Grade 10 422  3. Pipe the potato puree onto the plate using a pastry bag.  4. Plate the carrots using precision tongs.
  • 423. LM-Cookery Grade 10 423  5. Lean the steak against the puree and carrots using precision tongs.  6. Place the lima bean and pea blend around the plate using a spoon.
  • 424. LM-Cookery Grade 10 424  7. Drizzle the demi-glace around the plate using a spouted saucier.  8. Garnish the steak with fried leeks using precision tongs.
  • 425. LM-Cookery Grade 10 425  9. Wipe the edges of the plate with a clean towel.  10. Finished landscape plate. Whether you own a fine dining establishment, upscale restaurant, or eclectic cafe, thoughtful and attentive plating is sure to improve customers' impressions of your business. An awareness of food presentation also allows you to demonstrate your chefs' skills to customers and helps you highlight all of your restaurant's delicious offerings. With an awareness of these basic principles, techniques, and tools, you're sure to enhance your business' plating and increase sales.
  • 426. LM-Cookery Grade 10 426 Does food plating and presentation actually matter? In short, yes. The way you present your food is what tempts customers to try a dish. We eat with our senses: what we see, smell, and feel. And in the age of Instagrammers and food bloggers, food plating and presentation matters more than ever. A study from Oxford gastrophysicist, Professor Charles Spence, suggests that the food presentation can actually make a dish taste better. In the study, Spence gave 60 people 3 salads and asked them to rate each one before and after they ate them. The salads each used the same ingredients but presented them in different ways. One salad was put together with no regard given to presentation, one was neatly arranged, and the third was plated to resemble a painting by artist Wassily Kandinsky. Can you guess which salad diners liked best? It was the salad that resembled a painting. Diners thought it tasted better (29% tastier to be precise), even though it used the exact same ingredients. Spence’s study concluded that consumers were willing to spend as much as three times more on a well-plated dish. Even basic dishes like a salad can benefit from thoughtful presentation—it makes the dish seem more appetizing and valuable. So how can you use that information to your advantage?
  • 427. LM-Cookery Grade 10 427 We talked to chefs Daniel England, Joyce Tang, Tanner Agar, Jim Solomon, Michael Welch, and Brian Poe to learn their favorite food plating and presentation techniques. Each technique focuses on five key food presentation factors: color, arrangement, balance, texture, and how easy it is for guests to eat. The top food presentation and plating techniques 1. Create height on the plate 2. Cut meat horizontally 3. Play with textures 4. Use contrasting colors 5. Match presentation to the restaurant theme 6. Choose the right plates 7. Serve smaller portion sizes 8. Use edible garnishes and decorations 9. When in doubt, keep it simple 10.Express yourself Simplify your kitchen workflows With Lightspeed's Kitchen Display System, cooks spend less time on order logistics; time they can use to create beautifully-plated dishes. Learn more 1. Create height on the plate Daniel England, corporate chef with San Diego’s OMG Hospitality Group, likes to create height as he plates food.
  • 428. LM-Cookery Grade 10 428 “It’s important that you don’t separate the food trying to fill the plate—build from the bottom up,” he says. “If you could use a little structure, you can always purchase a ring mold to start with a base. Simply pack some food in the mold and gently lift it up. Now you have a base to build on.” 2. Cut meat horizontally England also recommends “fanning” or shingling out slices of meat to show off its quality. “Slice your meats on a 45-degree bias, and also slice against the grain of the meat for a more tender cut,” he says. “Show off that perfect medium-rare steak!”
  • 429. LM-Cookery Grade 10 429 3. Play with textures Joyce Tang, chief baking officer at Oakland, California’s La Chinoserie, suggests playing with textures, foams, and sauces to make the dish look more interesting. “I like to play up contrasting textures on my plate,” she adds. “Foams are usually really helpful in plating and can be really easily done, playing around with different sauces and textures.” 4. Use contrasting colors Tang also stresses the importance of playing with contrasting colors. She avoids artificial colors and uses matcha, powdered sugar, or natural colors to catch the eye instead. “The way you present your food is hyper-important” she adds. “The more time you spend on how you present each dish, the more visual interest you can stimulate in folks.” Tanner Agar, owner and chief experience officer at Rye Restaurant in McKinney, Texas, echos that sentiment.
  • 430. LM-Cookery Grade 10 430 Agar recommends using bold colors to create appealing visuals. “The easiest way to add color is to start working with more colorful ingredients. Items like carrots, potatoes, cauliflower, lettuces, beans, and more come in a variety of gorgeous colors,” he says. “The difference a purple cauliflower puree makes on a plate is striking.” 5. Match food presentation to your restaurant theme Jim Solomon, chef and former owner of The Fireplace in Brookline, Massachusetts, says that the style of plating should match the restaurant’s atmosphere.
  • 431. LM-Cookery Grade 10 431 “Small ethnic restaurants, where it appears grandma is cooking in the kitchen, can’t serve plates that try to emphasize vertical, architectural compositions,” he says. “Your guests expect a simple, welcoming presentation that stresses straightforward flavor cooked with heart and served with an unfussy, rustic quality. At relatively pricey, hip and high-end restaurants, guests want to see a degree of artistry and care taken in constructing the dishes.” The way you plate your food should directly reflect your restaurant type. Solomon adds that “food should have an element of height or visual texture, the balance of color and thoughtful garnishes—both carefully placed and intentional in flavor and texture.” 6. Choose the right plates Michael Welch, the executive chef at Backyard Kitchen & Tap in Pacific Beach, California, preaches using the right plate size, color, and style. The color of plate matters as the plate serves as the canvas for your food. “Typically, chefs will stay away from blue plates as there isn’t any naturally blue food and it is thought to be an unappetizing color,” he says. “If you have something with a lot of vibrant color, it might stand out better on a white plate.” 10
  • 432. LM-Cookery Grade 10 432 Jim Solomon echos the importance of choosing the right vessel to present your dish. “Choose a dish vessel that makes it easy for your guest to eat. This is also an opportunity for your chefs to show their personality in the dishes they create.” 7. Serve smaller portion sizes Smaller portion sizes were named by the National Restaurant Association as one of the top five hottest restaurant concepts for 2019. Of course, you still want to serve enough food to satisfy your guests and portion sizes can vary depending on the type of establishment you’re operating, but smaller portions are typically easier to style. Stick to no more than six elements on each dish to prevent them from looking overcrowded.
  • 433. LM-Cookery Grade 10 433 Related read:8 Benefits to Serving Smaller Portion Sizes 8. Use edible garnishes and decorations Garnishes and decorations are a great way of styling your dish, but there are some guidelines you should follow when using them. Whatever you use—whether it’s a herb, spice, or a flower—it needs to be edible. Everything on your plate should be placed with the intention of elevating the dishes taste first, and the way it looks second. 9. When in doubt, keep it simple
  • 434. LM-Cookery Grade 10 434 Michael Welch also emphasizes the value of simplicity. “Overcrowding the plate with unnecessary oils or spices or microgreens just takes away from the food you worked so hard to make,” he explains. “Subtraction is your best ingredient.” Rather than piling on a zillion garnishes or swirls of sauce, let the quality of the cooking speak for itself. “A properly seared steak with some fresh watercress and perfectly roasted baby potatoes will look better than the fanciest of plates with subpar cookery,” Welch says. “Proper cooking will give you a lot of contrast within your ingredients with both texture and color.” 10. Express yourself There’s an art in plating food; it’s where chefs can allow themselves to be creative and have a high impact on how guests perceive the dishes they’re eating. Chef Brian Poe of Bukowski Tavern in Cambridge, and Parish Café and Tip Tap Room in Boston, believes that chefs should approach food plating and presentation just as an artist would approach their next piece. “Presentation should be approached just like art, cooking, and music,” says Poe. “Take a moment to relax and look at what the others are doing, learn a bit of the technique and then find your own voice and style.”
  • 435. LM-Cookery Grade 10 435 One of Poe’s favorite approaches is to go “Jackson Pollock,” holding out the plate like a canvas and splattering it with sauce. “Other times we might look toward a more linear approach with could either be Picasso or street graffiti style,” he adds. “Other times the negative space technique might work.” Time-saving tools to help your food preparation Beautifully plating food takes time. While you want it to look great, you need to plate your food fast as possible—especially if it’s a hot dish that you don’t want to go cold before it reaches your guests. Now, you can’t help how long it takes to properly cook and prepare a meal, but you can give your chefs more time to prepare dishes by streamlining your ordering process. Lightspeed point of sale enables service staff to quickly take a guest’s order and send it to the appropriate kitchen workstation in seconds. Kitchen staff see orders in real-time on their kitchen display system and can notify servers as soon as the dish is ready to be run to guests. Over the course of a service, those saved seconds compound and enable kitchen staff to spend time getting food plating and presentation just right. The right restaurant technology can streamline your ordering and food preparation, which gives your cooks more time to create dishes with strong visual appeal
  • 436. LM-Cookery Grade 10 436 PLATE PRESENTATIONS Chefs labor over their food for countless hours to create a moment of pleasure for their guests. Plate presentation is the final step that showcases their creations. Often taken for granted or left as an afterthought, plate presentation should highlight the quality of the food and preparation techniques while engaging the diner’s senses. Effective plating should be simple enough to execute on a busy night, yet stylish and visually appealing to the guest. Consider the plate with the eye of a photographer to create a composition that brings the various elements of the dish together in harmony. A winning plate presentation is rarely achieved on the first try. Imagination, trial-and- error, and brainstorming in a collaborative fashion often help to achieve successful results. Plate presentations begin with the mastering the basic of proper culinary techniques, high quality food, and plate selections that fit the style of the dish. Numerous plate traditional, contemporary, and international concepts and templates are presented here that have ELEMENTS OF THE PLATE A plate should engage the senses and draw the diner into it much as a painting will draw in the observer. The dish should be carefully planned to balance tastes, textures, colors, and cooking methods. Intertwine the components to bring a sense of composition and harmony. The process begins by incorporating the best and freshest ingredients, executing accurate knife cuts, and using precise cooking techniques that highlight the quality of the food and the talents of the chef. The dish is pulled together by the sauces and other complementary ingredients. The final touch is the judicious use of garnishes. Each element should be there for a reason, adding dimensions of flavor, texture, and color that is in harmony with the finished plate. Main Item The main item is usually the focal point of the plate. On a savory dish this is often a protein such as meat, fish, or poultry that requires
  • 437. LM-Cookery Grade 10 437 butchering skills, portion control, and cooking techniques of the highest caliber, to achieve the desired results that are essential to the success of the plate presentation. Vegetarian dishes frequently highlight pasta, risotto, grains, and legumes, which are delicate items that, once prepared and plated, must be served immediately to retain their fresh appeal. Appetizers, including soups, salads, charcuterie, or small shared plates, should be plated with care and precision for maximum visual impact. Fresh, crisp, colorful salad greens with attractive garnishes, soups presented with the proper consistency and adornments, and charcuterie precisely prepared and sliced, are important for the opening of the meal. Desserts, as the closing chapter of the dining experience, should include fresh, rich, and sweet flavors with textural variety including cookies, crusts and garnishes, bright color variance from the use of fruits, herbs, and sauces, and visual appeal. Proper execution requires the crisp textures of pastry, the smooth and creamy consistency of a gelato or mousse, and colorful garnishes of herbs. For appetizers and desserts that serve as bookends of a meal, there may be one single focal point or several, in which case creative plating will achieve the best results. Supporting Elements Vegetables and fruits often constitute the supporting elements of a dish. Whereas proteins tend to be various shades of brown, beige, and white, fruits and vegetables add color and provide a high visual impact. Precise cuts help to create an elegant presentation. Carefully controlled cooking techniques will yield vibrant colors and accents. Textures achieved through variety in cooking techniques include starches, grains, and legumes prepared as smooth purees, al dente pastas, and creamy risottos; or as crisp textured frites, chips, and croquettes. Supporting components provide height in the form of mounded purees, pastas, and grains to support the main item. They contribute to the overall appearance by providing variety in taste, color, shapes, and textures. Sauces Sauces tie the elements of the dish together providing color and luster. They should be of the correct color, consistency, and texture.
  • 438. LM-Cookery Grade 10 438 Sauces variations include compotes, chutneys, or salsas, as well as the traditional brown, white, and butter sauces. Cold sauces include vinaigrette, mayonnaise emulsions, purees, pesto, and coulis. Sauces may be served under, over, or alongside the item and should have a light consistency yet flavorful punch. The combination of 2 sauces on a plate, for example a chocolate sauce paired with a raspberry coulis adds Garnishes Garnishes provide color and a finished touch to the dish. Choose items that are appropriate to the dish and that echo some of the ingredients. They should be functional, not merely a sprig of rosemary or a wedge of lemon, but incorporated as part of the plate concept. A tuile cookie for enhancing a gelato dessert, a tempura fried Meyer lemon slice to complement a sautéed fillet of fish, or delicate micro- greens to garnish a salad are all examples of functional garnishes. As the final touch of the plate presentation, garnishes must be precisely prepped to maximize their impact and give the plate the final visual pop. PLATE SELECTION We often speak of plates when plating food but service ware includes plates of varying sizes, bowls, cups, and other vessels used to hold the food. Plates and serving vessels come in a variety of colors, shapes, and sizes. They may be simple white, starkly black, or earth tone colors. Other materials may also be incorporated including metal or wood. The style of dinnerware used depends on the type of operation whether causal or formal. Plating choices also are influenced by the style of food, the chefs vision, and the overall image the operation is trying to convey. Styles Bambu Veneerware
  • 439. LM-Cookery Grade 10 439 Carefully consider your audience and the venue when choosing the style of service ware. For example, a fine dining restaurant might consider china or porcelain that conveys a sense of elegance. A casual restaurant may choose ceramic or stoneware that matches a more rustic dining experience, while a quick service operation could opt for economical plastic and melamine. An off-premise catered venue might decide that eco-friendly, disposable and compostable service ware made of bamboo or other recycled materials is a good fit. Service ware also includes materials like glass, wood, slate, tile, and metals of cast iron or stainless steel. Some chefs choose custom- made plates as a way to distinguish their cuisine using natural materials, reclaimed wood, or architecturally unique designs that are as artistic as the food itself. Plates and service ware come in a variety of geometric shapes including classic round, as well as square, oval, or rectangular. They may be teardrop shaped, oblong, or spoon- shaped. Plate Size https://savorjapan.com The size of the plate is dependent on the style of restaurant; for example a family-style restaurant might use larger plates, while a restaurant that features small plates for sharing would logically use small plates. Fine dining restaurants tend to use oversized plates, for example a 12 inch/30 cm dinner plate or a 7-9 inch/18-23 cm appetizer plate. Oversized plates act as a canvas providing negative space that frames the items, provides focus, and brings out the colors and characteristics of the food. Large plates also prevent crowding and food overflowing on the rim. The size of the plate affects the perception of quantity and portion size because the larger the plate, the smaller the portion appears to the guest. Smaller plates, bowls, or ramekins can be nested to accent or highlight components. Japanese Kaiseiki presentations use dishes of various shapes set on a rectangular underliner that emphasizes an asymmetrical or unbalanced, yet organic plate composition. Colors Wild Honey, London
  • 440. LM-Cookery Grade 10 440 The color of service ware affects the overall presentation as well as our taste perceptions and even our appetite. White plates are a traditional color favored by chefs because it makes the vibrant colors of the food more visually appealing to the guest. White plates are like a blank canvas that chefs can design without concern for color clashes from contrasting plate colors. Black plates provide an opposite contrast that can be used effectively with brightly colored foods. However, earth tones of brown, tan, warm gray, and greens that emulate the natural colors found in dirt, moss, trees and rocks can be used when paired with the right food colors. Green foods, including salads and vegetables pair well with yellow plates. Beige foods including pasta, chicken and potatoes pairs well with black and brown plates. Red foods including tomatoes, beef, and red sauces pair well on white plates, while yellow and orange foods including eggs, corn, and curries pair well with blue colors. Solid colors tend to dominate but some restaurants use patterns as a signature style. Some chefs today commission and even help design custom serving pieces and tableware. Colors affect not only how the food appears but also how appetizing it looks to us. Foods with high contrast, for example a grilled steak with asparagus, sweet potato puree, and béarnaise sauce on a white plate, usually appears more appetizing than those with low contrast, for example pasta with a white sauce on a white plate. Foods served on white plates tend to enhance sweet flavors in food, while black plates bring out more savory flavors, and serving food on a red plate has shown to reduce the amount diners eat. Service ware should be chosen to match the food, it’s shapes, and colors. Tools for Plating There are a broad variety of tools that are used for plate presentations including squeeze bottles, spoons, thin-offset spatulas, and brushes for applying sauces on the plate. Tweezers and chop sticks assist in placement of components and delicate garnishes. Slotted, flexible fish spatulas work well for delicate fish and similar items. Stacking rings and geometric molds help to keep the food contained and add height to the layout. Although tongs are
  • 441. LM-Cookery Grade 10 441 useful for sturdy items like steaks and chops, small serving spoons should be used when plating delicate foods including vegetables. Mercer Cutlery, Ateco ELEMENTARY PLATING TIPS Before beginning the plating process determine the focal point by visualizing how it will appear or draw out a plate diagram. The focal point should be the highlight of the plate and where the eye is drawn to first. Bright or contrasting colors, elevation, and food placement helps to highlight items. Usually our eyes scan a food plate much like a picture, from the lower left to the upper right. Photographer’s use this idea setting up a photo, called the rule-of-thirds, that divides a picture into thirds both horizontally and vertically and uses the intersecting lines as focal points. The alignment of the subject should be somewhere at one of these focal points and usually off-center. This template can also be used when apportioning the quantity of food on the plate, which as a general rule means no more than 2/3 of the plate should be filled with food, while the other 1/3 of the plate is negative or empty space. Avoid the rim while creating a buffer zone of ½ inch/13 mm of space from the rim to the flat of the plate. Play with symmetry, geometry, and sequencing of the foods. Use color contrasts to add visual impact and interest to the plate. Odd numbers are more pleasing to the eye than even numbers, so 3 asparagus spears versus four is better. Remember to keep the components of the plate in proportion to each other to balance the presentation. Determine the focal points, lines, and flow, as you apportion space to each element. Don’t crowd the plate; empty space will reinforce the focal point. Plate the foods simply without too much fuss or busyness. Practical Plate Presentations Food plating starts with the basics of functionality and practicality. Remember that the dish must be easily assembled on a busy night. The vision of a plate presentation is only possible to the extent of the quality of the food and the expertise of the kitchen. The food must be prepared and seasoned properly with a fresh, appetizing appearance.
  • 442. LM-Cookery Grade 10 442 Vegetable cuts should be clean and uniform and retain their bright colors, sauces must have a proper consistency, and proteins must be browned and cooked to the correct degree of doneness. Fundamentals for plating start with serving foods on plates that are the correct temperature; hot food on pre-heated plates, and cold food on chilled plates. Establish a focal point, and compose the plate based on a central component. Create variety in shapes, textures, colors, and flavors. Use molded forms when appropriate, but avoid too many geometric and precise shapes that can make the plate look like it was stamped with a cookie cutter. Odd numbers bring unity and harmony to the plate and pull in the surrounding elements. Height creates drama so, much like a sculpture, design the plate with a 3-D approach. Simple techniques like fluffing salad greens, or overlapping slices of meat are simple ways to create height. Use sauces to add color accents to the dish. Garnishes should be relevant to the plate so avoid the use of whole sprigs of rosemary. Spices and herbs on the edge of the plate should be avoided, however the discreet use of chopped herbs that are relevant to the dish are fine for adding color to the composition. Before the plate is presented to the guest, it must be examined and cleaned as needed of excess food and smudges. Use mildly acidulated water with lemon or vinegar and a clean, lint-free cloth to wipe the plate. The kitchen’s responsibility includes how the plate is presented to the guest. In kitchen language this is referred to as the 6 o’clock plate position or the edge of the plate placed closest to the guest. Traditional Plating Traditional plating presents the food simply by using a clock face as a guide. The entrée or main focal point is served between 4 and 8 o’clock. The starch is plated between 9 and 10 o’clock and the vegetables are plated between 2 and 3 o’clock. The sauce is served either under or over the main item. This simple presentation can be effective as long as the elements are balanced. Use the rule-of-thirds
  • 443. LM-Cookery Grade 10 443 concept, overlapping the components, and the plate as a backdrop to frame it. Gain height by leaning the protein on the starch. The sauce will also act as a tying element too. Vertical and Horizontal Lines Strong, clean lines that are vertical, horizontal, or angled, provide neat and logical dimension to the plate. Lines can be created by the placement of proteins, vegetables, or sauces. Patterns emerge by repeating these lines, and variety is introduced through intersecting or overlapping lines. The monotony of repetitive lines is interrupted by the addition of other food shapes and carefully placed garnishes. Arcs, Swooshes, and Swirls Arcs, swooshes, and swirls soften hard angular lines of the plate giving them fluidity and movement in appearance. Sauces and purees are commonly used to create curves. They may be juxtaposed with other plating designs including straight lines, or they may be layered to add height and dimension to the plate. Some styles of arcs use an off-centered approach that creates tension and drawing the diner’s attention to them. Another example of an arc is the golden ratio, a spiral pattern that is found in nature, including snail shells and sunflowers, and used in art and architecture. Stacked Plating Stacked plating brings height and drama to the presentation by layering the components in a vertical style. Items can be layered either free-form or with a mold, but to avoid the cookie cutter effect, vary the ingredients to create different shapes and colors. The focal point of the stack should be off-center, usually to the left, with added garnishes and sauces to create variety and strength in the presentation. Crisp textures can be added at the base, in the form of pastry or vegetables, or as a garnish, in the form of vegetable chips or crisps. Soft textures, purees of root vegetables, provide a base, and double as an anchor to support the main item. Break up round or square
  • 444. LM-Cookery Grade 10 444 geometric shapes with vegetables, pasta, grains or other items. Sauces provide accent and help to pull the dish together. Avoid the bull’s-eye effect when stacking by adding garnished elements cut into various shapes or use a saucing technique that breaks the round shape. Trios Popular for small plates and samplers, trios are another approach to plating that uses odd numbers and negative space. A plate of trios may include a seasonal item prepared three different ways. It may incorporate hot and cold temperatures. It also is an opportunity for a chef to display multiple creative pairings and preparations. Trio plating can be done in a linear fashion, a triangular pattern, or even free form style. Deconstructed Plating The concept of deconstruction re-imagines the elements of a dish in a new light. When presenting a deconstructed dish, it should hold the flavors and textures of the original inspiration (often a classic preparation), while creating a connection to the modern interpretation. Deconstruction is not merely serving separate elements of a dish on a single plate; rather a unified concept is woven throughout the plate. Desserts are good candidates for the deconstructed approach; for example, a strawberry shortcake can be broken down and recreated as a strawberry sorbet, dehydrated shortcake crumbles, crème fraiche sauce, and fresh strawberries. Free Form Plating The organized randomness of free-form plating presents an arbitrary yet natural appearance, however it still requires thought and planning using similar visual rules of composition. Free-form plating, sometimes referred to as organic, gives credence to the concept of “what grows together goes together”. This approach uses a flattened design that is more relaxed. Free form plating, like the deconstructed approach, can be used to create a more fluid approach to food layout
  • 445. LM-Cookery Grade 10 445 and design. This style of plating often uses wood, slate or stone plates to lend a natural element to the presentation Japanese Kaiseki Kaiseki, a formal dining tradition that dates back 400 years to Buddhist monk traditions, balances the tastes, textures, appearance, and colors of the food. Seasonality is important in the cooking as well as in the type of dishes, which are selected to enhance the seasonal nature of the dish using a variety of different shapes, colors, textures, sizes. Each meal is represented by five colors, red, white, green, black, and yellow which contributes to the eye appeal as well as ensuring the nutritional healthiness of the food. Each menu also includes items prepared raw, simmered, fried, steamed, and roasted or grilled. Foods are precisely cut into bite-sized slices or pieces to be easily eaten with chopsticks, and served in small, individual portions in separate dishes. Plate presentations emphasize a slightly askew approach and use height to add for dramatic affect. Negative space is emphasized in the plating philosophy. Kaiseki has influenced western plating styles from Europe to North and South America. Tasting menus available in fine dining restaurants around the world draw inspiration from the Japanese concept of small multi-course plates that showcase a chef’s repertoire emphasizing seasonal and local foods